summaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
authornfenwick <nfenwick@pglaf.org>2025-02-06 20:52:46 -0800
committernfenwick <nfenwick@pglaf.org>2025-02-06 20:52:46 -0800
commit786c07c7c0dbabf1e698e816dd5d18f98a5c3070 (patch)
treedaec052050a8cf98815bdf882b7599bad5a85a9e
parentf2f1b4f328d1892a6f176129d5d178476b533eea (diff)
NormalizeHEADmain
-rw-r--r--.gitattributes4
-rw-r--r--LICENSE.txt11
-rw-r--r--README.md2
-rw-r--r--old/54008-0.txt11719
-rw-r--r--old/54008-0.zipbin172447 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54008-h.zipbin3437415 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54008-h/54008-h.htm14478
-rw-r--r--old/54008-h/images/cover.jpgbin152231 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54008-h/images/i_032.jpgbin99312 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54008-h/images/i_046.jpgbin85218 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54008-h/images/i_048.jpgbin96497 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54008-h/images/i_051.jpgbin99434 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54008-h/images/i_069.jpgbin94002 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54008-h/images/i_072.jpgbin101295 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54008-h/images/i_099.jpgbin98749 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54008-h/images/i_101.jpgbin100371 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54008-h/images/i_102.jpgbin100550 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54008-h/images/i_108.jpgbin96022 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54008-h/images/i_110.jpgbin95066 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54008-h/images/i_113.jpgbin94772 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54008-h/images/i_115.jpgbin101367 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54008-h/images/i_116.jpgbin101766 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54008-h/images/i_117.jpgbin92441 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54008-h/images/i_119.jpgbin98212 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54008-h/images/i_120.jpgbin93538 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54008-h/images/i_121.jpgbin94928 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54008-h/images/i_122.jpgbin97130 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54008-h/images/i_124.jpgbin94611 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54008-h/images/i_127.jpgbin94446 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54008-h/images/i_128.jpgbin97462 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54008-h/images/i_134.jpgbin100592 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54008-h/images/i_136.jpgbin98761 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54008-h/images/i_139.jpgbin95899 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54008-h/images/i_141.jpgbin100571 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54008-h/images/i_145.jpgbin100718 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54008-h/images/i_147.jpgbin97929 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54008-h/images/i_150.jpgbin95673 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54008-h/images/i_152.jpgbin94401 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54008-h/images/i_222.jpgbin90306 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/54008-h/images/i_250.jpgbin95786 -> 0 bytes
40 files changed, 17 insertions, 26197 deletions
diff --git a/.gitattributes b/.gitattributes
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d7b82bc
--- /dev/null
+++ b/.gitattributes
@@ -0,0 +1,4 @@
+*.txt text eol=lf
+*.htm text eol=lf
+*.html text eol=lf
+*.md text eol=lf
diff --git a/LICENSE.txt b/LICENSE.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6312041
--- /dev/null
+++ b/LICENSE.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,11 @@
+This eBook, including all associated images, markup, improvements,
+metadata, and any other content or labor, has been confirmed to be
+in the PUBLIC DOMAIN IN THE UNITED STATES.
+
+Procedures for determining public domain status are described in
+the "Copyright How-To" at https://www.gutenberg.org.
+
+No investigation has been made concerning possible copyrights in
+jurisdictions other than the United States. Anyone seeking to utilize
+this eBook outside of the United States should confirm copyright
+status under the laws that apply to them.
diff --git a/README.md b/README.md
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..c2b6678
--- /dev/null
+++ b/README.md
@@ -0,0 +1,2 @@
+Project Gutenberg (https://www.gutenberg.org) public repository for
+eBook #54008 (https://www.gutenberg.org/ebooks/54008)
diff --git a/old/54008-0.txt b/old/54008-0.txt
deleted file mode 100644
index ef6efb1..0000000
--- a/old/54008-0.txt
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,11719 +0,0 @@
-The Project Gutenberg EBook of Technic and Practice of Chiropractic, by
-Joy Maxwell Loban
-
-This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
-almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
-re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
-with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org/license
-
-
-Title: Technic and Practice of Chiropractic
-
-Author: Joy Maxwell Loban
-
-Release Date: January 18, 2017 [EBook #54008]
-
-Language: English
-
-Character set encoding: UTF-8
-
-*** START OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK TECHNIC AND PRACTICE ***
-
-
-
-
-Produced by Turgut Dincer, Charlie Howard, and the Online
-Distributed Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net (This
-file was produced from images generously made available
-by The Internet Archive)
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-Transcriber’s Note: Boldface text is enclosed in =equals signs=;
-italics text is enclosed in _underscores_.
-
-
-
-
- TECHNIC AND PRACTICE
- OF
- CHIROPRACTIC
-
- BY
- JOY M. LOBAN, D. C., PH. C.
-
- Professor of Anatomy and of Theory and Practice of Chiropractic
- at the Universal Chiropractic College. Formerly
- Professor of Chiropractic Analysis at the
- Palmer School of Chiropractic
-
-
- SECOND EDITION
- _Revised and Enlarged_
-
-
- PUBLISHED BY
- UNIVERSAL CHIROPRACTIC COLLEGE
- DAVENPORT, IOWA
- 1915
-
-
-
-
- COPYRIGHT 1915
- BY
- JOY M. LOBAN
-
-
- HAMMOND PRESS
- W. B. CONKEY COMPANY
- CHICAGO
-
-
-
-
- THIS BOOK IS
-
- =Dedicated=
-
- TO THE GIRL WHO HAS BEEN MY STAFF
- AND LANTERN, AIDING AND LIGHTING
- ME ON MY WAY IN THIS NEW FIELD
-
- =My Wife=
-
-
-
-
-TABLE OF CONTENTS
-
-
- PAGE
-
- =Preface to First Edition= 9
-
- =Preface to Second Edition= 11
-
- =Introduction= 13
-
- =Vertebral Palpation= 15
- Definition 15
- General Propositions 15
- Habits of Palpation 15
- Facts Concerning the Spine 16
- Preparation of Patient 22
- Position of Patient 22
- The Record 23
- The Count 29
- Atlas Palpation 35
- The Group Method 37
- The Individual Subluxation 40
- Palpation in Position B 46
- Palpation in Position C 48
- Transverse Palpation 49
- Curves and Curvatures 53
- Difficulties in Palpation 59
- Landmarks 61
- Mental Attitude 63
-
- =Nerve Tracing= 64
- Organ Tracing 64
- What Nerves are Traceable 64
- Suggestion 67
- Place in Diagnosis 67
- Technic of Nerve Tracing 68
-
- =Subluxations= 76
- Definition--How Produced 76
- Law Governing Location of 78
- Varieties of Subluxations 80
-
- =Technic of Adjusting= 89
- General Principles of Adjusting 89
- Special Technic (Thirty-two Moves) 99
- Preferable Adjustments 155
-
- =The Cause of Disease= 165
- Simple Subluxation Disease 184
- Secondary Causes 185
- Germ Diseases 185
- Diet 192
- Poisons 194
- Exposure 198
- Bodily Excesses 201
- Inflammation 202
- The Process of Cure 208
- Adjuncts 215
-
- =Spino-Organic Connection= 217
- General Discussion 217
- Special Nerve Connections 235
- Table of Diseases and Adjustments 257
-
- =Practice= 276
- Office Equipment 277
- Schedule of Examination 292
- Necessity for Correct Diagnosis 298
- Frequency of Adjustments 302
- Specific vs. General Adjusting 303
- Talking Points 306
- Promises to Patients 308
- Retracing of Disease 309
- Limitations of Chiropractic 312
- The Use of Adjuncts 315
- Personality 319
-
- =Chiropractic Prognosis= 322
- General Discussion 322
- Practical Prognosis 323
-
-
-
-
-Preface to First Edition
-
-
-This little work is offered to the profession without apology for its
-brevity or its form. It has been prepared because of an immediate and
-pressing need for such a guide in our colleges, and is offered abroad
-under the impression that many practicing Chiropractors feel the same
-need.
-
-It is intended for handy reference and clinical use and is arranged
-as systematically as possible, style being everywhere sacrificed to
-utility.
-
-The author lays no claim to the origination of any of the subject
-matter of this book nor to having invented any of the movements
-described under Technic of Adjusting. The arrangement and phraseology
-are in the main original. The intention has been merely to condense
-into practical and convenient form for students and practitioners
-certain knowledge now held and utilized in our profession.
-
-The author feels himself indebted to the entire profession for the
-information embodied in this work, and to scientists of all time upon
-the results of whose infinite and painstaking research are based our
-present day advancement; to the many friends and co-workers whose
-valuable criticisms and suggestions have aided in this labor; and to
-his students, past and present, who have furnished the necessary
-encouragement and inspiration for the achievement of this, the author’s
-first text-book.
-
-The chief merit of this effort--if merit there be--is its honesty. The
-author has endeavored to set forth fairly and simply the facts and
-hypotheses with which we have to deal. Its chief offense, in the eyes
-of many, will lie in its being just what it purports to be--a book on
-Chiropractic. Constructive criticism and suggestion are invited from
-all sources, for by our interchange of thoughts we grow.
-
- J. M. L.
-
-
-
-
-Preface to Second Edition
-
-
-The republication of this book has been made possible by the sustained
-friendship of the profession for it, and the author’s thanks are due
-its many buyers and readers who, by their recommendation, have made it
-both possible and necessary that this book should live and grow.
-
-The new edition has been somewhat enlarged by the introduction of
-additional matter into each section and by the addition of two entire
-new chapters on “Preferable Adjustments” and “Chiropractic Prognosis.”
-New plates have been added and old errors corrected. In every way an
-attempt has been made to express with conservatism the real advance
-made by Chiropractic since the first edition was put on the press.
-
- J. M. L.
-
-
-
-
-INTRODUCTION
-
-
-No two students, approaching for the first time the study of
-Chiropractic, approach from the same angle. Their viewpoints differ. In
-order that all may gain as nearly as possible the same viewpoint from
-which to consider in turn the sections of this book, it will be well
-if each student reads the entire book before beginning to memorize its
-parts and convert them into practical working knowledge.
-
-An effort should be made, abandoning all other, to acquire the
-_Chiropractic viewpoint_. This accomplished, the rest of the task
-requires time and patience alone, without waste labor. The section
-on Vertebral Palpation should be studied step by step, the study of
-each step being combined with practice in it. Likewise the section on
-Nerve-Tracing, theory preceding practice. The study of the Technic
-of Adjusting should occupy those months immediately preceding the
-commencement of actual adjusting practice and continue during such
-practice. The chapters on Practice are intended for the student about
-to enter the field. The table of Spino-Organic Connection can be best
-understood by those who have studied or are studying the anatomy and
-physiology of the nervous system.
-
-Let every page be studied with a good medical dictionary open at the
-elbow of the reader. Pass no word without comprehension, no detail
-without mastery. He who would seek to modify the life processes of the
-human body must fortify himself against fatal error with every bit of
-knowledge he can acquire.
-
-
-
-
-VERTEBRAL PALPATION
-
-
-Definition
-
-Vertebral Palpation consists in the use of the tactile sense to
-determine the position, relation, size, shape, and as far as possible
-the condition, of the segments of the spinal column, in order thus to
-discover the primary causes indicative of disease.
-
-Or, Vertebral Palpation is the name given the manual examination of
-spinal vertebrae.
-
-
-General Propositions
-
-Every palpation should be made with the adjustment of the vertebrae in
-mind. The record of palpation should be a correct guide as to direction
-of adjustment. No subluxation impossible of adjustment should be
-recorded.
-
-The two essentials of correct palpation are _accurate perception_ and
-_correct reasoning_. To secure the first, a certain approved manner
-of using the hands is herein laid down and a considerable amount of
-tactile sense development by practice is required. Correct reasoning
-depends upon knowledge of all the important facts concerning the spine
-and of the rules governing palpation.
-
-Absolute concentration is required and to this end many of the
-following rules are directed.
-
-
-Habits of Palpation
-
-Every palpater unconsciously forms habits of thought and action. These
-habits may be good or bad. We deliberately form a habit of holding the
-first three fingers closely together or the habit of using a downward
-glide, but we should avoid the habit of finding certain subluxations
-because they are usual and expected rather than because they are
-actually there. For instance, one may easily form a habit of listing
-every other vertebra in the spine, his whole record thus depending upon
-his first choice.
-
-Because of this perfectly natural tendency to establish a routine
-of thought and action and to follow it precisely, it is best not to
-attempt palpation without the aid of an experienced teacher until after
-correct habits have been formed. Once formed, a palpation habit, right
-or wrong, is very hard to break. Many a teacher has expended himself
-uselessly in the effort to undo some technical fault acquired by the
-student in a blundering undirected trial.
-
-
-Facts Concerning the Spine
-
-The spinal column is composed of twenty-six segments called vertebrae,
-twenty-four movable and two fixed. The movable vertebrae are divided
-for convenience in study into three sections. There are seven Cervical
-vertebrae, twelve Dorsal, and five Lumbar in the normal individual.
-The number of Dorsals or Lumbars may vary by one in a rare case. These
-variations occur in about one spinal column in each five hundred
-and are usually in the Lumbar region, which may contain four or six
-vertebrae. A prominent first sacral spinous process may be mistaken for
-an extra Lumbar.
-
-Five vertebrae have special names. The first Cervical is called Atlas;
-the second Cervical, Axis; the seventh Cervical is commonly known as
-Vertebra Prominens on account of its long and large spinous process,
-although this long process belongs to the sixth Cervical or first
-Dorsal instead in 35% of all cases; the large, irregularly fusiform
-vertebra just below the Lumbars and between the ilia is called the
-Sacrum; and the smaller one below it, the Coccyx. The latter is
-occasionally missing.
-
-Each vertebra except the Atlas is composed of a body and an arch; the
-arch is made up of two pedicles, short, thick plates of bone extending
-outward and backward from the postero-lateral surface of the body
-nearer its upper than its lower border, two laminae, thin plates of
-bone extending backward and inward from their union with the pedicles
-and joining behind to form the spinous process, and has projecting from
-it seven processes, two transverse, one spinous, and four articular,
-two of which are superior and two inferior. The foramen enclosed by
-the body, pedicles, and laminae is called the neural or vertebral
-foramen and the canal formed by the connection of these foramina
-and completed by the ligaments which unite the arches is called the
-neural, vertebral, or spinal canal. It contains the spinal cord with
-its membranes and the roots of the spinal nerves. By means of the four
-articular processes each true vertebra except the first articulates
-with its fellows above and below.
-
-The body of the vertebra is its largest portion and is joined to its
-fellows by fibrocartilaginous disks which are sufficiently elastic to
-permit some torsion and compression. Nine sets of ligaments, including
-the intervertebral substance just mentioned, bind the vertebrae firmly
-together. Many muscles are attached to the spinal column.
-
-The intervertebral foramina are openings at the sides of the vertebrae,
-formed by the notching of apposed pedicles. These openings are
-surrounded by bone, cartilage, and ligaments and vary in shape in
-different sections of the spine. They permit the exit of the spinal
-nerves and their sheaths, the re-entrance of some nerve fibres into the
-neural canal, and the passage of blood-vessels to and from the cord.
-The entire philosophy of Chiropractic focuses at the intervertebral
-foramen because there we find the primary cause of all pathological
-changes in the body.
-
-The spinous and transverse processes merit particular description
-since they are the levers by which vertebrae are adjusted and nerve
-impingements at the intervertebral foramina corrected. But it will
-be found easiest to describe these processes separately in different
-sections of the spine and before proceeding to this description, a
-brief picture of the peculiar vertebrae will be presented.
-
-The _Atlas_ is a bony ring composed of two arches, an anterior and a
-posterior, separated in the recent state by a transverse ligament. Its
-body is detached and appears as a tooth-like projection upward from
-the body of the Axis, the odontoid process, which articulates with the
-anterior arch of the Atlas and around which the Atlas rotates, a ring
-around a pivot. The Atlas supports the head upon its lateral masses,
-two wedge shaped bodies between the anterior and posterior arches,
-thinner internally than externally. It has no spinous process but
-merely a tubercle where the laminae join, so that it can be palpated
-only from the sides upon the tips of its long transverses. The first
-Cervical, or suboccipital, nerves emerge by a groove above the pedicles
-instead of through a foramen.
-
-The _Axis_, or second Cervical, is distinguished by its large, strong
-spinous process, which is bifid at its tip, by its superior articular
-processes which rest upon body, pedicles, and transverses, and by its
-odontoid process, upreared from the body.
-
-The _Seventh Cervical_, or Vertebral Prominens, usually has a large
-spinous process, presents no foramina in its transverse processes, or
-only one, the left, and shows no facets on body or transverse for the
-rib articulation, as do the Dorsals.
-
-The _Sacrum_ is the largest vertebra; is curved with its convexity
-backward; is commonly made up of five fused segments; has only
-rudimentary spinous and transverse processes except the first; and
-shows sixteen openings, eight anterior and eight posterior, or four
-on either side of the median line in front and the same number and
-arrangement behind. These openings permit the exit of the anterior and
-posterior primary divisions of the sacral nerves separately.
-
-The _Coccyx_, usually composed of four fused segments, is a triangular
-bone which articulates with the Sacrum above and is free at its distal
-extremity. Its portion of the neural canal is open posteriorly and
-contains merely the thread-like termination of the cord membranes.
-It is frequently ankylosed to the Sacrum, sometimes in an abnormal
-position so as to impinge the single pair of coccygeal nerves.
-
-The different regions of the spine show decided differences in
-structure, though all resemble each other. The Cervicals are smallest,
-the Dorsals next in size, and the Lumbars largest and strongest of
-the movable vertebrae. The Dorsals have facets and demi-facets for
-the articulation of the twelve pairs of ribs with their bodies and
-intervertebral substance, as well as oval facets upon the anterior
-aspect of their transverses for articulation with the tubercles of the
-ribs.
-
-The _spinous processes_ are smallest and usually bifurcated down to
-and including the fifth. The sixth may show a plain bifurcation, or on
-any Cervical the bifurcation may be so small as to be imperceptible to
-touch. The spinous process of the second overlies that of the third so
-as to make the latter very difficult of detection. Indeed, all cervical
-spinous processes down to the sixth are harder to palpate than those in
-other regions, owing to the anterior cervical curve. The processes lie
-in a groove between prominent muscle ridges.
-
-Dorsal spinous processes are usually single, although the last four,
-three, two, or one may show plain bifurcation in certain individuals.
-They are somewhat pointed and overlap, except the lower ones, the
-obliquity being greatest in the mid-dorsal region and least at the
-first and last dorsals.
-
-Lumbar vertebrae have broad, flat-tipped spinous processes much larger
-than the others. The last Dorsal may sometimes appear like a Lumbar in
-shape, so that the change in shape commonly supposed to mark a division
-between Dorsals and Lumbars is not always an infallible guide.
-
-The _transverse_ processes in the cervical region are very short
-and lie close in front of the articular processes. They are pierced
-by foramina for the vertebral artery and vein, except the seventh,
-which may have one foramen or none. They are difficult of access for
-palpation because of their shortness and the amount of overlying
-muscle, but may be reached from the front and side by drawing back the
-sternomastoid. They increase in length from the second to the seventh.
-
-In the dorsal region the transverses are larger and stronger and
-more constant in size, shape, and direction, serving to support rib
-articulations. They extend in a curved direction outward, backward, and
-slightly upward from the union of laminae and pedicles and terminate
-in a large subcutaneous club-shaped extremity which may be readily
-palpated. The eleventh and twelfth dorsal transverses do not articulate
-with the ribs and must therefore be used with caution or not at all
-as levers for adjustment. The dorsal transverses are located on a
-higher level than the spinous processes. In the case of the upper three
-dorsals the transverse lies in a plane which would cross the mid-spinal
-line between its own and the next superior spinous. In the mid-dorsal
-region the transverse is even with the spinous of the vertebra above,
-though the relation may vary slightly. The lower dorsals return to the
-same relation as the upper.
-
-The transverse processes of the Lumbars are relatively light compared
-with the general structure of the vertebrae and are found just even
-with the interspace between their own and the adjacent superior spinous
-process. They vary greatly in size, length and strength and may be used
-as levers for adjustment only when they are large enough to be clearly
-palpable through the muscle mass which separates them from the body
-surface.
-
-
-Preparation of Patient
-
-In all cases where a complete spinal examination is intended the
-preparation is essentially the same. Have patient arrange clothing so
-that the spine is exposed to the touch throughout. Avoid bands of cloth
-across the spine, as these interfere with the necessary continuous
-gliding movement of the fingers. Advise the patient, if a female, to
-wear waist or dressing sack, reversed, and have skirts loosened at the
-waist. If a man, he should strip to the waist and wear coat or coat
-shirt reversed.
-
-
-Position of Patient
-
-This varies widely according to circumstances but for general purposes
-use position:
-
-(A) Place patient on stool, feet even on floor and body in an easy,
-relaxed position. This may be modified by asking him to lean forward
-and rest elbows on knees, evenly, to facilitate Lumbar palpation.
-Patient’s head may be erect or flexed forward or backward but should
-never be rotated or laterally flexed during Cervical palpation except
-for the purpose of locating some particular transverse process.
-
-(B) In emergency cases, where haste is urgent or patient is unable
-to assume a sitting posture, or as a means of re-verifying previous
-palpation, place the patient on adjusting table prone, face down. (See
-Fig. 2.) Remember that with the head lying upon its side the upper
-dorsal vertebrae will assume a curve with its convexity away from the
-face. Palpation in position (B) should precede every adjustment and, to
-guard against error, should be considered as a necessary preliminary to
-the movement of any vertebra.
-
-(C) For palpation preparatory to using the Rotary, the Break, and other
-moves, have patient lying on his back with his head projecting beyond
-upper end of bench and resting on the hands and wrists of the palpater,
-or have the patient’s head rest on the bench, a less accessible
-position.
-
-
-General Observation
-
-Each spinal examination should begin with a general survey by which
-curvatures, marked prominences, etc., may be appreciated. Frequently
-some very important fact may be noted which would escape attention upon
-minute examination.
-
-
-THE RECORD
-
-The record of spinal palpation, when completed, should be an accurate
-history of the irregularities found in the spine and an accurate
-guide to adjustment. It must be brief and concise as well as readily
-comprehensible. One should be able to see at a glance any desired
-point on the record, so that it may be used during the adjustment
-without undue loss of time or attention. Obviously the introduction of
-any useless mark or sign, such as the inclusion of a number and blank
-space for each vertebra of the spine, or all possible subluxations with
-indications as to which do or do not exist in the given case, is a
-mistake.
-
-The record should contain three parallel columns. In the first column
-place the number of the vertebra chosen for adjustment. In the second,
-place the direction of subluxation. In the third, place the word or
-sign which stands for the indicated movement for correction.
-
-
-Number of Vertebra
-
-The letter C is used to indicate Cervical, D Dorsal, L Lumbar, and S
-Sacrum in the record. Immediately following the letter which designates
-the region, place the number which shows the position in that region
-occupied by the vertebra in question, the _relation_ of that vertebra
-to its fellows. For instance, the third Cervical vertebra is C 3, the
-eleventh Dorsal D 11. To the S for Sacrum append B or A to indicate
-that the Base or Apex is described as to position. This _locates_ the
-subluxation. For a record of full spine palpation it is unnecessary
-to use the letters C, D, or L more than once, as subluxations are
-recorded in the order of their occurrence from above downward. A dash
-should always follow the number of the vertebra to separate it from the
-letters in the second column for convenience in reading.
-
-
-Direction of Subluxation
-
-The directions considered in palpating or recording subluxations are
-six in number, namely:
-
- Name Abbreviation Meaning
- Posterior P Toward the rear (Dorsad)
- Anterior A Toward the front (Ventrad)
- Right R Toward the right hand
- Left L Toward the left hand
- Superior S Toward the head (Cephalad)
- Inferior I Toward the feet (Caudad)
-
-As the fingers glide down the spine the _posterior_ vertebra is the one
-which interposes itself in the path of the fingers, forcing them to
-describe an outward curve. It is the hill on the automobile road which
-forces the surmounting of a curved departure from the evenness of the
-road. It is _relatively_ posterior to its fellows above and below.
-
-The _anterior_ vertebra, to the gliding fingers, means a depression,
-a valley. It causes the fingers to dip inward from the level of their
-course.
-
-The _right_ or the _left_ subluxation is appreciated by running the
-tips of the fingers down the sides of the spinous processes. It really
-indicates rotation of the whole vertebra more often than any other
-malposition.
-
-We say that a vertebra is _superior_ when its spinous process is nearer
-the one above than the one below. It requires a measuring of relative
-distances. The degree to which a vertebra is superior is measured, not
-by its actual closeness to its fellow, but by the relation between the
-space above and the space below.
-
-Likewise a vertebra is _inferior_ when it is closer to its fellow below
-than to its fellow above.
-
-_Anterior_ subluxations are rarely recorded as such, except of the
-Cervicals or the last Lumbar, because no means of properly adjusting
-them is known to Chiropractic.
-
-
-Order of Letters
-
-In the second column, that devoted to direction of subluxation, the
-letter P or A should appear, if at all, as this antero-posterior
-relation is the first thing to be determined concerning any individual
-subluxation chosen except the Atlas. With the Atlas the first letter
-will be R or L. Next the laterality or rotation is indicated by R or L
-in every case except Atlas subluxation. Finally the S or I indicates
-the last point to be determined, the _approximation_ of the vertebra to
-its fellows. This last letter usually shows thinning of intervertebral
-fibrocartilage, which will be discussed elsewhere.
-
-If you desire to emphasize any direction as being more important than
-another, underscore the letter which stands for that direction with
-a single line. If two directions are to be emphasized, one more than
-another, underscore the one with two lines and the other with one. For
-example, if a vertebra is found to be quite decidedly posterior, _more_
-plainly to the right, and _slightly_ superior, the record will show it
-thus: _P R S_.
-
-
-Movement for Correction
-
-This is indicated in the third column, separated from the second by a
-dash, by means of some brief word or words which describe a certain
-movement used in adjusting. The descriptive words and terms used in
-this work are all given and explained under Technic of Adjusting. (See
-p. 89.) Each word or term stands for a definite method of procedure.
-The best movement for the correction of any subluxation of any vertebra
-may be found by reference to the section on Preferable Adjustments,
-p. 155. If other terms are more familiar to the student, or in time
-replace those which are now common usage in the profession, they will
-be brief and clear and may be easily substituted for those given.
-
-Palpation, fixing in the mind of the palpater the manner and direction
-of the subluxation, should also suggest as the obvious correction a
-movement calculated to reverse the procedure by which the subluxation
-was first produced. In other words, a certain kind of subluxation
-stands as the effect of a certain application of force along definite
-lines determinable by examination. Its correction should be made in a
-reverse direction along the same lines. By recording with the record
-of subluxation the desired correction, the adjuster may be reminded
-daily without new palpation of the movement best fitted to the case.
-If on trial it is decided that some other movement than the one first
-indicated will better overcome the abnormality, the record should be
-changed to correspond to the decision, and thereafter followed.
-
-
-Complete Record
-
-The completed record in three columns separated by dashes can be
-conveniently read. It contains no superfluous mark of any kind. It
-conveys all the necessary information leading to adjustment except
-diagnosis and case history. This palpation record should be a part of a
-more comprehensive record concerning the case in full and is best kept
-on a card, the reverse side of which carries case history. If kept in
-an indexed card file it may be referred to daily without loss of time
-and an accurate handling of each case be assured.
-
-Have card perfectly blank on palpation record side. For convenience
-in reading draw a heavy line beneath the last Cervical subluxation
-recorded and another beneath the last Dorsal, thus dividing the record
-as the spine is divided, into three divisions.
-
-Below follows a sample palpation record. It will be seen that here in
-a very small space may be recorded a great deal of information, for
-this record contains an accurate list of the primary causes of every
-disease, weakness, or tendency to disease with which the patient is
-afflicted, together with the methods for their removal.
-
-
-Sample Record
-
- C 1 R Break
- 4 P L S Double Contact
- 7 L I Rotary
- ——————————————————————————————————————————————
- D 3 P R Recoil
- 7 L S Pisiform Single Transverse
- 10 P S Heel Contact
- ——————————————————————————————————————————————
- L 1 P L I Recoil
- 4 R Lumbar Single Transverse
-
-
-Use of Record
-
-The above record is made with patient sitting. It is to be used while
-patient is lying upon the adjusting bench. The most convenient way is
-to begin palpation in the Dorsal region after patient has been placed
-for adjustment, in this way. If first subluxation recorded is D 2--P R
-I, find the vertebra in the region of D 2 which appears P R I to the
-touch. To avoid error, let the fingers then glide downward to the next
-recorded subluxation. If this be found to agree in number and direction
-with the record, it is safe to assume that the first one found was
-correctly numbered in the palpater’s mind; if not, that an error was
-made. This can be quickly done. Before each adjustment the vertebra
-adjusted should be found to agree with the record; by doing this
-constant accuracy may be assured.
-
-
-THE COUNT
-
-Having described the preparation of the patient and the different
-positions in which he may be palpated, noted that all records should
-be made in position A, mentioned that general observation which should
-immediately precede actual palpation, and interpolated a description of
-the record to be made during the palpation, with its use afterward,
-we are now ready to consider the technic of the palpation itself. This
-should begin with a count of the vertebrae and continue with Atlas
-palpation, general examination of a group of vertebrae, and special
-examination of individual subluxations in the group. Each of these
-tasks will be considered in turn.
-
-
-Position of Palpater
-
-This depends upon the position of the patient. The letters which follow
-correspond to the letters describing the position of the patient. q. v.
-
-(A) If you desire to palpate with the right hand stand at patient’s
-left and face toward him with left hand resting on his shoulder
-or supporting his forehead as you palpate Dorsals or Cervicals
-respectively. To use left hand stand similarly at patient’s right. Have
-palpating arm relaxed and easy, extending as nearly as possible so that
-the forearm and hand make a right angle with the patient’s spine. Let
-the arm and hand remain close to the patient’s body at all times. Keep
-the elbow close to your own body and avoid flexion of wrist on forearm,
-or of forearm on arm at more than a right angle, since such flexion
-would bring about too great muscular tension for close appreciation of
-tactile impressions. If necessary lean sidewise and elevate shoulder
-and palpating arm in order to preserve the proper relation between hand
-and arm when hand must be elevated as in palpating upper Cervicals.
-
-(B) As above, if you desire to use right hand stand on left side of
-patient and if left hand stand on right. If the patient lies on a bench
-so constructed that the head lies on one side, his face must be toward
-the palpater in order that the same hand may be used in Cervical as in
-other regions. It is inadvisable to change hands except when absolutely
-unavoidable. If the patient’s head must be turned from you palpate the
-Cervicals by standing with feet pointed away from patient and turn your
-body with one hand resting on patient’s head to hold it steady and the
-other palpating as if you were standing on the other side. This is
-difficult and it is rarely necessary to count Cervicals in position B
-if the record be used as advised on page 29.
-
-(C) Palpation preparatory to the Cervical adjustment will be made in
-this position or in position A, according as you intend adjusting the
-Cervicals in the prone or the sitting posture. For the prone position
-have the patient’s head supported by either hand, while the other
-hand is applied with the tips of the first three fingers resting on
-the tips of the spinous processes, from which position they may glide
-smoothly down, noting deviations from normal in position as well as
-mentally numbering the vertebrae. While this method of palpation is
-not so accurate as those given elsewhere, and should be used only as
-an additional means after record has been made, it will always be
-necessary to make a count before adjusting any Cervical.
-
-
-Use of Hands
-
-In general it may be stated that the first three fingers of one
-hand are used with an easy downward gliding movement in which only
-the _tips_ of the three fingers, evenly placed, are in contact with
-the patient’s body. This concentrates the attention upon a very
-small tactile surface which may become extremely sensitive by the
-concentration. Indeed, it may be said that vertebral palpation only
-became an art through the application of the principle of concentration
-in practice. The gliding movement is always _downward_, because to
-palpate upward will mass the superficial tissues under the fingers
-and confuse the palpater. If there is uncertainty in the mind of the
-palpater, as he proceeds, as to the identity of any vertebra he should
-go back to the second Cervical, or to any certainly recognizable
-vertebra previously fixed in mind, and recount.
-
-The use of the hands for Atlas palpation differs from their use
-elsewhere and will be described under separate head. The use of the
-hands with the patient lying face upward is also different. If the
-patient be lying prone, the same three fingers are used and the same
-downward glide as with patient sitting.
-
-[Illustration: Fig. 1. Position of hands in palpation for record.]
-
-With patient sitting, the palpater should step from side to side,
-changing hands frequently and usually palpating each vertebra with
-each hand before reaching a conclusion. There are three reasons for
-this. More accurate records may be made by combining two different
-impressions on each vertebra; with frequent change of hands one may
-prevent tiring and consequent loss of sensibility of fingers; this
-practice develops the tactile organs of both hands equally so that if
-occasion demand the use of either hand alone it is fitted for the task.
-To be ambidexterous in all departments of Chiropractic is an invaluable
-attainment, too often neglected.
-
-
-The Count
-
-Commence at the second Cervical, the first spinous process below the
-occiput, and let the fingers glide smoothly downward over the tips or
-along the sides of the spinous processes, _without interruption of
-motion_, until they reach the Sacrum. The palpater notes each vertebra
-passed and its number--mentally--so that when he reaches the Sacrum
-he knows that he has passed every intervening vertebra and received a
-touch impression from each. The Sacrum itself may usually be recognized
-by its peculiar shape and also by its articulations with the ilia.
-
-If the fingers are raised from their contact during the count, the
-palpater must recommence at the second Cervical. It is impossible to
-be accurate in replacing the hand, once removed, until the count has
-been established and the peculiarities of certain vertebrae remembered,
-together with their numbers.
-
-To determine the location of the fourth Lumbar where, on account of
-obesity, lipoma, Cervical lordosis, etc., the count of Cervicals or
-Sacral palpation is difficult, drop on heels behind the patient and
-place the second finger of each hand on the crest of the ileum. Then
-let the thumbs meet in the mid-spinal line in the same horizontal
-plane as the two second fingers, which spot should correspond to the
-interspace between third and fourth Lumbars. This measurement is
-accurate in about 98% of all cases, when patient sits erect; when it
-varies it will vary by about half the width of a Lumbar spinous process.
-
-The count should be repeated until the palpater is certain that he
-is able to palpate every spinous process distinctly or to locate
-accurately any impalpable one. In making the count, palpater may note
-the number of some very prominent and easily recognizable Dorsal or
-Lumbar vertebra to be referred to as a starting point for a recount if
-confusion arises later. This recounting from some prominent vertebra
-is permissible only after the first accurate count has been made, but
-then will save the full count, especially when the patient is in an
-unfavorable position, as lying on table during adjustment.
-
-
-Difficulties in Counting
-
-The commonest difficulties met with in counting are the following:
-
-Inaccessibility of third Cervical, which lies closely beneath the
-spinous process of the second and, unless unusually large or somewhat
-out of its proper position, cannot be readily felt.
-
-An occasional anterior fourth or fifth Cervical which may escape notice
-unless the head is flexed far toward or the transverse processes
-examined.
-
-Lipoma or other adipose tissue covering part of the spine.
-
-A missing epiphyseal plate resulting from fracture and absorption,
-which absence may simulate a wide interspace and be overlooked without
-careful and detailed observation.
-
-Cervical or Lumbar lordosis. This difficulty may be at least partially
-overcome by having head bent far forward or body leaning forward with
-elbows resting on knees and a deliberate attempt on the patient’s part
-to render the dorsolumbar spine convex backward.
-
-An anterior fifth Lumbar.
-
-The occasional extra vertebra which confuses the palpater.
-
-Finally, the greatest of all difficulties is the imperfect touch of the
-untrained palpater or the imperfect concentration of the trained. And
-this is always remediable.
-
-
-ATLAS PALPATION
-
-With patient in position A stand _behind_ him and place the tips of the
-second fingers on the tips of the transverse processes of the Atlas, or
-first Cervical. It can be felt on each side just anterior and inferior
-to the mastoid process of the temporal bone. Let the first and third
-fingers rest respectively above and below the transverses and determine
-whether the Atlas is subluxated as a whole to the Right or to the Left.
-
-Another convenient method is:
-
-Place first fingers on mastoid processes, second on Atlas transverses,
-and third on angle of jaw. The three fingers of each hand then
-constitute the points of a triangle. Imagine the base line between
-the first and third fingers and measure the altitude as a line at
-right angles to this base line and reaching to the tip of the second
-finger as the apex of the triangle. The relation of the two altitudes
-determines the laterality of the Atlas. Thus, if the altitude of the
-right triangle is less than that of the left, the Atlas is laterally
-displaced to the Right.
-
-The second matter to determine is the _rotation_ of the Atlas. This is
-done by using the first and third fingers as probes to determine the
-amount of space between the transverse and the mandible in front or the
-mastoid behind. The intention is to compare the laterally prominent
-side with the other so that the letter A or P on the record will
-indicate the position of the prominent transverse compared with its
-fellow.
-
-Next decide as to _tipping_. Still comparing the prominent transverse
-with the other, decide whether it is above or below the level of the
-other by the following method. Placing first three fingers one above
-the other with the second finger on the tip of the process, note which
-transverse is highest in the space beneath the ear. List the prominent
-side as S or Superior, I or Inferior.
-
-Atlas palpation is rendered especially difficult by the special technic
-and by the interposing tendons of the sterno-cleido-mastoid muscle.
-
-
-Position of Head
-
-There are three head positions for Atlas palpation. Head erect, face
-forward; head flexed forward on chest; head flexed backward. Sometimes
-it is necessary to test in all three positions in order to reach a
-decision, but ordinarily the first is sufficient.
-
-
-THE GROUP METHOD
-
-In general palpation of the spine the author has had the greatest
-success and attained the greatest accuracy through which is called the
-Group Method. This consists in dividing the spine mentally into five
-groups or sections, each of which overlaps its fellows except the end
-groups. This is of advantage for several reasons.
-
-It limits somewhat the attention of the palpater so that he may examine
-thoroughly and in detail the various vertebrae without holding his
-attention so closely to one that he fails to perceive its relation to
-its surroundings. It furnishes five or six vertebrae at a time for
-comparison so that one may determine which is _most_ subluxated, and
-therefore most in need of adjustment, and then allows one to reason
-upon the remainder of the group with this major subluxation in mind.
-
-The use of the Group Method may best be understood by the study of
-certain didactic instructions, which follow:
-
-Never record or adjust two subluxations of contiguous vertebrae except
-in those unusual cases where they are equally subluxated and in the
-same direction; even then it is wisest to adjust them on alternate
-days. Let it be understood that only in _exceptional_ circumstances
-should two adjacent vertebrae be listed. The Group Method is chiefly
-valuable because of this rule, to prevent the overlooking of the most
-important subluxation by selecting that one _first_.
-
-Consider the spine as divisible into five groups; in the first group
-belong the Cervicals below the Atlas; in the second, the seventh
-Cervical and first five Dorsals; in the third, the vertebrae from the
-fourth to the eighth Dorsals inclusive; in the fourth, the last five
-Dorsals and sometimes first Lumbar; and in the last group, all of the
-Lumbars and the base of the Sacrum. Consider the first Sacral spinous
-process here rather than the whole Sacrum and remember that this
-process should seem to complete the regular Lumbar curve. This grouping
-may be modified somewhat by the exigencies of palpation in any given
-case, but the group considered should always include from four to seven
-vertebrae.
-
-In each group proceed in the same manner to select subluxations. Let
-the fingers glide over the group, first on the tips and then along
-the sides of the spinous processes, and note that some one vertebra
-stands out as the sharpest, most abrupt deviation in the group, thus
-indicating its selection. Remember that neither the one above this nor
-the one directly below may be adjusted. This narrows your field of
-observation for this group to two, three, or four remaining vertebrae.
-
-Select then such others in the group as need to be listed yet do
-not conflict with the rule against adjacent subluxations. Proceed to
-discover and record the exact direction of each. When this is done
-examine the next lower group in the same way and continue until the
-whole spine has been palpated.
-
-The Atlas must be considered alone and not as a part of any of the
-above mentioned groups and its position is judged rather by its
-relation to the head than to other vertebrae; the Sacrum also requires
-individual attention, being compared with the Lumbar curve and with the
-ilia.
-
-The one most pronounced subluxation in a group is often mentioned
-as the “key” to the group, since its correction would effectually
-loosen the entire group and sometimes partially correct the apparent
-abnormalities of the rest. It has also been called “major subluxation”
-to distinguish it from “minor subluxations” which are the others of
-less importance in the group. This term is not a good one because
-it suggests what is not always true, namely, that the mechanically
-greatest subluxation is more potent than any other. Occasionally a
-slighter subluxation irritates nerves so as to produce a disease more
-serious and immediately alarming than the condition following the
-greater displacement.
-
-
-Example of Group Method
-
-If, in the Cervicals, it is noticed upon gliding downward over the
-spinous processes that the fifth is badly subluxated and must be
-adjusted, this fact is held in mind for a moment while the palpater
-remembers that he cannot adjust and must not list the sixth or fourth.
-This leaves only the second, third and seventh for consideration, the
-Atlas having been separately examined. The seventh may best be included
-in the next group when such a selection is made, so that the palpater
-need only decide between the second and third Cervical, providing Atlas
-has not been chosen, as to which, if either, most requires attention.
-If Atlas has been listed, then there remains instead only the question
-as to whether the third is or is not subluxated.
-
-In using the Group Method no preference is given to subluxation in
-any particular direction, save only that below the Cervicals we
-discriminate against the anteriors, because we cannot adjust them.
-The Group Method has to do with determining the points of greatest
-pressure on nerves and this depends upon one’s impression as to the
-interrelations between all the members of the group. (See p. 80 under
-Subluxations.)
-
-
-THE INDIVIDUAL SUBLUXATION
-
-Having prepared our patient, surveyed the entire spine, carefully
-counted the vertebrae to secure a proper orientation, and specially
-examined the Atlas, then divided the spine into groups and selected the
-vertebrae to be adjusted with regard to their degree of malposition,
-let us confine our attention definitely for the first time to the
-_single_ vertebra below the Atlas.
-
-Reread “Direction of Subluxation” under “The Record,” p. 25. Also read
-article on “Subluxations,” p. 76.
-
-Bear in mind that each subluxation recorded is intended for adjustment
-and indicate nothing impossible on your record. For instance, an
-anterior subluxation in the Dorsal region cannot be corrected and
-should not be recorded for correction.
-
-Remember the six capital letters used in describing a subluxation.
-
-Use only the _downward gliding movement_ of the three palpating fingers.
-
-Keep in mind the count as you have established it for that particular
-spine, recalling one or two very prominent and noticeable vertebrae
-whose numbers you have noted.
-
-Use a light touch. If necessary, change the patient’s position to make
-the vertebra more accessible instead of pressing with more force.
-
-When in doubt as to direction, change sides and use the other hand. If
-still in doubt, take a longer glide, covering six vertebrae instead of
-three or four.
-
-Keep your mind on your work, forgetful of everything else.
-
-And picture to yourself the entire vertebra and its surroundings;
-its body, pedicles, and laminae, its transverse processes and all
-articulations; above all, _mentally visualize the foramina and nerves_.
-Estimate from the position of each vertebra the pressure at each
-foramen. Decide whether the vertebra is rotated, tipped, laterally
-displaced, anterior or posterior, or whether the subluxation partakes
-of several of these directions.
-
-Decide in what direction movement of the vertebra would release most
-pressure and list accordingly.
-
-Never hesitate to change your opinion if you discover evidence that you
-have made a mistake. Keep at all times an open mind in palpation.
-
-
-Cervical Palpation
-
-The third Cervical, lying under the projecting spinous process of the
-larger second, may be hard to find, and therefore the full count is
-always required before listing any vertebra. By requiring the patient,
-who is in position A, to drop his head forward and rest its weight
-in the hand which is not palpating, the Cervicals may be more easily
-palpated. Remember that this posture widens the interspaces and also
-makes the spinous processes appear more posterior than they really are,
-this difference being most noticeable at the fourth.
-
-One bifurcation of a Cervical spinous process may be longer than the
-other and prove confusing unless care be taken always to palpate
-both bifurcations and note their form. This can almost always be
-successfully accomplished.
-
-Sometimes the posterior neck muscles and ligaments will be rigid
-so that they interfere with palpation and at the same time make it
-impossible for the patient to flex his head forward. Having found that
-this is due to real _contracture_ and is therefore not susceptible of
-voluntary relaxation by the patient, support the head in front and push
-aside the muscles with the fingers, gliding _underneath_ the muscle
-layers as much as possible and close to the spinous processes.
-
-Transverse palpation in the Cervicals is used to verify findings from
-the spinous processes or to differentiate between rotated and laterally
-displaced vertebrae and bent spinous processes when the spinous swerves
-to right or left.
-
-
-Dorsal Palpation
-
-The Dorsals are usually considered in three groups. It must be
-remembered that the form and obliquity of spinous processes vary
-considerably in this region. The upper processes are very slightly
-oblique, slanting downward, the middle Dorsals very oblique, and the
-inferior ones again only slightly so. There is a form change, most
-commonly at the eighth Dorsal, which may be mistaken for a posterior
-subluxation. The process here becomes more horizontal and more blunt.
-
-Among the first four Dorsals a bad lateral or rotated vertebra may
-be listed as well as a posterior one, since we can readily adjust
-it. In the middle group either the posterior or rotated vertebra is
-chosen according to the estimate as to which causes greatest nerve
-impingement, either being adjustable. In the lower group, however,
-preference is usually given the posterior vertebra when possible,
-because rotary subluxations indicate transverse adjustments and it is
-somewhat dangerous in this region to use the transverses as levers.
-
-
-Lumbar Palpation
-
-The Lumbars and Sacrum are considered in one group. The Lumbars, with
-patient erect, _should_ curve anteriorly and the first Sacral spinous
-process should complete the regular curve. This is rarely found,
-however; the normal is the exception in any part of the spine.
-
-In the Lumbars we usually choose the rotated rather than the posterior
-vertebra, but solely because rotation here produces the greatest
-degree of impingement. The laterality of spinous processes, indicating
-rotation of the whole vertebra around an axis lying in the transverse
-line between the articular processes, can best be perceived, as a
-rule, with patient sitting quite erect. If in doubt, have patient lean
-forward and rest elbows on knees, which posture separates the Lumbars,
-rendering the individual spinous process easier to discover but the
-_relative_ position more difficult of determination.
-
-The fifth Lumbar, if anterior, may be so listed, forming an exception
-to the general rule.
-
-
-Sacral Palpation--Pelvis
-
-First palpate Sacrum as if part of Lumbar region. Note whether the base
-(upper portion) is posterior or not. Then stand behind the patient and
-use both hands to examine the sacroiliac articulations. Use palmar
-surfaces with the flat hand toward patient’s body, and carefully
-compare the two sides to detect inequalities, which indicate iliac
-subluxation, or rotation of Sacrum between the ilia on a transversely
-disposed axis passing through the two articulations, in which case
-the Sacrum is to be adjusted. Do not mistake a dislocated hip with
-compensatory tilting of the whole pelvis, or faulty sitting posture
-with only one tuber ischii supporting the body, for pelvic subluxation.
-
-Be not in undue haste to record pelvic subluxations lest your haste
-bring its immediate reward in the difficulty of adjustment.
-
-
-The Coccyx
-
-The Coccyx may be detached from the Sacrum by various accidents and
-later re-ankylosed thereto in an abnormal position so as to impinge
-upon the rectum or other structures. Impingement of the coccygeal
-nerves is usually unimportant. Chronic and intractable rectal
-constipation, with its attendant train of evils, _may_ result from
-coccygeal displacement with ankylosis. In spite of numerous treatises
-to the contrary, the writer avers that other symptoms are extremely
-rare.
-
-To examine the Coccyx use a rubber covering on the second finger. Place
-patient face down and insert second finger per rectum with the palmar
-surface upward. If subluxated Coccyx be found, it must usually be
-fractured with a sharp jerk, in order to relieve the condition. After
-fracture, it may be absorbed or may re-ankylose to the Sacrum in a
-better position, or it may remain freely movable.
-
-
-PALPATION IN POSITION B
-
-This is the position for the majority of adjustments, and as the
-palpation of each vertebra to be adjusted is a necessary preliminary to
-the adjustment, this method, though not so accurate as the one already
-described, must also be used.
-
-The use of the first three fingers of each hand and the relation of
-hands to patient’s body is the same as in Position A, except for
-palpating Cervicals when the patient’s face is turned away. It will be
-found very difficult to make a correct full count, especially to count
-Cervicals, in this position, and is better to use a record already
-prepared.
-
-
-Dorsals
-
-Begin at, or near, the first Dorsal to palpate in this position.
-Find the vertebra which agrees in direction with the first Dorsal
-subluxation recorded; let the fingers glide downward until they reach
-the vertebra which, according to the first decision, would correspond
-in number with the _next_ subluxation on the record. If this also
-agrees in direction with the record it may safely be assumed that you
-are accurate in your numbering. Thereafter, during that adjustment, the
-count can be made or repeated from any prominent vertebra the number
-and identity of which are easily recognized.
-
-[Illustration: Fig. 2. Palpation in Position B, preparatory to
-adjustment.]
-
-
-Lumbars
-
-It may be difficult to count or otherwise to palpate the Lumbars in
-this position because of the increase in the normal anterior curve
-when patient is suspended between the two sections of the bench. This
-will be obviated if a roll be placed under the thighs or if the bench
-has an adjustable rear section.
-
-
-Cervicals
-
-If a solid front bench is used remember the spiral turn in the
-Cervicals, which occurs because of the resting of the head on one side.
-The curve due to this rotation of the head is compounded with the ever
-present anterior curve to make a spiral. Do not expect the vertebrae in
-this position to agree in apparent direction with a record made with
-the head straight. It is better to make all decisions as to direction
-of Cervicals in position A and merely to _count_ them in other
-positions.
-
-In position B, if the patient’s face be away from the palpater it will
-be necessary to stand with back toward patient and body twisted, and to
-change hands for counting, resting the free hand on patient’s head to
-insure its steadiness.
-
-
-Disagreements
-
-If there be any apparent disagreement between findings in positions B
-and A, re-examine carefully in both positions, whereupon that which
-seemed a disagreement will probably prove to have been an error in
-one or the other palpation. If apparent disagreement persists after
-searching examination, position A furnishes the safest guide to
-adjustment because the patient is in his most usual attitude as regards
-the spinal curves, muscle tension, etc. But it is usually wisest when
-in grave doubt not to adjust the doubtful vertebra at all.
-
-
-PALPATION IN POSITION C
-
-Since palpation in this position, patient lying on his back with head
-supported by palpater’s hands, cannot be so reliable as that done in
-position A, the chief point to be observed is an accurate count. Only
-the Cervicals below the first can be properly palpated in this position.
-
-Induce the patient to relax the neck muscles as much as may be, and use
-in palpation the first three fingers of one hand if the count alone is
-desired or the first three fingers of _both_ hands if you desire to
-ascertain the _direction_ of any vertebra. In the former case let the
-fingers press aside the muscles and glide _downward_ from the second
-Cervical, being careful to lift the head high enough so that the third
-Cervical is not overlooked beneath the overlapping second. In the
-latter case let the fingers of both hands glide gently downward while
-the patient’s head rests upon the palpater’s wrists or knee. Palpate
-the transverses in much the same manner, paying special attention to
-their _laterality_, felt as a prominence on one side lateral to a
-transverse process and a corresponding depression on the opposite side.
-Do not be deceived by exceptionally long transverses where both project
-outward to an equal degree.
-
-[Illustration: Fig. 3. Locative palpation of Cervical spinous processes
-in Position C, preparatory to Rotary or Break.]
-
-Since the greater mass of the vertebra is divided with fair equality
-by the intertransverse line, laterality of transverses indicates
-laterality of the whole vertebra with the possible exception of the
-anterior portion of the body. Laterality of a Cervical _spinous_
-process may indicate laterality of the entire vertebra or merely
-rotation around its vertical axis, in which the one articular process
-is separated from its fellow of the adjacent vertebra while the other
-remains in partial apposition.
-
-
-Disagreements
-
-If disagreements appear between palpation made in positions A and C,
-re-palpate in both positions. If still uncertain call a consultation or
-follow finding in position A. The Rotary adjustment may sometimes aid
-in deciding difficult questions if gently attempted and free movement
-secured. With this adjustment a vertebra will not usually move without
-rather extreme force unless the articular process on the side sought
-to be moved has lost its apposition with its fellow of the adjacent
-vertebra. In any case of disagreement nerve-tracing, the discovery of
-sensitive nerves on one side only may aid in decision. A knowledge of
-probabilities, previous experience, and the diagnosis may also serve as
-partial guides.
-
-
-TRANSVERSE PALPATION
-
-Palpation of the transverse processes is easiest in the Cervical and
-mid-dorsal regions and most difficult in upper Dorsal and Lumbar
-regions. It has two uses: first, to assist in making a record by
-verifying the work done on the spinous processes; second, to locate
-a given transverse process in order to use it as a lever for the
-adjustment of the vertebra.
-
-It will be seen that fulfillment of the first purpose requires careful
-examination of the _direction_ and _position_ of the transverses as
-compared with each other and with the spinous process of the same
-vertebra, while the second requires only the discovery of the exact
-_location_ of some particular transverse. It will be best to consider
-the three divisions of the spine separately, excluding from the present
-chapter Atlas palpation, which has been thoroughly described.
-
-
-Cervicals
-
-These can be best palpated in the position for Atlas palpation; that
-is, standing behind the patient and using the palmar surfaces of the
-fingers of both hands. From the Atlas transverses follow the anterior
-border of the sternomastoid muscle downward, and opposite each spinous
-process draw the muscles backward and inward until the tips of the
-transverses are found with the middle fingers. Their position on the
-two sides may then be easily compared as well as their relation to
-those above and below them.
-
-[Illustration: Fig. 4. Locative palpation of Dorsal transverse
-processes.]
-
-The transverses of the second Cervical may sometimes be so prominent
-laterally that they are, or one of them is, mistaken for an Atlas
-transverse. As a rule, however, the width of the Cervicals increases
-from the second downward, the second being narrowest. Chassaignac’s
-tubercle, on the transverse process of the sixth Cervical and opposite
-the lower border of the cricoid cartilage, is a prominent point easily
-felt as a rule. The transverses of the fourth are usually opposite the
-upper border of the thyroid cartilage.
-
-The Cervical transverses lie very close to the articular processes and
-the determination of their relation is a better guide to the condition
-of the articulation than is spinous process palpation. It is also more
-difficult.
-
-Palpation of Cervical transverses to determine laterality of the
-vertebra as a whole or its rotation is possible in position C and has
-been described under that head.
-
-
-Dorsals
-
-Palpation for _direction_ can be done best in position B. Use three
-fingers with a gliding movement along the line of the transverses,
-passing over several to determine which is most posterior. Then
-repeat the glide on the other side of the spine to determine whether
-the transverse corresponding to the anterior one is posterior or
-vice versa, showing that the entire vertebra is merely rotated or
-is displaced backward. Some palpaters prefer using both hands and
-palpating both transverses at once and there is no serious objection
-to this method, if confined to palpation in position B. In many cases,
-however, it leads to similar palpation of spinous processes, a most
-execrable habit.
-
-It should be remembered that with the first two Dorsals the transverse
-will be found in a transverse plane which would pass between its own
-spinous process and that above. This is also true of the last three
-Dorsals, while in the middle Dorsals the transverse is usually (not
-always) level with the tip of the spinous process of the next superior
-vertebra.
-
-Before adjusting, to determine the _location_ of a transverse process
-in order to direct an adjustment against it, first palpate spinous
-process and hold it with the tip of the middle finger. Then approximate
-with the first finger a point even with the tip of the spinous process
-above and about one inch from the spine--this of course in mid-dorsal.
-Then let second and third fingers follow the first so that all three
-rest on or near the transverse to be palpated. Pressing gently, but
-firmly, move the three fingers until the process can be felt beneath
-them. Hold the process with the middle finger so as to direct with
-it the contact of the adjusting hand to a point exactly over the
-transverse process.
-
-
-Lumbars
-
-The transverses of a Lumbar vertebra lie just even with the interspace
-between their own and the adjacent superior spinous process. They are
-deeply embedded in muscle tissue and very hard to palpate. They may
-vary considerably in size or length and the last one or two may be
-absolutely impalpable. It is sometimes advisable to adjust a rotated
-Lumbar by using the transverse as a lever, but this should never be
-attempted unless the process can be distinctly felt. The method of
-locating in Lumbar is practically the same as in the Dorsal region.
-
-
-Transverse Palpation with Patient Sitting
-
-Palpation of Cervical transverses in position A has been described and
-is frequently done. Palpation of Dorsal or Lumbar transverses in the
-same position may sometimes be desirable. It can be done with the same
-movement as spinous process palpation, and may serve to detect a bent
-spinous process.
-
-If it is necessary to palpate both transverses at the same time,
-stand in front of the patient and lean over his shoulder, letting his
-shoulders rest against your body. Use palmar surface of fingers of both
-hands and note which transverse is posterior to its fellow, if either,
-or whether both are posterior to the line of the others above and below
-them.
-
-It is rarely possible to find if a transverse process be superior or
-inferior to its normal position, except the Atlas transverses, although
-this may occasionally be detected. Fortunately this is a rare form
-of subluxation, or appears rare, although it must be said that this
-apparent rarity may be due to our comparative inability to detect it in
-the living subject.
-
-
-CURVES AND CURVATURES
-
-For convenience, _curve_ is used to denote the normal curvilinear
-deviation from a straight line naturally present in the normal spine
-or naturally assumed in response to the need for equilibrium during
-the erect position of the body: _Curvature_ means either the abnormal
-increase of any normal curve or the appearance of any abnormal
-curvilinear deviation of vertebrae from their normal position.
-Deviations from normal must contain at least three vertebrae to be
-considered curvatures.
-
-
-Visual Examination
-
-The general inspection of the spine which precedes the count should
-bring to light, in addition to prominent subluxations, and general
-symptoms observable by inspection of the back, any _marked curvatures_.
-Their general locality and direction will be noted by this observation
-and their details left to be discovered by closer examination.
-
-During palpation with a long and rapid glide one may also note these
-general points with respect to any curvature.
-
-Do not mistake the four normal curves, the anterior Cervical and Lumbar
-and the posterior Dorsal and Sacral, for curvatures. The normal Lumbar
-curve is so unusual in practice that a novice has been known to name it
-a lordosis.
-
-
-Description of Curvatures
-
-Four varieties of curvature are commonly described. _Kyphosis_ is
-a curvature with its convexity directed backward, usually, but not
-always, found in the Dorsal region. _Lordosis_, the opposite of
-Kyphosis, is an anterior curvature, usually in the Lumbar in which
-case it is an accentuation of the normal curve. _Scoliosis_ has its
-convexity directed laterally either to the right or the left. It is
-commonly also _Rotatory_, having its vertebrae rotated around their
-vertical axes so as to make the outer or the inner transverses more
-prominent than those on the other side.
-
-In a Scoliosis the rotation may swing either the bodies or the spinous
-processes toward the convex side of the curvature; the latter is much
-the easier of adjustment while the former furnishes one of the most
-intricate problems of adjustment.
-
-
-Cause of Curvatures
-
-Without entering here into a discussion of those disturbed metabolic
-processes--themselves the result of subluxation--which result in
-curvature by general softening of the bone, as in rachitis or
-spondylitis deformans, we will simply state the general proposition
-that almost all curvatures which are in any degree _angular_ result
-from a single subluxation to be found at the point of the angle. It
-has been demonstrated in such cases that adjustment at that point
-will correct the curvature in time but it is usually wiser to hasten
-matters by selecting other points of attack by a method to be presently
-suggested.
-
-Long, regular, but not pronounced, Scoliosis, usually in the Dorsal,
-may be an example of _occupation curvature_, following the continued
-use of muscles in a fixed position and not due to subluxation. Another
-example is the mailman’s Lordosis. These in themselves are not
-detrimental to health and are negligible unless some special point of
-impingement through individual subluxation exists within them.
-
-The sharp, angular kyphosis of Pott’s Disease, tubercular caries of the
-vertebrae, the curvature involving three or four vertebrae which are
-extremely tender to palpation, should warn against adjustment unless
-one can be very certain that the vertebrae are sufficiently intact.
-Fracture of a decayed vertebra is easily possible under adjustment. The
-cause of Pott’s Disease is usually at the angle point, most frequently
-the tenth Dorsal but possibly any Dorsal from fifth to twelfth.
-
-
-Record on Curvatures
-
-If it is the purpose of the examiner to straighten the curvature he
-should choose for adjustment a series of non-adjacent vertebrae which
-are most prominent in the direction of the curvature; thus in a right
-scoliosis he should choose only those vertebrae most prominently out
-to the _right_, and in a kyphosis only posterior ones. A lordosis as
-such cannot be properly adjusted except in the Cervicals, but lordosis
-is usually a compensating curvature (see below) and can be otherwise
-corrected.
-
-If the patient suffers from some disease which assumes more importance
-than the curvature and demands attention, select the one vertebra
-which is causing the disease, without reference to its position in the
-curvature, and adjust that vertebra into a proper relation with the
-adjacent ones, even though you adjust directly toward the convexity
-of the curvature. Disease may often be relieved by _making a curvature
-regular_ more quickly than by eliminating the entire curvature.
-Sometimes both considerations may influence the selection of vertebrae.
-
-In a curvature there is not necessarily pressure on nerves at every
-foramen. In fact, such pressure is the exception rather than the rule
-in curvature and a careful study of the spine must be made in order
-that adjustments may be accomplished without _causing_ temporary
-impingement here and there.
-
-A foot-note describing curvature may be appended to the record of
-palpation. It should contain the special name of the curvature, whether
-simple or compound, and the numbers of the first and last vertebrae in
-it. For instance, note may read: “Right rotary scoliosis from D 3 to L
-1 inclusive.”
-
-
-Compensatory Curvatures
-
-When a primary curvature is present one or two secondary curvatures
-usually appear to preserve the equilibrium of the body. With a Dorsal
-kyphosis there is often a Lumbar lordosis and sometimes less marked
-lordosis in both Cervical and Lumbar. With a primary right scoliosis
-in the Lumbar there will be a secondary left scoliosis above. The
-secondary curvature is called compensatory. In selecting vertebrae for
-adjustment it is well to neglect the compensatory curvature as much as
-possible, leaving it to right itself as the primary one is corrected.
-If, however, the primary curvature be a lordosis, and not adjustable,
-work on the secondary curvature may gradually aid in reducing the
-primary, to a certain extent at least.
-
-
-Ankylosis
-
-This topic is discussed here partly because it is so often associated
-with curvature.
-
-Ankylosis can be appreciated only by detecting the lack of normal
-movement between adjacent vertebrae. Place a finger in the interspace
-between suspected vertebrae and ask the patient to perform the movement
-calculated to separate the spinous processes in a normally movable
-spine. If in the Dorsals, ask him to drop the head and shoulders as far
-forward as possible without bending at the hips. Alternate repetitions
-of this movement with straightening and the spinous processes should
-alternately separate and approach each other. Test several successive
-vertebrae so as to note that all change their position except two.
-
-In the Lumbars have the patient repeatedly bend the body forward from
-the hips striving to make his spine convex backward. In the Cervicals
-forward flexion of the head will serve. Occasionally general ankylosis
-is found with curvature, as in Spondylitis Deformans.
-
-Many Chiropractors mistake failure to move a vertebra with an attempted
-adjustment for evidence of ankylosis. In nine cases out of ten such
-failure is due to other reasons, ankylosis being very infrequent. It is
-a much abused excuse for incapability. Free movement between spinous
-processes is _absolute proof_ that the vertebrae are not ankylosed.
-
-
-DIFFICULTIES IN PALPATION
-
-The chief difficulty arises from failure to observe some of the rules
-herein laid down.
-
-Carelessness or inattention precludes accuracy.
-
-Pain may cause the patient to assume an unnatural or cramped attitude
-simulating curvature, especially of the Cervicals. More errors occur
-from this cause in judging the laterality of C 2 than with any other
-vertebra.
-
-The occasional bent spinous process in Cervical or Dorsal regions may
-deceive the palpater unless transverse palpation is employed. But the
-frequency of slightly bent processes in dry spines and a superficiality
-of reasoning upon the subject have led to great overestimation of their
-importance. As a matter of fact only a very few maladjustments arise
-from deception of the palpater in this way, though the profession
-contains few practitioners who make a routine method of verifying by
-the transverses. The reason is simple. Bent processes are caused by
-direct violence applied before the union of shaft and epiphysis is
-complete. Sufficient force to produce a change of direction usually
-produces subluxation _in the same direction_. Adjustment continued
-until the offending process was quite aligned with its fellows would
-constitute overadjustment, but adjustment is not usually continued
-after all symptoms have subsided, so that actually small harm occurs
-through failure to detect bending.
-
-An epiphyseal plate may be absent, having been broken off by trauma and
-absorbed. This can be discovered by noting the too-wide space between
-apparently adjacent vertebrae, and careful palpation will disclose the
-apparently much anterior vertebra, an appearance not borne out by the
-position of the transverses. When an epiphysis is absent a patient has
-a somewhat weak back from lack of muscular attachment.
-
-Lipoma, or the heavy cicatrix following a burn or carbuncle, may render
-palpation of two or three vertebrae impossible. In such a case only
-the palpater’s experience and his knowledge of the characteristics of
-various vertebrae will enable him accurately to number the remainder.
-
-Patients with much adipose tissue may require palpating in several
-positions in order to permit certainty.
-
-A deep third Cervical which is absolutely impalpable may mislead one,
-but a careful count which shows one vertebra overlooked indicates the
-necessity for a careful re-examination of the Cervicals, by which the
-gap at the third at least may be appreciated. If the Axis is very much
-inferior the third is especially likely to be overlooked.
-
-Anomalous cases have been found in which there were more or less than
-the usual number of movable vertebrae, the usual deviation being the
-presence of twenty-five, and the extra one being most commonly a
-Lumbar. In one case under my observation there were twenty-five movable
-vertebrae, apparently thirteen Dorsals according to shape, and only
-eleven pairs of ribs posteriorly, two pairs being dichotomous so that
-there appeared thirteen pairs anteriorly. Deviations in number occur,
-in my experience, about once in five hundred cases.
-
-
-LANDMARKS
-
-The regional location of vertebrae by means of certain landmarks (so
-called) in or near the spine, is a much discussed question in the
-profession. Without discussing the various arguments in favor of this
-method, chief of which is the _inability of the untrained to count
-vertebrae_, let us set forth the principal landmarks used and the facts
-in regard to them.
-
-The seventh Cervical, called Vertebra Prominens, is usually considered
-a guide to the count. In over three hundred cases examined for that
-purpose the seventh Cervical was found to be Vertebra Prominens in
-about 65%, the other 35% showing the sixth Cervical or first Dorsal to
-be the prominent one. This method is two-thirds as accurate as counting.
-
-The tubercle (Chassaignac’s) of the sixth Cervical transverse is said
-to be directly opposite the lower border of the cricoid cartilage and
-this is a better guide than the above.
-
-The third Dorsal spinous process is said to be on a level with the root
-of the spine of the scapula, and with arms hanging at sides, the upper
-angle of the scapula to be on a line between first and second Dorsal
-spinous process. This is not at all constant.
-
-The inferior angle of the scapula is said by some writers to be
-on a line with the tip of the seventh Dorsal spine. Others locate
-it opposite the interspace between seventh and eighth Dorsals.
-Still others give it as opposite the eighth Dorsal spine. All are
-correct--_sometimes_. In truth, the inferior angle may be opposite any
-part of the spine between the sixth and ninth Dorsals. There is nothing
-constant about it.
-
-The twelfth rib may be followed to its articulation with the twelfth
-Dorsal vertebra. This is a good guide, providing that the rib can be
-palpated. The lower margin of the last rib is usually even with the
-spinous process of D 12 about one inch and a half from the mid-spinal
-line. The humor lies in the fact that the patient upon whom the count
-is so difficult as to require this verification is usually obese and
-obesity renders the rib impalpable.
-
-The line drawn between the iliac crests falls between the third and
-fourth Lumbar spinous processes in about 98% of all cases. _This is our
-most reliable landmark._ It is used as described under the Count.
-
-All landmarks except the last two show such variance in different
-individuals as to be quite unreliable. The correct method of numbering
-spinous processes is the obvious and logical method--_count them_.
-The skill and accuracy of touch required for successful counting is
-invaluable in determining direction of subluxations.
-
-
-MENTAL ATTITUDE
-
-In order to secure that absolute concentration without which it is
-impossible to appreciate properly those tactile impressions for the
-very _reception_ of which such continued practice is necessary, the
-hands should leave the spine as little as possible during palpation;
-a second person should record subluxations found so that the palpater
-need only state, and not write, his conclusions; light pressure on
-the spine should always be used, as a heavy pressure desensitizes
-nerve-endings in the fingers; and silence should be maintained except
-for the necessary statement of points to be recorded.
-
-Palpate as rapidly as is consistent with good work. The more rapid
-the palpation, _if concentration is absolute_, the more accurate the
-impressions received.
-
-The _end_ and _aim_ of palpation is to determine the means by which
-impingement of nerves may be removed with the greatest rapidity and
-success. Palpation includes such a study of the vertebral column as
-will fix in your mind a clear thought-picture of the impinged nerves
-throughout its length.
-
-
-FINALLY
-
-If you would achieve success in Vertebral Palpation, be persistent.
-Spare no labor to acquire that accuracy of detail which distinguishes
-the expert from the amateur. You can make of yourself what you will.
-There is no limit to the ability which may be acquired. Another may
-guide your hands but with _you_ lies your success.
-
-
-
-
-NERVE-TRACING
-
-
-Definition
-
-Nerve-tracing is that branch of palpation by which the tenderness of
-irritated spinal nerves is discovered and their paths demonstrated.
-
-
-Organ-Tracing
-
-Organ-tracing is that branch of palpation which deals with the
-outlining of the boundaries and surface markings of a tender organ or
-part.
-
-Palpaters frequently confuse tenderness of one of the parenchymatous
-viscera for the tenderness of interlaced and branching nerve filaments,
-especially in the abdominal region. The fact that the tender area
-takes on the characteristic shape of one of the viscera is conclusive
-evidence that an organ, and not nerves, have been traced.
-
-
-What Nerves Traceable
-
-Any spinal nerve may be traceable for at least a part of its course.
-The cranial nerves are made inaccessible to palpation by their
-location, except the spinal portion of the spinal accessory and the
-terminal portions of the nerves to the face. Likewise the sympathetic
-trunks, except perhaps in the neck, are untraceable.
-
-Nerve-tracing is comparatively easy in the upper and lower extremities,
-neck and back. The superficial nerves of the scalp are hard to follow
-on account of the hair. The superficial nerves of thorax, abdomen, and
-pelvis are accessible under the conditions mentioned below; the deep or
-visceral branches, never.
-
-Of those nerves mentioned as traceable, only such as are _irritated_
-and consequently swollen and tender, can be followed. If a nerve is
-very heavily impinged, especially if the impingement be chronic, it
-is partially or wholly paralyzed and not traceable. If the heavy
-impingement be acute, or if there be a light impingement serving as a
-mechanical irritant, nerve-tracing is a real aid to diagnosis.
-
-
-Proportion of Cases with Traceable Nerves
-
-About one-half of all the cases which visit Chiropractors for
-adjustment are susceptible of nerve-tracing. In the remaining half it
-is absolutely impossible to acquire any information in this way. Of the
-half who are at all susceptible, it is possible in perhaps four-fifths
-of all cases to secure _some_ accurate or reliable information.
-
-The patient in whom all accessible nerves seem tender to light
-palpation is hyperesthetic and unavailable for tracing.
-
-In the usual case one or two nerves will be found easily traceable,
-while the rest exhibit no tenderness on pressure. Such a case furnishes
-the most reliable information securable by this method and the tender
-nerves may be considered as lightly or acutely impinged.
-
-
-Preconception of Nerves Essential
-
-Knowledge of the anatomy of the nervous system is a part of the
-necessary equipment of the Chiropractor who would trace nerves and this
-knowledge should be so thorough as to enable the palpater to recognize
-each tender line found as an anatomically described nerve-path or an
-error on his part. The examiner must know the paths of all nerves and
-be able to predict from the first tender points discovered the probable
-course which the tenderness will follow, so as to direct his search
-along that probable path.
-
-He must be able to detect unconscious deception on the part of the
-patient through his knowledge of the anatomical impossibility of the
-apparent tracing. For instance, if for any reason he may appear to have
-traced a nerve upward beside the spinal column from D 10 to the eye by
-way of the vertex, he must know that this is an illusion--because such
-nerves do not exist and cannot be anatomically demonstrated--or accept
-the well merited ridicule of any educated person who discovers his
-absurdity.
-
-Because of the difficulty of determining whether the tender structure
-found be muscle, nerve, or viscus, and because of the natural
-suggestibility of both palpater and patient, nerve-tracing cannot be
-so reliable a guide to nerve-paths as is dissection. It should not be
-necessary to state this obvious truth but the calm acceptance, by many,
-of the weird conclusions based upon a belief in the infallibility of
-nerve-tracing testifies that it is necessary.
-
-Nerve-tracing is valuable only where the nerve-path outlined as being
-tender corresponds to the known path of some nerve.
-
-
-Suggestion
-
-Paradoxically, knowledge of nerve-paths may lead to error. By the law
-of expectancy, we are prone to find what we look for and if we hold too
-strongly to the belief that because we have found one or two points of
-tenderness we must find a series of points extending along a mentally
-pictured nerve-path, we may search until we falsely believe that we
-have found this series.
-
-Likewise the patient, having been carefully informed as to the manner
-of procedure and knowing what we expect to discover, may unconsciously
-deceive us by feeling tenderness in response to suggestion, where no
-real impingement exists.
-
-
-Place in Diagnosis
-
-The value of nerve-tracing in diagnosis has been much overestimated
-by many, though the tendency of the profession seems to be toward
-rationalism along that line.
-
-Whereas, in palpation of the spine every real subluxation gives
-evidence of disease, or tendency to disease, while every normally
-aligned pair of vertebrae furnish proof that no disease can exist
-in the area of distribution of the nerve emerging between them,
-nerve-tracing is much less reliable. If the tender nerve be traceable
-to a vertebral subluxation it may be taken as additional evidence that
-the effect of that subluxation is _disease_, rather than _tendency_ to
-disease, truly an important distinction, but scarcely broad enough to
-support a diagnosis without aid.
-
-The absence of tenderness from nerves does not negative a disease in
-any instance, whereas the absence of subluxation _does_. Like all
-other expedients for the selection of vertebrae for adjustment without
-admitting the necessity for first acquiring much skill by much labor,
-nerve-tracing has a great weakness. Only irritated nerves are tender
-and the effects of subluxation may be either irritation or paralysis.
-
-If accurately done, sources of error carefully eliminated, and the
-results of nerve-tracing found to correspond with the condition of
-the spine and the other symptoms, this method of demonstrating to the
-patient the connection between the vertebrae and the diseased region of
-his body is valuable. It aids in convincing him of the validity of the
-Chiropractic theory.
-
-
-TECHNIC OF NERVE TRACING
-
-
-Where to Begin
-
-The palpater, having made his vertebral palpation, may begin at some
-point in the body indicated by the symptoms as diseased and, finding
-tenderness, follow the path of a nerve back to the spinal column where
-the nerve may be fairly presumed to enter the intervertebral foramen.
-
-Or he may use his palpation record as a guide and follow the tender
-nerves outward to their periphery. This is the better method.
-
-[Illustration: Fig. 5. Technic of nerve tracing, showing position of
-fingers and marking of tender points.]
-
-
-Palpation as Guide
-
-When palpation has been made, remember that the impinged nerve is
-usually found on the side opposite to the direction of the spinous
-process in its departure from the median line. With a left subluxation
-the tenderness is usually, though not always, on the right side. If in
-the Lumbar, and the subluxation a rotation, the impinged nerve will be
-found _below_ the transverse process of the subluxated vertebra. In the
-Cervical and Dorsal regions the tender nerve is usually below, but may
-be either above or below, the transverse of the subluxated one.
-
-Examine the nerves having exit from the foramina of each subluxated
-vertebra in turn from above downward. When a tender point is found
-about an inch from the mid-spinal line, attempt to follow the nerve and
-palpate until it has been traced as completely as possible.
-
-
-Where to Expect Tenderness
-
-The region immediately surrounding the spinous process of the
-subluxated vertebra may be tender because of impingement of the axons
-of the posterior primary division of that spinal nerve which emerges
-below the vertebra. Such tenderness is more common with anterior
-subluxations than with others. It is not to be confused with the
-_soreness_ which often appears after adjustment and is due to bruising
-or straining of the tissues.
-
-Nerve tenderness may be discovered at a little distance from the
-mid-spinal line and at a level slightly lower than the emergence of
-the nerve. If a nerve is irritated, the finger inserted between the
-ribs near their articulation with the transverse processes will elicit
-tenderness. The discovery of tender points along the spine is the most
-important part of nerve-tracing.
-
-
-Nerve-Paths
-
-Detailed description of the paths of all the spinal nerves may be
-studied from any standard work on anatomy and will not be included
-here, but it may be well to remind the reader of certain general
-tendencies.
-
-The spinal nerves do not cross the median line in front except perhaps
-fine interlacing fibres.
-
-In the Dorsal region the nerves are usually found following the
-interspaces until the lower ones debauch upon the abdominal wall
-anteriorly. There are, however, some Dorsal and lower Cervical nerve
-bundles which pass obliquely downward and outward to innervate back
-muscles.
-
-Reference to the section on Spino-Organic Connection will make clear
-the tissues supplied by each nerve.
-
-_Slight_ deviations from the usual course of nerves are common;
-_marked_ deviations very infrequent.
-
-
-Use of Fingers
-
-Use second finger of either hand for the palpating finger, choosing the
-hand which can be most conveniently used as determined by the position
-of patient and the part of the body to be examined. There is no set
-rule. Reinforce this second finger by the pressure upon it of the first
-and third and, if desired, by pressing thumb against it. (See Fig. 5.)
-
-Apply the tip of the palpating finger to the nerve with a motion such
-that it crosses the path of the nerve at right angles back and forth.
-Meanwhile the probable path of the nerve must be kept in mind. As the
-finger crosses the nerve-path it makes steady and even pressure upon
-any structures passing beneath it. The motion of the hand is almost a
-rolling motion, the finger tip probing, as it were, for a tender spot.
-
-
-Tenderness--How Recognized
-
-The irritated condition of the nerve which has thus been rolled beneath
-the finger may be recognized in one of three ways; the patient may
-involuntarily flinch, betraying the hurt; or he may inform the palpater
-of the hurt; or the swollen, cord-like nerve may be felt.
-
-The two former are the reliable guides, while the latter is only
-occasionally possible. In children and in feeble-minded, insane, or
-mute adults, the first mentioned method must be relied upon entirely.
-Muscular contraction is the unconscious or reflex response to pain and
-often occurs independently of the intelligence or state of mind of the
-subject.
-
-Of all the three methods the one most commonly relied upon is the
-second--the statements of the patient.
-
-
-Instruction to Patient
-
-The patient should be informed of your intentions when palpation is
-begun and should be asked to answer every time you apply your finger,
-saying, “Yes,” if the spot is tender and, “No,” if not. He should
-speak promptly each time so as to avoid self-deception which might come
-with reasoning upon his sensations. Occasionally vary the steady rhythm
-of your movements by omitting one and note if the patient responds
-mechanically when you do not press.
-
-At times during the tracing, it is well to depart from the probable
-nerve-path and to touch again a point marked as tender, to see if
-the patient’s information may be relied upon. Whenever you leave the
-nerve-path his answer should be, “No,” immediately changing to, “Yes,”
-when you re-cross the tender line.
-
-
-Marking Tender Points
-
-At each tender point noted a small mark should be made with an eye-brow
-pencil or other grease-paint, which leaves a distinct but easily
-removable mark. These tender points should be noted and marked at
-intervals of about an inch.
-
-
-Connecting Line
-
-When the entire nerve-path has been traversed in this way, draw a line
-with the eye-brow pencil, passing through all the marks indicating
-points of tenderness. This line should be a sufficiently accurate
-rough outline of the nerve-path to make clear the spinal connection
-with the diseased area. The significance of this connection will be
-better understood when the section on Spino-Organic Connection has been
-studied.
-
-[Illustration: Fig. 6. Anterior half of completed nerve tracing.]
-
-
-Common Findings
-
-In muscular rheumatism, neuralgia, neuritis, or in case of a local boil
-or abscess indicating local disturbance of the trophic influence of
-nerves, clear and definite tracings are common. Muscular spasm, such
-as wry-neck, usually has a very tender nerve associated. Localized
-painful disease of any kind is likely to be associated with a very
-definite nerve tenderness, as is the case frequently with appendicitis,
-ovaritis, hepatic colic, etc.
-
-The painless disorders, or various disorders of spleen, diaphragm,
-heart, lungs, etc., though they be of a very serious nature, seldom
-are discoverable by nerve-tracing unless their serous membranes are
-involved. Tracings _may_ be made from D 2 or 3 to anterior thoracic
-walls in heart or lung disease but are not common.
-
-Any spinal nerve may be traceable at times through at least a part of
-its course.
-
-
-Sources of Error
-
-Several of these have been mentioned, such as the natural
-suggestibility of both examiner and patient. Among others are: failure
-in the back, thigh, or leg to reach the really tender nerve because of
-the interposition of several muscle layers between it and the finger,
-ignorance of nerve-paths, failure to apply equal pressure to all parts
-of a nerve, application of such heavy pressure that muscle tissue is
-bruised and hurt, and failure of full co-operation on the part of the
-patient. Let us consider these in turn.
-
-If several muscle layers interpose themselves between the searching
-finger and the nerve, it is proper to push aside the intervening
-layers, using a twisting and rolling movement until the finger
-feels _underneath_ the muscles. This done, and a tender nerve found
-underneath several muscle layers, the same amount of overlying tissue
-must be pushed aside each time the finger searches for the nerve. Only
-exhaustive study of the anatomy of the typical nervous system will
-enable the examiner to know exactly at what point a nerve will become
-more or less superficial. Unless he does know this it is best to follow
-the neutral rule that nerves tend to follow the long axes of ribs and
-limbs and to maintain their depth beneath the surface throughout their
-course. This statement is too general for accuracy.
-
-Care should be taken that equal pressure be made on all points palpated
-on one nerve. If the nerve pass over a bone, _less force_ is needed
-to exert the same pressure than if it overlie muscle or other soft
-structure. The force used varies constantly as the hand moves from
-place to place, according to the density and hardness of the structures
-overlying and underlying a nerve.
-
-Sufficiently heavy pressure will elicit tenderness in all except
-anaesthetic patients. But if a nerve be irritated it will be tender
-without heavy pressure, when the finger really makes a close contact
-with it.
-
-If the patient willfully attempts to deceive the palpater,
-nerve-tracing might as well be abandoned except in those extreme cases
-where the patient will flinch against his will on account of extreme
-sensitiveness.
-
-
-Use of Second Hand
-
-As far as possible, the second hand is placed opposite the tracing hand
-and steadily supports the body; its position changes with changes in
-the position of the first. If the arm is to be examined it had best be
-held away from the body, and the part to be examined held between the
-two hands.
-
-
-Position of Patient
-
-For tracing nerves in the neck, back, and upper extremities, the
-patient should sit easily. For lumbar, abdominal, or pelvic tracing,
-or for tracing in the lower extremities, have patient lie on side or
-back. Do not hesitate to change the position of the patient as often
-as is necessary to secure easy access to the part to be examined and
-relaxation of the patient’s muscles. Never allow the assumption of a
-strained position during tracing; the sensation of cramped muscles may
-be confused with sensations of nerve tenderness.
-
-
-
-
-SUBLUXATIONS
-
-
-Definition
-
-A vertebral subluxation is a displacement, less than a dislocation,
-in which the chief element is the partial loss of normal apposition
-of the articular surfaces of the subluxated vertebra with those of
-the vertebra above or below, or both. Or, Vertebral subluxation is a
-permanent partial dislocation.
-
-
-How Produced
-
-Subluxations are primarily caused by trauma--falls, blows, strains,
-etc., being the chief factors. Hereditary weakness in structure of some
-part predisposes by rendering that portion more easily displaced.
-
-Subluxations are never hereditary but may be congenital through violent
-or instrumental delivery into the world or may _appear_ hereditary
-because they occur shortly after birth through the effect of light jars
-upon the hereditarily weakened segments of the spinal column.
-
-They are always the result of concussions of forces; never of forces
-acting entirely _within_ the organism. They result from the contact of
-the body with its environment.
-
-It has been said that muscular action in response to peripheral
-irritation may produce subluxation. The laws of reflex action render
-this impossible. Given a normally aligned vertebra, and consequently
-normal nerves and a normal reflex arc in that segment, the ventral
-horn cells respond to a _slight_ peripheral stimulus by exciting
-muscular contraction on the _same_ side with the irritation. If the
-irritation be sufficiently increased, the response occurs on _both_
-sides but most strongly on the side from which the irritation comes.
-Greater irritation merely serves to cause greater distribution of the
-responsive action. (See any standard physiology on reflex action.) In
-no case will the difference between the contractions of muscles on the
-two sides be sufficient to displace a normally aligned vertebra. Nature
-has provided against that contingency.
-
-Given a subluxated vertebra causing nerve impingement and thus
-interruption of the normal action of the reflex arc, irritation may
-result in greater contraction upon the _opposite_ side than upon the
-side of the irritation. This is an abnormal condition and accounts
-for the _increase_ of previously existing subluxations under pain or
-peripheral irritation. But in every instance trauma must and does
-precede and cause subluxation.
-
-
-Reaction of Secondary Causes
-
-Once produced, however, a subluxation may not cause noticeable effect
-until it has been _increased_ in degree by the reaction of forces
-within the body such as poisons, general fever, etc. Thus germs,
-dietetic errors, exposure to sudden temperature changes, waste of
-energy through abnormal mental activities, as hate, fear, worry, etc.,
-or through physical excess--in fact, all the _secondary_ causes of
-disease may _appear_ to have produced a subluxation. In fact, they have
-merely accentuated that which already existed and have done so through
-the muscular contractions which they induced.
-
-General thinning of intervertebral substance through a condition
-of disturbed metabolism itself produced through the agency of some
-_one_ serious subluxation, may narrow all the foramina and increase
-impingement of nerves at any point where a slight subluxation
-previously existed. An irritated nerve may become swollen and the nerve
-impinged at the foramen.
-
-
-Law Governing Location
-
-So definite is the law governing the effect of force applied to a given
-portion of the body upon an associated vertebral segment that the
-skilled Chiropractor who has studied vertebrate segmentation thoroughly
-may determine, from the history of a fall or injury, the vertebra which
-would tend to be subluxated by that injury and the tissues controlled
-from that part. The rule is this:
-
-_Force applied to any body segment tends to subluxate the segmentally
-associated vertebra. This subluxation tends to produce disease
-throughout the area of distribution of the subjacent pair of spinal
-nerves._
-
-The task of explaining this law seems hopeless unless the student is
-familiar with human embryology and the life history of the vertebrata,
-as well all the details of human anatomy. To such a student the
-law will be self-evident, so interwoven with the threads of higher
-organization as practically to form its pattern.
-
-In simple terms we might offer this general statement. Any force
-applied to the body with sufficient violence will produce subluxation
-of the vertebra above the spinal nerves supplying the injured area.
-Thus, the brachial plexus controls the arm and shoulder and connects
-with the spine by way of the 5, 6, 7, 8, Cervical and 1 Dorsal nerves.
-Any force striking the arm or shoulder tends to produce subluxation
-of the sixth or seventh Cervical or first Dorsal vertebra so that all
-permanent disease conditions resulting will be found in the arm or
-shoulder or nearby tissues of the neck.
-
-This theme presents a magnificent field for individual study and
-research but is, per se, beyond the limitations set for this work.
-
-
-Effect of Subluxations
-
-Slight subluxations may exist, because of the adaptation of surrounding
-parts and the slight play within the intervertebral foramen, without
-producing noticeable effect. They always, however, evidence a
-_tendency_ to disease.
-
-The majority of subluxations do produce disease, to some degree, and
-do so by _impinging nerves_. Impingement may be either by pressure
-_against_ a nerve or ganglion or by _constriction_ of a nerve where it
-passes through an intervertebral foramen; the former occurs in the case
-of the Cervical sympathetic, the sub-occipital nerves, and the sacral
-nerves; the latter is the commoner form in Dorsal and Lumbar regions of
-the spine. Probably the most positive constriction of a nerve which can
-occur within the body is to be found in rotation of Lumbar vertebrae;
-the body of the rotated vertebra encroaches upon the inferior nerve on
-the side opposite to the direction taken by the spinous process.
-
-Either variety of impingement produces disease, morbid structure or
-function, by irritation of the nerve: light impingement irritates,
-heavy impingement partially or completely paralyzes, the nerve.
-
-
-VARIETIES OF SUBLUXATION
-
-According to the abnormal relations between vertebrae subluxations may
-be variously described as rotated, tipped, anteriorly, posteriorly,
-or laterally displaced. They commonly combine two or more of these
-forms, so that the purely rotary or the entirely lateral subluxation is
-uncommon.
-
-
-Rotation
-
-Every vertebra has a vertical axis around which it tends to rotate.
-This axis is not always the center of mass but depends upon the
-arrangement of mass, the fixity of cartilages, ligaments, and muscles,
-which tend to hold some parts of the vertebra more fixed than others,
-and the apposition of articular processes, which tends to prevent
-movement in certain directions.
-
-The axis of rotation of the first Cervical is the center of the
-odontoid process of the second Cervical, which articulates with
-the transverse ligament and anterior arch of the first. A frequent
-subluxation of the Atlas is a rotation around this process so that the
-one transverse is permanently posterior to its normal position and the
-other correspondingly anterior.
-
-The axis of rotation of the Cervicals below the Atlas is in the extreme
-anterior portion of their bodies. This part remains relatively fixed in
-rotatory subluxation while the tip of the spinous process describes the
-greatest arc.
-
-In the Dorsals the axis of rotation lies in the posterior portion of
-the centrum near the neural canal. When the spinous process appears
-laterally displaced in rotation the anterior portion of the body is
-slightly displaced in the opposite direction, twisting and straining
-the fibres of the intervertebral disk.
-
-In the Lumbar region rotation is the commonest form of subluxation,
-the axis of rotation being laterally movable upon a transverse line
-between the articular processes in the beginning and shifting, as
-soon as the vertebra leaves its normal relations, to the junction of
-the articular process with that of the adjacent vertebra on the side
-toward which the spinous process is moving. Thus, in rotation of the
-vertebra so that the spinous is to the right, the axis will be found
-on the right side, the superior articular process of the next vertebra
-serving as a support on which the inferior articular process of the
-rotating vertebra may turn. The processes are so firmly locked that
-unless the whole vertebra be quite posterior little lateral movement
-of the spinous process is possible without marked rotation. The body
-describes the greatest arc because it is further removed from the
-center of rotation than is the tip of the spinous.
-
-
-Tipping
-
-This is a subluxation in which the one transverse process is, or
-appears to be, superior or inferior to the other. It occurs frequently
-to the Atlas in combination with lateral subluxation. In fact, the
-shape of the occipito-atlantal articulations is such that, if the
-remaining Cervicals maintain their proper relation to each other,
-the Atlas cannot be laterally displaced without a certain amount of
-tipping. It will be relatively superior on the prominent side and the
-head will be tipped toward that side; that is toward the side of the
-lateral displacement. Thus, on account of the wedge-shaped lateral
-masses, if the whole Atlas be to the right of its normal position the
-right side will be superior and the head tipped toward the right. This
-is only true when the vertebrae below maintain a normal interrelation.
-
-
-Approximation
-
-This is a name applied to that condition in which, on account of
-changes in the intervertebral disks due to subluxation interfering with
-metabolic processes, the bodies or spinous processes of vertebrae are
-crowded too closely together.
-
-Occasionally a spine is found in which, on palpation, the spinous
-processes are found to be crowded together in groups, sometimes of
-two or three, sometimes of five or six; no two interspaces appear
-equal, a very wide one being succeeded by one or two which are almost
-inappreciable; the variation in width of the interspaces does not
-correspond to the known normal variation in those regions where the
-changing obliquity of spinous processes should modify the relative
-width of successive spaces. We expect, for instance, to find a wider
-space between third and fourth Dorsals than between second and third;
-if we do not find this difference it is doubtless due to cartilage
-change and the vertebrae are approximated.
-
-In case of general thinning of intervertebral substance unequally
-divided between different sections of the spine the record will show
-that almost every vertebra is listed either S or I, and if a system of
-underscoring is used that these two directions are frequently indicated
-as most noticeable.
-
-A study of the spine will make clear the fact that if the cartilage
-between any two Dorsal vertebrae be thinned in front the bodies of the
-vertebrae will be closer together and the spinous processes more widely
-separated; the spinous process of the upper vertebra will be crowded
-against the one superior to it and that of the lower against the one
-inferior to it. These spinous processes are said to be _approximated_.
-
-The correction of S or I subluxations, then, depends upon correction of
-disturbed nutritive processes.
-
-
-Lateral Displacements
-
-According to the usage of earlier writers on subluxations this
-term (lateral displacement) included rotation of the vertebra as
-well as those changes in position in which the whole or nearly all
-of the vertebra deviates sidewise from its normal position. Since
-the introduction of the term “rotation” into the description of
-subluxations, the meaning of the term “lateral displacement” is much
-more restricted. It refers now to a condition which probably occurs in
-the strictest sense only in the Cervical region, most frequently with
-the first and second Cervical, the two being subluxated together.
-
-We have already stated that the most important fact to be determined
-regarding the Atlas is its lateral displacement, since this produces
-the greatest impingement of nerves. Lateral displacement of any other
-Cervical can best be judged by examination of the transverse processes,
-since by palpation of the spinous process alone it is quite impossible
-to distinguish between lateral and rotary subluxation.
-
-In the Dorsal and Lumbar regions the R or L used to describe the
-position of the spinous process most often indicates rotation of the
-vertebra. While it is perfectly proper thus to describe the subluxation
-on a record, in the determining of the form of adjustment to be used
-the position of the _whole_ vertebra must be considered.
-
-
-Anterior Subluxations
-
-Forward displacements may occur anywhere in the spine. In the case
-of the first Cervical they are usually, though not always, forward
-displacements of only one side--rotation--though the whole Atlas may be
-anterior if the Axis has moved with it or is tipped so that the spinous
-process is much superior. This is rare.
-
-Any Cervical may be anterior; usually a series are anterior (if any)
-amounting to an increase in the Cervical curve--a lordosis. This
-condition may be corrected by transverse adjustments given from the
-front and side.
-
-A Dorsal vertebra is only _relatively_ anterior, the adjacent ones
-being relatively posterior, and the only possible correction at present
-is the adjustment of the posterior ones. A Lumbar cannot be anterior
-unless those below it are also anterior, on account of the locking of
-articulations. Discovery of anterior Lumbars is quite common. The fifth
-Lumbar may be subluxated anteriorly by slipping forward on the Sacrum;
-it must be _superior_ at the same time, on account of the shape of the
-articulating surfaces which face downward and forward. The spinous
-process is crowded closely against the fourth while the body of the
-fifth is too widely separated from that of the fourth.
-
-
-Posterior Subluxations
-
-There are many Chiropractors who have always considered the posterior
-subluxation more than any other, not because it produces greater
-nerve impingement than others but because it is easiest to detect;
-it intrudes itself upon the attention of the unskilled examiner most
-persistently. Nor should its importance be underestimated, though we
-now realize that in some instances a rotated or anterior vertebra may
-cause more nerve impingement than a posterior one.
-
-The posterior subluxation in the lower Dorsals and Lumbars is the
-easiest variety to adjust; in this region a posterior displacement of
-one vertebra tends to bring with that one the next adjacent superior
-one, the sharpest deviation occurring between the posterior one and the
-one below it.
-
-Any vertebra may be posterior: the Atlas is rarely so as a whole,
-and never unless the Axis is also displaced backward; the Cervical
-and Dorsal regions present frequent variations of this sort, which
-must not, however, be confused with long, prominent, or overdeveloped
-spinous processes; the Sacrum may be posterior to the ilium on one
-side, or to both ilia.
-
-
-Occipital Subluxations
-
-Mention should be made here of a form of subluxation not strictly
-vertebral--displacement between the condyles of the occipital bone and
-the lateral masses of the Atlas. This occurs when the head has been
-moved too violently upon the Atlas so as to cause an immediate nerve
-irritation and muscle tension sufficient to hold it in its abnormal
-position. The Cervicals may be quite normal below the Atlas though
-this, of course, is not the rule. Correction of occipital subluxations
-is made by applying force to the Atlas and to the skull, sometimes by
-holding Atlas and rotating the skull.
-
-
-Age of Subluxations
-
-The relative age of subluxations may be determined, within rather wide
-limits, it is true, by a study of the form of the spinous process.
-Newly acquired subluxations are sharply defined, having noticeable
-_edges_ on the spinous process. In time they tend to become rounded
-and blunt and appear to cover more surface, just as the mountain range
-which, when first upheaved, is sharp and rugged, gradually rounds into
-regular curves through the work of the elements.
-
-In this way Nature protects the subluxated vertebra from further
-contact with the environment surrounding man, the rounded process
-offering less opportunity for a blow or shock to affect it.
-
-
-Changes in Shape
-
-Bone diseases such as rachitis osteomalacia, etc., and especially
-Potts’ Disease, or spinal caries, make marked changes in the shape of
-vertebrae. Also a subluxated vertebra may gradually assume a shape
-suited to the abnormal position it occupies, the commonest change
-being the assumption of a wedge shape by the centrum. This is a great
-obstacle to adjustment, as the abnormal shape of the vertebra makes it
-tend to settle after each movement into the old abnormal position.
-
-There are few spines without some more or less misshapen vertebrae.
-
-Ankylosis also makes great changes in the shape of vertebrae. There
-are two kinds of ankylosis--true and false. The first is a deposit of
-bone cells upon bone, often the formation of a bridgelike structure
-to hold contiguous vertebrae together. This may bind any portions of
-the vertebrae but most commonly holds the bodies, in which case it can
-only be appreciated by detecting the lack of movement between normally
-separable vertebrae. False ankylosis occurs with fever in bone and
-consists in an exudation of bone substance which sometimes produces
-remarkable distortions of shape.
-
-
-
-
-TECHNIC OF ADJUSTING
-
-
-Definitions
-
-Vertebral Adjusting is the art of correcting by hand the malpositions
-of subluxated vertebrae.
-
-A Vertebral Adjustment, strictly speaking, should mean the complete
-restoration of normal relation between previously subluxated vertebrae.
-As used in Chiropractic, it means either a partial or complete
-restoration of such normal relation.
-
-Maladjustment, as used in the profession, designates any movement of
-vertebrae by hand which produces or increases subluxation.
-
-
-GENERAL PRINCIPLES OF ADJUSTING
-
-It will be well for the student to master first the general rules and
-principles which govern vertebral adjustment and then to proceed to a
-detailed investigation of each movement, in turn, before practicing
-it. The art of adjusting can only be acquired by practice, and a high
-degree of excellence in it only by _long-continued_ practice. However,
-the rapidity with which it can be mastered depends largely upon the
-formation of a clear pre-conception of the work to be done and the
-manner of its doing.
-
-As the student progresses in the art he finds himself occasionally
-guilty of errors which mar, in some degree, the efficiency of his
-work. These may arise from unconscious modification of the technic
-first learned or from unconscious repetition of some necessary
-modification demanded by a special peculiarity in one or more cases.
-
-This section is intended to furnish the proper pre-conception and also
-to serve as a monitor to adjusters who, by reference to the precepts
-herein set down, may discover and remedy their own errors. It is not
-intended to furnish sufficient education to warrant practice without
-clinical instruction, which is unwarrantable, but rather to accelerate
-the education which practice alone can furnish.
-
-
-Object of Adjustment
-
-The vertebral subluxation being an abnormality of _relation_ between
-vertebrae, it is obvious that its correction must be a return of normal
-relation. This can only be accomplished by bringing about a change of
-_relative_ position. Movement of a section of the spine composed of
-several vertebrae is not, in the true sense, an Adjustment. It is the
-_single_ vertebra which must be moved.
-
-The movement should be one calculated to bring the vertebra to its
-normal position _in the most direct manner possible_. Such a movement
-should be used as will reverse the direction of the forces which
-subluxated the vertebra. It should be applied to the transverse or
-spinous processes, or to the lamina, as is sometimes done in the
-case of the Atlas, according to the _kind_ of subluxation. Different
-subluxations require different handling. Cases vary. Select the move
-_best suited to the case_. This can be determined most properly by
-correct palpation which fixes in the mind of the adjuster the position
-of every part of the vertebra, its relation to its fellows, the points
-of greatest nerve impingement, etc., all of which should suggest the
-best method for correction.
-
-The prime object of adjustment is the removal of impingement from
-nerves.
-
-
-Transmitted Shock vs. Thrust
-
-The movement used in adjusting has been variously described. Many
-writers and teachers have used the term “thrust” to describe the
-movement of the hands, and the term is correctly applied to the
-movement used by many Chiropractors. But a careful study of the methods
-of applying force in use among the most successful adjusters, those who
-have attained the greatest results with the slightest percentage of
-failures and a minimum of pain to the patient, discloses the fact that
-the chief element of their adjustment is _transmitted shock_.
-
-The hand is held in close contact with the vertebra to be adjusted
-and the arms and shoulders describe such movements as to deliver the
-required amount of force with the slightest possible change in the
-position of the hands. The vertebra bounds away from the contact hand.
-In the delivery of a _thrust_ the hand would follow the vertebra,
-forcing each portion of the movement. The real effect of a thrusting
-motion, since the hand cannot enter the body as a sharp instrument
-would, is that of _pushing_. Pushing neither subluxates nor adjusts
-vertebrae so readily as does a rapidly applied shock.
-
-Let us illustrate with a common experiment in physics. Suspend a number
-of ivory balls by cords of equal length in such a manner that each
-is in contact with its fellow and all are in a straight line. When
-the balls are properly adjusted a straight line should connect their
-centers. Hold one end ball firmly in the hand or with an instrument
-which renders it absolutely fixed. Then strike sharply with a light
-hammer. The balls will all remain stationary except the one on the
-opposite end which will fly off to a distance exactly measurable
-according to the force of the blow. How does this occur?
-
-A shock is transmitted through the molecules of the ivory until it
-reaches the end ball, which is not held back by another. Here the
-transmitted force is expended in molar motion, the ball leaping away
-from its fellows as if it had been hung alone and had been struck with
-the same force.
-
-It is well known that by placing an elbow firmly against a man’s jaw
-and then sharply striking the closed fist with the other hand, open, a
-very heavy blow can be given; yet the forearm, through which the shock
-is transmitted, does not move.
-
-Now ivory is very like human bone. Further, it has been demonstrated
-that the law illustrated by the above experiment is equally applicable
-to the movement of vertebrae. The pushing or thrusting movement _may_
-move a specific vertebra, but it is probable that the chief factor in
-so doing is the element of transmitted shock contained in the movement
-and delivered at the instant of release of the hand from the spine at
-the end of the movement.
-
-On the other hand it is obvious that a pushing or thrusting movement
-may move several vertebrae in addition to the one directly in contact
-with the adjusting hand, in consequence of the way in which the spinal
-segments are closely bound together. If a steady strain is used, in
-which muscles and ligaments have time to act, one of three results
-may occur: (a) the specific adjustment; (b) the movement of several
-vertebrae at one time, which does not constitute an adjustment; (c)
-the giving way of the spine at its weakest point, which may be some
-distance from the point of contact with the adjusting hand, the
-ligaments and muscles having communicated and diffused the strain
-throughout a large area. In the latter contingency the result is
-usually a new subluxation or the increase of an old one, instead of an
-adjustment.
-
-
-The Rapid Movement
-
-Thus _Speed_ becomes an important factor in correct adjustment.
-
-A good illustration of the value of speed may be taken from a pile
-of stakes bound together by a cord. If a man with a hammer desires
-to remove the center stake of the group, and attempts to do so with
-a slow pushing movement, the result is a change of position of many
-stakes, which adhere to the center stake and to each other. If, on
-the contrary, he strikes a sharp, quick blow with his hammer, meeting
-squarely the center of balance of the one stake, it will fly straight
-from its position leaving the others unmoved. This is exactly what we
-desire to accomplish with an adjustment. By the speed of the movement
-we expect to move _one_ vertebra before adhesion or the contraction of
-muscles or inelasticity of ligaments can diffuse the force.
-
-
-Close Contact
-
-In order to accomplish the transmitted shock it would seem wisest,
-at first thought, to draw back the hand and strike the vertebra
-sharply. On the contrary, it has been found advisable to place the
-hand carefully in _close_ and _immediate contact_ with the vertebra
-to be adjusted. Nature herself shows us the way in the delicate
-shock-transmitting mechanism of the tympanum.
-
-Also the hand of the adjuster will cover much more than merely the
-spinous or transverse process which is used as a lever and to which
-it is desired to transmit the shock, unless carefully placed so that
-only a _small portion_ is in contact; by such a contact diffusion of
-the shock is prevented and its efficiency within a limited area is
-increased. A carpenter wishing to countersink a nail places in contact
-with the nail head a small instrument called a countersink, which he
-then strikes sharply with a hammer. The contact hand of the adjuster
-represents the countersink and is used by the two arms as a passive
-instrument for transmitting shock.
-
-The close contact of the hand, which remains passive, renders the
-adjustment much less painful to the patient than it would otherwise
-be, and one of the prime objects in the mind of the adjuster should be
-the minimizing of pain inflicted, by any means which does not lessen
-the resulting benefit. Also any drawing back of the hand before the
-movement warns the patient and tends to induce involuntary muscular
-contraction which interferes with adjustment.
-
-
-Relaxation
-
-In an adjustment it is necessary to overcome two kinds of
-resistance--the passive resistance of inertia, of ligaments, or
-of superincumbent weight, and the active resistance of muscular
-contraction. It is important that both forms be minimized.
-
-The first may be lessened through the position of the patient’s
-body; he is placed so that the vertebra to be adjusted is in the
-freest possible position. The second is reduced to the least possible
-quantity, amounting to no more than muscle tonus, by using two methods:
-(a) Oral Suggestion, and (b) Muscular Suggestion.
-
-
-Oral Suggestion
-
-Explain to the patient the need for relaxation. Make it clear to him
-that less force will be required if his muscles are passive. Remind
-him frequently of this and assume that he desires to relax. A word
-immediately before the adjustment often induces a temporary relaxation
-during which the adjustment is given. Anything which detracts the
-attention from the coming shock is an aid. Sometimes asking the
-patient to inhale and exhale slowly and deeply will sufficiently take
-his attention from the adjustment. Experience will teach him that he
-suffers less pain when relaxed and presently relaxation becomes a
-habit. Instructing patients to think of sleep, turning the eyeballs
-upward, has been effective with some.
-
-
-Muscular Suggestion
-
-This can only be given by maintaining a state of relaxation in one’s
-own muscles, which in itself is desirable in most cases, for reasons
-to be presently explained. In handling Cervical vertebrae move the
-head gently from side to side with your own hands relaxed as much as
-possible. The lazy motion suggests relaxation. Then when it is felt
-that the neck is thoroughly relaxed, vary the motion with a quick
-adjusting movement.
-
-In Dorsal and Lumbar regions after the hands are in correct position
-the adjuster should pause a moment both to be sure that the direction
-of movement and his purpose to move are clearly fixed in his mind
-and to be certain that both himself and the patient are relaxed. The
-adjustment is given instantly and from a perfectly lax muscle, as a
-boxer strikes.
-
-An added advantage is the greater amount of speed and control which
-may be commanded in this way. The lax arm, being in a neutral state as
-regards motion, can be contracted in any desired direction without
-loss of force or of time, whereas a taut muscle cannot further effect
-motion of the arm without relaxation of its antagonistic muscles, which
-takes time.
-
-
-Muscular Control
-
-Considerable contral over one’s own muscles is necessary in order
-perfectly to relax arm and shoulder muscles just before the adjustment
-and then to utilize a measured and determined quantity of force in a
-desired direction. To acquire this much practice is necessary--practice
-on the living subject. The desired end may be hastened, however, by
-acquiring the abstract property of muscular control or by developing
-control already gained.
-
-Many different forms of exercise will aid in the acquisition of
-muscular control and the ability to relax and then to follow the
-relaxation with an instantaneous whiplike contraction in a given
-direction. The best of these is without doubt _bag-punching_. The
-movements employed with a punching-bag, especially the lateral
-quadruple movement with both elbows and both hands, tend to develop
-precisely the sort of control needed for correct adjusting. The
-beginner can do no better than to practice in this way, by which, it
-must be remembered, only a necessary _property_, and not by any means
-the exact movement, may be acquired.
-
-
-Amount of Force
-
-The amount of force used in an adjustment varies so much in different
-spines and in different parts of the same spine that it is quite
-impossible to state any correct estimate of it in terms of physical
-units. In general the Cervicals move with least resistance, then the
-Dorsals, then the Lumbars, and finally the Sacrum and Ilia as hardest
-of all to displace or replace.
-
-In developing additional force when it is found that the force first
-used on any vertebra has been insufficient to move it, remember this
-law: _Work equals one-half Mass times the square of the Velocity_.
-In other words, doubling the speed of the movement increases its
-effectiveness four-fold; tripling it, nine-fold.
-
-The increase in force should never be effected by increasing the
-_weight_ or _pressure_ upon the patient’s body, for reasons which
-should be clear from a study of previous pages, but always by
-increasing the _speed_ of the movement.
-
-
-Names Used to Describe Movements
-
-The names herein employed to indicate certain movements, each a
-well-defined method of procedure for the accomplishment of some special
-end, are the names or descriptive terms which seem to be in the most
-general use at this time. Few of these movements have arrived suddenly;
-most of them are the result of gradual growth and evolution: so with
-the terms by which they are known; they have gradually become a part
-of the common language of the profession. Usage sanctions them, though
-some of them are cumbersome, unwieldy, or entirely inappropriate.
-
-[Illustration:
-
- Fig. 7. Morikubo Move. For correction of a lateral and rotated
- Atlas (L. A.). Pisiform contact with anterior transverse.
-]
-
-
-SPECIAL TECHNIC
-
-
-MORIKUBO MOVE
-
-A movement for the correction of a lateral and rotated Atlas, indicated
-for use only when the Atlas is recorded as R. A. or L. A. The position
-of the patient’s head renders the transverse process inaccessible
-unless it be anterior on the side from which adjustment is to be given.
-
-
-Position of Patient
-
-Place two sections of the bifid bench together so as to secure the
-effect of a solid bench with an upward sloping front. Have patient
-lying on back with back of head resting firmly on bench, chin slightly
-uptilted. Then turn patient’s head so that it faces sidewise and rests
-flatly on the side of the least prominent transverse. This exposes
-the anterior transverse in front of the tendons of the sterno-mastoid
-muscle.
-
-
-Use of Hands
-
-Stand leaning over head of bench and carefully place the pisiform bone
-of adjusting hand upon the tip of the transverse process, being careful
-to push aside the sterno-mastoid tendons if they interpose themselves
-between the pisiform and the process. The fingers of the adjusting hand
-extend downward toward the clavicle and rest lightly, very lightly,
-upon the patient’s neck. With the other hand firmly grip the wrist of
-the adjusting hand, fitting the pisiform of the upper hand into the
-hollow below the styloid process of the radius.
-
-
-Movement
-
-This is delivered straight downward toward the bench. It should be
-light and quick and the hand should not follow the process in its
-movement.
-
-This movement is painful and should not be used if avoidable. When
-used it requires the utmost care and a careful measuring of force.
-Err, if at all, on the side of overcaution. The technic will be better
-understood after study of the more detailed description of “The
-Recoil”, since the position and use of hands, arms, and shoulders is
-much the same for both.
-
-
-PISIFORM ANTERIOR CERVICAL MOVE
-
-Indicated for rotation of a Cervical vertebra in which one transverse
-process is anterior to its normal position or more anterior than its
-fellow which may also be somewhat, though less, anterior.
-
-
-Placing Patient
-
-As for the Morikubo Move place the patient in the dorsal recumbent
-posture with head resting on bench and chin uptilted. Turn patient’s
-face slightly away from the side of the selected anterior transverse
-and steady the head with the free hand while palpating.
-
-[Illustration: Fig. 8. Pisiform anterior Cervical move.]
-
-
-Making Contact
-
-Palpate downward from the Atlas transverse along the posterior margin
-of the sterno-mastoid, dipping deeply into the neck and exploring with
-the tips of the first three fingers until the offending process is felt
-as a nodule of bone plainer to the touch than those above and below.
-Always reach _across_ the neck to the selected transverse; if it be the
-right, stand on the patient’s left and use left hand for palpating and
-for contact hand as well.
-
-Having found the process, gently move aside any tissues which tend to
-interpose between the finger and the bone, change hands so that the
-palpating hand is free and the other holds the contact spot clear of
-interposed tissue and plainly points it out, then place pisiform bone
-of contact hand gently but firmly against the _front_ of the process
-so that a mass of bone is felt between the pisiform and the bench when
-downward pressure is made.
-
-
-Completing Position
-
-It will be noted here that the head is unstable and tends to rock
-with slight pressure or movement of the contact hand. Steady the head
-by placing the knee upon head of bench and against side of patient’s
-head, not roughly but so that the head cannot move further toward the
-adjuster.
-
-Now reinforce the contact hand by gripping the wrist with the other,
-press slightly downward to tighten the contact and avoid slipping, and
-you are ready for
-
-
-The Movement
-
-which is directed sharply _downward_ toward the bench. This move
-rotates the vertebra around its vertical axis and puts a strain in a
-backward direction on the whole column at this point.
-
-Care must be used, because the move at best is painful. It is easy to
-slip across the end of the transverse. Take every precaution to avoid
-imprisoning a muscle, nerve, or blood-vessel between the contact hand
-and the vertebra. Rightly used this move is valuable, perhaps most
-valuable of all anterior Cervical moves, but it requires nice judgment.
-
-
-LAST FINGER CONTACT
-
-This movement differs from the preceding one in two important
-particulars; the contact hand must be so selected with relation to the
-side of vertebra adjusted that the fingers will extend upward toward
-the patient’s head, and the opposing hand supports the head instead of
-reinforcing the contact hand.
-
-
-Placing Patient
-
-As for preceding move. The head will remain in this position only until
-the contact is made, after which it will be raised by the supporting
-hand until a tight contact is felt and the neck muscles drawn fairly
-taut.
-
-[Illustration: Fig. 9. Last finger contact for anterior Cervical.]
-
-
-Making Contact
-
-Palpate with left hand if standing on patient’s left to adjust a right,
-anterior subluxation. Find the offending anterior transverse, draw
-tissues away with middle finger of palpating hand, change to middle
-finger of free hand which marks and holds the point of contact. Now
-place (with care) the base of the little finger of the hand which was
-used for palpating, at a point just below the condyle of the last
-metacarpal and a little to the palmar side, in direct contact with the
-front of the transverse. The last finger will be flexed toward the
-radial side and a shallow depression thus left for the contact.
-
-
-Completing Position
-
-Hold contact lightly and slip the free hand under the patient’s head,
-which faces slightly toward the adjuster. Raise the head, bending the
-neck away from the adjusting hand and toward patient’s chest until it
-is felt that the contact is secure and that further movement would put
-the neck upon a strain. You are ready for
-
-
-The Movement
-
-which is delivered entirely with contact hand, downward and toward the
-back of the neck. The delivery is difficult because the force arm is
-flexed at the elbow and the position awkward. Practice, however, will
-soon render one adept.
-
-
-Uses
-
-For rotated vertebrae which have one transverse anterior to the other,
-Cervicals only. This move gives a slightly less advantageous force
-angle than the preceding, but is less likely to be painful.
-
-
-SECOND METACARPAL CONTACT
-
-
-Position of Patient
-
-Place patient supine on bench so that his head extends beyond the end
-of bench and is supported by the upraised knee of the palpater. Stand
-at head of bench so as to face patient’s feet.
-
-
-Use of Hands
-
-Differing from their use in the preceding moves the hands are so placed
-that the adjusting hand for a right, anterior subluxation will be right
-hand, for a left anterior the left hand. The opposite hand supports the
-head after contact is made.
-
-
-Making Contact
-
-Contact point on hand is second metacarpal at the end of the condyle,
-or second metacarpo-phalangeal joint. This is placed in front of the
-offending transverse, the head having been rotated away from that side
-and other tissues drawn carefully aside from the bone. The back of the
-hand is downward toward the clavicle, fingers semi-flexed on palm,
-thumb resting on jaw.
-
-
-Supporting Head
-
-The following position is the correct one for supporting the head in
-all Cervical adjustments delivered in the above position of patient and
-adjuster.
-
-Cup the supporting hand slightly and fit the patient’s ear into the
-cupped palm. Let fingers extend toward the base and back of the neck,
-the finger position varying according to the amount of rotation of the
-head so that the fingers are in all cases directly _under_ the head
-weight. The wrist then flexes on the hand, and wrist and forearm are
-brought up across the patient’s forehead so that a force delivered
-from the opposite side cannot cause the head to roll or move upon the
-supporting hand. After placing both hands draw the head so that the
-chin is tilted upward until it is felt that contact is snug and tight.
-This supporting position is invaluable and much neglected by adjusters,
-who might save themselves much annoyance and many failures by its
-constant use. In the study of succeeding Cervical moves refer to this
-description frequently. We shall call it the Hook Support, because the
-arm and hand resemble a hook which grasps the under side of the head
-and curves over the upper.
-
-
-Movement
-
-This is delivered entirely with contact hand and in a direction as
-much posterior as can be achieved without slipping past the end of the
-process. If the head is sufficiently rotated away from the contact side
-the angle of force is better than with a straight lateral adjustment,
-which it somewhat resembles, but not so good for anteriors as either of
-the two preceding moves. It is chiefly useful when the other two fail.
-
-
-OCCIPITO--ATLANTAL MOVE
-
-To move an Atlas so disposed that its one side is posterior while the
-whole vertebra is laterally displaced in the same direction; to move,
-for instance, an Atlas R. P.
-
-Have patient lying on back in position C with head projecting beyond
-bench and supported by adjuster’s knee.
-
-
-Placing of Hands
-
-Place the first three fingers of one hand under the most laterally
-prominent transverse so as to hold it firm, first placing the first
-finger carefully just behind and against the end of that transverse and
-then reinforcing it with the second and third fingers, slightly tensed,
-and resting their tips on the lamina close underneath the occipital
-bone.
-
-Next place the other hand so that the thumb rests firmly upon the
-patient’s jaw and the first finger extends backward along the lower
-margin of the occipital bone.
-
-To complete the position rotate the head gently toward the side of the
-laterally prominent Atlas, until it rests, face toward the side, and is
-supported by the three fingers of the one hand and the heel and wrist
-of the same hand. It will be noted that when the head is rotated the
-first finger of supporting hand slips to a position directly upon the
-tip of the transverse process and the other two take its place against
-the posterior aspect of the tip of the transverse. The Atlas now rests
-with its intertransverse line almost vertically upward from supporting
-fingers, which hold it against further rotation.
-
-
-Movement
-
-When the neck muscles have been thoroughly relaxed by slight and gentle
-movement, throw the upper elbow sharply away from your body, which
-has the effect of transmitting force through the thumb to the jaw and
-sharply rotating the head still further, loosening its articulation
-with the now firmly held Atlas. The condyloid joints thus loosened tend
-to settle into their proper relations, the weight of the head causing
-it to slip downward--laterally upon the Atlas.
-
-
-Uses
-
-This is really a movement of the head rather than of the Atlas and is
-an easy movement when practicable. It requires complete relaxation and
-will often fail. It is probable that many apparent Atlas subluxations
-are really subluxations of the head upon that bone which leave Atlas
-and Axis in normal relation. This move is most used to loosen the Atlas
-when it resists ordinary adjustments.
-
-
-“THE BREAK” No. 1
-
-(Lateral Cervical Move)
-
-The principle involved in this and the three succeeding moves is the
-same. The contact is made with the end of the laterally prominent
-transverse process of a Cervical vertebra other than the Atlas, and the
-movement is directed entirely from side to side. It is to be used only
-for lateral and not for rotary or anterior or posterior subluxations, a
-point to be remembered as it is just as easy to produce as to correct
-subluxation with this move.
-
-
-Position
-
-Have patient lying on back in position C, with head projecting beyond
-bench and supported by adjuster’s knee. Following a record previously
-made count downward to a subluxated vertebra and palpate both
-transverses with the two hands at once to find if one is prominent
-laterally, remembering that the record indicates merely the position of
-the spinous process.
-
-Having found the laterally prominent transverse, place the tip of the
-finger of the corresponding hand on the spinous of the subluxated
-vertebra; that is, if a right subluxation, use right hand and if a
-left, use left hand. Then draw the hand around until the middle of
-the proximal phalanx of the first finger rests against the end of the
-transverse. The tip of the finger will be freed from the spinous by
-this movement.
-
-Hold the adjusting hand tense, edgewise to the neck, fingers together
-and pointing downward. The thumb may rest against the patient’s jaw
-or may be free; the essential thing is the snug contact of the first
-finger against the transverse.
-
-[Illustration: Fig. 10. “The Break,” No. 1, from right. Contact; first
-phalanx with end of right transverse.]
-
-
-Movement
-
-With the hand in position and the head supported by the Hook Support,
-bend the head laterally, keeping the face upward, until it is felt
-that further movement would strain the muscles.
-
-Deliver the movement in a straight lateral direction, quickly and
-entirely with the contact hand.
-
-
-“THE BREAK” No. 2
-
-For the Atlas only, and for straight lateral displacement of that
-vertebra.
-
-
-Position and Contact
-
-Position of patient’s head and of supporting hand exactly as in using
-Break No. 1. Contact is made with the end of the Atlas transverse
-on the laterally prominent side. Contact point on hand is second
-metacarpo-phalangeal joint, or rather, the condyle of the second
-metacarpal.
-
-
-Movement
-
-As for Break No. 1.
-
-
-“THE BREAK” No. 3
-
-
-Position
-
-Have patient sitting erect on bench or stool and stand before him. For
-a right subluxation use left hand and for a left, right hand. Contact
-point is the middle of the proximal phalanx of the first finger and the
-fingers reach backward and downward, thumb upward so as to be out of
-the way.
-
-
-Movement
-
-Force _should_ be applied entirely with the contact hand to avoid the
-possibility that movement of the head may bring about movement of some
-other vertebra than the desired one. But in practice the force is
-usually divided between the head and the vertebra. The Hook Support
-cannot be used in this position.
-
-
-Uses
-
-The use of this position for the Break avoids the necessity for the
-patient to lie down again in a new position after having Dorsals and
-Lumbars adjusted. It is extremely convenient. But on the other hand it
-is undeniably harder for the patient to relax his muscles when sitting
-up with head flexed sidewise and a sense of lost equilibrium than when
-lying down. The Break No. 1 will be found the better for the average
-case.
-
-
-“THE BREAK” No. 4
-
-
-Position
-
-Same as Break No. 3 except that adjuster stands behind patient and
-rests the thumb upon the base of the neck posteriorly while the fingers
-extend downward and forward toward the clavicle. As with No. 3, the
-supporting hand rests against the opposite side of the head and forces
-it sidewise to tighten the contact.
-
-[Illustration: Fig. 11. “The Break,” No. 3.]
-
-
-Movement
-
-Properly, a quick lateral movement of contact hand while the head is
-firmly held by the opposing hand.
-
-NOTE: “The Break” is unfortunately named and it would be well if some
-less suggestive term were generally substituted.
-
-
-THE ROTARY No. 1
-
-For the correction of rotation only, and usable in the Cervicals from 2
-to 7 inclusive.
-
-
-Philosophy of the Rotary
-
-A study of the Cervical articulations will make it clear that if a
-force be applied laterally to the spinous process the probable result
-will be a _rotation_ of the vertebra, which swings one articular
-process back from its fellow but leaves the other in close, but
-modified, contact. Thus the spinous process may appear to the left
-while the left articular process is fitted firmly against that of the
-adjacent vertebra, while those on the right are separated. Similar
-rotation, modified only by the difference in shape of the vertebrae,
-occurs in the Lumbar region.
-
-A movement applied to the spinous process might correct this condition
-or might complicate it according to the manner of application. But the
-_most direct line_ of force for correction is along a line which would
-pierce the separated articular processes almost in an antero-posterior
-direction. The Rotary approaches this very closely. It is a setting
-forward of the articular process against its fellow by applying a
-movement directly to the transverse process, which lies very close to
-the articular process.
-
-The great safety of the movement lies in the fact that it is impossible
-with any reasonable amount of force to move the transverse process too
-far. If the vertebra is not subluxated so as to indicate this movement,
-gentle attempts to use it will fail. The deceptive bent spinous process
-may sometimes be detected in this way.
-
-The chief objection to Rotary Nos. 1 and 2 is that the Dorsals and
-Lumbars cannot be adjusted in this position and the patient must rise
-from the bench and lie down again to have his Cervicals adjusted. This
-is obviated if No. 3 is used but the latter position fails to secure
-the perfect relaxation of muscles of Nos. 1 and 2, and is therefore
-recommended as an alternative only.
-
-The commonest obstacle to the use of this move is the voluntary or
-involuntary contraction of the neck muscles. The Hook Support, q. v.,
-will limit this resistance by affording a sense of perfect security to
-the patient. If muscles are _contractured_ a slight “check” will be
-felt as the head reaches a certain degree of rotation, and beyond this
-point it will refuse to move though easily movable within the radius
-limited by the “check.” It is as if the head were held by an inelastic
-cord. It is best when contracture is present not to attempt moving
-the head too far but to deliver the movement with the muscles as much
-relaxed as possible.
-
-[Illustration: Fig. 12. The Rotary, No. 1. Ready for the movement.]
-
-
-Position and Palpation
-
-Place patient in position C as described under Technic of Palpation.
-Stand at head of bench with patient’s head supported by one knee and
-perhaps also by one hand. Palpate chiefly to discover the numbers of
-vertebrae, following a record previously made. Finish palpation with
-the tip of the first finger of either hand resting upon the spinous
-process of the vertebra to be adjusted.
-
-
-Placing Contact
-
-Consider here which way the vertebra is to be moved; if toward
-the right use right hand and if toward the left use left hand for
-adjusting. Draw the adjusting hand straight around until the first
-finger, about the middle of the proximal phalanx, rests against and
-_behind_ the transverse process.
-
-It is important that the finger be drawn _straight_ around, and not
-upward or downward, except with the second Cervical with which the
-finger may pass slightly upward to the transverse. To insure correct
-placing of finger let patient’s head be absolutely at rest, supported
-by the Hook Support with face turned slightly away from the adjusting
-hand. Reinforce contact finger with the other three fingers held
-close together behind it. The thumb may or may not be placed against
-patient’s jaw as desired, but one must be careful not to lose exact
-contact by drawing adjusting hand upward from a lower Cervical in an
-attempt to reach the jaw.
-
-
-Use of Second Hand
-
-Meanwhile the other hand supports the head and holds its weight as
-described under the Hook Support, q. v.
-
-
-Turning Head
-
-Next, holding the first finger gently but firmly pressed against the
-transverse process, turn the head in the direction of the subluxation
-and away from the adjusting hand. That is, if the vertebra be
-subluxated to the right turn the face toward the right, the use of the
-terms “right” or “left” referring to the spinous process.
-
-
-Movement
-
-When the head is drawn around so that the vertebrae are thoroughly
-separated on the side toward which movement is to be directed, and the
-patient’s muscles are thoroughly relaxed though it is felt that further
-rotation of the head would put them upon a tension, give the movement.
-It consists in a quick throw of the adjusting hand, force transmitted
-from shoulder through an outward fling of the elbow, directed upward
-and inward against the transverse process. It replaces the articular
-process against its fellow, moving one vertebra, smoothly and easily.
-
-_All_ force should be delivered with contact hand. The hand moves
-through very little space. The principle of the movement is transmitted
-shock.
-
-[Illustration: Fig. 13. The Rotary, No. 2.]
-
-
-THE ROTARY No. 2
-
-A transition in technic between No. 1 and No. 3.
-
-
-Position
-
-Patient lies face upward on closed table, head resting upon forward
-section. Adjuster stands at side of patient, choosing the side
-according to the subluxation so as to face across the table in the
-direction toward which spinous process is to move. Palpation is
-difficult in this position on account of the increase in the curve of
-the Cervicals, so that it is best to follow a record previously made.
-
-Having found the subluxation make contact as follows.
-
-
-Contact
-
-Reach across patient’s neck with right hand for a right subluxation or
-left hand for a left, and find spinous process. Then draw the middle
-finger straight around until the palmar surface of the middle finger
-just below the second joint fits snugly behind the transverse process.
-Place the other hand under the head and with both hands working
-together turn the head toward you, chin upraised, and draw the neck
-into a greater flexion until it is felt that contact is firm and close.
-
-
-Movement
-
-The movement is a quick drawing toward the adjuster of the second,
-or contact, finger, which has been, as it were, hooked over the
-transverse. The transverse is thus drawn sharply forward and the
-vertebra rotates around its vertical axis so that the spinous follows,
-or tends to follow, the transverse in the same arc of movement.
-
-
-ROTARY No. 3
-
-
-Position
-
-Patient sitting erect, both feet evenly on floor and hands not braced.
-Stand in front of the patient but to one side or the other as for
-Rotary No. 2. Use right hand for adjusting right subluxations and left
-hand for lefts.
-
-
-Contact
-
-As for No. 2, contact is with palmar surface of second finger but
-may be shifted to third finger for the lower vertebrae if desired.
-The thumb is usually placed on the mandible and aids the opposite
-hand, placed on the other side of the head, in turning and otherwise
-controlling the head.
-
-
-Movement
-
-Turn the head away from the adjusting hand until the neck muscles feel
-taut as a result of position and not of contraction. The movement then
-is given as a sharp jerk of the contact hand forward.
-
-[Illustration: Fig. 14. The Rotary, No. 3.]
-
-
-ANCHOR MOVE No. 1
-
-
-Theory
-
-It is held that a vertebra often loses its proper relation with the
-vertebra below, and consequently with _all_ the vertebrae, or the
-entire column of the spine below, without being disturbed in its
-relation to the one, or ones, above; that, in other words, the column
-may be divided into two sections by subluxation, the upper section set
-askew upon the lower. With this reasoning it would clearly be desirable
-to so adjust the spine as to move a given vertebra, and with it all
-vertebra above, so to speak, upon the vertebra below. To do this all
-vertebrae above the one to which force is applied must needs be firmly
-_anchored_ to prevent strain between them.
-
-Such a move has been devised by Bunn for Cervical use and is here
-described from the author’s few observations only. Further study may
-modify the technic somewhat.
-
-[Illustration: Fig. 15. “Anchor Move,” No. 1. For a P. L. subluxation.]
-
-
-Position
-
-Patient is placed as for Dorsal and Lumbar adjustments in position
-B. Move is applied to rotated, postero-rotary, and antero-rotary
-subluxations and face turned toward side from which move is to be made.
-Adjuster, after palpation which discovers the vertebra to be moved and
-the direction of movement, stands at the head of table facing patient’s
-feet.
-
-
-Contact
-
-With the palms of both hands resting against the side of the neck and
-thumbs extended at right angles to hands, make contact with both thumbs
-on one vertebra as follows:
-
-If vertebra is to be rotated toward patient’s left, place right thumb
-against spinous process on its left side and left thumb upon right
-transverse process from behind it. Press firmly with the palm and
-fingers of each hand against the vertebrae above, gripping around neck
-and base of skull so as to hold all parts together.
-
-
-Movement
-
-The move is delivered simultaneously with the two hands, forcing
-spinous process toward the right and transverse in an anterior
-direction. The head must be raised from the bench and wholly supported
-by the hands and the head turns with the vertebra.
-
-
-Uses
-
-A powerful comparatively easy move which has the advantage of wide
-applicability and of avoiding the change of posture of the patient
-which mars many Cervical moves.
-
-[Illustration: Fig. 16. Posterior Cervical move.]
-
-
-ANCHOR MOVE No. 2
-
-
-Position
-
-Same as for No. 1.
-
-
-Contact
-
-For a left subluxation to be moved toward the right, place the left
-thumb upon the right side of the spinous process so that it hooks over
-the spinous in position to draw or pull the spinous. Place right thumb
-against the end of the left transverse as much on the anterior
-side as possible so that it may exert a _prying_ force in a posterior
-direction.
-
-
-Movement
-
-Simultaneous application of force with the thumbs tends to rotate the
-vertebra as does No. 1, but unlike No. 1 the tendency is to bring
-the vertebra out in a posterior direction instead of driving it more
-anteriorly.
-
-
-Uses
-
-This move is applied to rotated Cervicals which are anterior, more on
-one side than on the other.
-
-
-POSTERIOR CERVICAL MOVE
-
-
-Uses
-
-For a posterior Cervical below the Atlas. The common and careless
-practice of moving such a vertebra with the Rotary, or the dangerous
-practice of using the Recoil may be avoided by this move and much
-better results obtained.
-
-
-Position
-
-Patient in position C, head projecting well beyond bench so as to allow
-for a dropping backward of the head. Palpate as for the Rotary and hold
-palpating finger on tip of spinous process of posterior vertebra while
-contact is made.
-
-
-Contact
-
-Contact point is middle of radial surface of first phalanx of first
-finger and is placed against the tip of the spinous process, directly
-between it and the floor, as the patient lies. Hand is held rigid and
-edgewise, fingers together so that the contact finger is well supported.
-
-
-Completing Position
-
-Use the free hand to hold the head with the Hook Support, q. v. Turn
-the patient’s chin slightly away from the adjusting hand and drop the
-elbow of adjusting arm down until a straight line could pass through
-elbow, spinous process, and patient’s chin. It may be well to crouch
-and rest the elbow against one knee for solidity. Then allow the head
-to drop backward until chin is elevated and further backward flexion
-would strain the muscles. You are ready for the movement.
-
-
-Movement
-
-A quick throwing movement upward and inward, or toward patient’s chin.
-As nearly as may be the force should tend to pass along the spinous
-process in a direction exactly anterior to the (then) plane of the
-vertebra.
-
-NOTE: Either hand may be used with this movement.
-
-[Illustration: Fig. 17. Movement for correction of a lateral Atlas
-whose prominent transverse is posterior.]
-
-
-DOUBLE CONTACT MOVE
-
-
-Uses
-
-This is indicated for postero-rotary or postero-lateral subluxations.
-Its line of force is a bisector of the angle between the straight
-anterior and the straight lateral movement.
-
-[Illustration:
-
- Fig. 18. A movement for Atlas when laterally displaced. Contact:
- metacarpo-phalangeal joint with end of prominent transverse.
-]
-
-
-Contact
-
-There are two points of contact, both on the first finger, one (first
-secured) on the radial side of the second phalanx and the other on the
-radial side of the proximal phalanx. The first contact point is placed
-against the tip of the spinous, the other behind the transverse process.
-
-Press slightly against the two processes with the finger so as to feel
-them plainly.
-
-
-Completing Position
-
-Hold the head with the Hook Support and turn the face away from the
-adjusting hand (right hand for a P. R., left hand for a P. L.). Drop
-elbow low and hold it well away from your body so that there appears
-an obtuse angle between wrist and forearm with the point of the angle
-toward you. Be careful of this point as the tendency is to make an
-angle with the point away from you--a weak position.
-
-Drop head backward until firm resistance is felt.
-
-
-Movement
-
-Force is delivered in an antero-lateral direction as above described,
-_entirely_ with adjusting hand.
-
-
-THE “T. M.” No. 1
-
-
-Uses
-
-For subluxations listed R or L but not Posterior and upon C 6, C 7, D
-1, and D 2 only. This movement applies a lateral force to the spinous
-process so as to correct _rotation_ of the vertebra, but I repeat that
-it is inappropriate for posterior or postero-lateral subluxations.
-
-
-Position
-
-Patient lying in position B as for Dorsal adjustment. Find the
-subluxation by following the record and perceiving that the count
-assumed to be correct permits the subluxations to correspond to those
-recorded and that a vertebra in this region is R or L, R. A. or L. A.,
-R. S. or L. S., R. I. or L. I. The laterality of the spinous process
-determines the next step.
-
-For a right subluxation turn the face toward the _left_ and use _right_
-hand for contact hand. For a left subluxation turn the face to the
-right and use left hand for contact hand.
-
-
-Contact
-
-Thumb of contact hand is placed upon and against the side of the
-spinous process so that it presses firmly. The thumb is extended almost
-at right angles to the hand which rests upon the patient’s shoulder
-with fingers extending, and gripping, over the clavicle. Be sure of the
-solidity of the position.
-
-Next place the other hand upon the patient’s forehead and press the
-head backward, or toward the side of the contact hand, until the neck
-is well flexed and the tissues tightened between the now opposing
-hands.
-
-[Illustration: Fig. 19. The “T. M.,” No. 1.]
-
-
-Movement
-
-When this tightened condition is reached a quick decisive movement of
-_both_ hands in opposite directions, but chiefly of the hand applied to
-the head, will secure an easy movement of the vertebra.
-
-This move is a very valuable adaptation of the old crude and other
-dangerous “T. M.,” of which No. 2, below, is another, more like the
-original move but possessing several “safety” features.
-
-
-“T. M.” No. 2
-
-
-Position of Patient
-
-The patient sits erect on a flat seat with both feet resting upon the
-floor as during palpation.
-
-
-Placing Hands
-
-After careful palpation and selection of a vertebra to be adjusted
-in this way, stand directly behind the patient. If the vertebra is
-subluxated to the right use right hand for adjusting (or contact) hand,
-if to the left use left hand. Hold the hand so that the thumb is at
-right angles to the hand and tense and firm. Place the palmar surface
-of the end of the thumb against and upon the tip of the spinous process
-and grasp the neck firmly with the fingers, which extend over the base
-of the neck and toward the clavicle. The other hand is placed easily on
-the top of the head.
-
-
-Position of Head
-
-The completing of position after contact has been made is governed by
-two considerations; the need for relaxing the neck muscles and for
-so supporting the vertebrae above the contact that movement will take
-place only at the point of contact. If the neck muscles are contracted
-the movement is almost always defeated and should always be abandoned
-to avoid strain.
-
-To secure the desired position ask the patient to relax his muscles
-and allow you to place his head as desired. If he seeks to place it
-himself the necessary muscular contraction on his part will defeat the
-movement. The movements of the head must be passive.
-
-With thumb and remainder of adjusting hand properly placed, use the
-other hand upon the head as follows: First flex the head forward on
-the chest as far as possible, then rotate it slightly so that the face
-is turned a little toward adjusting hand. Then flex the head sidewise
-until a resisting pull of muscles indicates that they have been
-stretched taut. It is well during the third movement described to let
-the forearm swing down at right angles to the hand so that it presses
-firmly against the ends of all the Cervical transverses, distributing
-the force among them.
-
-Or, after placing contact hand rest the elbow in the angle at the base
-of the neck and let the forearm extend upward along the side of the
-neck. Then flex the wrist until the hand will rest upon the patient’s
-head and perform the movements of the head as described above.
-
-[Illustration: Fig. 20. The “T. M.,” No. 2. Note position of right arm
-and hand of adjuster.]
-
-
-Movement
-
-A quick, simultaneous movement of both hands in opposite directions,
-_two-thirds_ of which is given with the hand which holds the head.
-The thumb in contact with the spinous process moves slightly inward
-toward the median line but its chief use is to hold the vertebra very
-firmly. To this end part of its force is directed forward against the
-shoulder and through the ball of the thumb.
-
-Failure to place the head properly or in securing sufficient flexion
-of the neck before move is attempted are the chief causes of failure.
-Force must be delivered quickly and sharply and the best adjustment of
-this kind is usually the one in which the head and hands move through
-the least space.
-
-
-Uses
-
-This movement is obviously useful only for the correction of
-_rotation_, since the force is directed sidewise against the spinous
-process.
-
-The “T. M.” was originally intended as a Cervical adjustment, but its
-greatest use is now from C 6 to D 2 inclusive. Above the sixth its use
-is questionable because of the possibility of moving more than one
-vertebra or some other than the one desired.
-
-
-“THE RECOIL”
-
-(Pisiform Contact)
-
-
-Position of Patient
-
-This movement is best given on bifid bench of the type commonly known
-to the profession. Place patient on forward section so that its rear
-edge rests just below the axilla; this may be ascertained by passing a
-hand under patient’s arm after he is in position, when the edge of the
-bench should be felt about an inch below the hanging arm. The thighs
-should rest on rear section so that the pubic symphysis is free of the
-bench. The semicircular pubic cut is an advantage in that it avoids
-injury without making necessary too great a suspension between sections.
-
-Thus the abdomen and the lower part of the thorax are suspended between
-sections. Under them an abdominal support may be used but it must have
-the quality of elasticity in a high degree and must lie always below
-the plane of the other two sections or it will interfere with a perfect
-adjustment.
-
-For adjustment of the last two Cervicals or any Dorsal down to the
-sixth, it is best to turn patient’s head toward the direction of the
-subluxation. This curves that section of the spine into an arc toward
-the convex side of which movement may be made more easily than toward
-the concave.
-
-The patient’s hands may lie under the table, loosely, or may reach back
-and rest upon the buttocks, palm upward. Whichever position secures
-best relaxation is to be used in any case.
-
-This movement may be used with the roll. (See Fig. 30 and p. 285.)
-
-[Illustration: Fig. 21. After palpation. Finger ready to guide contact
-hand to a spinous process.]
-
-
-Position of Adjuster
-
-Stand on either side of patient, feet apart for base and poise. The
-direction of the feet and position of body will vary according to
-the direction of the adjustment, by the following two rules:
-
-Rule 1. For movement of a vertebra _away_ from the side on which
-you stand, place your arms and hands in such a position that the
-pisiform bone of adjusting hand, both elbows, and both shoulder joints
-(shoulders being dropped loosely forward) will fall in the same plane
-and that the plane of direction in which the vertebra is to be moved.
-In other words, let the force be applied in a line straight from
-your body _through_ the vertebra. Always shift your feet to a proper
-position from which to direct the movement.
-
-Rule 2. To move a vertebra _toward_ the side on which you stand, step
-close to patient’s body and support yourself with one knee against
-the adjusting table at the most convenient point. Then place arms so
-that contact point, elbows, shoulders, and the mid-point of the body’s
-base, between the feet, are all in the same plane. This insures balance
-during and after the movement and is the attitude from which the
-greatest and most carefully measured force can be delivered.
-
-It will be seen that the desire is always to deliver all force in one
-plane and thus avoid conflict of forces and waste or misdirection
-through the predominance of one force over the other, and to use both
-arms with equal facility in the move. There are at least a hundred
-ways to hinder this movement by varying the preliminary positions. And
-no one can know the real efficiency of the move who has not become
-instinctively adept at taking position.
-
-
-Use of Hands and Arms
-
-Use of hands for palpation has been described. (P. 46.)
-
-The palpating hand comes to rest with the middle finger on the spinous
-process of the vertebra to be adjusted. The heel of the hand is raised,
-the first and third fingers doubled back, and the heel lowered again.
-Now the middle finger alone is a slender pointer guiding to the contact
-point.
-
-Place pisiform bone of other hand snugly _against_ the process to
-be moved. The hand should rest in a slight arch, pisiform against
-spinous, fingers rigid and flexed on hand, last finger firmly anchored,
-or pressed into the flesh, to prevent slipping. (Fig. 22 shows the
-position.)
-
-The anchoring fingers must always extend away from the adjuster. To
-turn the fingers back across the spine, in moving a vertebra toward
-you, is always an error, and the price is partial loss of use of one
-arm.
-
-With the adjusting hand satisfactorily placed, grasp its wrist firmly
-with the other hand so that the pisiform of the supporting hand rests
-in the hollow between the wrist and the metacarpal bone of the extended
-thumb. By this contact force is driven directly through the chain of
-bones across the wrist and to the pisiform bone without spreading.
-In grasping the wrist let the thumb extend around the forearm in one
-direction and the four fingers in the other. Beware of gripping only
-with thumb and first finger in which case the edge of the supporting
-hand will rest on the back of the contact hand and spread the delivered
-force too widely.
-
-[Illustration: Fig. 22. “The Recoil.” Ready for the movement.]
-
-
-Movement
-
-I have said, but have not sufficiently emphasized the command, that the
-shoulders must be dropped loosely forward. Let me add that just before
-the movement is given the head should be allowed to sag downward and
-the muscles to become relaxed. This movement given with stiff shoulders
-and upraised head becomes a _push_.
-
-The desired movement is a _throwing_ movement.
-
-Force is released from both shoulders at once, concentrated at the
-same instant by a slight shifting forward of the elbows, and strikes
-the spinous process as _one_ force, which is the resultant of the two
-meeting at the wrist of contact hand and being united there. The two
-arms use the contact hand as a passive instrument for driving the
-vertebra.
-
-The objective point, the distance to which the movement is mentally
-thrown at the instant of delivery, should be the center of mass of the
-vertebra, varying according to the section of the spine.
-
-
-Contact Point
-
-The exact contact point of hand with vertebra varies. If the vertebra
-is to be moved toward the right the pisiform rests _against_ (not
-_upon_) the left side of the spinous; if toward the left and inferior,
-against the right side and just above, in the notch between it and the
-next superior process. The rule is to so place hand that the spinous
-process is between the pisiform and the direction to which movement is
-given.
-
-On the hand the contact may be said to vary, according to the direction
-of subluxation and position of adjuster, so as to describe a circle
-around the pisiform in the course of the various changes of position
-necessary to the use of this movement. No error could be greater than
-to attempt to use always the same face of the pisiform and to adapt the
-position of hands and arms to this end, when any face or aspect of the
-little bone is equally good with any other.
-
-
-Which Hand Used
-
-When standing on patient’s right use left hand for palpating hand
-and right hand for contact with the vertebra, using left hand again
-to grip and reinforce the contact hand. Exception to this is made by
-introducing an extra change of hands with C 6, or 7, D 1, L 4 or 5,
-and Sacrum. The change is necessitated by the insecurity of the usual
-position or the fact that it cramps the wrist of contact hand. To make
-the change: palpate as usual, hold subluxation with second finger of
-palpating hand, substitute second finger of other hand and withdraw
-palpating hand, which is then free to make the contact.
-
-When standing on left side exactly reverse the use of hands. Palpate
-with the same hand which would be used if patient were sitting.
-Introduce no unnecessary move into the placing of the hands. This will
-be found to produce better results than any other technic for this
-portion of the move.
-
-
-Delivery of Force
-
-In using this movement it is perhaps best to deliver nearly equal force
-with both hands; certainly whatever forces are released by the arms
-should be simultaneous. It is possible, however, to allow one arm to
-preponderate in the movement without marring its efficiency, but the
-amateur adjuster will do well to balance his forces at first.
-
-
-Speed and Concentration
-
-Speed is a prime essential. By its employment a very ordinary amount of
-muscular strength can be made to accomplish a large amount of work and
-very difficult adjustments may be accomplished.
-
-Concentration of mind at the instant of adjustment, so as to secure
-muscular control and perfect co-ordination of the two arms as well
-as to direct and concentrate the forces used at a given and strictly
-limited area, is also essential.
-
-
-Uses
-
-For ordinary adjustments of Dorsal or Lumbar subluxations, excepting
-the middle four Dorsals, for breaking ankyloses by repeated
-applications of force, and for overcoming muscular resistance in
-patients who are unable to relax at all, this form or style of
-adjusting is probably the best. It is most useful in the Dorsals. In
-many instances Lumbar vertebrae will move better by application of a
-slightly slower force, especially if a roll is used. The Recoil may be
-used with the roll.
-
-While it is easily possible to move any Cervical in this way, making
-no change in the technic except to use the ulnar side of the fifth
-metacarpal bone for the contact instead of the pisiform, it is
-inadvisable in most cases above the sixth, and in some instances
-absolutely unpardonable. The shock to the nervous system and the danger
-of moving two or more vertebrae or of subluxating a normal one are
-too great. In at least one instance hemiplegia instantly followed the
-use of this move on the Axis, and headaches and nerve exhaustion are
-frequent sequelae.
-
-For these reasons it is probably best never to use “The Recoil” above
-the sixth Cervical. For every form of subluxation there is an easier
-and safer mode of correction.
-
-
-Name
-
-This has been called “The Recoil” because of a belief that if force
-be applied to a vertebra in the form of a very rapidly transmitted
-shock the vertebra will rebound to the shock and settle in its normal
-position, the intelligence within the body utilizing the force thus
-blindly applied to bring about this result.
-
-This belief is erroneous. First the vertebra and all surrounding
-tissues are misshapen to fit their _abnormal_ position and relation
-and this shape gives them a tendency, if rapidly loosened, to settle
-into the old abnormal position. Second, there is no such conscious
-intelligence which has power to replace a subluxated vertebra. If this
-supposition were correct, then the Innate Intelligence would do well to
-utilize those jars and shocks which ordinarily _produce_ subluxation
-to bring about normality and keep the spine perfectly aligned.
-
-There is no such internal rebound or recoil as stated above. The chief
-value of the movement lies in its speed, according to principles
-equally applicable to other moves, and in accord with the Law of
-Momentum.
-
-
-Sources of Information
-
-This movement as described above contains many essential principles
-which follow Parker and Palmer, developers of “The Recoil,” but the
-technic is considerably modified to suit the author’s own views. It
-cannot be claimed, therefore, that this is “The Recoil” as now taught
-by Palmer, since the chief stress is here laid upon the movement of
-the vertebra in a predetermined direction and not upon the withdrawal
-of the hands to let “Innate” do the work. The name “Recoil” is really
-inappropriate for the move as described.
-
-
-THE HEEL CONTACT
-
-A movement for the adjustment of posterior, postero-superior, or
-postero-inferior subluxations in the Dorsal region (except middle
-four) and in the Lumbar. May also be used for postero-laterals when
-laterality is very slight. Given with patient in position B. Contact
-point, heel of hand with spinous process.
-
-
-Heel Contact
-
-By the “heel of the hand” is here meant the depression between the
-scaphoid and pisiform bones. This hollow forms a natural receiver for a
-spinous process and thus avoids lateral slipping.
-
-The four fingers of adjusting hand are spread out and anchored upon
-the patient’s body. The wrist is held at a right angle to hand and the
-arm straightened, the elbow being outrotated until it “locks,” that is
-until it will move no farther. The other hand grasps the wrist of the
-adjusting hand.
-
-
-Adjusting Hand
-
-The rule is to use the right hand for adjusting hand if standing on
-patient’s right and palpating with left, or to use left hand if on left
-side and palpating with right. The fingers are to be directed toward
-the patient’s feet. Exception to this rule is made with the last two
-Lumbars, where it is more convenient to change hands and direct the
-fingers toward the head.
-
-[Illustration: Fig. 23. “Heel contact.”]
-
-
-Movement
-
-This is given almost entirely with adjusting arm; that is, with the arm
-whose hand is in contact with the vertebra. The supporting hand serves
-merely to guide the force to a definite point as if a straight rod were
-working through a fixed circlet. Indeed, the force in this movement is
-delivered almost straight down from the shoulder. Shoulder should
-be dropped well out of its socket so as to secure play for a sudden
-downward movement without raising the hand from its contact. If the
-shoulder is stiff or the head of the humerus remains in the glenoid
-cavity the movement cannot be properly given without raising the hand.
-Movement is quick, sharp, and _deep_, i. e., directed to the center of
-mass of the vertebra.
-
-It may be directed straight toward floor to correct a posterior,
-inclined slightly toward the head or feet to correct approximation,
-or--as some aver--slightly sidewise to correct a mild degree of
-rotation.
-
-
-PISIFORM DOUBLE TRANSVERSE No. 1
-
-An adjustment to be used only in the Dorsals from fourth to ninth
-inclusive, for posterior or postero-rotary subluxations. It is probably
-best to use this movement only for straight posterior subluxations and
-to apply either the Pisiform Single Transverse or the Two Finger Double
-Transverse to the rotary displacements in this region.
-
-
-Contact
-
-Both pisiform bones, each _upon_ a transverse process and both upon the
-_same_ vertebra.
-
-With patient in position B and the adjuster standing upon his left
-the contact should be made by the following exact method. Palpate
-with right hand, which comes to rest upon the spinous process of the
-subluxated vertebra. Note if it be P. R. or P. L., because this fact
-will govern the next movement. Let the first finger of palpating hand
-reach outward about one inch and upward to a point opposite the tip of
-the next superior spinous process, which point will approximate the
-position of the transverse. This first upon the side of the _posterior_
-transverse, which will be the right with a left subluxation or the left
-with a right one. Let second and third fingers, now abandoning the
-spinous, follow the first and rest over the assumed position of the
-transverse.
-
-Now palpate with a deep, limited, massage movement until the
-club-shaped extremity of the transverse is felt under the middle
-finger. Hold this point with the middle finger, drawing away the other
-two, and guide the free hand to an exact contact _upon_ the transverse.
-Thus if standing on the left, as predicated, the _left_ hand will be
-first to make contact and with the most posterior transverse, with
-which most _exact_ contact is necessary.
-
-With pisiform placed, let the fingers extend away from your body; if on
-the side of the spine opposite you, let them extend downward so as to
-follow the curve of the rib and to be anchored upon the rib connected
-with the transverse of contact; if on the same side, let fingers extend
-downward parallel with the column.
-
-[Illustration: Fig. 24. Pisiform double transverse adjustment as it
-should be given, elbows locked.]
-
-Now--still using the original palpating hand--palpate on the other
-side from the first contact until the other transverse is discovered.
-Mark its tip with a quick, deep pressure and a sharp withdrawal of the
-fingers, so that a spot of anaemia appears momentarily. Carefully
-place the pisiform of the palpating hand in contact, guided by the
-anaemic spot. If this second contact is on the side on which you stand
-the fingers will be toward the head; if on the opposite side, they will
-follow the rib curve outward and downward.
-
-Re-read the above directions carefully. It will be seen that the
-technic is quite free from unnecessary movements.
-
-The two hands are now placed almost exactly at right angles to each
-other, arched fingers anchored to prevent slipping.
-
-If you stand on the patient’s right the use of hands is, of course,
-exactly reversed, the left hand being palpating hand, and making the
-first contact.
-
-
-Completing Position
-
-When hands are in position and adjuster standing so as to face directly
-across the spine, the arms are rotated outward until the elbows
-“lock.” The adjuster leans over so as to have shoulders directly over
-the spine, draws the body back from the shoulder girdle to secure
-freest play in the shoulder joints, and drops head loosely between the
-shoulders so as to relax the trapezius and prevent any checking of the
-force.
-
-
-Movement
-
-Directly downward from the shoulders through straight, stiff arms. The
-force is delivered separately with the two arms and yet simultaneously.
-If the vertebra is straight posterior, equal force must be applied
-on the two sides; if it is posterior and slightly rotated (P. R. or
-P. L.), most force must be applied to the more posterior transverse.
-
-Considerable practice and looseness of shoulder are required to use
-this movement properly. It is a regrettable fact that few adjusters
-_do_ use it correctly, most of them giving a _thrust_ instead of a
-transmitted shock.
-
-
-PISIFORM DOUBLE TRANSVERSE No. 2
-
-This modification of the pisiform double transverse move is here
-described because of its popularity rather than because the author
-wishes to recommend it. The position is the same as for No. 1, and
-the uses also, except that it tends to correct postero-inferior
-subluxations and is not at all adapted for use with superiors.
-
-
-Contact
-
-Both pisiforms below the two transverses (caudad). After palpation
-which discloses the posterior transverse the hands are placed as
-follows: Palpating hand rests always on the side of the spine next the
-operator; opposite hand crosses the spine. Both are slanted upward
-so that the fingers point toward the head with the axes of the hand
-slightly diverging above. The wrists are thus crossed in such a way as
-to force the forearms to be somewhat flexed on the arms and to slant
-away from the wrists at an obtuse angle. This with the contact _below_
-the transverses, renders it impossible not to force the vertebra in an
-upward (superior) direction when movement is given.
-
-[Illustration: Fig. 25. Two-finger double transverse.]
-
-
-Movement
-
-A comparatively slow thrusting movement, which tends to spring the
-spine. The merit of this method lies in its comparative painlessness.
-Its technic is not attractive.
-
-
-TWO FINGER DOUBLE TRANSVERSE
-
-A movement for posterior or postero-rotary displacements from fourth
-to ninth Dorsal inclusive. It serves the same purpose as the Pisiform
-Double Transverse but is less painful and often easier of delivery. The
-palmar surface of the fingers, with the flesh of the patient’s back,
-make a compound cushion which acts as a shock-absorber.
-
-
-Palpation--Contact
-
-The usual downward gliding movement of left hand if standing on right
-or of right hand if standing on left will serve for the discovery of
-the vertebra listed for adjustment. The gliding hand stops with the
-second finger indicating the spinous process. The first finger reaches
-upward and outward to the assumed location of the transverse on the
-side nearest the adjuster; then the second finger reaches to a similar
-point on the other side, both fingers pointing toward patient’s head.
-Now the fingers are rolled a little to make sure that they are in
-contact with the ends of the transverse, the palmar surface of the tip
-of each finger being the proper contact point. The heel of the contact
-hand rests near, but not on, the surface of the body over the midspinal
-line.
-
-
-Supporting Hand
-
-The ulnar edge of the free hand is now placed across the tips of the
-two contact fingers so that it rests directly above the ends of the
-transverses but separated from them by the finger tips. The upper arm
-is then straightened and the elbow outrotated until it locks firmly so
-that the arm makes a straight line directly above the transverses. The
-body is drawn away from the shoulder girdle, pulling the head of the
-humerus out of its socket as far as possible to allow free play, for
-all force is to be given by this straight arm.
-
-
-Movement
-
-If the subluxation is a straight posterior the force is driven directly
-downward so as to be distributed equally to the two contact points. If
-it be a postero-rotary, most force is directed to the more prominent
-(posterior) transverse. Force should be delivered quickly, keeping in
-mind the principle of transmitted shock.
-
-Contrary to the general belief, as much force can be developed with
-this move as is needful for any ordinary adjustment. The fact that it
-is often recommended for use with children or with sensitive or frail
-patients has led to the belief that it is a relatively ineffective
-move, whereas its value in such cases lies only in the fact that it
-inflicts less pain than some others.
-
-[Illustration: Fig. 26. Pisiform single transverse move, No. 1.]
-
-
-PISIFORM SINGLE TRANSVERSE MOVE No. 1
-
-Like the movement just described, this adjustment may be used in
-the Dorsals from fourth to ninth inclusive. It should be limited to
-those subluxations which are rotated without being posterior. In such
-an instance the spinous process _appears_ to be laterally displaced
-without being posterior, or may appear slightly _anterior_ because it
-is describing an arc about a fixed center of rotation in the body of
-the vertebra. One transverse process appears anterior and the other
-posterior to the line of their fellows.
-
-
-Palpation
-
-Palpate as for the Recoil and use the same adjusting hand as in that
-movement, i. e., right hand if standing on right side and palpating
-with left, or left hand if standing on left and palpating with right.
-When the palpating fingers have discovered the subluxated spinous
-process, the first finger seeks a point even with the tip of the next
-superior spinous process and about an inch to the side on which is the
-_posterior_ (prominent) transverse. The second and third fingers follow
-and, dipping inward with a rolling or massage motion, discover the end
-of the transverse.
-
-
-Contact
-
-Now the adjusting hand is placed with its pisiform resting directly
-_upon_ the blunt end of the transverse. If the contact is on the same
-side of the spine with the adjuster the fingers of adjusting hand
-extend across the spine and are anchored on the other side, the hand
-arching sharply and fingers extending somewhat downward. If contact is
-on opposite side of spine the fingers follow the rib curve downward and
-outward and are similarly anchored. In every case the fingers should
-extend away from, and never toward, the adjuster’s body. To violate
-this rule renders one arm almost useless through its position.
-
-At this juncture the palpating hand becomes a reinforcing hand, to grip
-the wrist of the other and to aid in the movement.
-
-
-Movement
-
-The force is directed in a straight anterior direction, quickly and
-decisively, as if a spinous process were the lever used. Remember that
-contact must always be made with the _posterior_ transverse. To drive
-this anterior is to rotate the vertebra around its vertical axis and to
-bring the spinous process toward the median line, while the opposite,
-and more anterior, transverse becomes more posterior, as it should be.
-
-
-PISIFORM SINGLE TRANSVERSE No. 2
-
-
-Uses
-
-For rotated first or second Dorsals with which, for any reason, the
-“T. M.” fails. This move involves a use of the head as a lever, as does
-the “T. M.” No. 2. Inadvisable unless the posterior transverse of the
-rotated vertebra can be palpated--but often used in cheerful disregard
-of this detail by those sublimely capable adjusters who do not need to
-find a vertebra before moving it.
-
-
-Palpation--Contact
-
-Palpate as for No. 1 above. Very deep palpation will be necessary
-because the spinous process here is nearly horizontal to the body and
-the transverse is very deeply placed, overlaid with heavy muscles.
-
-When process is found place pisiform bone of free hand upon it,
-pressing the muscles aside as much as possible to avoid bruising and
-resting a considerable amount of weight upon the contact hand. Fingers
-of contact hand may extend across the spine or downward and parallel
-with the spine. Or, the hands may be changed so that the palpating hand
-becomes the contact hand and is placed with the fingers gripped over
-the base of the neck toward the clavicle.
-
-
-Head Leverage
-
-The free hand is now placed upon the forehead and the head, which faces
-toward the contact hand, is flexed backward until the muscles seem taut.
-
-
-Movement
-
-Is a quick, but fairly gentle, movement of both hands together, so that
-the head is rocked still further backward at the instant an anteriorly
-directed force is applied to the prominent transverse. The result is
-rotation of the vertebra--unless there be a loose articulation in the
-Cervicals which gives way under the force applied to the head.
-
-
-THE EDGE CONTACT
-
-(“Point 2 Contact”--“Knife Move.”)
-
-
-Name
-
-This movement has various names. The name “Point 2 Contact” is
-handed down from the days when Palmer used three contact points and
-three moves and designated the middle of the ulnar side of the fifth
-metacarpal bone as “Point 2.” The name “Edge Contact” was applied
-later, during the improvements in its technic when the hooking of the
-thumbs stiffened its efficiency and made it very valuable. It has since
-been rediscovered (though in constant use) and re-named “Knife Move.”
-
-
-Uses
-
-A movement which uses the spinous process as a lever and is applicable
-to D 2, 3, or 4, and to any Dorsal or Lumbar from D 8 down, when
-posterior, postero-superior, or postero-inferior. It does not correct
-rotation except insofar as the shape of articular processes may aid an
-anteriorly directed move in rotating the vertebra.
-
-Some Chiropractors have used the Edge Contact in the Cervicals but this
-is always improper, as it is practically
-
-impossible in some, and difficult in all, cases to cover only one
-spinous process when the head is resting on its side.
-
-[Illustration: Fig. 27. The edge contact in Lumbar region.]
-
-
-Palpation
-
-Same as for Recoil or Heel Contact, q. v.
-
-
-Contact
-
-Using the same adjusting hand as for the Heel Contact, place the
-middle of the ulnar edge of the fifth metacarpal bone in contact with
-the spinous process. If the vertebra be superior, place the edge of
-hand _above_, if inferior, place the hand _below_. This contact is
-especially good for S or I vertebrae.
-
-
-Position of Hands and Arms
-
-The fingers of adjusting hand cross the spine at a right angle to its
-long axis. The back of hand will be toward patient’s head except in
-adjusting the last two Lumbars, with which a change of hands is made
-necessary by the upward slant of the lower half of the Lumbar curve.
-
-The palpating hand now grips the adjusting hand so that the fingers of
-the upper hand, held close together, press against and reinforce the
-lower on its dorsum and just above the contact point. The thumbs are
-hooked together as shown in Fig. 27, so that the hands may be stiffened
-and their tendency to roll avoided.
-
-The elbows are outrotated and locked as in the Pisiform Double
-Transverse Move and both shoulders are loosened.
-
-
-Movement
-
-This is chiefly delivered with the upper arm, using upper hand to
-drive the lower. Force should be quickly delivered when patient is
-relaxed. The direction of force should be determined by the direction
-of subluxation and by the slant of the spinous process. Thus, when
-patient lies prone upon a bifid bench and sways downward against a lax
-abdominal support, the spinous processes of the lower dorsal make an
-acute angle with the plane of the floor. If one be superior, contact
-above it and force driven straight toward the floor will tend to
-correct the subluxation. There is a slightly different force angle for
-every subluxation correctable by this move.
-
-This move is less painful than the pisiform contact and may often be
-used to advantage, especially in the Lumbar region.
-
-
-LUMBAR SINGLE TRANSVERSE
-
-For the correction of a rotated Lumbar. Best used on second and third.
-This movement should never be attempted unless the transverse process
-can be palpated. Lumbar transverses are sometimes short or fragile, and
-unless they can be distinctly felt no force should be applied where
-they are _believed_ to lie.
-
-
-Contact
-
-Pisiform bone with posterior transverse.
-
-[Illustration: Fig. 28. Lumbar single transverse move.]
-
-
-Palpation and Placing of Hands
-
-Palpating as if for other movements, pause with the second finger of
-palpating hand indicating the spinous process of the vertebra to be
-moved. Note that if the spinous process be to the right of the median
-line the left transverse will be posterior, if to the left, the right
-transverse.
-
-The transverse may then be found as in the Dorsals; it should lie even
-with the interspace above the spinous process, deeply overlaid with
-strong muscles. When the transverse has been located by a deep, probing
-movement of the fingers, place adjusting hand, pisiform on transverse,
-close to the spinous process for greater solidity and fingers extending
-downward and outward from the midspinal line parallel with the lower
-rib curve.
-
-If the adjuster stands on the side of the patient opposite to the
-transverse to be moved the hand opposite the palpating hand becomes the
-contact hand, as in other moves. But if the posterior transverse is
-on the same side with the adjuster, a change of hands is made and the
-palpating hand becomes contact hand. To accomplish this the adjuster
-must turn and face away from the patient with arm extended straight
-downward to the contact. After contact is made the remaining hand
-reinforces the adjusting hand by gripping the wrist.
-
-
-Movement
-
-In making the contact press downward, deeply and firmly, so as to
-crowd the muscles aside and place the pisiform directly _upon_ the
-transverse. Movement is given after the patient’s body has been swung
-downward for a considerable distance, and is sharp and decisive,
-directed straight toward the floor.
-
-
-LUMBAR DOUBLE TRANSVERSE MOVE
-
-A movement sometimes applied to posterior or postero-rotary Lumbars.
-
-
-Palpation and Contact
-
-From the spinous, find first the more posterior transverse and make
-contact with it, since most force must be directed there. Stand facing
-patient’s head and place right hand on right transverse and left hand
-on left.
-
-Contact point in this move is the tuberosity of the scaphoid with the
-posterior surface of the transverse. Fingers curve away from median
-line so as to avoid the rib curve.
-
-
-Movement
-
-After heavy, steady pressure downward, force is delivered with a quick,
-throwing movement, most force on the posterior side.
-
-
-THE “SPREAD” MOVE
-
-Upon the theory that when two forces are simultaneously applied, the
-one to drive some vertebra cephalad (by its spinous process) and the
-other to drive some lower vertebra caudad, the intervening vertebrae
-tend, if anterior, to be drawn outward or toward a more posterior
-position, this move is predicated.
-
-The author does not believe that it accomplishes its purpose, but will
-briefly describe it for the benefit of those who do.
-
-
-Position
-
-Patient is placed over a roll which rests under the thighs so as to
-flex thighs and pelvis on the Lumbar spine, or an adjustable table
-is so tilted, both sections sloping downward from the middle, as to
-accomplish the same result.
-
-
-Contact
-
-The usual method, if only a single vertebra is anterior, is to make
-contact with the vertebrae immediately adjacent, crossing the hands and
-having fingers of upper hand pointing toward head and of lower hand
-toward Sacrum. But some adjusters use this move differently, making
-contact with Sacrum and with the mid-dorsal region in general and
-applying a slow force with both hands. Contact is with heel of hand
-upon spinous process.
-
-
-SACRAL ADJUSTMENTS
-
-The adjustment of the comparatively fixed sacrum is difficult at
-best and requires a very considerable force, violently applied. It
-is probable that nine-tenths of all attempts to move sacra fail. In
-children, when sacrum does not articulate properly with the ilia, and
-in adults in whom the sacrum has been loosened by trauma and remains
-in an abnormal relation to surrounding structures, it can be moved.
-
-The sacrum is described as being posterior at the base or at the apex,
-and its axis for rotation is believed to be a transverse line through
-the sacroiliac articulations. Force for its adjustment is applied at
-right angles to the curve of the sacrum at the point of contact. The
-best contact is with the heel of the hand against a part of the sacrum,
-the wrist of the adjusting hand being gripped and reinforced by the
-other hand. If standing on patient’s left, the right hand becomes
-adjusting hand for sacrum as for the last two Lumbars, if on the right,
-the left hand.
-
-Another contact is with the pisiform and adjacent soft part of hand
-upon the sacral base, the pisiform hooking against the first sacral
-spinous process.
-
-Do not mistake an anterior fifth Lumbar for a posterior sacral base.
-Discriminate between iliac and sacral subluxations by noting that with
-the latter both sacroiliac articulations, and with the former only one
-seems abnormal.
-
-[Illustration: Fig. 29. “Bohemian Move” for correction of anterior
-fifth Lumbar by transmitting shock through spine.]
-
-
-ILIAC ADJUSTMENTS
-
-
-Palpation
-
-With patient sitting erect on flat surface, feet on floor, stand behind
-and examine both sacroiliac articulations at once with the palmar
-surfaces of the fingers of both hands. If the two articulations are
-similar in every line neither ilium is subluxated, though the _sacrum_
-may be rotated on its transverse axis between the ilia, so as to be
-posterior or anterior at base or apex.
-
-But no examination of the ilia is complete without investigating also
-the lumbosacral articulation. It sometimes happens that though the
-first sacral spinous process naturally completes the lumbar curve and
-there is no lumbosacral subluxation the crests of both ilia appear much
-posterior to their normal relation to the upper part of sacrum: this is
-a double iliac displacement.
-
-Usually the ilia are both normally articulated; this is one of the most
-difficult joints to weaken and is seldom affected except by the most
-extreme force. When iliac subluxation exists one side is affected alone
-nine times out of ten. The tenth case may show double subluxation.
-
-
-Movement
-
-Nine-tenths of the so-called “iliac adjustments” are quite amusingly
-ineffective. The force required really to _move_ an ileum (save in
-joint disease or in children) is tremendous and not to be commanded by
-the ordinary adjuster. The light jars applied as a routine procedure
-by so many Chiropractors are in reality nothing more than single
-percussion strokes which stimulate the sacral nerves.
-
-Place patient in position B and apply the hands to a posterior ilium
-as to a posterior sacrum, making contact with the most prominent
-portion of crest or posterior border and driving in a direction which
-would represent a part of the circumference of a circle of which the
-transverse sacral axis of rotation touches the center, or the center
-of fixation in the sacroiliac joint.
-
-
-COCCYGEAL ADJUSTMENTS
-
-
-Examination
-
-Place patient on an angle table, i. e., one which rises in the center
-and slopes away toward either end. Separate the thighs slightly,
-patient lying face down, and insert the rubber-covered second finger,
-palmar surface upward, very carefully into the rectum. The tip of the
-coccyx may then be felt and its movability and position determined.
-Unless it is immovably fixed in an abnormal position it should not be
-molested; the movable coccyx responds to mere muscle tension by changes
-of position and cannot act as a primary cause of nerve impingement.
-
-Usually this examination will be rendered unnecessary by the external
-palpation which may disclose the movability of the coccyx and at once
-render further exploration superfluous.
-
-When the coccyx is anteriorly subluxated and ankylosed in that position
-it may be a factor in producing constipation, hemorrhoids, etc., but
-its influence in other diseases, especially of the nervous system, has
-been greatly overrated by those who have not yet fully accepted the
-doctrine that nerve impingement is the primary cause of all disease.
-
-[Illustration: Fig. 30. Edge contact with “Roll,” q. v. Attitude of
-patient for coccygeal adjustment.]
-
-
-Movement
-
-When it has been decided that the coccyx must be moved, the position
-and use of hand is the same as for the palpation. The finger hooks
-under the tip of the coccyx, draws upon it until a tight contact is
-secured and then jerks sharply backward upon it with a view to its
-abrupt fracture. No mitigation of the jerk in the hope of previously
-loosening or gradually replacing the bone is of value for _osseous
-tissue_ must be broken before any movement may take place.
-
-This movement is painful and the region of the newly fractured coccyx
-may remain sore for a period ranging from a few days to several weeks.
-It is wise to warn the patient of the facts before proceeding.
-
-The fractured coccyx may be absorbed, or may be reankylosed in a proper
-position or in a new abnormal position, or may remain loose and movable.
-
-
-ADJUSTMENT OF CURVATURES
-
-We have previously discussed in detail the nature and discovery of
-curvatures. A few words should be said here about their correction.
-
-If the sole object of the adjustment is to correct the curvature it is
-best to select for adjustment those vertebrae which are most subluxated
-in the direction of the curvature. According to the length of the
-curvature a series of from two to six, separated by some distance, are
-chosen. These are adjusted until they cease to be the most prominent
-ones in the curvature and then others, then most prominent, are chosen
-and adjusted until they in turn cease to be most prominent. In this
-way the curvature may eventually be straightened, or nearly so. It is
-doubtful if any curvature can be absolutely eradicated, although it may
-be straightened until unnoticeable except by the expert.
-
-To overcome a curvature it may be necessary to break every rule which
-governs ordinary adjusting and to invent new ways of placing the hands
-or of delivering force. No two require exactly the same measures and he
-is most successful with curvatures who is most adaptable to changing
-conditions.
-
-One rule may be safely laid down. Do not alternate from day to day,
-loosening at the same time many vertebrae, but choose the ones most in
-need of adjustment and _follow your choice_ as long as it is indicated.
-The chief vertebra is nearly always the one at the _angle_ or _point_
-of the curvature.
-
-The sharp, angular curve of Potts’ Disease, involving two or three
-vertebrae, should warn against adjustment, usually, since in this
-disease the vertebrae are fragile and easily fractured. If a case has
-not progressed too far a cure may be effected, but great caution in
-taking such cases must be exercised. Every Chiropractor should be well
-informed on the diagnosis of Potts’ Disease, or spinal caries.
-
-Many months are usually required for the straightening of a
-curvature--how many can scarcely be estimated in advance of the
-experiment with any case. Often the case which seems simplest requires
-the longer time, while a very pronounced curvature, as in some cases of
-rachitis, may yield in a few months.
-
-
-PREFERABLE ADJUSTMENTS
-
-The selection of the move with which to correct each subluxation
-depends upon the adjuster’s concept of the _kind_ and _direction_ of
-the subluxation and of the mechanics of the different corrective moves
-in his repertoire. The move used should be one in which the application
-of force is exactly along opposite lines to the lines of force which
-originally produced the subluxation.
-
-Omitting involved explanations as to the elements of each displacement
-and the manner of change in bone, muscle, ligament, cartilage, etc.,
-and presupposing a comprehension of the principles of each adjustment
-named, there follows here a list of possible subluxations of each
-vertebra in turn, from Atlas down, with a simple statement of the RIGHT
-MOVE for that subluxation.
-
-In each instance there are other moves than the one listed which would
-_move_ the vertebra and some which would partially correct it, but none
-which would quite so definitely tend to _correct the displacement_.
-Unfortunately it is not a fact that every movement of a vertebra is an
-adjustment. If this were true subluxations would not exist, because
-they could never have been produced. Too often the adjuster uses a
-move because it is easy, because its use has become habitual with him,
-rather than because it is indicated by the conditions of the case--then
-blames Chiropractic because his results are negative or bad.
-
-The move which is suited to a certain kind of subluxation of one
-vertebra may be quite out of place with another, in a different part of
-the spine. Thus the Recoil is quite proper for a posterior Lumbar and
-is contraindicated with a posterior middle Dorsal.
-
-If all vertebrae were shaped exactly alike, if all were equal in size,
-if subluxation were possible only in one direction, then one method of
-adjustment would be quite sufficient. Diversity of technic is demanded,
-but a discriminating diversity, with a good reason for every move used.
-
-
-First Cervical
-
- _Subluxation._ _Adjustment._
-
- Right--R. Break, or straight lateral.
- Right, posterior--R. P. Rotary lateral.
- Right, anterior--R. A. Morikubo.
- Right, superior--R. S. Break.
- Right, inferior--R. I. Break.
- Right, posterior, superior--R. P. S. Rotary lateral.
- Right, posterior, inferior--R. P. I. Rotary lateral.
- Right, anterior, superior--R. A. S. Morikubo.
- Right, anterior, inferior--R. A. I. Morikubo.
- Left--L. Break.
- Left, posterior--L. P. Rotary lateral.
- Left, anterior--L. A. Morikubo.
- Left, superior--L. S. Break.
- Left, inferior--L. I. Break.
- Left, posterior, superior--L. P. S. Rotary lateral.
- Left, posterior, inferior--L. P. I. Rotary lateral.
- Left, anterior, superior--L. A. S. Morikubo.
- Left, anterior, inferior--L. A. I. Morikubo.
- Anterior (entire Atlas)--A. Morikubo (both sides).
- Posterior (entire Atlas)--P. Rotary lateral (both sides).
-
- NOTE.--All right subluxations adjusted from right side, all left
- from left side.
-
-
-Second Cervical
-
- Posterior--P. Posterior Cervical move.
- Posterior, right--P. R. Double contact on right side.
- Posterior, left--P. L. Double contact on left side.
- Posterior, right, inferior--P. R. L. Double contact on right.
- Posterior, right, superior--P. R. S. Double contact on right.
- Posterior, left, inferior--P. L. I. Double contact on left side.
- Posterior, left, superior--P. L. S. Double contact on left side.
- Right (lateral)--R. Break (Same if R. I. or R. S.)
- Right (rotary)--R. Rotary (Same if R. I. or
- R. S.)
- Left (lateral)--L. Break (Same if L. I. or L. S.)
- Left (rotary)--L. Rotary (Same if L. I. or
- L. S.)
- Superior--S. Posterior Cervical move.
- Inferior--I. Posterior Cervical move.
- Anterior (entire Vertebra)--A. Ventral transverse contact on
- most anterior side.
- Anterior, right (lateral)--A. R. Second metacarpal contact from
- right.
- Anterior, right (rotary)--A. R. Pisiform Ant. Cerv. contact on
- right.
- Anterior, left (lateral)--A. L. Second metacarpal contact from
- left.
- Anterior, left (rotary)--A. L. Pisiform Ant. Cerv. contact
- on left.
-
-
-Third Cervical
-
-Same as second.
-
-
-Fourth Cervical
-
-Same as second.
-
-
-Fifth Cervical
-
-Same as second.
-
-
-Sixth Cervical
-
- Posterior--P. The Recoil, hands reversed.
- Posterior, right--P. R. Recoil, hands reversed.
- Posterior, left--P. L. Recoil, hands reversed.
- Posterior, right, superior--P. R. S. Recoil, hands reversed.
- Posterior, right, inferior--P. R. I. Recoil, hands reversed.
- Posterior, left, superior--P. L. S. Recoil, hands reversed.
- Posterior, left, inferior--P. L. I. Recoil, hands reversed.
- Right (lateral)--R. Break (Same if R. I. or R. S.)
- Right (rotary)--R. Rotary (Same if R. I. or
- R. S.)
- Left (lateral)--L. Break, from left (Same if
- L. I. or L. S.)
- Left (rotary)--L. Rotary (Same if L. I. or
- L. S.)
- Superior--S. Edge contact move.
- Inferior--I. Edge contact move.
- Anterior (entire vertebra)--A. Pisiform Ant. Cerv. contact on
- most anterior side.
- Anterior, right (lateral)--A. R. Second metacarpal contact from
- right.
- Anterior, right (rotary)--A. R. Pisiform Ant. Cerv. contact on
- right.
- Anterior, left (lateral)--A. L. Second metacarpal contact from
- left.
- Anterior, left (rotary)--A. L. Pisiform Ant. Cerv. contact on
- left.
-
-
-Seventh Cervical
-
- Same as sixth Cervical, except that T. M. may be used on right or
- left rotary subluxations.
-
-
-First Dorsal
-
- Posterior--P. Recoil, hands reversed.
- Posterior, right--P. R. Recoil, hands reversed.
- Posterior, right, superior--P. R. S. Recoil, hands reversed.
- Posterior, right, inferior--P. R. I. Recoil, hands reversed.
- Posterior, left--P. L. Recoil, hands reversed.
- Posterior, left, superior--P. L. S. Recoil, hands reversed.
- Posterior, left, inferior--P. L. I. Recoil, hands reversed.
- Posterior, superior--P. S. Heel contact.
- Posterior, inferior--P. I. Edge contact.
- Superior--S. Heel contact.
- Inferior--I. Edge contact.
- Right--R. T. M. (Same if R. S. or R. I.)
- Left--L. T. M. (Same if L. S. or L. I.)
- Anterior--A. No correction.
-
-
-Second Dorsal
-
- Posterior--P. Heel contact.
- Posterior, superior--P. S. Heel contact.
- Posterior, inferior--P. I. Edge contact.
- Posterior, right--P. R. Recoil.
- Posterior, right, superior--P. R. S. Recoil.
- Posterior, right, inferior--P. R. I. Recoil.
- Posterior, left--P. L. Recoil.
- Posterior, left, superior--P. L. S. Recoil.
- Posterior, left, inferior--P. L. I. Recoil.
- Left--L. T. M. (Same if L. S. or L. I.)
- Right--R. T. M. (Same if R. S. or R. I.)
- Anterior--A. No correction.
-
-
-Third Dorsal
-
- Posterior--P. Heel contact.
- Posterior, superior--P. S. Heel contact.
- Posterior, inferior--P. I. Edge contact.
- Posterior, right--P. R. Recoil.
- Posterior, right, superior--P. R. S. Recoil.
- Posterior, right, inferior--P. R. I. Recoil.
- Posterior, left--P. L. Recoil.
- Posterior, left, superior--P. L. S. Recoil.
- Posterior, left, inferior--P. L. I. Recoil.
- Right--R. Pisiform single transverse (on
- left) (Same if R. S. or
- R. I.)
- Left--L. Pisiform single transverse (on
- right) (Same if L. S. or
- L. I.)
- Anterior--A. No correction.
-
-
-Fourth Dorsal
-
-Same as third Dorsal.
-
- NOTE.--While the Recoil is here, the preferred move for posterior
- and postero-lateral subluxations, the pisiform double transverse or
- the two finger double transverse may be used if both transverses
- are palpable.
-
-
-Fifth Dorsal
-
- Posterior--P. Double transverse move.
- Posterior, superior--P. S. Heel contact.
- Posterior, inferior--P. I. Double transverse.
- Posterior, right--P. R. Double transverse.
- Posterior, right, superior--P. R. S. Double transverse.
- Posterior, right, inferior--P. R. I. Double transverse.
- Posterior, left--P. L. Double transverse.
-
- NOTE.--The pisiform double transverse and the two-finger double
- transverse, apply force in exactly similar directions and may
- therefore be used interchangeably. The latter is preferable for
- children.
-
- Posterior, left, superior--P. L. S. Double transverse.
- Posterior, left, inferior--P. L. I. Double transverse.
- Right--R. Pisiform single transverse
- (Same if R. S. or R. I.)
- Left--L. Pisiform single transverse.
- (Same if L. S. or L. I.)
- Anterior--A. No correction.
-
-
-Sixth Dorsal
-
-Same as Fifth Dorsal.
-
-
-Seventh Dorsal
-
-Same as Fifth Dorsal.
-
-
-Eighth Dorsal
-
-Same as Fifth Dorsal.
-
-
-Ninth Dorsal
-
-Same as Fifth Dorsal.
-
-
-Tenth Dorsal
-
- Posterior--P. Heel contact.
- Posterior, superior--P. S. Edge contact.
- Posterior, inferior--P. I. Edge contact.
- Posterior, right--P. R. Recoil.
- Posterior, right, superior--P. R. S. Recoil.
- Posterior, right, inferior--P. R. I. Recoil.
- Posterior, left--P. L. Recoil.
- Posterior, left, superior--P. L. S. Recoil.
- Posterior, left, inferior--P. L. I. Recoil.
- Right--R. Recoil (Same if R. S. or
- R. I.)[A]
- Left--L. Recoil (Same if L. S. or
- L. I.)[A]
- Anterior--A. No correction.
-
- [A] Note.--The use of this move is not quite mechanically correct,
- but it is advised because of the possible danger of using the
- transverse processes as levers.
-
-
-Eleventh Dorsal
-
-Same as Tenth Dorsal.
-
-
-Twelfth Dorsal
-
-Same as Tenth Dorsal.
-
-
-First Lumbar
-
- Posterior--P. Heel contact.
- Posterior, superior--P. S. Heel contact.
- Posterior, inferior--P. I. Heel contact.
- Posterior, right, superior--P. R. S. Recoil.
- Posterior, right, inferior--P. R. I. Recoil.
- Posterior, left--P. L. Recoil.
- Posterior, left, superior--P. L. S. Recoil.
- Posterior, left, inferior--P. L. I. Recoil.
- Right--R. Lumbar single transverse move,
- if transverse is palpable,
- otherwise Recoil. (Same if
- R. S. or R. I.)
- Left--L. Lumbar single transverse move,
- if transverse is palpable,
- otherwise Recoil. (Same if
- L. S. or L. I.)
- Anterior--A. No correction.
-
-
-Second Lumbar
-
-Same as First Lumbar.
-
-
-Third Lumbar
-
-Same as First Lumbar.
-
-
-Fourth Lumbar
-
- Posterior--P. Heel contact.
- Posterior, superior--P. S. Heel contact.
- Posterior, inferior--P. I. Heel contact.
- Posterior, right--P. R. Recoil, hands reversed.
- Posterior, right, superior--P. R. S. Recoil, hands reversed.
-
- NOTE.--The Heel contact may be substituted for the Recoil above if
- force be carefully directed in the proper direction in delivery.
-
- Posterior, right, inferior--P. R. I. Recoil, hands reversed.
- Posterior, left--P. L. Recoil, hands reversed.
- Posterior, left, superior--P. L. S. Recoil, hands reversed.
- Posterior, left, inferior--P. L. I. Recoil, hands reversed.
- Right--R. Lumbar single transverse move,
- if transverse is palpable,
- otherwise Recoil. (Same if
- R. S. or R. I.)
- Left--L. Lumbar single transverse, if
- transverse is palpable,
- otherwise Recoil. (Same
- if L. S. or L. I.)
- Anterior--A. No correction.
-
-
-Fifth Lumbar
-
- Posterior--P. Heel contact.
- Posterior, superior--P. S. Edge contact.
- Posterior, inferior--P. I. Edge contact.
- Posterior, right--P. R. Recoil.
- Posterior, right, superior--P. R. S. Recoil.
- Posterior, right, inferior--P. R. I. Recoil.
- Posterior, left--P. L. Recoil.
- Posterior, left, superior--P. L. S. Recoil.
- Posterior, left, inferior--P. L. I. Recoil.
- Right--R. Recoil (Same if R. S. or
- R. I.)
- Left--L. Recoil (Same if L. S. or
- L. I.)
- Anterior--A. “Bohemian” anterior fifth
- Lumbar move. (Not always
- advisable.)
-
-
-Sacrum
-
- Posterior base--B. of S.--P. Heel contact on base.
- Posterior apex--A. of S.--P. Heel contact on apex.
- Entire Sacrum posterior Sac. P. Heel contact between
- sacroiliac articulations.
-
-
-Coccyx
-
- To be adjusted only when ankylosed in an abnormal position and then
- by leverage of finger through rectum.
-
-
-A FINAL WORD
-
-Some useful information pertaining to adjustment will be found in
-section entitled, “Practice,” q. v.
-
-After a careful and painstaking study of the foregoing pages it will
-still be found that the student is not by any means equipped for the
-work. He must _practice_ these things to learn them. We learn to do by
-_doing_. The chief use of this section will be as a reference and guide
-during the practice of adjusting.
-
-
-
-
-THE CAUSE OF DISEASE
-
-
-Disease a Morbid Process
-
-Disease has been variously regarded as an entity, a process, a
-condition. It has been mentioned in terms which would almost
-personalize it, such as, “attacked by pneumonia,” “seized with cramps,”
-“in the clutches of tuberculosis.” Men have endeavored constantly
-to discriminate between diseases and to learn the appearance and
-peculiarity of each, and have resolved each into its peculiar elements
-only to learn that the merging lines between two diseases or between
-cases of the same disease are imperceptible. It is no more possible to
-define any one disease within exact limits and to distinguish it from
-all others than to consider one function of the human body without
-studying its interdependence with others.
-
-Disease is a _process_. It is a natural process. It follows certain
-well-defined laws and consists in the abnormal performance of function
-in some bodily organ or organs, or in the untimely performance of some
-function which would be normal in its proper chronological relation
-with other functions or at another period of the body’s development.
-The balance of function of the body is destroyed--some function
-intensified or diminished--that is all. Every disease, properly
-studied, reveals its functional base.
-
-Disturbances of the functions of _growth_, _nutrition_, and _repair_
-produce changes in structure, physical evidences of disease. It is
-probable that every disease has a certain amount of structural change
-connected with it; it is hard to conceive of functional derangement
-without structural change, in a universe in which Nature is eternally
-building, destroying, or modifying organic peculiarities to meet
-changing functional demands. But in many instances this structural
-change is so slight as to be undiscoverable; such diseases are called
-“functional” to distinguish them from those in which structural
-pathologic changes are directly discernible, called “organic.”
-
-
-Beginning of the Process
-
-Recognizing the fact that disease consists in a succession of steps
-or a series of events, each depending upon the next preceding one and
-making possible its successor, and desiring to arrest or check this
-process and correct the damage done, in other words, “to cure disease,”
-the question arises, “Where does this process begin?”
-
-If we wish merely to check the process or to modify it, as does
-medicine, the etiology of the disease is less important than the
-present state. It is then more important that we understand the changes
-which are taking place in the body at the time of our attempt, the
-condition of each organ at that time, and the general recuperative or
-resisting power of the individual.
-
-But if we would correct all the damage done instead of merely
-preventing further damage or building up internal resistance against a
-still active destructive process; if we would so eliminate the effects
-of the earlier steps as to make the resumption of the disease process
-most improbable, we must know each step from the beginning to the
-present, understand their sequence and relation, and go back to the
-beginning with our correction, _removing the cause_.
-
-
-The Cause of Disease
-
-Since each event in the morbid process depends upon the preceding
-one and makes possible those which follow, it is possible to stop at
-any point in the chain of events and declare, “Here lies the Cause
-of Disease.” This explains the various etiologies adhered to each
-by a school of intelligent and scientific men, yet each apparently
-disagreeing most flatly with the others. No matter which step we select
-as our “ultimate cause” it truly is the cause, or one of the causes,
-of succeeding steps, which succeeding steps may well stand in our
-minds as the whole of the disease. Thus the physician, having found a
-germ, is quite content to look forward from the invasion of the germ
-and consider that as the primarily necessary requisite for disease
-production. In retrospect he follows disease back within the body to
-the time of entrance of the germ and then leaves the body to study
-the life habits of the germ and its favorite mode of conveyance. He
-has unwittingly left the direct line of investigation and followed a
-spur-track.
-
-So with the osteopath who discovers contractured muscles drawing a
-member, or a bone, from its normal position. He proceeds to a study
-of the effect of such contracture upon other tissues and strives to
-relieve it by treatment--of the muscle.
-
-The dietist discovers that certain food combinations cannot be properly
-cared for by an individual and that if taken they tend to develop
-toxins deleterious to the system. Whereupon he undertakes to discover
-food combinations which the body _can_ care for and believes that he
-has solved the question of etiology.
-
-Now it is _most_ important that we find the _primary_ cause, the one
-which makes possible the operation of all the rest and without which
-all would be powerless to harm man. This we shall expect to find at
-the point of entrance of disease into the human organism. The primary
-cause must be the first step _which concerns man_, the first change
-from normal to abnormal, on which all subsequent changes depend. It is
-useless to pass outside of the consideration of man and those forces
-which directly affect man, in our search for the cause of disease. We
-are powerless to affect outside forces or to control or amend the laws
-of nature through which disease exists.
-
-Let us attempt then to resolve disease into its successive steps and
-to find the first which concerns man. Correcting that, we shall have
-corrected, fully and completely, the process which constitutes disease.
-By striking at the root we may destroy the entire growth.
-
-
-Vital Energy
-
-_Irritability_ is the property of being susceptible to excitement
-or stimulation. Stimulation is the process of increasing the
-functional activity of any organ. Inhibition is the act of checking,
-restraining, or holding back the functional activity of any organ.
-These definitions, taken from Gould, are here introduced as a necessary
-preface to an attempt to set forth, without unnecessary reference to,
-or discussion of, any other theory as to the etiology of disease, the
-Chiropractic explanation of its presence.
-
-Chiropractic maintains that all the chemical and physical activities of
-the human organism are controlled, directly or indirectly, through a
-third form of energy transmitted through the Nerve System; that while
-all three forms of energy are interdependent and closely related in
-their ultimate expression, one of the three is the _primary_ and most
-essential form, and especially indicative of life. We may call this
-third form _Vital Energy_.
-
-There are several good reasons for believing that this nerve force is
-the primary form in which energy is expressed in man and for believing
-that it controls and directs the others in greater degree than it is
-controlled and directed by them.
-
-Of the four forms of tissue of which the body is composed--connective,
-epithelial, muscular, and nervous--the latter is the one damage to
-which is followed by the greatest and most permanent consequences.
-
-It is a fact that there are several organs whose removal leads to
-certain death because of their importance in the general economy of
-the body, but it is also true that section of the nerves leading
-to these organs just as certainly causes death by the cessation of
-their functions. There is no organ in the body aside from the nerves
-themselves which does not immediately cease to act upon withdrawal of
-its nerve force and at once begin a process of degeneration or atrophy.
-
-Pathologic changes in the Nerve System invariably are followed by
-pathologic changes in the organs controlled by the diseased segment but
-the converse is not true. Excitation or inhibition of nerve activity
-produces corresponding and responsive change in the activity of the
-organs innervated, but excitation of an organ does not necessarily
-produce similar changes in the Nerve System. That system possesses the
-power of inhibiting or permitting responsive action, in other words,
-the power of _choice_.
-
-Research in Comparative Anatomy develops the fact that the differences
-in power of complex action possessed by different organisms are
-entirely measurable by differences in the structure and complexity of
-their nerve mechanisms.
-
-Further, by studying the effects of removal or extirpation, or of
-pathologic changes in various parts of the nerve system it has been
-demonstrated that the Brain is the center for those higher forms of
-activity known as psychic, for the power of accelerating or inhibiting
-the responses of the lower centers of the nerve system to stimulation
-from without, and for the conveyance of authority to act to all the
-lower centers. The Nerve System is the morphologic, physiologic, and
-dynamic center of the organism and the Brain the center of the Nerve
-System. We may, then, logically expect to find in the Brain, or in the
-channels by which power is distributed from the Brain to lower centers
-or organs, the initial step in the disease process, which is our
-present quest.
-
-
-One Nerve System
-
-All nerve tissue in the body is organized and linked together in
-a complicated aggregation of individual units, communicating by
-_contact_, and forming one great Nerve System having its directing
-center in the Brain. It is said by some writers to consist of two
-distinct systems--cerebro-spinal and sympathetic--but would better be
-described as consisting of central organs--brain and spinal cord--and
-peripheral organs--cranial, spinal, and sympathetic peripheral axons
-connecting with cells in the central axis and linked together in a
-net-work improperly separable into separate or distinct divisions,
-the fibres of different parts being bound together in such a way as
-to establish an intricate intercommunication, closest on the one hand
-between the cranial and sympathetic and on the other between the spinal
-and sympathetic. The sympathetic system may be regarded as nothing more
-than a medium for proper distribution of impulses originating in the
-cerebro-spinal system, and a series of reflex centers deriving their
-power to act from the central axis. The proper action of sympathetic
-ganglia has been demonstrated to depend upon the integrity of the
-spinal nerve fibres, or rami communicantes, which pass to and terminate
-in the ganglia with their telodendria (terminal arborizations) in
-contact with the dendrites (cellulipetal processes) of the ganglion
-cells.
-
-It will appear that interference with one division or part of the
-nerve system may be followed by effects partly manifested through a
-distant part; that excitation or inhibition of a spinal nerve may
-correspondingly excite or inhibit sympathetic fibres.
-
-
-Chiropractic Hypothesis
-
-Chiropractic has accepted, as a convenient working hypothesis
-amply justified by years of clinical experiment and anatomical and
-physiological research, the proposition that all disease in the human
-body is primarily made possible by injury to (stimulation or inhibition
-of) some part of the nervous mechanism.
-
-Injury to other tissues, unless the injury also involves nerve tissue,
-is quickly repaired and the body goes on without disease. Or the injury
-is sufficient at once to render the body untenable and death ensues.
-Few pathological changes follow trauma unless nerve tissue be injured.
-
-This theory to be logical must and does include the entire nerve
-system. Also, since it is noted that each nerve cell presides over the
-nutrition of its own processes and possesses its own power of repair,
-it follows that unless an injury be of fatal nature or of permanent
-duration, even injuries to nerves tend toward automatic cure. We must
-seek a permanently operating interference with nerve tissue.
-
-The brain, enclosed within the comparatively solid cranium, is so
-well protected that nothing except fracture of the skull, violent
-concussion, or shutting off of its blood supply from without, will
-produce permanent change there. Also, unless there be pressure by
-foreign substance against the brain, an injury will be repaired in
-time and the body resume its normal functional activity. It has been
-demonstrated that comparatively few diseases occur in this way. Such as
-do are called traumatic; i. e., caused by wound or injury.
-
-In the broadest sense all disease is caused by trauma, as we shall
-presently show.
-
-The upper or cephalic peripheral nerves, called cranial, leave
-the skull by foramina in its base (except the auditory) and are
-so protected by the immobility of the bones of the skull as to be
-comparatively free from direct injury. Peripheral injuries occur to
-cranial nerves but are repairable; even section of the trigeminal for
-neuralgia is usually followed after an interval by a reunion of the
-severed parts. As will be shown later, the special end organs of the
-cranial nerves are not free from the effects of spinal subluxation and
-their nuclei (deep origins) often share in morbid changes in the brain
-tissue due to nutritional disturbances.
-
-The sympathetic portion of the nervous system might be classed with
-the cranial as regards infrequency of permanent interference were it
-not for the proximity of the great gangliated cord to the transverse
-processes and bodies of the vertebrae. This proximity renders it liable
-to sustain permanent impingement in vertebral subluxation.
-
-
-Trauma Affects Spinal Nerves
-
-With the exception of the first pair of Cervical nerves and the Sacral
-and Coccygeal, all spinal nerves pass through foramina of exit which
-are composed each of two movable vertebrae. The Chiropractic hypothesis
-is based upon the discovery that in addition to the part these
-vertebrae may take in general movements of the spine it is possible
-that their relation to each other may be changed by the application of
-force from without, and that this change once produced tends to remain
-permanently. These permanent vertebral subluxations occur with great
-frequency, a fact clinically demonstrable by palpation and by the X-Ray.
-
-The discovery of this fact led to the ascertaining of two more, namely,
-
-_No disease is ever found without accompanying subluxation._
-
-Since each organ or tissue is connected with some definite and special
-vertebra, subluxations accompanying disease bear a relation to disease
-which is controlled by a general law, operative alike on all human
-organisms.
-
-The latter fact required one other for its complete demonstration;
-namely, that the removal of the subluxation is always followed by the
-complete disappearance of the disease. Given more perfect methods of
-correcting subluxations it would follow that proof of the Chiropractic
-theory would be so complete and overwhelming as to meet at once with
-general acceptance. The difficulty lies in the fact that with our
-present methods much time is often required for complete correction of
-the vertebral displacement and much skill is needed even for successful
-investigation of the results obtainable. The theory is too often judged
-by unskilled or imperfect applications of it.
-
-Every school of Chiropractic accepts the presence of the subluxation
-and has spent much thought and time in the effort to deduce the law
-governing its connection with disease. Diverse conclusions have been
-reached owing to the difficulty experienced in completely eradicating
-the subluxation. When it _is_ accomplished the results are absolutely
-conclusive. When it is partially or relatively accomplished the results
-are so good in a great per cent of cases as to lead sometimes to the
-erroneous belief that the subluxation did not cause the disease since
-mere partial correction of the subluxation suffices to bring about
-the apparent total removal of the disease. In every case of thorough
-experiment the results warrant the recommendation of the subluxation
-theory as at least a proper working hypothesis.
-
-Without attempting here to review all the various conclusions reached
-or the methods by which they have been attained, we would simply state
-our own conclusion, which we believe is the only one compatible with
-demonstrable facts. It is briefly this: Since every portion of the body
-is connected through the nervous system with the spinal nerves and
-since it has been proven that this connection is reasonably constant
-and anatomically demonstrable; since the removal or correction of a
-subluxation leads in all cases to the complete disappearance of disease
-from the organs or tissues innervated from the subluxated portion of
-the spinal column, we conclude that the subluxation is the _primary
-cause_ of disease.
-
-The final test of the correctness of any theory is the result of its
-application. Since Chiropractic secures a larger percentage of results
-than any other known system of healing it is safe to assume, at least,
-that it has discovered the way to remove the primary cause of disease.
-
-That the Chiropractic theory, or more properly the subluxation theory,
-does not include all of the etiology of disease is evidenced by the
-facts of contagion and infection, by the effect upon the organism of
-the introduction of poison, by the consequences of worry, anger, and
-other abnormal mental states and conditions. These facts do not in the
-least invalidate the theory. They merely require explanation which will
-make clear their relation to the subluxation. That such explanation is
-abundantly at hand strengthens the position of Chiropractic more than
-would negation of all other causes save the one we concentrate upon.
-
-The Mentalist who holds that all diseases exist in and are but figments
-of the mind is as far afield as the Physicist who holds that special
-nerve energy is nonexistent. The Chiropractor views Man as a complex
-psycho-physical unit, self-operating and internally self-healing until
-environmental forces disturb the nice adjustment of the machinery.
-
-Disease is produced by, and is, a series of events, chief and most
-permanent of which is the subluxation. We may consider its etiology
-according to the order in which the events take place thus:
-
-
-Direct Chain
-
-Concussion of Forces.
-
-Subluxation of Vertebra.
-
-Impingement of Nerve.
-
-Excitation or Inhibition.
-
-Disease--Abnormal Function.
-
-
-Accessory Chains
-
-Between the last two steps above, or following the last, are often
-introduced one or more of the following accessory chains which modify
-or increase the final effect and are themselves made possible by the
-first four steps in the direct chain.
-
-Pathogenic germ.
-
-Poisonous excretions from germs.
-
-Tissue destruction by chemical action of such toxins.
-
-Reflex muscular tension tending to increase subluxation and thus
-augment nerve impingement and its effects.
-
-Or
-
-Dietetic error.
-
-Abnormal chemical action.
-
-Tissue destruction or nerve irritation by chemical poisons.
-
-Reflex motor disturbances which further limit digestive power.
-
-Or
-
-Abnormal mental condition.
-
-Waste of nerve energy with production of toxins.
-
-General metabolic disturbance.
-
-Increased disease wherever disease previously existed.
-
-These are offered merely as illustrations. There are many accessory
-chains which aid in the production or development of disease and act as
-_secondary causes_.
-
-
-Concussion of Forces
-
-Man was so created, so provided with means for repair, growth, etc.,
-that the body tends to maintain its own functional balance--perfect
-harmony among all its parts--unless interfered with by some outside
-agency. There are certain natural laws such as the law of gravitation
-and the law of momentum and inertia which operate without regard for
-man or man’s welfare. If man, wittingly or unwittingly, allows himself
-to come into violent conflict with one of these laws by falling to the
-ground or in meeting sudden and unexpected opposing force or mass while
-in motion, that which may be termed a concussion is produced by the
-meeting of the outside force and the internal bodily resistance.
-
-Many such concussions may occur without serious damage. Some produce
-wounds or injuries which it is possible for the body to heal without
-causing serious disturbance of function. Other concussions are so
-violent as to produce displacement of structure which tends to
-remain permanently. Under Spino-Organic Connection will be found an
-explanation of the manner in which force applied to various parts of
-the body tends to affect the spine.
-
-Now the displacement of a bone cannot be corrected by the body without
-outside aid. No method is provided for such correction. Produced by
-outside force affecting the body, it can only be reduced by outside
-force. It is this failure of Nature to make man adaptable to _every
-untoward circumstance_ which renders him susceptible to disease.
-
-
-Subluxation
-
-As has been previously stated by no means all concussions of forces
-produce subluxation. (All subluxations, however, are produced by
-concussion of forces.) It may be added that not all subluxations
-impinge nerves and that when they do not so encroach upon nerve tissue
-they produce no noticeable effect after the first temporary soreness
-has disappeared.
-
-Every subluxation, however, evidences a _tendency_ to disease. Once
-moved from its normal position and the poise and symmetry of the body
-disturbed, there are influences which tend more readily to affect the
-same vertebra. The subluxated vertebra is more easily disturbed by
-jars, strains, etc., than the normal one because such jars are less
-regularly distributed to all its parts. A reflex muscular tension due
-to other and more pronounced subluxations and their disease effects
-may in turn increase the slight deviations throughout the spine,
-rendering them in their turn capable of producing disease. When the
-spine or any part of it has lost its perfect regularity disease is made
-_possible_, if not a fact at once. The average number of subluxations
-in each individual is about nine and one-third. Of this number probably
-not more than one-third (though no accurate figures are available)
-are actually productive of conditions nameable as disease at any
-given time. Discrimination between those which do, and those which do
-not, produce discoverable symptoms in a given case is a matter which
-requires a nice technical skill and perfect judgment.
-
-
-Impingement of Nerves
-
-When a vertebra has lost its normal articular relations with its
-fellows and occupies an abnormal position as a consequence in regard
-to _all_ surrounding or adjacent tissues it may impinge nerve tissue
-in two ways, by _tension_ or by _constriction_. By the displacement of
-one vertebra of a pair the size and shape of the intervertebral foramen
-may be altered (occlusion) constricting the nerve which passes through
-the opening. That this change in the size and shape of the foramina
-does frequently occur is shown by the frequency with which alterations
-in the shape of vertebrae appear in dry spines, by post-mortems which
-have demonstrated the altered foramina in the cadaver and by permanent
-occlusion of the foramina in ankylosed spines so that the occlusion may
-be preserved. Adding cartilage changes in the intervertebral disks to
-alterations in bone shape and position, especially the latter, we find
-full and sufficient reason for all the pathological phenomena which
-follow the subluxation. Explain it as you will, these morbid results
-_do_ follow subluxation and can be experimentally produced in animals.
-Moreover, the disease may be directed to a desired organ or region by
-selection of the particular vertebra to be displaced.
-
-The suboccipital, sacral, and coccygeal nerves cannot be constricted
-as they pass through the foramina because they do not emerge through
-complete rings formed of separate and movable bones. But these
-nerves may be _pressed upon_ or stretched by displaced bone, as may
-also the great gangliated cord of the sympathetic, especially the
-Cervical portion of it. _Tension_ of the Cervical sympathetic cord by
-subluxation of vertebrae is a very common occurrence.
-
-Whether the impingement be by constriction or by tension the effect
-is much the same depending upon the degree to which the molecular
-continuity of the nerve substance is impaired--interference with the
-function of the organ connected with the nerve and sometimes swelling
-and pain in the nerve itself followed by degeneration. The effects are
-chiefly noticeable in peripheral tissues. S. Weir Mitchell says (1872),
-“A continuous pressure upon a nerve results in the degeneration of the
-nerve and a disturbance of function of the parts innervated by that
-nerve.” No clearer statement can be made.
-
-It must not be understood that all nerve impingement is due directly
-to subluxation of a vertebra. A dislocated shoulder would produce a
-similar effect of nerve tension. But dislocated shoulders are seldom
-met with as permanent conditions. Likewise there may be secondary
-impingement from new growths, themselves due to some primary
-subluxation. Aneurism of the thoracic aorta often produces hoarseness
-by impingement of the recurrent laryngeal.
-
-Not all impingement is sufficient to produce noticeable disease.
-To a certain extent the power of adaptation inherent in the body
-can overcome its deleterious effects and suppress all signs of its
-existence until an overtax upon bodily energy lessens this adaptative
-power. Then disease appears and we say that the overtax caused it.
-
-
-Excitation or Inhibition
-
-A slight impingement serves as a mechanical irritant to increase the
-action of the nerve and the functions of the attached peripheral
-organs. Such stimulation beyond the normal is always followed by a
-reaction, or fall to subnormal action.
-
-Heavy impingement, especially the impingement due to marked occlusion
-of foramina, partly or wholly paralyzes the affected nerves. Often the
-impingement produces only a latent weakness in some organ, a weakness
-which may be brought to light only through the introduction of some
-secondary cause which takes advantage of the susceptibility of the
-organ to produce some definite disease. As an instance of this we may
-mention typhoid fever. No typhoid case is found without subluxation
-in the region of the second Lumbar; yet the latent weakness produced
-by that subluxation may not have been observed until the typhoid germ
-found a fertile feeding and breeding ground in the weakened tissue and
-proceeded to multiply there and develop its toxins.
-
-
-Effect Upon Single Cell
-
-Each nerve cell is trophic to its processes and to the tissue cells to
-which these processes are distributed. The growth, nutrition and repair
-of each cell of the body is dependent upon the integrity of the axon
-which supplies it. The effect of nerve impingement upon the single cell
-is a weakening of cell structure and a disturbance, slight or great,
-of the special function possessed by that cell. Dunglisson says of
-diseases, “All ... are dependent upon modified cell-action.”
-
-
-Effect Upon Organs
-
-Each organ is but an aggregation of cells of some special type or kind.
-Nerve Impingement usually involves either a whole nerve trunk or many
-of its fibres and thus weakens either the entire organ or many of its
-cells and increases or diminishes its special function. Some organs are
-innervated by more than one nerve and may be injured only in part by a
-localized impingement.
-
-Alteration of the action of one organ often tends to affect the entire
-body, as in subluxation of the fourth Dorsal interfering with the nerve
-supply to the liver the secretion of bile becomes altered in character
-or quantity and the entire system suffers, through deranged digestion,
-from this alteration in a necessary secretion. Every disease presents
-symptoms only indirectly referable to the organ which is primarily
-affected and the problem of the diagnostician is to so discriminate
-between direct and indirect symptoms as to be able to _locate_ disease.
-
-
-Simple Subluxation Disease
-
-We have considered a chain of events by which disease is produced
-without the intervention of any secondary cause. Such a condition may
-be called, for convenience, a simple subluxation disease. Its existence
-depends directly upon the subluxation which is the first change
-manifest in the individual and upon which all the other changes depend.
-
-The two facts that not all subluxations impinge nerves and not all
-nerve impingements cause demonstrable disease explain why we do not, in
-practice, find a disease to correspond with each subluxation discovered
-by palpation. It must be remembered that there may be latent weakness
-following a subluxation and of importance because it renders the
-patient susceptible to infection or to the action of other secondary
-causes.
-
-
-SECONDARY CAUSES
-
-Among the secondary causes of disease may be mentioned the pathogenic
-germ, poisons, dietetic errors, abnormal mental states, bodily
-excesses, exposure to sudden temperature changes, and inhalation of
-non-poisonous but irritating substances as the most common. Many others
-might be included but these will suffice for complete illustration
-of the principle. It will be our endeavor to show how each of these
-secondary causes operates by virtue of a previous susceptibility, or
-breaking down of the normal resisting power of the organism caused
-by subluxation, and how each in turn _may_ bring about increase in
-subluxation and thus, both directly and indirectly, increase disease.
-
-Bear in mind these two all-important facts. _None of these secondary
-causes can operate without previous subluxation. A subluxation may
-produce disease without the aid of any secondary cause._
-
-
-GERM DISEASES
-
-These comprise a large portion of the febrile affections. Most germ
-diseases are characterized by fever and the presence of circulating
-toxins with resulting disturbance of the metabolic processes of the
-body.
-
-It is generally agreed among pathologists that the greater number of
-varieties of micro-organisms found at times in man are not pathogenic.
-Some aid in the decomposition of food in the alimentary canal; others
-have various beneficial functions to perform. But some, under proper
-conditions, feed upon and destroy living tissue. These are the
-so-called pathogenic germs.
-
-The pathogenic germs are many. They enter the body by various routes,
-in the air we breathe, the food we eat, the water we drink; sometimes
-they are communicated by direct contact with other persons or with
-objects infected with them. The term “contagious” is applied to those
-diseases whose germs may be carried through the air from one to
-another; “infectious” refers to those communicable only by contact.
-
-In every healthy individual are found multitudes of germs of both
-the pathogenic and harmless varieties. We are constantly exposed to
-the influence of the former yet by no means all bodies into which
-pathogenic germs find entrance contract disease. This fact has caused
-much study and among pathologists and bacteriologists generally the
-conclusion has been reached that the development of colonies of
-micro-organisms sufficiently to produce disease depends upon what is
-known as “susceptibility” of the organism. There must be a latent
-weakness of which the micro-organisms take advantage.
-
-This amounts to the admission that the body contains the inherent
-property of successfully resisting all germ action. Indeed, the
-fundamental proposition of Serum-Therapy is that under stress of the
-presence of dilute germ infusions the body _does_ develop special
-chemicals which neutralize the germ poisons and kill the germs and
-which remain after the inoculation to guard against any further
-entrance of germs of the same kind and vulnerable to the same
-protective chemicals.
-
-This theory is sufficiently correct to have served as an unassailable
-basis for a most illogical procedure. The truth is that the
-auto-protective power of the body must be lower than normal and the
-germs must find a weakened area for development and multiplication
-before they can develop sufficiently to produce disease. Once they gain
-a foothold they tend to multiply with great rapidity and to develop
-alarming symptoms often leading to death.
-
-Only in a few instances does modern science believe that a pathogenic
-germ can successfully attack a healthy body, but is claimed that there
-are a few germs, such as the Klebs-Loeffler bacillus (diphtheria
-producer) and the bacillus of anthrax, which may find lodgment in any
-organism, healthy or unhealthy, to produce disease.
-
-Now, the susceptibility of the body to germ invasion requires
-explanation. Merely to say that one is susceptible and another is not
-leaves too wide a field of possibility for error. It is easy to reason
-from the fact that all persons are at some time exposed to contagious
-or infectious diseases while comparatively few contract them that
-some persons are vulnerable to certain diseases while others are not.
-It is plain that while a person may be susceptible to typhoid fever
-because he has a weakness in the intestines, he may be quite immune
-from pneumonia or tuberculosis or any other infectious or contagious
-disease. But why this difference? Let us look at the problem from
-another angle.
-
-Chiropractors find with every contagious or infectious disease certain
-subluxations whose location with relation to the disease is constant
-and demonstrable. Thus all cases of pulmonary tuberculosis show a third
-Dorsal subluxation with only enough exceptions to prove the rule;
-tonsilitis is invariably accompanied by subluxation of the second,
-third or fourth Cervical. Correction of the subluxation is, in all
-except the most fully and virulently developed cases, followed by a
-radical cure. Indeed, in many of the germ diseases it is possible to
-abort the fever with improvement of all symptoms in from five minutes
-to twelve hours. We are so accustomed to checking germ diseases at
-once that failure to do so leads us to immediate investigation of
-our palpation and adjustment to discover some technical error in the
-application of the principles of Chiropractic to the case in question.
-
-It is manifestly impossible by vertebral adjustment to raise the body
-beyond _normal power_. Nothing is added to the body; no energy is
-utilized other than the energy of the body itself which is provided
-by Nature and released through restoration of the normal carrying
-capacity of nerves. The highest goal attainable is normality, and it
-is observed that no matter whether the impingement be in the nature of
-an excitation or an inhibition of nerve action the effect of a correct
-adjustment is always in that direction--toward normality. It may be
-as well to digress here long enough to remark that abnormal change is
-never the result of _adjustment_ but always of _maladjustment_, and
-those who claim to be able to produce stimulation by moving a given
-vertebra one way and inhibition by moving it another are entirely wrong.
-
-It is evident from the results of adjustment in germ disease that
-the normal body is entirely capable of throwing off the poisons and
-exterminating the germs, which conclusion quite agrees with science.
-The fact, not known by other branches of science, and asserted by
-Chiropractic is simply that _the subluxation is the factor which
-determines susceptibility_.
-
-Upon ascertaining that a certain vertebra is in normal alignment we may
-say with absolute certainty that the organs innervated by the nerves
-passing through its foramina are not and cannot be the site of any
-pernicious germ activities. To go further, it has been demonstrated in
-a number of cases that the subluxation existed before the contagion
-or infection developed. A man has been known to have a second Lumbar
-subluxation for many years without effects other than a tendency to
-constipation and on the appearance of a typhoid epidemic to contract
-the disease. Correction of the subluxation afforded a cure. Such
-instances might be cited in great numbers. No person without the
-necessary subluxation ever contracts a germ disease and the necessary
-subluxation can be exactly located for the vast majority of such
-diseases. Unfortunately it is impossible to find a person who has not
-_some_ subluxations and is not, therefore, subject to _some_ form of
-contagion or infection.
-
-So far Chiropractic agrees with general knowledge of germ disease and
-its etiology, simply adding the explanation of susceptibility which all
-other modes of investigation have failed to afford. In one particular
-we find apparent disagreement.
-
-We have said that several bacilli are supposed to have power to cause
-disease in healthy bodies. Diphtheria is a disease caused by one of
-these. Yet Chiropractic adjustments have rapidly aborted diphtheria,
-apparently proving that the body has power to react strongly enough to
-conquer even this germ, providing the nerve channels be opened to allow
-of exertion of its full activity. It is probable that all diseases fall
-under the same law and that _no_ germ can find lodgment in healthy
-tissue. Chiropractic affirms this as a truth and as yet no experience
-has tended to disprove it; the belief is strengthened by the years.
-
-The experiments which are said to have proven that certain
-micro-organisms can attack healthy tissue are based upon the
-supposition that careful examination demonstrated the absence of
-disease in the animals experimented upon by inoculation. Since these
-experiments and these examinations were made without any knowledge of
-vertebral subluxations, and consequently without discovering whether
-or not there existed latent weaknesses of various organs, we doubt the
-validity of the experiments. Our own examination of human and animal
-spines has thus far failed to discover any perfectly normal specimens.
-
-Our clinical experience with diphtheria at least absolutely disproves
-the conclusions of Pasteur and others in regard to its origin.
-
-
-Increase of Subluxations
-
-It has been observed that in many instances the subluxation which
-existed previous to infection or contagion is greater and more
-noticeable during the febrile and active stage of the disease than
-before, and this fact has led some careless or insufficiently skilled
-palpaters to assume that the disease caused the subluxation.
-
-The development of germ life is accompanied by the excretion of
-toxins of greater or less virulence which circulate through the blood
-and affect the entire body. This poison, irritating sensor nerves,
-brings about motor reactions in the segments irritated and, since
-the normal operation of the laws of reflex action is interrupted
-somewhat by subluxation, and since the muscles immediately around a
-subluxated vertebra tend to pull upon it with unequal leverage, this
-motor reaction is likely to _increase_ already existing malalignments,
-especially in the same body segment in which the poison is generated
-and in which the irritation is consequently greatest. Thus subluxation
-is most pronounced during the activity of the disease caused by it
-and reacting upon it and thus a disease which began as a localized
-destructive process may manifest systemic effects through its action
-upon other abnormal spinal segments.
-
-
-DIET
-
-The internal chemistry of the body varies so greatly under changing
-conditions, the operation of any two different organisms is so hard
-to compare accurately, that it is impossible to set down any rule for
-diet which will apply properly to all patients or to all with the same
-disease or habit of body. In fact, only experiment with an individual
-can determine the exactly proper diet for him.
-
-Through lack of judgment or of observation of the effects of certain
-foods upon us we often eat that which our bodies cannot properly digest
-and assimilate. Sometimes through accident or negligence we partake of
-food which is proper in kind for us but improper in quality, perhaps
-partially decomposed. Improper food, when taken into the body, tends to
-exert a deleterious effect upon health. This fact should not lead us to
-confine ourselves to reasoning superficially that improper foods _cause
-disease_ or that dietary measures will _cure_ disease.
-
-Some Chiropractors have held that the hunger of individuals for certain
-foods is a safe guide to a proper diet. This is manifestly untrue
-in some cases; the voracious appetite of the convalescent typhoid
-patient is an example. But it would probably be true _if all men were
-normal_. Close observation of a few exceptionally well-developed and
-normal individuals has disclosed an interesting fact. If a man has no
-subluxation in that portion of the spine which controls the stomach,
-the ingestion of decomposing food, even though the alteration be so
-slight as to escape notice on casual examination, induces immediate
-vomiting followed by no untoward consequences. Only occasionally
-does one find persons without subluxations in some way affecting the
-stomach; in such cases the body promptly rejects and expels injurious
-material.
-
-This carries us to the rather surprising conclusion that _the normal
-person is not susceptible to the influence of bad food_. In the
-majority of individuals, some degree of abnormality existing, improper
-food has a decidedly bad effect. Passing through the alimentary canal
-it is improperly digested; toxins are developed; these chemically
-affect the entire body, perhaps leading only to a congestion and
-inflammation of some part of the lining of the alimentary tract,
-perhaps producing a general fever, malaise, diarrhea, and the other
-effects of a general poisoning.
-
-It has been found that proper adjustment is followed by quick relief
-in such cases, the commonest effect being the rapid expulsion of the
-deleterious matter by vomiting and diarrhea with breaking of the fever
-and lessening of all symptoms.
-
-It has also been observed that during the suffering from dietetic
-error the subluxation controlling the stomach or some part of the
-small intestines is often found increased in degree with tension of
-the adjacent muscles. With adjustment and relief of the other symptoms
-the muscular tension tends to disappear. This motor reaction from the
-irritation of food poison undoubtedly serves to _increase_ subluxation
-already existing, thus intensifying effects. But for its primary effect
-food poison requires a previous subluxation lowering the natural
-protective power of the body. Food poisoning is often a secondary cause
-of disease.
-
-When it is found in any specific case that certain foods exert a
-bad influence upon the progress of the case, that the symptoms are
-aggravated by the taking of these foods, they must be abandoned. Yet no
-rigid diet need be prescribed in any case. Every patient will require a
-different diet, nor is it possible to understand the intimate chemical
-relations within the body sufficiently to fix a proper diet except by
-experiment.
-
-A word here about fasting. If improper food were a primary cause of
-disease, fasting would be an effective, though somewhat radical,
-removal of the cause of disease and a logical procedure. Since improper
-food is _not_ a primary cause of disease and since nature requires
-food for the repair work made possible through adjustments, it would
-seem unwise for Chiropractors to prescribe fasting. Also it is well to
-remember that fasting and starvation are synonymous and their symptoms
-identical.
-
-
-POISONS
-
-Any substance taken into the body and not usable as food may be
-considered poison. Most drugs administered as medicine or used
-habitually are either directly poisonous and commonly so considered
-or are poisonous in the sense that they do not build but rather tend
-to injure the body. Injurious substances accidentally taken into
-the body; certain products included in the preparation of otherwise
-nutritious foods, alcohol, tobacco, etc., affect the body in varying
-degrees but in accordance with the same laws. Poisons may be internally
-generated through the action of pathogenic germs or through the failure
-of the body to digest food and to prevent injurious chemical changes in
-it. It has even been said by some that abnormal mental states so affect
-metabolism as to cause the formation of certain auto-toxins which
-injuriously affect the entire body.
-
-However poison may make its appearance in the body its presence
-is associated with certain bad effects. Poison may be corrosive,
-destroying tissue wherever it touches; it may be stimulating, affecting
-the nerves so as to increase their activity, following which waste of
-energy there is a weakening reaction; it may be narcotic, lowering some
-physiologic process below normal.
-
-If a man without subluxation--and therefore normal--have poison
-introduced into his body one of two effects will follow. Either the
-poison will be sufficient to produce death in a short time, and will do
-so, or the poison will be ejected from the body and the patient recover
-naturally and without treatment, and recover fully.
-
-This is the statement of the ideal, not the real. The fact is that
-no person has yet been found without subluxation in some part of
-the spinal column. Occasional cases have been reported but always
-by Chiropractors whose statements are open to question on account
-of imperfect training in vertebral palpation or a known habit of
-unconsidered statement. And in the weakened body, whose natural
-protective power has been lowered, the effect is different.
-
-The body fails to throw off all the poison normally and some of it
-remains in the circulation and tends to cause progressively increasing
-damage. In addition to the direct effect of the poison upon the
-tissues, the irritation of sensory nerves gives rise to a motor
-reaction which increases subluxation generally throughout the spine but
-especially in the segment in which the sensory irritation is greatest.
-If the poison be taken into the stomach the vertebrae affecting that
-organ are most affected in the resulting motor disturbances. When
-vaccine virus is introduced into the arm the greatest influence is upon
-the last two Cervicals and first Dorsal, causing increased weakening of
-the nerves to the arm. If the vaccination does not “take” it is because
-the body is so normal as to be able to take up and rapidly excrete the
-poison or to neutralize it with an internally generated antitoxin.
-
-This tendency of poisons to increase subluxations already existing has
-caused many to conclude that _new_ subluxations could be produced by
-the motor reactions from poison. The laws governing reflex action make
-this impossible. If a mild stimulus be applied in the segment occupied
-by a given, and normally aligned, vertebra, the resulting contraction
-will tend to appear on the same side as the irritation and would--if
-sufficient to subluxate the vertebra--draw it _toward_ the irritated
-side. If a stronger stimulus were applied the resulting reaction would
-appear on _both_ sides and with sufficient intensity on the opposite
-side to the irritation so that the difference between the contractions
-on the two sides would never be sufficient to overcome the fixity and
-inertia of the vertebra. If this bit of theorizing be doubted, let me
-add that if poisons _could_ cause subluxation they would undoubtedly
-cause drawing of the vertebra _toward_ the irritated side--which is
-not the way we find them in poisoning cases. Almost without variation,
-the subluxation is _away from_ the affected side. Such a subluxation
-produces most impingement on the side of the irritation; the only kind
-which could follow poisons would produce its effects on the opposite
-side.
-
-In acute poisoning cases which may possibly proceed to a rapidly fatal
-termination, while immediate adjustment may be sufficient to cause the
-expulsion of the poison and the recovery of the patient it is probably
-wisest to administer an antidote or to call a physician with a stomach
-pump. Just so, the pulmotor should be summoned for gas asphyxiation;
-but at least one case was recently encountered in which an adjustment
-started the heart and artificial respiration movements restored
-consciousness before the pulmotor could arrive. There are few, if any,
-acute poisoning cases in which an adjustment will not aid. Sometimes it
-should be assisted by other measures not strictly within the province
-of Chiropractic.
-
-Chronic poisoning, such as lead poisoning from paint work, yields
-well to adjustments providing the secondary cause, the persistent
-inhalation of lead fumes, be discontinued.
-
-Poisons may wound or injure the body whether or not it be normal; in
-such case they might properly be classed with trauma. But no poison
-causes disease except through the medium of vertebral subluxation
-previously produced. Some subluxation which has never been sufficient
-to produce active disease may be so increased by the action of poisons
-as to be of serious effect even though the poison has long since been
-eradicated from the body--for the subluxation is permanent until
-affected by force outside itself. In considering the etiology of any
-disease the possibility of its being augmented by medicines, drug
-habits, or dietetic errors should be weighed with other evidence.
-
-
-EXPOSURE
-
-By this term is especially meant exposure to sudden temperature
-changes. The body may sustain a very high or a very low outside
-temperature providing the change is gradual enough so that the
-heat-regulating mechanism may adapt itself properly to protect the
-body and maintain an even temperature within. A sudden change from a
-very warm room to a very cold atmosphere; a quick transportation from
-cold air to a superheated apartment; or a sudden draft of air whose
-temperature is sharply at variance with surrounding air and therefore
-with the condition of the body surface may have a very bad effect.
-
-The skin and mucous membranes of the body have become accustomed
-to a certain temperature; the change irritates them. And the
-immediate result is a motor reaction increasing subluxation in the
-same body segment in which the irritation is greatest and probably
-producing first an irritation of the nerves at the spine and then an
-inflammation of the exposed surface. Thus a “cold” is produced. One
-who has no subluxation affecting the respiratory tract--a rare degree
-of normality--may escape coryza, bronchitis, or pneumonia, the most
-common effects, but may suffer a congestion of the stomach walls or
-of other parts of the body. It is said that the cold “settled on the
-stomach.” The fact is that the motor reaction takes advantage of the
-weak parts of the spine and affects them most, like the pernicious
-habit of spine-stretching which used to prevail among Chiropractors.
-This explains why “cold in the head” is so very frequent. The fourth
-Cervical vertebra is situated at the middle point of the neck and is
-very freely movable and easily subluxated and, in fact, more often
-displaced than other Cervicals.
-
-Noxious or poisonous vapors may have an effect identical with that of
-sudden temperature change. Sleeping in an improperly ventilated room
-often appears to cause “cold.” Careful study of the part of the body
-exposed to draft, and of spino-organic connection, will show that in
-most instances the effect of such exposure is first felt in the same
-body segment.
-
-It is a well-known fact that not all people are “subject to colds.” One
-may be “subject to lung colds,” another to “cold in the head.” The
-susceptibility is entirely governed by the condition of the spine, the
-person having no middle Cervical subluxation being immune from coryza
-even though subjected to the same exposure which will produce it in
-others. The pollen of plants produces hay fever in the susceptible
-in much the same manner that draft produces coryza, both acting as
-secondary causes.
-
-
-BODILY EXCESSES
-
-In this division of secondary causes may be mentioned overwork,
-continuous loss of sleep, overeating, venereal excesses, etc.
-
-They act in this manner. Wasting and overusing the bodily resources
-they lower the general vitality. Now, though there be subluxations at
-various points in the spine there is still transmitted through each
-impinged nerve a certain amount of Vital Force which to a certain
-extent maintains the functions of the body and keeps it in a state
-of activity sufficient for ordinary demands. When the entire stock
-of vitality is lowered through excess the amount of energy passing
-through each nerve in the body is lessened, but the effect of such
-lessening is felt most where there is subluxation. At the high tide
-of vitality the subluxations are not sufficient, perhaps, to produce
-serious disease. At low ebb, every organ whose nerve is interfered with
-suffers keenly. Under such conditions the body is much more subject to
-adverse influences, to shocks and jars, to contagion or infection, to
-the action of cold or exposure. Thus bodily excess acts as a secondary
-cause of disease.
-
-
-ABNORMAL MENTAL STATES
-
-There are many who believe that fear, worry, hate, grief, etc., are
-in themselves sufficient to produce disease in a normal organism.
-Shock following the demise of a loved one or some deep disgrace is
-occasionally alleged as a cause of death or of a rapid decline in
-health which terminates fatally.
-
-The failure of Suggestive Therapeutics to cure disease except when it
-is largely imaginary rather argues against this theory. It is also
-true that proper Chiropractic adjustments not only lead to the cure of
-disease apparently caused by abnormal mental states but also, restoring
-proper blood-supply and nutrition to the brain, induce a happier mental
-state in the patient. Even insanity has been cured in a number of cases
-by Chiropractic.
-
-We hold that worry, fear, etc., are abnormal; that they arise from the
-improper expression of Mind through disordered brain-cells. “Diseases
-of the Mind,” in the strictest sense, cannot occur, but only diseases
-of the physical medium through which mind is expressed and translated
-to the physical plane of being--the brain.
-
-A condition of abnormal mental expression or activity, especially
-worry, fear or anger, probably has a two-fold effect: it rapidly wastes
-the body energy and, like bodily excess, renders every subluxation more
-effective; it is possible that it may also really produce auto-toxins,
-generated by abnormal brain-action and affecting the body metabolism
-adversely. In this way disease appears through the action of abnormal
-mental states as secondary causes.
-
-They themselves are the result of subluxation of the first or second,
-sometimes third, Cervical, impinging the nerves which control the
-blood-supply to the brain and hence its nutrition. Correction of the
-subluxation causes them to disappear.
-
-
-INFLAMMATION
-
-Inflammation is a morbid process characterized by the presence of
-increased temperature and one or more of the symptoms, pain, redness,
-and swelling. It is distinguished from fever by being confined locally,
-while fever is a general functional disturbance showing elevation of
-temperature, increased katabolism, decreased secretion, etc.
-
-Our clinical experience with fevers leads us to accept Metchnikoff’s
-conclusion that the essential phenomenon of inflammation is hyperaemia.
-Upon the hyperaemia depend the swelling, pain, and local increase in
-heat-production. Hyperaemia in turn depends upon disturbance of the
-vasomotor nerves either as a direct result of some local subluxation or
-as an indirect consequence of local irritation.
-
-A newly acquired subluxation produces an acute irritation of the
-pre-ganglionic axons which connect the spinal nerves with the
-sympathetic ganglia. If these ganglia send out post-ganglionic axons
-which are vaso-motor in function, an inflammation may be produced
-without the intervention of any secondary cause. On the other hand,
-there may be a subluxation producing weakness of some part; through
-injury to that part or the introduction of poisons or irritants such as
-germ infection, sensory end-organs are affected and the motor reaction
-which follows increases the subluxation; this slight increase produces
-acute irritation of the nerve and hyperaemia, with its resultant
-phenomena, follows. Stated briefly, irritants produce inflammation
-only by acting through the medium of the spine. If the spine be normal
-these irritants are insufficient to produce morbid process. Local
-inflammation tends to develop toxins, especially if it be of bacterial
-origin, which may in turn affect the entire organism--an effect which
-will be discussed presently. Exception must be made in those traumatic
-cases in which hyperaemia is essential to the reparatory process,
-and which are attended by what may be termed a normally increased
-heat-production. This beneficent and reparatory condition cannot be
-termed disease or morbid process.
-
-The normal temperature of the body depends upon the balance maintained
-between heat-production and heat-expenditure. This balance is
-maintained through a complicated nerve mechanism consisting of various
-nidi in thalamus, medulla, spinal cord and sympathetic ganglia, and
-a network of communicating axons of both the cerebro-spinal and
-sympathetic systems, controlling the amount of blood passing through
-any given body area at a given time, the secretion of the perspiratory
-glands, the internal metabolic processes, etc. Most important are the
-vaso-motor nerves, directly, but not originally, derived from the
-sympathetic, and governing the size and caliber of all blood-vessels
-so as to control the amount of blood flowing to and through the surface
-capillaries on the one hand, or the deep-seated, heat-making organs on
-the other. More than seventy per cent of the body’s heat expenditure
-is through the skin by evaporation, radiation, and direct conduction.
-The major portion of the heat production is in the muscles and the
-parenchymatous viscera, such as liver, spleen, etc., where metabolism
-is active.
-
-This mechanism is so delicately adjusted that when the outside
-temperature is lowered the amount of blood passing to the skin is
-reflexly lessened while internal heat production is increased and the
-bodily temperature retained at normal. Conversely, the body perspires
-freely and the surface is flushed with blood in a high temperature, so
-that heat production is lessened and its discharge accelerated, again
-tending to maintain an even and normal temperature.
-
-The nervous mechanism is responsive to many and various forms of
-stimuli--thermic, emotional, mechanical, physiologic need, toxic.
-Poisons in circulation may affect the bulbar center and produce general
-fever. A number of centers in the spinal gray may be stimulated with
-like result. Or there may be purely local irritation which results in
-local hyperaemia and inflammation.
-
-It will always be found that the primary cause of any permanent
-derangement of the mechanism lies in vertebral subluxation impinging
-some of the nerves and thus throwing the mechanism out of its natural
-balance and poise. Other forms of disturbance are transient and the
-very nature of the mechanism makes it normally capable of adjusting
-itself to thermic, mechanic, or emotional stimuli in a short time.
-Only the subluxation produces permanent elevation of temperature. When
-such elevation does occur there are many associated changes, increased
-katabolism, lessening of secretions, anorexia, sometimes mental
-changes, such as delirium or coma. Fevers vary according to the part of
-the nerve mechanism affected and the action of any secondary causes.
-
-Fever due to vertebral subluxation alone without any secondary cause
-operating is very rare. Ordinarily fevers come about in this way. A
-subluxation occurs which weakens tissue and permits germ invasion;
-toxins enter the circulation from the germ action and motor reaction
-increases the original subluxation and causes local inflammation; germ
-activity is favored by the increasing degree of abnormality and toxins
-from rapid tissue destruction are added to those already present.
-The poison-loaded blood then affects the general centers for heat
-regulation, blood becomes internally engorged, and a chill (internal
-fever) followed by general increase of temperature occurs. At this
-juncture any subluxation previously existing is likely to be increased
-and to add its quota of harm to the rapidly developing picture.
-
-Our problem is to find the original subluxation which controls the
-site of the original pathologic change and to correct that. In nearly
-all cases where this is done, even partially, the body is enabled to
-care for the remainder of the damage and to throw off the accumulated
-toxins. It is not uncommon that the temperature falls two degrees in
-five or ten minutes after a proper adjustment. We expect always to
-abort or check a fever in twenty-four hours or less.
-
-There are cases in which the temperature drops after adjustment
-but presently rises again. This indicates the virulence of the
-autointoxication or that some other area of poison production is
-operating than the one our first adjustment would control. A correct
-diagnosis will enable one to give specific adjustment and check
-practically any fever except a chronic one with much tissue destruction
-already accomplished; even some of these yield.
-
-The commonest cause of fever is at the fifth or sixth Dorsal vertebra,
-long known as Center Place, or Fever Center. Here emerge many
-pre-ganglionic fibres which distribute their impulses through lower
-neurons in the sympathetic system to the coeliac plexus and thence to
-the blood-vessels supplying the major portion of the abdominal viscera.
-Adjustment here causes a sudden contraction of these abdominal vessels
-and a forcing of the blood to the surface with rapid cooling.
-
-Often, however, this adjustment is followed by a recrudescence which
-indicates that some other vertebra must be adjusted. Many fevers,
-such as typhoid, pneumonia, tonsilitis, etc., yield to specific local
-adjustment without any involvement of the so-called Center Place.
-
-I have said that we expect to check or abort a fever with spinal
-adjustments. The facts that we do so and that the more rapidly
-we accomplish the result the more rapid the convalescence and the
-less likely are complications and sequelae argue loudly against the
-correctness of any theory which supposes fever to be a beneficial and
-cleansing process. According to such theory it would be totally wrong
-and dangerous to abort a fever but wiser to encourage it in taking its
-course. The exact opposite proves true under Chiropractic. The very
-fact that fevers _do_ diminish and disappear under proper adjustments
-is a proof that they are abnormal, since adjustment does not in any
-case tend to lessen normal processes, but only to restore normality no
-matter in what way the functions of the body have departed from that
-condition.
-
-All the clinical evidence gathered by Chiropractors in regard to
-inflammations and fevers tends to prove the correctness of the theories
-herein set down. Fever plays a part in so many diseases that it has
-been considered advisable to consider the subject under a special head.
-
-
-IN CONCLUSION
-
-The vertebral subluxation is the primary cause of all truly
-pathological conditions. Through its existence the action of a large
-number of secondary causes becomes possible. Upon no other hypothesis
-can we explain the remarkable percentage of cures of all known classes
-of disease through the specific vertebral adjustment.
-
-
-THE PROCESS OF CURE
-
-Nature is the only real _curative_ agent. Neither suggestion,
-manipulation, adjustment, nor any other known method applied by Man
-for the eradication of disease has in itself any power to heal. No man
-possesses power to do more than so arouse the vital energies of the
-patient that the body heals itself.
-
-We contain within our own bodies the possibilities of perfect
-normality. Unless interfered with by powerful outside force we should
-continue normal from birth to death and death itself would only
-occur through the simultaneous wearing out of all the parts of the
-human mechanism. The Chiropractor, insofar as his work succeeds in
-its purpose, assists the body by adjusting displaced structure and
-affording the body a free and unhindered opportunity for the exercise
-of its own self-healing powers. It may be interesting and instructive
-to analyze the process of cure and to study the exact effects of
-vertebral adjustment as we have studied the exact effects of vertebral
-subluxation.
-
-
-Cure of Simple Subluxation Disease
-
-An acute subluxation--that is, one resulting entirely from concussion
-of forces within twenty-four or forty-eight hours prior to the moment
-of adjustment--rarely produces a condition which could be named as any
-particular disease. The symptoms are those of “wrenched back,” if any.
-A single adjustment usually suffices to correct such subluxation just
-as a single movement might correct a dislocated humerus within the
-same period, and any symptoms promptly disappear. This is probably the
-maximum benefit to be derived from adjustment and the best time for
-its administration, because it leaves the spinal column in an exactly
-normal condition and no more susceptible to further jars or shocks than
-before the injury. All disease which might have resulted from that
-subluxation has been fully prevented.
-
-Older subluxations must be dealt with differently because they present
-a different condition. Adaptative changes have taken place in the shape
-of the vertebra itself and of every surrounding tissue as they prepare
-to make the best of their situation. But a vertebra once displaced
-has lost its poise and broken or modified the reflex arcs through its
-nerves so that it becomes more likely to respond to further forces
-applied, or to muscular contractions within the body, by further change
-of position. Such changes are always followed by further adaptation of
-the surrounding parts.
-
-The degree of nerve impingement must change to keep pace with the
-developing malposition and thus, by gradually successive steps, disease
-develops in the area of peripheral distribution of the nerves. The
-nerve is under a thumbscrew gradually tightening.
-
-To adjust such a vertebra many successive movements are required. An
-apparently full and free movement of a subluxation meets the elastic
-resistance of the solidly packed tissues and the pull of the modified
-intervertebral disk--strains at these tissues--and rebounds so as to
-settle almost, but not quite, in its old abnormal position. The amount
-gained in a single adjustment can rarely be appreciated by palpation.
-To the touch it would appear that no change had been made, except
-occasionally in the Cervical region. But with repeated adjustments
-the vertebra will be found to have approached its normal position.
-Sometimes in a few weeks, sometimes in a few months, the gain becomes
-palpable and then perhaps visible to the eye in thin subjects.
-
-The relief of impingement then is not usually an instantaneous process,
-but proceeds by gradual steps. Each movement of the vertebra is
-accompanied by a shock to the nerve against some part of which the bone
-is pressing, which may produce some disturbance in the diseased organs
-and may even appear to have aggravated disease for a time. Some pain
-and soreness around the vertebra may accompany the necessary adaptative
-changes of shape which readapt the tissues to their proper shape and
-relation.
-
-As the impingement of the nerve is gradually relieved the disease is
-gradually modified and finally disappears. As the course of adjustments
-nears its conclusion and the impingement has been reduced to a
-comparatively slight one there may appear a stage of irritation of the
-nerve which is a reduplication of the first steps which appeared in
-the development of the disease. As most subluxations appear not all at
-once but by a series of changes, so disease develops synchronously,
-passing from stage to stage with the changes in the impingement. Often
-it passes through first an acute and active stage due to irritation
-and then a chronic and comparatively passive stage due to heavier,
-inhibiting impingement.
-
-Under adjustment these successive stages tend to reappear in reverse
-order, the most alarming sometimes appearing last and just before the
-cure is completed. It must be remembered that from the moment one
-practitioner administers medicine or other remedy and the other adjusts
-a vertebra, the clinical courses differ widely. No text-book on medical
-practice has as yet described the clinical course of the various
-diseases under Chiropractic adjustment.
-
-In chronic diseases where the nerves are paralyzed there may be a
-period under adjustment during which no change is apparent. This is
-followed by a period of rapid gain leading to complete recovery. This
-may be accounted for by the fact that the nerves are degenerated
-and must be repaired all along their course before communication is
-reestablished between nerve centers and peripheral organs. When this
-repair is sufficiently completed to allow communication, the cure is
-really well advanced, although evidence of it then first appears. This
-has been noted especially in locomotor ataxia.
-
-
-Cure of a Germ Disease
-
-First, under adjustment, the acute or acutely increased impingement is
-relieved. The caliber of the blood-vessels is at once regulated and the
-destructive action of fever checked. At the same time the vitality of
-the local tissue in which the germs are active is suddenly increased
-and there ensues a struggle between the body, as represented by its
-phagocytes and auto-protective chemicals, and the germs, which if
-adjustments be continued results in the rapid destruction of the germ
-colony. Also the elimination of the toxins already in the body proceeds
-so rapidly that if the fever can be held in check it takes only a short
-time for the body completely to overcome and eradicate the germs.
-
-
-Cure of Mental Disease
-
-Mental diseases--so-called--usually depend upon disturbance of the
-blood-supply to the brain, controlled by the Cervical sympathetic.
-Adjustments, relieving the pressure on the sympathetic ganglia or
-cord and perhaps the direct impingement from the vertebral arteries,
-restore a normal circulation to the brain. The time required by Nature
-to effect a cure depends upon the rapidity with which the impingement
-is removed and the amount and character of the damage to brain tissue
-which must be repaired. The cure often requires time for a change
-of materials in brain cells or fibre tracts, by which they are
-reconstructed and again become capable of expressing normal function.
-
-
-Cure of Dietetic Disease
-
-When the subluxation is corrected, or partially so, the appetite
-changes and the craving for food becomes more normal. Adjustments may
-lessen a voracious appetite, increase a too capricious one, or abolish
-a perverted. At the same time the stomach is enabled to digest its
-contents more properly, the intestines to take it up and continue it,
-and the tissues to assimilate that which is brought to them. The body
-eliminates its waste with less effort and in some extreme cases the
-first effect of the adjustment may be to cause vomiting and diarrhea
-and thus purge the alimentary tract of materials which have become
-unusable.
-
-If injurious diet be persisted in the effects of the adjustments will
-be partly counteracted, the tendency of the poisons generated within
-the body being to increase subluxation while the tendency of the
-adjustments is to correct them.
-
-
-Cure of Poisoning Cases
-
-In acute poisoning by way of the alimentary canal and sometimes when
-poison has been injected hypodermically, the body rids itself of the
-menace to its integrity by means of vomiting, diarrhea, and increased
-secretion of urine. Chronic cases tend rather toward the gradual
-absorption and removal from the body of the poisons and their cure
-depends upon the cessation of the poisoning; i. e., it is useless to
-try to cure a morphine case while the patient is still using the drug.
-
-In acute poisoning the muscular contraction often increases subluxation
-and counteracts the effect of the adjustments, so that it becomes
-necessary to give very frequent adjustments until relief is had.
-
-
-Cure of Exposure Disease
-
-After the acute irritation of nerves arising from the exposure and
-causing irritation has been removed, perhaps by the first adjustment,
-if the exposure is not repeated the body heals itself with great
-rapidity, repairing with comparative ease the damage done.
-
-
-Cure of Bodily Excess Disease
-
-This depends upon the nature of the excess. If it be overeating,
-perhaps a more moderate diet will of itself and without adjustments
-enable the body to rid itself of the bad effects and restore general
-equilibrium. Adjustments will aid and accelerate this process. Venereal
-excess is most often engendered by an improper state of mind, perhaps
-demanding attention as a mental disorder, or by an irritation of the
-genital organs which demands local adjustment for its relief. Normality
-of the reproductive tract leads to sane forgetfulness and libidinous
-habits always suggest sexual weakness or disease. Often where a cure
-would be possible with right habits, no cure can be effected without
-their correction. A little good sound advice which will arouse the will
-of the patient to co-operation may aid. Boys with the masturbation
-habit offer small chance for favorable results in enuresis or nervous
-disorders unless the secondary cause be understood and overcome.
-
-
-ADJUNCTS
-
-In this connection the author cannot forbear a reference to the use of
-other methods to relieve disease in combination with the Chiropractic
-adjustment. From the foregoing study of the laws governing the cause
-and cure of disease it will be seen that therapeutical methods have
-little direct bearing upon the removal of disease. The logical method
-of effecting the cure is the removal of the cause. The subluxation
-being always the primary cause, its correction is always the logical
-method of effecting a cure. Not sometimes but _always_.
-
-We know that when the subluxation is corrected the body naturally
-heals itself. Can we accelerate and aid that healing with stimulant
-or narcotic? Logic says no; experience says no: the use of any method
-which strikes at the disease beyond its primary cause and operates upon
-some of the effects of that cause without touching the cause itself is
-inconsistent with belief in Chiropractic.
-
-Administration of poisonous drugs to the well body is considered
-poisoning; their administration to the sick body is also poisoning,
-whose symptoms combine with the disease to produce different outward
-signs. Fasting is starvation. Massage is stimulation or inhibition.
-Spondylotherapy means exhaustion of the spinal nerve centers in riotous
-expenditure of their stored-up energy.
-
-It would require a wisdom beyond the human to improve upon the natural
-healing processes with which the body has been provided. It should
-be our entire business to remove the obstructions which hinder the
-full exercise of that healing power--the subluxations--to remove them
-dexterously and decisively and to interfere in no other way.
-
-Other methods may and do serve to scatter or modify disease but not to
-cure it--unless they affect subluxations, as they sometimes do without
-intent. This accidental adjustment factor is valueless in the presence
-of a scientific and intelligent adjustment.
-
-Let Medicine, Osteopathy, Spondylotherapy, Christian Science, Massage,
-and Electricity have their field. It is not ours. Nor can any of
-these methods be rationally combined with Chiropractic. Their basic
-principles contradict ours; their application interferes with the
-results of adjustment. If you claim to remove the cause of disease, _do
-so_, and do not mar your work by treatment of effects.
-
-
-
-
-SPINO-ORGANIC CONNECTION
-
-
-It has been said in a previous section that when subluxation and
-disease are associated the subluxation always precedes the disease and
-that the former is the cause, the latter the effect. So clearly do we
-understand this law that we are able to say _what_ subluxation would
-cause a certain disease and err by only so many cases per centum as
-there are variations from the usual structure of the spinal column and
-the nervous system.
-
-But merely to state that a second Dorsal subluxation causes heart
-disease is not enough. We must know why and how it causes heart disease
-and whether, perchance, some other subluxation may sometimes have a
-like effect. We must map out the sphere of malign influence of each
-possible subluxation so that when our fingers encounter it it at once
-and inevitably suggests its possible effects, from which, by diagnostic
-methods, we may choose the one toward which most symptoms point. And we
-must know the relation of every nerve in the body to peripheral organs
-and their functions so that when we encounter indubitable evidence of
-some functional or organic disease we may know exactly where, in the
-spinal column, to seek for its cause.
-
-We have learned how to discover a subluxation, how to adjust it, and
-how that adjustment permits a natural cure of its abnormal effects. We
-must now learn exactly _where_ to apply adjustment for any given organ
-in the body or for any disease. It must be understood in interpreting
-this statement and all those which follow in this section that it is
-never proper to adjust a vertebra merely because it is stated to be the
-cause of a disease believed to exist in a patient. No vertebra should
-be moved unless palpation determines it to be subluxated. Rather let it
-be known that _as a rule_ the statements of spino-organic connection
-here made will prove to be verifiable by palpation. There is no rule in
-Chiropractic without some exceptions, and mere diagnosis of disease is
-too notoriously unreliable to serve as a guide to adjustment without
-the verification of the trained touch.
-
-
-The Field of Study
-
-We wish to know the relation existing between each part of the Nerve
-System and other parts and between each part and the other organs of
-the body. Especially we wish to understand the relation between each
-part of the Nerve System and the spinal column, by which permanent
-subluxations of the latter interfere with the former’s action and
-therefore with the peripheral organs.
-
-This requires a general knowledge of anatomy, physiology, and pathology
-which we shall presuppose the reader to possesses so that we may
-present only facts to which his attention should be particularly
-called. Let us begin with the relation of nerve tissue to other tissues
-where this relation can be most clearly comprehended, namely, with the
-development of the human embryo.
-
-
-Segmentation
-
-The complete human organism represents the snarled fusion of a series
-of similar, yet specialized, somatic segments, each presenting most
-of the attributes of a simple animal, though the association and
-co-ordination of all are required for the production of higher animal
-phenomena.
-
-The embryo is composed of such segments placed with their centers in
-the same axial line. Each segment contains in association which is
-morphologic, physiologic, and anatomical, a segment of nerve matter and
-a somatic (body) segment. The neural segments are arranged end to end
-so as to form the rudimentary beginning of the complete central nerve
-axis of the adult human body; the somatic segments blend together with
-somewhat indefinite lines of cleavage which are to become much more
-indefinite and obscure by changes in relative form due to differences
-in the growth rate of different parts or to involuntionary changes
-following functional inutility at various periods. Gray says, “The
-intrinsically segmental nature of the spinal cord is expressed by the
-association of each definite segment with the somatic segment supplied
-by its nerve.”
-
-Within each segment there may be observed at an early period cell
-migrations from the walls of the primitive neural tube and amoeboid
-projection of axonic and dendritic processes from these cells, which
-serve to bring the other tissues of the segment under the control of
-the nerve elements; there is an assumption of command, as it were, by
-the nervous system, so that the epithelial, connective, and muscular
-tissues of each segment are linked in sensomotor and vegetative
-co-ordination by the contact association of the nerves which ramify
-them--sensomotor because the nerves are presently to carry the only
-force capable of inciting activity of any kind in other tissues,
-vegetative because the functions of growth, nutrition, and repair, in
-each somatic cell, depend upon the continuity of communication between
-it and the lowest nerve cell in the nerve pathway which connects it
-with the higher motor and sensor centers.
-
-
-Development of the Nerve System
-
-Already may be noted a hint and a prophecy of that future segmental
-organization by which it becomes possible for some spinal vertebra to
-become displaced and thus begin a morbid process which may diffuse
-itself throughout an entire body segment, involving neural and somatic
-elements together. Already the simple organization begins to become
-rapidly complex and difficult to trace.
-
-Cell masses begin to migrate from the walls of the primitive neural
-tube to a position laterad to become the spinal ganglia; these send
-out long dendritic processes which marvellously thread their way to a
-predetermined peripheral connection which is to bring some cutaneous,
-or muscular, or joint tissue into sensor relation with the dorsal,
-or Sensor, portion of the cord and through it with the brain; at the
-same time they send their axonic processes inward to mingle with and
-communicate with the dendrites of other sensor cells remaining in the
-central axis to form the gray matter of the cord, and thus, migrating,
-keep up communication both with the central axis and the periphery.
-Other cell masses migrate ventrolaterad to form the sympathetic ganglia
-and they also send out afferent and efferent processes which make a
-connection on the one hand with the periphery and on the other with the
-source from which the cells developed, the situation to be occupied
-by the cord. From this view it is seen that the sympathetic system
-is merely an offshoot from the same source with all the rest of the
-peripheral nerve system, merely a mechanism for the proper distribution
-of nerve impulses from the central organs, and that it retains its
-connection in all its parts with those organs. Its ganglia, like those
-of the cord, are always and from the beginning under the domination of
-the upper or cephalic end of the neural tube.
-
-This cephalic end rapidly expands. Its growth is faster than the rest
-of the neural tube and from its walls, by proliferation, develop the
-structures of the cerebrum, mid-brain, and hind-brain. It also gives
-off ganglionic masses from which grow sensor processes to form the
-afferent elements of the cranial nerves and contains, like the cord,
-motor nuclei, or nidi, from which motor axons grow toward the periphery
-to come into relation with definitely predetermined organs.
-
-
-The Spinal Column and Cranium
-
-Now appear the primitive cartilaginous and membranous elements from
-which a bony wall is to be built around the central nerve axis,
-primitive vertebrae, the upper known as cranial and numbering four,
-and the lower, or spinal, numbering usually thirty-three. These bone
-structures develop around the brain and spinal cord. Later the cephalic
-vertebrae fuse into a solid vault, the cranium, completely enclosed
-except for various foramina for the passage of spinal cord, nerves, and
-blood-vessels. The succeeding twenty-four vertebrae remain separate and
-movable upon each other and leave between them the openings for the
-emergence of the spinal nerves. The last nine segments fuse eventually
-into two immovable or false vertebrae called Sacrum and Coccyx. These
-latter also contain foramina from which nerves issue.
-
-
-The Adult Nerve System
-
-When this development and growth of new parts is completed the
-Nerve System appears as a set of complex organs made of a central
-axis, brain and spinal cord, and peripheral connections made up of
-forty-three pairs of directly attached nerves (12 cranial and 31
-spinal) with two great gangliated cords and numerous other sympathetic
-ganglia and communicating cords situated outside the skeletal axis
-but communicating with it intimately by means of interchange of fibre
-bundles between the sympathetic and the cerebro-spinal nerves.
-
-[Illustration: Schematic diagram of Spinal nerve and Rami.
-
-A: Spinal nerve. B: Spinal ganglion. C: Posterior nerve root. D:
-Anterior nerve root. E: White ramus communicans. F: Gray ramus
-communicans. G: Sympathetic ganglion. H: Sympathetic cord.
-
- After Gray
- Parker
-
-31. Interchange of fibre bundles between spinal and sympathetic
-nerves.]
-
-But we who have viewed the embryonic development even briefly and
-sketchily, understand that all these complex organs are merely an
-aggregation of neurons, each neuron made up of a cell body, one or more
-axons, and dendrites; that the nerve cells are the controlling elements
-and the axons the centrifugal carriers of nerve energy, while the
-dendrites are the centripetal processes through which each nerve cell
-receives communications.
-
-
-The Body Axis
-
-The skull and spinal column, taken together, constitute the bony axis
-of the body, the center of organization of the skeleton; to these parts
-are attached other skeletal structures, mandible, ribs and sternum,
-extremities, classified as the appendicular portion of the skeleton.
-Likewise are attached, directly or indirectly, the voluntary muscles
-which move the skeleton, and the vessels and viscera. Any given
-structure in the body can be traced to a supporting connection with
-this bony axis.
-
-The bony axis contains the neural axis. Its strength and solidity are
-such as to preserve the integrity of the most vitally important tissue
-of the body from every form of injury if such protection be possible.
-Through openings in the bony axis--foramina--the central nerve
-organs give off or receive the nerve bundles which bring them into
-communication with every other structure of the body. And the body has
-been so arranged that every single part of it is partly or wholly under
-control of nerves emerging through these foramina. Even the brain
-and spinal cord themselves respond to changes in the blood-vessels
-which are controlled by nerve impulses which have emerged through the
-intervertebral or cranial foramina and returned by other routes to
-supply the muscular coats of the vessels.
-
-
-Concussion of Forces Affects Spinal Column
-
-Reverting for a moment to the primitive segmental arrangement which
-is none the less persistent and important because in the completed
-human the regularity of contour of the segments has been wholly lost
-and aberrant organs have moved from their original positions carrying
-their nerve supply with them, let us first state and then illustrate a
-general law.
-
-Any violence applied to the body tends to affect the spinal column.
-Such violence does or does not produce permanent displacement of a
-spinal segment according as it does or does not succeed in overcoming
-the internal resistance. But whatever effect upon the spine is
-accomplished will occur most noticeably in the same body segment
-to which violence was applied. That is, force applied to any body
-segment tends to subluxate the vertebra which would impinge the nerves
-controlling that segment. Thus diseases are primarily segmental and
-later general just as the body is primarily segmental and later
-co-ordinated into complicated functional systems, all more or less
-interdependent.
-
-If a man falls so that he strikes first on the point of his shoulder
-the force will be transmitted almost directly across the line of the
-spine, at right angles, and may subluxate the sixth or seventh Cervical
-or first Dorsal. If subluxation occurs it is because the law of gravity
-causes the remainder of the body to keep moving downward after the
-shoulder strikes and until it too comes to rest. The subluxation
-which results is a right one if the left shoulder be struck and vice
-versa. Now the brachial plexus is chiefly controlled by these three
-vertebrae and a right subluxation tends to impinge most the nerves
-on the left side, so that if any permanent effect of the fall follow
-it will be a permanent weakness or disease of the left shoulder or
-arm, with possible slight extensions along other branches of the same
-plexus, as to the latissimus dorsi. Also by the internal sympathetic
-communications from this same region the larynx, trachea, or large
-bronchi may be affected, occasionally the heart, all structures
-segmentally associated with the arm.
-
-This law applies throughout the body and can be fully demonstrated
-by any one having a complete knowledge of nerve connections and body
-segmentation upon being furnished with a complete and accurate history
-of any injury to the body. It goes further than this. Toxins or other
-secondary causes operating within the body tend always to produce their
-motor reactions and consequent effect upon any subluxated vertebrae in
-the same body segment with the peripheral irritation, so that if the
-stomach contain a poison which affects the spine the sixth or seventh
-Dorsal vertebrae will be most affected and the stomach itself the organ
-to suffer most.
-
-The spinal column is peculiarly adapted, with its strong ligaments,
-its cartilage cushions, its perfect flexibility and flexuousness,
-to withstand jars and shocks. Yet the spine is the door by which
-disease enters the organism. Concussion of forces, the energy from the
-environment encountering the bodily resistance, is of no serious effect
-upon the organism--of no permanent or irreparable effect--unless it
-affects the spine and brings about vertebral subluxation, disturbance
-of the normal alignment between vertebrae, and thereby interrupts the
-perfect healing and controlling influence exerted by the vital part of
-the segment, the central nerve portion.
-
-When a concussion of forces _does_ produce subluxations, does disturb
-the perfect poise and balance of that center of structure of the body,
-its consequences affect an entire body segment, producing, or tending
-to produce, disturbances through the entire segment.
-
-Disease is the indirect consequence of the contact of man with his
-environment and is _natural_ but not _normal_.
-
-The spinal column is a _center_ or a series of centers for disease.
-In this column will be found the primary cause--the introductory
-element--by which disease first makes its appearance in a previously
-healthy body.
-
-
-Comparative Anatomy
-
-The study of Comparative Anatomy is necessary to a complete
-understanding of the human organism. We may trace in the simplest forms
-of animal life the beginnings and foreshadowings of the same plan of
-organization. We may follow it through the ascending scale and watch
-its complexity develop, and by viewing each step in the process we
-may come fully to realize that the original plan has been preserved
-throughout, though often in such form that by study of the single
-species we should fail to recognize it.
-
-We lack space for complete consideration of this subject and shall
-merely suggest certain facts and phases. No clear analogy can be drawn
-until we reach the worm, with its rudimentary spinal column and nerves.
-Roughly speaking, dissection of one spinal segment with its nerves and
-their controlled area--if this were possible--would separate from the
-rest a fairly regular _layer_ similar to all the other layers. This is
-the primitive segmentation.
-
-It is shown much more clearly in the fish but the segments have begun
-to curve with their periphery directed slightly caudad and some have
-already shown a preponderating growth over other segments and a change
-of shape from the original symmetry.
-
-The reptiles and birds show still more complicated segmentation. It
-is notable that in these lower animals the purely reflex portion
-of the nervous system is highly developed while the volitional and
-sensory portions, the cerebral hemispheres, are yet rudimentary. In
-birds, particularly, the cerebellum is very highly developed because
-its function of co-ordination of muscles for the maintainence of
-equilibrium is required in a high degree for flying.
-
-Those land animals which walk on all fours approach still closer
-but their arrangement is much more readily comprehensible than in
-man. As the animal stands on all fours with head extended, a gigantic
-cleaver slicing out each vertebra and pair of nerves and slicing
-straight toward the base of support might be said to divide the body
-_approximately_ according to the structural and functional arrangement
-in segments. Yet no segment so separated would exactly correspond to
-the nerve distribution; there would be enlargement of some organs
-with extension into the zone previously occupied by their neighbors;
-enlargement here and atrophy there; invagination of one organ by
-another and overlapping and intermingling of parts. Even the relation
-between the spinal cord segments and the vertebrae has departed much
-from the primitive so that the growth of the vertebrae has exceeded
-that of the cord and the cord terminates opposite the Lumbar region
-instead of at the end of the Sacral canal. It may here be remarked
-that in the human embryo the cord at first occupies the entire length
-of the neural canal formed within the vertebrae; that in the adult it
-terminates opposite the lower border of the body of the first Lumbar
-vertebra and that the nerves, still retaining their original foramina
-of exit and their relation to the somatic segments, pass downward
-within the canal to their respective openings and collectively form a
-brush like mass called “cauda equina.”
-
-
-Causes of Segmental Changes
-
-The causes of the change in the shape, form, and relation of the
-different segments are functional: the body changes to meet the
-changing needs of its environment and the steady progressive functional
-development from one species to another.
-
-When the animal at last assumes the erect position, doing more
-intricately and intelligently the bidding of a developing and improving
-central nervous system, the change of position and the force of gravity
-bring about a gradual downward, or caudad, tendency of the parts of the
-somatic segments most remote from the spine and of the nerves which
-supply them.
-
-The nerves, muscles, and bones of the lower extremities change from
-almost a right angle to an extremely obtuse angle, less obtuse during
-infancy and more so in the adult. The forelegs become arms and hang at
-the sides, extending downward from the part of the spine which controls
-them. The ribs tend more obliquely downward and outward from the spine
-and the tendency of all the nerves is downward from their attachment to
-the spinal cord to their emergence from the intervertebral foramina. In
-the neck and head alone is this rule varied, the tendency of the nerves
-and some other structures there being to run from the spine either at
-right angles or upward.
-
-It seems almost symbolic and indicative of the purpose of creation that
-the body, which is less strong and vigorous in Man than in the lower
-animals, should tend more and more obliquely downward from its central
-axis, while the cranium, containing a highly specialized mass of cells
-and fibres, the organ of Mind, which marks Man’s supremacy in the
-animal kingdom and is his crowning glory, is reared _above_ the body it
-dominates.
-
-In all the form changes which mark the growth of the body the organs
-are arranged to afford the greatest possible economy of space and
-convenience for use. This perfect and matchless mechanism adapts itself
-to the changing habits and environments and to the quality and needs of
-the Mind which inhabits it.
-
-
-Necessity for Table of Spino-Organic Connection
-
-To the practitioner who is fully equipped with an instantly available
-knowledge of all the nerve connections in the body and to whom
-palpation of a subluxation at once suggests its somatic sphere of
-influence as a weakened or diseased area, or to whom mention of a
-disease immediately calls to mind the organ, or segment, which is
-primarily affected and its nerve connection with the spine, any
-tabulation of spino-organic connection or of diseases and adjustments,
-for reference, is unnecessary. But the ordinary practitioner finds it
-difficult to acquire and retain such an array of information and much
-more convenient to refer to reliable and easily read tables which will
-supply at once any such information desired.
-
-No specific adjustment is possible without knowledge of the vertebra
-which controls the part diseased and toward the healing of which the
-nerve energy should be directed. Specific adjustment without correct
-diagnosis is of course impossible. And whenever correct diagnosis has
-been made it is essential that the mind of the Chiropractor should
-revert to one certain vertebra which he expects to find subluxated as
-the primary cause of the disease.
-
-Diagnosis is essential in order to find out _what_ organ is the site
-of the disease, for all disease is primarily segmental. The _location_
-of the disease having been determined, a quick reference to a table
-showing the spinal connection with that location makes specific
-adjustment possible. The value of specific, as against general,
-adjustments will be considered under “Practice.”
-
-
-Method of Investigation
-
-One who wishes to determine for himself the proper specific adjustment
-for a certain disease must, in order to be able to attach any weight to
-his conclusions or to announce them with any hope of credence by the
-scientific world, proceed very much after the following method, which
-sets down what may be termed “standard test conditions” for research
-into the spino-organic connection.
-
-He must make a correct diagnosis which serves to determine the nature
-and location of the disease process. In this he may be greatly aided
-by vertebral palpation and nerve-tracing, especially in differential
-diagnosis. Any case which affords less than a quite positively correct
-diagnosis should be excluded from the test list because any conclusion
-based on a doubtful diagnosis must itself be doubtful and may be
-seriously misleading.
-
-He must then ascertain as far as possible the known anatomical nerve
-connection between the spine and the diseased part. If several
-connections are known he must decide according to nervous physiology,
-by recognizing the morbid functions which constitute the disease and
-learning which nerves control these functions and which must therefore
-be deranged in order that the disease may exist. I may say right
-here that to attempt to answer the problems of Chiropractic on the
-assumption that standard anatomies are incorrect in their statement of
-nerve connections is as hopeless as the wail of the schoolboy that the
-answers in his arithmetic are wrong because his sums fail to come out
-that way.
-
-The investigator must next be accurate in Palpation, selecting the
-subluxation which would, from his knowledge of the body segmentation,
-seem most likely to influence the nerves involved, and positively
-ascertaining the _number_ of the subluxated vertebra. No one who cannot
-count vertebrae accurately can positively say which vertebra he has
-adjusted. More than that, no one who _has not_ counted the vertebrae in
-the special case in question can say which vertebra he has adjusted. No
-mere regional localization will suffice for scientific investigation.
-
-Correct and accurate adjustment must follow selection of the single
-vertebra and the adjuster must know that he has used the one
-special movement, or form of adjustment, which is mechanically right
-for that kind of subluxation and has so moved the vertebra as to
-release impingement. Mere movement of a vertebra is not necessarily
-an adjustment or even a maladjustment; it may be movement without
-permanent change of relation or release of impingement. (See
-“Preferable Adjustments,” p. 155.)
-
-There follows the observation of the progress of the case and this
-must be so careful and accurate that the observer knows to a certainty
-whether the disease is progressing unfavorably, or favorably, or
-whether it has been entirely eradicated. He must know the value of
-every changing symptom, the real meaning of each new development. Every
-diagnostic method should be at his command for this work. Constant
-vigilance and constant thought should mark each step of his work.
-
-Finally he must be so cautious and careful in his statements that no
-doubtful conclusion is allowed to escape from his own mind. We may
-believe or suspect or hope for proof of our theories but we have no
-right to state as a fact anything except that which has been proven
-under the most rigidly guarded scientific test conditions.
-
-Failure to observe any of the precautions mentioned renders worthless
-the results of investigation. Nothing further than a mere presumption
-can be based upon research which fails to observe all these rules.
-It will be readily understood that there are few Chiropractors
-whose training has been sufficient to enable them successfully to
-accomplish such research. There are thus many things connected with the
-spino-organic connections which are commonly held as facts but which
-should be classed as presumptions. And the prevalence of the habit of
-general adjustment rather than specific makes the future final solution
-of all these problems remote.
-
-
-Kinds of Evidence Acceptable
-
-It will be seen that of the three kinds of evidence--Anatomical,
-Physiological, and Clinical--which are admissible in reasoning upon
-the connection between the spine and disease, only one form--clinical
-evidence--has been adduced by Chiropractic. For anatomical and
-physiological corroboration of our apparent clinical findings we are
-obliged to turn to standard works on these subjects; fortunately we
-find it in abundance.
-
-Anatomy, fortified now by research in the morphologic relations of the
-parts studied and by physiological and pathological experiment which
-has thrown much light on the proper viewpoints from which to describe
-structure, contains sufficient data on the nervous system to enable us
-to explain practically every fact observable in a Chiropractic clinic.
-
-It is true that there are a few statements in the ensuing outlines for
-which we cannot as yet find the anatomical or physiological proof. But
-it must be remembered that anatomists and physiologists have never
-studied the body with a knowledge of the subluxation theory to aid them
-in gaining perspective and that Chiropractors, as a class, have not
-yet delved deeply enough into anatomy and physiology to extract all the
-available and illuminating information from them. Ofttimes the facts we
-value most are most obscure in the texts because to others they seem
-least important. But they are there. Armed with information concerning
-Chiropractic facts it is probable that the scientist of the future will
-corroborate all of our clinical findings of today and emphasize the
-rational explanations of them.
-
-In the following tables it has been found best to insert in parentheses
-the capital letter (P) to call attention to any statement in support of
-which we have gathered less than all three forms of admissible evidence
-and which is therefore as yet presumptive. It is well, however, for the
-practitioner to be careful lest he regard too lightly such presumptive
-statements. Unless there is very strong and reasonable ground for such
-presumption or a general belief in its correctness all mention of it
-is omitted. Those labelled presumptive are merely so indicated because
-they have not yet been proven and not because they have failed to serve
-as a convenient and useful guide to adjustment. For each presumption
-offered there is either clinical or anatomical justification but not
-both.
-
-
-SPECIAL NERVE CONNECTIONS
-
-This section does not purport to state with any degree of completeness
-the various nerve-paths by which spinal vertebrae come into relation
-with all, or nearly all, the peripheral organs of the body. It merely
-points out some of the more interesting and important connections,
-some of the paths which serve to explain the common effects of
-vertebral adjustment. It is not expected that this resume of the
-subject will be more than suggestive to the student; certainly it
-cannot, in so brief a space, be a complete exposition.
-
-
-Outline of Nerve System
-
-Let us begin with the observation that almost every organ of the
-body, including the central nerve organs themselves, may be adversely
-affected by spinal subluxation impinging spinal nerve axons at their
-exit from, or entrance through, intervertebral foramina, or by
-spinal subluxation producing direct impingement upon some part of
-the sympathetic system and similarly interfering with its power to
-functionate.
-
-The Nerve System may be divided into two great divisions, the central
-axis and the peripheral system which distributes nerve energy from,
-and brings stimuli to, the central axis. The central axis consists of
-the brain and spinal cord; the peripheral system of 12 pairs of nerves
-attached to the brain and having exit (except the eighth) through
-foramina in the base of the cranium, 31 pairs of spinal nerves emerging
-through intervertebral foramina whose parts are movable upon each other
-(except the foramina for sacral and coccygeal nerves), and an intricate
-system of sympathetic fibres and ganglia arranged in a double chain
-of ganglia in front and at the sides of the vertebral column, three
-great prevertebral plexuses, the cardiac, coeliac, and hypogastric,
-and numerous scattered ganglia and communicating cords which bind the
-ganglia together and connect them with spinal or cranial nerves and
-with the periphery.
-
-The peripheral system is somewhat complex and numerous
-intercommunications are established by which nerve impulses originating
-in the central axis and leaving by one part of the peripheral system
-may exercise a controlling influence over another part. Plexuses, or
-intertwinings of nerve axons, are so numerous and complicated that it
-is difficult to follow each set of nerve stimuli from their origin to
-their final destination and effect without considerable study.
-
-
-Direct Distribution of Spinal Axons
-
-The spinal nerve axons, taken as a whole, establish paths between
-the motor gray of the ventral horn of the spinal cord and all
-voluntary muscles of the body below the head except the trapezius
-and sternomastoid, partially innervated by the eleventh cranial, and
-between the sensor cells of the dorsal spinal gray and gracile and
-cuneate nuclei of the medulla on the one hand and the sensor end
-organs in skin and mucuous membrane, muscles, tendons, and joints on
-the other. The ventral cornu receives impulses from the cortico-spinal
-axons of the direct pyramidal, crossed pyramidal, rubrospinal, and
-other smaller tracts which bring the spinal gray under the direct
-voluntary domination of the volitional centers in the brain or of
-the indirectly voluntary pathway through the cerebellum. The spinal
-nerves are the direct media for motion of the body or its parts in
-relation to its environment. The sensor gray of the cord is similarly
-in communication with the conscious sensation area in the cerebrum
-and with the cerebellum by way of the dorsal tracts of the cord, the
-lemnisci, and the cerebellar peduncles.
-
-In the main these nerves of motion and sensation are arranged as
-follows:
-
-The Cervical plexus is composed of the intertwining of axons from the
-anterior primary divisions of the four upper Cervical nerves. Its
-branches pass to and innervate many voluntary muscles of the neck
-and side and back of head, and supply sensor fibres to the adjacent
-cutaneous areas. Branches also communicate with the last three cranial
-nerves and one long branch, the Phrenic, or Internal Respiratory Nerve
-of Bell, passes through the neck and thorax to the diaphragm, as its
-motor nerve.
-
-The Brachial plexus is made up of the anterior primary divisions of the
-four lower Cervical nerves and the greater part of the first Thoracic.
-It is distributed chiefly to the voluntary muscles and integument of
-the shoulder and arm, forearm, and hand, but sends branches to some
-muscles of the neck and upper back as well. It, like the Cervical
-plexus, receives branches from, but gives none to, the Cervical
-sympathetic.
-
-The Thoracic nerves are not arranged in plexiform fashion like those
-above but pass separately, for the most part, to their destinations.
-They are distributed to the walls of the thorax and abdomen following
-the curve of the ribs in direction. The last Thoracic sends one
-division downward as far as the outer aspect of the ilium.
-
-The Lumbar, Sacral, and Pudendal plexuses are formed of the ventral
-divisions of the Lumbar, Sacral, and Coccygeal nerves and distribute
-branches to the integument and voluntary muscles of the lower abdomen,
-pelvis, and lower extremities. From two of the sacral nerves branches
-known as “Visceral” pass through the plexus to terminate in the walls
-of the uterus and rectum.
-
-All of the thoracic nerves and the first and second, sometimes the
-third and fourth, lumbar give off branches to the sympathetic ganglia,
-known as white rami communicantes.
-
-
-Direct Distribution of Cranial Nerves
-
-The distribution of the 12 pairs of cranial nerves is not so definitely
-to voluntary muscles and to areas from which conscious sensation is to
-be derived as is the case with the spinal, although the cranial nerves
-present many analogies with the spinal and there is abundant reason
-for considering them as in one series of 43 pairs. There is direct
-distribution of some cranial nerve fibres to secreting glands, but
-these fibres are probably merely derived from sympathetic trunks and
-carried in company with the axons of cranial origin. There is also some
-direct distribution of cranial nerve axons to visceral walls made of
-non-striated muscle, as in the case of the vagus distribution to the
-respiratory and alimentary tracts and that of the spinal accessory to
-the heart. This is a resemblance to the sympathetic.
-
-The cranial nerves carry afferent impressions from the special sense
-organs, except those of the sense of touch, which function is divided
-with the spinal nerves.
-
-Various intercommunications exist between the cranial and sympathetic
-divisions of the peripheral system, by means of which axons starting
-with one division may be finally distributed with another, or by which
-an axon of the sympathetic may pass to one of the sensor ganglia of the
-cranial system and influence its nutrition and condition, and therefore
-its power to act. There is a limited intermingling of spinal fibres
-with the lower cranial.
-
-
-Distribution of Sympathetic
-
-The sympathetic system directly innervates most of the nutritive or
-vegetative system, the alimentary tract and its accessory organs, the
-vascular systems, the genito-urinary system, and the ductless glands.
-To a limited degree it shares this control with the cerebro-spinal
-and to a much greater degree it brings the central axis into indirect
-connection with these viscera.
-
-Gray says, “The distinction of the sympathetic system from the
-cerebrospinal system is made merely for reasons of convenience. The two
-systems are intimately connected and the sympathetic is morphologically
-a derivative of the central axis disseminated in connection with
-the nutritive apparatus and establishing relationships among the
-vegetative organs.”
-
-
-Structure of Nerve Pathways
-
-Most pathways which carry nerve impulses from their origin or inception
-to the organ in which they are finally expressed as action of some sort
-or translated into sensation or into stimuli which pass out reflexly
-over a connected neuron, are composed of more than one neuron. The
-neurons of a nerve pathway are arranged end to end with the axons all
-pointing in one general direction so that the nerve energy travels
-always in the same direction over the entire nerve path. Impulses are
-transferred from the first neuron in the chain to the second, and from
-second to third, etc., by contact of the telodendria of the one neuron
-with the dendrites or receptive processes of the next. Part of the
-nerve pathway may be within the central axis and part within the trunk
-of a peripheral nerve.
-
-Several peripheral pathways for afferent impulses may be joined to an
-efferent pathway so as to complete reflex arcs and the efferent cell
-be under the controlling influence of some upper neuron coming down
-from the central axis with the power either to permit or to inhibit the
-reflex acts which would otherwise take place as a result of peripheral
-stimuli. Several such lower cells may be under the domination of one
-upper neuron.
-
-In some instances the nutrition of ganglia or nerve trunks, or of
-parts of the central axis itself, is under the control of sympathetic
-neurons terminating in connection therewith, so that interruption of
-the normal action of the sympathetic neuron may be followed by effects
-manifested through some distant part of the cerebrospinal system. In
-the following pages we shall discuss nerve pathways with reference to
-the explanation of diseases caused by vertebral subluxation impinging
-nerves either by tension or constriction, and therefore our grouping
-of parts will differ somewhat from any anatomical or physiological
-grouping with another object in view.
-
-
-Important Nerve Pathways
-
-_To brain_: C 2, 3, or 4 to superior cervical ganglion by direct
-impingement, through internal carotid nerve to sympathetic plexuses
-following branch arteries from Circle of Willis. The blood-supply of
-the brain is under control of the cervical sympathetic and most brain
-lesions or diseases are due to vascular changes leading to anaemia,
-hyperaemia, inflammation, or hemorrhage.
-
-_To meninges_: Loop between first and second cervical nerves to trunk
-ganglion of vagus and through meningeal branches of vagus (P), or
-by way of internal carotid nerve to pial sympathetic plexuses. (P)
-The connection of the first, second, or third cervical with cerebral
-meningitis is established clinically but there is still doubt as to the
-explanation.
-
-_Eye and Muscles_, _Retina_, _Optic Nerve_: The external muscles of
-the eye, the four recti and two oblique with the levator palpebrae
-superioris, are innervated by the Oculomotor, or third cranial, and the
-fourth and sixth cranial, which receive branches from the cavernous
-plexus of the sympathetic derived from the internal carotid branch
-of the superior cervical ganglion. As the ganglion lies in front of
-the transverse processes of the second, third, and fourth cervical
-vertebrae, direct impingement upon it by subluxation of one of these
-vertebrae may cause strabismus or other affection of the external
-ocular muscles.
-
-The eye-ball receives filaments from the ciliary or ophthalmic
-ganglion, which in turn is connected with the cervical ganglion by way
-of cavernous plexus and internal carotid nerve. This pathway controls
-the radial fibres of the iris and dilates the pupil as a part of the
-light accommodation reflex mechanism. Loss of pupillary reaction,
-especially with small pupils, suggests upper cervical subluxation.
-
-The retina, containing the cells of origin of the optic nerve axons and
-being the special end-organ of the sense of sight has no direct spinal
-or sympathetic connections but its blood-supply, and therefore its
-nutrition, is influenced by branches from the sympathetic which enter
-with the central artery of the retina. Retinal hemorrhage has been
-cured by cervical adjustment, C 2, 3, or 4.
-
-The conjunctiva is innervated by the sympathetic and by the fifth
-cranial, or trigeminal.
-
-_Olfactory Nerve_: Nerve of smell, distributed to the Schneiderian
-membrane over the upper portion of the nasal septum and over the upper
-lateral wall. There is no known connection by which the trunk of the
-olfactory nerve can be reached by adjustment but the condition of the
-special end organs in the membrane and their ability to functionate
-depend not only upon the integrity of their axons but also upon the
-nutrition and moisture of the membrane in which they are embedded.
-This is under the control of the Vidian nerve and of branches from the
-spheno-palatine, or Meckel’s ganglion, both connected with the carotid
-plexus of the sympathetic and therefore responsive to adjustment of
-C 2, 3, or 4. This is also the route by which epistaxis is usually
-checked.
-
-The external nasal muscles, like those of the rest of the face except
-some of the muscles of mastication, get their supply from the facial
-nerve, which connects with the sympathetic plexus on the middle
-meningeal artery. It may be said parenthetically here that peripheral
-facial paralysis (Bell’s palsy) yields to adjustment and proves the
-value of this connection. The nasal integument is under the sensor
-control of the trigeminal and trophic disturbances may result from its
-involvement.
-
-_Trigeminal Nerve_: This is the great sensor nerve of the face and
-carries a motor division, the inferior maxillary, to some of the
-muscles of mastication, as the temporal, masseter, and buccinator. It
-has connected with it four ganglia, which also receive sympathetic
-roots, and the ganglion of origin of its sensor axons, the Gasserian
-or semilunar, also receives direct sympathetic communications. The
-importance of this communication is shown by the powerful effect of
-adjustment of third or fourth Cervical for tic dolouroux.
-
-_Ear_: The external ear receives branches from the vagus and from
-the first and second cervical nerves. The middle ear and Eustachian
-tube are supplied by the tympanic plexus made up of branches from
-the glosso-pharyngeal, otic ganglion, facial nerve and the small
-deep petrosal from the sympathetic on the carotid artery. By all
-these routes communication from the third and fourth cervicals is
-possible but especially is the latter important. The fourth cervical
-is the especially frequent subluxation with middle ear disease. To
-the internal ear and auditory or acoustic nerve there appears to be
-no direct route from the spine. It has not yet been conclusively
-established within the writer’s knowledge that adjustments will
-affect auditory deafness but Meniere’s Disease, inflammation of the
-semicircular canals, has been cured repeatedly by adjustments of Atlas
-or Axis, by what route I am unable to state.
-
-_Teeth and Gums_: It is probable that the only connection between the
-vertebrae and the teeth is an afferent one by way of the trigeminal.
-Toothache may be stopped by adjustment of C 3, or C 4, but no evidence
-is at hand to show that the condition of the teeth is improved or that
-more than a temporary effect can be had. Trophic changes in the gums
-may be due to vascular disturbances controlled by the sympathetic.
-
-_Tongue_: The hypoglossal, motor nerve to both the intrinsic and
-extrinsic muscles of the tongue, receives direct axons from the loop
-between the first and second Cervical nerves. Sympathetic fibres pass
-to the blood-vessels and secreting glands of the tongue.
-
-_Tonsils_: Receive fibres from the spheno-palatine ganglion and by
-this means are brought under the domination of C 2, 3, and 4. Abundant
-clinical evidence in tonsilitis, simple, follicular, and suppurative,
-proves this to be the practically, as well as anatomically, correct
-nerve connection.
-
-_Salivary Glands_: The parotid receives branches from the great
-auricular nerve from the second and third cervical, and from the
-sympathetic on the external carotid artery, branches from the superior
-cervical ganglion. The submaxillary and sublingual glands are connected
-with the submaxillary ganglion, which receives a sympathetic root and
-which, with the chorda tympani also carrying fibres derived from the
-sympathetic, controls the secretions of these glands.
-
-_Pharynx_: The pharyngeal plexus is a mixture of sensory axons from
-the glosso-pharyngeal, motor components from the vagus and probably
-sensor from the same nerve, and sympathetic branches from the superior
-cervical ganglion. All of these may be influenced by the upper cervical
-adjustment.
-
-_Larynx_: According to anatomy the larynx is innervated by the superior
-and inferior, or recurrent, branches of the vagus and by sympathetic
-branches from the superior cervical ganglion. Clinically the sixth
-cervical adjustment cures laryngitis and aphonia. The explanation
-probably lies in the fact that the thyroid branches of the middle
-cervical ganglion, lying in front of the transverses of the sixth,
-communicate within the thyroid gland with the recurrent laryngeal and
-with the external laryngeal branch of the superior laryngeal.
-
-_Thyroid Gland_: “The nerves to the thyroid are amyelinic and are
-derived from the middle and inferior ganglia of the sympathetic.”
-(Gray.) The middle cervical ganglia are situated in front of the
-transverse processes of the sixth cervical vertebra. Clinically, the
-sixth cervical reaches goitre.
-
-_Muscles of Neck_: The platysma is supplied by the facial nerve;
-the sternomastoid by the spinal accessory and cervical plexus; the
-infrahyoid region by the first three cervical nerves; the suprahyoid
-region by the facial and the ansa cervicalis; the anterior and lateral
-vertebral muscles by the cervical nerves from second to seventh
-inclusive, but especially the second, third, and fourth. It will be
-seen that muscular disturbance in the neck may result from any cervical
-subluxation. Torticollis, which usually involves the sternomastoid,
-yields to the second cervical most frequently.
-
-_Lymph Nodes of Head and Face_: These lymph nodes are controlled by
-the cervical sympathetic. Pathological changes in one or more nodes
-requires careful cervical palpation to determine the presence of a
-subluxation away from the affected side.
-
-_Muscles of Back_: The trapezius is innervated by the spinal accessory
-and by the third and fourth cervical nerves; the latissimus dorsi by
-the sixth, seventh, and eighth cervical through the middle or long
-subscapular. Occasionally a tender nerve, traceable from the lower
-reaches of the latissimus to the cervical region has mislead the
-practitioner into imagining a cervical connection over the back with
-internal viscera.
-
-The second layer of the back is supplied by the third, fourth, and
-fifth cervical nerves. The third layer is innervated by the middle and
-lower cervical and upper three thoracic nerves except the serratus
-posticus inferior which is supplied by the ninth, tenth, and eleventh
-thoracic. The fourth and fifth layer are supplied by the posterior
-primary divisions of the spinal nerves and any given section of these
-layers may be traced to a vertebra directly above, or cephalad.
-
-_Thoracic Walls_: The parietal muscles of the thorax are innervated by
-the intercostal nerves and a very definite segmental association with
-the spine is traceable.
-
-_Diaphragm_: Phrenic nerve, which arises from fourth cervical chiefly;
-lower intercostals, especially eighth and ninth; and phrenic plexus of
-the sympathetic which may sometimes be reached from the fourth or fifth
-dorsal vertebrae through the gangliated cord. For motor disturbances of
-the diaphragm adjust fourth cervical.
-
-_Abdominal Muscles_: These are supplied by the lower intercostals and
-the transversalis and internal oblique make connection with L 1 by the
-iliohypogastric. Cremaster is supplied by L 1 and 2 by way of the
-genital branch of the genitofemoral.
-
-_Perineal Muscles_: The anterior perineal group are supplied by
-the perineal branch of the internal pudic which traces to the
-second, third, and fourth sacral nerves. The posterior perineal and
-ischiorectal region is also supplied by the sacral and coccygeal nerves.
-
-_Trachea and Bronchi_: Vagus and sympathetic filaments from first and
-second thoracic ganglia. The latter receive preganglionic fibres from
-first dorsal nerve in all probability, as this adjustment reaches the
-bronchi.
-
-_Lungs_: The third thoracic ganglia connect with the pulmonary plexus
-and establish a connection from third dorsal vertebra direct to the
-lung parenchyma. The _Pleurae_ have a similar connection or may
-sometimes be reached by the first dorsal.
-
-_Heart and Pericardium_: In 55% of all heart disease or improper
-action the second dorsal is responsible; in 40% the first dorsal, and
-perhaps in the remaining 5% the atlas or axis. The former nerves (T 1
-and 2) furnish pre-ganglionic fibres which stream upward through the
-gangliated cord to terminate in the three cervical ganglia in relation
-with the dendrites of new neurons (amyelinic) which form the superior,
-middle, and inferior cardiac nerves and pass into the thorax to mingle
-with vagal fibres to form the superficial and deep cardiac plexuses,
-controlling the heart. Probably the upper cervicals occasionally affect
-the vagus through the loop between the first and second cervical
-nerves.
-
-_Thoracic Aorta_: Controlled by sympathetic from first thoracic
-ganglion or last cervical ganglion, and thus by seventh cervical or
-first dorsal vertebra.
-
-_Abdominal aorta--Coeliac Axis_: The upper portion of the abdominal
-aorta is innervated by the coeliac or solar plexus of the sympathetic.
-Sub-plexuses from the coeliac accompany the various branches of the
-aorta and are widely distributed to the blood-vessels and to the glands
-and non-striated muscle of the abdominal organs. The coeliac plexus
-receives fibres from the right vagus and from the greater, lesser, and
-least splanchnic nerves, by the latter route making connection with the
-thoracic ganglia of the sympathetic from fifth to last. These ganglia
-receive pre-ganglionic fibres from the thoracic spinal nerves in the
-form of white rami communicantes, so that it is not incorrect to say
-that the coeliac plexus and its branches are largely controlled by the
-condition of the last eight thoracic nerves.
-
-Through this intricate plexus it is difficult to trace the relations
-of each abdominal organ with the particular vertebrae of which
-subluxation would produce disease in said organ. By the aid of clinical
-experimentation covering a period of years and by diligent search
-among anatomies and physiologies, we have arrived at the conclusions
-indicated in succeeding statements.
-
-The most important spinal connection with the abdominal blood-vessels
-is that of the fifth dorsal vertebra, for the fifth dorsal nerve, by
-its rami, seems greatly to influence the caliber of the aorta and
-coeliac axis.
-
-[Illustration:
-
-A. Cortico Spinal nerve. B. Spino Ganglionic nerve. C. Ganglio
-Ganglionic nerve. D. Ganglio Peripheric nerve. E. Blood Vessel Wall.
-
- Parker
-
- Fig. 32. Schematic representation of nerve pathway from brain to
- periphery by way of sympathetic.
-]
-
-_Liver_: Fourth thoracic nerves (especially the right) to gangliated
-cord, via great splanchnic nerve to coeliac plexus, by hepatic plexus
-to interior of liver. The hepatic plexus gives off the cystic plexus
-which controls the gall-bladder.
-
-_Stomach_: Sixth and seventh dorsal nerves by white rami to and through
-the ganglia of the gangliated cord to coeliac plexus. The gastric
-plexus is an offshoot of the coeliac and gives off Auerbach’s plexus
-to the muscular coat, and Meissner’s plexus to the submucous and
-mucous coats of the stomach. The nutrition of the stomach walls, their
-peristaltic action, and the secretory action of the stomach glands are
-thus brought under the direct influence of the sixth or the seventh
-dorsal subluxation.
-
-_Pancreas_: Eighth dorsal nerve by great splanchnic to coeliac
-plexus, to hepatic and superior mesenteric plexuses, and by the
-pancreatico-duodenal branches of the former and pancreatic branches of
-the latter to the pancreas.
-
-_Spleen_: The coeliac plexus, the left semilunar ganglion, and the
-left vagus and right phrenic nerves give off branches which form the
-splenic plexus. Spinal connection by way of ninth dorsal nerve, by rami
-communicantes to gangliated cord to great splanchnic nerve to coeliac
-plexus to splenic plexus. Many nerve pathways like this one are less
-indirect than they sound; various names have been given to different
-parts of the same pathway through which, often, the axons pass without
-interruption. On the way from the cerebral cortex to one of the
-abdominal viscera there may be only three, sometimes four or five,
-neurons connected end to end.
-
-_Duodenum_: Coeliac plexus by way of duodenal branches of hepatic
-plexus and branches from the superior mesenteric plexus. Spinal
-connection from eighth dorsal nerve and possibly branches from
-the upper lumbar ganglia of the sympathetic may join the superior
-mesenteric plexus, as results in duodenal disease are occasionally
-reported following specific adjustment of L 1 or 2.
-
-_Jejunum and Ileum_: Connection same as for duodenum, by superior
-mesenteric plexus. Adjustment of L 2 in typhoid fever is undoubtedly
-correct so that it is probable that the lumbar ganglia send branches to
-this vicinity.
-
-_Peritoneum_: Nerve supply to the peritoneum is rather general owing to
-its great extent. It is supplied by the sympathetic from both the lower
-thoracic and lumbar portions of the gangliated cord through the various
-abdominal plexuses and in general it may be said that any localized
-peritoneal disease will yield to the same adjustment as would be made
-for disease in the immediately subjacent organ.
-
-_Suprarenal Capsules_: These important glands are supplied by amyelinic
-fibres derived from the gangliated cord by the lesser splanchnic nerve
-and connecting with pre-ganglionic fibres from the tenth dorsal nerve.
-The suprarenal plexus is an offshoot of the coeliac.
-
-_Kidneys_: Tenth, eleventh, and twelfth dorsal nerves by way of lesser
-and least splanchnic nerves to renal plexus, an offshoot of the
-coeliac. McConnell’s experiments and the frequently duplicated clinical
-feats of Chiropractors prove this to be a vital and dominant nerve
-pathway in kidney disease.
-
-_Ureters_: Nerves derived from inferior mesenteric, pelvic, and
-spermatic plexuses. Most important connection seems to be from first
-lumbar nerve by lumbar ganglia to inferior mesenteric plexus.
-
-_Caecum and Vermiform Appendix_: The inferior mesenteric plexus, which
-supplies these organs probably carries to them chiefly fibres derived
-from the lumber ganglia which complete a connection with the second
-lumbar vertebra, especially on the right side.
-
-_Colon_: Third and fourth lumbar vertebrae, influencing lumbar ganglia
-and thus inferior mesenteric plexus.
-
-_Rectum_: Lower lumbar ganglia by inferior mesenteric and plevic
-plexuses, through superior and inferior hemorrhoidal plexus to rectum.
-Adjustment L 4 or 5. Visceral branches from the third and fourth sacral
-nerves also pass directly to the rectal wall and sacral adjustment may
-affect rectum or anus.
-
-_Bladder_: The urinary bladder is innervated by the vesical plexus from
-the pelvic, and by sacral nerve fibres direct. It is said that the
-vesical plexus contains many spinal nerve fibres which are derived from
-the second and fourth lumbar nerves especially. Clinically the second
-or the fourth lumbar will control the bladder much oftener than the
-sacrum.
-
-_Prostate Gland, Seminal Vesicles, Penis, and Urethra_: By the vesical
-and prostatic plexuses derived from the pelvic plexuses, divisions of
-the hypogastric plexus, which is formed of the abdominal aortic plexus
-and filaments from the lumbar ganglia. The latter receive filaments
-from the second and third lumbar nerves. There is a connection with the
-sacral nerves also by the pelvic plexus, though the lumbar adjustment
-appears the more potent.
-
-_Testes and Scrotum_: Ilioinguinal from second lumbar, genital branch
-of genito-femoral from second and third lumbar nerves, internal pudic
-nerve from the pudendal plexus, and spermatic and pelvic plexuses. The
-most effective adjustment for scrotal or testicular diseases is L 3.
-
-_Uterus and Vagina_: Uterovaginal plexus from the pelvic and containing
-spinal nerve fibres from L 4, L 5, and sacrum.
-
-_Ovaries and Fallopian Tubes_: The ovarian plexus receives fibres from
-the abdominal aortic and through it from the lumbar ganglia, influenced
-by second lumbar adjustment.
-
-_Brachial Plexus_: The brachial plexus of spinal nerves arises from
-the nerves from the fifth cervical to the first thoracic inclusive
-and controls the voluntary muscles of the upper extremity, with its
-integument. Muscle groups, rather than single muscles, are represented
-for the most part in the spinal segments giving off these nerves, and
-the ramification of the nerves within the plexus is such that almost
-any given muscle might be affected by more than one spinal subluxation.
-Below are given the principal connections:
-
-_Pectoralis Major and Minor Muscles_: Sixth or seventh cervical through
-internal anterior thoracic nerve and first dorsal through external
-anterior thoracic.
-
-_Shoulder Joint_: The joint, muscles covering the joint, and integument
-of this region are innervated by the circumflex nerve which traces
-through the plexus to fifth and sixth cervical nerves. Sixth cervical
-adjustment usually affects this joint.
-
-_Serratus Magnus Muscle_: Sixth cervical by long thoracic, or External
-Respiratory Nerve of Bell.
-
-_Elbow Joint_: Sixth cervical vertebra by musculocutaneous nerve.
-
-_Anterior Arm Muscles_: Sixth cervical.
-
-_Posterior Arm Muscles_: Seventh cervical and first dorsal.
-
-_Lumbosacral Plexus_: This plexus, derived from the anterior primary
-divisions of the lumbar, sacral, and coccygeal nerves, supplies the
-muscles and integument of the lower extremity, taking with it axons
-derived from the sympathetic by the lumbar ganglia to supply the
-blood-vessels, perspiratory glands and sebaceous glands of this region.
-The latter are responsive to adjustments of the first or second lumbar
-vertebrae.
-
-_Hip-Joint_: Third and fourth lumbar nerves by femoral and obturator
-or accessory obturator nerves and fifth lumbar or first sacral by the
-nerve to the quadratus femoris or the great sciatic. Fourth lumbar
-seems the most potent connection and is usually adjusted for hip-joint
-disease.
-
-_Psoas Magnus Muscles_: Anterior branches of the second and third
-lumbar nerves.
-
-_Anterior Thigh Muscles_: Supplied mostly through the femoral nerve
-from the second and third lumbar nerves.
-
-_Internal Thigh Muscles_: Second and third lumbar nerves (chiefly but
-not wholly) through the obturator, accessory obturator and femoral
-nerves.
-
-_Gluteus Maximus_: From the fifth lumbar and first and second sacral
-nerves through the inferior gluteal branch of the sacral plexus.
-
-_Obturator Externus_: Second, third, and fourth lumbar nerves through
-the obturator nerve.
-
-_Posterior Thigh Muscles_: Fourth and fifth lumbar and sacral nerves
-through the great sciatic.
-
-_Great Sciatic Nerve_: This great nerve, direct continuation of the
-sacral plexus, arises from the fourth and fifth lumbar and first
-three or four sacral nerves and is widely distributed to muscles and
-integument of the lower extremity. Sciatica, or sciatic rheumatism,
-is most commonly relieved by adjustment of fourth or fifth lumbar
-vertebra; but there is a condition commonly diagnosed as sciatica which
-is really a sciatic neuritis and due to vasomotor disturbance affecting
-the blood-supply to the nerve trunk. This responds to adjustment of
-first or second lumbar because the amyelinic fibres which control these
-blood-vessels are derived from lumbar ganglia of the sympathetic.
-
-_Anterior Leg Muscles_: Fourth and fifth lumbar and first sacral nerves
-through the anterior tibial.
-
-_Posterior Leg Region_: Fourth and fifth lumbar and first and second
-sacral through the internal popliteal and posterior tibial.
-
-_Knee-Joint_: This joint receives branches from the great sciatic
-through both internal and external popliteal, and from the femoral
-and obturator. It is therefore connected with the lower lumbar and
-sacrum and with the second lumbar. The latter connection seems oftenest
-involved in knee joint inflammations.
-
-_Foot_: Fourth and fifth lumbar and sacral nerves through the great
-sciatic and its branches.
-
-_Sensor Areas of Lower Extremity_: In general, any given cutaneous area
-receives sensor branches from the nerve which supplies the subjacent
-muscle area. For accurate diagnostic purposes a good chart of sensor
-distribution may be consulted.
-
-
-DISEASES AND ADJUSTMENTS
-
-The appended list includes the diseases with which the profession has
-had experience but is not in any sense a complete list of diseases. It
-is merely intended for quick and handy reference. In obscure cases or
-diseases not mentioned it is suggested that the practitioner carefully
-diagnose the case with reference to the _location_ of the morbid
-process and then refer to Special Nerve Connections to find the nerve
-pathway between the spine and the organ indicated as the seat of the
-disease. Standard works on anatomy and physiology will explain more
-fully the paths and functions of the nerves but information gleaned
-from them must be sought out and pieced together from scattered
-statements and discussions.
-
-
- A
-
- _Disease_ _Adjustment._
- Abscess According to location.
- Accommodative iridoplegia C 3 or 4.
- Acid stomach D 6 or 7.
- Acne D 11 or 12.
- Acoria D 6 or 7.
- Acromegaly C 1 or 2, D 10, 11, or 12.
- Addison’s disease D 10.
- Adenitis According to location.
- Adenoids of pharynx C 2 or 3.
- Adiposis dolorosa D 8 and D 11 or 12.
- Adrenals, tuberculosis of D 10.
- Ageusia C 1 or 2.
- Ague D 4, D 9, D 11 or 12.
- Albuminuria D 10, 11, or 12.
- Albumosuria D 8, D 10, 11 or 12.
- Alcoholism C 1, D 10, 11 or 12.
- Amenorrhoea L 4 or 5.
- Amnesia C 1 or 2.
- Amyosthenia General.
- Amyloid liver D 4.
- Amyloid kidney D 10, 11 or 12.
- Anachlorhydria D 6 or 7.
- Anaemia D 4, D 9 and D 11 or 12.
- Sometimes L 4.
- Anaesthesia, general C 1 or 2.
- Anasarca D 10, 11 or 12.
- Aneurism D 1 or according to location.
- Angina pectoris D 2.
- Aniscoria C 4.
- Anorexia nervosa C 1, D 6 or 7.
- Anosmia C 1 or 2, C 4.
- Anthracosis D 3.
- Anterior poliomyelitis C 3 or 4. local zones for
- permanent paralyses
- following.
- Anuria D 10, 11 or 12. Or L 2 or 4.
- Aortic stenosis D 2.
- Aphasia C 1 or 2.
- Aphonia C 6.
- Aphthous stomatitis C 2.
- Apoplexy C 2, 3.
- Appendicitis L 2.
- Apraxia C 1 or 2.
- Argyll-Robertson pupil C 1 or 2.
- Arrhythmia C 2 or D 2.
- Arteriosclerosis D 10, 11 or 12 and local.
- Arteritis According to location.
- Arthritis According to location.
- Arthritis deformans D 10, 11 or 12 and according to
- location.
- Ascarides L 2 or 3.
- Ascites D 4.
- Asphyxia, gas D 2 or 3, Atlas (First aid only).
- Asthenia To correct disease producing
- same.
- Asthenopia C 4.
- Asthma D 1.
- Ataxia, cerebellar C 1 or 2.
- Ataxia, locomotor General adjustment.
- Athetosis C 1 or 2.
- Atrophic cirrhosis of liver D 4.
- Atrophy According to location.
- Aural discharges C 1, 2, 3 or 4.
-
-
- B
-
- Back, pain in According to location.
- Barber’s itch C 5, D 10, 11 or 12.
- Bell’s palsy C 2, 3 or 4.
- Biliousness D 4.
- Blepharitis C 3 or 4.
- Blepharospasm C 3 or 4.
- Blindness C 1, 2, 3 or 4.
- “Blood poisoning” D 10, 11 or 12 and local.
- Boils D 10, 11 or 12 and according to
- location.
- Bradycardia D 1 or 2, possibly C 2.
- Bright’s disease D 10, 11 or 12.
- Bronchitis D 1.
- Bronchiectasis D 1.
- Broncho-pneumonia D 1, D 3.
-
-
- C
-
- Caked breast D 3.
- Calculi, cystic L 2 or 4.
- Calculi, hepatic D 4.
- Calculi, renal D 10, 11 or 12.
- Cancer No cure.
- Cancrum oris C 2 or 3, D 11 or 12.
- Canker (mouth) C 2.
- Carbuncle According to location.
- Carcinoma No cure.
- Caries of spine According to location. See
- “Prognosis.”
- Cataract C 2, 3, or 4.
- Catarrh, nasal C 4.
- Catarrhal gastritis D 6 or 7.
- Catarrhal stomatitis C 2 or 3.
- Cerebral abscess C 1 or 2.
- Cerebrospinal meningitis C 2.
- Cervical glands, enlargement of Any cervical.
- Cervico-brachial neuralgia C 6.
- Cervico-occipital neuralgia C 1 or 2.
- Chickenpox C 5, D 10, 11 or 12.
- Chills D 5.
- Chlorosis D 4, D 9, D 11 or 12.
- Cholangitis D 4.
- Cholecystitis D 4.
- Cholelithiasis D 4.
- Cholera infantum D 5 or 6, D 10, 11 or 12, L 2.
- Chorea C 1 or 2.
- Chyluria D 8, D 11 or 12.
- Cirrhosis of liver D 4.
- Claw hand C 6 or 7 or D 1.
- Clubfoot L 4 or 5.
- Colic, hepatic D 4.
- Colic, renal D 10, 11 or 12.
- Colitis L 2 or 3.
- Collapse C 1, D 2, and according to
- associated condition.
- Coma According to cause.
- Conjunctivitis C 3 or 4.
- Constipation D 4, D 10, or L 3, 4 or 5.
- Contractures According to location.
- Coryza C 4.
- Coxalgia L 4.
- Cramp According to location.
- Croup C 2 or C 6.
- Cutaneous eruptions D 10, 11 or 12.
- Cyanosis D 2, D 3 or C 2.
- Cystitis L 2 or L 4.
-
-
- D
-
- Deafness, catarrhal C 4.
- Deafness, central C 1 or 2 (P).
- Delirium C 1 or 2.
- Dementia C 1.
- Dengue D 5, D 10, 11 or 12 (P).
- Dentition, disorders of D 6 or 7.
- Diabetes insipidus D 10, 11 or 12.
- Diabetes mellitus D 4, D 8, D 11 or 12.
- Diarrhoea D 10, 11 or L 2, 3.
- Dilatation of heart D 2.
- Diphtheria C 2, C 6 and D 11 or 12.
- Dipsomania C 1 or 2, D 11 or 12.
- Dropsy, abdominal D 4.
- Dropsy, cardiac D 2.
- Dropsy, renal D 10, 11 or 12.
- Duodenal ulcer D 8 or 9.
- Duodenitis D 8 or 9.
- Dysentery L 2, 3, or 4 and D 11 or 12.
- Dysmenorrhoea L 4.
- Dyspepsia D 7.
- Dysphagia C 2 or D 6 or 7 (P).
- Dyspnea D 1 or D 2 or D 3.
- Dysuria L 2 or L 4 or sacrum.
-
-
- E
-
- Earache C 2 or C 4.
- Ecchymoses D 11 or 12.
- Eczema D 11 or 12 and according to
- location.
- Embolism, cerebral C 2 or 3.
- Emphysema D 3.
- Encephalitis C 1, 2 or 3.
- Endocarditis D 2.
- Enlarged glands According to location.
- Enlarged heart D 2.
- Enlarged liver D 4.
- Enlarged tonsils C 2 or 3.
- Enteralgia D 9 or 10, or L 1 or 2.
- Enteritis D 9 or 10, or L 1 or 2.
- Enterocolitis D 9 or 10, or L 1, 2 or 3.
- Enteroptosis D 9, 10, 11 or L 1, 2, 3.
- Enterospasm D 9 or 10, or L 1 or 2.
- Enuresis L 2 or 4.
- Epilepsy C 1 or 2, sometimes L 3.
- Epistaxis C 4.
- Epithelioma No cure.
- Eructations D 6 or 7.
- Eruptions, cutaneous D 11 or 12.
- Erysipelas C 5 and D 11 or 12.
- Exophthalmic goitre C 6 or 7.
-
-
- F
-
- Facial hemiatrophy C 1 or 2.
- Facial paralysis C 1 or 2.
- Faecal obstruction L 2, 3 or 4.
- Fainting D 2.
- False angina C 1 or 2.
- Fatty degeneration of heart D 2.
- Fatty degeneration of liver D 4.
- Fatty infiltration of heart D 2.
- Fatty infiltration of liver D 4.
- Felon C 6 or 7 or D 1.
- Fever D 5. Locate organ of origin.
- Fibroid tumor According to location.
- Follicular tonsilitis C 2 or 3.
-
-
- G
-
- Gallstones D 4.
- Gangrene According to location.
- Gastralgia D 6 or 7.
- Gastrectasia D 6 or 7.
- Gastric neuroses D 6 or 7.
- Gastric ulcer D 6 or 7.
- Gastritis D 6 or 7.
- Gastro-duodenitis D 7 or 8.
- Gastroptosis D 6 or 7.
- Gland, mammary D 3.
- Glaucoma C 2 or 3.
- Gleet L 3 and D 11 or 12.
- Glossitis C 2 or 3.
- Glycosuria D 4 and D 11 or 12.
- Goitre C 6.
- Gonorrhoea L 3.
- Gonnorrhoeal rheumatism D 11 or 12 and L 3.
- Gout D 11 or 12 and L 4.
- Granulated lids C 4 and D 11 or 12.
-
-
- H
-
- Hay fever C 3 or 4.
- Headache, anaemia To correct anaemia.
- Headache, bilious D 4.
- Headache, neuralgic C 1.
- Headache, neurasthenic C 1 or 2.
- Headache, ocular C 2 or C 4.
- Headache, of constipation D 4 or D 9 or 10, or L 4 or 5.
- Headache, toxic Locate toxin-forming organ.
- Headache, uterine L 4 or 5 or sacrum.
- Hematemesis D 6 or 7.
- Hematuria D 10, 11 or 12.
- Hemicrania C 1, 2 or 3.
- Hemiplegia C 2 or 3.
- Hemoptysis D 3.
- Hemorrhoids L 4 or 5 or sacrum.
- Hepatic hyperemia D 4.
- Hepatoptosis D 4.
- Hernia, diaphragmatic C 4 (P).
- Hernia, femoral L 4.
- Hernia, inguinal L 2 or 3.
- Hernia, umbilical D 8.
- Herpes facialis C 4.
- Herpes zoster (shingles) Vertebra above nerve involved.
- Hiccough C 4.
- Hodgkins’ disease General adjustment.
- Hydrocele D 10, 11 or 12 and L 4.
- Hydrocephalus C 2 and D 2.
- Hydronephrosis D 10, 11 or 12.
- Hydropericardium D 2.
- Hydrothorax D 3.
- Hyperaemia According to location.
- Hyperaesthesia, general C 1 or 2.
- Hyperchlorhydria D 6 or 7.
- Hypertrophy According to location.
- Hysteria C 2.
- Hystero-epilepsy C 2.
-
-
- I
-
- Icterus D 4.
- Icterus neonatorum D 4.
- Ileocolitis L 2, 3 or 4.
- Impacted gallstones in ducts D 4.
- Impotence L 3 or sacrum.
- Incontinence of urine L 2 or L 4.
- Incompetency, aortic D 1 or 2.
- Incompetency, mitral D 1 or 2.
- Incompetency, pulmonary D 1 or 2.
- Incompetency, pyloric D 6 or 7.
- Incompetency, tricuspid D 1 or 2.
- Infantile paralysis C 3 or 4 and according to
- location.
- Inflammation, general D 5.
- Inflammation of appendix L 2.
- Inflammation of bladder L 2 or 4.
- Inflammation of bowels D 9 or 10, L 2, 3 or 4.
- Inflammation of bronchi D 1.
- Inflammation of kidneys D 11 or 12.
- Inflammation of larynx C 6.
- Inflammation of lungs D 3.
- Inflammation of meninges C 1 or 2.
- Inflammation of ovaries L 2 or 3.
- Inflammation of pharynx C 2.
- Inflammation of pleurae D 3.
- Inflammation of stomach D 6 or 7.
- Inflammation of vertebrae Next above inflamed one.
- Inflammation of uterus L 4 or 5.
- Influenza C 4, D 1, D 11 or 12.
- Intestinal neuralgia D 9 or 10, L 1 or 2.
- Intestinal neuroses D 9 or 10, L 1 or 2.
- Intestinal obstruction See “Practice.”
- Intussusception See “Practice.”
- Insanity C 1 or 2, sometimes L 4.
- Insomnia C 2.
- Iritis C 3 or 4.
-
-
- J
-
- Jaundice D 4.
-
-
- K
-
- Keratitis C 3 or 4.
- Kyphosis See “Curvatures.”
-
-
- L
-
- Lactation, disorders of D 3.
- Lacunar tonsilitis C 2 or 3.
- La grippe C 4, D 1, D 11 or 12.
- Laryngeal paralysis C 6.
- Laryngismus stridulus C 6.
- Laryngitis C 6.
- Lateral spinal sclerosis According to location.
- Lead poisoning D 4, D 11 or 12.
- Leucaemia D 9 and D 11 or 12.
- Leucorrhoea L 4.
- Lipoma According to location.
- Lobar pneumonia D 3.
- Lockjaw C 1, 2, or 3.
- Locomotor ataxia General adjustment.
- Lordosis See “Curvatures.”
- Lumbago L 3, 4 or 5.
- Lumbo-abdominal neuralgia Any Lumbar.
-
-
- M
-
- Malaria D 4, D 9, and D 11 or 12.
- Malignant endocarditis D 2 and D 5 or 6.
- Mastoiditis C 1 or 2.
- Measles C 5, D 11 or 12.
- Memory, disorders of C 1 or 2.
- Meniere’s disease C 1 or 2.
- Meningitis C 1 or 2.
- Menorrhagia L 4.
- Metrorrhagia L 4.
- Migraine C 1, 2, or 3.
- Mitral incompetency D 2.
- Mitral stenosis D 2.
- Monoplegia According to location.
- Mouth breathing C 4 or 5.
- Movable kidney D 11 or 12.
- Mucous colic D 10 or L 3.
- Mumps C 4.
- Mutism C 1 or 2 or C 6.
- Myelitis According to location.
- Myocarditis D 2.
- Myopia C 4.
- Myositis ossificans According to location, also
- D 11 or 12.
- Myxoedema C 6.
-
-
- N
-
- Nephritis D 10, 11 or 12.
- Nephrolithiasis D 10, 11 or 12.
- Nephroptosis D 10, 11 or 12.
- Neuralgia, trigeminal C 3 or 4.
- Neuralgia, brachial C 6 or 7 or D 1.
- Neuralgia, intercostal According to location.
- Neuralgia, of feet L 4, L 5 or sacrum.
- Neurasthenia C 2.
- Neuritis According to location.
- Nodding spasm C 1 or 2.
- Nystagmus C 1, 2, 3 or 4 (P).
-
-
- O
-
- Obesity, pathological D 8 and D 11 or 12.
- Obstruction, intestinal See “Practice.”
- Oculomotor paralysis C 2 or 3.
- Oedema According to location.
- Optic atrophy C 3 or 4.
- Optic neuritis C 3 or 4.
- Orchitis L 3.
- Otitis media C 4.
- Ovarian disease L 2.
-
-
- P
-
- Pachymeningitis C 2.
- Pallor D 2 or to correct anaemia.
- Palpitation D 2 or C 2.
- Pancreatic calculi D 8.
- Pancreatic hemorrhage D 8.
- Pancreatitis D 8.
- Paralysis agitans C 1 or 2.
- Paralysis, brachial C 6 or 7 or D 1.
- Paralysis, crural L 4 or L 5.
- Paralysis, facial C 1 or 2.
- Paralysis, diplegic C 1 or 2.
- Paralysis, hemiplegic C 1 or 2.
- Paralysis, monoplegic According to location.
- Paralysis, sensory According to location.
- Parageusia C 1 or 2.
- Paratyphoid fever L 2.
- Parosmia C 2 or 3.
- Parotitis C 4.
- Pericarditis D 2.
- Perihepatitis D 4.
- Perinephric abscess D 10, 11 or 12.
- Peritonitis D 9, 10 and L 2, 3 or 4.
- Pertussis C 6, D 1.
- Pharyngitis C 2 or 3.
- Photophobia C 1 or 2 or C 4.
- Plantar neuralgia L 4 or 5.
- Pleurisy D 3.
- Pleurodynia D 3.
- Pneumonia D 3.
- Priapism L 3 or sacrum.
- Proctitis L 4 or 5.
- Prolapsed kidney D 11 or 12.
- Prolapsed uterus L 4 or 5.
- Prostatic disease L 4 or 5 or sacrum.
- Ptosis C 4.
- Puerperal fever L 4, D 5, and D 11 or 12.
- Pulmonary incompetence D 2.
- Pulmonary phthisis D 3.
- Pulmonary stenosis D 2.
- Pyelitis D 11 or 12.
- Pyelonephrosis D 11 or 12.
- Pyaemia D 5 or 6 and D 10, 11 or 12.
-
-
- Q
-
- Quinsy C 2 or 3.
-
-
- R
-
- Rabies C 1 or 2, D 10, 11 or 12.
- Rachitis See “Adjustment of Curvatures.”
- Raynaud’s disease C 6 or 7 or D 1, or L 4 or 5.
- Rectal fistula L 4 or 5.
- Rectal neuralgia L 4 or 5.
- Relapsing fever D 5, D 9 and D 11 or 12.
- Renal colic D 10, 11 or 12.
- Retinal hemorrhage C 4.
- Retinitis C 4.
- Retropharyngeal abscess C 2 or 3.
- Rheumatic fever D 5 or 6, D 11 or 12.
- Rheumatism D 11 or 12 and according to
- location.
- Rhinitis C 4.
- Roseola D 10, 11 or 12.
- Rubella C 5, D 6, D 11 or 12.
- Rubeola See “Measles.”
-
-
- S
-
- Salivation C 2, 3 or 4.
- Salpingitis (Eustachian) C 4.
- Salpingitis (Fallopian) L 2.
- Sarcoma No cure.
- Scarlatina C 5, D 6, D 11 or 12.
- Scarlet fever C 5, D 6, D 11 or 12.
- Sciatica L 4 or 5, or sacrum.
- Sclerosis According to location.
- Scoliosis See “Curvatures.”
- Scrofula D 11 or 12 and locally.
- Seminal emissions L 3.
- Septicaemia D 5, D 11 or 12, and for site
- of entrance of toxins.
- Smallpox C 5, D 5, D 10, 11 or 12.
- Sneezing C 4.
- Softening of brain C 2.
- Spasm According to location.
- Spermatorrhoea L 3.
- Splanchnoptosis Caudad of D 5 according to
- palpation.
- Splenic enlargement D 9.
- Splenitis D 9.
- Splenoptosis D 9.
- Spondylitis Deformans General adjustment.
- Stenosis According to location.
- Stomatitis C 2, 3 or 4.
- Strabismus C 3 or 4.
- Sudamina D 10, 11 or 12.
- Sunstroke C 2, D 2, D 11 or 12.
- Suppression of urine D 11 or 12.
- Syncope D 2.
- Syphilis, primary According to location of ulcer.
- Syphilis, secondary D 5 or 6, D 11 or 12.
- Syphilis, tertiary No cure.
-
-
- T
-
- Tabes dorsalis General adjustment.
- Tapeworm D 8, 9 or 10, L 2 or 3.
- Tenesmus L 4 or 5.
- Tension, high arterial D 5.
- Testicles, pendulous L 3.
- Tetanus C 4, D 5, D 10, 11 or 12.
- Thrush C 2 or 3.
- Tic dolouroux C 3 or 4.
- Tinnitus aurium C 1 or 2.
- Tonsilitis C 2 or 3.
- Toothache C 4.
- Torticollis C 2, 3 or 4.
- Toxaemia D 11 or 12 and local according
- to indications.
- Toxic gastritis D 6 or 7.
- Tricuspid incompetency D 2.
- Tricuspid stenosis D 2.
- Trigeminal neuralgia C 3 or 4.
- Tuberculosis of any organ See “Special Nerve Connections”
- to organ diseased.
- Tuberculosis, general D 5 or 6, D 11 or 12.
- Tuberculosis, pulmonary D 3.
- Tumor According to location.
- Typhoid fever L 2.
- Typhus fever D 5 and L 2 (P).
-
-
- U
-
- Ulceration According to location.
- Ulnar neuritis D 1.
- Ununited fracture According to location.
- Uraemia D 10, 11 or 12.
- Urethritis L 3.
- Urticaria D 10, 11 or 12.
- Uterine catarrh L 4.
- Uteroversion L 4.
-
-
- V
-
- Vaccinia D 5, D 10, 11 or 12 and for
- site of inoculation.
- Vaginitis L 3.
- Valvular lesions D 2.
- Varicella D 5 or 6, D 10, 11 or 12.
- Varicocele L 3.
- Varicose veins of lower extremities L 2, 3 or 4.
- Variola Same as Smallpox.
- Varioloid Same as Smallpox.
- Vertigo C 1 or 2. Locally for toxic
- vertigo.
- Vomiting, pernicious D 6 or 7 or C 1.
-
-
- W
-
- Whooping-cough C 6, D 1.
- Writer’s Cramp C 6 or 7 or D 1.
- Worms, stomach D 6 or 7.
- Worms, intestinal Any Lumbar.
- Wryneck C 2, 3 or 4.
-
-
- X
-
- Xerostomia C 2.
-
-
- Y
-
- Yellow fever D 4, D 6, D 10, 11 or 12 (P).
-
-
-CONCLUSION
-
-The correct use of the foregoing table depends entirely upon correct
-diagnosis. Knowledge of the vertebra to be adjusted for the correction
-of any disease is useless unless the disease be recognized when met.
-Diagnosis may be, and usually is, aided by Palpation and Nerve-Tracing,
-which may be considered as divisions of diagnosis since the subluxation
-and the tender nerve are evidences (symptoms) of disease. But these
-two divisions can never wholly take the place of a complete diagnosis
-which calls to the aid of the examiner _every_ harmless method of
-ascertaining the patient’s condition. The part may not suffice for the
-whole.
-
-The Chiropractor has an opportunity to become the best of
-diagnosticians because he has at his command all the usually taught
-methods and _in addition_ Palpation and Nerve-Tracing, which are
-especially useful in differential diagnosis. (See “Schedule of
-Examination.”) The profession is at present lamentably weak in
-diagnosis and as long as they remain so they will fail to achieve the
-possible maximum of results from the application of a theory which,
-_per se_, is applicable to all disease but which is often imperfectly
-applied in practice.
-
-
-
-
-PRACTICE
-
-
-Introduction
-
-The ensuing section is intended rather more for the use of the
-practitioner than for the guidance of the student but may furnish the
-student a preconception which will prepare him somewhat, before leaving
-college, to meet the problems of practice.
-
-Just as too frequently the young Chiropractor overlooks the fundamental
-logic of Chiropractic which may be epitomized with the terse command,
-“Adjust the _cause_,” and considers his practice as requiring him to
-dabble in every suggested or discovered method of treating _effects_,
-so, too frequently, the young Chiropractor is prone to consider that
-his practice consists solely of the adjustment of vertebrae, that he
-practices a mechanic art rather than a profession; too frequently
-he overlooks the thousand details which lead to and surround the
-adjustment and are essential to its success.
-
-The practice of Chiropractic involves more than correct technic. It
-includes the use of a vast fund of knowledge; the constant study of
-diseases and of patients; the art of controlling and directing others
-sometimes in their very trivial acts. Successful practice requires a
-proper setting, proper business methods, and a knowledge of psychology.
-
-Anyone entering upon a profession assumes a great moral responsibility
-and the greatest responsibility of all falls upon the doctor, of
-whatever school. He enters the stricken home at a time when all members
-of the household are off guard, as it were, at a time when all turn
-to him as to one of higher knowledge and of greater power for their
-guidance and often for their strength in affliction; he becomes the
-repository of their most sacred confidences. He who is unable to meet
-this responsibility, to realize his influence and his power and to
-prepare himself with care and conscientious training to acquit himself
-well, has mistaken his calling. He is unfit for his ministry.
-
-The thorough student wrestles not alone with the technic and the
-text-book branches necessary in practice but also studies his
-profession from every possible standpoint, broadening his field of
-usefulness wherever possible.
-
-This section does not by any means contain all the information not
-found elsewhere in this book but necessary to the Chiropractor in his
-practice. It is intended merely to suggest some of the many sides and
-phases of our work and to open the way for a life study of humanity and
-of professional life as a Chiropractor.
-
-
-OFFICE EQUIPMENT
-
-
-Value of First Appearance
-
-The patient, upon first entering an office, consciously or
-unconsciously forms an estimate of the personality and standing in his
-profession of the occupant of that office. This impression is gathered
-from the kind and arrangement of the furniture and visible equipment,
-from the neatness or disorder of the room, from countless little things
-which play each their part in making up the whole appearance. This
-first estimate is sometimes the only one, for an unfavorable first
-impression may lead to the loss of a prospective patient. In any case
-it will play a part in all subsequent judgments which the patient may
-form concerning the Chiropractor and his work.
-
-Many patients entering our offices have no previous knowledge of our
-profession; their minds are open and curious, alert for new impressions
-of some sort. We may impress them as we choose. Every good business
-or professional man realizes the value of the first impression and
-strives for a good one. Therefore, upon entering practice, choose for
-yourself every article which shall have a place in your office. Your
-surroundings will then truly reflect your personality and will attract
-those upon whom that personality can work in harmony and understanding.
-It is of no avail to attract the type of patients you cannot hold, to
-draw through the borrowed judgment or taste of another surroundings
-alien to yourself and thus to attract people who will at once sense the
-incongruity and be repelled by it.
-
-Yet one may aspire. And if you are able to perceive and appreciate
-truly professional surroundings you may hope to school yourself by
-association and study to harmonize with them.
-
-
-Choice of Articles
-
-In choosing the contents of your office keep in mind good taste,
-utility, and the psychological effect upon all visitors. Remember
-that you expect to spend many hours each day in the company of your
-furniture, and select such things as will contribute to a proper
-professional state of mind in yourself. A Chiropractor’s profession is
-in many ways like, yet in many ways unlike, any other. Therefore his
-office equipment, while following in general the equipment of other
-professional offices, must be selected with an eye to the special and
-particular needs of the Chiropractor and his patients. Too little
-attention has been paid thus far by the profession to the selection of
-office equipment.
-
-
-Furniture in General
-
-The furnishing of an office depends upon the amount and disposition
-of the room at your command. One must have at least a waiting room
-and a private office even if a single rented room must be cheaply
-partitioned to make the division. A larger suite is a better investment
-when possible. In the waiting-room should be found easy chairs, library
-table, hall-rack, mirror, and an easy divan or couch. The floor should
-be covered with a good rug or carpet and the walls properly and cleanly
-decorated and hung with restful, pleasant pictures. A book-case filled
-with carefully selected books is a good addition.
-
-On entering your private office the patient should see your diploma,
-which hangs in full view of the entrance and which bespeaks with no
-weak voice your fitness to practice, your professional ability. The
-importance of this point cannot be overestimated. The intelligent
-visitor expects you to have had careful training and to possess
-thorough knowledge of your work. If he notes the diploma as evidence of
-it and of your pride in your college he is assured.
-
-If only two rooms are at your command the second must be at once
-consulting room, adjusting room, dressing room. As such it should
-contain your desk, desk chair, chairs for the patient or patients,
-adjusting table or tables, towel cabinet, lavatory, and a curtained
-recess for a dressing-table, chair, and hooks for hanging clothing.
-On the wall hang those charts from which it is at times necessary to
-explain a part of the human mechanism to the inquirer.
-
-This room should convey a two-fold impression--business and
-professional. It should contain the special paraphenalia of your
-profession and some of the suggestive contents of the ordinary business
-office, such as desk, card-index file, typewriter, etc.
-
-Let us consider these points more in detail.
-
-
-Waiting Room
-
-In your waiting room new patients wait and form their estimate of you
-before your appearance. They are tired patients, worn perhaps with
-years of disease, and their comfort must be considered. Some time
-is theirs for use in some way and the use of their minds during the
-waiting interval must be studied.
-
-For these reasons first of all the waiting room should be furnished
-quietly, in perfect taste, but _well furnished_. A good dark rug
-for the floor rather than matting or linoleum with their suggestion
-of bareness, a tinted or papered wall done in a soothing shade,
-upholstered furniture pleasing to the eye and comfortable for tired,
-weak bodies, and a library table with proper literature for the
-occupation of the mind--these are the proper furnishings for a waiting
-room.
-
-Let the table contain chiefly Chiropractic literature and select that
-literature with care. Be sure that it reflects the view-point toward
-your profession with which you wish your patients to be impressed. It
-must be scientific, well written, not sensational, not dealing coarsely
-or vulgarly with the revolting diseases or features of disease, but
-quietly convincing. Your literature must impress with the greatness
-of Chiropractic without setting forth extravagant claims which your
-patients will expect you to vindicate. Your selection of books for the
-book-case must convince all observers of your proper literary taste or
-the book-case had better be omitted. Likewise the pictures on the walls
-must suggest pleasant things, restful things, good to contemplate.
-
-When possible secure a high-ceilinged room with good ventilation,
-plenty of fresh air without drafts. And then let all the articles in
-the room _harmonize_. One jarring note in form or color may mar the
-entire effect, which should be that of comfortable simplicity.
-
-
-Private Office
-
-Even more important than the contents of the waiting room is the
-equipment of your private office. It is in this room that your work is
-done. There your patients confide to you their weaknesses; there they
-determine finally whether to trust themselves to your knowledge and
-skill; in that room they form their judgment as to your cleanliness,
-your use of system; _there they meet you_.
-
-
-Arrangement of Furniture
-
-Every bit of furniture for the private office having been carefully
-selected its _arrangement_ should be studied.
-
-When the patient first enters the private office he should be able
-to see your diploma. He should also sit where he can notice it as
-he consults you and every other object within his vision during the
-consultation should be picked so as to avoid attracting his attention
-to anything foreign to his visit and its purpose.
-
-Two chairs are placed near the desk, one an easy chair for
-yourself, a revolving chair being preferable, and a straight-backed
-leather-upholstered chair for the patient. In placing these chairs be
-careful of two things: let the strongest light shine over your own
-shoulder and bring the face of the patient out in clear detail; and let
-your own chair be _higher_ than the patient’s so that he looks slightly
-upward to meet your direct gaze. For the last mentioned point there
-is a sound psychological reason; to control any dialogue with another
-person place yourself on a higher level than he and unconsciously he
-will obey the suggestion and lift his thought to meet yours, offering
-it rather than commanding with it. The light is arranged for its value
-in observing, as a matter of diagnosis, every indication in expression,
-gesture, and skin coloring.
-
-Hanging back of the desk where it may be easily reached but where its
-gruesome suggestion will not obtrude itself upon the nerves of the
-sensitive without your deliberate intention, have a vertebral column
-for demonstration purposes. There are many times when it is necessary
-to show a subluxation as it would occur.
-
-Beside the desk and within easy reach of your hand should be placed at
-least a single book-case section containing those reference works which
-you frequently consult. The contents of this section will be considered
-later; suffice now to say that they should be well bound and should
-be so placed that if a doubtful point arise they can be consulted at
-once without your rising. I am not of the opinion that a pretension of
-unlimited knowledge is a valuable professional asset. It seems better
-frankly to seek authoritative information, even in the presence of
-the patient, than to allow an error to creep into your work, and your
-more intelligent patients will appreciate your care. Furthermore, this
-placing of your books is convenient when you are alone and considering
-the cases which have passed before you during the day. It tempts to
-study.
-
-The desk should hold a typewriter, significant of business methods,
-and a card file for case records. Incidentally, you should have neat
-bill-heads and printed stationery for all correspondence, though blank
-white paper is better than over-ornate design or profuse coloring.
-
-On the wall hang a few good anatomical and physiological charts upon
-which may be pointed out certain facts for the instruction of patients.
-It may be suggested that these hang on racks so that the surface charts
-may be easily changeable and that those ordinarily exposed to view be
-such as will avoid unpleasant suggestion of any kind. For instance, an
-X-Ray chart of the body showing the skeleton is but one degree less
-repugnant to the average person than the bones themselves. Though your
-college training has robbed the subject of all emotion, for _you_, take
-thought for the feelings of your visitors.
-
-
-Adjusting Tables
-
-For all purposes the best type of bench now on the market is probably
-that composed of two sections, one fixed and the other--the rear
-one--sliding on a track. Both sections should be adjustable at various
-angles to the plane of the base and some of the best tables are made so
-as to permit changes in the distance from the floor to the entire top
-or to any part of the top, a great advantage in that the table height
-may thus be made to suit the height of the adjuster.
-
-An abdominal support is now indispensable but must be so elastic as not
-to interfere with the adjustment. Leather upholstery is more sanitary
-than plush and has come into general use.
-
-An opening in the front section such that the face may look downward
-through it and straighten the cervical and upper dorsal spine for
-palpation and adjustment has been proven a disadvantage instead of a
-help and will be entirely unnecessary to one who follows the technic
-laid down in this book.
-
-
-The Roll
-
-A desirable addition to this table is an upholstered roll of quite
-solid material and about eight inches in diameter. This can be placed
-under the patient’s thighs on the rear section, thus elevating the
-thighs and straightening the Lumbar region so as to separate the
-spinous processes. The roll is especially useful for the adjustment of
-posterior Lumbar subluxations, being inadvisable with rotation.
-
-With a patient lying on the bifid bench in the ordinary adjusting
-position the Lumbar spinous processes are crowded together and the
-bodies separated. In rotation, since the adjustment works by using
-a short power arm against a long weight arm (distance from contact
-point to center of rotation against distance from center of rotation
-to anterior margin of body), and since the heaviest portion of the
-vertebra--the body--is to be moved most, this position of suspension
-secures the easiest adjustment. But if the vertebra be posterior and a
-spinous process contact is used the best adjustment can be secured over
-the roll or with a table adjustable to an angle equal to that which
-would be secured with the roll.
-
-
-Cleanliness
-
-Everything in the office should be kept scrupulously clean. A lavatory
-with towel racks well filled with clean towels is an absolute
-necessity. If no lavatory is inbuilt in the office a portable one may
-be secured which will answer every purpose. It will be well if the
-patient observes that you carefully cleanse your hands before giving an
-adjustment.
-
-The office should contain a towel cabinet with a stack of clean towels
-and a compartment for used towels. Or tissue towels may be used to
-save laundry bills. Before each adjustment a clean towel should be
-unfolded and placed upon the front section of the bench so that the
-patient rests head and face upon a perfectly clean surface. When the
-adjustment is completed toss the towel into the used-towel compartment.
-This use of towels minimizes the risk of contagion or infection from
-a germ-infested upholstery, suggests care and cleanliness to your
-patient, and gives the patient greater trust in you.
-
-
-Dressing-room
-
-A curtained recess separated by a screen from the remainder of the room
-will serve if no separate room is available for a dressing-room. It is
-better, if possible, to have a separate dressing-room and better still
-to have separate dressing-rooms for men and women. If extra rooms are
-not at your command and you use a curtained recess be sure that it
-contains good light, a dressing-table with mirror, a small chair, and
-hooks for clothing. Provide also a few dressing-sacks for women though
-most of them will prefer to furnish their own.
-
-
-The Rest Room
-
-It is a known fact that the patient who can be kept in a quiet,
-restful, and relaxed state for some time following the adjustment
-derives the greatest benefit therefrom. Having loosened subluxated
-vertebrae by adjustment their tendency is to settle in their old
-abnormal position and every movement of the patient for a time aids
-this tendency. Quiet permits adaptation of surrounding tissues to the
-changed position of the vertebra; action facilitates the re-adaptation
-of the vertebra to the state of surrounding tissues.
-
-If possible a special room should be provided in which patients may lie
-down in comfort for twenty or thirty minutes following an adjustment.
-If more than one patient at a time is to rest, separate rooms should be
-provided for men and women. The rest rooms should have high ceilings
-and excellent ventilation without drafts. The floors should be carpeted
-so as to soften footfalls and suggest quiet and rest. Potted plants
-adorn such a room very well and always afford a pleasant suggestion.
-
-The patients lie on cots, foldable for convenience when not in use, and
-should lie on their backs as quietly as possible. Some prefer solid
-cots on rollers so that the cot may be noiselessly rolled beside the
-adjusting table after the adjustment, the patient may by one turn move
-himself upon it, and it may then be gently rolled into the rest room.
-This is a more finished, if more expensive, handling of the problem.
-
-It may be well to furnish some occupation for the mind and to this
-end, since reading in such a position is injurious to the eyes, a good
-phonograph is a valuable addition. Equip it with a soft parlor needle
-and select only soothing, restful music. Just as you would avoid doing
-the walls of the rest room in striking or garish colors, exciting to
-a diseased mind, so avoid exciting or harsh music. The object of this
-room is _rest_ for mind and body. Let every thought be directed to that
-end. With some patients the use of the phonograph or other amusement
-must be avoided. Study your cases with care.
-
-The trip to the Chiropractor’s office is too often regarded in the
-light of an unpleasant necessity. If proper care be used in equipping
-an office and if such means as have been suggested for the rest room
-be employed, these in addition to the pleasing personality of the
-Chiropractor may make of the visit a pleasant thing, a part of the day
-to be anticipated with eagerness.
-
-
-A Complete Suite
-
-The number of rooms in a perfectly convenient suite depends upon the
-approximate number of cases to be handled daily. If it is needful to
-economize the practitioner’s time a greater number of rooms will be
-required than would be desirable with a small practice.
-
-A waiting room, a consulting room, two or more adjusting rooms, and
-two rest rooms make probably the best number and employment of rooms.
-It is desirable if possible that the adjusting room be used for that
-purpose only and that there be separate rooms for men and women. Each
-adjusting room can then have its own dressing room or recess. Or in
-addition to the other rooms named above there may be many small rooms
-each containing an adjusting table and a rest cot and each serving as
-the rest room after the adjustment. If a sufficient number be provided
-as many patients can be handled in this way as time permits, the
-practitioner need lose no time at all, and each patient may have a room
-entirely to himself throughout his visit.
-
-
-Reference Library
-
-This should consist of those standard works to which you will
-necessarily refer most often. Gray, Morris, or other standard
-anatomical authority, Brubaker’s or Haliburton’s physiology, Butler or
-Osier on diagnosis, Delafield and Prudden on pathology, Morat on the
-physiology of the nervous system, Bing on regional diagnosis of nerve
-lesions, one or two good works on psychology, gynecology, histology,
-etc., a good medical dictionary, and any books on Chiropractic in which
-you have confidence make up an excellent list. Any standard works
-will suffice and this list is merely suggested for those who may be
-uncertain as to their own tastes. Always examine a book before buying
-it, even those named above. Next to works on Chiropractic no single
-book is as necessary or useful as a good medical dictionary, preferably
-a large and complete one.
-
-
-Door Sign
-
-Your door should bear a sign in gold or black, setting forth your name
-and business and perhaps your office hours. It may read, “W. R. Jones,
-Chiropractor,” or, “Jones & Jones, Chiropractors,” with office hours
-appended. Avoid repetitions such as “Dr. W. R. Jones, Chiropractor,” or
-“W. R. Jones, D. C., Chiropractor.”
-
-
-Advertising
-
-The word of a satisfied patient to his friend is the best
-advertisement. Beyond this, considerable diversity of opinion exists as
-to what constitutes proper, ethical, and wise advertising. I shall make
-no attempt to settle this question but shall simply suggest that while
-it is undoubtedly necessary often to explain to the public through
-various avenues what Chiropractic is and what it can do it is wise to
-be as reserved and dignified as possible and to avoid offense to any.
-Thus it is clearly unwise to advertise that your competitor is a fraud,
-much wiser to convince your readers by the logic and strength of your
-statements that _you_ are not. Consider good taste and avoid unpleasant
-references to loathsome or vulgar diseases. Such advertising is
-associated in the public mind with quackery, with patent medicines and
-medical institutes, and no matter how sincere and right your motives
-may be it will be misinterpreted by those you wish to reach.
-
-Consider also the legal side of advertising. Study the laws of your
-state and avoid any statement which will conflict with the law. In some
-states it is illegal to advertise with the term “Dr.” unless you hold a
-medical license. In others to advertise to “treat,” “cure,” or “heal”
-disease is to practice medicine technically. Such statements miss the
-truth, in any case, because the Chiropractor administers an adjustment
-and not a treatment and because Nature alone can cure or heal.
-
-
-Collection Cards
-
-Different communities respond to different collection methods. With
-one class of patients it may be better never to mention fees except to
-answer inquiry and simply to submit monthly statements of account to
-all patients. With another it is necessary to charge in advance. More
-Chiropractors use this method than any other and many use cards for the
-purpose.
-
-These cards are best printed with name, address, telephone number,
-etc., on one side and on the other six or twelve spaces ruled off at
-one end for punching to indicate adjustments given, and the words,
-“Good for six (or twelve) Chiropractic adjustments at (office)
-(residence) when properly countersigned.” A line should be left below
-for your signature and at the bottom the price of the card should be
-printed plainly. If desired a space may be left for the patient’s name
-so that the card may be made non-transferable.
-
-The card is issued at the beginning of a course of adjustments and
-a duplicate is kept on file. Each time the patient is adjusted he
-presents his card before leaving and one space is punched out. By this
-system both the patient and the adjuster may know exactly the number of
-adjustments given and accounts may be easily kept. Without it, a book
-entry of some sort must be made for every adjustment.
-
-The best thing about this system is that it reminds the patient that
-you expect to be paid in advance without the necessity of your saying
-so, since the words “in advance” follow the statement of price on
-the card. At the time of payment you give him, as a receipt, a card
-entitling him to a certain amount of your service at a stipulated place.
-
-
-Schedule of Examination
-
-This method of procedure for the investigation of new cases is
-offered as a suggestion to be followed as far as the education of
-the Chiropractor will permit. If every practitioner adopts some such
-method of making his own diagnoses he will advance in ability much
-more rapidly than by accepting the diagnoses given his patients by
-physicians or others. We should remember, though without arrogance,
-that our special ability to discover subluxations and our knowledge
-of their significance as the primary causes of disease renders us
-better prepared for correct diagnosis than our medical friends, other
-education being equal.
-
-It should be quite obvious that in attempting the accomplishment of
-any object it is necessary first to have in mind a clear preconception
-of the things to be accomplished, and second, to have a clear and
-concise, yet complete, outline of the steps to be taken, their order or
-sequence, and their relative importance in the accomplishment. These
-two needs, as regards a Chiropractic diagnosis, we shall endeavor to
-supply in this section.
-
-Chiropractic Diagnosis properly consists of three parts, Vertebral
-Palpation, Nerve-Tracing, and Symptomatology, together with the
-reasoning necessary to properly weigh and summarize the facts
-ascertained. Of these three divisions two fall properly under the head
-of Physical Diagnosis and the third, symptomatology, should consist
-principally of physical diagnosis.
-
-Everywhere the physical or objective sign is given preference over the
-subjective symptom. Before a single question is asked of the patient
-relative to the case or its history, every other means of obtaining
-information properly coming under the head of a Chiropractic diagnosis
-should be utilized. The questions should come last and be very few and
-direct. They should serve only to illuminate the few remaining doubtful
-points in the mind of the examiner, points which perhaps exist only
-because of some fault or weakness in his methods of examination.
-
-The proper order of examination is as follows:
-
-1. General Observation.
-
-2. Vertebral Palpation.
-
-3. Nerve Tracing.
-
-4. Special Examination.
-
-5. History of Case.
-
-6. Summary.
-
-
-General Observation
-
-Observation of the patient with a view to determining any signs of
-disease should begin with the moment the patient steps into the office.
-It should continue during your conversation and during the Vertebral
-Palpation and Nerve Tracing which follow. The mind of the examiner
-should be constantly on the alert to note any sign on any exposed part
-of the patient’s body, or any motion which may betray the nature of the
-disease or diseases with which he suffers.
-
-Before preparing the patient for palpation observe temperament,
-position and carriage of head, body, and limbs, and facies.
-
-Ask male patients to strip to the waist and female patients to remove
-all clothing down to the waist except a loose gown or kimono, which
-is worn reversed so that it opens behind and exposes the spine to
-direct examination. No greater error can be committed than to attempt
-examination of the vertebral column through clothing or other covering.
-Examine with patient seated on a bench or stool with feet evenly placed
-upon the floor. If the patient is for any reason unable to assume this
-position the examination may be varied somewhat.
-
-While in this position continue observation of points mentioned above
-and observe also condition of skin, whether abnormal in color,
-moisture or nutrition, or whether there is flushing, cyanosis, or
-pallor, roughness, eruption, etc.; the condition of bones and joints
-other than vertebral; general emaciation or obesity, local malnutrition
-or hypertrophy; evidences of operation, scars etc.; and action of
-muscles more in detail than is indicated under position and carriage of
-parts.
-
-Having observed these things discontinue general observation and all
-other considerations for the time in favor of Vertebral Palpation.
-
-
-Vertebral Palpation
-
-The primary object of Vertebral Palpation is the location of
-subluxations, or partial displacements, and the determination of the
-relative degree and direction of those found. Next comes the recording
-of subluxations in such a manner that a perusal of your record will
-enable you to reconstruct at any time a mental picture of the spine, as
-far as possible. (See Record.) With the making of the record the proper
-form of adjustment for the correction of each subluxation is decided.
-
-Finally, by _failing_ to find subluxation in certain segments you may
-safely eliminate those segments from consideration and confine your
-further attention to the remainder. (See Spino-Organic Connection.) It
-must be borne in mind that while the finding of a subluxation is not
-always positive evidence of the necessity for adjustment there, the
-_absence_ of subluxation of any spinal segment is proof positive that
-no disease exists in the corresponding somatic segment. Differential
-diagnosis is thus often greatly aided by palpation.
-
-
-Nerve Tracing
-
-Having thus narrowed the field of operation, trace from spine to
-periphery every nerve tender enough to be traced, noting the relation
-of the tender nerves to the subluxations already found by palpation.
-Whenever it is possible note the _degree_ of tenderness of the various
-nerves and keep in mind through the remainder of the examination the
-fact that greater tenderness in some one segment indicated either
-greater or more acute disease in that segment.
-
-It is best to use great caution about entirely eliminating any segment
-from consideration because of negative findings in attempted nerve
-tracing. The fact that no nerve is traceable is not always proof that
-no impingement exists, but only that no _irritation_ exists. Only light
-or acute impingement may irritate a nerve. In forty, and possibly
-fifty, per cent of all cases no nerves are traceable at any time. (See
-Nerve-Tracing.)
-
-
-Special Examination
-
-The examiner has by this time formed some concept of the case in
-hand. He has a clue to the possible nature of the disease and he has
-narrowed his observation to a few segments of the body or a few organs
-which demand a more special examination. This may be accomplished by
-Inspection, Palpation, Auscultation, and Percussion.
-
-
-History of Case
-
-Having determined by these methods every fact possible of determination
-without information from the patient, it becomes necessary to go
-somewhat into the history of the case. The history of falls, jars,
-shocks, or injuries of any kind should be taken first and these should
-be viewed in the light of their bearing upon the previously ascertained
-condition of the spine. Sometimes the definite history of an accident
-immediately preceding the development of disease symptoms suggests its
-connection with the disease and the exact nature of the accident points
-out to us some one of the several recorded subluxations as the one
-involved. This in turn may aid a doubtful differential diagnosis. Each
-step in the process of examination helps to explain and clarify the
-facts elicited by other steps until the facts marshal themselves into a
-complete and comprehensible picture.
-
-At this point it will be possible to stop in some cases and rest upon
-the evidence gathered. If you are able at this time to state clearly
-the nature of the case, the manner of its cause, the site of disease
-and of the subluxations causing it, the kind of subluxations, and
-the chance of recovery under adjustment, it is preferable to do so.
-You will thus have made a complete diagnosis without recourse to
-information from the patient except the history of injuries.
-
-Sometimes, however, it will be necessary to go further into the case
-and ascertain the presence and nature of subjective symptoms. If this
-be necessary, the examiner should confine his questions to the parts
-indicated as diseased, and thus limit the number of questions and make
-them all direct and essential. It is important to avoid trivial or
-irrelevant questioning.
-
-
-Summary
-
-Finally, having ascertained all necessary facts, mentally summarize
-them all, combining the results of Palpation, Nerve-Tracing, and
-Symptomatology so as to reach a definite conclusion as to the location
-and nature of the morbid process, the subluxation producing it, and the
-exact form of adjustment necessary to correct it.
-
-The examiner should be able at the end of the examination to state
-exactly what he finds to be the condition of the patient, to give
-reasons and nerve connections, and to demonstrate a subluxation to back
-every statement.
-
-The case record should contain all essential information relating to
-the diagnosis and the correction to be applied.
-
-
-Necessity for Correct Diagnosis
-
-Diagnosis, in a restricted sense, means merely the naming of diseases.
-But in the broader and more proper sense it means disease knowing and
-includes a knowledge of the causal factors, the location and nature
-of disease, the amount of damage to structure and of functional
-disturbance, and the probable duration and outcome of the case either
-with or without Chiropractic adjustments. In this broader sense we use
-the term hereafter.
-
-The object of diagnosis is correct adjustment. Including as it does
-palpation, nerve-tracing, and symptomatology, the Chiropractor’s
-diagnosis of a case should embrace all the knowledge upon which he
-proceeds with his adjustment.
-
-There are really two all-important questions which constantly recur
-to confront the busy practitioner. One is, “What is the matter with
-my patient?” and the other, “What can I do to relieve him?” Practice
-resolves itself into these two divisions, diagnosis and adjustment.
-
-The real question which should suggest itself to the thinking
-Chiropractor is not, then, “Should a Chiropractor study diagnosis?”
-but rather, “From what viewpoint should we study diagnosis? Upon what
-portions of the subject shall we concentrate our attention?”
-
-Undoubtedly the most important branch of diagnosis to us is vertebral
-palpation. By its use we discover those facts about the spinal column
-without which we are entirely unable to proceed as Chiropractors.
-Knowledge concerning the spine is the _most essential_ part of
-diagnosis.
-
-Next in order of importance comes the study of physical or objective
-signs throughout the body--the examination of the body for the
-discovery of all the changes in the size, shape, position, etc., of
-organs which indicate disease. This includes nerve-tracing, which in
-some cases is the most important branch of physical diagnosis after
-vertebral palpation.
-
-Finally, a certain degree of examination for _subjective_ symptoms may
-be necessary. But the Chiropractor of the future should become, and
-probably will become, par excellence a _physical diagnostician_.
-
-For many reasons we should be able to rely upon our own diagnoses.
-Capability in diagnosis renders us independent of the errors or false
-beliefs of others. Since it includes a knowledge of subluxations, not
-included in medical training but still vital to correct interpretation
-of morbid phenomena, it can be more accurate than any diagnosis which
-ignores these causal factors. A habit of diagnosing one’s own cases
-enables one, always resting on his own judgment, to correct and improve
-himself through all errors, for which he is then alone responsible.
-
-A general knowledge of medical diagnosis, of pathology, bacteriology,
-etc., enables a Chiropractor to meet the physician on common ground; in
-fact, it gives the Chiropractor a distinct advantage, since he knows
-not only what his medical friend knows but also the all-important facts
-regarding the spine which are unknown to others. Such knowledge and
-the ability to discuss disease intelligently also furnishes common
-ground with every patient. Each patient is a specialist in the disease
-he believes himself to have and he expects from his doctor a greater
-knowledge than his own.
-
-The recognition of contagious or infectious diseases as such is an
-absolute necessity in order to obey the laws and safeguard the public
-health. The exact condition and degree of vitality of the patient
-and the knowledge of the existence of abscess, gangrene, intestinal
-obstruction, etc., often warns the Chiropractor that his adjustment
-would be dangerous to the patient. Much possible injury is avoided by
-accurate diagnosis. Even the frequency with which adjustments should be
-given depends upon diagnosis.
-
-
-Special Cases
-
-There are certain cases which a Chiropractor is powerless to aid
-and immediate recognition of such cases will save much trouble. In
-intestinal obstruction from intussusception or from strangulated
-hernia, for instance, it is best to advise the calling of a surgeon
-immediately, while in obstruction from volvulus or intestinal paralysis
-the adjustments may afford relief and should at least be tried first of
-all.
-
-Any internal abscess presents a possibility of rupture into a serous
-cavity or the substance of a parenchymatous organ and is therefore
-dangerous, while a superficial abscess, pointing toward the surface,
-can best be cared for by adjustment. A badly ulcerated or gangrenous
-appendix may rupture under adjustment and be followed by diffuse
-peritonitis. The fragile walls of the ileum in typhoid may perforate
-under adjustment, while in its earlier stages the disease is easily
-curable. The rotted vertebral bodies in Potts’ Disease (spinal caries)
-may be crushed under the heavy hand of an ignorant adjuster.
-
-Intelligent case-taking _must_ include accurate diagnosis.
-
-
-Frequency of Adjustments
-
-The frequency of adjustments in practice should be determined entirely
-by the nature of the case and the circumstances in which patient and
-adjuster are placed. No hard and fast rules can be laid down but some
-general advice may be profitable.
-
-Acute fever cases may be adjusted, until the fever is broken, oftener
-than any other type of cases. The chief object is the regulation of the
-temperature, after which the body is able properly to repair itself.
-Sometimes it may be necessary to give from two to six adjustments in
-a day and in at least one tetanus case the adjustments were given
-at intervals of about ten minutes for several hours until the fever
-was under control. After such a series it is wisest to refrain from
-adjusting again for several days so that the patient may recuperate
-during the interval, providing the fever does not return. It has been
-noticed that after a series of adjustments given at short intervals the
-improvement of the patient often extends over a period of days or weeks.
-
-In ordinary chronic cases, with good vitality and reactive power, the
-daily adjustment is best at first. Then after a course of from six to
-twenty-four adjustments according to the judgment of the practitioner,
-the interval is lengthened and adjustments given on alternate days, a
-day of rest intervening between each two. In weak patients or those who
-are extremely sensitive, the shock of the daily adjustment, even at
-first, and the demand on the body’s recuperative power may be greater
-than can be met.
-
-In this connection it may be mentioned that the author has encountered
-several cases of dorsal lordosis produced by too heavy and too frequent
-adjustments, straining the ligaments faster than they could be repaired
-and continuing the strain over too long a period. It is possible
-to _over-adjust_ a patient, producing a weakened spine and other
-deleterious effects, just as it is possible to establish a “tolerance”
-for a drug by long continued use.
-
-During a long course of adjustments it is well to allow the patient
-an occasional week of complete rest, or even more, and it may be wise
-after a time to reduce the number of adjustments to two per week in
-some cases.
-
-On the other hand, the practice of giving one adjustment a week
-from the beginning, as followed by some practitioners who maintain
-offices in numerous localities and visit each one day per week, is not
-generally productive of good results and it is the author’s practice
-to refuse new cases who profess their inability to take more than one
-adjustment weekly. The interval is so long that all repair work started
-by each adjustment is completed and an involutionary change sets in
-before the next.
-
-
-Specific vs. General Adjusting
-
-By specific adjusting is meant the selection and adjustment of the
-vertebra or vertebrae which are known to be causing definite disease
-or weakness. The term “specific adjustment” implies that there is a
-particular reason existing and recognized for every vertebra adjusted.
-
-General adjustment, on the other hand means either the adjustment of
-all palpable subluxations, or of all the most noticeable ones, or of
-all found providing that no two successive vertebrae be adjusted,
-according to the beliefs of different elements in the profession.
-
-Specific adjusting relies upon the diagnosis and requires correct
-interpretation of disease. General adjusting considers only the
-condition of the spine and is given upon the principle that if the
-spine is right the man is right--a perfectly correct principle
-regardless of whether or not the general adjustment is advisable. Let
-us consider some of the arguments for and against each method and reach
-a conclusion if possible.
-
-The use of specific adjustment demands of the Chiropractor an accurate
-diagnosis and compels him to get his mind into direct contact with the
-exact condition of the patient in order to select the proper vertebrae.
-Sometimes the less prominent subluxation causes a more acute or
-dangerous disease than the more pronounced. Specific adjusting tends to
-develop more discriminating and accurate palpation.
-
-Specific adjusting weakens and shocks the weak or nervous patient
-less than general adjusting. It also concentrates the recuperative or
-reparatory power of the patient on the parts which _most need repair_.
-The body possesses only a certain limited capacity for combating
-disease or building weakened tissue. To scatter this force widely is to
-weaken its effect in any particular locality.
-
-The habit of specific adjustment and of selecting proper vertebrae
-enables the Chiropractor to explain definitely at any time just what he
-is doing and why he is doing it. We assert that in adjusting a vertebra
-we are removing the primary cause of disease. It is sometimes awkward
-to be asked if the patient has nine diseases or if it takes nine
-subluxations to cause one case of acute coryza. A correct answer to
-either question leaves an embarrassing discrepancy between theory and
-practice.
-
-In favor of the practice of general adjusting it has been said that
-errors in diagnosis become unimportant if all subluxations be adjusted;
-that if the spine be straightened the patient _must_ recover. Against
-the first statement, which is forceful because diagnosticians are
-so notably liable to err, it may be said that errors in palpation
-are almost, if not quite, as frequent as errors in other branches
-of diagnosis and that one’s tendency to err is less if all possible
-methods be checked against each other than if one only is used. The
-second statement is quite true; but it is based upon the assumption
-that in ordinary practice the spine _may_ be straightened completely.
-As a matter of fact this rarely, if ever, occurs. It is practically
-impossible ever to thoroughly “line up” a spine. The best that has been
-done as yet except in acute subluxations is to so modify subluxations
-that disease disappears.
-
-We may interject here the statement that no greater or more conclusive
-betrayal of incompetency can be offered by a Chiropractor than the
-declaration that he has completely “lined up” a spinal column in one,
-six, or a dozen adjustments, as some have declared. If one be honest in
-such statements it is proof positive that he is not capable of accuracy
-in palpation or else lamentably liable to auto-suggestion. Clinicians
-of proven ability, who have examined more than five thousand spines
-each, agree that no perfectly normal spine has been discovered, whether
-the spine has been adjusted or not.
-
-But the chiefest argument against general adjusting is that it scatters
-the reparatory forces of the body throughout many segments, some
-of which are not really in need of attention, while the one or two
-segments which need all possible concentration of energy receive only a
-diluted share.
-
-If my patient suffers from an acute pneumonia and nothing else and if
-I require that he submit to a general adjustment including some eight
-subluxations, two of which are Lumbars, I am unscientific and unwise.
-What that case demands is an immediate localized improvement.
-
-It is highly probable that the efficient Chiropractor of the future
-will be a specific adjuster; that every recognized body condition will
-suggest a definite and scientifically determined corrective measure;
-and that guesswork will be largely eliminated.
-
-
-Talking Points
-
-The things which it is most important that the Chiropractor should
-set before his patient are the theories and facts peculiar to
-Chiropractic, perhaps adduced by Chiropractic investigations alone.
-These theories and facts have been discussed elsewhere in detail: the
-subluxation theory, easily demonstratable with a spinal column as an
-object lesson, the relations between primary and secondary causes of
-disease, the directness and completeness of the results of vertebral
-adjustments, these explanations are more convincing than the display
-of a wealth of knowledge of methods and theories used by other schools
-of practice. Chiropractic has been builded not by virtue of previously
-established truths but solely on the vitality of the new principles
-enunciated by it.
-
-These new ideas cannot hope for full and immediate credence and must be
-presented carefully, with this fact in mind and with due consideration
-for the degree of intelligence of the listener. Avoid argumentative
-discussion with patients, seeking rather to enlighten them about those
-facts peculiar to Chiropractic and unknown to them than to antagonize
-them by contradicting their cherished beliefs. It is much wiser to
-begin with that knowledge of disease which you hold in common with the
-patient and advance with him, step by step, from that firm foundation
-to new truths than to begin by attempting to tear down his beliefs.
-Reason from the known to the unknown. Replace an old idea as to the
-causation of disease by quietly inserting a new one of greater verity
-and it will presently and painlessly crowd out the old. This process is
-much the simplest and easiest.
-
-Nevertheless in presenting Chiropractic we must be gently positive.
-Chiropractic is known and provable. Always able to fall back upon the
-clinical test as a final argument with supreme assurance that it will
-not fail to vindicate our claims, we may present an unshaken front
-before the most powerful and intelligent attack.
-
-
-Promises to Patients
-
-The majority of patients will require from the Chiropractor an
-expression of his belief in his ability or inability to cure them. They
-will desire a statement as to the probable time required for a cure.
-They may even ask a guarantee of success.
-
-These questions are hard to meet truthfully and convincingly, for
-the truth is that every Chiropractor fails sometimes and is unable
-to predict that failure in advance and that no one wise enough to
-predict the length of time which will be required for the cure of any
-given case has yet arisen. And these truths do not sound reassuring or
-convincing.
-
-Explain to the patient that nature alone is the curative agent and that
-the cure depends not alone upon the skill of the adjuster but upon
-the exact condition of the vertebrae, the exact amount or degree of
-damage to tissue, the patient’s habits of living, etc. Any accidental
-interjection of other factors into the case may have an important
-bearing. You may assure him of the excellent results you have obtained
-in other cases similar to his, or even cite individual cases if to
-do so does not violate a professional confidence. But you had best
-avoid a promise to cure or an exact statement of the time which will
-be needed. State your belief or opinion but do not bind yourself to a
-promise. Offer your best skill and closest attention; you can do no
-more.
-
-The patient should rely upon the skill of the Chiropractor as upon the
-skill of his lawyer or his physician. Neither can honestly promise that
-he will succeed in his efforts, even though all indications point that
-way.
-
-
-Re-Tracing of Disease
-
-From the original concussion of forces which produces a nerve-impigning
-subluxation to the stage of chronic disease with which the patient
-usually approaches the Chiropractor for relief, disease develops by a
-series of gradual steps. Successive changes take place from time to
-time in the degree of subluxation as it is augmented by further jars,
-strains, etc., or by the reaction of secondary causes upon it and with
-these changes come corresponding changes in the development of the
-disease.
-
-Perhaps the first effect of the bad subluxation is irritation of a
-nerve and acute functional disturbance such as pain, fever, etc. The
-later effect may be paralysis and its attendant train of evils.
-
-When the Chiropractor begins adjustment he does not at once return the
-long-displaced and misshapen vertebra to its normal position. He merely
-_tends_ to do so, his adjustments making slight and gradual changes
-from the abnormal back to normal.
-
-Thus it is that the subluxation passes back in reverse order through
-the successive stages of its development, following a process which
-may be called the involution of the subluxation. At the same time
-the morbid process resulting from the subluxation tends to retrace
-its steps, passing in reverse order through the stages by which it
-developed. Pains which have not been felt for years may unaccountably
-return under the reawakening of the long dormant nerves. Headache, long
-absent but once a prominent feature of the disease, may again make its
-appearance. The patient _feels_ worse.
-
-These changes, however, take place much more rapidly during the
-correction than during the development of the disease. To a certain
-extent they are probably always present, although in many cases they
-occur so rapidly or are modified so much by changed environment as to
-be unrecognizable. In many cases it is possible by securing an accurate
-history and by careful observation of the patient’s progress to
-observe a definite reappearance, in reverse order, of every important
-event in the history of the disease. For instance, if the patient has
-at one time had a severe fever, perhaps lasting many weeks, and has
-later developed a chronic weakness marking the increase in degree of
-subluxation, the fever may reappear during adjustments, last a day or
-two, and disappear forever, having been corrected beyond that stage.
-
-If explained in advance to patients with chronic diseases, the facts
-of retracing may not cause the patient to become discouraged as he
-would if he failed to understand them. If he knows before your work is
-commenced that he may expect such phenomena but may possibly escape
-them he meets them as necessary parts of the process of cure. If they
-are not explained in advance he is likely to feel that you are doing
-him injury and to discontinue your service just at the time he most
-needs them. In fact, it occasionally happens that if adjustments are
-stopped at some irritant stage of the cure that condition will remain
-and do great damage.
-
-This theory of retracing has been much abused. Chiropractors have used
-it to cover a multitude of errors in practice. With some it becomes a
-habit to call all unfavorable events which occur during adjustments
-retracing, thus shifting the blame from their own shoulders to
-Nature’s. This is a pernicious practice because it deceives the patient
-and also because too frequent repetition of this explanation finally
-deludes the practitioner into the belief that all such events really
-_are_ retracing. This view withdraws his attention from his own technic
-and he ceases to discover his own mistakes by ceasing to look for them.
-
-It is best in the face of any painful or apparently unfavorable
-development always to examine our own work thoroughly to detect any
-possible error in diagnosis, palpation, or selection of move for
-correction. It is always possible for us to err and our cases should be
-observed at every stage with the most minute care to insure accuracy in
-detail.
-
-
-Limitations of Chiropractic
-
-There are many things which can be done better by others than by a
-Chiropractor. There are others for which the Chiropractor’s training
-does not fit him at all and to which his methods do not in any
-sense apply. Knowledge of these limitations is just as essential as
-acquaintance with the powers of the vertebral adjustment.
-
-Bony dislocations other than vertebral, fractures, wounds causing, or
-likely to cause, hemorrhage or severe internal injury, should at sight
-be diverted into the hands of a surgeon. The Chiropractor receives no
-training in handling such cases and has neither legal nor moral right
-to attend them. In obstetrics likewise no practical training is given
-which would prepare the practitioner for delivery and he is unprepared
-to use necessary asceptic or antiseptic measures.
-
-Some individual cases of disease usually curable will have advanced
-so far as to require surgical interference. Abscesses or suppurative
-diseases internally located or having any liability to discharge
-internally must be avoided. Gangrene, cancer, the advanced stages of
-tuberculosis (usually) are incurable.
-
-Quarantinable diseases as a class yield readily to adjustment unless
-some serum treatment has been administered, when the chances of
-recovery are greatly lessened. But such cases must be reported in
-conformity with the laws of the state and will probably then be taken
-out of the hands of the Chiropractor--unfortunately. The laws of the
-various states should be modified to permit Chiropractors, with
-precautions required of physicians to safeguard the public health,
-to pass quarantine. Every effort should be put forth to secure such
-legislation but until it is secured in any state and the Chiropractor’s
-work is brought under the supervision of the authorities, the laws must
-be respected strictly.
-
-Syphilis and gonorrhoea, communicable diseases, should be recognized
-and refused in practice. The former in the primary and secondary stages
-(not tertiary) and the latter in all stages is corrective by adjustment
-but the liability of transmission of the disease warns against contact
-with it unless all precautions known to science be used to avoid
-possible transmission.
-
-Congenital anomalies of structure do not yield to Chiropractic and are
-best let alone although no harm is likely to arise through any attempt
-to correct them by vertebral adjustment.
-
-
-Relation of Chiropractic to Other Methods
-
-There are certain other methods which present a superficial resemblance
-to Chropractic which leads many to believe them closely related. Such
-methods are Spondylotherapy, Osteopathy, etc. There is a system called
-Napravit or Naprapathy which may be dismissed with the statement that
-it is Chiropractic, renamed.
-
-Spondylotherapy, on the other hand, is a system of treating disease
-which takes no account of the vertebral subluxation as its primary
-cause and seeks to cure disease by stimulating or inhibiting nerve
-action through the use of mechanical, thermic, or electrical means.
-Its resemblance is due solely to the fact that most of the treatment
-is applied to the spine. As well might we say that serum injection for
-meningitis is Chiropractic because the serum is introduced by lumbar
-puncture into the spinal canal.
-
-Osteopathy, since the profession has become aware of the superior
-results obtainable by vertebral adjustment, is rapidly adopting many
-Chiropractic methods and counterfeiting it as far as possible. Perusal
-of their literature of various periods clearly shows that this is a new
-growth and that they have never adopted in theory what they sometimes
-use in practice. In fact both the above methods _treat disease_,
-following the theory of medicine with the use of different remedies
-only, while Chiropractic _adjusts the cause_ of disease and avoids
-treatment of any kind. Chiropractic is not a branch of medicine, never
-can be a branch of medicine because it is inherently and fundamentally
-antagonistic to the very basic principles of medicine, and no statute
-can change the fact of such antagonism. But unless we adhere strictly
-to the fundamental principles of our own practice and limit ourselves
-to the methods which grow from those principles Chiropractic _may
-become_ a part of medicine. Which brings us to
-
-
-The Use of Adjuncts
-
-There are many methods of treating disease which are more or less
-beneficial to the patient just as there are some which are always
-injurious. Shall we employ such of these methods as are beneficial as
-adjuncts to the practice of Chiropractic? Or shall we adhere to the
-principle that the treatment of disease is erroneous and the adjustment
-of its cause the only logical method of procedure? There is much to
-be said on both sides of this question which has so long agitated the
-profession.
-
-In the class of beneficial adjuncts may be placed massage,
-hydrotherapy, spondylotherapy, dietetics, osteopathy, Christian
-Science, suggestive therapeutics, mechano-therapy, and many others.
-Each of these has its field of usefulness; each taken alone is
-productive of some good in some cases at least. Each might possibly
-augment the results of Chiropractic, or hasten them in some cases,
-if judiciously used. By judiciously used we mean the avoidance of
-any method which would in the least interfere with proper vertebral
-adjustment or its results or which might carelessly cause subluxation.
-Osteopathy and mechano-therapy frequently cause subluxation because of
-the ignorance on the part of their users; they need not do so.
-
-Among the pernicious adjuncts, or those which are harmful if combined
-with adjustments or harmful whenever and however used, may be mentioned
-drug medicine, serum therapy, and electricity. The first two may
-sometimes prove the lesser evil if used alone. With Chiropractic they
-are always unnecessary and always tend to lessen the good effect
-of adjustments. The latter alone is beneficial but in combination
-with Chiropractic proves a double stimulant to the nerves and should
-be avoided. The effect of these methods when used with Chiropractic
-can never be accurately predicted. One can only be certain that some
-unfortunate effect will follow.
-
-As a secondary consideration the Chiropractor has neither legal nor
-moral right to practice medicine unless he has received a state license
-to do so.
-
-Having admitted that the forms of “mixing” indicated as beneficial to
-the patient may be sometimes justifiable on the score of immediate good
-to the patient, let us consider another side of the question.
-
-Just as surely as we admit into our practice any method which attacks
-the disease itself, or which treats any other than the primary cause of
-the disease, or which seeks to stimulate or inhibit the functions of
-the body without freeing the natural channels through which the natural
-healing power of the body should be manifested, just so surely are
-we adopting the medical theory and making our profession a branch of
-medicine. Medicine uses many remedies for the cure of disease. Medicine
-is now broader than the mere administration of drugs. And no matter how
-we vary the remedy, or what treatment we select, we are denying the
-truth of the Chiropractic theory and admitting the truth of the medical
-principle when we use adjuncts in our practice.
-
-Nor are these adjuncts necessary. It has been demonstrated by repeated
-observations that the Chiropractors who use only the vertebral
-adjustment secure just as high a percentage of results as those who
-combine one or more other methods with it. This is due to various
-reasons: the greater perfection attained in Chiropractic by those who
-apply themselves with concentration to the task of settling every
-problem by that means; the fact that adjuncts often detract from the
-effect of adjustment as much as they add results of their own; the
-tendency of the patient to prefer and to insist upon the easier and
-less painful methods rather than the adjustment.
-
-The lay patient and the ignorant public are inclined to give credit for
-results obtained to the best known method used upon them. Thus in spite
-of the fact that Chiropractic alone obtains a far greater percentage
-of results than any other combination of methods, the patient is prone
-to believe that the change of diet or the massage effected a cure and
-to overlook entirely the least pleasant part of his “treatment,” the
-adjustment. He does not understand and cannot understand with a mind
-divided for the consideration of several methods, the connection of the
-spine with his disease. Often he fails to understand if Chiropractic
-is used alone but he is forced to conclude that the spine _has_ such
-connection because adjustment of the spine cured him.
-
-The use of adjuncts has done more to hold back the advance of the
-profession in the public mind than any other single factor except
-ignorance within the profession. Furthermore, the Chiropractor who
-knows that he can rely upon various other methods if his adjustment
-fails does not feel impelled to _study his Chiropractic_ as he should.
-He weakens in practice, relying more and more upon adjuncts.
-
-It has been repeatedly proven that the Chiropractor who uses _only_
-Chiropractic becomes the better practitioner by necessity. It has also
-proven that the man who is expert in Chiropractic needs nothing else,
-providing only that he refuses those cases to which Chiropractic cannot
-apply at all.
-
-The only _real_ problem in Chiropractic is the problem of _adjustment_.
-All failures may be attributed either to lack of knowledge and proper
-application of Chiropractic or to the fact that the patient has
-not vitality enough to recover from the disease. Do not shift the
-responsibility for failure upon the system, since with one or two
-exceptions every known disease has been cured by _some_ Chiropractor,
-thus proving its possibility. Realize that the work can be done and
-that its doing depends upon your own skill in diagnosis and technic.
-
-It is inevitable that at some future time Chiropractic will be used
-in connection with other beneficial methods which will enable us to
-get results _sooner_, though not more surely. It is also inevitable
-that Chiropractic will fail to receive its proper place among healing
-methods unless we force the world to believe in it as we believe; to
-know it as we know it. If we develop our system in its purity until
-it obtains general recognition at its true valuation we shall have
-accomplished an infinite good for humanity for all time.
-
-We should endeavor to accomplish the greatest good for the greatest
-number, laboring rather for the ultimate recognition of the subluxation
-theory and its application at its real value than for immediate slight
-good or personal gain.
-
-
-Personality
-
-He who would succeed in Chiropractic must have, in addition to a
-thorough education in his profession, a proper personality. This is
-the medium through which his education becomes effective, the channel
-through which he reaches the public, gaining their confidence and
-approval that he may utilize his knowledge to their good. Many skillful
-and well-educated practitioners have failed because they lacked the
-proper personal qualities for attracting patients.
-
-
-Elements of Personality
-
-The most essential elements of a proper personality are Courage,
-Conviction, Confidence, Honesty, Sympathy, and Aggressiveness.
-
-Courage, not recklessness or carelessness but a fearless willingness to
-assume responsibility--the heavy responsibility of our profession--is
-indispensable. He who accepts the easy case or the chronic and slowly
-progressive one and refuses to face the appalling rush of a dangerous
-and acute malady; he who shrinks through fear for his reputation from a
-grave risk, has no right in Chiropractic. He has mistaken his calling.
-While we acquire the knowledge of Chiropractic we acquire also a great
-responsibility for its use; we must utilize it wherever and whenever
-it is best for the patient, whenever our chances of effecting a cure
-are the best chances, without regard to ourselves or any personal risk.
-
-By _conviction_ is meant a firm and well-grounded _belief_ in the
-greatness and efficiency of Chiropractic. Sincerity in one’s practice
-is a prime requisite for success. A belief grounded in _knowledge_
-girds the Chiropractor with an armor so strong that no adversity can
-pierce it. He who practices Chiropractic without believing in it is in
-his own mind a cheat and a fraud and cannot expect ultimate prosperity.
-
-Confidence in one’s own ability and knowledge, in one’s power and skill
-to contest with disease, begets confidence in others. Not conceit, not
-exaggerated egotism, but a healthy and sane assurance and faith in
-oneself, engender that steadiness of mind and of hand which make for
-accuracy and excellence.
-
-Without honesty with oneself, one’s profession, and one’s patients, one
-forfeits public confidence--and justly. If we promise that which we
-cannot perform, if we deceive our patients by misleading explanations
-of untoward events, we deserve failure. It is not intended here to
-refer to the cheerful and optimistic manner and habit of speech which
-often aids in the sick room to keep the patient’s mind at rest. This
-may sometimes deceive the patient as to the gravity of his condition
-and such deceit may be justifiable; but it should never be extended to
-the family or to those who have a right to know the real condition and
-cannot be harmed by such knowledge. Strict honesty, whenever harmless
-to others, should be the fixed policy of all practitioners.
-
-The weak, strained minds of the very ill require and demand _sympathy_;
-not the sort which expresses itself in fixed words or phrases of
-condolence with the unfortunate and at once forgets their needs and
-sorrows, but the deeper, unspoken feeling of desire to aid, which
-springs from the heart and finds its best expression in active
-assistance. If you do not care whether your patient is or is not
-benefited, if you have no other feeling for him than a business
-interest in holding a case, you lack the strongest impulse to hard work
-and study, the desire to aid.
-
-Chiropractic is new. Its principles are yet unknown to the general
-public. Also this is an age of keen competition and it is our duty
-to our profession and to the world that instead of hiding our light
-under a bushel we proclaim our mission to all who will hear. We must
-be intelligently and wisely _aggressive_. We must bring ourselves into
-contact with the public in every legitimate way, compelling it by force
-of logic and personality to see the reasonableness and greatness of our
-work.
-
-Question yourself in regard to these things. Examine your own
-characteristics to discover whether any of these essential elements
-of personality are lacking. If one be found wanting cultivate it
-assiduously. Having chosen Chiropractic as a life vocation, _work at
-it_ not alone for the acquisition of ever-increasing knowledge but for
-the unfoldment of a powerful and winning personality.
-
-
-
-
-CHIROPRACTIC PROGNOSIS
-
-
-=Prognosis= is the determining, in advance of the fact, of the probable
-course, duration, or outcome of a disease. A Chiropractic prognosis is
-a prediction as to the changes which will take place in a case during
-and after Chiropractic adjustments.
-
-=General Prognosis= is an opinion expressed of a disease without
-reference to any particular case. It is based upon the experience of
-the profession and the average result obtained with the disease. It
-furnishes only a basis for consideration of the =special prognosis=
-of an individual case. This latter must be based upon the general
-prognosis of the disease and upon study of every modifying factor
-present in the case, as general vitality, living habits, facility of
-adjustment, apparent response to early adjustments, and especially
-an estimate of the amount and kind of damage done to tissue and the
-probability of its repair.
-
-Only general prognosis can be set down as a guide to others. To state
-even this with certainty and safety many precautions must be observed.
-All cases included as a basis of conclusions must be handled under
-standard test conditions (see index) as far as may be; in accepting
-the observations of others one must be sure that they are sufficiently
-trained and sufficiently careful and veracious to render their
-statements reliable.
-
-In order to introduce the subject to the literature of the profession
-and to invite comment and discussion looking toward the ultimate
-development of a complete Chiropractic prognosis we shall set down,
-without further preliminary, the general prognosis of those commonly
-described diseases concerning which we feel qualified to speak. No
-statement is made without the gathering of reliable evidence.
-
-
-GENERAL PROGNOSIS
-
-=Abscesses.=--Those abscesses which would tend to discharge externally
-may be adjusted for with success and will rapidly develop, point, and
-discharge, with quick recovery. Those which might break internally
-absolutely forbid adjustment because of the almost certain occurrence
-of peritonitis, pyaemia, or other grave condition.
-
-=Acne.=--Good, but usually slow.
-
-=Addison’s Disease.=--Few cases reported, and these slow cures.
-
-=Adenoids of Pharynx.=--Prognosis so good as to contraindicate
-operation in every case. The lymphoid growths gradually and slowly
-absorb under adjustment.
-
-=Adiposis Dolorosa.=--Only one case seen, the Derkum case. This reduced
-in six months of adjustment from 360 to 280 lbs. in weight, and was
-improved in every particular. No final report received.
-
-=Alcoholism.=--Adjustments greatly aid a cure if alcohol be
-discontinued at once, or if the daily consumption is gradually and
-steadily decreased. No permanent cure can be secured without the aid of
-the patient. Acute alcoholic intoxication may be lessened at once by
-the aid of a single adjustment.
-
-=Amenorrhoea.=--Prognosis excellent. One to several months required.
-Conservative amenorrhoea, as in tuberculosis or other wasting disease,
-disappears only with the occasion.
-
-=Anaemia.=--If primary, yields slowly but surely. Secondary anaemia
-depends upon some disease process and its prognosis is that of the
-disease which produces it.
-
-=Angina Pectoris.=--A case for careful diagnosis. False angina
-recovers with general building of nervous system. True angina,
-usually associated with arteriosclerosis, is frequently fatal and
-death may occur during any adjustment. If this does not happen most
-cases recover, though slowly. Let me repeat, there is great danger in
-handling true angina pectoris.
-
-=Anidrosis.=--Usually responds to adjustments for the kidneys.
-
-=Ankylosis.=--Almost any ankylosis, except that in which there is
-gross deformity of the bones, would yield to repeated applications
-of force along right lines. Only vertebral ankyloses are amenable to
-Chiropractic adjustment and those are usually broken in time.
-
-=Anterior Poliomyelitis.=--Chiropractic experience with “infantile
-paralysis” has been very extensive and gratifying. During the febrile
-stage the disease may be aborted by one or several adjustments with
-only slight and transient paralyses resulting. The chronic paralysis
-which follows an unadjusted case is curable, but restoration of the
-motor function and trophic tone of the paralyzed members is delayed
-while the ventral horn cells are regenerated, the axons rebuilt, and
-the atrophied muscles redeveloped. Often no apparent results will be
-obtained for one or several months, after which gradual improvement
-progresses to a complete cure.
-
-=Aphonia.=--Prognosis excellent. No failures reported.
-
-=Apoplexy.=--The occasional case in which a premonitory partial
-paralysis precedes real hemorrhage responds remarkably to adjustment
-so that with care the hemorrhage may be averted. After hemorrhage the
-absorption of the clot is slow and tedious, but about 50 per cent
-recover.
-
-=Appendicitis.=--In the early stages of the acute form, and in nearly
-all chronic cases, recovery is almost certain under adjustments. Signs
-of suppuration indicate immediate operative interference and drainage,
-and failure to read the signs may lead to rupture, peritonitis, and
-death. Acute cases yield very quickly as a rule.
-
-=Arthritis Deformans.=--In well developed cases some almost complete
-cures have been effected in periods varying from two to four years.
-Prognosis good as to relief, but poor as to complete recovery.
-
-=Ascites.=--Fair prognosis, depending upon the nature of the portal
-obstruction. Cirrhotic ascites does not yield well.
-
-=Asthma.=--Spasmodic bronchial asthma is almost always curable except
-in the very aged, but the usual posterior curvature in lower cervicals
-and upper dorsals requires time and persistent heavy adjustments for
-its correction. The asthmatic paroxysm may be relieved instantaneously,
-but will recur at intervals for a long period before the cure is fully
-established. The cardiac form of asthma depends upon restoration of
-compensation for a leaking valve, and yields by irregularly progressive
-diminution.
-
-=Blindness.=--As a condition, without qualifying terms, blindness
-offers a bad prognosis. Most cases fail to develop sight under
-adjustments. Yet some individual cures in optic atrophy, in detached
-retina, and in other conditions, attest the possibility. Cataract
-blindness perhaps yields best.
-
-=Bradycardia.=--If symptomatic, yields as does the disease. If primary,
-a few adjustments are usually sufficient. In one case the first
-adjustment increased to 90 a pulse which had been at 60 for fifteen
-years. In twenty-four hours, without further adjustment, the rate had
-settled at 69 and there remained.
-
-=Bright’s Disease.=--Prognosis good, but some cases terminate abruptly
-with intercurrent disease, such as pneumonia. There is danger until
-the albuminuria has ceased and the strength of the patient markedly
-improved. Probably the diseased kidney area is simply walled off from
-the healthy tissue, which then hypertrophies and takes on the work of
-the entire organ, or pair of organs. If too much damage has been done,
-the case will terminate fatally in time, even though its progress is
-checked by adjustments.
-
-=Bronchitis.=--Acute bronchitis is quickly checked as a rule. Chronic
-bronchitis may prove intractable, or may require many months for a
-cure. There are exceptional quick cures of the most chronic cases.
-
-=Caked Breast--Mammary Inflammations=.--Rapid and positive cure follows
-proper adjustments.
-
-=Cerebral Softening.=--Prognosis bad.
-
-=Cerebrospinal Meningitis.=--Serious always, but no fatalities reported
-in adjusted cases. Failure to modify fever and cervical retraction
-within two or three hours, and with one to ten adjustments, is alarming.
-
-=Chickenpox.=--Like smallpox and the other exanthemata, chickenpox
-should be modified at once by adjustment and all cases should be light,
-eruption hastened, and fever quickly broken. Sometimes the rash may be
-strongly marked and the disease run its usual course in all particulars
-except fever and prostration, being a febrile with absence of all the
-consequences of fever.
-
-=Cholangitis.=--Recovers quickly under adjustment.
-
-=Cholecystitis.=--Prognosis excellent.
-
-=Chorea.=--Prognosis excellent in acute and subacute cases, less
-favorable in chronic. No figures are available, but many chronic cases
-fail to respond at all.
-
-=Cirrhosis of Liver.=--Doubtful. No statistics have been compiled, but
-it seems probable that most cases are unmodified by adjustment.
-
-=Congestion of Liver.=--Prognosis good.
-
-=Conjunctivitis.=--Readily curable, unless part of a more general
-infection.
-
-=Constipation.=--Prognosis usually good, but some cases which have
-paralyzed the intestines with drugs, or in which atony of the
-intestinal muscles exists from any cause, are very stubborn. One is
-led to believe that any case of chronic constipation would respond to
-proper adjustments in time, but sometimes the time is prolonged more
-than seems reasonable.
-
-=Coryza.=--Some cases respond instantly, others persist and run their
-usual course. Chronic nasal catarrh recovers in favorable climates,
-and in unfavorable tends to become permanent, though less severe and
-annoying under adjustment.
-
-=Croup.=--Always dangerous, but no fatalities reported under
-adjustments, which are powerfully effective. Croup requires constant
-attention until all symptoms subside, usually within an hour or two.
-
-=Cystitis.=--Usually curable, but some chronic cases prove intractable
-for an unknown reason. There is no way of recognizing the curability of
-a case before the attempt.
-
-=Deafness.=--Variable outlook. Deafness due to catarrhal occlusion of
-the Eustachian tubes is usually curable. That due to middle ear disease
-sometimes yields. That due to nerve disease is possibly--though not
-certainly--incurable.
-
-=Diabetes Insipidus.=--Prognosis excellent. Few cases fail of cure, and
-no fatalities are reported.
-
-=Diabetes Mellitus.=--Always necessitating grave and careful
-consideration, this metabolic disease is marvellously controlled by
-Chiropractic adjustment. Probably 90 per cent of all cases are curable,
-and only those presenting impossible problems of adjustment, or those
-in the very last stages, are hopeless.
-
-=Diarrhoea.=--Prognosis depends largely upon secondary causes.
-Adjustments sometimes produce diarrhoea to cleanse the intestinal tract
-of waste or poisons. Such a diarrhoea, if instituted by Nature without
-aid, does not cease with adjustments until its purpose is accomplished.
-Nervous and infective diarrhoeas usually respond well.
-
-=Dilatation of Heart.=--Compensatory hypertrophy and strengthening of
-the muscle usually follows adjustment.
-
-=Diphtheria.=--Under adjustment the false membrane tends to exfoliate
-and to be coughed out entire within a few hours, with rapid recovery.
-In children, watch for possible strangulation from loosened membrane.
-Constant bedside attention is imperative until fever and membrane
-have disappeared. Convalescence, unless antitoxin has been used, is
-very rapid, and physicians watching the clinical course of diphtheria
-under adjustment customarily doubt the diagnosis unless culture is
-made. Antitoxin modifies the prognosis toward gravity, and in spite of
-adjustments persistent sequelae often follow its use.
-
-=Dropsy.=--Cardiac or renal dropsy disappears with improvement in the
-diseased organ.
-
-=Dysentery.=--In temperate climates death is extremely unlikely.
-Recovery is often quick and easy, but some cases persist. The tropical
-amoebic dysentery seems hardest to master and may not improve at all.
-
-=Dyspepsia.=--Prognosis good.
-
-=Endocarditis.=--If primary, recovery is the rule. Occurring in the
-course of some other disease, as rheumatic fever, it renders the
-prognosis less certain and may terminate fatally. Likely to leave
-chronic valve weakness or contraction.
-
-=Enteritis.=--Prognosis generally fair. No figures available.
-
-=Enuresis.=--The majority recover within a few weeks or months, with
-occasional exceptions. Failure to get results within a few weeks
-suggests a change of adjustment.
-
-=Epilepsy.=--Doubtful. Less than half of all cases recover, and no
-case can be pronounced cured until all symptoms have been absent for
-a year. Cases with anterior cervicals offer the poorest chance. It
-is usually possible to restore consciousness and muscular control
-by an adjustment during the grande mal, in the instant between
-the tonic and clonic spasms, but such immediate response does
-not--unfortunately--always mean that a cure will eventually be effected.
-
-=Epistaxis.=--Nose-bleed usually stops at once following proper
-adjustment.
-
-=Erysipelas.=--Cases adjusted early show little spreading of the
-eruption with but slight constitutional symptoms. After eruption
-is fully developed it is more difficult to keep down the fever and
-recovery is slower, but none the less certain unless cardiac or other
-grave weakness is present.
-
-=Exophthalmic Goitre.=--Like other forms of goitre this may be reduced,
-and with its reduction all other symptoms disappear. Many cures are on
-record.
-
-=Friedrich’s Ataxia.=--In hereditary cerebellar ataxia (which is
-probably congenital, rather) cures are limited to 40 per cent or
-less. History of instrumental delivery, with marked upper cervical
-subluxation, argue for the natal origin of the disease and increase the
-probability of cure.
-
-=Gallstones.=--Prognosis excellent. The calculi absorb under adjustment
-by a reversal of the chemical process by which their deposit was
-induced. When small they may pass through the ducts and escape, with
-slight pain. Adjustment during the painful passage of a gallstone may
-act upon the duct so as to lessen greatly the pain and hasten the
-passage.
-
-=Gastralgia.=--Like other gastric neuroses, is easily curable but may
-sometimes require correction of a neurotic diathesis, which means time.
-
-=Gastric Ulcer.=--Usually recovers, but occasionally leaves a fibrous
-cicatrix which cannot be affected by adjustment and which, if located
-at the pylorus, may produce stenosis, with consequent incurable
-dilatation of the stomach. Operation is required for such a condition,
-but the diagnosis is difficult, and it may be best to test with
-adjustments for some time.
-
-=Gastritis.=--Prognosis good. To prevent recurrence adjustments should
-continue after symptoms subside.
-
-=Goitre.=--Prognosis good. One large goitre under the author’s
-observation was reduced in one week so that the neck measurement
-decreased one inch. Most cases require several months for complete
-reduction.
-
-=Gonorrhoeal Rheumatism.=--More stubborn than other forms of rheumatism
-and sometimes defies adjustment. No percentages are available. It
-is probable that nothing but a general cleansing of the system will
-prevent recurrence.
-
-=Hay Fever.=--Perhaps one-half of all adjusted cases recover fully,
-some at once and some after several months. By recovery is meant
-failure of the annual appearance of the attack with no symptoms at
-any time. No case can be pronounced cured in less than a year. The
-remaining half are modified little or not at all.
-
-=Headache.=--Nervous, bilious, ocular, and reflex headaches yield
-well. Toxic headaches, or those accompanying systemic infections, give
-way slowly with the cleansing of the system.
-
-=Hemorrhoids.=--Excellent, except when lower lumbars are anterior and
-defy adjustment.
-
-=Hernia.=--In all sites and forms of hernia, excepting strangulated
-hernia, prognosis is good. Strangulation requires immediate surgical
-interference. Prognosis is better if a truss be used.
-
-=Hodgkins’ Disease.=--Prognosis theoretically good, but the few cases
-under adjustment, while benefited, seem to have died of intercurrent
-disease, so that it is well to suspend judgment.
-
-=Hydrocele.=--Theoretically hydrocele should respond well, but in
-practice the author has seen several failures, and no cures.
-
-=Hydrocephalus.=--If due to cervical twisting at birth, the prognosis
-is fair; otherwise bad.
-
-=Hypertrophy.=--Adaptative hypertrophies, those due to overstrain upon
-an organ, do not and should not disappear until the strain has been
-relieved. Hypertrophy is sometimes accelerated by adjustment, as in the
-case of defective heart valves, when thickening of the wall restores
-and maintains compensation. Other hypertrophies tend to disappear under
-adjustment.
-
-=Hysteria.=--Good, but slow. Some extreme cases refuse to respond.
-Instant recovery from hysterical coma is the rule following adjustment,
-but the coma tends to recur.
-
-=Immunity.=--There is no doubt that adjustments often confer immunity
-from infection and contagion, but it is so difficult to strengthen
-every part of the body against every possible infection or contagion,
-and so uncertain that immunity really exists in a given case, that
-it is best always to assume the possibility of contagion and act
-accordingly. Adjustments following exposure to known contagion are
-always wise, but one may never know, if they succeed, that the patient
-might not have escaped without them.
-
-=Impotence.=--Variable outlook, according to secondary causes and
-pathology. Previous venereal disease renders the prognosis most
-doubtful. Nervous or vascular impotence is likely to respond well.
-If due to cord disease, the prognosis is to be made on the original
-disease.
-
-=Influenza.=--Mortality not more than 2 per cent, and that in the
-very aged and infirm. Duration varies greatly. May yield at once,
-first adjustment being followed by disappearance of fever, profuse
-perspiration, and completed convalescence in from twenty-four to
-forty-eight hours; or may require several adjustments at frequent
-intervals to break fever.
-
-=Insanity.=--No accurate tabulation of results in different forms of
-insanity has been made. Numerous successes, interspersed with fewer
-failures, have been reported. The author has both succeeded and failed
-with acute dementia, but the failure was a twenty-four-hour trial only,
-and included but three adjustments.
-
-=Intestinal Obstruction.=--The prognosis of intestinal obstruction from
-intussusception or strangulated hernia is, under Chiropractic, bad.
-Such cases are almost surely fatal unless operated. Faecal obstructions
-or masses of worms, also volvulus, respond quickly and prognosis is
-good. Careful diagnosis is required before taking a case of apparent
-complete obstruction.
-
-=Irritable Heart.=--If purely nervous, recovery is quick and easy. If
-there is a drug diathesis or organic disease, slow and doubtful.
-
-=Jaundice.=--Yields readily, but if of the obstructive form the
-obstruction must first be reduced or removed by adjustments.
-
-=Laryngitis.=--A few adjustments suffice for simple acute cases.
-Specific laryngeal infections are more difficult. Laryngitis with
-ulceration, which is either syphilitic or tubercular, may not recover
-or may recover after a protracted struggle. Chronic laryngitis of other
-forms is curable, but requires more time than acute.
-
-=Leucorrhoea.=--Fair prognosis only.
-
-=Lumbago.=--Good, unless pain prevents proper adjustment. True lumbago
-is quick to respond.
-
-=Malaria.=--Tenacity varies according to climatic conditions. Malarial
-cachexia always yields slowly, sometimes defies adjustment altogether.
-No reports are to be had on pernicious malaria. Other forms recover
-though paroxysms tend to recur several times before checked, but of
-shorter duration than if no adjustment is given.
-
-=Mastoiditis.=--Good results in the few cases observed.
-
-=Measles.=--Excellent. Recovers quickly. Eruption hastened by early
-adjustment, runs very mild course with little or no fever, catarrhal
-symptoms disappear early. No sequelae.
-
-=Meniere’s Disease.=--Labyrinthine disease of this character has been
-cured, without reported failures, but data is meagre, not more than
-three or four cases having come under the author’s notice.
-
-=Menorrhagia--Metrorrhagia=.--Results excellent, and usually quick. One
-fifty-two-hour intermenstrual hemorrhage from uterus was stopped in one
-hour by adjustment, with no recurrence.
-
-=Migraine.=--Migraine, or hemicrania, gives a fair prognosis only. Most
-cases require a long course of adjustments.
-
-=Movable Kidney.=--Prognosis good, but change of position and complete
-fixation slow. No treatment required--merely adjustment.
-
-=Myelitis.=--Transverse myelitis, if adjusted in the acute stage, may
-be checked as any other inflammation, and the damage and resulting
-paralysis will be greatly lessened or altogether prevented. The
-paralyses which follow myelitis require time for the rebuilding of the
-degenerated axons whose course is interrupted at the diseased area, but
-tend to recover.
-
-=Myocarditis.=--Reports conflict. It is well to consider this a grave
-condition and one open to investigation.
-
-=Myxoedema.=--Only one case known to have been under adjustment, and
-this after several years was markedly improved, but not yet quite cured.
-
-=Nephritis.=--Prognosis good. Acute cases show rapid, chronic cases
-slow, improvement.
-
-=Neuralgia.=--Prognosis excellent in any form. Trophic neuralgias,
-such as herpes zoster, are slowest as a rule, but occasional cases of
-tic doloureux will require several months. One may always expect a
-cure unless the patient, in long cases, becomes discouraged and stops
-adjustments.
-
-=Neurasthenia.=--Good, but will be slow unless mental aid be given in
-the form of freedom from worry or strain.
-
-=Neuritis.=--Good, but very uncertain as to time; some cases show quick
-disappearance of all pain and some drag interminably.
-
-=Optic Atrophy.=--Complete atrophy with total blindness is rarely
-cured, though occasional partial or complete cures have been reported.
-Partial atrophy may slowly recover, or recovery may cease at some point
-short of completion and case remain stationary thereafter.
-
-=Ovaritis.=--Good, except in suppurative forms. When adhesions have
-been formed, results are doubtful.
-
-=Pancreatitis.=--Obscure, hard to recognize, and hard to cure.
-Prognosis probably bad.
-
-=Paralysis Agitans.=--Probably in the earliest stages this is curable.
-Cure of a fully developed case is exceedingly doubtful and the writer
-has yet to see marked benefit in such a case.
-
-=Paralyses.=--Prognosis decidedly variable. Apoplectic hemorrhage
-recovers in about 50 per cent of all cases. Paralyses from central
-lesions require much more time than peripheral palsies because of the
-necessity for rebuilding degenerated nerve cells as well as fibres. The
-paralyses following anterior poliomyelitis are almost certain to be
-cured if sufficient time is allowed. Most peripheral palsies, except in
-the very aged, are curable. Any other paralysis but a purely functional
-one recovers slowly, but this form may yield almost in a day.
-
-=Parotitis.=--Mumps respond immediately and may be checked at any stage.
-
-=Pericarditis.=--Usually recovers. Effusions are stubborn and may
-become purulent, in which case the prognosis is grave.
-
-=Peritonitis.=--Prognosis grave, but some cases have been reported
-as cured under adjustment. These are probably localized rather than
-diffuse inflammations, usually pelvic.
-
-=Pertussis, or Whooping-Cough.=--Tends to run its course despite
-adjustments, though some aborted cases are reported. All cases mild
-under adjustment, with small liability of complications. A nervous
-cough is likely to persist for months after the infection has passed.
-Adjustments seem seldom to prevent contagion.
-
-=Pharyngitis.=--Acute form yields readily. Chronic pharyngitis is more
-stubborn, but usually curable.
-
-=Pleurisy.=--Pleurisy, unless purulent or tubercular, yields well in
-varying periods. Purulent and tubercular pleurisy are stubborn and may
-not recover.
-
-=Pneumonia.=--The author has had a wide and gratifying experience
-with pneumonia. At every stage it seems amenable to adjustment, and
-the usual effect of the first adjustment is a drop of from one to two
-degrees in the temperature with immediate softening of the consolidated
-area. Specific adjustments get best and quickest results. Pneumonia
-should =always= recover, unless it occurs as an intercurrent event in
-some chronic and wasting disease, as Bright’s Disease.
-
-=Potts’ Disease.=--Tubercular caries of the bodies of the vertebrae
-is curable, within limits. Occasional cases are seen in which Nature
-has stopped the spread of the disease by walling off the morbid area
-with exostosis. Such cases should not be adjusted, and the disease may
-remain latent through a long life. When active the disease proves fatal
-unless checked, which is possible in the earlier stages, and becomes
-impossible when the vertebral bodies are too fragile to stand strong
-adjustments. Discernment in case-taking will avoid any fatalities under
-adjustment, but by no means all cases of Potts’ Disease are curable.
-
-=Pregnancy.=--We may correct by adjustment any pathological conditions
-arising during pregnancy which would be amenable to adjustment under
-other conditions. A course of adjustments during a normal pregnancy
-will render delivery easier and lessen, but not abolish, the pains.
-Great care must be exercised in the manner of adjustment.
-
-=Prostatic Enlargement.=--Varies according to age and recuperative
-power. Prognosis is bad in the very aged and infirm, but in more
-vigorous subjects quite good for steady reduction of the hypertrophied
-gland, with subsidence of attendant symptoms. Venereal history is
-unfavorable.
-
-=Pulmonary Tuberculosis.=--In the early stages, where little damage
-has been done to lung tissue, recovery is rapid and quite certain. In
-fully developed cases, with characteristic symptoms and marked damage
-to tissue, prognosis is very grave, and it is usually wisest to advise
-a trip to the Southwest in preference to adjustments. Tubercular cases
-should be studied with a view to estimating the exact condition and
-recuperative power of the patient before taking.
-
-=Rachitis.=--Prognosis excellent. In a period varying from six months
-in the best to five to seven years in the slowest cases, all show
-complete or nearly complete cures. All deformity may be checked in
-a short time and proper bone nourishment established. Correction of
-deformities existing prior to adjustment is a growth process. Too
-many cases become discouraged at the slowness of the work and stop
-adjustments.
-
-=Retinal Hemorrhage.=--Prognosis fair. Undoubted cures have been
-recorded, as well as a few failures. At least one case of hemorrhages
-followed by partially detached retina has been cured, or nearly so, by
-adjustments.
-
-=Rheumatic Fever.=--Hard to adjust because of its painful nature.
-Results of proper adjustment usually, but not always, good.
-
-=Rheumatism.=--Muscular rheumatism yields more rapidly than articular.
-Acute tends to quick recovery, chronic to more or less lengthened
-and slow improvement. Rheumatic diathesis may require many months of
-careful adjustment.
-
-=Rubella.=--Simply and easily checked. Rash slight, and no prostration
-at all.
-
-=Scarlet Fever.=--Data on quarantinable cases is meagre, but scarlet
-fever, or scarlatina, seems to be quickly modified by adjustment. One
-may expect a drop of from one to two degrees in temperature after first
-adjustment, followed by steady rise, which will again be checked by the
-next adjustment. Rash appears early, and all symptoms are mild, but
-several days are often required to put the patient at ease. Occasional
-sequelae, such as endocarditis, otitis media, or other inflammations,
-occur unless case be watched with great care. No fatal terminations
-under adjustment except in cases which were at first misdiagnosed.
-
-=Seminal Emissions.=--Prognosis excellent in cases uncomplicated by
-masturbation or excessive venery; in such cases bad until habits are
-changed.
-
-=Simple Continued Fever.=--Always recovers. Usually drops one to two
-degrees shortly following correct adjustment, with amelioration of all
-symptoms.
-
-=Smallpox.=--Infections vary in virulence. In temperate climates all
-phases are hastened by adjustment and tend to recover without sequelae.
-The milder smallpox due to infection by vaccination is also amenable to
-adjustment, and prompt handling will often prevent serious poisoning.
-
-=Splanchnoptosis.=--Partial or marked relief is usual--and slow.
-Complete natural replacement of all viscera is the exception rather
-than the rule.
-
-=Splenic Enlargement.=--Variable prognosis according to cause.
-Secondary enlargements due to systematic infection yield with the
-disappearance of the infection. Primary enlargements yield more readily
-as a rule, with exceptions. Malarial spleen is slow to reduce.
-
-=Splenitis.=--Prognosis presumably good, but few authentic cases
-reported.
-
-=Spondylitis Deformans.=--Prognosis favorable for slow, slight
-improvement, but not for complete cure.
-
-=Strabismus.=--Excellent in young subjects, less than fair in patients
-over thirty.
-
-=Sunstroke.=--Theoretically curable, but no experience.
-
-=Syphilis.=--The primary sore frequently dries under adjustment without
-the development of any secondary or tertiary stage. If first adjusted
-during the secondary manifestations symptoms may readily disappear and
-no tertiary stage ever appear. There are some authenticated cures eight
-and ten years past without recurrence of any sign. In the tertiary
-stage the organic lesions do not respond. Prognosis is so hopeless in
-this stage that it seems useless to apply Chiropractic at all.
-
-=Tabes Dorsalis.=--Posterior spinal sclerosis, commonly called from
-its chief symptom “locomotor ataxia,” recovers in 40 to 50 per cent
-of cases adjusted. No accurate pre-judgment can be formed as to the
-probabilities in any particular case without experiment, nor has any
-adequate explanation been offered as to why some cases recover and
-others do not. Those cases which improve at all are likely to recover
-fully. In any instance, time is required for the regeneration of the
-dorsal column axons, and while this is going on no improvement may be
-apparent at all.
-
-=Tachycardia.=--If symptomatic, as of exophthalmic goitre, tachycardia
-yields as the disease does. If primary, a few adjustments usually
-establish a proper pulse rate.
-
-=Tetanus.=--Only one undoubted case has been brought to the writer’s
-attention and this one a marvellous cure. Adjustments were given as
-often as every ten minutes for a time.
-
-=Thoracic Aneurism.=--Cure exceedingly doubtful, and fatal termination
-possible at any time. Little information is at hand.
-
-=Tonsilitis--Quinsy=.--Simple or follicular tonsilitis aborts under
-adjustment in from a few hours to two or three days. Quinsy, or
-suppurative tonsilitis, runs its regular course as to duration, but is
-frequently a febrile after the first day. Spontaneous rupture of the
-tonsil will usually occur and sometimes two or three such ruptures
-will lengthen the case slightly. Sequalae are wanting, but all forms of
-tonsilar inflammation tend to recur unless a long course of corrective
-adjustments is applied to the cervical region.
-
-=Torticollis.=--Acute spastic or rheumatic torticollis in which
-permanent contractures have not yet set in may be cured almost
-invariably in a period varying from a few days to several weeks.
-Chronic cases with permanent contractures yield very slowly, but
-prognosis is good for a fairly accurate straightening of the neck. Such
-cases often leave slight abnormalities even in the most competent hands.
-
-=Tuberculosis, Pulmonary.=--See Pulmonary Tuberculosis.
-
-=Tumors, Benign.=--Unlike malignant growths, benign tumors, fatty,
-fibroid, etc., tend to gradual absorption under adjustment. Perhaps 75
-per cent or more may be completely cured. Age is a factor, tumors in
-young subjects being more readily curable than in the aged or infirm.
-
-=Tumors, Malignant.=--Prognosis bad. If cancer in any form can be cured
-proof has escaped the author’s diligent search. It is wisest to refuse
-all cancerous cases.
-
-=Typhoid Fever.=--Prognosis excellent if adjustments are commenced
-during first week of fever, in which case the fever should be aborted
-at once, followed by one or two mild exacerbations, then permanently
-checked. Doubtful prognosis after first week, because of liability to
-perforation during adjustment. After second week of fever very grave
-prognosis under adjustment, and better with nursing alone.
-
-=Uteroversion--Prolapsus=.--Uteroversions and prolapses are corrected,
-sometimes rapidly but more often slowly and gradually. Favoring
-circumstances are freedom from overwork or overlifting. Some extreme
-cases result in failure.
-
-=Valvular Diseases.=--These may be grouped for prognosis. No
-percentages have been compiled, but it may be said that the prognosis
-is generally good as to relief and restoration of compensation,
-but poor as to rebuilding of the valves. Many cases of apparent
-permanent and complete recovery are probably simply cases of excellent
-compensation. Death occasionally occurs despite adjustments.
-
-=Varicocele.=--Outlook good for a slow, certain recovery.
-
-=Varicose Veins.=--Probability favors cure in subjects not beyond
-middle life, providing they are not greatly overweight or too much on
-their feet. Cure always slow.
-
-
-
-
-INDEX
-
-
- A
-
- Abdominal muscles, 248
-
- Abscesses, 323
-
- Acne, 323
-
- Adenoids of pharynx, 323
-
- Addison’s disease, 323
-
- Adiposis dolorosa, 323
-
- Adjuncts, 215
-
- Adjuncts, use of, 315
-
- Adjusting, contact in, 94
- definition of, 89
- general, 303
- how to learn, 164
- principles of, 89
- rapid movement in, 93
- specific, 303
- special technic of, 99
- speed in, 131
- technic of, 89
-
- Adjusting position, rules for, 127
-
- Adjusting tables, 284
-
- Adjustment, effect of, 186, 189
- object of, 90
- specific, 230
- vertebral, 89
-
- Adjustment of curvatures, 153
-
- Adjustments, coccygeal, 152
- frequency of, 302
- iliac, 150
- sacral, 150
- table of for any subluxation, 156
-
- Advertising, 290
-
- Age of subluxations, 84
-
- Alcoholism, 323
-
- Amenorrhoea, 324
-
- Anatomy, comparative, 226
- nervous, 234
-
- Anchor move, 116, 118
-
- Angina pectoris, 324
-
- Anidroses, 324
-
- Ankylosis, 58, 88, 324
-
- Anosmia, 324
-
- Anterior cervical move, 102, 103
- pisiform, 100
-
- Anterior fifth lumbar, 150
-
- Anterior poliomyelitis, 324
-
- Anterior subluxations, 84
-
- Aorta, abdominal, 250
- thoracic, 250
-
- Aphonia, 325
-
- Apoplexy, 325
-
- Appendicitis, 325
-
- Appendix, vermiform, 253
-
- Approximation, vertebral, 82
-
- Arm, anterior muscles of, 255
- posterior muscles of, 255
-
- Arteria centralis retinae, 243
-
- Arthritis deformans, 325
-
- Ascites, 326
-
- Asthma, 326
-
- Atlanto-occipital move, 106
-
- Atlas, 18
-
- Atlas move, 106
-
- Atlas palpation, 35
-
- Axis, 19
-
- Axis of body, 223
-
-
- B
-
- Back, muscles of, 247
-
- Bag punching, 97
-
- Bent process, 59
-
- Blindness, 326
-
- Bodily excesses, 200
-
- Body axis, 223
-
- Brachial plexus, 225, 236
-
- Bradycardia, 326
-
- Brain, 242
-
- Break move, the 107, 109, 110
-
- Bright’s disease, 326
-
- Bronchi, 249
-
- Bronchitis, 327
-
- Bladder, 253
-
-
- C
-
- Caecum, 253
-
- Caked Breast, 327
-
- Cards for collection, 291
-
- Caries of spine, 56, 154
-
- Case history, 297
-
- Causes, accessory chains of, 177
- direct chain of, 177
-
- Cause of disease, 165, 167
-
- Cause of disease, primary, 207
-
- Cause of disease, secondary, 185
-
- Cell, effect of impingement upon, 183
-
- Center place, 206
-
- Cerebrospinal meningitis, 327
-
- Cervical move, double contact, 120
-
- Cervical move, posterior, 119
-
- Cervical plexus, 238
-
- Chassaignac’s tubercle, 61
-
- Chickenpox, 327
-
- Chiropractice hypothesis, 172
-
- Chiropractic, limitations of, 312
-
- Choice of furnishings, 178
-
- Cholangitis, 327
-
- Cholecystitis, 327
-
- Chorea, 327
-
- Christian Science, 216, 315
-
- Cirrhosis of liver, 328
-
- Cleanliness, 286
-
- Coccyx, 17, 19, 45, 152
-
- Coeliac axis, 250
-
- Collection cards, 291
-
- Colon, 253
-
- Comparative anatomy, 226
-
- Concussion of forces, 178, 224, 226
-
- Congestion of liver, 328
-
- Conjunctiva, 243
-
- Conjunctivitis, 328
-
- Contact, close, 94
-
- Contact point, 129
-
- Constipation, 328
-
- Coryza, 328
-
- Count, 30, 33
- difficulties in, 34
- verifying, 33
-
- Cranial nerves, distribution of, 240
-
- Croup, 328
-
- Cure of bodily excess disease, 214
- dietetic disease, 212
- germ disease, 211
- exposure disease, 214
- mental disease, 212
- poisoning cases, 213
- simple subluxation disease, 208
- process of, 208
-
- Curvatures, 153
- causes of, 55
- compensatory, 57
- description of, 54
- record of, 56
- rotatory, 55
-
- Curves and curvatures, 53
-
-
- D
-
- Deafness, 329
-
- Diabetes insipidus, 329
- mellitus, 329
-
- Diagnosis, 231, 275, 298
-
- Diaphragm, 248
-
- Diarrhoea, 329
-
- Diet, 192, 193
-
- Dietetics, 315
-
- Dilatation of heart, 329
-
- Diphtheria, 187, 190, 329
-
- Direction of subluxation, 25
-
- Disease, cause of, 165
- functional, 166
- organic, 166
-
- Diseases and adjustments, 257
- table of, 258
-
- Displacements, 84
-
- Door sign, 290
-
- Double contact move, 120
-
- Double transverse moves, 135, 138, 139, 148
-
- Dressing room, 286
-
- Dropsy, 330
-
- Drugs, 315
-
- Duodenum, 252
-
- Dysentery, 330
-
- Dyspepsia, 330
-
-
- E
-
- Ear, 245
-
- Edge contact, the, 144
-
- Effect of adjustment, 188, 189
-
- Effect of subluxations, 79
-
- Elbow joint, 255
-
- Electricity, 216, 315
-
- Enuresis, 330
-
- Epidemics, 189
-
- Epilepsy, 330
-
- Epiphysis, absent, 60
-
- Epistaxis, 331
-
- Erysipelas, 331
-
- Eustachian tube, 245
-
- Evidence, kinds of acceptable, 234
-
- Examination, schedule of, 292
- special, 296
-
- Excesses, bodily, 200
-
- Excitation, 162
-
- Exposure, 198
-
- Eye, 242
-
-
- F
-
- Fallopian tubes, 254
-
- Fasting, 215
-
- Fear, 201
-
- Fees, 291
-
- Fever, 205
-
- Fever center, 206
-
- Fibrocartilages, intervertebral, 83
-
- First appearance, value of, 277
-
- Foods, 194
-
- Foot, 257
-
- Force in adjusting, 98
-
- Freidrich’s ataxia, 331
-
- Frequency of adjustments, 302
-
- Furniture, arrangement of, 282
- office, 278
-
-
- G
-
- Gallstones, 331
-
- Ganglion, ciliary, 243
-
- Gasserian, 244
- middle cervical, 247
- sphenopalatine, 244, 246
- superior cervical, 244, 246
-
- Gastralgia, 332
-
- Gastric ulcer, 332
-
- Gastritis, 332
-
- General adjusting, 303
-
- Germ diseases, 185
-
- Germs, 185
- pathogenic, 185
-
- Gland, thyroid, 247
- prostate, 253
-
- Glands, salivary, 246
- suprarenal, 252
-
- Gluteus maximus muscle, 256
-
- Goitre, 332
-
- Gonorrhoeal rheumatism, 332
-
- Group method, the, 37
- example of, 39
-
- Gums, 245
-
-
- H
-
- Habits, 15
-
- Hay fever, 332
-
- Headache, 332
-
- Heart, 249
-
- Heat-regulating mechanism, 203
-
- Heel contact, the, 133
-
- Hemorrhoids, 333
-
- Hernia, 333
-
- Hip joint, 255
-
- History of case, 297
-
- Hodgkins’ disease, 333
-
- Hook support, 105
-
- Hydrocephalus, 333
-
- Hydrotherapy, 315
-
- Hyperaemia, 202
-
- Hypertrophy, 333
-
- Hypothesis, chiropractic, 172
-
- Hysteria, 333
-
-
- I
-
- Ileum, 252
-
- Iliac adjustments, 150
-
- Ilium, 150
-
- Immunity, 334
-
- Impingement of nerves, 180, 209
-
- Impotence, 334
-
- Individual subluxation, 40
-
- Infection, 186
-
- Inflammation, 202
-
- Influenza, 334
-
- Inhibition, 169, 182, 189
-
- Insanity, 201, 334
-
- Interiliac line, 34, 62
-
- Intervertebral disks, 83
-
- Intervertebral foramina, 18
-
- Intestinal obstruction, 335
-
- Iris, 243
-
- Irritable heart, 335
-
- Irritability, 169
-
-
- J
-
- Jaundice, 335
-
- Jejunum, 252
-
-
- K
-
- Key, 39
-
- Kidneys, 252
-
- Klebs-Loeffler bacillus, 187
-
- Knee joint, 256
-
- Knife move, 144
-
- Kyphosis, 54
-
-
- L
-
- Landmarks, 61
-
- Laryngitis, 335
-
- Larynx, 246
-
- Last finger contact, 102
-
- Lateral cervical move, 107, 109, 110
-
- Lateral displacements, 84
-
- Law of momentum, 98
-
- Leg, anterior muscles of, 256
- posterior muscles of, 256
-
- Leucorrhoea, 335
-
- Library, reference, 289
-
- Limitations of Chiropractic, 212
-
- Liver, 251
-
- Location of subluxations, 78
-
- Lordosis, 54, 85
-
- Lumbago, 335
-
- Lumbar, anterior, 150
-
- Lumbar plexus, 239
-
- Lungs, 249
-
-
- M
-
- Maladjustment, 89
-
- Malaria, 335
-
- Major subluxations, 39
-
- Massage, 215, 315
-
- Mastoiditis, 336
-
- Measles, 336
-
- Meckel’s ganglion, 244
-
- Mechano-therapy, 315
-
- Medicine, 315, 316
-
- Meniere’s disease, 336
-
- Meninges, 242
-
- Menorrhagia, 336
-
- Mental attitude, 63
-
- Mental states, abnormal, 201
-
- Metrorrhagia, 336
-
- Migraine, 336
-
- Minor subluxations, 39
-
- Mixing, 315
-
- Morikubo move, 99
-
- Motor reaction, 193, 196, 199
-
- Movable kidney, 336
-
- Movement for correction, 27
-
- Muscles of abdomen, 244
- of back, 247
- of neck, 247
- of perineum, 249
-
- Muscular control, 97
-
- Muscular suggestion, 96
-
- Myelitis, 336
-
- Myocarditis, 336
-
- Myxoedema, 337
-
-
- N
-
- Naprapathy, 313
-
- Napravit, 313
-
- Neck, muscles of, 247
-
- Nephritis, 337
-
- Nerve, auditory, 245
- chorda tympani, 246
- great sciatic, 256
- hypoglossal, 245
- inferior maxillary, 244
- internal carotid, 242
- olfactory, 243
- phrenic, 248
- recurrent laryngeal, 246
- trigeminal (trifacial), 244
- Vidian, 244
-
- Nerve connections, special, 235
-
- Nerve impingement, 180, 182, 209
-
- Nerve paths, 70
-
- Nerve pathways, important, 242
- structure of, 241
-
- Nerves, cranial, 240
- optic, 242
- spinal, 237
- splanchnic, 250
- sympathetic, 240
- traceable, 64
-
- Nerve system, 171, 222
- development of, 219, 220
- outline of, 235
- sympathetic, 171
-
- Nerve-tracing, 64, 296
- errors in, 73
- place of in diagnosis, 67
- suggestion in, 67
- technic of, 68
-
- Neuralgia, 337
-
- Neurasthenia, 337
-
- Neuritis, 337
-
- Neurology, 234
-
- Neuron, 220
-
-
- O
-
- Observation of patient, 294
-
- Occipital subluxations, 66
-
- Occipito-atlantal move, 106
-
- Occlusion of foramina, 180
-
- Office equipment, 277
-
- Optic atrophy, 337
-
- Optic nerve, 242
-
- Oral suggestion, 95
-
- Organs, effect of impingement upon, 183
-
- Organ-tracing, 64
-
- Osteopathy, 216, 313, 314, 315
-
- Ovaries, 254
-
- Ovaritis, 337
-
- Overadjustment, 303
-
-
- P
-
- Palpation, atlas, 35
- cervical, 42, 47, 48
- coccygeal, 45
- difficulties in, 59
- dorsal, 43, 46
- habits of, 15
- lumbar, 44, 46
- pelvic, 44
- sacral, 44
- transverse, 49
- vertebral, 15, 295
-
- Pancreas, 251
-
- Paralysis agitans, 337
-
- Parotitis, 338
-
- Pectoralis muscles, 254
-
- Penis, 253
-
- Pericarditis, 338
-
- Pericardium, 249
-
- Perineal muscles, 249
-
- Peritoneum, 252
-
- Peritonitis, 338
-
- Personality, 319
-
- Pertussis, 338
-
- Pharyngitis, 338
-
- Pharynx, 246
-
- Pisiform anterior cervical move, 100
-
- Pisiform contact, 125, 135, 139, 141, 146
-
- Pleurisy, 338
-
- Plexus, abdominal aortic, 253, 254
- Auerbach’s, 251
- brachial, 238, 254
- cardiac, 249
- carotid, 244
- cavernous, 243
- cervical, 238
- coelic, 250, 252
- cystic, 251
-
- Plexus, gastric, 251
- hemorrhoidal, 253
- hepatic, 251, 252
- hypogastric, 253
- inferior mesenteric, 253
- lumbar, 239
- lumbosacral, 255
- Meissner’s, 251
- ovarian, 254
- pelvic, 253
- pharyngeal, 246
- phrenic, 248
- prostatic, 253
- pudendal, 239, 254
- pulmonary, 249
- renal, 252
- sacral, 239, 254
- solar, 250
- spermatic, 253, 254
- splenic, 251
- superior mesenteric, 251, 252
- suprarenal, 252
- uterovaginal, 254
- vesical, 253
-
- Pneumonia, 339
-
- Point 2 contact, 144
-
- Poisons, 197
-
- Position A, 22
-
- Position B, 23
-
- Position C, 23
-
- Positions for palpation, 30
-
- Posterior cervical move, 119
-
- Posterior subluxations, 85
-
- Potts’ disease, 56, 154, 339
-
- Practice, 276
-
- Preferable adjustments, 155
-
- Pregnancy, 339
-
- Preparation of patient, 22
-
- Presumptive statements, 235
-
- Private office, 282
-
- Process, bent spinous, 59
-
- Processes, spinous, 20
- transverse, 21
-
- Prognosis, 322
- general, 323
-
- Prolapsus, 345
-
- Promises to patients, 306
-
- Prostate gland, 253
-
- Prostatic enlargement, 340
-
- Psychoses, 201
-
- Pudendal plexus, 239
-
- Pulmonary tuberculosis, 340
-
-
- Q
-
- Quinsy, 343
-
-
- R
-
- Rachitis, 340
-
- Rami communicantes, 172
- white, 250
-
- Recoil, name of, 132, 133
- the, 125
- uses of, 131
-
- Record, the, 23
- the complete, 29
- sample of, 29
- use of, 30
-
- Rectum, 253
-
- Reference library, 289
-
- Reflex arcs, 241
-
- Relaxation, 95
-
- Rest room, 287
-
- Retina, 242
- central artery of, 243
-
- Retinal hemorrhage, 340
-
- Retracing of disease, 211, 309
-
- Rheumatic fever, 341
-
- Rheumatism, 341
-
- Roll, the, 285
-
- Rotary move, the, 111, 115, 116
-
- Rotation, axis of, 80
- vertebral, 80
-
- Rubella, 341
-
- Rules for adjusting positions, 127
-
-
- S
-
- Sacrum, 17, 19, 149
-
- Sacral adjustments, 149
-
- Sacral plexus, 239
-
- Salivary glands, 246
-
- Sample record, 29
-
- Scarlet fever, 341
-
- Schedule of examination, 292
-
- Schneiderian membrane, 243
-
- Scoliosis, 55
-
- Scrotum, 254
-
- Second metacarpal contact, 103
-
- Segmentation, 219, 229
-
- Selecting movement, 156
-
- Seminal emissions, 341
-
- Seminal vesicles, 258
-
- Sensor areas of lower extremity, 257
-
- Serratus magnus muscle, 255
-
- Serum-therapy, 186, 315
-
- Shoulder joint, 255
-
- Signs, 290
-
- Simple continued fever, 341
-
- Single transverse moves, 141, 142, 146
-
- Smallpox, 342
-
- Smell, 243
-
- Special cases, 301
-
- Special nerve connections, 235
-
- Specific adjustment, 230, 303
-
- Spinal column, 16, 222
-
- Spinal nerves, distribution of, 237
-
- Spine, 16
-
- Spino-organic connection, 217
-
- Spinous, bent 59
-
- Spinous process, 20
-
- Splanchnoptosis, 342
-
- Spleen, 251
-
- Splenic enlargement, 342
-
- Splenitis, 342
-
- Spondylitis deformans, 342
-
- Spondylotherapy, 215, 313, 315
-
- Spread move, 148
-
- Stimulation, 169, 189
-
- Stomach, 251
-
- Strabismus, 342
-
- Subluxation, 217
- direction of, 25
- effect of, 179
- the individual, 40
- theory, 172
-
- Subluxations, age of, 87
- anterior, 84
- contiguous, 37
- effect of, 79
- increase of, 191, 193, 196, 199
-
- Subluxations, inferior, 83
- lateral, 84
- law governing location of, 78
- major, 39
- minor, 39
- occipital, 86
- posterior, 85
- production of, 76
- secondary causes of, 77
- superior, 83
- varieties of, 80
-
- Suggestion, muscular, 96
- oral, 95
-
- Suggestive therapeutics, 315
-
- Sunstroke, 342
-
- Supporting head in adjusting, 105
-
- Suprarenal capsules, 252
-
- Susceptibility, 186
-
- Sympathetic, cervical, 242
-
- Sympathetic nerves, distribution of, 240
-
- Sympathetic nerve system, 171
-
- Syphilis, 342
-
-
- T
-
- Tabes dorsalis, 343
-
- Table of diseases and adjustments, 257
-
- Table of subluxations and moves, 155
-
- Tachycardia, 343
-
- Talking points, 306
-
- Teeth, 245
-
- Tenderness 69, 71
-
- Tension, 181
-
- Testes, 254
-
- Tetanus, 343
-
- Theory of Chiropractic, 172
-
- Theory, subluxation, 172
-
- Thigh, 255, 256
-
- Thoracic aneurism, 343
-
- Thoracic nerves, 238
-
- Thrust, 91
-
- Thumb move, 121, 123
-
- Thyroid gland, 247
-
- Tipping, vertebral, 82
-
- T. M., 121, 123
-
- Tongue, 245
-
- Tonsilitis, 343
-
- Tonsils, 246
-
- Torticollis, 344
-
- Trachea, 249
-
- Transmitted shock, 91
-
- Transverse adjusting, 135, 138, 139, 141, 143, 146, 148
-
- Transverses, 21
-
- Trauma, effect of, 174, 178
-
- Tube, eustachian, 245
- fallopian, 254
-
- Tuberculosis, pulmonary, 344
-
- Tumors, benign, 344
- malignant, 344
-
- Typhoid fever, 189, 344
-
-
- U
-
- Underscoring, 26
-
- Ureters, 253
-
- Urethra, 253
-
- Use of adjuncts, 315
-
- Uterus, 254
-
- Uteroversion, 345
-
-
- V
-
- Vagina, 254
-
- Valvular disease, 345
-
- Variations in number of vertebrae, 60
-
- Varieties of subluxation, 80
-
- Varicocele, 345
-
- Varicose veins, 345
-
- Vermiform appendix, 253
-
- Vertebrae, 16
- cervical, 16
- dorsal, 16
- lumbar, 16
- variations in number of, 16, 60
-
- Vertebral palpation, 15, 295
-
- Vertebra prominens, 17, 19
-
- Vital energy, 169
-
- Visceral nerves, 239, 253
-
-
- W
-
- Waiting room, 280
-
- Worry, 201
-
-
-
-
-Transcriber’s Notes
-
-
-Punctuation, hyphenation, and spelling were made consistent when a
-predominant preference was found in this book; otherwise they were not
-changed.
-
-Simple typographical errors were corrected; occasional unbalanced
-quotation marks retained.
-
-Ambiguous hyphens at the ends of lines were retained.
-
-The hierarchy of the Table of Contents has been used as the guide to
-the rest of the book, even though the two sometimes differ.
-
-Index not checked for proper alphabetization or correct page references.
-
-Page 26: “P R S” has an underline below “P” and a double-underline
-below “R”.
-
-Page 34: “flexed far toward” perhaps should be “forward”.
-
-Page 79: “as well all the details” may be missing “as” after “well”.
-
-Page 117: “all vertebra above, so to speak” perhaps should be
-“vertebrae”.
-
-Page 147: “this move is predicated” was printed as “this more was
-predicated”; changed here.
-
-Page 158: “Posterior, right, inferior--P. R. I.” was printed as
-“P. R. L.”; changed here.
-
-Page 187: “but is claimed” probably should be “but it is claimed”.
-
-Page 307: “has been builded” was printed that way.
-
-
-
-
-
-End of the Project Gutenberg EBook of Technic and Practice of Chiropractic, by
-Joy Maxwell Loban
-
-*** END OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK TECHNIC AND PRACTICE ***
-
-***** This file should be named 54008-0.txt or 54008-0.zip *****
-This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
- http://www.gutenberg.org/5/4/0/0/54008/
-
-Produced by Turgut Dincer, Charlie Howard, and the Online
-Distributed Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net (This
-file was produced from images generously made available
-by The Internet Archive)
-
-
-Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions
-will be renamed.
-
-Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no
-one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation
-(and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without
-permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules,
-set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to
-copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to
-protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project
-Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you
-charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you
-do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the
-rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose
-such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and
-research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do
-practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is
-subject to the trademark license, especially commercial
-redistribution.
-
-
-
-*** START: FULL LICENSE ***
-
-THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
-PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
-
-To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
-distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
-(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
-Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project
-Gutenberg-tm License (available with this file or online at
-http://gutenberg.org/license).
-
-
-Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works
-
-1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
-and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
-(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
-the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy
-all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession.
-If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the
-terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or
-entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8.
-
-1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
-used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
-agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
-things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
-paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement
-and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
-works. See paragraph 1.E below.
-
-1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the Foundation"
-or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the
-collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an
-individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are
-located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from
-copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative
-works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg
-are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project
-Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by
-freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of
-this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with
-the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by
-keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project
-Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others.
-
-1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
-what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in
-a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check
-the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement
-before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or
-creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project
-Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning
-the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United
-States.
-
-1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
-
-1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate
-access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently
-whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the
-phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the phrase "Project
-Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed,
-copied or distributed:
-
-This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
-almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
-re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
-with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org/license
-
-1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived
-from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is
-posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied
-and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees
-or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work
-with the phrase "Project Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the
-work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1
-through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the
-Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or
-1.E.9.
-
-1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
-with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
-must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional
-terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked
-to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the
-permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work.
-
-1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
-License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
-work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
-
-1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
-electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
-prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
-active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm License.
-
-1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
-compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any
-word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or
-distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than
-"Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official version
-posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.org),
-you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a
-copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon
-request, of the work in its original "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other
-form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm
-License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
-
-1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
-performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
-unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
-
-1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
-access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided
-that
-
-- You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
- the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
- you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is
- owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he
- has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the
- Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments
- must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you
- prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax
- returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and
- sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the
- address specified in Section 4, "Information about donations to
- the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation."
-
-- You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
- you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
- does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
- License. You must require such a user to return or
- destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium
- and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of
- Project Gutenberg-tm works.
-
-- You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any
- money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
- electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days
- of receipt of the work.
-
-- You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
- distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
-
-1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set
-forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from
-both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael
-Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the
-Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
-
-1.F.
-
-1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
-effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
-public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm
-collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
-works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain
-"Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or
-corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual
-property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a
-computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by
-your equipment.
-
-1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
-of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
-liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
-fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
-LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
-PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
-TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
-LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
-INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
-DAMAGE.
-
-1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
-defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
-receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
-written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
-received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with
-your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with
-the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a
-refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity
-providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to
-receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy
-is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further
-opportunities to fix the problem.
-
-1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
-in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS' WITH NO OTHER
-WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
-WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
-
-1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
-warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages.
-If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the
-law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be
-interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by
-the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any
-provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions.
-
-1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
-trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
-providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance
-with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production,
-promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works,
-harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees,
-that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do
-or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm
-work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any
-Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause.
-
-
-Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
-electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers
-including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists
-because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from
-people in all walks of life.
-
-Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
-assistance they need, are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
-goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
-remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
-and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations.
-To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
-and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4
-and the Foundation web page at http://www.pglaf.org.
-
-
-Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive
-Foundation
-
-The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
-501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
-state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
-Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
-number is 64-6221541. Its 501(c)(3) letter is posted at
-http://pglaf.org/fundraising. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg
-Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent
-permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
-
-The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S.
-Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered
-throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at
-809 North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887, email
-business@pglaf.org. Email contact links and up to date contact
-information can be found at the Foundation's web site and official
-page at http://pglaf.org
-
-For additional contact information:
- Dr. Gregory B. Newby
- Chief Executive and Director
- gbnewby@pglaf.org
-
-
-Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
-Literary Archive Foundation
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
-spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
-increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
-freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
-array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
-($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
-status with the IRS.
-
-The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
-charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
-States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
-considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
-with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
-where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To
-SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any
-particular state visit http://pglaf.org
-
-While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
-have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
-against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
-approach us with offers to donate.
-
-International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
-any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
-outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
-
-Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
-methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
-ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations.
-To donate, please visit: http://pglaf.org/donate
-
-
-Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
-works.
-
-Professor Michael S. Hart is the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm
-concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared
-with anyone. For thirty years, he produced and distributed Project
-Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support.
-
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
-editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S.
-unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily
-keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition.
-
-
-Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility:
-
- http://www.gutenberg.org
-
-This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
-including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
-subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
diff --git a/old/54008-0.zip b/old/54008-0.zip
deleted file mode 100644
index 1b1d26f..0000000
--- a/old/54008-0.zip
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54008-h.zip b/old/54008-h.zip
deleted file mode 100644
index c808e08..0000000
--- a/old/54008-h.zip
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54008-h/54008-h.htm b/old/54008-h/54008-h.htm
deleted file mode 100644
index b9d0b5b..0000000
--- a/old/54008-h/54008-h.htm
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,14478 +0,0 @@
-<!DOCTYPE html PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD XHTML 1.0 Strict//EN"
- "http://www.w3.org/TR/xhtml1/DTD/xhtml1-strict.dtd">
-<html xmlns="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xml:lang="en" lang="en">
- <head>
- <meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html;charset=utf-8" />
- <meta http-equiv="Content-Style-Type" content="text/css" />
- <title>
- The Project Gutenberg eBook of Technic and Practice Of Chiropractic, by Joy M. Loban.
- </title>
- <link rel="coverpage" href="images/cover.jpg" />
- <style type="text/css">
-
-body {
- margin-left: 2.5em;
- margin-right: 2.5em;
-}
-
-h1,h2, h3 {
- text-align: center;
- clear: both;
- margin-top: 2.5em;
- margin-bottom: 1em;
-}
-
-h4 {text-align: left;
- margin-top: 1em;
- margin-bottom: 0;
- font-weight: bold;
- font-size: 120%;
-}
-h4+p {margin-top: .1em;}
-
-h1 {line-height: 1;}
-
-h2.chap {margin-bottom: 0;}
-h2+p {margin-top: 1.5em;}
-h2 .subhead {display: block; margin-top: 1em; margin-bottom: 1em;}
-
-.transnote h2 {
- margin-top: .5em;
- margin-bottom: 1em;
-}
-
-.subhead {
- text-indent: 0;
- text-align: center;
- font-size: smaller;
-}
-
-p {
- text-indent: 1.75em;
- margin-top: .51em;
- margin-bottom: .24em;
- text-align: justify;
-}
-.caption p {text-align: center; text-indent: 0;}
-p.center {text-indent: 0;}
-
-.p0 {margin-top: 0em;}
-.p1 {margin-top: 1em;}
-.p2 {margin-top: 2em;}
-.p4 {margin-top: 4em;}
-.vspace {line-height: 1.5;}
-
-.in0 {text-indent: 0;}
-.in2 {padding-left: 2em;}
-.l2 {padding-right: 2em;}
-.l4 {padding-right: 4em;}
-
-.small {font-size: 70%;}
-.smaller {font-size: 85%;}
-.larger {font-size: 125%;}
-
-p.drop-cap {text-indent: 0; margin-bottom: 1.1em;}
-p.drop-cap:first-letter {
- float: left;
- margin: .22em .3em 0 0;
- font-size: 210%;
- line-height:0.7em;
- text-indent: 0em;
- clear: both;
- font-weight: bold;
-}
-p.drop-cap .smcap1 {margin-left: -.6em;}
-p .smcap1 {font-size: 125%;}
-.smcap1 {font-variant: small-caps;}
-
-.center {text-align: center;}
-
-.smcap {font-variant: small-caps;}
-.smcap.smaller {font-size: 75%;}
-
-hr {
- width: 33%;
- margin-top: 4em;
- margin-bottom: 4em;
- margin-left: 33%;
- margin-right: auto;
- clear: both;
-}
-
-table {
- margin-left: auto;
- margin-right: auto;
- max-width: 80%;
- border-collapse: collapse;
-}
-
-.tdl {
- text-align: left;
- vertical-align: top;
- padding-right: 1em;
- padding-left: 1.5em;
- text-indent: -1.5em;
-}
-#toc .tdl {padding-left: 3.25em;}
-
-#toc tr.chap .tdl {
- padding-left: 1.5em;
- padding-top: .5em;
- font-size: 105%;
-}
-
-#toc tr.chap .tdr {padding-top: .5em;}
-
-.tdc {text-align: center;}
-
-#adjustments .hdr, #diseases .hdr {
- font-size: 120%;
- font-weight: bold;
- padding-top: 1.5em;
- padding-bottom: .5em;
-}
-#adjustments .tdl {padding-left: 1em; text-indent: -1em;}
-#adjustments .tdl.note {padding-top: .5em; padding-bottom: .5em;}
-
-.tdr {
- text-align: right;
- vertical-align: bottom;
- padding-left: .3em;
- white-space: nowrap;
-}
-
-.pagenum {
- position: absolute;
- right: 4px;
- text-indent: 0em;
- text-align: right;
- font-size: 70%;
- font-weight: normal;
- font-variant: normal;
- font-style: normal;
- letter-spacing: normal;
- line-height: normal;
- color: #acacac;
- border: 1px solid #acacac;
- background: #ffffff;
- padding: 1px 2px;
-}
-
-.figcenter {
- margin: 2em auto 2em auto;
- text-align: center;
- page-break-inside: avoid;
- max-width: 100%;
-}
-
-img {
- padding: 1em 0 0 0;
- max-width: 100%;
- height: auto;
-}
-
-.caption {text-align: center; margin-top: 0;}
-.captionl {text-align: left;}
-
-.captionr {text-align: right; font-size: 85%;}
-.figcenter p.hang {padding-left: 4.5em; text-indent: -4.5em; margin: auto;}
-
-ul {margin-left: 3em; padding-left: 0;}
-li {list-style-type: none; padding-left: 2em; text-indent: -2.5em; text-align: left;}
-
-.fnanchor {
- vertical-align: 80%;
- line-height: .7;
- font-size: .75em;
- text-decoration: none;
-}
-
-.index {margin-left: 1em;}
-ul.index {padding-left: 0;}
-li {list-style-type: none;}
-li.indx, li.ifrst {list-style-type: none; padding-left: 3em; text-indent: -3em; padding-top: .2em;}
-li.isub1 {padding-left: 3em; text-indent: -2em;}
-li.ifrst {margin-top: 2em; margin-bottom: 1em; font-weight: bold; text-indent: 0; padding-left: 4em;}
-
-.hang {
- margin: .5em 5% 3em 5%;
- text-align: justify;
- padding-left: 1.5em;
- text-indent: -1.5em;
-}
-
-.transnote {
- background-color: #EEE;
- border: thin dotted;
- font-family: sans-serif, serif;
- color: #000;
- margin-left: 5%;
- margin-right: 5%;
- margin-top: 4em;
- margin-bottom: 2em;
- padding: 1em;
-}
-.covernote {visibility: hidden; display: none;}
-
-.fright {float: right; clear: both; margin-bottom: 4em;}
-.narrow {max-width: 30em; margin: auto;}
-.sigright {
- margin-right: 2em;
- text-align: right;}
-
-.undersingle {border-bottom: thin solid black;}
-.underdouble {border-bottom: .3em double black;}
-
-.wspace {word-spacing: .3em;}
-
-@media print, handheld
-{
- h1, .chapter, .newpage {page-break-before: always;}
- h1.nobreak, h2.nobreak, .nobreak {page-break-before: avoid; padding-top: 0;}
- h2, h3, h4 {page-break-after: avoid;}
- .intact {page-break-inside: avoid;}
-
- p {
- margin-top: .5em;
- text-align: justify;
- margin-bottom: .25em;
- }
-
- table {width: 100%; max-width: 100%; margin-left: 2em;}
- table#toc {margin-left: 0;}
-
- .tdl {
- padding-left: 1em;
- text-indent: -1em;
- padding-right: 0;
- }
-
- p.drop-cap {text-indent: 0; margin-bottom: .24em;}
- p.drop-cap:first-letter {
- float: none;
- font-size: 200%;
- margin-left: 0;
- margin-right: 0;
- text-indent: 0;
- }
-
- p.drop-cap .smcap1 {margin-left: 0;}
- p .smcap1 {font-size: 100%;}
- .smcap1 {font-variant: normal;}
-
-}
-
-@media handheld
-{
- body {margin: 0;}
-
- hr {
- margin-top: .1em;
- margin-bottom: .1em;
- visibility: hidden;
- color: white;
- width: .01em;
- display: none;
- }
-
- ul {margin-left: 1em; padding-left: 0;}
- li {list-style-type: none; padding-left: 1em; text-indent: -1.5em;}
-
- .hang {margin: .5em 3% 2em 3%;}
-
- .transnote {
- page-break-inside: avoid;
- margin-left: 2%;
- margin-right: 2%;
- margin-top: 1em;
- margin-bottom: 1em;
- padding: .5em;
- }
-
- .index {margin-left: 0;}
-
- .covernote {visibility: visible; display: block; text-align: center;}
-}
- </style>
- </head>
-
-<body>
-
-
-<pre>
-
-The Project Gutenberg EBook of Technic and Practice of Chiropractic, by
-Joy Maxwell Loban
-
-This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
-almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
-re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
-with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org/license
-
-
-Title: Technic and Practice of Chiropractic
-
-Author: Joy Maxwell Loban
-
-Release Date: January 18, 2017 [EBook #54008]
-
-Language: English
-
-Character set encoding: UTF-8
-
-*** START OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK TECHNIC AND PRACTICE ***
-
-
-
-
-Produced by Turgut Dincer, Charlie Howard, and the Online
-Distributed Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net (This
-file was produced from images generously made available
-by The Internet Archive)
-
-
-
-
-
-
-</pre>
-
-
-<div class="transnote covernote">
-<p class="center">Transcriber’s Note:
-Cover created by Transcriber and placed in the Public Domain.</p>
-</div>
-
-<h1 class="vspace wspace">TECHNIC AND PRACTICE<br />
-<span class="small">OF</span><br />
-<span class="larger">CHIROPRACTIC</span></h1>
-
-<p class="p2 center vspace">BY<br />
-<span class="larger wspace">JOY M. LOBAN, D. C., <span class="smcap">Ph. C.</span></span></p>
-
-<p class="p1 center smaller wspace">Professor of Anatomy and of Theory and Practice of Chiropractic
-at the Universal Chiropractic College. Formerly<br />
-Professor of Chiropractic Analysis at the<br />
-Palmer School of Chiropractic</p>
-
-<p class="p2 center larger"><span class="wspace">SECOND EDITION</span><br />
-<span class="smaller"><i>Revised and Enlarged</i></span></p>
-
-<p class="p2 center vspace wspace"><span class="smaller">PUBLISHED BY</span><br />
-<span class="larger">UNIVERSAL CHIROPRACTIC COLLEGE</span><br />
-DAVENPORT, IOWA<br />
-<span class="larger">1915</span></p>
-
-<hr />
-
-<div class="narrow">
-<p class="newpage p4 center vspace smaller">
-<span class="smcap">Copyright 1915</span><br />
-BY<br />
-<span class="larger">JOY M. LOBAN</span>
-</p>
-
-<div class="p2 fright">
-<p class="p0 center small">
-HAMMOND PRESS<br />
-W. B. CONKEY COMPANY<br />
-CHICAGO
-</p>
-</div>
-</div>
-
-<hr />
-
-<div class="newpage p4 narrow">
-<p class="p0 center vspace">
-THIS BOOK IS<br />
-<b class="larger">Dedicated</b><br />
-TO THE GIRL WHO HAS BEEN MY STAFF<br />
-AND LANTERN, AIDING AND LIGHTING<br />
-ME ON MY WAY IN THIS NEW FIELD<br />
-<b class="larger">My Wife</b>
-</p>
-</div>
-
-<hr />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_7">7</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<h2><a id="TABLE_OF_CONTENTS"></a>TABLE OF CONTENTS</h2>
-</div>
-
-<table id="toc" summary="Table of Contents">
- <tr>
- <td> </td>
- <td class="tdr"><span class="smcap">Page</span></td></tr>
- <tr class="chap">
- <td class="tdl"><b>Preface to First Edition</b></td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_1">9</a></td></tr>
- <tr class="chap">
- <td class="tdl"><b>Preface to Second Edition</b></td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_2">11</a></td></tr>
- <tr class="chap">
- <td class="tdl"><b>Introduction</b></td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_3">13</a></td></tr>
- <tr class="chap">
- <td class="tdl"><b>Vertebral Palpation</b></td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_4">15</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Definition</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_5">15</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">General Propositions</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_6">15</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Habits of Palpation</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_7">15</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Facts Concerning the Spine</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_8">16</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Preparation of Patient</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_9">22</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Position of Patient</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_10">22</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">The Record</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_11">23</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">The Count</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_12">29</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Atlas Palpation</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_13">35</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">The Group Method</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_14">37</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">The Individual Subluxation</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_15">40</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Palpation in Position B</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_16">46</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Palpation in Position C</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_17">48</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Transverse Palpation</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_18">49</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Curves and Curvatures</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_19">53</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Difficulties in Palpation</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_20">59</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Landmarks</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_21">61</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Mental Attitude</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_22">63</a></td></tr>
- <tr class="chap">
- <td class="tdl"><b>Nerve Tracing</b></td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_23">64</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Organ Tracing</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_24">64</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">What Nerves are Traceable</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_25">64</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Suggestion</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_26">67</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Place in Diagnosis</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_27">67</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Technic of Nerve Tracing</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_28">68</a></td></tr>
- <tr class="chap">
- <td class="tdl"><b>Subluxations</b></td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_29">76</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Definition—How Produced</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_30">76</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Law Governing Location of</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_31">78</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Varieties of Subluxations</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_32">80</a></td></tr>
- <tr class="chap">
- <td class="tdl"><b>Technic of Adjusting</b></td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_33">89</a><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_8">8</a></span></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">General Principles of Adjusting</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_34">89</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Special Technic (Thirty-two Moves)</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_35">99</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Preferable Adjustments</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_36">155</a></td></tr>
- <tr class="chap">
- <td class="tdl"><b>The Cause of Disease</b></td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_37">165</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Simple Subluxation Disease</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_38">184</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Secondary Causes</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_39">185</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Germ Diseases</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_40">185</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Diet</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_41">192</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Poisons</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_42">194</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Exposure</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_43">198</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Bodily Excesses</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_44">201</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Inflammation</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_45">202</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">The Process of Cure</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_46">208</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Adjuncts</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_47">215</a></td></tr>
- <tr class="chap">
- <td class="tdl"><b>Spino-Organic Connection</b></td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_48">217</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">General Discussion</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_49">217</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Special Nerve Connections</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_50">235</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Table of Diseases and Adjustments</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_51">257</a></td></tr>
- <tr class="chap">
- <td class="tdl"><b>Practice</b></td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_52">276</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Office Equipment</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_53">277</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Schedule of Examination</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_54">292</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Necessity for Correct Diagnosis</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_55">298</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Frequency of Adjustments</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_56">302</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Specific vs. General Adjusting</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_57">303</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Talking Points</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_58">306</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Promises to Patients</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_59">308</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Retracing of Disease</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_60">309</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Limitations of Chiropractic</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_61">312</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">The Use of Adjuncts</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_62">315</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Personality</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_63">319</a></td></tr>
- <tr class="chap">
- <td class="tdl"><b>Chiropractic Prognosis</b></td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_64">322</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">General Discussion</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_65">322</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Practical Prognosis</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#h_66">323</a></td></tr>
-</table>
-
-<hr />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_9">9</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<h2 id="h_1"><a id="Preface_to_First_Edition"></a>Preface to First Edition</h2>
-</div>
-
-<p class="drop-cap"><span class="smcap1">This</span> little work is offered to the profession without
-apology for its brevity or its form. It has been
-prepared because of an immediate and pressing need
-for such a guide in our colleges, and is offered abroad under
-the impression that many practicing Chiropractors feel the
-same need.</p>
-
-<p>It is intended for handy reference and clinical use and
-is arranged as systematically as possible, style being everywhere
-sacrificed to utility.</p>
-
-<p>The author lays no claim to the origination of any of
-the subject matter of this book nor to having invented any
-of the movements described under Technic of Adjusting.
-The arrangement and phraseology are in the main original.
-The intention has been merely to condense into practical
-and convenient form for students and practitioners certain
-knowledge now held and utilized in our profession.</p>
-
-<p>The author feels himself indebted to the entire profession
-for the information embodied in this work, and to
-scientists of all time upon the results of whose infinite and
-painstaking research are based our present day advancement;
-to the many friends and co-workers whose valuable
-criticisms and suggestions have aided in this labor; and to
-his students, past and present, who have furnished the necessary<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_10">10</a></span>
-encouragement and inspiration for the achievement
-of this, the author’s first text-book.</p>
-
-<p>The chief merit of this effort—if merit there be—is its
-honesty. The author has endeavored to set forth fairly and
-simply the facts and hypotheses with which we have to
-deal. Its chief offense, in the eyes of many, will lie in its
-being just what it purports to be—a book on Chiropractic.
-Constructive criticism and suggestion are invited from all
-sources, for by our interchange of thoughts we grow.</p>
-
-<p class="sigright">J. M. L.</p>
-
-<hr />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_11">11</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<h2 id="h_2"><a id="Preface_to_Second_Edition"></a>Preface to Second Edition</h2>
-</div>
-
-<p class="drop-cap"><span class="smcap1">The</span> republication of this book has been made possible
-by the sustained friendship of the profession for it,
-and the author’s thanks are due its many buyers and
-readers who, by their recommendation, have made it both
-possible and necessary that this book should live and grow.</p>
-
-<p>The new edition has been somewhat enlarged by the
-introduction of additional matter into each section and by
-the addition of two entire new chapters on “Preferable
-Adjustments” and “Chiropractic Prognosis.” New plates
-have been added and old errors corrected. In every way an
-attempt has been made to express with conservatism the
-real advance made by Chiropractic since the first edition
-was put on the press.</p>
-
-<p class="sigright">J. M. L.</p>
-
-<hr />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_13">13</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<h2 id="h_3"><a id="INTRODUCTION"></a>INTRODUCTION</h2>
-</div>
-
-<p class="drop-cap"><span class="smcap1">No</span> two students, approaching for the first time the
-study of Chiropractic, approach from the same
-angle. Their viewpoints differ. In order that all
-may gain as nearly as possible the same viewpoint from
-which to consider in turn the sections of this book, it will
-be well if each student reads the entire book before beginning
-to memorize its parts and convert them into practical
-working knowledge.</p>
-
-<p>An effort should be made, abandoning all other, to acquire
-the <em>Chiropractic viewpoint</em>. This accomplished, the
-rest of the task requires time and patience alone, without
-waste labor. The section on Vertebral Palpation should be
-studied step by step, the study of each step being combined
-with practice in it. Likewise the section on Nerve-Tracing,
-theory preceding practice. The study of the Technic of
-Adjusting should occupy those months immediately preceding
-the commencement of actual adjusting practice and
-continue during such practice. The chapters on Practice
-are intended for the student about to enter the field. The
-table of Spino-Organic Connection can be best understood
-by those who have studied or are studying the anatomy and
-physiology of the nervous system.</p>
-
-<p>Let every page be studied with a good medical dictionary<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_14">14</a></span>
-open at the elbow of the reader. Pass no word without
-comprehension, no detail without mastery. He who would
-seek to modify the life processes of the human body must
-fortify himself against fatal error with every bit of knowledge
-he can acquire.</p>
-
-<hr />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_15">15</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<h2 id="h_4"><a id="VERTEBRAL_PALPATION"></a>VERTEBRAL PALPATION</h2>
-</div>
-
-<h4 id="h_5">Definition</h4>
-
-<p>Vertebral Palpation consists in the use of the tactile
-sense to determine the position, relation, size, shape, and as
-far as possible the condition, of the segments of the spinal
-column, in order thus to discover the primary causes indicative
-of disease.</p>
-
-<p>Or, Vertebral Palpation is the name given the manual
-examination of spinal vertebrae.</p>
-
-<h4 id="h_6">General Propositions</h4>
-
-<p>Every palpation should be made with the adjustment of
-the vertebrae in mind. The record of palpation should be
-a correct guide as to direction of adjustment. No subluxation
-impossible of adjustment should be recorded.</p>
-
-<p>The two essentials of correct palpation are <em>accurate perception</em>
-and <em>correct reasoning</em>. To secure the first, a certain
-approved manner of using the hands is herein laid down
-and a considerable amount of tactile sense development by
-practice is required. Correct reasoning depends upon
-knowledge of all the important facts concerning the spine
-and of the rules governing palpation.</p>
-
-<p>Absolute concentration is required and to this end many
-of the following rules are directed.</p>
-
-<h4 id="h_7">Habits of Palpation</h4>
-
-<p>Every palpater unconsciously forms habits of thought
-and action. These habits may be good or bad. We deliberately<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_16">16</a></span>
-form a habit of holding the first three fingers closely
-together or the habit of using a downward glide, but we
-should avoid the habit of finding certain subluxations because
-they are usual and expected rather than because they
-are actually there. For instance, one may easily form a
-habit of listing every other vertebra in the spine, his whole
-record thus depending upon his first choice.</p>
-
-<p>Because of this perfectly natural tendency to establish
-a routine of thought and action and to follow it precisely,
-it is best not to attempt palpation without the aid of an experienced
-teacher until after correct habits have been
-formed. Once formed, a palpation habit, right or wrong,
-is very hard to break. Many a teacher has expended himself
-uselessly in the effort to undo some technical fault acquired
-by the student in a blundering undirected trial.</p>
-
-<h4 id="h_8">Facts Concerning the Spine</h4>
-
-<p>The spinal column is composed of twenty-six segments
-called vertebrae, twenty-four movable and two fixed. The
-movable vertebrae are divided for convenience in study into
-three sections. There are seven Cervical vertebrae, twelve
-Dorsal, and five Lumbar in the normal individual. The
-number of Dorsals or Lumbars may vary by one in a rare
-case. These variations occur in about one spinal column in
-each five hundred and are usually in the Lumbar region,
-which may contain four or six vertebrae. A prominent first
-sacral spinous process may be mistaken for an extra Lumbar.</p>
-
-<p>Five vertebrae have special names. The first Cervical
-is called Atlas; the second Cervical, Axis; the seventh Cervical<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_17">17</a></span>
-is commonly known as Vertebra Prominens on account
-of its long and large spinous process, although this
-long process belongs to the sixth Cervical or first Dorsal
-instead in 35% of all cases; the large, irregularly fusiform
-vertebra just below the Lumbars and between the ilia is
-called the Sacrum; and the smaller one below it, the Coccyx.
-The latter is occasionally missing.</p>
-
-<p>Each vertebra except the Atlas is composed of a body
-and an arch; the arch is made up of two pedicles, short,
-thick plates of bone extending outward and backward from
-the postero-lateral surface of the body nearer its upper than
-its lower border, two laminae, thin plates of bone extending
-backward and inward from their union with the pedicles and
-joining behind to form the spinous process, and has projecting
-from it seven processes, two transverse, one spinous,
-and four articular, two of which are superior and two inferior.
-The foramen enclosed by the body, pedicles, and
-laminae is called the neural or vertebral foramen and the
-canal formed by the connection of these foramina and completed
-by the ligaments which unite the arches is called
-the neural, vertebral, or spinal canal. It contains the spinal
-cord with its membranes and the roots of the spinal nerves.
-By means of the four articular processes each true vertebra
-except the first articulates with its fellows above and below.</p>
-
-<p>The body of the vertebra is its largest portion and is
-joined to its fellows by fibrocartilaginous disks which are
-sufficiently elastic to permit some torsion and compression.
-Nine sets of ligaments, including the intervertebral substance<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_18">18</a></span>
-just mentioned, bind the vertebrae firmly together.
-Many muscles are attached to the spinal column.</p>
-
-<p>The intervertebral foramina are openings at the sides
-of the vertebrae, formed by the notching of apposed pedicles.
-These openings are surrounded by bone, cartilage, and
-ligaments and vary in shape in different sections of the
-spine. They permit the exit of the spinal nerves and their
-sheaths, the re-entrance of some nerve fibres into the neural
-canal, and the passage of blood-vessels to and from the cord.
-The entire philosophy of Chiropractic focuses at the intervertebral
-foramen because there we find the primary cause
-of all pathological changes in the body.</p>
-
-<p>The spinous and transverse processes merit particular
-description since they are the levers by which vertebrae are
-adjusted and nerve impingements at the intervertebral foramina
-corrected. But it will be found easiest to describe
-these processes separately in different sections of the spine
-and before proceeding to this description, a brief picture
-of the peculiar vertebrae will be presented.</p>
-
-<p>The <dfn>Atlas</dfn> is a bony ring composed of two arches, an
-anterior and a posterior, separated in the recent state by a
-transverse ligament. Its body is detached and appears as
-a tooth-like projection upward from the body of the Axis,
-the odontoid process, which articulates with the anterior
-arch of the Atlas and around which the Atlas rotates, a
-ring around a pivot. The Atlas supports the head upon
-its lateral masses, two wedge shaped bodies between the
-anterior and posterior arches, thinner internally than externally.<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_19">19</a></span>
-It has no spinous process but merely a tubercle
-where the laminae join, so that it can be palpated only from
-the sides upon the tips of its long transverses. The first
-Cervical, or suboccipital, nerves emerge by a groove above
-the pedicles instead of through a foramen.</p>
-
-<p>The <dfn>Axis</dfn>, or second Cervical, is distinguished by its
-large, strong spinous process, which is bifid at its tip, by its
-superior articular processes which rest upon body, pedicles,
-and transverses, and by its odontoid process, upreared from
-the body.</p>
-
-<p>The <dfn>Seventh Cervical</dfn>, or Vertebral Prominens, usually
-has a large spinous process, presents no foramina in its
-transverse processes, or only one, the left, and shows no
-facets on body or transverse for the rib articulation, as do
-the Dorsals.</p>
-
-<p>The <dfn>Sacrum</dfn> is the largest vertebra; is curved with its
-convexity backward; is commonly made up of five fused
-segments; has only rudimentary spinous and transverse
-processes except the first; and shows sixteen openings, eight
-anterior and eight posterior, or four on either side of the
-median line in front and the same number and arrangement
-behind. These openings permit the exit of the anterior and
-posterior primary divisions of the sacral nerves separately.</p>
-
-<p>The <dfn>Coccyx</dfn>, usually composed of four fused segments,
-is a triangular bone which articulates with the Sacrum
-above and is free at its distal extremity. Its portion of the
-neural canal is open posteriorly and contains merely the
-thread-like termination of the cord membranes. It is frequently<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_20">20</a></span>
-ankylosed to the Sacrum, sometimes in an abnormal
-position so as to impinge the single pair of coccygeal nerves.</p>
-
-<p>The different regions of the spine show decided differences
-in structure, though all resemble each other. The
-Cervicals are smallest, the Dorsals next in size, and the
-Lumbars largest and strongest of the movable vertebrae.
-The Dorsals have facets and demi-facets for the articulation
-of the twelve pairs of ribs with their bodies and intervertebral
-substance, as well as oval facets upon the anterior
-aspect of their transverses for articulation with the tubercles
-of the ribs.</p>
-
-<p>The <dfn>spinous processes</dfn> are smallest and usually bifurcated
-down to and including the fifth. The sixth may show
-a plain bifurcation, or on any Cervical the bifurcation may
-be so small as to be imperceptible to touch. The spinous
-process of the second overlies that of the third so as to
-make the latter very difficult of detection. Indeed, all cervical
-spinous processes down to the sixth are harder to
-palpate than those in other regions, owing to the anterior
-cervical curve. The processes lie in a groove between
-prominent muscle ridges.</p>
-
-<p>Dorsal spinous processes are usually single, although the
-last four, three, two, or one may show plain bifurcation in
-certain individuals. They are somewhat pointed and overlap,
-except the lower ones, the obliquity being greatest in
-the mid-dorsal region and least at the first and last dorsals.</p>
-
-<p>Lumbar vertebrae have broad, flat-tipped spinous processes
-much larger than the others. The last Dorsal may<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_21">21</a></span>
-sometimes appear like a Lumbar in shape, so that the change
-in shape commonly supposed to mark a division between
-Dorsals and Lumbars is not always an infallible guide.</p>
-
-<p>The <dfn>transverse</dfn> processes in the cervical region are very
-short and lie close in front of the articular processes. They
-are pierced by foramina for the vertebral artery and vein,
-except the seventh, which may have one foramen or none.
-They are difficult of access for palpation because of their
-shortness and the amount of overlying muscle, but may be
-reached from the front and side by drawing back the
-sternomastoid. They increase in length from the second
-to the seventh.</p>
-
-<p>In the dorsal region the transverses are larger and
-stronger and more constant in size, shape, and direction,
-serving to support rib articulations. They extend in a
-curved direction outward, backward, and slightly upward
-from the union of laminae and pedicles and terminate in a
-large subcutaneous club-shaped extremity which may be
-readily palpated. The eleventh and twelfth dorsal transverses
-do not articulate with the ribs and must therefore
-be used with caution or not at all as levers for adjustment.
-The dorsal transverses are located on a higher level than
-the spinous processes. In the case of the upper three dorsals
-the transverse lies in a plane which would cross the
-mid-spinal line between its own and the next superior spinous.
-In the mid-dorsal region the transverse is even with
-the spinous of the vertebra above, though the relation may
-vary slightly. The lower dorsals return to the same relation
-as the upper.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_22">22</a></span></p>
-
-<p>The transverse processes of the Lumbars are relatively
-light compared with the general structure of the vertebrae
-and are found just even with the interspace between
-their own and the adjacent superior spinous process. They
-vary greatly in size, length and strength and may be used
-as levers for adjustment only when they are large enough
-to be clearly palpable through the muscle mass which separates
-them from the body surface.</p>
-
-<h4 id="h_9">Preparation of Patient</h4>
-
-<p>In all cases where a complete spinal examination is intended
-the preparation is essentially the same. Have patient
-arrange clothing so that the spine is exposed to the touch
-throughout. Avoid bands of cloth across the spine, as these
-interfere with the necessary continuous gliding movement
-of the fingers. Advise the patient, if a female, to wear
-waist or dressing sack, reversed, and have skirts loosened
-at the waist. If a man, he should strip to the waist and
-wear coat or coat shirt reversed.</p>
-
-<h4 id="h_10">Position of Patient</h4>
-
-<p>This varies widely according to circumstances but for
-general purposes use position:</p>
-
-<p>(A) Place patient on stool, feet even on floor and body
-in an easy, relaxed position. This may be modified by asking
-him to lean forward and rest elbows on knees, evenly,
-to facilitate Lumbar palpation. Patient’s head may be erect
-or flexed forward or backward but should never be rotated
-or laterally flexed during Cervical palpation except for the
-purpose of locating some particular transverse process.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_23">23</a></span></p>
-
-<p>(B) In emergency cases, where haste is urgent or
-patient is unable to assume a sitting posture, or as a means
-of re-verifying previous palpation, place the patient on
-adjusting table prone, face down. (See <a href="#ip_46">Fig. 2</a>.) Remember
-that with the head lying upon its side the upper dorsal
-vertebrae will assume a curve with its convexity away from
-the face. Palpation in position (B) should precede every
-adjustment and, to guard against error, should be considered
-as a necessary preliminary to the movement of any
-vertebra.</p>
-
-<p>(C) For palpation preparatory to using the Rotary,
-the Break, and other moves, have patient lying on his back
-with his head projecting beyond upper end of bench and
-resting on the hands and wrists of the palpater, or have
-the patient’s head rest on the bench, a less accessible
-position.</p>
-
-<h4>General Observation</h4>
-
-<p>Each spinal examination should begin with a general
-survey by which curvatures, marked prominences, etc., may
-be appreciated. Frequently some very important fact may
-be noted which would escape attention upon minute examination.</p>
-
-<h3 id="h_11">THE RECORD</h3>
-
-<p>The record of spinal palpation, when completed, should
-be an accurate history of the irregularities found in the
-spine and an accurate guide to adjustment. It must be
-brief and concise as well as readily comprehensible. One
-should be able to see at a glance any desired point on the<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_24">24</a></span>
-record, so that it may be used during the adjustment without
-undue loss of time or attention. Obviously the introduction
-of any useless mark or sign, such as the inclusion
-of a number and blank space for each vertebra of the spine,
-or all possible subluxations with indications as to which
-do or do not exist in the given case, is a mistake.</p>
-
-<p>The record should contain three parallel columns. In
-the first column place the number of the vertebra chosen
-for adjustment. In the second, place the direction of subluxation.
-In the third, place the word or sign which stands
-for the indicated movement for correction.</p>
-
-<h4>Number of Vertebra</h4>
-
-<p>The letter C is used to indicate Cervical, D Dorsal, L
-Lumbar, and S Sacrum in the record. Immediately following
-the letter which designates the region, place the number
-which shows the position in that region occupied by the
-vertebra in question, the <em>relation</em> of that vertebra to its fellows.
-For instance, the third Cervical vertebra is C 3, the
-eleventh Dorsal D 11. To the S for Sacrum append B or
-A to indicate that the Base or Apex is described as to
-position. This <em>locates</em> the subluxation. For a record of full
-spine palpation it is unnecessary to use the letters C, D, or L
-more than once, as subluxations are recorded in the order
-of their occurrence from above downward. A dash should
-always follow the number of the vertebra to separate it
-from the letters in the second column for convenience in
-reading.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_25">25</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="intact">
-<h4 id="dirsub">Direction of Subluxation</h4>
-
-<p>The directions considered in palpating or recording subluxations
-are six in number, namely:</p>
-
-<table id="sublux" class="p1" summary="Directions of subluxation">
- <tr class="smaller">
- <td class="tdl">Name</td>
- <td class="tdc">Abbreviation</td>
- <td class="tdc l4">Meaning</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior</td>
- <td class="tdc">P</td>
- <td class="tdl">Toward the rear (Dorsad)</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Anterior</td>
- <td class="tdc">A</td>
- <td class="tdl">Toward the front (Ventrad)</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Right</td>
- <td class="tdc">R</td>
- <td class="tdl">Toward the right hand</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Left</td>
- <td class="tdc">L</td>
- <td class="tdl">Toward the left hand</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Superior</td>
- <td class="tdc">S</td>
- <td class="tdl">Toward the head (Cephalad)</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Inferior</td>
- <td class="tdc">I</td>
- <td class="tdl">Toward the feet (Caudad)</td></tr>
-</table>
-</div>
-
-<p>As the fingers glide down the spine the <em>posterior</em> vertebra
-is the one which interposes itself in the path of the
-fingers, forcing them to describe an outward curve. It
-is the hill on the automobile road which forces the surmounting
-of a curved departure from the evenness of the
-road. It is <em>relatively</em> posterior to its fellows above and
-below.</p>
-
-<p>The <dfn>anterior</dfn> vertebra, to the gliding fingers, means a
-depression, a valley. It causes the fingers to dip inward
-from the level of their course.</p>
-
-<p>The <dfn>right</dfn> or the <dfn>left</dfn> subluxation is appreciated by running
-the tips of the fingers down the sides of the spinous
-processes. It really indicates rotation of the whole vertebra
-more often than any other malposition.</p>
-
-<p>We say that a vertebra is <em>superior</em> when its spinous
-process is nearer the one above than the one below. It
-requires a measuring of relative distances. The degree<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_26">26</a></span>
-to which a vertebra is superior is measured, not by its actual
-closeness to its fellow, but by the relation between the space
-above and the space below.</p>
-
-<p>Likewise a vertebra is <em>inferior</em> when it is closer to its
-fellow below than to its fellow above.</p>
-
-<p><em>Anterior</em> subluxations are rarely recorded as such, except
-of the Cervicals or the last Lumbar, because no means
-of properly adjusting them is known to Chiropractic.</p>
-
-<h4>Order of Letters</h4>
-
-<p>In the second column, that devoted to direction of subluxation,
-the letter P or A should appear, if at all, as this
-antero-posterior relation is the first thing to be determined
-concerning any individual subluxation chosen except the
-Atlas. With the Atlas the first letter will be R or L. Next
-the laterality or rotation is indicated by R or L in every
-case except Atlas subluxation. Finally the S or I indicates
-the last point to be determined, the <em>approximation</em> of the
-vertebra to its fellows. This last letter usually shows thinning
-of intervertebral fibrocartilage, which will be discussed
-elsewhere.</p>
-
-<p>If you desire to emphasize any direction as being more
-important than another, underscore the letter which stands
-for that direction with a single line. If two directions are
-to be emphasized, one more than another, underscore the
-one with two lines and the other with one. For example,
-if a vertebra is found to be quite decidedly posterior, <em>more</em>
-plainly to the right, and <em>slightly</em> superior, the record will
-show it thus: <em><span class="undersingle">P</span> <span class="underdouble">R</span> S</em>.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_27">27</a></span></p>
-
-<h4>Movement for Correction</h4>
-
-<p>This is indicated in the third column, separated from the
-second by a dash, by means of some brief word or words
-which describe a certain movement used in adjusting. The
-descriptive words and terms used in this work are all given
-and explained under Technic of Adjusting. (See <a href="#Page_89">p. 89</a>.)
-Each word or term stands for a definite method of procedure.
-The best movement for the correction of any
-subluxation of any vertebra may be found by reference
-to the section on <a href="#h_36">Preferable Adjustments</a>, <a href="#Page_155">p. 155</a>. If other
-terms are more familiar to the student, or in time replace
-those which are now common usage in the profession, they
-will be brief and clear and may be easily substituted for
-those given.</p>
-
-<p>Palpation, fixing in the mind of the palpater the manner
-and direction of the subluxation, should also suggest as the
-obvious correction a movement calculated to reverse the
-procedure by which the subluxation was first produced. In
-other words, a certain kind of subluxation stands as the
-effect of a certain application of force along definite lines
-determinable by examination. Its correction should be made
-in a reverse direction along the same lines. By recording
-with the record of subluxation the desired correction, the
-adjuster may be reminded daily without new palpation of
-the movement best fitted to the case. If on trial it is
-decided that some other movement than the one first indicated
-will better overcome the abnormality, the record
-should be changed to correspond to the decision, and thereafter
-followed.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_28">28</a></span></p>
-
-<h4>Complete Record</h4>
-
-<p>The completed record in three columns separated by
-dashes can be conveniently read. It contains no superfluous
-mark of any kind. It conveys all the necessary information
-leading to adjustment except diagnosis and case
-history. This palpation record should be a part of a more
-comprehensive record concerning the case in full and is
-best kept on a card, the reverse side of which carries case
-history. If kept in an indexed card file it may be referred
-to daily without loss of time and an accurate handling of
-each case be assured.</p>
-
-<p>Have card perfectly blank on palpation record side.
-For convenience in reading draw a heavy line beneath the
-last Cervical subluxation recorded and another beneath the
-last Dorsal, thus dividing the record as the spine is divided,
-into three divisions.</p>
-
-<p>Below follows a sample palpation record. It will be
-seen that here in a very small space may be recorded a
-great deal of information, for this record contains an accurate
-list of the primary causes of every disease, weakness,
-or tendency to disease with which the patient is afflicted,
-together with the methods for their removal.</p>
-
-<div class="intact">
-<h4>Sample Record</h4>
-
-<table id="samprec" class="p1" summary="Sample Record">
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">C</td>
- <td class="tdl">1</td>
- <td class="tdl">R</td>
- <td class="tdl">Break</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td> </td>
- <td class="tdl">4</td>
- <td class="tdl">P L S</td>
- <td class="tdl">Double Contact</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td> </td>
- <td class="tdl">7</td>
- <td class="tdl">L I</td>
- <td class="tdl">Rotary</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl" colspan="4">———————————————————</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">D</td>
- <td class="tdl">3</td>
- <td class="tdl">P R</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_29">29</a></span></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td> </td>
- <td class="tdl">7</td>
- <td class="tdl">L S</td>
- <td class="tdl">Pisiform Single Transverse</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td> </td>
- <td class="tdl">10</td>
- <td class="tdl">P S</td>
- <td class="tdl">Heel Contact</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl" colspan="4">———————————————————</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">L</td>
- <td class="tdl">1</td>
- <td class="tdl">P L I</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td> </td>
- <td class="tdl">4</td>
- <td class="tdl">R</td>
- <td class="tdl">Lumbar Single Transverse</td></tr>
-</table>
-</div>
-
-<h4>Use of Record</h4>
-
-<p>The above record is made with patient sitting. It is to
-be used while patient is lying upon the adjusting bench.
-The most convenient way is to begin palpation in the Dorsal
-region after patient has been placed for adjustment, in this
-way. If first subluxation recorded is D 2—P R I, find the
-vertebra in the region of D 2 which appears P R I to the
-touch. To avoid error, let the fingers then glide downward
-to the next recorded subluxation. If this be found to agree
-in number and direction with the record, it is safe to assume
-that the first one found was correctly numbered in
-the palpater’s mind; if not, that an error was made. This
-can be quickly done. Before each adjustment the vertebra
-adjusted should be found to agree with the record; by
-doing this constant accuracy may be assured.</p>
-
-<h3 id="h_12">THE COUNT</h3>
-
-<p>Having described the preparation of the patient and the
-different positions in which he may be palpated, noted that
-all records should be made in position A, mentioned that
-general observation which should immediately precede actual
-palpation, and interpolated a description of the record to<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_30">30</a></span>
-be made during the palpation, with its use afterward, we
-are now ready to consider the technic of the palpation
-itself. This should begin with a count of the vertebrae and
-continue with Atlas palpation, general examination of a
-group of vertebrae, and special examination of individual
-subluxations in the group. Each of these tasks will be
-considered in turn.</p>
-
-<h4>Position of Palpater</h4>
-
-<p>This depends upon the position of the patient. The
-letters which follow correspond to the letters describing
-the position of the patient. q. v.</p>
-
-<p>(A) If you desire to palpate with the right hand stand
-at patient’s left and face toward him with left hand resting
-on his shoulder or supporting his forehead as you palpate
-Dorsals or Cervicals respectively. To use left hand stand
-similarly at patient’s right. Have palpating arm relaxed
-and easy, extending as nearly as possible so that the forearm
-and hand make a right angle with the patient’s spine.
-Let the arm and hand remain close to the patient’s body
-at all times. Keep the elbow close to your own body
-and avoid flexion of wrist on forearm, or of forearm on
-arm at more than a right angle, since such flexion would
-bring about too great muscular tension for close appreciation
-of tactile impressions. If necessary lean sidewise and
-elevate shoulder and palpating arm in order to preserve
-the proper relation between hand and arm when hand must
-be elevated as in palpating upper Cervicals.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_31">31</a></span></p>
-
-<p>(B) As above, if you desire to use right hand stand
-on left side of patient and if left hand stand on right. If
-the patient lies on a bench so constructed that the head
-lies on one side, his face must be toward the palpater in
-order that the same hand may be used in Cervical as in
-other regions. It is inadvisable to change hands except
-when absolutely unavoidable. If the patient’s head must
-be turned from you palpate the Cervicals by standing with
-feet pointed away from patient and turn your body with
-one hand resting on patient’s head to hold it steady and
-the other palpating as if you were standing on the other
-side. This is difficult and it is rarely necessary to count
-Cervicals in position B if the record be used as advised
-on page 29.</p>
-
-<p>(C) Palpation preparatory to the Cervical adjustment
-will be made in this position or in position A, according
-as you intend adjusting the Cervicals in the prone or the
-sitting posture. For the prone position have the patient’s
-head supported by either hand, while the other hand is
-applied with the tips of the first three fingers resting on
-the tips of the spinous processes, from which position they
-may glide smoothly down, noting deviations from normal
-in position as well as mentally numbering the vertebrae.
-While this method of palpation is not so accurate as those
-given elsewhere, and should be used only as an additional
-means after record has been made, it will always be necessary
-to make a count before adjusting any Cervical.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_32">32</a></span></p>
-
-<h4>Use of Hands</h4>
-
-<p>In general it may be stated that the first three fingers
-of one hand are used with an easy downward gliding movement
-in which only the <em>tips</em> of the three fingers, evenly
-placed, are in contact with the patient’s body. This concentrates
-the attention upon a very small tactile surface
-which may become extremely sensitive by the concentration.
-Indeed, it may be said that vertebral palpation only
-became an art through the application of the principle of
-concentration in practice. The gliding movement is always
-<em>downward</em>, because to palpate upward will mass the superficial
-tissues under the fingers and confuse the palpater.
-If there is uncertainty in the mind of the palpater, as he
-proceeds, as to the identity of any vertebra he should go
-back to the second Cervical, or to any certainly recognizable
-vertebra previously fixed in mind, and recount.</p>
-
-<p>The use of the hands for Atlas palpation differs from
-their use elsewhere and will be described under separate
-head. The use of the hands with the patient lying face
-upward is also different. If the patient be lying prone,
-the same three fingers are used and the same downward
-glide as with patient sitting.</p>
-
-<div id="ip_32" class="figcenter" style="max-width: 24.6875em;">
- <img src="images/i_032.jpg" width="395" height="600" alt="" />
- <div class="caption">Fig. 1. Position of hands in palpation for record.</div></div>
-
-<p>With patient sitting, the palpater should step from side
-to side, changing hands frequently and usually palpating
-each vertebra with each hand before reaching a conclusion.
-There are three reasons for this. More accurate records
-may be made by combining two different impressions on
-each vertebra; with frequent change of hands one may<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_33">33</a></span>
-prevent tiring and consequent loss of sensibility of fingers;
-this practice develops the tactile organs of both hands
-equally so that if occasion demand the use of either hand
-alone it is fitted for the task. To be ambidexterous in all
-departments of Chiropractic is an invaluable attainment,
-too often neglected.</p>
-
-<h4>The Count</h4>
-
-<p>Commence at the second Cervical, the first spinous
-process below the occiput, and let the fingers glide smoothly
-downward over the tips or along the sides of the spinous
-processes, <em>without interruption of motion</em>, until they reach
-the Sacrum. The palpater notes each vertebra passed and
-its number—mentally—so that when he reaches the Sacrum
-he knows that he has passed every intervening vertebra and
-received a touch impression from each. The Sacrum itself
-may usually be recognized by its peculiar shape and also by
-its articulations with the ilia.</p>
-
-<p>If the fingers are raised from their contact during the
-count, the palpater must recommence at the second Cervical.
-It is impossible to be accurate in replacing the hand, once
-removed, until the count has been established and the
-peculiarities of certain vertebrae remembered, together with
-their numbers.</p>
-
-<p>To determine the location of the fourth Lumbar where,
-on account of obesity, lipoma, Cervical lordosis, etc., the
-count of Cervicals or Sacral palpation is difficult, drop on
-heels behind the patient and place the second finger of<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_34">34</a></span>
-each hand on the crest of the ileum. Then let the thumbs
-meet in the mid-spinal line in the same horizontal plane
-as the two second fingers, which spot should correspond
-to the interspace between third and fourth Lumbars. This
-measurement is accurate in about 98% of all cases, when
-patient sits erect; when it varies it will vary by about half
-the width of a Lumbar spinous process.</p>
-
-<p>The count should be repeated until the palpater is certain
-that he is able to palpate every spinous process distinctly
-or to locate accurately any impalpable one. In making
-the count, palpater may note the number of some very
-prominent and easily recognizable Dorsal or Lumbar vertebra
-to be referred to as a starting point for a recount if
-confusion arises later. This recounting from some prominent
-vertebra is permissible only after the first accurate
-count has been made, but then will save the full count,
-especially when the patient is in an unfavorable position,
-as lying on table during adjustment.</p>
-
-<h4>Difficulties in Counting</h4>
-
-<p>The commonest difficulties met with in counting are
-the following:</p>
-
-<p>Inaccessibility of third Cervical, which lies closely beneath
-the spinous process of the second and, unless unusually
-large or somewhat out of its proper position, cannot
-be readily felt.</p>
-
-<p>An occasional anterior fourth or fifth Cervical which
-may escape notice unless the head is flexed far toward or
-the transverse processes examined.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_35">35</a></span></p>
-
-<p>Lipoma or other adipose tissue covering part of the
-spine.</p>
-
-<p>A missing epiphyseal plate resulting from fracture and
-absorption, which absence may simulate a wide interspace
-and be overlooked without careful and detailed observation.</p>
-
-<p>Cervical or Lumbar lordosis. This difficulty may be at
-least partially overcome by having head bent far forward
-or body leaning forward with elbows resting on knees and
-a deliberate attempt on the patient’s part to render the
-dorsolumbar spine convex backward.</p>
-
-<p>An anterior fifth Lumbar.</p>
-
-<p>The occasional extra vertebra which confuses the
-palpater.</p>
-
-<p>Finally, the greatest of all difficulties is the imperfect
-touch of the untrained palpater or the imperfect concentration
-of the trained. And this is always remediable.</p>
-
-<h3 id="h_13">ATLAS PALPATION</h3>
-
-<p>With patient in position A stand <em>behind</em> him and place
-the tips of the second fingers on the tips of the transverse
-processes of the Atlas, or first Cervical. It can be felt on
-each side just anterior and inferior to the mastoid process
-of the temporal bone. Let the first and third fingers rest
-respectively above and below the transverses and determine
-whether the Atlas is subluxated as a whole to the Right
-or to the Left.</p>
-
-<p>Another convenient method is:</p>
-
-<p>Place first fingers on mastoid processes, second on Atlas<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_36">36</a></span>
-transverses, and third on angle of jaw. The three fingers
-of each hand then constitute the points of a triangle. Imagine
-the base line between the first and third fingers and
-measure the altitude as a line at right angles to this base
-line and reaching to the tip of the second finger as the apex
-of the triangle. The relation of the two altitudes determines
-the laterality of the Atlas. Thus, if the altitude of
-the right triangle is less than that of the left, the Atlas is
-laterally displaced to the Right.</p>
-
-<p>The second matter to determine is the <em>rotation</em> of the
-Atlas. This is done by using the first and third fingers as
-probes to determine the amount of space between the transverse
-and the mandible in front or the mastoid behind. The
-intention is to compare the laterally prominent side with
-the other so that the letter A or P on the record will indicate
-the position of the prominent transverse compared with its
-fellow.</p>
-
-<p>Next decide as to <em>tipping</em>. Still comparing the prominent
-transverse with the other, decide whether it is above
-or below the level of the other by the following method.
-Placing first three fingers one above the other with the
-second finger on the tip of the process, note which transverse
-is highest in the space beneath the ear. List the
-prominent side as S or Superior, I or Inferior.</p>
-
-<p>Atlas palpation is rendered especially difficult by the
-special technic and by the interposing tendons of the sterno-cleido-mastoid
-muscle.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_37">37</a></span></p>
-
-<h4>Position of Head</h4>
-
-<p>There are three head positions for Atlas palpation. Head
-erect, face forward; head flexed forward on chest; head
-flexed backward. Sometimes it is necessary to test in all
-three positions in order to reach a decision, but ordinarily
-the first is sufficient.</p>
-
-<h3 id="h_14">THE GROUP METHOD</h3>
-
-<p>In general palpation of the spine the author has had
-the greatest success and attained the greatest accuracy
-through which is called the Group Method. This consists in
-dividing the spine mentally into five groups or sections,
-each of which overlaps its fellows except the end groups.
-This is of advantage for several reasons.</p>
-
-<p>It limits somewhat the attention of the palpater so that
-he may examine thoroughly and in detail the various vertebrae
-without holding his attention so closely to one that
-he fails to perceive its relation to its surroundings. It furnishes
-five or six vertebrae at a time for comparison so
-that one may determine which is <em>most</em> subluxated, and
-therefore most in need of adjustment, and then allows one
-to reason upon the remainder of the group with this major
-subluxation in mind.</p>
-
-<p>The use of the Group Method may best be understood
-by the study of certain didactic instructions, which follow:</p>
-
-<p>Never record or adjust two subluxations of contiguous
-vertebrae except in those unusual cases where they are
-equally subluxated and in the same direction; even then it
-is wisest to adjust them on alternate days. Let it be understood<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_38">38</a></span>
-that only in <em>exceptional</em> circumstances should two
-adjacent vertebrae be listed. The Group Method is chiefly
-valuable because of this rule, to prevent the overlooking
-of the most important subluxation by selecting that one
-<em>first</em>.</p>
-
-<p>Consider the spine as divisible into five groups; in the
-first group belong the Cervicals below the Atlas; in the
-second, the seventh Cervical and first five Dorsals; in the
-third, the vertebrae from the fourth to the eighth Dorsals
-inclusive; in the fourth, the last five Dorsals and sometimes
-first Lumbar; and in the last group, all of the Lumbars
-and the base of the Sacrum. Consider the first Sacral
-spinous process here rather than the whole Sacrum and
-remember that this process should seem to complete the
-regular Lumbar curve. This grouping may be modified
-somewhat by the exigencies of palpation in any given case,
-but the group considered should always include from four
-to seven vertebrae.</p>
-
-<p>In each group proceed in the same manner to select
-subluxations. Let the fingers glide over the group, first
-on the tips and then along the sides of the spinous processes,
-and note that some one vertebra stands out as the
-sharpest, most abrupt deviation in the group, thus indicating
-its selection. Remember that neither the one above this
-nor the one directly below may be adjusted. This narrows
-your field of observation for this group to two, three, or
-four remaining vertebrae.</p>
-
-<p>Select then such others in the group as need to be listed<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_39">39</a></span>
-yet do not conflict with the rule against adjacent subluxations.
-Proceed to discover and record the exact direction
-of each. When this is done examine the next lower group
-in the same way and continue until the whole spine has
-been palpated.</p>
-
-<p>The Atlas must be considered alone and not as a part
-of any of the above mentioned groups and its position is
-judged rather by its relation to the head than to other
-vertebrae; the Sacrum also requires individual attention,
-being compared with the Lumbar curve and with the ilia.</p>
-
-<p>The one most pronounced subluxation in a group is
-often mentioned as the “key” to the group, since its correction
-would effectually loosen the entire group and sometimes
-partially correct the apparent abnormalities of the
-rest. It has also been called “major subluxation” to distinguish
-it from “minor subluxations” which are the others
-of less importance in the group. This term is not a good
-one because it suggests what is not always true, namely,
-that the mechanically greatest subluxation is more potent
-than any other. Occasionally a slighter subluxation irritates
-nerves so as to produce a disease more serious and
-immediately alarming than the condition following the
-greater displacement.</p>
-
-<h4>Example of Group Method</h4>
-
-<p>If, in the Cervicals, it is noticed upon gliding downward
-over the spinous processes that the fifth is badly subluxated
-and must be adjusted, this fact is held in mind for a moment<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_40">40</a></span>
-while the palpater remembers that he cannot adjust and
-must not list the sixth or fourth. This leaves only the
-second, third and seventh for consideration, the Atlas having
-been separately examined. The seventh may best be
-included in the next group when such a selection is made,
-so that the palpater need only decide between the second
-and third Cervical, providing Atlas has not been chosen, as
-to which, if either, most requires attention. If Atlas has
-been listed, then there remains instead only the question as
-to whether the third is or is not subluxated.</p>
-
-<p>In using the Group Method no preference is given to
-subluxation in any particular direction, save only that below
-the Cervicals we discriminate against the anteriors, because
-we cannot adjust them. The Group Method has to do with
-determining the points of greatest pressure on nerves and
-this depends upon one’s impression as to the interrelations
-between all the members of the group. (See <a href="#Page_80">p. 80</a> under
-<a href="#h_32">Subluxations.)</a></p>
-
-<h3 id="h_15">THE INDIVIDUAL SUBLUXATION</h3>
-
-<p>Having prepared our patient, surveyed the entire spine,
-carefully counted the vertebrae to secure a proper orientation,
-and specially examined the Atlas, then divided the
-spine into groups and selected the vertebrae to be adjusted
-with regard to their degree of malposition, let us confine
-our attention definitely for the first time to the <em>single</em> vertebra
-below the Atlas.</p>
-
-<p>Reread “<a href="#dirsub">Direction of Subluxation</a>” under “<a href="#h_11">The Record</a>,”
-<a href="#Page_25">p. 25</a>. Also read article on “<a href="#h_29">Subluxations</a>,” <a href="#Page_76">p. 76</a>.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_41">41</a></span></p>
-
-<p>Bear in mind that each subluxation recorded is intended
-for adjustment and indicate nothing impossible on your
-record. For instance, an anterior subluxation in the Dorsal
-region cannot be corrected and should not be recorded for
-correction.</p>
-
-<p>Remember the six capital letters used in describing a
-subluxation.</p>
-
-<p>Use only the <em>downward gliding movement</em> of the three
-palpating fingers.</p>
-
-<p>Keep in mind the count as you have established it for
-that particular spine, recalling one or two very prominent
-and noticeable vertebrae whose numbers you have noted.</p>
-
-<p>Use a light touch. If necessary, change the patient’s
-position to make the vertebra more accessible instead of
-pressing with more force.</p>
-
-<p>When in doubt as to direction, change sides and use
-the other hand. If still in doubt, take a longer glide, covering
-six vertebrae instead of three or four.</p>
-
-<p>Keep your mind on your work, forgetful of everything
-else.</p>
-
-<p>And picture to yourself the entire vertebra and its surroundings;
-its body, pedicles, and laminae, its transverse
-processes and all articulations; above all, <em>mentally visualize
-the foramina and nerves</em>. Estimate from the position of
-each vertebra the pressure at each foramen. Decide whether
-the vertebra is rotated, tipped, laterally displaced, anterior
-or posterior, or whether the subluxation partakes of several
-of these directions.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_42">42</a></span></p>
-
-<p>Decide in what direction movement of the vertebra would
-release most pressure and list accordingly.</p>
-
-<p>Never hesitate to change your opinion if you discover
-evidence that you have made a mistake. Keep at all times
-an open mind in palpation.</p>
-
-<h4>Cervical Palpation</h4>
-
-<p>The third Cervical, lying under the projecting spinous
-process of the larger second, may be hard to find, and therefore
-the full count is always required before listing any
-vertebra. By requiring the patient, who is in position A,
-to drop his head forward and rest its weight in the hand
-which is not palpating, the Cervicals may be more easily
-palpated. Remember that this posture widens the interspaces
-and also makes the spinous processes appear more
-posterior than they really are, this difference being most
-noticeable at the fourth.</p>
-
-<p>One bifurcation of a Cervical spinous process may be
-longer than the other and prove confusing unless care be
-taken always to palpate both bifurcations and note their
-form. This can almost always be successfully accomplished.</p>
-
-<p>Sometimes the posterior neck muscles and ligaments
-will be rigid so that they interfere with palpation and at
-the same time make it impossible for the patient to flex his
-head forward. Having found that this is due to real <em>contracture</em>
-and is therefore not susceptible of voluntary relaxation
-by the patient, support the head in front and push
-aside the muscles with the fingers, gliding <em>underneath</em> the<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_43">43</a></span>
-muscle layers as much as possible and close to the spinous
-processes.</p>
-
-<p>Transverse palpation in the Cervicals is used to verify
-findings from the spinous processes or to differentiate between
-rotated and laterally displaced vertebrae and bent
-spinous processes when the spinous swerves to right or left.</p>
-
-<h4>Dorsal Palpation</h4>
-
-<p>The Dorsals are usually considered in three groups. It
-must be remembered that the form and obliquity of spinous
-processes vary considerably in this region. The upper
-processes are very slightly oblique, slanting downward, the
-middle Dorsals very oblique, and the inferior ones again
-only slightly so. There is a form change, most commonly
-at the eighth Dorsal, which may be mistaken for a posterior
-subluxation. The process here becomes more horizontal
-and more blunt.</p>
-
-<p>Among the first four Dorsals a bad lateral or rotated
-vertebra may be listed as well as a posterior one, since we
-can readily adjust it. In the middle group either the posterior
-or rotated vertebra is chosen according to the estimate
-as to which causes greatest nerve impingement, either
-being adjustable. In the lower group, however, preference
-is usually given the posterior vertebra when possible, because
-rotary subluxations indicate transverse adjustments
-and it is somewhat dangerous in this region to use the
-transverses as levers.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_44">44</a></span></p>
-
-<h4>Lumbar Palpation</h4>
-
-<p>The Lumbars and Sacrum are considered in one group.
-The Lumbars, with patient erect, <em>should</em> curve anteriorly
-and the first Sacral spinous process should complete the
-regular curve. This is rarely found, however; the normal
-is the exception in any part of the spine.</p>
-
-<p>In the Lumbars we usually choose the rotated rather
-than the posterior vertebra, but solely because rotation here
-produces the greatest degree of impingement. The laterality
-of spinous processes, indicating rotation of the whole
-vertebra around an axis lying in the transverse line between
-the articular processes, can best be perceived, as a
-rule, with patient sitting quite erect. If in doubt, have
-patient lean forward and rest elbows on knees, which posture
-separates the Lumbars, rendering the individual spinous
-process easier to discover but the <em>relative</em> position more
-difficult of determination.</p>
-
-<p>The fifth Lumbar, if anterior, may be so listed, forming
-an exception to the general rule.</p>
-
-<h4>Sacral Palpation—Pelvis</h4>
-
-<p>First palpate Sacrum as if part of Lumbar region. Note
-whether the base (upper portion) is posterior or not. Then
-stand behind the patient and use both hands to examine
-the sacroiliac articulations. Use palmar surfaces with the
-flat hand toward patient’s body, and carefully compare the
-two sides to detect inequalities, which indicate iliac subluxation,
-or rotation of Sacrum between the ilia on a transversely<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_45">45</a></span>
-disposed axis passing through the two articulations,
-in which case the Sacrum is to be adjusted. Do not mistake
-a dislocated hip with compensatory tilting of the whole
-pelvis, or faulty sitting posture with only one tuber ischii
-supporting the body, for pelvic subluxation.</p>
-
-<p>Be not in undue haste to record pelvic subluxations lest
-your haste bring its immediate reward in the difficulty of
-adjustment.</p>
-
-<h4>The Coccyx</h4>
-
-<p>The Coccyx may be detached from the Sacrum by
-various accidents and later re-ankylosed thereto in an abnormal
-position so as to impinge upon the rectum or other
-structures. Impingement of the coccygeal nerves is usually
-unimportant. Chronic and intractable rectal constipation,
-with its attendant train of evils, <em>may</em> result from coccygeal
-displacement with ankylosis. In spite of numerous treatises
-to the contrary, the writer avers that other symptoms
-are extremely rare.</p>
-
-<p>To examine the Coccyx use a rubber covering on the
-second finger. Place patient face down and insert second
-finger per rectum with the palmar surface upward. If
-subluxated Coccyx be found, it must usually be fractured
-with a sharp jerk, in order to relieve the condition. After
-fracture, it may be absorbed or may re-ankylose to the
-Sacrum in a better position, or it may remain freely
-movable.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_46">46</a></span></p>
-
-<h3 id="h_16">PALPATION IN POSITION B</h3>
-
-<p>This is the position for the majority of adjustments,
-and as the palpation of each vertebra to be adjusted is a
-necessary preliminary to the adjustment, this method,
-though not so accurate as the one already described, must
-also be used.</p>
-
-<p>The use of the first three fingers of each hand and the
-relation of hands to patient’s body is the same as in Position
-A, except for palpating Cervicals when the patient’s
-face is turned away. It will be found very difficult to make
-a correct full count, especially to count Cervicals, in this
-position, and is better to use a record already prepared.</p>
-
-<h4>Dorsals</h4>
-
-<p>Begin at, or near, the first Dorsal to palpate in this position.
-Find the vertebra which agrees in direction with the
-first Dorsal subluxation recorded; let the fingers glide downward
-until they reach the vertebra which, according to the
-first decision, would correspond in number with the <em>next</em>
-subluxation on the record. If this also agrees in direction
-with the record it may safely be assumed that you are accurate
-in your numbering. Thereafter, during that adjustment,
-the count can be made or repeated from any prominent
-vertebra the number and identity of which are easily
-recognized.</p>
-
-<div id="ip_46" class="figcenter" style="max-width: 37.5em;">
- <img src="images/i_046.jpg" width="600" height="346" alt="" />
- <div class="caption">Fig. 2. Palpation in Position B, preparatory to adjustment.</div></div>
-
-<h4>Lumbars</h4>
-
-<p>It may be difficult to count or otherwise to palpate the
-Lumbars in this position because of the increase in the<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_47">47</a></span>
-normal anterior curve when patient is suspended between
-the two sections of the bench. This will be obviated if a
-roll be placed under the thighs or if the bench has an adjustable
-rear section.</p>
-
-<h4>Cervicals</h4>
-
-<p>If a solid front bench is used remember the spiral turn
-in the Cervicals, which occurs because of the resting of the
-head on one side. The curve due to this rotation of the
-head is compounded with the ever present anterior curve to
-make a spiral. Do not expect the vertebrae in this position
-to agree in apparent direction with a record made with the
-head straight. It is better to make all decisions as to direction
-of Cervicals in position A and merely to <em>count</em> them
-in other positions.</p>
-
-<p>In position B, if the patient’s face be away from the
-palpater it will be necessary to stand with back toward
-patient and body twisted, and to change hands for counting,
-resting the free hand on patient’s head to insure its
-steadiness.</p>
-
-<h4>Disagreements</h4>
-
-<p>If there be any apparent disagreement between findings
-in positions B and A, re-examine carefully in both positions,
-whereupon that which seemed a disagreement will
-probably prove to have been an error in one or the other
-palpation. If apparent disagreement persists after searching
-examination, position A furnishes the safest guide to<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_48">48</a></span>
-adjustment because the patient is in his most usual attitude
-as regards the spinal curves, muscle tension, etc. But it
-is usually wisest when in grave doubt not to adjust the
-doubtful vertebra at all.</p>
-
-<h3 id="h_17">PALPATION IN POSITION C</h3>
-
-<p>Since palpation in this position, patient lying on his
-back with head supported by palpater’s hands, cannot be so
-reliable as that done in position A, the chief point to be
-observed is an accurate count. Only the Cervicals below
-the first can be properly palpated in this position.</p>
-
-<p>Induce the patient to relax the neck muscles as much
-as may be, and use in palpation the first three fingers of
-one hand if the count alone is desired or the first three
-fingers of <em>both</em> hands if you desire to ascertain the <em>direction</em>
-of any vertebra. In the former case let the fingers press
-aside the muscles and glide <em>downward</em> from the second Cervical,
-being careful to lift the head high enough so that
-the third Cervical is not overlooked beneath the overlapping
-second. In the latter case let the fingers of both hands
-glide gently downward while the patient’s head rests upon
-the palpater’s wrists or knee. Palpate the transverses in
-much the same manner, paying special attention to their
-<em>laterality</em>, felt as a prominence on one side lateral to a
-transverse process and a corresponding depression on the
-opposite side. Do not be deceived by exceptionally long
-transverses where both project outward to an equal degree.</p>
-
-<div id="ip_48" class="figcenter" style="max-width: 24.75em;">
- <img src="images/i_048.jpg" width="396" height="600" alt="" />
- <div class="caption">Fig. 3. Locative palpation of Cervical spinous processes in Position
-C, preparatory to Rotary or Break.</div></div>
-
-<p>Since the greater mass of the vertebra is divided with<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_49">49</a></span>
-fair equality by the intertransverse line, laterality of transverses
-indicates laterality of the whole vertebra with the
-possible exception of the anterior portion of the body.
-Laterality of a Cervical <em>spinous</em> process may indicate laterality
-of the entire vertebra or merely rotation around its
-vertical axis, in which the one articular process is separated
-from its fellow of the adjacent vertebra while the other
-remains in partial apposition.</p>
-
-<h4>Disagreements</h4>
-
-<p>If disagreements appear between palpation made in positions
-A and C, re-palpate in both positions. If still uncertain
-call a consultation or follow finding in position A. The
-Rotary adjustment may sometimes aid in deciding difficult
-questions if gently attempted and free movement secured.
-With this adjustment a vertebra will not usually move without
-rather extreme force unless the articular process on
-the side sought to be moved has lost its apposition with its
-fellow of the adjacent vertebra. In any case of disagreement
-nerve-tracing, the discovery of sensitive nerves on
-one side only may aid in decision. A knowledge of probabilities,
-previous experience, and the diagnosis may also
-serve as partial guides.</p>
-
-<h3 id="h_18">TRANSVERSE PALPATION</h3>
-
-<p>Palpation of the transverse processes is easiest in the
-Cervical and mid-dorsal regions and most difficult in upper
-Dorsal and Lumbar regions. It has two uses: first, to assist<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_50">50</a></span>
-in making a record by verifying the work done on the
-spinous processes; second, to locate a given transverse
-process in order to use it as a lever for the adjustment of
-the vertebra.</p>
-
-<p>It will be seen that fulfillment of the first purpose requires
-careful examination of the <em>direction</em> and <em>position</em> of
-the transverses as compared with each other and with the
-spinous process of the same vertebra, while the second requires
-only the discovery of the exact <em>location</em> of some
-particular transverse. It will be best to consider the three
-divisions of the spine separately, excluding from the present
-chapter Atlas palpation, which has been thoroughly
-described.</p>
-
-<h4>Cervicals</h4>
-
-<p>These can be best palpated in the position for Atlas
-palpation; that is, standing behind the patient and using
-the palmar surfaces of the fingers of both hands. From
-the Atlas transverses follow the anterior border of the
-sternomastoid muscle downward, and opposite each spinous
-process draw the muscles backward and inward until the
-tips of the transverses are found with the middle fingers.
-Their position on the two sides may then be easily compared
-as well as their relation to those above and below
-them.</p>
-
-<div id="ip_50" class="figcenter" style="max-width: 24.875em;">
- <img src="images/i_051.jpg" width="398" height="600" alt="" />
- <div class="caption">Fig. 4. Locative palpation of Dorsal transverse processes.</div></div>
-
-<p>The transverses of the second Cervical may sometimes
-be so prominent laterally that they are, or one of them is,
-mistaken for an Atlas transverse. As a rule, however, the<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_51">51</a></span>
-width of the Cervicals increases from the second downward,
-the second being narrowest. Chassaignac’s tubercle, on the
-transverse process of the sixth Cervical and opposite the
-lower border of the cricoid cartilage, is a prominent point
-easily felt as a rule. The transverses of the fourth are
-usually opposite the upper border of the thyroid cartilage.</p>
-
-<p>The Cervical transverses lie very close to the articular
-processes and the determination of their relation is a better
-guide to the condition of the articulation than is spinous
-process palpation. It is also more difficult.</p>
-
-<p>Palpation of Cervical transverses to determine laterality
-of the vertebra as a whole or its rotation is possible in
-position C and has been described under that head.</p>
-
-<h4>Dorsals</h4>
-
-<p>Palpation for <em>direction</em> can be done best in position B.
-Use three fingers with a gliding movement along the line
-of the transverses, passing over several to determine which
-is most posterior. Then repeat the glide on the other side
-of the spine to determine whether the transverse corresponding
-to the anterior one is posterior or vice versa, showing
-that the entire vertebra is merely rotated or is displaced
-backward. Some palpaters prefer using both hands and
-palpating both transverses at once and there is no serious
-objection to this method, if confined to palpation in position
-B. In many cases, however, it leads to similar palpation of
-spinous processes, a most execrable habit.</p>
-
-<p>It should be remembered that with the first two Dorsals<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_52">52</a></span>
-the transverse will be found in a transverse plane which
-would pass between its own spinous process and that above.
-This is also true of the last three Dorsals, while in the
-middle Dorsals the transverse is usually (not always) level
-with the tip of the spinous process of the next superior
-vertebra.</p>
-
-<p>Before adjusting, to determine the <em>location</em> of a transverse
-process in order to direct an adjustment against it,
-first palpate spinous process and hold it with the tip of the
-middle finger. Then approximate with the first finger a
-point even with the tip of the spinous process above and
-about one inch from the spine—this of course in mid-dorsal.
-Then let second and third fingers follow the first so that
-all three rest on or near the transverse to be palpated.
-Pressing gently, but firmly, move the three fingers until the
-process can be felt beneath them. Hold the process with
-the middle finger so as to direct with it the contact of
-the adjusting hand to a point exactly over the transverse
-process.</p>
-
-<h4>Lumbars</h4>
-
-<p>The transverses of a Lumbar vertebra lie just even with
-the interspace between their own and the adjacent superior
-spinous process. They are deeply embedded in muscle
-tissue and very hard to palpate. They may vary considerably
-in size or length and the last one or two may be absolutely
-impalpable. It is sometimes advisable to adjust a
-rotated Lumbar by using the transverse as a lever, but this<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_53">53</a></span>
-should never be attempted unless the process can be distinctly
-felt. The method of locating in Lumbar is practically
-the same as in the Dorsal region.</p>
-
-<h4>Transverse Palpation with Patient Sitting</h4>
-
-<p>Palpation of Cervical transverses in position A has been
-described and is frequently done. Palpation of Dorsal or
-Lumbar transverses in the same position may sometimes
-be desirable. It can be done with the same movement as
-spinous process palpation, and may serve to detect a bent
-spinous process.</p>
-
-<p>If it is necessary to palpate both transverses at the same
-time, stand in front of the patient and lean over his shoulder,
-letting his shoulders rest against your body. Use
-palmar surface of fingers of both hands and note which
-transverse is posterior to its fellow, if either, or whether
-both are posterior to the line of the others above and
-below them.</p>
-
-<p>It is rarely possible to find if a transverse process be
-superior or inferior to its normal position, except the Atlas
-transverses, although this may occasionally be detected.
-Fortunately this is a rare form of subluxation, or appears
-rare, although it must be said that this apparent rarity may
-be due to our comparative inability to detect it in the living
-subject.</p>
-
-<h3 id="h_19">CURVES AND CURVATURES</h3>
-
-<p>For convenience, <dfn>curve</dfn> is used to denote the normal
-curvilinear deviation from a straight line naturally present
-in the normal spine or naturally assumed in response to<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_54">54</a></span>
-the need for equilibrium during the erect position of the
-body: <dfn>Curvature</dfn> means either the abnormal increase of
-any normal curve or the appearance of any abnormal curvilinear
-deviation of vertebrae from their normal position.
-Deviations from normal must contain at least three vertebrae
-to be considered curvatures.</p>
-
-<h4>Visual Examination</h4>
-
-<p>The general inspection of the spine which precedes the
-count should bring to light, in addition to prominent subluxations,
-and general symptoms observable by inspection
-of the back, any <em>marked curvatures</em>. Their general locality
-and direction will be noted by this observation and their
-details left to be discovered by closer examination.</p>
-
-<p>During palpation with a long and rapid glide one may
-also note these general points with respect to any curvature.</p>
-
-<p>Do not mistake the four normal curves, the anterior
-Cervical and Lumbar and the posterior Dorsal and Sacral,
-for curvatures. The normal Lumbar curve is so unusual
-in practice that a novice has been known to name it a
-lordosis.</p>
-
-<h4 id="curvatures">Description of Curvatures</h4>
-
-<p>Four varieties of curvature are commonly described.
-<dfn>Kyphosis</dfn> is a curvature with its convexity directed backward,
-usually, but not always, found in the Dorsal region.
-<dfn>Lordosis</dfn>, the opposite of Kyphosis, is an anterior curvature,
-usually in the Lumbar in which case it is an accentuation<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_55">55</a></span>
-of the normal curve. <dfn>Scoliosis</dfn> has its convexity directed
-laterally either to the right or the left. It is commonly
-also <dfn>Rotatory</dfn>, having its vertebrae rotated around
-their vertical axes so as to make the outer or the inner
-transverses more prominent than those on the other side.</p>
-
-<p>In a Scoliosis the rotation may swing either the bodies
-or the spinous processes toward the convex side of the
-curvature; the latter is much the easier of adjustment while
-the former furnishes one of the most intricate problems of
-adjustment.</p>
-
-<h4>Cause of Curvatures</h4>
-
-<p>Without entering here into a discussion of those disturbed
-metabolic processes—themselves the result of subluxation—which
-result in curvature by general softening of
-the bone, as in rachitis or spondylitis deformans, we will
-simply state the general proposition that almost all curvatures
-which are in any degree <em>angular</em> result from a single
-subluxation to be found at the point of the angle. It has
-been demonstrated in such cases that adjustment at that
-point will correct the curvature in time but it is usually
-wiser to hasten matters by selecting other points of attack
-by a method to be presently suggested.</p>
-
-<p>Long, regular, but not pronounced, Scoliosis, usually in
-the Dorsal, may be an example of <em>occupation curvature</em>,
-following the continued use of muscles in a fixed position
-and not due to subluxation. Another example is the mailman’s
-Lordosis. These in themselves are not detrimental<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_56">56</a></span>
-to health and are negligible unless some special point of
-impingement through individual subluxation exists within
-them.</p>
-
-<p>The sharp, angular kyphosis of Pott’s Disease, tubercular
-caries of the vertebrae, the curvature involving three or
-four vertebrae which are extremely tender to palpation,
-should warn against adjustment unless one can be very
-certain that the vertebrae are sufficiently intact. Fracture
-of a decayed vertebra is easily possible under adjustment.
-The cause of Pott’s Disease is usually at the angle point,
-most frequently the tenth Dorsal but possibly any Dorsal
-from fifth to twelfth.</p>
-
-<h4>Record on Curvatures</h4>
-
-<p>If it is the purpose of the examiner to straighten the
-curvature he should choose for adjustment a series of non-adjacent
-vertebrae which are most prominent in the direction
-of the curvature; thus in a right scoliosis he should
-choose only those vertebrae most prominently out to the
-<em>right</em>, and in a kyphosis only posterior ones. A lordosis
-as such cannot be properly adjusted except in the Cervicals,
-but lordosis is usually a compensating curvature (see below)
-and can be otherwise corrected.</p>
-
-<p>If the patient suffers from some disease which assumes
-more importance than the curvature and demands attention,
-select the one vertebra which is causing the disease, without
-reference to its position in the curvature, and adjust that
-vertebra into a proper relation with the adjacent ones, even<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_57">57</a></span>
-though you adjust directly toward the convexity of the
-curvature. Disease may often be relieved by <em>making a
-curvature regular</em> more quickly than by eliminating the
-entire curvature. Sometimes both considerations may influence
-the selection of vertebrae.</p>
-
-<p>In a curvature there is not necessarily pressure on nerves
-at every foramen. In fact, such pressure is the exception
-rather than the rule in curvature and a careful study of
-the spine must be made in order that adjustments may be
-accomplished without <em>causing</em> temporary impingement here
-and there.</p>
-
-<p>A foot-note describing curvature may be appended to
-the record of palpation. It should contain the special name
-of the curvature, whether simple or compound, and the
-numbers of the first and last vertebrae in it. For instance,
-note may read: “Right rotary scoliosis from D 3 to L 1
-inclusive.”</p>
-
-<h4>Compensatory Curvatures</h4>
-
-<p>When a primary curvature is present one or two secondary
-curvatures usually appear to preserve the equilibrium of
-the body. With a Dorsal kyphosis there is often a Lumbar
-lordosis and sometimes less marked lordosis in both Cervical
-and Lumbar. With a primary right scoliosis in the
-Lumbar there will be a secondary left scoliosis above. The
-secondary curvature is called compensatory. In selecting
-vertebrae for adjustment it is well to neglect the compensatory
-curvature as much as possible, leaving it to right<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_58">58</a></span>
-itself as the primary one is corrected. If, however, the
-primary curvature be a lordosis, and not adjustable, work
-on the secondary curvature may gradually aid in reducing
-the primary, to a certain extent at least.</p>
-
-<h4>Ankylosis</h4>
-
-<p>This topic is discussed here partly because it is so often
-associated with curvature.</p>
-
-<p>Ankylosis can be appreciated only by detecting the lack
-of normal movement between adjacent vertebrae. Place a
-finger in the interspace between suspected vertebrae and ask
-the patient to perform the movement calculated to separate
-the spinous processes in a normally movable spine. If in
-the Dorsals, ask him to drop the head and shoulders as
-far forward as possible without bending at the hips. Alternate
-repetitions of this movement with straightening and the
-spinous processes should alternately separate and approach
-each other. Test several successive vertebrae so as to note
-that all change their position except two.</p>
-
-<p>In the Lumbars have the patient repeatedly bend the
-body forward from the hips striving to make his spine
-convex backward. In the Cervicals forward flexion of the
-head will serve. Occasionally general ankylosis is found
-with curvature, as in Spondylitis Deformans.</p>
-
-<p>Many Chiropractors mistake failure to move a vertebra
-with an attempted adjustment for evidence of ankylosis.
-In nine cases out of ten such failure is due to other reasons,
-ankylosis being very infrequent. It is a much abused excuse<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_59">59</a></span>
-for incapability. Free movement between spinous processes
-is <em>absolute proof</em> that the vertebrae are not ankylosed.</p>
-
-<h3 id="h_20">DIFFICULTIES IN PALPATION</h3>
-
-<p>The chief difficulty arises from failure to observe some
-of the rules herein laid down.</p>
-
-<p>Carelessness or inattention precludes accuracy.</p>
-
-<p>Pain may cause the patient to assume an unnatural or
-cramped attitude simulating curvature, especially of the
-Cervicals. More errors occur from this cause in judging
-the laterality of C 2 than with any other vertebra.</p>
-
-<p>The occasional bent spinous process in Cervical or
-Dorsal regions may deceive the palpater unless transverse
-palpation is employed. But the frequency of slightly bent
-processes in dry spines and a superficiality of reasoning
-upon the subject have led to great overestimation of their
-importance. As a matter of fact only a very few maladjustments
-arise from deception of the palpater in this way,
-though the profession contains few practitioners who make
-a routine method of verifying by the transverses. The
-reason is simple. Bent processes are caused by direct violence
-applied before the union of shaft and epiphysis is
-complete. Sufficient force to produce a change of direction
-usually produces subluxation <em>in the same direction</em>.
-Adjustment continued until the offending process was quite
-aligned with its fellows would constitute overadjustment,
-but adjustment is not usually continued after all symptoms
-have subsided, so that actually small harm occurs through
-failure to detect bending.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_60">60</a></span></p>
-
-<p>An epiphyseal plate may be absent, having been broken
-off by trauma and absorbed. This can be discovered by
-noting the too-wide space between apparently adjacent
-vertebrae, and careful palpation will disclose the apparently
-much anterior vertebra, an appearance not borne out by
-the position of the transverses. When an epiphysis is absent
-a patient has a somewhat weak back from lack of
-muscular attachment.</p>
-
-<p>Lipoma, or the heavy cicatrix following a burn or carbuncle,
-may render palpation of two or three vertebrae
-impossible. In such a case only the palpater’s experience
-and his knowledge of the characteristics of various vertebrae
-will enable him accurately to number the remainder.</p>
-
-<p>Patients with much adipose tissue may require palpating
-in several positions in order to permit certainty.</p>
-
-<p>A deep third Cervical which is absolutely impalpable
-may mislead one, but a careful count which shows one
-vertebra overlooked indicates the necessity for a careful
-re-examination of the Cervicals, by which the gap at the
-third at least may be appreciated. If the Axis is very much
-inferior the third is especially likely to be overlooked.</p>
-
-<p>Anomalous cases have been found in which there were
-more or less than the usual number of movable vertebrae,
-the usual deviation being the presence of twenty-five, and
-the extra one being most commonly a Lumbar. In one case
-under my observation there were twenty-five movable vertebrae,
-apparently thirteen Dorsals according to shape, and
-only eleven pairs of ribs posteriorly, two pairs being dichotomous<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_61">61</a></span>
-so that there appeared thirteen pairs anteriorly.
-Deviations in number occur, in my experience, about once
-in five hundred cases.</p>
-
-<h3 id="h_21">LANDMARKS</h3>
-
-<p>The regional location of vertebrae by means of certain
-landmarks (so called) in or near the spine, is a much discussed
-question in the profession. Without discussing the
-various arguments in favor of this method, chief of which
-is the <em>inability of the untrained to count vertebrae</em>, let us
-set forth the principal landmarks used and the facts in
-regard to them.</p>
-
-<p>The seventh Cervical, called Vertebra Prominens, is usually
-considered a guide to the count. In over three hundred
-cases examined for that purpose the seventh Cervical was
-found to be Vertebra Prominens in about 65%, the other
-35% showing the sixth Cervical or first Dorsal to be the
-prominent one. This method is two-thirds as accurate as
-counting.</p>
-
-<p>The tubercle (Chassaignac’s) of the sixth Cervical
-transverse is said to be directly opposite the lower border
-of the cricoid cartilage and this is a better guide than the
-above.</p>
-
-<p>The third Dorsal spinous process is said to be on a level
-with the root of the spine of the scapula, and with arms
-hanging at sides, the upper angle of the scapula to be on a
-line between first and second Dorsal spinous process. This
-is not at all constant.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_62">62</a></span></p>
-
-<p>The inferior angle of the scapula is said by some writers
-to be on a line with the tip of the seventh Dorsal spine.
-Others locate it opposite the interspace between seventh and
-eighth Dorsals. Still others give it as opposite the eighth
-Dorsal spine. All are correct—<em>sometimes</em>. In truth, the
-inferior angle may be opposite any part of the spine between
-the sixth and ninth Dorsals. There is nothing constant
-about it.</p>
-
-<p>The twelfth rib may be followed to its articulation with
-the twelfth Dorsal vertebra. This is a good guide, providing
-that the rib can be palpated. The lower margin of the last
-rib is usually even with the spinous process of D 12 about
-one inch and a half from the mid-spinal line. The humor
-lies in the fact that the patient upon whom the count is so
-difficult as to require this verification is usually obese and
-obesity renders the rib impalpable.</p>
-
-<p>The line drawn between the iliac crests falls between
-the third and fourth Lumbar spinous processes in about
-98% of all cases. <em>This is our most reliable landmark.</em> It
-is used as described under the Count.</p>
-
-<p>All landmarks except the last two show such variance
-in different individuals as to be quite unreliable. The correct
-method of numbering spinous processes is the obvious
-and logical method—<em>count them</em>. The skill and accuracy
-of touch required for successful counting is invaluable in
-determining direction of subluxations.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_63">63</a></span></p>
-
-<h3 id="h_22">MENTAL ATTITUDE</h3>
-
-<p>In order to secure that absolute concentration without
-which it is impossible to appreciate properly those tactile
-impressions for the very <em>reception</em> of which such continued
-practice is necessary, the hands should leave the spine as
-little as possible during palpation; a second person should
-record subluxations found so that the palpater need only
-state, and not write, his conclusions; light pressure on the
-spine should always be used, as a heavy pressure desensitizes
-nerve-endings in the fingers; and silence should be
-maintained except for the necessary statement of points
-to be recorded.</p>
-
-<p>Palpate as rapidly as is consistent with good work. The
-more rapid the palpation, <em>if concentration is absolute</em>, the
-more accurate the impressions received.</p>
-
-<p>The <em>end</em> and <em>aim</em> of palpation is to determine the means
-by which impingement of nerves may be removed with the
-greatest rapidity and success. Palpation includes such a
-study of the vertebral column as will fix in your mind a
-clear thought-picture of the impinged nerves throughout
-its length.</p>
-
-<h3>FINALLY</h3>
-
-<p>If you would achieve success in Vertebral Palpation, be
-persistent. Spare no labor to acquire that accuracy of
-detail which distinguishes the expert from the amateur.
-You can make of yourself what you will. There is no
-limit to the ability which may be acquired. Another may
-guide your hands but with <em>you</em> lies your success.</p>
-
-<hr />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_64">64</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<h2 id="h_23"><a id="NERVE-TRACING"></a>NERVE-TRACING</h2>
-</div>
-
-<h4>Definition</h4>
-
-<p>Nerve-tracing is that branch of palpation by which the
-tenderness of irritated spinal nerves is discovered and their
-paths demonstrated.</p>
-
-<h4 id="h_24">Organ-Tracing</h4>
-
-<p>Organ-tracing is that branch of palpation which deals
-with the outlining of the boundaries and surface markings
-of a tender organ or part.</p>
-
-<p>Palpaters frequently confuse tenderness of one of the
-parenchymatous viscera for the tenderness of interlaced and
-branching nerve filaments, especially in the abdominal region.
-The fact that the tender area takes on the characteristic
-shape of one of the viscera is conclusive evidence
-that an organ, and not nerves, have been traced.</p>
-
-<h4 id="h_25">What Nerves Traceable</h4>
-
-<p>Any spinal nerve may be traceable for at least a part
-of its course. The cranial nerves are made inaccessible to
-palpation by their location, except the spinal portion of the
-spinal accessory and the terminal portions of the nerves to
-the face. Likewise the sympathetic trunks, except perhaps
-in the neck, are untraceable.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_65">65</a></span></p>
-
-<p>Nerve-tracing is comparatively easy in the upper and
-lower extremities, neck and back. The superficial nerves of
-the scalp are hard to follow on account of the hair. The
-superficial nerves of thorax, abdomen, and pelvis are accessible
-under the conditions mentioned below; the deep or
-visceral branches, never.</p>
-
-<p>Of those nerves mentioned as traceable, only such as
-are <em>irritated</em> and consequently swollen and tender, can be
-followed. If a nerve is very heavily impinged, especially if
-the impingement be chronic, it is partially or wholly paralyzed
-and not traceable. If the heavy impingement be
-acute, or if there be a light impingement serving as a
-mechanical irritant, nerve-tracing is a real aid to diagnosis.</p>
-
-<h4>Proportion of Cases with Traceable Nerves</h4>
-
-<p>About one-half of all the cases which visit Chiropractors
-for adjustment are susceptible of nerve-tracing. In the
-remaining half it is absolutely impossible to acquire any
-information in this way. Of the half who are at all susceptible,
-it is possible in perhaps four-fifths of all cases to
-secure <em>some</em> accurate or reliable information.</p>
-
-<p>The patient in whom all accessible nerves seem tender
-to light palpation is hyperesthetic and unavailable for tracing.</p>
-
-<p>In the usual case one or two nerves will be found easily
-traceable, while the rest exhibit no tenderness on pressure.
-Such a case furnishes the most reliable information securable
-by this method and the tender nerves may be considered
-as lightly or acutely impinged.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_66">66</a></span></p>
-
-<h4>Preconception of Nerves Essential</h4>
-
-<p>Knowledge of the anatomy of the nervous system is a
-part of the necessary equipment of the Chiropractor who
-would trace nerves and this knowledge should be so thorough
-as to enable the palpater to recognize each tender line
-found as an anatomically described nerve-path or an error
-on his part. The examiner must know the paths of all
-nerves and be able to predict from the first tender points
-discovered the probable course which the tenderness will
-follow, so as to direct his search along that probable path.</p>
-
-<p>He must be able to detect unconscious deception on the
-part of the patient through his knowledge of the anatomical
-impossibility of the apparent tracing. For instance, if for
-any reason he may appear to have traced a nerve upward
-beside the spinal column from D 10 to the eye by way of
-the vertex, he must know that this is an illusion—because
-such nerves do not exist and cannot be anatomically demonstrated—or
-accept the well merited ridicule of any educated
-person who discovers his absurdity.</p>
-
-<p>Because of the difficulty of determining whether the
-tender structure found be muscle, nerve, or viscus, and
-because of the natural suggestibility of both palpater and
-patient, nerve-tracing cannot be so reliable a guide to
-nerve-paths as is dissection. It should not be necessary to
-state this obvious truth but the calm acceptance, by many,
-of the weird conclusions based upon a belief in the infallibility
-of nerve-tracing testifies that it is necessary.</p>
-
-<p>Nerve-tracing is valuable only where the nerve-path<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_67">67</a></span>
-outlined as being tender corresponds to the known path
-of some nerve.</p>
-
-<h4 id="h_26">Suggestion</h4>
-
-<p>Paradoxically, knowledge of nerve-paths may lead to
-error. By the law of expectancy, we are prone to find what
-we look for and if we hold too strongly to the belief that
-because we have found one or two points of tenderness we
-must find a series of points extending along a mentally pictured
-nerve-path, we may search until we falsely believe
-that we have found this series.</p>
-
-<p>Likewise the patient, having been carefully informed as
-to the manner of procedure and knowing what we expect
-to discover, may unconsciously deceive us by feeling tenderness
-in response to suggestion, where no real impingement
-exists.</p>
-
-<h4 id="h_27">Place in Diagnosis</h4>
-
-<p>The value of nerve-tracing in diagnosis has been much
-overestimated by many, though the tendency of the profession
-seems to be toward rationalism along that line.</p>
-
-<p>Whereas, in palpation of the spine every real subluxation
-gives evidence of disease, or tendency to disease, while
-every normally aligned pair of vertebrae furnish proof that
-no disease can exist in the area of distribution of the nerve
-emerging between them, nerve-tracing is much less reliable.
-If the tender nerve be traceable to a vertebral subluxation
-it may be taken as additional evidence that the effect of that<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_68">68</a></span>
-subluxation is <em>disease</em>, rather than <em>tendency</em> to disease, truly
-an important distinction, but scarcely broad enough to support
-a diagnosis without aid.</p>
-
-<p>The absence of tenderness from nerves does not negative
-a disease in any instance, whereas the absence of subluxation
-<em>does</em>. Like all other expedients for the selection of
-vertebrae for adjustment without admitting the necessity for
-first acquiring much skill by much labor, nerve-tracing has a
-great weakness. Only irritated nerves are tender and the
-effects of subluxation may be either irritation or paralysis.</p>
-
-<p>If accurately done, sources of error carefully eliminated,
-and the results of nerve-tracing found to correspond with
-the condition of the spine and the other symptoms, this
-method of demonstrating to the patient the connection between
-the vertebrae and the diseased region of his body
-is valuable. It aids in convincing him of the validity of
-the Chiropractic theory.</p>
-
-<h3 id="h_28">TECHNIC OF NERVE TRACING</h3>
-
-<h4>Where to Begin</h4>
-
-<p>The palpater, having made his vertebral palpation, may
-begin at some point in the body indicated by the symptoms
-as diseased and, finding tenderness, follow the path of a
-nerve back to the spinal column where the nerve may be
-fairly presumed to enter the intervertebral foramen.</p>
-
-<p>Or he may use his palpation record as a guide and
-follow the tender nerves outward to their periphery. This
-is the better method.</p>
-
-<div id="ip_68" class="figcenter" style="max-width: 24.9375em;">
- <img src="images/i_069.jpg" width="399" height="600" alt="" />
- <div class="caption">Fig. 5. Technic of nerve tracing, showing position of fingers
-and marking of tender points.</div></div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_69">69</a></span></p>
-
-<h4>Palpation as Guide</h4>
-
-<p>When palpation has been made, remember that the impinged
-nerve is usually found on the side opposite to the
-direction of the spinous process in its departure from the
-median line. With a left subluxation the tenderness is
-usually, though not always, on the right side. If in the
-Lumbar, and the subluxation a rotation, the impinged nerve
-will be found <em>below</em> the transverse process of the subluxated
-vertebra. In the Cervical and Dorsal regions the tender
-nerve is usually below, but may be either above or below,
-the transverse of the subluxated one.</p>
-
-<p>Examine the nerves having exit from the foramina of
-each subluxated vertebra in turn from above downward.
-When a tender point is found about an inch from the mid-spinal
-line, attempt to follow the nerve and palpate until
-it has been traced as completely as possible.</p>
-
-<h4>Where to Expect Tenderness</h4>
-
-<p>The region immediately surrounding the spinous process
-of the subluxated vertebra may be tender because of impingement
-of the axons of the posterior primary division of
-that spinal nerve which emerges below the vertebra. Such
-tenderness is more common with anterior subluxations than
-with others. It is not to be confused with the <em>soreness</em>
-which often appears after adjustment and is due to bruising
-or straining of the tissues.</p>
-
-<p>Nerve tenderness may be discovered at a little distance
-from the mid-spinal line and at a level slightly lower than<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_70">70</a></span>
-the emergence of the nerve. If a nerve is irritated, the
-finger inserted between the ribs near their articulation with
-the transverse processes will elicit tenderness. The discovery
-of tender points along the spine is the most important
-part of nerve-tracing.</p>
-
-<h4>Nerve-Paths</h4>
-
-<p>Detailed description of the paths of all the spinal nerves
-may be studied from any standard work on anatomy and
-will not be included here, but it may be well to remind the
-reader of certain general tendencies.</p>
-
-<p>The spinal nerves do not cross the median line in front
-except perhaps fine interlacing fibres.</p>
-
-<p>In the Dorsal region the nerves are usually found following
-the interspaces until the lower ones debauch upon the
-abdominal wall anteriorly. There are, however, some Dorsal
-and lower Cervical nerve bundles which pass obliquely
-downward and outward to innervate back muscles.</p>
-
-<p>Reference to the section on Spino-Organic Connection
-will make clear the tissues supplied by each nerve.</p>
-
-<p><em>Slight</em> deviations from the usual course of nerves are
-common; <em>marked</em> deviations very infrequent.</p>
-
-<h4>Use of Fingers</h4>
-
-<p>Use second finger of either hand for the palpating finger,
-choosing the hand which can be most conveniently used as
-determined by the position of patient and the part of the
-body to be examined. There is no set rule. Reinforce this
-second finger by the pressure upon it of the first and third
-and, if desired, by pressing thumb against it. (See <a href="#ip_68">Fig. 5</a>.)</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_71">71</a></span></p>
-
-<p>Apply the tip of the palpating finger to the nerve with
-a motion such that it crosses the path of the nerve at right
-angles back and forth. Meanwhile the probable path of
-the nerve must be kept in mind. As the finger crosses
-the nerve-path it makes steady and even pressure upon any
-structures passing beneath it. The motion of the hand is
-almost a rolling motion, the finger tip probing, as it were,
-for a tender spot.</p>
-
-<h4>Tenderness—How Recognized</h4>
-
-<p>The irritated condition of the nerve which has thus been
-rolled beneath the finger may be recognized in one of three
-ways; the patient may involuntarily flinch, betraying the
-hurt; or he may inform the palpater of the hurt; or the
-swollen, cord-like nerve may be felt.</p>
-
-<p>The two former are the reliable guides, while the latter
-is only occasionally possible. In children and in feeble-minded,
-insane, or mute adults, the first mentioned method
-must be relied upon entirely. Muscular contraction is the
-unconscious or reflex response to pain and often occurs
-independently of the intelligence or state of mind of the
-subject.</p>
-
-<p>Of all the three methods the one most commonly relied
-upon is the second—the statements of the patient.</p>
-
-<h4>Instruction to Patient</h4>
-
-<p>The patient should be informed of your intentions when
-palpation is begun and should be asked to answer every time
-you apply your finger, saying, “Yes,” if the spot is tender<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_72">72</a></span>
-and, “No,” if not. He should speak promptly each time
-so as to avoid self-deception which might come with reasoning
-upon his sensations. Occasionally vary the steady
-rhythm of your movements by omitting one and note if the
-patient responds mechanically when you do not press.</p>
-
-<p>At times during the tracing, it is well to depart from
-the probable nerve-path and to touch again a point marked
-as tender, to see if the patient’s information may be relied
-upon. Whenever you leave the nerve-path his answer
-should be, “No,” immediately changing to, “Yes,” when
-you re-cross the tender line.</p>
-
-<h4>Marking Tender Points</h4>
-
-<p>At each tender point noted a small mark should be made
-with an eye-brow pencil or other grease-paint, which leaves
-a distinct but easily removable mark. These tender points
-should be noted and marked at intervals of about an inch.</p>
-
-<h4>Connecting Line</h4>
-
-<p>When the entire nerve-path has been traversed in this
-way, draw a line with the eye-brow pencil, passing through
-all the marks indicating points of tenderness. This line
-should be a sufficiently accurate rough outline of the nerve-path
-to make clear the spinal connection with the diseased
-area. The significance of this connection will be better
-understood when the section on Spino-Organic Connection
-has been studied.</p>
-
-<div id="ip_72" class="figcenter" style="max-width: 24.9375em;">
- <img src="images/i_072.jpg" width="399" height="600" alt="" />
- <div class="caption">Fig. 6. Anterior half of completed nerve tracing.</div></div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_73">73</a></span></p>
-
-<h4>Common Findings</h4>
-
-<p>In muscular rheumatism, neuralgia, neuritis, or in case
-of a local boil or abscess indicating local disturbance of the
-trophic influence of nerves, clear and definite tracings are
-common. Muscular spasm, such as wry-neck, usually has
-a very tender nerve associated. Localized painful disease
-of any kind is likely to be associated with a very definite
-nerve tenderness, as is the case frequently with appendicitis,
-ovaritis, hepatic colic, etc.</p>
-
-<p>The painless disorders, or various disorders of spleen,
-diaphragm, heart, lungs, etc., though they be of a very
-serious nature, seldom are discoverable by nerve-tracing
-unless their serous membranes are involved. Tracings <em>may</em>
-be made from D 2 or 3 to anterior thoracic walls in heart
-or lung disease but are not common.</p>
-
-<p>Any spinal nerve may be traceable at times through at
-least a part of its course.</p>
-
-<h4>Sources of Error</h4>
-
-<p>Several of these have been mentioned, such as the natural
-suggestibility of both examiner and patient. Among
-others are: failure in the back, thigh, or leg to reach the
-really tender nerve because of the interposition of several
-muscle layers between it and the finger, ignorance of nerve-paths,
-failure to apply equal pressure to all parts of a nerve,
-application of such heavy pressure that muscle tissue is
-bruised and hurt, and failure of full co-operation on the
-part of the patient. Let us consider these in turn.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_74">74</a></span></p>
-
-<p>If several muscle layers interpose themselves between
-the searching finger and the nerve, it is proper to push
-aside the intervening layers, using a twisting and rolling
-movement until the finger feels <em>underneath</em> the muscles.
-This done, and a tender nerve found underneath several
-muscle layers, the same amount of overlying tissue must
-be pushed aside each time the finger searches for the nerve.
-Only exhaustive study of the anatomy of the typical nervous
-system will enable the examiner to know exactly at what
-point a nerve will become more or less superficial. Unless
-he does know this it is best to follow the neutral rule that
-nerves tend to follow the long axes of ribs and limbs and
-to maintain their depth beneath the surface throughout
-their course. This statement is too general for accuracy.</p>
-
-<p>Care should be taken that equal pressure be made on all
-points palpated on one nerve. If the nerve pass over a
-bone, <em>less force</em> is needed to exert the same pressure than
-if it overlie muscle or other soft structure. The force used
-varies constantly as the hand moves from place to place,
-according to the density and hardness of the structures
-overlying and underlying a nerve.</p>
-
-<p>Sufficiently heavy pressure will elicit tenderness in all
-except anaesthetic patients. But if a nerve be irritated it
-will be tender without heavy pressure, when the finger really
-makes a close contact with it.</p>
-
-<p>If the patient willfully attempts to deceive the palpater,
-nerve-tracing might as well be abandoned except in those
-extreme cases where the patient will flinch against his will
-on account of extreme sensitiveness.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_75">75</a></span></p>
-
-<h4>Use of Second Hand</h4>
-
-<p>As far as possible, the second hand is placed opposite
-the tracing hand and steadily supports the body; its position
-changes with changes in the position of the first. If the
-arm is to be examined it had best be held away from the
-body, and the part to be examined held between the two
-hands.</p>
-
-<h4>Position of Patient</h4>
-
-<p>For tracing nerves in the neck, back, and upper extremities,
-the patient should sit easily. For lumbar, abdominal,
-or pelvic tracing, or for tracing in the lower extremities,
-have patient lie on side or back. Do not hesitate to
-change the position of the patient as often as is necessary
-to secure easy access to the part to be examined and relaxation
-of the patient’s muscles. Never allow the assumption
-of a strained position during tracing; the sensation of
-cramped muscles may be confused with sensations of nerve
-tenderness.</p>
-
-<hr />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_76">76</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<h2 id="h_29"><a id="SUBLUXATIONS"></a>SUBLUXATIONS</h2>
-</div>
-
-<h4 id="h_30">Definition</h4>
-
-<p>A vertebral subluxation is a displacement, less than a
-dislocation, in which the chief element is the partial loss
-of normal apposition of the articular surfaces of the subluxated
-vertebra with those of the vertebra above or below,
-or both. Or, Vertebral subluxation is a permanent partial
-dislocation.</p>
-
-<h4>How Produced</h4>
-
-<p>Subluxations are primarily caused by trauma—falls,
-blows, strains, etc., being the chief factors. Hereditary
-weakness in structure of some part predisposes by rendering
-that portion more easily displaced.</p>
-
-<p>Subluxations are never hereditary but may be congenital
-through violent or instrumental delivery into the world or
-may <em>appear</em> hereditary because they occur shortly after birth
-through the effect of light jars upon the hereditarily weakened
-segments of the spinal column.</p>
-
-<p>They are always the result of concussions of forces;
-never of forces acting entirely <em>within</em> the organism. They
-result from the contact of the body with its environment.</p>
-
-<p>It has been said that muscular action in response to
-peripheral irritation may produce subluxation. The laws
-of reflex action render this impossible. Given a normally<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_77">77</a></span>
-aligned vertebra, and consequently normal nerves and a
-normal reflex arc in that segment, the ventral horn cells
-respond to a <em>slight</em> peripheral stimulus by exciting muscular
-contraction on the <em>same</em> side with the irritation. If the irritation
-be sufficiently increased, the response occurs on <em>both</em>
-sides but most strongly on the side from which the irritation
-comes. Greater irritation merely serves to cause greater
-distribution of the responsive action. (See any standard
-physiology on reflex action.) In no case will the difference
-between the contractions of muscles on the two sides be
-sufficient to displace a normally aligned vertebra. Nature
-has provided against that contingency.</p>
-
-<p>Given a subluxated vertebra causing nerve impingement
-and thus interruption of the normal action of the reflex arc,
-irritation may result in greater contraction upon the <em>opposite</em>
-side than upon the side of the irritation. This is an
-abnormal condition and accounts for the <em>increase</em> of previously
-existing subluxations under pain or peripheral irritation.
-But in every instance trauma must and does precede
-and cause subluxation.</p>
-
-<h4>Reaction of Secondary Causes</h4>
-
-<p>Once produced, however, a subluxation may not cause
-noticeable effect until it has been <em>increased</em> in degree by the
-reaction of forces within the body such as poisons, general
-fever, etc. Thus germs, dietetic errors, exposure to sudden
-temperature changes, waste of energy through abnormal
-mental activities, as hate, fear, worry, etc., or through<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_78">78</a></span>
-physical excess—in fact, all the <em>secondary</em> causes of disease
-may <em>appear</em> to have produced a subluxation. In fact, they
-have merely accentuated that which already existed and
-have done so through the muscular contractions which they
-induced.</p>
-
-<p>General thinning of intervertebral substance through a
-condition of disturbed metabolism itself produced through
-the agency of some <em>one</em> serious subluxation, may narrow all
-the foramina and increase impingement of nerves at any
-point where a slight subluxation previously existed. An
-irritated nerve may become swollen and the nerve impinged
-at the foramen.</p>
-
-<h4 id="h_31">Law Governing Location</h4>
-
-<p>So definite is the law governing the effect of force applied
-to a given portion of the body upon an associated vertebral
-segment that the skilled Chiropractor who has studied vertebrate
-segmentation thoroughly may determine, from the
-history of a fall or injury, the vertebra which would tend to
-be subluxated by that injury and the tissues controlled from
-that part. The rule is this:</p>
-
-<p><em>Force applied to any body segment tends to subluxate
-the segmentally associated vertebra. This subluxation tends
-to produce disease throughout the area of distribution of the
-subjacent pair of spinal nerves.</em></p>
-
-<p>The task of explaining this law seems hopeless unless
-the student is familiar with human embryology and the life
-history of the vertebrata, as well all the details of human<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_79">79</a></span>
-anatomy. To such a student the law will be self-evident, so
-interwoven with the threads of higher organization as practically
-to form its pattern.</p>
-
-<p>In simple terms we might offer this general statement.
-Any force applied to the body with sufficient violence will
-produce subluxation of the vertebra above the spinal nerves
-supplying the injured area. Thus, the brachial plexus controls
-the arm and shoulder and connects with the spine by
-way of the 5, 6, 7, 8, Cervical and 1 Dorsal nerves. Any
-force striking the arm or shoulder tends to produce subluxation
-of the sixth or seventh Cervical or first Dorsal vertebra
-so that all permanent disease conditions resulting will be
-found in the arm or shoulder or nearby tissues of the
-neck.</p>
-
-<p>This theme presents a magnificent field for individual
-study and research but is, per se, beyond the limitations set
-for this work.</p>
-
-<h4>Effect of Subluxations</h4>
-
-<p>Slight subluxations may exist, because of the adaptation
-of surrounding parts and the slight play within the intervertebral
-foramen, without producing noticeable effect. They
-always, however, evidence a <em>tendency</em> to disease.</p>
-
-<p>The majority of subluxations do produce disease, to
-some degree, and do so by <em>impinging nerves</em>. Impingement
-may be either by pressure <em>against</em> a nerve or ganglion or by
-<em>constriction</em> of a nerve where it passes through an intervertebral
-foramen; the former occurs in the case of the<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_80">80</a></span>
-Cervical sympathetic, the sub-occipital nerves, and the sacral
-nerves; the latter is the commoner form in Dorsal and
-Lumbar regions of the spine. Probably the most positive
-constriction of a nerve which can occur within the body is to
-be found in rotation of Lumbar vertebrae; the body of the
-rotated vertebra encroaches upon the inferior nerve on the
-side opposite to the direction taken by the spinous process.</p>
-
-<p>Either variety of impingement produces disease, morbid
-structure or function, by irritation of the nerve: light impingement
-irritates, heavy impingement partially or completely
-paralyzes, the nerve.</p>
-
-<h3 id="h_32">VARIETIES OF SUBLUXATION</h3>
-
-<p>According to the abnormal relations between vertebrae
-subluxations may be variously described as rotated, tipped,
-anteriorly, posteriorly, or laterally displaced. They commonly
-combine two or more of these forms, so that the
-purely rotary or the entirely lateral subluxation is uncommon.</p>
-
-<h4>Rotation</h4>
-
-<p>Every vertebra has a vertical axis around which it tends
-to rotate. This axis is not always the center of mass but
-depends upon the arrangement of mass, the fixity of
-cartilages, ligaments, and muscles, which tend to hold some
-parts of the vertebra more fixed than others, and the apposition
-of articular processes, which tends to prevent movement
-in certain directions.</p>
-
-<p>The axis of rotation of the first Cervical is the center of<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_81">81</a></span>
-the odontoid process of the second Cervical, which articulates
-with the transverse ligament and anterior arch of the first.
-A frequent subluxation of the Atlas is a rotation around this
-process so that the one transverse is permanently posterior
-to its normal position and the other correspondingly anterior.</p>
-
-<p>The axis of rotation of the Cervicals below the Atlas is
-in the extreme anterior portion of their bodies. This part
-remains relatively fixed in rotatory subluxation while the tip
-of the spinous process describes the greatest arc.</p>
-
-<p>In the Dorsals the axis of rotation lies in the posterior
-portion of the centrum near the neural canal. When the
-spinous process appears laterally displaced in rotation the
-anterior portion of the body is slightly displaced in the opposite
-direction, twisting and straining the fibres of the
-intervertebral disk.</p>
-
-<p>In the Lumbar region rotation is the commonest form
-of subluxation, the axis of rotation being laterally movable
-upon a transverse line between the articular processes in
-the beginning and shifting, as soon as the vertebra leaves its
-normal relations, to the junction of the articular process
-with that of the adjacent vertebra on the side toward which
-the spinous process is moving. Thus, in rotation of the
-vertebra so that the spinous is to the right, the axis will be
-found on the right side, the superior articular process of the
-next vertebra serving as a support on which the inferior
-articular process of the rotating vertebra may turn. The
-processes are so firmly locked that unless the whole vertebra
-be quite posterior little lateral movement of the spinous<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_82">82</a></span>
-process is possible without marked rotation. The body
-describes the greatest arc because it is further removed from
-the center of rotation than is the tip of the spinous.</p>
-
-<h4>Tipping</h4>
-
-<p>This is a subluxation in which the one transverse process
-is, or appears to be, superior or inferior to the other. It
-occurs frequently to the Atlas in combination with lateral
-subluxation. In fact, the shape of the occipito-atlantal
-articulations is such that, if the remaining Cervicals maintain
-their proper relation to each other, the Atlas cannot be
-laterally displaced without a certain amount of tipping. It
-will be relatively superior on the prominent side and the
-head will be tipped toward that side; that is toward the
-side of the lateral displacement. Thus, on account of the
-wedge-shaped lateral masses, if the whole Atlas be to the
-right of its normal position the right side will be superior
-and the head tipped toward the right. This is only true
-when the vertebrae below maintain a normal interrelation.</p>
-
-<h4>Approximation</h4>
-
-<p>This is a name applied to that condition in which, on
-account of changes in the intervertebral disks due to subluxation
-interfering with metabolic processes, the bodies or
-spinous processes of vertebrae are crowded too closely
-together.</p>
-
-<p>Occasionally a spine is found in which, on palpation,<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_83">83</a></span>
-the spinous processes are found to be crowded together in
-groups, sometimes of two or three, sometimes of five or six;
-no two interspaces appear equal, a very wide one being
-succeeded by one or two which are almost inappreciable;
-the variation in width of the interspaces does not correspond
-to the known normal variation in those regions where
-the changing obliquity of spinous processes should modify
-the relative width of successive spaces. We expect, for
-instance, to find a wider space between third and fourth
-Dorsals than between second and third; if we do not find
-this difference it is doubtless due to cartilage change and
-the vertebrae are approximated.</p>
-
-<p>In case of general thinning of intervertebral substance
-unequally divided between different sections of the spine the
-record will show that almost every vertebra is listed either
-S or I, and if a system of underscoring is used that these
-two directions are frequently indicated as most noticeable.</p>
-
-<p>A study of the spine will make clear the fact that if the
-cartilage between any two Dorsal vertebrae be thinned in
-front the bodies of the vertebrae will be closer together and
-the spinous processes more widely separated; the spinous
-process of the upper vertebra will be crowded against the
-one superior to it and that of the lower against the one
-inferior to it. These spinous processes are said to be <em>approximated</em>.</p>
-
-<p>The correction of S or I subluxations, then, depends
-upon correction of disturbed nutritive processes.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_84">84</a></span></p>
-
-<h4>Lateral Displacements</h4>
-
-<p>According to the usage of earlier writers on subluxations
-this term (lateral displacement) included rotation of
-the vertebra as well as those changes in position in which
-the whole or nearly all of the vertebra deviates sidewise
-from its normal position. Since the introduction of the
-term “rotation” into the description of subluxations, the
-meaning of the term “lateral displacement” is much more
-restricted. It refers now to a condition which probably
-occurs in the strictest sense only in the Cervical region, most
-frequently with the first and second Cervical, the two being
-subluxated together.</p>
-
-<p>We have already stated that the most important fact to
-be determined regarding the Atlas is its lateral displacement,
-since this produces the greatest impingement of nerves.
-Lateral displacement of any other Cervical can best be
-judged by examination of the transverse processes, since
-by palpation of the spinous process alone it is quite impossible
-to distinguish between lateral and rotary subluxation.</p>
-
-<p>In the Dorsal and Lumbar regions the R or L used to
-describe the position of the spinous process most often
-indicates rotation of the vertebra. While it is perfectly
-proper thus to describe the subluxation on a record, in the
-determining of the form of adjustment to be used the position
-of the <em>whole</em> vertebra must be considered.</p>
-
-<h4>Anterior Subluxations</h4>
-
-<p>Forward displacements may occur anywhere in the
-spine. In the case of the first Cervical they are usually,<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_85">85</a></span>
-though not always, forward displacements of only one side—rotation—though
-the whole Atlas may be anterior if the
-Axis has moved with it or is tipped so that the spinous process
-is much superior. This is rare.</p>
-
-<p>Any Cervical may be anterior; usually a series are
-anterior (if any) amounting to an increase in the Cervical
-curve—a lordosis. This condition may be corrected by
-transverse adjustments given from the front and side.</p>
-
-<p>A Dorsal vertebra is only <em>relatively</em> anterior, the adjacent
-ones being relatively posterior, and the only possible correction
-at present is the adjustment of the posterior ones.
-A Lumbar cannot be anterior unless those below it are also
-anterior, on account of the locking of articulations. Discovery
-of anterior Lumbars is quite common. The fifth
-Lumbar may be subluxated anteriorly by slipping forward
-on the Sacrum; it must be <em>superior</em> at the same time, on
-account of the shape of the articulating surfaces which face
-downward and forward. The spinous process is crowded
-closely against the fourth while the body of the fifth is too
-widely separated from that of the fourth.</p>
-
-<h4>Posterior Subluxations</h4>
-
-<p>There are many Chiropractors who have always considered
-the posterior subluxation more than any other, not
-because it produces greater nerve impingement than others
-but because it is easiest to detect; it intrudes itself upon the
-attention of the unskilled examiner most persistently. Nor
-should its importance be underestimated, though we now<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_86">86</a></span>
-realize that in some instances a rotated or anterior vertebra
-may cause more nerve impingement than a posterior one.</p>
-
-<p>The posterior subluxation in the lower Dorsals and
-Lumbars is the easiest variety to adjust; in this region a
-posterior displacement of one vertebra tends to bring with
-that one the next adjacent superior one, the sharpest deviation
-occurring between the posterior one and the one below
-it.</p>
-
-<p>Any vertebra may be posterior: the Atlas is rarely so
-as a whole, and never unless the Axis is also displaced
-backward; the Cervical and Dorsal regions present frequent
-variations of this sort, which must not, however, be confused
-with long, prominent, or overdeveloped spinous processes;
-the Sacrum may be posterior to the ilium on one side,
-or to both ilia.</p>
-
-<h4>Occipital Subluxations</h4>
-
-<p>Mention should be made here of a form of subluxation
-not strictly vertebral—displacement between the condyles of
-the occipital bone and the lateral masses of the Atlas. This
-occurs when the head has been moved too violently upon
-the Atlas so as to cause an immediate nerve irritation and
-muscle tension sufficient to hold it in its abnormal position.
-The Cervicals may be quite normal below the Atlas though
-this, of course, is not the rule. Correction of occipital subluxations
-is made by applying force to the Atlas and to the
-skull, sometimes by holding Atlas and rotating the skull.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_87">87</a></span></p>
-
-<h4>Age of Subluxations</h4>
-
-<p>The relative age of subluxations may be determined,
-within rather wide limits, it is true, by a study of the form
-of the spinous process. Newly acquired subluxations are
-sharply defined, having noticeable <em>edges</em> on the spinous
-process. In time they tend to become rounded and blunt
-and appear to cover more surface, just as the mountain
-range which, when first upheaved, is sharp and rugged,
-gradually rounds into regular curves through the work of
-the elements.</p>
-
-<p>In this way Nature protects the subluxated vertebra
-from further contact with the environment surrounding
-man, the rounded process offering less opportunity for a
-blow or shock to affect it.</p>
-
-<h4>Changes in Shape</h4>
-
-<p>Bone diseases such as rachitis osteomalacia, etc., and
-especially Potts’ Disease, or spinal caries, make marked
-changes in the shape of vertebrae. Also a subluxated
-vertebra may gradually assume a shape suited to the abnormal
-position it occupies, the commonest change being
-the assumption of a wedge shape by the centrum. This is
-a great obstacle to adjustment, as the abnormal shape of the
-vertebra makes it tend to settle after each movement into
-the old abnormal position.</p>
-
-<p>There are few spines without some more or less misshapen
-vertebrae.</p>
-
-<p>Ankylosis also makes great changes in the shape of<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_88">88</a></span>
-vertebrae. There are two kinds of ankylosis—true and
-false. The first is a deposit of bone cells upon bone, often
-the formation of a bridgelike structure to hold contiguous
-vertebrae together. This may bind any portions of the
-vertebrae but most commonly holds the bodies, in which
-case it can only be appreciated by detecting the lack of
-movement between normally separable vertebrae. False
-ankylosis occurs with fever in bone and consists in an
-exudation of bone substance which sometimes produces
-remarkable distortions of shape.</p>
-
-<hr />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_89">89</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<h2 id="h_33"><a id="TECHNIC_OF_ADJUSTING"></a>TECHNIC OF ADJUSTING</h2>
-</div>
-
-<h4>Definitions</h4>
-
-<p>Vertebral Adjusting is the art of correcting by hand
-the malpositions of subluxated vertebrae.</p>
-
-<p>A Vertebral Adjustment, strictly speaking, should mean
-the complete restoration of normal relation between previously
-subluxated vertebrae. As used in Chiropractic, it
-means either a partial or complete restoration of such normal
-relation.</p>
-
-<p>Maladjustment, as used in the profession, designates any
-movement of vertebrae by hand which produces or increases
-subluxation.</p>
-
-<h3 id="h_34">GENERAL PRINCIPLES OF ADJUSTING</h3>
-
-<p>It will be well for the student to master first the general
-rules and principles which govern vertebral adjustment and
-then to proceed to a detailed investigation of each movement,
-in turn, before practicing it. The art of adjusting
-can only be acquired by practice, and a high degree of excellence
-in it only by <em>long-continued</em> practice. However, the
-rapidity with which it can be mastered depends largely upon
-the formation of a clear pre-conception of the work to be
-done and the manner of its doing.</p>
-
-<p>As the student progresses in the art he finds himself
-occasionally guilty of errors which mar, in some degree,<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_90">90</a></span>
-the efficiency of his work. These may arise from unconscious
-modification of the technic first learned or from
-unconscious repetition of some necessary modification demanded
-by a special peculiarity in one or more cases.</p>
-
-<p>This section is intended to furnish the proper pre-conception
-and also to serve as a monitor to adjusters who, by
-reference to the precepts herein set down, may discover and
-remedy their own errors. It is not intended to furnish
-sufficient education to warrant practice without clinical instruction,
-which is unwarrantable, but rather to accelerate
-the education which practice alone can furnish.</p>
-
-<h4>Object of Adjustment</h4>
-
-<p>The vertebral subluxation being an abnormality of
-<em>relation</em> between vertebrae, it is obvious that its correction
-must be a return of normal relation. This can only be accomplished
-by bringing about a change of <em>relative</em> position.
-Movement of a section of the spine composed of several
-vertebrae is not, in the true sense, an Adjustment. It is the
-<em>single</em> vertebra which must be moved.</p>
-
-<p>The movement should be one calculated to bring the
-vertebra to its normal position <em>in the most direct manner
-possible</em>. Such a movement should be used as will reverse
-the direction of the forces which subluxated the vertebra.
-It should be applied to the transverse or spinous processes,
-or to the lamina, as is sometimes done in the case of the
-Atlas, according to the <em>kind</em> of subluxation. Different subluxations
-require different handling. Cases vary. Select<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_91">91</a></span>
-the move <em>best suited to the case</em>. This can be determined
-most properly by correct palpation which fixes in the mind
-of the adjuster the position of every part of the vertebra,
-its relation to its fellows, the points of greatest nerve impingement,
-etc., all of which should suggest the best method
-for correction.</p>
-
-<p>The prime object of adjustment is the removal of impingement
-from nerves.</p>
-
-<h4>Transmitted Shock vs. Thrust</h4>
-
-<p>The movement used in adjusting has been variously
-described. Many writers and teachers have used the term
-“thrust” to describe the movement of the hands, and the
-term is correctly applied to the movement used by many
-Chiropractors. But a careful study of the methods of applying
-force in use among the most successful adjusters,
-those who have attained the greatest results with the slightest
-percentage of failures and a minimum of pain to the
-patient, discloses the fact that the chief element of their
-adjustment is <em>transmitted shock</em>.</p>
-
-<p>The hand is held in close contact with the vertebra to be
-adjusted and the arms and shoulders describe such movements
-as to deliver the required amount of force with the
-slightest possible change in the position of the hands. The
-vertebra bounds away from the contact hand. In the delivery
-of a <em>thrust</em> the hand would follow the vertebra, forcing each
-portion of the movement. The real effect of a thrusting
-motion, since the hand cannot enter the body as a sharp<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_92">92</a></span>
-instrument would, is that of <em>pushing</em>. Pushing neither
-subluxates nor adjusts vertebrae so readily as does a rapidly
-applied shock.</p>
-
-<p>Let us illustrate with a common experiment in physics.
-Suspend a number of ivory balls by cords of equal length
-in such a manner that each is in contact with its fellow and
-all are in a straight line. When the balls are properly adjusted
-a straight line should connect their centers. Hold one
-end ball firmly in the hand or with an instrument which
-renders it absolutely fixed. Then strike sharply with a
-light hammer. The balls will all remain stationary except
-the one on the opposite end which will fly off to a distance
-exactly measurable according to the force of the blow.
-How does this occur?</p>
-
-<p>A shock is transmitted through the molecules of the ivory
-until it reaches the end ball, which is not held back by another.
-Here the transmitted force is expended in molar
-motion, the ball leaping away from its fellows as if it had
-been hung alone and had been struck with the same force.</p>
-
-<p>It is well known that by placing an elbow firmly against
-a man’s jaw and then sharply striking the closed fist with
-the other hand, open, a very heavy blow can be given; yet
-the forearm, through which the shock is transmitted, does
-not move.</p>
-
-<p>Now ivory is very like human bone. Further, it has been
-demonstrated that the law illustrated by the above experiment
-is equally applicable to the movement of vertebrae.
-The pushing or thrusting movement <em>may</em> move a specific<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_93">93</a></span>
-vertebra, but it is probable that the chief factor in so doing
-is the element of transmitted shock contained in the movement
-and delivered at the instant of release of the hand from
-the spine at the end of the movement.</p>
-
-<p>On the other hand it is obvious that a pushing or
-thrusting movement may move several vertebrae in addition
-to the one directly in contact with the adjusting hand, in
-consequence of the way in which the spinal segments are
-closely bound together. If a steady strain is used, in which
-muscles and ligaments have time to act, one of three results
-may occur: (a) the specific adjustment; (b) the movement
-of several vertebrae at one time, which does not constitute
-an adjustment; (c) the giving way of the spine at
-its weakest point, which may be some distance from the
-point of contact with the adjusting hand, the ligaments and
-muscles having communicated and diffused the strain
-throughout a large area. In the latter contingency the
-result is usually a new subluxation or the increase of an
-old one, instead of an adjustment.</p>
-
-<h4>The Rapid Movement</h4>
-
-<p>Thus <em>Speed</em> becomes an important factor in correct adjustment.</p>
-
-<p>A good illustration of the value of speed may be taken
-from a pile of stakes bound together by a cord. If a man
-with a hammer desires to remove the center stake of the
-group, and attempts to do so with a slow pushing movement,
-the result is a change of position of many stakes, which<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_94">94</a></span>
-adhere to the center stake and to each other. If, on the
-contrary, he strikes a sharp, quick blow with his hammer,
-meeting squarely the center of balance of the one stake, it
-will fly straight from its position leaving the others unmoved.
-This is exactly what we desire to accomplish with an adjustment.
-By the speed of the movement we expect to
-move <em>one</em> vertebra before adhesion or the contraction of
-muscles or inelasticity of ligaments can diffuse the force.</p>
-
-<h4>Close Contact</h4>
-
-<p>In order to accomplish the transmitted shock it would
-seem wisest, at first thought, to draw back the hand and
-strike the vertebra sharply. On the contrary, it has been
-found advisable to place the hand carefully in <em>close</em> and
-<em>immediate contact</em> with the vertebra to be adjusted. Nature
-herself shows us the way in the delicate shock-transmitting
-mechanism of the tympanum.</p>
-
-<p>Also the hand of the adjuster will cover much more
-than merely the spinous or transverse process which is used
-as a lever and to which it is desired to transmit the shock,
-unless carefully placed so that only a <em>small portion</em> is in
-contact; by such a contact diffusion of the shock is prevented
-and its efficiency within a limited area is increased. A carpenter
-wishing to countersink a nail places in contact with
-the nail head a small instrument called a countersink, which
-he then strikes sharply with a hammer. The contact hand
-of the adjuster represents the countersink and is used by the
-two arms as a passive instrument for transmitting shock.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_95">95</a></span></p>
-
-<p>The close contact of the hand, which remains passive,
-renders the adjustment much less painful to the patient than
-it would otherwise be, and one of the prime objects in the
-mind of the adjuster should be the minimizing of pain inflicted,
-by any means which does not lessen the resulting
-benefit. Also any drawing back of the hand before the
-movement warns the patient and tends to induce involuntary
-muscular contraction which interferes with adjustment.</p>
-
-<h4>Relaxation</h4>
-
-<p>In an adjustment it is necessary to overcome two kinds
-of resistance—the passive resistance of inertia, of ligaments,
-or of superincumbent weight, and the active resistance of
-muscular contraction. It is important that both forms be
-minimized.</p>
-
-<p>The first may be lessened through the position of the
-patient’s body; he is placed so that the vertebra to be adjusted
-is in the freest possible position. The second is reduced
-to the least possible quantity, amounting to no more
-than muscle tonus, by using two methods: (a) Oral Suggestion,
-and (b) Muscular Suggestion.</p>
-
-<h4>Oral Suggestion</h4>
-
-<p>Explain to the patient the need for relaxation. Make it
-clear to him that less force will be required if his muscles
-are passive. Remind him frequently of this and assume that
-he desires to relax. A word immediately before the adjustment
-often induces a temporary relaxation during which<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_96">96</a></span>
-the adjustment is given. Anything which detracts the
-attention from the coming shock is an aid. Sometimes asking
-the patient to inhale and exhale slowly and deeply will
-sufficiently take his attention from the adjustment. Experience
-will teach him that he suffers less pain when relaxed
-and presently relaxation becomes a habit. Instructing
-patients to think of sleep, turning the eyeballs upward, has
-been effective with some.</p>
-
-<h4>Muscular Suggestion</h4>
-
-<p>This can only be given by maintaining a state of relaxation
-in one’s own muscles, which in itself is desirable in
-most cases, for reasons to be presently explained. In handling
-Cervical vertebrae move the head gently from side to
-side with your own hands relaxed as much as possible. The
-lazy motion suggests relaxation. Then when it is felt that
-the neck is thoroughly relaxed, vary the motion with a quick
-adjusting movement.</p>
-
-<p>In Dorsal and Lumbar regions after the hands are in
-correct position the adjuster should pause a moment both
-to be sure that the direction of movement and his purpose
-to move are clearly fixed in his mind and to be certain that
-both himself and the patient are relaxed. The adjustment is
-given instantly and from a perfectly lax muscle, as a boxer
-strikes.</p>
-
-<p>An added advantage is the greater amount of speed and
-control which may be commanded in this way. The lax
-arm, being in a neutral state as regards motion, can be contracted<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_97">97</a></span>
-in any desired direction without loss of force or of
-time, whereas a taut muscle cannot further effect motion of
-the arm without relaxation of its antagonistic muscles, which
-takes time.</p>
-
-<h4>Muscular Control</h4>
-
-<p>Considerable contral over one’s own muscles is necessary
-in order perfectly to relax arm and shoulder muscles
-just before the adjustment and then to utilize a measured
-and determined quantity of force in a desired direction. To
-acquire this much practice is necessary—practice on the living
-subject. The desired end may be hastened, however, by
-acquiring the abstract property of muscular control or by
-developing control already gained.</p>
-
-<p>Many different forms of exercise will aid in the acquisition
-of muscular control and the ability to relax and
-then to follow the relaxation with an instantaneous whiplike
-contraction in a given direction. The best of these is
-without doubt <em>bag-punching</em>. The movements employed
-with a punching-bag, especially the lateral quadruple movement
-with both elbows and both hands, tend to develop
-precisely the sort of control needed for correct adjusting.
-The beginner can do no better than to practice in this way,
-by which, it must be remembered, only a necessary <em>property</em>,
-and not by any means the exact movement, may be acquired.</p>
-
-<h4>Amount of Force</h4>
-
-<p>The amount of force used in an adjustment varies so
-much in different spines and in different parts of the same<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_98">98</a></span>
-spine that it is quite impossible to state any correct estimate
-of it in terms of physical units. In general the Cervicals
-move with least resistance, then the Dorsals, then the Lumbars,
-and finally the Sacrum and Ilia as hardest of all to
-displace or replace.</p>
-
-<p>In developing additional force when it is found that
-the force first used on any vertebra has been insufficient to
-move it, remember this law: <em>Work equals one-half Mass
-times the square of the Velocity</em>. In other words, doubling
-the speed of the movement increases its effectiveness four-fold;
-tripling it, nine-fold.</p>
-
-<p>The increase in force should never be effected by increasing
-the <em>weight</em> or <em>pressure</em> upon the patient’s body, for
-reasons which should be clear from a study of previous
-pages, but always by increasing the <em>speed</em> of the movement.</p>
-
-<h4>Names Used to Describe Movements</h4>
-
-<p>The names herein employed to indicate certain movements,
-each a well-defined method of procedure for the
-accomplishment of some special end, are the names or descriptive
-terms which seem to be in the most general use at
-this time. Few of these movements have arrived suddenly;
-most of them are the result of gradual growth and evolution:
-so with the terms by which they are known; they have
-gradually become a part of the common language of the
-profession. Usage sanctions them, though some of them are
-cumbersome, unwieldy, or entirely inappropriate.</p>
-
-<div id="ip_98" class="figcenter" style="max-width: 24.9375em;">
- <img src="images/i_099.jpg" width="399" height="600" alt="" />
- <div class="caption">
-
-<p>Fig. 7. Morikubo Move. For correction of a lateral and rotated
-Atlas (L. A.). Pisiform contact with anterior transverse.</p></div></div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_99">99</a></span></p>
-
-<h3 id="h_35">SPECIAL TECHNIC</h3>
-
-<h3>MORIKUBO MOVE</h3>
-
-<p>A movement for the correction of a lateral and rotated
-Atlas, indicated for use only when the Atlas is recorded as
-R. A. or L. A. The position of the patient’s head renders
-the transverse process inaccessible unless it be anterior on
-the side from which adjustment is to be given.</p>
-
-<h4>Position of Patient</h4>
-
-<p>Place two sections of the bifid bench together so as to
-secure the effect of a solid bench with an upward sloping
-front. Have patient lying on back with back of head resting
-firmly on bench, chin slightly uptilted. Then turn patient’s
-head so that it faces sidewise and rests flatly on the side of
-the least prominent transverse. This exposes the anterior
-transverse in front of the tendons of the sterno-mastoid
-muscle.</p>
-
-<h4>Use of Hands</h4>
-
-<p>Stand leaning over head of bench and carefully place
-the pisiform bone of adjusting hand upon the tip of the
-transverse process, being careful to push aside the sterno-mastoid
-tendons if they interpose themselves between the
-pisiform and the process. The fingers of the adjusting
-hand extend downward toward the clavicle and rest lightly,<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_100">100</a></span>
-very lightly, upon the patient’s neck. With the other hand
-firmly grip the wrist of the adjusting hand, fitting the pisiform
-of the upper hand into the hollow below the styloid
-process of the radius.</p>
-
-<h4>Movement</h4>
-
-<p>This is delivered straight downward toward the bench.
-It should be light and quick and the hand should not follow
-the process in its movement.</p>
-
-<p>This movement is painful and should not be used if
-avoidable. When used it requires the utmost care and a
-careful measuring of force. Err, if at all, on the side of
-overcaution. The technic will be better understood after
-study of the more detailed description of “The Recoil”,
-since the position and use of hands, arms, and shoulders is
-much the same for both.</p>
-
-<h3>PISIFORM ANTERIOR CERVICAL MOVE</h3>
-
-<p>Indicated for rotation of a Cervical vertebra in which one
-transverse process is anterior to its normal position or more
-anterior than its fellow which may also be somewhat, though
-less, anterior.</p>
-
-<h4>Placing Patient</h4>
-
-<p>As for the Morikubo Move place the patient in the dorsal
-recumbent posture with head resting on bench and chin
-uptilted. Turn patient’s face slightly away from the side of
-the selected anterior transverse and steady the head with the
-free hand while palpating.</p>
-
-<div id="ip_100" class="figcenter" style="max-width: 24.5625em;">
- <img src="images/i_101.jpg" width="393" height="600" alt="" />
- <div class="caption">Fig. 8. Pisiform anterior Cervical move.</div></div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_101">101</a></span></p>
-
-<h4>Making Contact</h4>
-
-<p>Palpate downward from the Atlas transverse along the
-posterior margin of the sterno-mastoid, dipping deeply into
-the neck and exploring with the tips of the first three fingers
-until the offending process is felt as a nodule of bone plainer
-to the touch than those above and below. Always reach
-<em>across</em> the neck to the selected transverse; if it be the right,
-stand on the patient’s left and use left hand for palpating
-and for contact hand as well.</p>
-
-<p>Having found the process, gently move aside any tissues
-which tend to interpose between the finger and the bone,
-change hands so that the palpating hand is free and the
-other holds the contact spot clear of interposed tissue and
-plainly points it out, then place pisiform bone of contact
-hand gently but firmly against the <em>front</em> of the process so
-that a mass of bone is felt between the pisiform and the
-bench when downward pressure is made.</p>
-
-<h4>Completing Position</h4>
-
-<p>It will be noted here that the head is unstable and tends
-to rock with slight pressure or movement of the contact
-hand. Steady the head by placing the knee upon head of
-bench and against side of patient’s head, not roughly but
-so that the head cannot move further toward the adjuster.</p>
-
-<p>Now reinforce the contact hand by gripping the wrist
-with the other, press slightly downward to tighten the contact
-and avoid slipping, and you are ready for</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_102">102</a></span></p>
-
-<h4>The Movement</h4>
-
-<p class="in0">which is directed sharply <em>downward</em> toward the bench. This
-move rotates the vertebra around its vertical axis and puts
-a strain in a backward direction on the whole column at
-this point.</p>
-
-<p>Care must be used, because the move at best is painful.
-It is easy to slip across the end of the transverse. Take every
-precaution to avoid imprisoning a muscle, nerve, or blood-vessel
-between the contact hand and the vertebra. Rightly
-used this move is valuable, perhaps most valuable of all
-anterior Cervical moves, but it requires nice judgment.</p>
-
-<h3>LAST FINGER CONTACT</h3>
-
-<p>This movement differs from the preceding one in two
-important particulars; the contact hand must be so selected
-with relation to the side of vertebra adjusted that the fingers
-will extend upward toward the patient’s head, and the opposing
-hand supports the head instead of reinforcing the contact
-hand.</p>
-
-<h4>Placing Patient</h4>
-
-<p>As for preceding move. The head will remain in this
-position only until the contact is made, after which it will be
-raised by the supporting hand until a tight contact is felt and
-the neck muscles drawn fairly taut.</p>
-
-<div id="ip_102" class="figcenter" style="max-width: 24.5625em;">
- <img src="images/i_102.jpg" width="393" height="600" alt="" />
- <div class="caption">Fig. 9. Last finger contact for anterior Cervical.</div></div>
-
-<h4>Making Contact</h4>
-
-<p>Palpate with left hand if standing on patient’s left to
-adjust a right, anterior subluxation. Find the offending<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_103">103</a></span>
-anterior transverse, draw tissues away with middle finger of
-palpating hand, change to middle finger of free hand which
-marks and holds the point of contact. Now place (with
-care) the base of the little finger of the hand which was
-used for palpating, at a point just below the condyle of the
-last metacarpal and a little to the palmar side, in direct contact
-with the front of the transverse. The last finger will be
-flexed toward the radial side and a shallow depression thus
-left for the contact.</p>
-
-<h4>Completing Position</h4>
-
-<p>Hold contact lightly and slip the free hand under the
-patient’s head, which faces slightly toward the adjuster.
-Raise the head, bending the neck away from the adjusting
-hand and toward patient’s chest until it is felt that the
-contact is secure and that further movement would put the
-neck upon a strain. You are ready for</p>
-
-<h4>The Movement</h4>
-
-<p class="in0">which is delivered entirely with contact hand, downward
-and toward the back of the neck. The delivery is difficult
-because the force arm is flexed at the elbow and the position
-awkward. Practice, however, will soon render one adept.</p>
-
-<h4>Uses</h4>
-
-<p>For rotated vertebrae which have one transverse anterior
-to the other, Cervicals only. This move gives a slightly less
-advantageous force angle than the preceding, but is less
-likely to be painful.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_104">104</a></span></p>
-
-<h3>SECOND METACARPAL CONTACT</h3>
-
-<h4>Position of Patient</h4>
-
-<p>Place patient supine on bench so that his head extends
-beyond the end of bench and is supported by the upraised
-knee of the palpater. Stand at head of bench so as to face
-patient’s feet.</p>
-
-<h4>Use of Hands</h4>
-
-<p>Differing from their use in the preceding moves the
-hands are so placed that the adjusting hand for a right,
-anterior subluxation will be right hand, for a left anterior
-the left hand. The opposite hand supports the head after
-contact is made.</p>
-
-<h4>Making Contact</h4>
-
-<p>Contact point on hand is second metacarpal at the end of
-the condyle, or second metacarpo-phalangeal joint. This is
-placed in front of the offending transverse, the head having
-been rotated away from that side and other tissues drawn
-carefully aside from the bone. The back of the hand is
-downward toward the clavicle, fingers semi-flexed on palm,
-thumb resting on jaw.</p>
-
-<h4>Supporting Head</h4>
-
-<p>The following position is the correct one for supporting
-the head in all Cervical adjustments delivered in the above
-position of patient and adjuster.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_105">105</a></span></p>
-
-<p>Cup the supporting hand slightly and fit the patient’s
-ear into the cupped palm. Let fingers extend toward the
-base and back of the neck, the finger position varying according
-to the amount of rotation of the head so that the
-fingers are in all cases directly <em>under</em> the head weight. The
-wrist then flexes on the hand, and wrist and forearm are
-brought up across the patient’s forehead so that a force
-delivered from the opposite side cannot cause the head to roll
-or move upon the supporting hand. After placing both
-hands draw the head so that the chin is tilted upward until
-it is felt that contact is snug and tight. This supporting
-position is invaluable and much neglected by adjusters, who
-might save themselves much annoyance and many failures
-by its constant use. In the study of succeeding Cervical
-moves refer to this description frequently. We shall call it
-the Hook Support, because the arm and hand resemble a
-hook which grasps the under side of the head and curves
-over the upper.</p>
-
-<h4>Movement</h4>
-
-<p>This is delivered entirely with contact hand and in a
-direction as much posterior as can be achieved without
-slipping past the end of the process. If the head is sufficiently
-rotated away from the contact side the angle of force is
-better than with a straight lateral adjustment, which it somewhat
-resembles, but not so good for anteriors as either of
-the two preceding moves. It is chiefly useful when the other
-two fail.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_106">106</a></span></p>
-
-<h3>OCCIPITO—ATLANTAL MOVE</h3>
-
-<p>To move an Atlas so disposed that its one side is posterior
-while the whole vertebra is laterally displaced in the same
-direction; to move, for instance, an Atlas R. P.</p>
-
-<p>Have patient lying on back in position C with head projecting
-beyond bench and supported by adjuster’s knee.</p>
-
-<h4>Placing of Hands</h4>
-
-<p>Place the first three fingers of one hand under the most
-laterally prominent transverse so as to hold it firm, first
-placing the first finger carefully just behind and against the
-end of that transverse and then reinforcing it with the
-second and third fingers, slightly tensed, and resting their
-tips on the lamina close underneath the occipital bone.</p>
-
-<p>Next place the other hand so that the thumb rests
-firmly upon the patient’s jaw and the first finger extends
-backward along the lower margin of the occipital bone.</p>
-
-<p>To complete the position rotate the head gently toward
-the side of the laterally prominent Atlas, until it rests, face
-toward the side, and is supported by the three fingers of the
-one hand and the heel and wrist of the same hand. It will
-be noted that when the head is rotated the first finger of
-supporting hand slips to a position directly upon the tip of
-the transverse process and the other two take its place
-against the posterior aspect of the tip of the transverse. The
-Atlas now rests with its intertransverse line almost vertically
-upward from supporting fingers, which hold it against further
-rotation.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_107">107</a></span></p>
-
-<h4>Movement</h4>
-
-<p>When the neck muscles have been thoroughly relaxed by
-slight and gentle movement, throw the upper elbow sharply
-away from your body, which has the effect of transmitting
-force through the thumb to the jaw and sharply rotating
-the head still further, loosening its articulation with the now
-firmly held Atlas. The condyloid joints thus loosened tend
-to settle into their proper relations, the weight of the head
-causing it to slip downward—laterally upon the Atlas.</p>
-
-<h4>Uses</h4>
-
-<p>This is really a movement of the head rather than of
-the Atlas and is an easy movement when practicable. It
-requires complete relaxation and will often fail. It is
-probable that many apparent Atlas subluxations are really
-subluxations of the head upon that bone which leave Atlas
-and Axis in normal relation. This move is most used to
-loosen the Atlas when it resists ordinary adjustments.</p>
-
-<h3>“THE BREAK” No. 1<br />
-
-<span class="subhead">(Lateral Cervical Move)</span></h3>
-
-<p>The principle involved in this and the three succeeding
-moves is the same. The contact is made with the end of the
-laterally prominent transverse process of a Cervical vertebra
-other than the Atlas, and the movement is directed entirely
-from side to side. It is to be used only for lateral and not
-for rotary or anterior or posterior subluxations, a point to<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_108">108</a></span>
-be remembered as it is just as easy to produce as to correct
-subluxation with this move.</p>
-
-<h4>Position</h4>
-
-<p>Have patient lying on back in position C, with head
-projecting beyond bench and supported by adjuster’s knee.
-Following a record previously made count downward to a
-subluxated vertebra and palpate both transverses with the
-two hands at once to find if one is prominent laterally, remembering
-that the record indicates merely the position of
-the spinous process.</p>
-
-<p>Having found the laterally prominent transverse, place
-the tip of the finger of the corresponding hand on the spinous
-of the subluxated vertebra; that is, if a right subluxation,
-use right hand and if a left, use left hand. Then draw the
-hand around until the middle of the proximal phalanx of the
-first finger rests against the end of the transverse. The tip
-of the finger will be freed from the spinous by this movement.</p>
-
-<p>Hold the adjusting hand tense, edgewise to the neck,
-fingers together and pointing downward. The thumb may
-rest against the patient’s jaw or may be free; the essential
-thing is the snug contact of the first finger against the
-transverse.</p>
-
-<div id="ip_108" class="figcenter" style="max-width: 24.6875em;">
- <img src="images/i_108.jpg" width="395" height="600" alt="" />
- <div class="caption">Fig. 10. “The Break,” No. 1, from right. Contact; first phalanx
-with end of right transverse.</div></div>
-
-<h4>Movement</h4>
-
-<p>With the hand in position and the head supported by the
-Hook Support, bend the head laterally, keeping the face upward,<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_109">109</a></span>
-until it is felt that further movement would strain
-the muscles.</p>
-
-<p>Deliver the movement in a straight lateral direction,
-quickly and entirely with the contact hand.</p>
-
-<h3>“THE BREAK” No. 2</h3>
-
-<p>For the Atlas only, and for straight lateral displacement
-of that vertebra.</p>
-
-<h4>Position and Contact</h4>
-
-<p>Position of patient’s head and of supporting hand exactly
-as in using Break No. 1. Contact is made with the end
-of the Atlas transverse on the laterally prominent side. Contact
-point on hand is second metacarpo-phalangeal joint, or
-rather, the condyle of the second metacarpal.</p>
-
-<h4>Movement</h4>
-
-<p>As for Break No. 1.</p>
-
-<h3>“THE BREAK” No. 3</h3>
-
-<h4>Position</h4>
-
-<p>Have patient sitting erect on bench or stool and stand
-before him. For a right subluxation use left hand and for
-a left, right hand. Contact point is the middle of the proximal
-phalanx of the first finger and the fingers reach backward
-and downward, thumb upward so as to be out of the
-way.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_110">110</a></span></p>
-
-<h4>Movement</h4>
-
-<p>Force <em>should</em> be applied entirely with the contact hand
-to avoid the possibility that movement of the head may bring
-about movement of some other vertebra than the desired one.
-But in practice the force is usually divided between the head
-and the vertebra. The Hook Support cannot be used in this
-position.</p>
-
-<h4>Uses</h4>
-
-<p>The use of this position for the Break avoids the necessity
-for the patient to lie down again in a new position after
-having Dorsals and Lumbars adjusted. It is extremely
-convenient. But on the other hand it is undeniably harder
-for the patient to relax his muscles when sitting up with
-head flexed sidewise and a sense of lost equilibrium than
-when lying down. The Break No. 1 will be found the better
-for the average case.</p>
-
-<h3>“THE BREAK” No. 4</h3>
-
-<h4>Position</h4>
-
-<p>Same as Break No. 3 except that adjuster stands behind
-patient and rests the thumb upon the base of the neck posteriorly
-while the fingers extend downward and forward toward
-the clavicle. As with No. 3, the supporting hand rests
-against the opposite side of the head and forces it sidewise
-to tighten the contact.</p>
-
-<div id="ip_110" class="figcenter" style="max-width: 24.8125em;">
- <img src="images/i_110.jpg" width="397" height="600" alt="" />
- <div class="caption">Fig. 11. “The Break,” No. 3.</div></div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_111">111</a></span></p>
-
-<h4>Movement</h4>
-
-<p>Properly, a quick lateral movement of contact hand
-while the head is firmly held by the opposing hand.</p>
-
-<p><span class="smcap">Note</span>: “The Break” is unfortunately named and it
-would be well if some less suggestive term were generally
-substituted.</p>
-
-<h3>THE ROTARY No. 1</h3>
-
-<p>For the correction of rotation only, and usable in the
-Cervicals from 2 to 7 inclusive.</p>
-
-<h4>Philosophy of the Rotary</h4>
-
-<p>A study of the Cervical articulations will make it clear
-that if a force be applied laterally to the spinous process
-the probable result will be a <em>rotation</em> of the vertebra, which
-swings one articular process back from its fellow but leaves
-the other in close, but modified, contact. Thus the spinous
-process may appear to the left while the left articular process
-is fitted firmly against that of the adjacent vertebra, while
-those on the right are separated. Similar rotation, modified
-only by the difference in shape of the vertebrae, occurs in the
-Lumbar region.</p>
-
-<p>A movement applied to the spinous process might correct
-this condition or might complicate it according to the manner
-of application. But the <em>most direct line</em> of force for correction
-is along a line which would pierce the separated
-articular processes almost in an antero-posterior direction.
-The Rotary approaches this very closely. It is a setting<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_112">112</a></span>
-forward of the articular process against its fellow by applying
-a movement directly to the transverse process, which
-lies very close to the articular process.</p>
-
-<p>The great safety of the movement lies in the fact that it
-is impossible with any reasonable amount of force to move
-the transverse process too far. If the vertebra is not subluxated
-so as to indicate this movement, gentle attempts to
-use it will fail. The deceptive bent spinous process may
-sometimes be detected in this way.</p>
-
-<p>The chief objection to Rotary Nos. 1 and 2 is that the
-Dorsals and Lumbars cannot be adjusted in this position
-and the patient must rise from the bench and lie down again
-to have his Cervicals adjusted. This is obviated if No. 3 is
-used but the latter position fails to secure the perfect relaxation
-of muscles of Nos. 1 and 2, and is therefore recommended
-as an alternative only.</p>
-
-<p>The commonest obstacle to the use of this move is the
-voluntary or involuntary contraction of the neck muscles.
-The Hook Support, q. v., will limit this resistance by affording
-a sense of perfect security to the patient. If muscles are
-<em>contractured</em> a slight “check” will be felt as the head reaches
-a certain degree of rotation, and beyond this point it will
-refuse to move though easily movable within the radius
-limited by the “check.” It is as if the head were held by an
-inelastic cord. It is best when contracture is present not
-to attempt moving the head too far but to deliver the movement
-with the muscles as much relaxed as possible.</p>
-
-<div id="ip_112" class="figcenter" style="max-width: 24.9375em;">
- <img src="images/i_113.jpg" width="399" height="600" alt="" />
- <div class="caption">Fig. 12. The Rotary, No. 1. Ready for the movement.</div></div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_113">113</a></span></p>
-
-<h4>Position and Palpation</h4>
-
-<p>Place patient in position C as described under Technic of
-Palpation. Stand at head of bench with patient’s head supported
-by one knee and perhaps also by one hand. Palpate
-chiefly to discover the numbers of vertebrae, following a
-record previously made. Finish palpation with the tip of
-the first finger of either hand resting upon the spinous process
-of the vertebra to be adjusted.</p>
-
-<h4>Placing Contact</h4>
-
-<p>Consider here which way the vertebra is to be moved; if
-toward the right use right hand and if toward the left use
-left hand for adjusting. Draw the adjusting hand straight
-around until the first finger, about the middle of the proximal
-phalanx, rests against and <em>behind</em> the transverse process.</p>
-
-<p>It is important that the finger be drawn <em>straight</em> around,
-and not upward or downward, except with the second Cervical
-with which the finger may pass slightly upward to the
-transverse. To insure correct placing of finger let patient’s
-head be absolutely at rest, supported by the Hook Support
-with face turned slightly away from the adjusting hand.
-Reinforce contact finger with the other three fingers held
-close together behind it. The thumb may or may not be
-placed against patient’s jaw as desired, but one must be
-careful not to lose exact contact by drawing adjusting hand
-upward from a lower Cervical in an attempt to reach the
-jaw.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_114">114</a></span></p>
-
-<h4>Use of Second Hand</h4>
-
-<p>Meanwhile the other hand supports the head and holds
-its weight as described under the Hook Support, q. v.</p>
-
-<h4>Turning Head</h4>
-
-<p>Next, holding the first finger gently but firmly pressed
-against the transverse process, turn the head in the direction
-of the subluxation and away from the adjusting hand. That
-is, if the vertebra be subluxated to the right turn the face
-toward the right, the use of the terms “right” or “left”
-referring to the spinous process.</p>
-
-<h4>Movement</h4>
-
-<p>When the head is drawn around so that the vertebrae
-are thoroughly separated on the side toward which movement
-is to be directed, and the patient’s muscles are thoroughly
-relaxed though it is felt that further rotation of the
-head would put them upon a tension, give the movement. It
-consists in a quick throw of the adjusting hand, force transmitted
-from shoulder through an outward fling of the elbow,
-directed upward and inward against the transverse process.
-It replaces the articular process against its fellow, moving
-one vertebra, smoothly and easily.</p>
-
-<p><em>All</em> force should be delivered with contact hand. The
-hand moves through very little space. The principle of the
-movement is transmitted shock.</p>
-
-<div id="ip_114" class="figcenter" style="max-width: 25em;">
- <img src="images/i_115.jpg" width="400" height="600" alt="" />
- <div class="caption">Fig. 13. The Rotary, No. 2.</div></div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_115">115</a></span></p>
-
-<h3>THE ROTARY No. 2</h3>
-
-<p>A transition in technic between No. 1 and No. 3.</p>
-
-<h4>Position</h4>
-
-<p>Patient lies face upward on closed table, head resting
-upon forward section. Adjuster stands at side of patient,
-choosing the side according to the subluxation so as to face
-across the table in the direction toward which spinous process
-is to move. Palpation is difficult in this position on
-account of the increase in the curve of the Cervicals, so that
-it is best to follow a record previously made.</p>
-
-<p>Having found the subluxation make contact as follows.</p>
-
-<h4>Contact</h4>
-
-<p>Reach across patient’s neck with right hand for a right
-subluxation or left hand for a left, and find spinous process.
-Then draw the middle finger straight around until the palmar
-surface of the middle finger just below the second joint
-fits snugly behind the transverse process. Place the other
-hand under the head and with both hands working together
-turn the head toward you, chin upraised, and draw the neck
-into a greater flexion until it is felt that contact is firm and
-close.</p>
-
-<h4>Movement</h4>
-
-<p>The movement is a quick drawing toward the adjuster
-of the second, or contact, finger, which has been, as it were,
-hooked over the transverse. The transverse is thus drawn<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_116">116</a></span>
-sharply forward and the vertebra rotates around its vertical
-axis so that the spinous follows, or tends to follow, the transverse
-in the same arc of movement.</p>
-
-<h3>ROTARY No. 3</h3>
-
-<h4>Position</h4>
-
-<p>Patient sitting erect, both feet evenly on floor and hands
-not braced. Stand in front of the patient but to one side or
-the other as for Rotary No. 2. Use right hand for adjusting
-right subluxations and left hand for lefts.</p>
-
-<h4>Contact</h4>
-
-<p>As for No. 2, contact is with palmar surface of second
-finger but may be shifted to third finger for the lower vertebrae
-if desired. The thumb is usually placed on the mandible
-and aids the opposite hand, placed on the other side of the
-head, in turning and otherwise controlling the head.</p>
-
-<h4>Movement</h4>
-
-<p>Turn the head away from the adjusting hand until the
-neck muscles feel taut as a result of position and not of
-contraction. The movement then is given as a sharp jerk of
-the contact hand forward.</p>
-
-<div id="ip_116" class="figcenter" style="max-width: 24.75em;">
- <img src="images/i_116.jpg" width="396" height="600" alt="" />
- <div class="caption">Fig. 14. The Rotary, No. 3.</div></div>
-
-<h3>ANCHOR MOVE No. 1</h3>
-
-<h4>Theory</h4>
-
-<p>It is held that a vertebra often loses its proper relation
-with the vertebra below, and consequently with <em>all</em> the vertebrae,<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_117">117</a></span>
-or the entire column of the spine below, without being
-disturbed in its relation to the one, or ones, above; that, in
-other words, the column may be divided into two sections
-by subluxation, the upper section set askew upon the lower.
-With this reasoning it would clearly be desirable to so adjust
-the spine as to move a given vertebra, and with it all vertebra
-above, so to speak, upon the vertebra below. To do
-this all vertebrae above the one to which force is applied
-must needs be firmly <em>anchored</em> to prevent strain between
-them.</p>
-
-<p>Such a move has been devised by Bunn for Cervical
-use and is here described from the author’s few observations
-only. Further study may modify the technic somewhat.</p>
-
-<div id="ip_117" class="figcenter" style="max-width: 24.9375em;">
- <img src="images/i_117.jpg" width="399" height="600" alt="" />
- <div class="caption">Fig. 15. “Anchor Move,” No. 1. For a P. L. subluxation.</div></div>
-
-<h4>Position</h4>
-
-<p>Patient is placed as for Dorsal and Lumbar adjustments
-in position B. Move is applied to rotated, postero-rotary,
-and antero-rotary subluxations and face turned toward
-side from which move is to be made. Adjuster, after
-palpation which discovers the vertebra to be moved and the
-direction of movement, stands at the head of table facing
-patient’s feet.</p>
-
-<h4>Contact</h4>
-
-<p>With the palms of both hands resting against the side of
-the neck and thumbs extended at right angles to hands,
-make contact with both thumbs on one vertebra as follows:</p>
-
-<p>If vertebra is to be rotated toward patient’s left, place<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_118">118</a></span>
-right thumb against spinous process on its left side and
-left thumb upon right transverse process from behind it.
-Press firmly with the palm and fingers of each hand against
-the vertebrae above, gripping around neck and base of skull
-so as to hold all parts together.</p>
-
-<h4>Movement</h4>
-
-<p>The move is delivered simultaneously with the two
-hands, forcing spinous process toward the right and transverse
-in an anterior direction. The head must be raised
-from the bench and wholly supported by the hands and the
-head turns with the vertebra.</p>
-
-<h4>Uses</h4>
-
-<p>A powerful comparatively easy move which has the advantage
-of wide applicability and of avoiding the change
-of posture of the patient which mars many Cervical moves.</p>
-
-<div id="ip_118" class="figcenter" style="max-width: 24.75em;">
- <img src="images/i_119.jpg" width="396" height="600" alt="" />
- <div class="caption">Fig. 16. Posterior Cervical move.</div></div>
-
-<h3>ANCHOR MOVE No. 2</h3>
-
-<h4>Position</h4>
-
-<p>Same as for No. 1.</p>
-
-<h4>Contact</h4>
-
-<p>For a left subluxation to be moved toward the right,
-place the left thumb upon the right side of the spinous
-process so that it hooks over the spinous in position to draw
-or pull the spinous. Place right thumb against the end of<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_119">119</a></span>
-the left transverse as much on the anterior side as possible
-so that it may exert a <em>prying</em> force in a posterior direction.</p>
-
-<h4>Movement</h4>
-
-<p>Simultaneous application of force with the thumbs tends
-to rotate the vertebra as does No. 1, but unlike No. 1 the
-tendency is to bring the vertebra out in a posterior direction
-instead of driving it more anteriorly.</p>
-
-<h4>Uses</h4>
-
-<p>This move is applied to rotated Cervicals which are
-anterior, more on one side than on the other.</p>
-
-<h3>POSTERIOR CERVICAL MOVE</h3>
-
-<h4>Uses</h4>
-
-<p>For a posterior Cervical below the Atlas. The common
-and careless practice of moving such a vertebra with the
-Rotary, or the dangerous practice of using the Recoil may
-be avoided by this move and much better results obtained.</p>
-
-<h4>Position</h4>
-
-<p>Patient in position C, head projecting well beyond bench
-so as to allow for a dropping backward of the head. Palpate
-as for the Rotary and hold palpating finger on tip of
-spinous process of posterior vertebra while contact is made.</p>
-
-<h4>Contact</h4>
-
-<p>Contact point is middle of radial surface of first phalanx
-of first finger and is placed against the tip of the spinous<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_120">120</a></span>
-process, directly between it and the floor, as the patient lies.
-Hand is held rigid and edgewise, fingers together so that
-the contact finger is well supported.</p>
-
-<h4>Completing Position</h4>
-
-<p>Use the free hand to hold the head with the Hook Support,
-q. v. Turn the patient’s chin slightly away from the
-adjusting hand and drop the elbow of adjusting arm down
-until a straight line could pass through elbow, spinous process,
-and patient’s chin. It may be well to crouch and rest
-the elbow against one knee for solidity. Then allow the
-head to drop backward until chin is elevated and further
-backward flexion would strain the muscles. You are ready
-for the movement.</p>
-
-<h4>Movement</h4>
-
-<p>A quick throwing movement upward and inward, or toward
-patient’s chin. As nearly as may be the force should
-tend to pass along the spinous process in a direction exactly
-anterior to the (then) plane of the vertebra.</p>
-
-<p><span class="smcap">Note</span>: Either hand may be used with this movement.</p>
-
-<div id="ip_120" class="figcenter" style="max-width: 24.8125em;">
- <img src="images/i_120.jpg" width="397" height="600" alt="" />
- <div class="caption">Fig. 17. Movement for correction of a lateral Atlas whose
-prominent transverse is posterior.</div></div>
-
-<h3>DOUBLE CONTACT MOVE</h3>
-
-<h4>Uses</h4>
-
-<p>This is indicated for postero-rotary or postero-lateral
-subluxations. Its line of force is a bisector of the angle between
-the straight anterior and the straight lateral movement.</p>
-
-<div id="ip_120b" class="figcenter" style="max-width: 25.0625em;">
- <img src="images/i_121.jpg" width="401" height="600" alt="" />
- <div class="captionl">
-
-<p class="hang">Fig. 18. A movement for Atlas when laterally displaced. Contact:
-metacarpo-phalangeal joint with end of prominent
-transverse.</p></div></div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_121">121</a></span></p>
-
-<h4>Contact</h4>
-
-<p>There are two points of contact, both on the first finger,
-one (first secured) on the radial side of the second phalanx
-and the other on the radial side of the proximal phalanx.
-The first contact point is placed against the tip of the
-spinous, the other behind the transverse process.</p>
-
-<p>Press slightly against the two processes with the finger so
-as to feel them plainly.</p>
-
-<h4>Completing Position</h4>
-
-<p>Hold the head with the Hook Support and turn the face
-away from the adjusting hand (right hand for a P. R., left
-hand for a P. L.). Drop elbow low and hold it well away
-from your body so that there appears an obtuse angle between
-wrist and forearm with the point of the angle toward
-you. Be careful of this point as the tendency is to make an
-angle with the point away from you—a weak position.</p>
-
-<p>Drop head backward until firm resistance is felt.</p>
-
-<h4>Movement</h4>
-
-<p>Force is delivered in an antero-lateral direction as above
-described, <em>entirely</em> with adjusting hand.</p>
-
-<h3>THE “T. M.” No. 1</h3>
-
-<h4>Uses</h4>
-
-<p>For subluxations listed R or L but not Posterior and
-upon C 6, C 7, D 1, and D 2 only. This movement applies
-a lateral force to the spinous process so as to correct <em>rotation</em><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_122">122</a></span>
-of the vertebra, but I repeat that it is inappropriate for
-posterior or postero-lateral subluxations.</p>
-
-<h4>Position</h4>
-
-<p>Patient lying in position B as for Dorsal adjustment.
-Find the subluxation by following the record and perceiving
-that the count assumed to be correct permits the subluxations
-to correspond to those recorded and that a vertebra in this
-region is R or L, R. A. or L. A., R. S. or L. S., R. I. or L. I.
-The laterality of the spinous process determines the next
-step.</p>
-
-<p>For a right subluxation turn the face toward the <em>left</em>
-and use <em>right</em> hand for contact hand. For a left subluxation
-turn the face to the right and use left hand for contact hand.</p>
-
-<h4>Contact</h4>
-
-<p>Thumb of contact hand is placed upon and against the
-side of the spinous process so that it presses firmly. The
-thumb is extended almost at right angles to the hand which
-rests upon the patient’s shoulder with fingers extending, and
-gripping, over the clavicle. Be sure of the solidity of the
-position.</p>
-
-<p>Next place the other hand upon the patient’s forehead
-and press the head backward, or toward the side of the contact
-hand, until the neck is well flexed and the tissues tightened
-between the now opposing hands.</p>
-
-<div id="ip_122" class="figcenter" style="max-width: 24.9375em;">
- <img src="images/i_122.jpg" width="399" height="600" alt="" />
- <div class="caption">Fig. 19. The “T. M.,” No. 1.</div></div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_123">123</a></span></p>
-
-<h4>Movement</h4>
-
-<p>When this tightened condition is reached a quick decisive
-movement of <em>both</em> hands in opposite directions, but chiefly
-of the hand applied to the head, will secure an easy movement
-of the vertebra.</p>
-
-<p>This move is a very valuable adaptation of the old crude
-and other dangerous “T. M.,” of which No. 2, below, is
-another, more like the original move but possessing several
-“safety” features.</p>
-
-<h3>“T. M.” No. 2</h3>
-
-<h4>Position of Patient</h4>
-
-<p>The patient sits erect on a flat seat with both feet resting
-upon the floor as during palpation.</p>
-
-<h4>Placing Hands</h4>
-
-<p>After careful palpation and selection of a vertebra to be
-adjusted in this way, stand directly behind the patient. If
-the vertebra is subluxated to the right use right hand for
-adjusting (or contact) hand, if to the left use left hand.
-Hold the hand so that the thumb is at right angles to the
-hand and tense and firm. Place the palmar surface of the
-end of the thumb against and upon the tip of the spinous
-process and grasp the neck firmly with the fingers, which
-extend over the base of the neck and toward the clavicle.
-The other hand is placed easily on the top of the head.</p>
-
-<h4>Position of Head</h4>
-
-<p>The completing of position after contact has been made
-is governed by two considerations; the need for relaxing the<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_124">124</a></span>
-neck muscles and for so supporting the vertebrae above
-the contact that movement will take place only at the point
-of contact. If the neck muscles are contracted the movement
-is almost always defeated and should always be abandoned
-to avoid strain.</p>
-
-<p>To secure the desired position ask the patient to relax his
-muscles and allow you to place his head as desired. If he
-seeks to place it himself the necessary muscular contraction
-on his part will defeat the movement. The movements of
-the head must be passive.</p>
-
-<p>With thumb and remainder of adjusting hand properly
-placed, use the other hand upon the head as follows: First
-flex the head forward on the chest as far as possible, then
-rotate it slightly so that the face is turned a little toward
-adjusting hand. Then flex the head sidewise until a resisting
-pull of muscles indicates that they have been stretched
-taut. It is well during the third movement described to let
-the forearm swing down at right angles to the hand so that
-it presses firmly against the ends of all the Cervical transverses,
-distributing the force among them.</p>
-
-<p>Or, after placing contact hand rest the elbow in the
-angle at the base of the neck and let the forearm extend upward
-along the side of the neck. Then flex the wrist until
-the hand will rest upon the patient’s head and perform the
-movements of the head as described above.</p>
-
-<div id="ip_124" class="figcenter" style="max-width: 25em;">
- <img src="images/i_124.jpg" width="400" height="600" alt="" />
- <div class="caption">Fig. 20. The “T. M.,” No. 2. Note position of right arm and
-hand of adjuster.</div></div>
-
-<h4>Movement</h4>
-
-<p>A quick, simultaneous movement of both hands in opposite
-directions, <em>two-thirds</em> of which is given with the hand<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_125">125</a></span>
-which holds the head. The thumb in contact with the spinous
-process moves slightly inward toward the median line but
-its chief use is to hold the vertebra very firmly. To this
-end part of its force is directed forward against the shoulder
-and through the ball of the thumb.</p>
-
-<p>Failure to place the head properly or in securing sufficient
-flexion of the neck before move is attempted are the
-chief causes of failure. Force must be delivered quickly
-and sharply and the best adjustment of this kind is usually
-the one in which the head and hands move through the least
-space.</p>
-
-<h4>Uses</h4>
-
-<p>This movement is obviously useful only for the correction
-of <em>rotation</em>, since the force is directed sidewise against the
-spinous process.</p>
-
-<p>The “T. M.” was originally intended as a Cervical adjustment,
-but its greatest use is now from C 6 to D 2 inclusive.
-Above the sixth its use is questionable because of the
-possibility of moving more than one vertebra or some other
-than the one desired.</p>
-
-<h3>“THE RECOIL”<br />
-
-<span class="subhead">(Pisiform Contact)</span></h3>
-
-<h4>Position of Patient</h4>
-
-<p>This movement is best given on bifid bench of the type
-commonly known to the profession. Place patient on forward
-section so that its rear edge rests just below the axilla;
-this may be ascertained by passing a hand under patient’s<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_126">126</a></span>
-arm after he is in position, when the edge of the bench
-should be felt about an inch below the hanging arm. The
-thighs should rest on rear section so that the pubic symphysis
-is free of the bench. The semicircular pubic cut is
-an advantage in that it avoids injury without making necessary
-too great a suspension between sections.</p>
-
-<p>Thus the abdomen and the lower part of the thorax are
-suspended between sections. Under them an abdominal
-support may be used but it must have the quality of elasticity
-in a high degree and must lie always below the plane of the
-other two sections or it will interfere with a perfect adjustment.</p>
-
-<p>For adjustment of the last two Cervicals or any Dorsal
-down to the sixth, it is best to turn patient’s head toward
-the direction of the subluxation. This curves that section
-of the spine into an arc toward the convex side of which
-movement may be made more easily than toward the concave.</p>
-
-<p>The patient’s hands may lie under the table, loosely, or
-may reach back and rest upon the buttocks, palm upward.
-Whichever position secures best relaxation is to be used in
-any case.</p>
-
-<p>This movement may be used with the roll. (See <a href="#ip_152">Fig. 30</a>
-and <a href="#Page_285">p. 285</a>.)</p>
-
-<div id="ip_126" class="figcenter" style="max-width: 24.75em;">
- <img src="images/i_127.jpg" width="396" height="600" alt="" />
- <div class="caption">Fig. 21. After palpation. Finger ready to guide contact hand
-to a spinous process.</div></div>
-
-<h4>Position of Adjuster</h4>
-
-<p>Stand on either side of patient, feet apart for base and
-poise. The direction of the feet and position of body will<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_127">127</a></span>
-vary according to the direction of the adjustment, by the
-following two rules:</p>
-
-<p>Rule 1. For movement of a vertebra <em>away</em> from the side
-on which you stand, place your arms and hands in such a
-position that the pisiform bone of adjusting hand, both elbows,
-and both shoulder joints (shoulders being dropped
-loosely forward) will fall in the same plane and that the
-plane of direction in which the vertebra is to be moved. In
-other words, let the force be applied in a line straight from
-your body <em>through</em> the vertebra. Always shift your feet to
-a proper position from which to direct the movement.</p>
-
-<p>Rule 2. To move a vertebra <em>toward</em> the side on which
-you stand, step close to patient’s body and support yourself
-with one knee against the adjusting table at the most convenient
-point. Then place arms so that contact point, elbows,
-shoulders, and the mid-point of the body’s base, between
-the feet, are all in the same plane. This insures balance during
-and after the movement and is the attitude from which
-the greatest and most carefully measured force can be delivered.</p>
-
-<p>It will be seen that the desire is always to deliver all
-force in one plane and thus avoid conflict of forces and
-waste or misdirection through the predominance of one
-force over the other, and to use both arms with equal facility
-in the move. There are at least a hundred ways to hinder
-this movement by varying the preliminary positions. And
-no one can know the real efficiency of the move who has not
-become instinctively adept at taking position.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_128">128</a></span></p>
-
-<h4>Use of Hands and Arms</h4>
-
-<p>Use of hands for palpation has been described. (<a href="#Page_46">P. 46</a>.)</p>
-
-<p>The palpating hand comes to rest with the middle finger
-on the spinous process of the vertebra to be adjusted. The
-heel of the hand is raised, the first and third fingers doubled
-back, and the heel lowered again. Now the middle finger
-alone is a slender pointer guiding to the contact point.</p>
-
-<p>Place pisiform bone of other hand snugly <em>against</em> the
-process to be moved. The hand should rest in a slight arch,
-pisiform against spinous, fingers rigid and flexed on hand,
-last finger firmly anchored, or pressed into the flesh, to
-prevent slipping. (Fig. 22 shows the position.)</p>
-
-<p>The anchoring fingers must always extend away from the
-adjuster. To turn the fingers back across the spine, in moving
-a vertebra toward you, is always an error, and the price
-is partial loss of use of one arm.</p>
-
-<p>With the adjusting hand satisfactorily placed, grasp its
-wrist firmly with the other hand so that the pisiform of the
-supporting hand rests in the hollow between the wrist and
-the metacarpal bone of the extended thumb. By this contact
-force is driven directly through the chain of bones
-across the wrist and to the pisiform bone without spreading.
-In grasping the wrist let the thumb extend around the forearm
-in one direction and the four fingers in the other. Beware
-of gripping only with thumb and first finger in which
-case the edge of the supporting hand will rest on the back
-of the contact hand and spread the delivered force too
-widely.</p>
-
-<div id="ip_128" class="figcenter" style="max-width: 37.5em;">
- <img src="images/i_128.jpg" width="600" height="345" alt="" />
- <div class="caption">Fig. 22. “The Recoil.” Ready for the movement.</div></div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_129">129</a></span></p>
-
-<h4>Movement</h4>
-
-<p>I have said, but have not sufficiently emphasized the
-command, that the shoulders must be dropped loosely forward.
-Let me add that just before the movement is given
-the head should be allowed to sag downward and the muscles
-to become relaxed. This movement given with stiff
-shoulders and upraised head becomes a <em>push</em>.</p>
-
-<p>The desired movement is a <em>throwing</em> movement.</p>
-
-<p>Force is released from both shoulders at once, concentrated
-at the same instant by a slight shifting forward of
-the elbows, and strikes the spinous process as <em>one</em> force,
-which is the resultant of the two meeting at the wrist of
-contact hand and being united there. The two arms use the
-contact hand as a passive instrument for driving the vertebra.</p>
-
-<p>The objective point, the distance to which the movement
-is mentally thrown at the instant of delivery, should be the
-center of mass of the vertebra, varying according to the
-section of the spine.</p>
-
-<h4>Contact Point</h4>
-
-<p>The exact contact point of hand with vertebra varies. If
-the vertebra is to be moved toward the right the pisiform
-rests <em>against</em> (not <em>upon</em>) the left side of the spinous; if toward
-the left and inferior, against the right side and just
-above, in the notch between it and the next superior process.
-The rule is to so place hand that the spinous process is between<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_130">130</a></span>
-the pisiform and the direction to which movement is
-given.</p>
-
-<p>On the hand the contact may be said to vary, according
-to the direction of subluxation and position of adjuster, so
-as to describe a circle around the pisiform in the course of
-the various changes of position necessary to the use of this
-movement. No error could be greater than to attempt to
-use always the same face of the pisiform and to adapt the
-position of hands and arms to this end, when any face or
-aspect of the little bone is equally good with any other.</p>
-
-<h4>Which Hand Used</h4>
-
-<p>When standing on patient’s right use left hand for palpating
-hand and right hand for contact with the vertebra,
-using left hand again to grip and reinforce the contact hand.
-Exception to this is made by introducing an extra change of
-hands with C 6, or 7, D 1, L 4 or 5, and Sacrum. The
-change is necessitated by the insecurity of the usual position
-or the fact that it cramps the wrist of contact hand. To
-make the change: palpate as usual, hold subluxation with
-second finger of palpating hand, substitute second finger of
-other hand and withdraw palpating hand, which is then
-free to make the contact.</p>
-
-<p>When standing on left side exactly reverse the use of
-hands. Palpate with the same hand which would be used if
-patient were sitting. Introduce no unnecessary move into
-the placing of the hands. This will be found to produce
-better results than any other technic for this portion of the
-move.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_131">131</a></span></p>
-
-<h4>Delivery of Force</h4>
-
-<p>In using this movement it is perhaps best to deliver
-nearly equal force with both hands; certainly whatever
-forces are released by the arms should be simultaneous. It
-is possible, however, to allow one arm to preponderate in
-the movement without marring its efficiency, but the amateur
-adjuster will do well to balance his forces at first.</p>
-
-<h4>Speed and Concentration</h4>
-
-<p>Speed is a prime essential. By its employment a very
-ordinary amount of muscular strength can be made to accomplish
-a large amount of work and very difficult adjustments
-may be accomplished.</p>
-
-<p>Concentration of mind at the instant of adjustment, so
-as to secure muscular control and perfect co-ordination of
-the two arms as well as to direct and concentrate the forces
-used at a given and strictly limited area, is also essential.</p>
-
-<h4>Uses</h4>
-
-<p>For ordinary adjustments of Dorsal or Lumbar subluxations,
-excepting the middle four Dorsals, for breaking
-ankyloses by repeated applications of force, and for overcoming
-muscular resistance in patients who are unable to
-relax at all, this form or style of adjusting is probably the
-best. It is most useful in the Dorsals. In many instances
-Lumbar vertebrae will move better by application of a
-slightly slower force, especially if a roll is used. The Recoil
-may be used with the roll.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_132">132</a></span></p>
-
-<p>While it is easily possible to move any Cervical in this
-way, making no change in the technic except to use the ulnar
-side of the fifth metacarpal bone for the contact instead of
-the pisiform, it is inadvisable in most cases above the sixth,
-and in some instances absolutely unpardonable. The shock
-to the nervous system and the danger of moving two or
-more vertebrae or of subluxating a normal one are too great.
-In at least one instance hemiplegia instantly followed the
-use of this move on the Axis, and headaches and nerve
-exhaustion are frequent sequelae.</p>
-
-<p>For these reasons it is probably best never to use “The
-Recoil” above the sixth Cervical. For every form of subluxation
-there is an easier and safer mode of correction.</p>
-
-<h4>Name</h4>
-
-<p>This has been called “The Recoil” because of a belief
-that if force be applied to a vertebra in the form of a very
-rapidly transmitted shock the vertebra will rebound to the
-shock and settle in its normal position, the intelligence within
-the body utilizing the force thus blindly applied to bring
-about this result.</p>
-
-<p>This belief is erroneous. First the vertebra and all surrounding
-tissues are misshapen to fit their <em>abnormal</em> position
-and relation and this shape gives them a tendency, if rapidly
-loosened, to settle into the old abnormal position. Second,
-there is no such conscious intelligence which has power to
-replace a subluxated vertebra. If this supposition were
-correct, then the Innate Intelligence would do well to utilize<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_133">133</a></span>
-those jars and shocks which ordinarily <em>produce</em> subluxation
-to bring about normality and keep the spine perfectly
-aligned.</p>
-
-<p>There is no such internal rebound or recoil as stated
-above. The chief value of the movement lies in its speed,
-according to principles equally applicable to other moves,
-and in accord with the Law of Momentum.</p>
-
-<h4>Sources of Information</h4>
-
-<p>This movement as described above contains many essential
-principles which follow Parker and Palmer, developers
-of “The Recoil,” but the technic is considerably
-modified to suit the author’s own views. It cannot be claimed,
-therefore, that this is “The Recoil” as now taught by Palmer,
-since the chief stress is here laid upon the movement
-of the vertebra in a predetermined direction and not upon
-the withdrawal of the hands to let “Innate” do the work.
-The name “Recoil” is really inappropriate for the move as
-described.</p>
-
-<h3>THE HEEL CONTACT</h3>
-
-<p>A movement for the adjustment of posterior, postero-superior,
-or postero-inferior subluxations in the Dorsal
-region (except middle four) and in the Lumbar. May also
-be used for postero-laterals when laterality is very slight.
-Given with patient in position B. Contact point, heel of hand
-with spinous process.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_134">134</a></span></p>
-
-<h4>Heel Contact</h4>
-
-<p>By the “heel of the hand” is here meant the depression
-between the scaphoid and pisiform bones. This hollow
-forms a natural receiver for a spinous process and thus
-avoids lateral slipping.</p>
-
-<p>The four fingers of adjusting hand are spread out and
-anchored upon the patient’s body. The wrist is held at a
-right angle to hand and the arm straightened, the elbow
-being outrotated until it “locks,” that is until it will move no
-farther. The other hand grasps the wrist of the adjusting
-hand.</p>
-
-<h4>Adjusting Hand</h4>
-
-<p>The rule is to use the right hand for adjusting hand if
-standing on patient’s right and palpating with left, or to
-use left hand if on left side and palpating with right. The
-fingers are to be directed toward the patient’s feet. Exception
-to this rule is made with the last two Lumbars, where
-it is more convenient to change hands and direct the fingers
-toward the head.</p>
-
-<div id="ip_134" class="figcenter" style="max-width: 24.9375em;">
- <img src="images/i_134.jpg" width="399" height="600" alt="" />
- <div class="caption">Fig. 23. “Heel contact.”</div></div>
-
-<h4>Movement</h4>
-
-<p>This is given almost entirely with adjusting arm; that
-is, with the arm whose hand is in contact with the vertebra.
-The supporting hand serves merely to guide the force to a
-definite point as if a straight rod were working through a
-fixed circlet. Indeed, the force in this movement is delivered<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_135">135</a></span>
-almost straight down from the shoulder. Shoulder
-should be dropped well out of its socket so as to secure
-play for a sudden downward movement without raising the
-hand from its contact. If the shoulder is stiff or the head
-of the humerus remains in the glenoid cavity the movement
-cannot be properly given without raising the hand. Movement
-is quick, sharp, and <em>deep</em>, i. e., directed to the center of
-mass of the vertebra.</p>
-
-<p>It may be directed straight toward floor to correct a
-posterior, inclined slightly toward the head or feet to correct
-approximation, or—as some aver—slightly sidewise to
-correct a mild degree of rotation.</p>
-
-<h3>PISIFORM DOUBLE TRANSVERSE No. 1</h3>
-
-<p>An adjustment to be used only in the Dorsals from
-fourth to ninth inclusive, for posterior or postero-rotary subluxations.
-It is probably best to use this movement only for
-straight posterior subluxations and to apply either the Pisiform
-Single Transverse or the Two Finger Double Transverse
-to the rotary displacements in this region.</p>
-
-<h4>Contact</h4>
-
-<p>Both pisiform bones, each <em>upon</em> a transverse process
-and both upon the <em>same</em> vertebra.</p>
-
-<p>With patient in position B and the adjuster standing
-upon his left the contact should be made by the following
-exact method. Palpate with right hand, which comes to
-rest upon the spinous process of the subluxated vertebra.<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_136">136</a></span>
-Note if it be P. R. or P. L., because this fact will govern
-the next movement. Let the first finger of palpating hand
-reach outward about one inch and upward to a point opposite
-the tip of the next superior spinous process, which point
-will approximate the position of the transverse. This
-first upon the side of the <em>posterior</em> transverse, which will be
-the right with a left subluxation or the left with a right
-one. Let second and third fingers, now abandoning the
-spinous, follow the first and rest over the assumed position
-of the transverse.</p>
-
-<p>Now palpate with a deep, limited, massage movement
-until the club-shaped extremity of the transverse is felt
-under the middle finger. Hold this point with the middle
-finger, drawing away the other two, and guide the free hand
-to an exact contact <em>upon</em> the transverse. Thus if standing
-on the left, as predicated, the <em>left</em> hand will be first to make
-contact and with the most posterior transverse, with which
-most <em>exact</em> contact is necessary.</p>
-
-<p>With pisiform placed, let the fingers extend away from
-your body; if on the side of the spine opposite you, let them
-extend downward so as to follow the curve of the rib and to
-be anchored upon the rib connected with the transverse of
-contact; if on the same side, let fingers extend downward
-parallel with the column.</p>
-
-<div id="ip_136" class="figcenter" style="max-width: 24.5625em;">
- <img src="images/i_136.jpg" width="393" height="600" alt="" />
- <div class="caption">Fig. 24. Pisiform double transverse adjustment as it should be
-given, elbows locked.</div></div>
-
-<p>Now—still using the original palpating hand—palpate
-on the other side from the first contact until the other transverse
-is discovered. Mark its tip with a quick, deep pressure
-and a sharp withdrawal of the fingers, so that a spot<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_137">137</a></span>
-of anaemia appears momentarily. Carefully place the pisiform
-of the palpating hand in contact, guided by the anaemic
-spot. If this second contact is on the side on which you
-stand the fingers will be toward the head; if on the opposite
-side, they will follow the rib curve outward and downward.</p>
-
-<p>Re-read the above directions carefully. It will be seen
-that the technic is quite free from unnecessary movements.</p>
-
-<p>The two hands are now placed almost exactly at right
-angles to each other, arched fingers anchored to prevent
-slipping.</p>
-
-<p>If you stand on the patient’s right the use of hands is, of
-course, exactly reversed, the left hand being palpating hand,
-and making the first contact.</p>
-
-<h4>Completing Position</h4>
-
-<p>When hands are in position and adjuster standing so as
-to face directly across the spine, the arms are rotated outward
-until the elbows “lock.” The adjuster leans over so
-as to have shoulders directly over the spine, draws the body
-back from the shoulder girdle to secure freest play in the
-shoulder joints, and drops head loosely between the shoulders
-so as to relax the trapezius and prevent any checking of the
-force.</p>
-
-<h4>Movement</h4>
-
-<p>Directly downward from the shoulders through straight,
-stiff arms. The force is delivered separately with the two
-arms and yet simultaneously. If the vertebra is straight<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_138">138</a></span>
-posterior, equal force must be applied on the two sides; if
-it is posterior and slightly rotated (P. R. or P. L.), most
-force must be applied to the more posterior transverse.</p>
-
-<p>Considerable practice and looseness of shoulder are required
-to use this movement properly. It is a regrettable
-fact that few adjusters <em>do</em> use it correctly, most of them
-giving a <em>thrust</em> instead of a transmitted shock.</p>
-
-<h3>PISIFORM DOUBLE TRANSVERSE No. 2</h3>
-
-<p>This modification of the pisiform double transverse move
-is here described because of its popularity rather than because
-the author wishes to recommend it. The position is
-the same as for No. 1, and the uses also, except that it tends
-to correct postero-inferior subluxations and is not at all
-adapted for use with superiors.</p>
-
-<h4>Contact</h4>
-
-<p>Both pisiforms below the two transverses (caudad).
-After palpation which discloses the posterior transverse the
-hands are placed as follows: Palpating hand rests always
-on the side of the spine next the operator; opposite hand
-crosses the spine. Both are slanted upward so that the
-fingers point toward the head with the axes of the hand
-slightly diverging above. The wrists are thus crossed in
-such a way as to force the forearms to be somewhat flexed
-on the arms and to slant away from the wrists at an obtuse
-angle. This with the contact <em>below</em> the transverses, renders
-it impossible not to force the vertebra in an upward (superior)
-direction when movement is given.</p>
-
-<div id="ip_138" class="figcenter" style="max-width: 24.625em;">
- <img src="images/i_139.jpg" width="394" height="600" alt="" />
- <div class="caption">Fig. 25. Two-finger double transverse.</div></div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_139">139</a></span></p>
-
-<h4>Movement</h4>
-
-<p>A comparatively slow thrusting movement, which tends
-to spring the spine. The merit of this method lies in its
-comparative painlessness. Its technic is not attractive.</p>
-
-<h3>TWO FINGER DOUBLE TRANSVERSE</h3>
-
-<p>A movement for posterior or postero-rotary displacements
-from fourth to ninth Dorsal inclusive. It serves the
-same purpose as the Pisiform Double Transverse but is less
-painful and often easier of delivery. The palmar surface of
-the fingers, with the flesh of the patient’s back, make a compound
-cushion which acts as a shock-absorber.</p>
-
-<h4>Palpation—Contact</h4>
-
-<p>The usual downward gliding movement of left hand if
-standing on right or of right hand if standing on left will
-serve for the discovery of the vertebra listed for adjustment.
-The gliding hand stops with the second finger indicating the
-spinous process. The first finger reaches upward and outward
-to the assumed location of the transverse on the side
-nearest the adjuster; then the second finger reaches to a
-similar point on the other side, both fingers pointing toward
-patient’s head. Now the fingers are rolled a little to make
-sure that they are in contact with the ends of the transverse,
-the palmar surface of the tip of each finger being the proper
-contact point. The heel of the contact hand rests near, but
-not on, the surface of the body over the midspinal line.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_140">140</a></span></p>
-
-<h4>Supporting Hand</h4>
-
-<p>The ulnar edge of the free hand is now placed across
-the tips of the two contact fingers so that it rests directly
-above the ends of the transverses but separated from them
-by the finger tips. The upper arm is then straightened and
-the elbow outrotated until it locks firmly so that the arm
-makes a straight line directly above the transverses. The
-body is drawn away from the shoulder girdle, pulling the
-head of the humerus out of its socket as far as possible to
-allow free play, for all force is to be given by this straight
-arm.</p>
-
-<h4>Movement</h4>
-
-<p>If the subluxation is a straight posterior the force is
-driven directly downward so as to be distributed equally to
-the two contact points. If it be a postero-rotary, most force
-is directed to the more prominent (posterior) transverse.
-Force should be delivered quickly, keeping in mind the principle
-of transmitted shock.</p>
-
-<p>Contrary to the general belief, as much force can be
-developed with this move as is needful for any ordinary
-adjustment. The fact that it is often recommended for use
-with children or with sensitive or frail patients has led to
-the belief that it is a relatively ineffective move, whereas its
-value in such cases lies only in the fact that it inflicts less
-pain than some others.</p>
-
-<div id="ip_140" class="figcenter" style="max-width: 24.5625em;">
- <img src="images/i_141.jpg" width="393" height="600" alt="" />
- <div class="caption">Fig. 26. Pisiform single transverse move, No. 1.</div></div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_141">141</a></span></p>
-
-<h3>PISIFORM SINGLE TRANSVERSE MOVE No. 1</h3>
-
-<p>Like the movement just described, this adjustment may
-be used in the Dorsals from fourth to ninth inclusive. It
-should be limited to those subluxations which are rotated
-without being posterior. In such an instance the spinous
-process <em>appears</em> to be laterally displaced without being posterior,
-or may appear slightly <em>anterior</em> because it is describing
-an arc about a fixed center of rotation in the body
-of the vertebra. One transverse process appears anterior
-and the other posterior to the line of their fellows.</p>
-
-<h4>Palpation</h4>
-
-<p>Palpate as for the Recoil and use the same adjusting
-hand as in that movement, i. e., right hand if standing on
-right side and palpating with left, or left hand if standing
-on left and palpating with right. When the palpating fingers
-have discovered the subluxated spinous process, the first
-finger seeks a point even with the tip of the next superior
-spinous process and about an inch to the side on which is
-the <em>posterior</em> (prominent) transverse. The second and
-third fingers follow and, dipping inward with a rolling or
-massage motion, discover the end of the transverse.</p>
-
-<h4>Contact</h4>
-
-<p>Now the adjusting hand is placed with its pisiform resting
-directly <em>upon</em> the blunt end of the transverse. If the
-contact is on the same side of the spine with the adjuster
-the fingers of adjusting hand extend across the spine and<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_142">142</a></span>
-are anchored on the other side, the hand arching sharply
-and fingers extending somewhat downward. If contact is
-on opposite side of spine the fingers follow the rib curve
-downward and outward and are similarly anchored. In
-every case the fingers should extend away from, and never
-toward, the adjuster’s body. To violate this rule renders
-one arm almost useless through its position.</p>
-
-<p>At this juncture the palpating hand becomes a reinforcing
-hand, to grip the wrist of the other and to aid in the movement.</p>
-
-<h4>Movement</h4>
-
-<p>The force is directed in a straight anterior direction,
-quickly and decisively, as if a spinous process were the
-lever used. Remember that contact must always be made
-with the <em>posterior</em> transverse. To drive this anterior is to
-rotate the vertebra around its vertical axis and to bring the
-spinous process toward the median line, while the opposite,
-and more anterior, transverse becomes more posterior, as it
-should be.</p>
-
-<h3>PISIFORM SINGLE TRANSVERSE No. 2</h3>
-
-<h4>Uses</h4>
-
-<p>For rotated first or second Dorsals with which, for any
-reason, the “T. M.” fails. This move involves a use of the
-head as a lever, as does the “T. M.” No. 2. Inadvisable unless
-the posterior transverse of the rotated vertebra can be<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_143">143</a></span>
-palpated—but often used in cheerful disregard of this detail
-by those sublimely capable adjusters who do not need to
-find a vertebra before moving it.</p>
-
-<h4>Palpation—Contact</h4>
-
-<p>Palpate as for No. 1 above. Very deep palpation will
-be necessary because the spinous process here is nearly
-horizontal to the body and the transverse is very deeply
-placed, overlaid with heavy muscles.</p>
-
-<p>When process is found place pisiform bone of free hand
-upon it, pressing the muscles aside as much as possible to
-avoid bruising and resting a considerable amount of weight
-upon the contact hand. Fingers of contact hand may extend
-across the spine or downward and parallel with the
-spine. Or, the hands may be changed so that the palpating
-hand becomes the contact hand and is placed with the fingers
-gripped over the base of the neck toward the clavicle.</p>
-
-<h4>Head Leverage</h4>
-
-<p>The free hand is now placed upon the forehead and the
-head, which faces toward the contact hand, is flexed backward
-until the muscles seem taut.</p>
-
-<h4>Movement</h4>
-
-<p>Is a quick, but fairly gentle, movement of both hands
-together, so that the head is rocked still further backward
-at the instant an anteriorly directed force is applied to the<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_144">144</a></span>
-prominent transverse. The result is rotation of the vertebra—unless
-there be a loose articulation in the Cervicals which
-gives way under the force applied to the head.</p>
-
-<h3>THE EDGE CONTACT<br />
-
-<span class="subhead">(“Point 2 Contact”—“Knife Move.”)</span></h3>
-
-<h4>Name</h4>
-
-<p>This movement has various names. The name “Point
-2 Contact” is handed down from the days when Palmer
-used three contact points and three moves and designated
-the middle of the ulnar side of the fifth metacarpal bone as
-“Point 2.” The name “Edge Contact” was applied later,
-during the improvements in its technic when the hooking
-of the thumbs stiffened its efficiency and made it very valuable.
-It has since been rediscovered (though in constant
-use) and re-named “Knife Move.”</p>
-
-<h4>Uses</h4>
-
-<p>A movement which uses the spinous process as a lever
-and is applicable to D 2, 3, or 4, and to any Dorsal or Lumbar
-from D 8 down, when posterior, postero-superior, or postero-inferior.
-It does not correct rotation except insofar as the
-shape of articular processes may aid an anteriorly directed
-move in rotating the vertebra.</p>
-
-<p>Some Chiropractors have used the Edge Contact in the
-Cervicals but this is always improper, as it is practically<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_145">145</a></span>
-impossible in some, and difficult in all, cases to cover only one
-spinous process when the head is resting on its side.</p>
-
-<div id="ip_145" class="figcenter" style="max-width: 24.5625em;">
- <img src="images/i_145.jpg" width="393" height="600" alt="" />
- <div class="caption">Fig. 27. The edge contact in Lumbar region.</div></div>
-
-<h4>Palpation</h4>
-
-<p>Same as for Recoil or Heel Contact, q. v.</p>
-
-<h4>Contact</h4>
-
-<p>Using the same adjusting hand as for the Heel Contact,
-place the middle of the ulnar edge of the fifth metacarpal
-bone in contact with the spinous process. If the vertebra
-be superior, place the edge of hand <em>above</em>, if inferior, place
-the hand <em>below</em>. This contact is especially good for S or I
-vertebrae.</p>
-
-<h4>Position of Hands and Arms</h4>
-
-<p>The fingers of adjusting hand cross the spine at a right
-angle to its long axis. The back of hand will be toward
-patient’s head except in adjusting the last two Lumbars,
-with which a change of hands is made necessary by the
-upward slant of the lower half of the Lumbar curve.</p>
-
-<p>The palpating hand now grips the adjusting hand so
-that the fingers of the upper hand, held close together, press
-against and reinforce the lower on its dorsum and just
-above the contact point. The thumbs are hooked together
-as shown in Fig. 27, so that the hands may be stiffened and
-their tendency to roll avoided.</p>
-
-<p>The elbows are outrotated and locked as in the Pisiform
-Double Transverse Move and both shoulders are
-loosened.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_146">146</a></span></p>
-
-<h4>Movement</h4>
-
-<p>This is chiefly delivered with the upper arm, using upper
-hand to drive the lower. Force should be quickly delivered
-when patient is relaxed. The direction of force should be
-determined by the direction of subluxation and by the slant
-of the spinous process. Thus, when patient lies prone upon
-a bifid bench and sways downward against a lax abdominal
-support, the spinous processes of the lower dorsal make an
-acute angle with the plane of the floor. If one be superior,
-contact above it and force driven straight toward the floor
-will tend to correct the subluxation. There is a slightly
-different force angle for every subluxation correctable by
-this move.</p>
-
-<p>This move is less painful than the pisiform contact and
-may often be used to advantage, especially in the Lumbar
-region.</p>
-
-<h3>LUMBAR SINGLE TRANSVERSE</h3>
-
-<p>For the correction of a rotated Lumbar. Best used on
-second and third. This movement should never be attempted
-unless the transverse process can be palpated. Lumbar
-transverses are sometimes short or fragile, and unless they
-can be distinctly felt no force should be applied where they
-are <em>believed</em> to lie.</p>
-
-<h4>Contact</h4>
-
-<p>Pisiform bone with posterior transverse.</p>
-
-<div id="ip_146" class="figcenter" style="max-width: 24.75em;">
- <img src="images/i_147.jpg" width="396" height="600" alt="" />
- <div class="caption">Fig. 28. Lumbar single transverse move.</div></div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_147">147</a></span></p>
-
-<h4>Palpation and Placing of Hands</h4>
-
-<p>Palpating as if for other movements, pause with the
-second finger of palpating hand indicating the spinous process
-of the vertebra to be moved. Note that if the spinous
-process be to the right of the median line the left transverse
-will be posterior, if to the left, the right transverse.</p>
-
-<p>The transverse may then be found as in the Dorsals; it
-should lie even with the interspace above the spinous process,
-deeply overlaid with strong muscles. When the transverse
-has been located by a deep, probing movement of the
-fingers, place adjusting hand, pisiform on transverse, close
-to the spinous process for greater solidity and fingers extending
-downward and outward from the midspinal line
-parallel with the lower rib curve.</p>
-
-<p>If the adjuster stands on the side of the patient opposite
-to the transverse to be moved the hand opposite the palpating
-hand becomes the contact hand, as in other moves. But if
-the posterior transverse is on the same side with the adjuster,
-a change of hands is made and the palpating hand becomes
-contact hand. To accomplish this the adjuster must turn
-and face away from the patient with arm extended straight
-downward to the contact. After contact is made the remaining
-hand reinforces the adjusting hand by gripping the
-wrist.</p>
-
-<h4>Movement</h4>
-
-<p>In making the contact press downward, deeply and
-firmly, so as to crowd the muscles aside and place the pisiform<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_148">148</a></span>
-directly <em>upon</em> the transverse. Movement is given after
-the patient’s body has been swung downward for a considerable
-distance, and is sharp and decisive, directed
-straight toward the floor.</p>
-
-<h3>LUMBAR DOUBLE TRANSVERSE MOVE</h3>
-
-<p>A movement sometimes applied to posterior or postero-rotary
-Lumbars.</p>
-
-<h4>Palpation and Contact</h4>
-
-<p>From the spinous, find first the more posterior transverse
-and make contact with it, since most force must be directed
-there. Stand facing patient’s head and place right hand on
-right transverse and left hand on left.</p>
-
-<p>Contact point in this move is the tuberosity of the
-scaphoid with the posterior surface of the transverse. Fingers
-curve away from median line so as to avoid the rib curve.</p>
-
-<h4>Movement</h4>
-
-<p>After heavy, steady pressure downward, force is delivered
-with a quick, throwing movement, most force on
-the posterior side.</p>
-
-<h3>THE “SPREAD” MOVE</h3>
-
-<p>Upon the theory that when two forces are simultaneously
-applied, the one to drive some vertebra cephalad (by its
-spinous process) and the other to drive some lower vertebra
-caudad, the intervening vertebrae tend, if anterior, to be<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_149">149</a></span>
-drawn outward or toward a more posterior position, this
-move is predicated.</p>
-
-<p>The author does not believe that it accomplishes its
-purpose, but will briefly describe it for the benefit of those
-who do.</p>
-
-<h4>Position</h4>
-
-<p>Patient is placed over a roll which rests under the thighs
-so as to flex thighs and pelvis on the Lumbar spine, or an
-adjustable table is so tilted, both sections sloping downward
-from the middle, as to accomplish the same result.</p>
-
-<h4>Contact</h4>
-
-<p>The usual method, if only a single vertebra is anterior,
-is to make contact with the vertebrae immediately adjacent,
-crossing the hands and having fingers of upper hand pointing
-toward head and of lower hand toward Sacrum. But
-some adjusters use this move differently, making contact
-with Sacrum and with the mid-dorsal region in general
-and applying a slow force with both hands. Contact is with
-heel of hand upon spinous process.</p>
-
-<h3>SACRAL ADJUSTMENTS</h3>
-
-<p>The adjustment of the comparatively fixed sacrum is
-difficult at best and requires a very considerable force, violently
-applied. It is probable that nine-tenths of all attempts
-to move sacra fail. In children, when sacrum does
-not articulate properly with the ilia, and in adults in whom
-the sacrum has been loosened by trauma and remains in<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_150">150</a></span>
-an abnormal relation to surrounding structures, it can be
-moved.</p>
-
-<p>The sacrum is described as being posterior at the base
-or at the apex, and its axis for rotation is believed to be a
-transverse line through the sacroiliac articulations. Force
-for its adjustment is applied at right angles to the curve of
-the sacrum at the point of contact. The best contact is with
-the heel of the hand against a part of the sacrum, the wrist
-of the adjusting hand being gripped and reinforced by the
-other hand. If standing on patient’s left, the right hand
-becomes adjusting hand for sacrum as for the last two Lumbars,
-if on the right, the left hand.</p>
-
-<p>Another contact is with the pisiform and adjacent soft
-part of hand upon the sacral base, the pisiform hooking
-against the first sacral spinous process.</p>
-
-<p>Do not mistake an anterior fifth Lumbar for a posterior
-sacral base. Discriminate between iliac and sacral subluxations
-by noting that with the latter both sacroiliac articulations,
-and with the former only one seems abnormal.</p>
-
-<div id="ip_150" class="figcenter" style="max-width: 25.125em;">
- <img src="images/i_150.jpg" width="402" height="600" alt="" />
- <div class="caption">Fig. 29. “Bohemian Move” for correction of anterior fifth Lumbar
-by transmitting shock through spine.</div></div>
-
-<h3>ILIAC ADJUSTMENTS</h3>
-
-<h4>Palpation</h4>
-
-<p>With patient sitting erect on flat surface, feet on floor,
-stand behind and examine both sacroiliac articulations at
-once with the palmar surfaces of the fingers of both hands.
-If the two articulations are similar in every line neither
-ilium is subluxated, though the <em>sacrum</em> may be rotated on<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_151">151</a></span>
-its transverse axis between the ilia, so as to be posterior or
-anterior at base or apex.</p>
-
-<p>But no examination of the ilia is complete without investigating
-also the lumbosacral articulation. It sometimes
-happens that though the first sacral spinous process naturally
-completes the lumbar curve and there is no lumbosacral
-subluxation the crests of both ilia appear much posterior to
-their normal relation to the upper part of sacrum: this is
-a double iliac displacement.</p>
-
-<p>Usually the ilia are both normally articulated; this is
-one of the most difficult joints to weaken and is seldom
-affected except by the most extreme force. When iliac
-subluxation exists one side is affected alone nine times out
-of ten. The tenth case may show double subluxation.</p>
-
-<h4>Movement</h4>
-
-<p>Nine-tenths of the so-called “iliac adjustments” are
-quite amusingly ineffective. The force required really to <em>move</em>
-an ileum (save in joint disease or in children) is tremendous
-and not to be commanded by the ordinary adjuster. The
-light jars applied as a routine procedure by so many Chiropractors
-are in reality nothing more than single percussion
-strokes which stimulate the sacral nerves.</p>
-
-<p>Place patient in position B and apply the hands to a
-posterior ilium as to a posterior sacrum, making contact
-with the most prominent portion of crest or posterior border
-and driving in a direction which would represent a part of
-the circumference of a circle of which the transverse sacral<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_152">152</a></span>
-axis of rotation touches the center, or the center of fixation
-in the sacroiliac joint.</p>
-
-<h3>COCCYGEAL ADJUSTMENTS</h3>
-
-<h4>Examination</h4>
-
-<p>Place patient on an angle table, i. e., one which rises in
-the center and slopes away toward either end. Separate
-the thighs slightly, patient lying face down, and insert the
-rubber-covered second finger, palmar surface upward, very
-carefully into the rectum. The tip of the coccyx may then
-be felt and its movability and position determined. Unless
-it is immovably fixed in an abnormal position it should not be
-molested; the movable coccyx responds to mere muscle
-tension by changes of position and cannot act as a primary
-cause of nerve impingement.</p>
-
-<p>Usually this examination will be rendered unnecessary
-by the external palpation which may disclose the movability
-of the coccyx and at once render further exploration superfluous.</p>
-
-<p>When the coccyx is anteriorly subluxated and ankylosed
-in that position it may be a factor in producing constipation,
-hemorrhoids, etc., but its influence in other diseases, especially
-of the nervous system, has been greatly overrated by
-those who have not yet fully accepted the doctrine that
-nerve impingement is the primary cause of all disease.</p>
-
-<div id="ip_152" class="figcenter" style="max-width: 24.9375em;">
- <img src="images/i_152.jpg" width="399" height="600" alt="" />
- <div class="caption">Fig. 30. Edge contact with “Roll,” q. v. Attitude of patient
-for coccygeal adjustment.</div></div>
-
-<h4>Movement</h4>
-
-<p>When it has been decided that the coccyx must be
-moved, the position and use of hand is the same as for the<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_153">153</a></span>
-palpation. The finger hooks under the tip of the coccyx,
-draws upon it until a tight contact is secured and then
-jerks sharply backward upon it with a view to its abrupt
-fracture. No mitigation of the jerk in the hope of
-previously loosening or gradually replacing the bone is of
-value for <em>osseous tissue</em> must be broken before any movement
-may take place.</p>
-
-<p>This movement is painful and the region of the newly
-fractured coccyx may remain sore for a period ranging
-from a few days to several weeks. It is wise to warn the
-patient of the facts before proceeding.</p>
-
-<p>The fractured coccyx may be absorbed, or may be reankylosed
-in a proper position or in a new abnormal position,
-or may remain loose and movable.</p>
-
-<h3 id="adjustcurvatures">ADJUSTMENT OF CURVATURES</h3>
-
-<p>We have previously discussed in detail the nature and
-discovery of curvatures. A few words should be said here
-about their correction.</p>
-
-<p>If the sole object of the adjustment is to correct the
-curvature it is best to select for adjustment those vertebrae
-which are most subluxated in the direction of the curvature.
-According to the length of the curvature a series of from
-two to six, separated by some distance, are chosen. These
-are adjusted until they cease to be the most prominent ones
-in the curvature and then others, then most prominent, are
-chosen and adjusted until they in turn cease to be most
-prominent. In this way the curvature may eventually be<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_154">154</a></span>
-straightened, or nearly so. It is doubtful if any curvature
-can be absolutely eradicated, although it may be straightened
-until unnoticeable except by the expert.</p>
-
-<p>To overcome a curvature it may be necessary to break
-every rule which governs ordinary adjusting and to invent
-new ways of placing the hands or of delivering force. No
-two require exactly the same measures and he is most successful
-with curvatures who is most adaptable to changing
-conditions.</p>
-
-<p>One rule may be safely laid down. Do not alternate
-from day to day, loosening at the same time many vertebrae,
-but choose the ones most in need of adjustment and <em>follow
-your choice</em> as long as it is indicated. The chief vertebra is
-nearly always the one at the <em>angle</em> or <em>point</em> of the curvature.</p>
-
-<p>The sharp, angular curve of Potts’ Disease, involving
-two or three vertebrae, should warn against adjustment,
-usually, since in this disease the vertebrae are fragile and
-easily fractured. If a case has not progressed too far a
-cure may be effected, but great caution in taking such cases
-must be exercised. Every Chiropractor should be well
-informed on the diagnosis of Potts’ Disease, or spinal caries.</p>
-
-<p>Many months are usually required for the straightening
-of a curvature—how many can scarcely be estimated in
-advance of the experiment with any case. Often the case
-which seems simplest requires the longer time, while a very
-pronounced curvature, as in some cases of rachitis, may
-yield in a few months.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_155">155</a></span></p>
-
-<h3 id="h_36">PREFERABLE ADJUSTMENTS</h3>
-
-<p>The selection of the move with which to correct each
-subluxation depends upon the adjuster’s concept of the <em>kind</em>
-and <em>direction</em> of the subluxation and of the mechanics of
-the different corrective moves in his repertoire. The move
-used should be one in which the application of force is
-exactly along opposite lines to the lines of force which
-originally produced the subluxation.</p>
-
-<p>Omitting involved explanations as to the elements of
-each displacement and the manner of change in bone,
-muscle, ligament, cartilage, etc., and presupposing a comprehension
-of the principles of each adjustment named,
-there follows here a list of possible subluxations of each
-vertebra in turn, from Atlas down, with a simple statement
-of the RIGHT MOVE for that subluxation.</p>
-
-<p>In each instance there are other moves than the one
-listed which would <em>move</em> the vertebra and some which would
-partially correct it, but none which would quite so definitely
-tend to <em>correct the displacement</em>. Unfortunately it is not a
-fact that every movement of a vertebra is an adjustment. If
-this were true subluxations would not exist, because they
-could never have been produced. Too often the adjuster
-uses a move because it is easy, because its use has become
-habitual with him, rather than because it is indicated by the
-conditions of the case—then blames Chiropractic because his
-results are negative or bad.</p>
-
-<p>The move which is suited to a certain kind of subluxation<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_156">156</a></span>
-of one vertebra may be quite out of place with another,
-in a different part of the spine. Thus the Recoil is quite
-proper for a posterior Lumbar and is contraindicated with
-a posterior middle Dorsal.</p>
-
-<p>If all vertebrae were shaped exactly alike, if all were
-equal in size, if subluxation were possible only in one direction,
-then one method of adjustment would be quite sufficient.
-Diversity of technic is demanded, but a discriminating
-diversity, with a good reason for every move used.</p>
-
-<table id="adjustments" class="narrow" summary="List of adjustments">
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">First Cervical</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc" style="width: 55%;"><i>Subluxation.</i></td>
- <td class="tdc" style="width: 45%;"><i>Adjustment.</i></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Right—R.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Break, or straight lateral.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Right, posterior—R. P.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Rotary lateral.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Right, anterior—R. A.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Morikubo.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Right, superior—R. S.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Break.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Right, inferior—R. I.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Break.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Right, posterior, superior—R. P. S.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Rotary lateral.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Right, posterior, inferior—R. P. I.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Rotary lateral.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Right, anterior, superior—R. A. S.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Morikubo.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Right, anterior, inferior—R. A. I.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Morikubo.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Left—L.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Break.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Left, posterior—L. P.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Rotary lateral.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Left, anterior—L. A.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Morikubo.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Left, superior—L. S.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Break.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Left, inferior—L. I.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Break.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Left, posterior, superior—L. P. S.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Rotary lateral.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Left, posterior, inferior—L. P. I.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Rotary lateral.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Left, anterior, superior—L. A. S.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Morikubo.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Left, anterior, inferior—L. A. I.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Morikubo.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Anterior (entire Atlas)—A.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Morikubo (both sides).</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior (entire Atlas)—P.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Rotary lateral (both sides).</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl note" colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Note.</span>—All right subluxations adjusted from right side, all left from left side.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">Second Cervical<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_157">157</a></span></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior—P.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior Cervical move.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, right—P. R.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Double contact on right side.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, left—P. L.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Double contact on left side.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, right, inferior—P. R. L.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Double contact on right.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, right, superior—P. R. S.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Double contact on right.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, left, inferior—P. L. I.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Double contact on left side.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, left, superior—P. L. S.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Double contact on left side.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Right (lateral)—R.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Break (Same if R. I. or R. S.)</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Right (rotary)—R.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Rotary (Same if R. I. or R. S.)</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Left (lateral)—L.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Break (Same if L. I. or L. S.)</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Left (rotary)—L.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Rotary (Same if L. I. or L. S.)</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Superior—S.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior Cervical move.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Inferior—I.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior Cervical move.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Anterior (entire Vertebra)—A.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Ventral transverse contact on most anterior side.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Anterior, right (lateral)—A. R.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Second metacarpal contact from right.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Anterior, right (rotary)—A. R.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Pisiform Ant. Cerv. contact on right.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Anterior, left (lateral)—A. L.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Second metacarpal contact from left.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Anterior, left (rotary)—A. L.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Pisiform Ant. Cerv. contact on left.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">Third Cervical</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Same as second.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">Fourth Cervical</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Same as second.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">Fifth Cervical</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Same as second.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">Sixth Cervical<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_158">158</a></span></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior—P.</td>
- <td class="tdl">The Recoil, hands reversed.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, right—P. R.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil, hands reversed.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, left—P. L.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil, hands reversed.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, right, superior—P. R. S.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil, hands reversed.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, right, inferior—P. R. I.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil, hands reversed.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, left, superior—P. L. S.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil, hands reversed.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, left, inferior—P. L. I.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil, hands reversed.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Right (lateral)—R.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Break (Same if R. I. or R. S.)</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Right (rotary)—R.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Rotary (Same if R. I. or R. S.)</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Left (lateral)—L.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Break, from left (Same if L. I. or L. S.)</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Left (rotary)—L.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Rotary (Same if L. I. or L. S.)</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Superior—S.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Edge contact move.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Inferior—I.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Edge contact move.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Anterior (entire vertebra)—A.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Pisiform Ant. Cerv. contact on most anterior side.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Anterior, right (lateral)—A. R.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Second metacarpal contact from right.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Anterior, right (rotary)—A. R.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Pisiform Ant. Cerv. contact on right.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Anterior, left (lateral)—A. L.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Second metacarpal contact from left.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Anterior, left (rotary)—A. L.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Pisiform Ant. Cerv. contact on left.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">Seventh Cervical</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl" colspan="2">Same as sixth Cervical, except that T. M. may be used on right or left rotary subluxations.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">First Dorsal<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_159">159</a></span></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior—P.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil, hands reversed.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, right—P. R.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil, hands reversed.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, right, superior—P. R. S.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil, hands reversed.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, right, inferior—P. R. I.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil, hands reversed.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, left—P. L.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil, hands reversed.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, left, superior—P. L. S.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil, hands reversed.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, left, inferior—P. L. I.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil, hands reversed.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, superior—P. S.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Heel contact.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, inferior—P. I.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Edge contact.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Superior—S.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Heel contact.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Inferior—I.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Edge contact.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Right—R.</td>
- <td class="tdl">T. M. (Same if R. S. or R. I.)</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Left—L.</td>
- <td class="tdl">T. M. (Same if L. S. or L. I.)</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Anterior—A.</td>
- <td class="tdl">No correction.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">Second Dorsal</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior—P.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Heel contact.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, superior—P. S.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Heel contact.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, inferior—P. I.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Edge contact.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, right—P. R.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, right, superior—P. R. S.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, right, inferior—P. R. I.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, left—P. L.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, left, superior—P. L. S.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, left, inferior—P. L. I.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Left—L.</td>
- <td class="tdl">T. M. (Same if L. S. or L. I.)</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Right—R.</td>
- <td class="tdl">T. M. (Same if R. S. or R. I.)</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Anterior—A.</td>
- <td class="tdl">No correction.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">Third Dorsal<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_160">160</a></span></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior—P.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Heel contact.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, superior—P. S.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Heel contact.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, inferior—P. I.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Edge contact.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, right—P. R.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, right, superior—P. R. S.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, right, inferior—P. R. I.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, left—P. L.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, left, superior—P. L. S.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, left, inferior—P. L. I.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Right—R.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Pisiform single transverse (on left) (Same if R. S. or R. I.)</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Left—L.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Pisiform single transverse (on right) (Same if L. S. or L. I.)</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Anterior—A.</td>
- <td class="tdl">No correction.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">Fourth Dorsal</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Same as third Dorsal.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl note" colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Note.</span>—While the Recoil is here, the preferred move for posterior and postero-lateral subluxations, the pisiform double transverse or the two finger double transverse may be used if both transverses are palpable.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">Fifth Dorsal</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior—P.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Double transverse move.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, superior—P. S.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Heel contact.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, inferior—P. I.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Double transverse.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, right—P. R.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Double transverse.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, right, superior—P. R. S.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Double transverse.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, right, inferior—P. R. I.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Double transverse.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, left—P. L.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Double transverse.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl note" colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Note.</span>—The pisiform double transverse and the two-finger double transverse, apply force in exactly similar directions and may therefore be used interchangeably. The latter is preferable for children.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, left, superior—P. L. S.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Double transverse.<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_161">161</a></span></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, left, inferior—P. L. I.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Double transverse.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Right—R.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Pisiform single transverse (Same if R. S. or R. I.)</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Left—L.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Pisiform single transverse. (Same if L. S. or L. I.)</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Anterior—A.</td>
- <td class="tdl">No correction.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">Sixth Dorsal</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Same as Fifth Dorsal.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">Seventh Dorsal</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Same as Fifth Dorsal.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">Eighth Dorsal</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Same as Fifth Dorsal.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">Ninth Dorsal</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Same as Fifth Dorsal.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">Tenth Dorsal</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior—P.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Heel contact.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, superior—P. S.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Edge contact.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, inferior—P. I.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Edge contact.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, right—P. R.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, right, superior—P. R. S.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, right, inferior—P. R. I.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, left—P. L.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, left, superior—P. L. S.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, left, inferior—P. L. I.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Right—R.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil (Same if R. S. or R. I.)<a id="FNanchor_A" href="#Footnote_A" class="fnanchor">A</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Left—L.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil (Same if L. S. or L. I.)<a href="#Footnote_A" class="fnanchor">A</a></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Anterior—A.</td>
- <td class="tdl">No correction.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl note" colspan="2"><a id="Footnote_A" href="#FNanchor_A" class="fnanchor">A</a> Note.—The use of this move is not quite mechanically correct, but it is advised because of the possible danger of using the transverse processes as levers.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">Eleventh Dorsal</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Same as Tenth Dorsal.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">Twelfth Dorsal<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_162">162</a></span></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Same as Tenth Dorsal.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">First Lumbar</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior—P.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Heel contact.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, superior—P. S.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Heel contact.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, inferior—P. I.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Heel contact.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, right, superior—P. R. S.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, right, inferior—P. R. I.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, left—P. L.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, left, superior—P. L. S.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, left, inferior—P. L. I.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Right—R.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Lumbar single transverse move, if transverse is palpable, otherwise Recoil. (Same if R. S. or R. I.)</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Left—L.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Lumbar single transverse move, if transverse is palpable, otherwise Recoil. (Same if L. S. or L. I.)</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Anterior—A.</td>
- <td class="tdl">No correction.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">Second Lumbar</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Same as First Lumbar.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">Third Lumbar</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Same as First Lumbar.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">Fourth Lumbar</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior—P.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Heel contact.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, superior—P. S.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Heel contact.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, inferior—P. I.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Heel contact.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, right—P. R.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil, hands reversed.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, right, superior—P. R. S.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil, hands reversed.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl note" colspan="2"><span class="smcap">Note.</span>—The Heel contact may be substituted for the Recoil above if force be carefully directed in the proper direction in delivery.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, right, inferior—P. R. I.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil, hands reversed.<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_163">163</a></span></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, left—P. L.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil, hands reversed.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, left, superior—P. L. S.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil, hands reversed.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, left, inferior—P. L. I.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil, hands reversed.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Right—R.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Lumbar single transverse move, if transverse is palpable, otherwise Recoil. (Same if R. S. or R. I.)</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Left—L.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Lumbar single transverse, if transverse is palpable, otherwise Recoil. (Same if L. S. or L. I.)</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Anterior—A.</td>
- <td class="tdl">No correction.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">Fifth Lumbar</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior—P.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Heel contact.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, superior—P. S.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Edge contact.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, inferior—P. I.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Edge contact.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, right—P. R.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, right, superior—P. R. S.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, right, inferior—P. R. I.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, left—P. L.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, left, superior—P. L. S.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior, left, inferior—P. L. I.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Right—R.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil (Same if R. S. or R. I.)</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Left—L.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Recoil (Same if L. S. or L. I.)</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Anterior—A.</td>
- <td class="tdl">“Bohemian” anterior fifth Lumbar move. (Not always advisable.)</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">Sacrum<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_164">164</a></span></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior base—B. of S.—P.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Heel contact on base.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Posterior apex—A. of S.—P.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Heel contact on apex.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Entire Sacrum posterior Sac. P.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Heel contact between sacroiliac articulations.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">Coccyx</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl" colspan="2">To be adjusted only when ankylosed in an abnormal position and then by leverage of finger through rectum.</td></tr>
-</table>
-
-<h3>A FINAL WORD</h3>
-
-<p>Some useful information pertaining to adjustment will
-be found in section entitled, “Practice,” q. v.</p>
-
-<p>After a careful and painstaking study of the foregoing
-pages it will still be found that the student is not by any
-means equipped for the work. He must <em>practice</em> these
-things to learn them. We learn to do by <em>doing</em>. The chief
-use of this section will be as a reference and guide during
-the practice of adjusting.</p>
-
-<hr />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_165">165</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<h2 id="h_37"><a id="THE_CAUSE_OF_DISEASE"></a>THE CAUSE OF DISEASE</h2>
-</div>
-
-<h4>Disease a Morbid Process</h4>
-
-<p>Disease has been variously regarded as an entity, a process,
-a condition. It has been mentioned in terms which
-would almost personalize it, such as, “attacked by pneumonia,”
-“seized with cramps,” “in the clutches of tuberculosis.”
-Men have endeavored constantly to discriminate
-between diseases and to learn the appearance and peculiarity
-of each, and have resolved each into its peculiar elements
-only to learn that the merging lines between two diseases or
-between cases of the same disease are imperceptible. It is
-no more possible to define any one disease within exact limits
-and to distinguish it from all others than to consider one
-function of the human body without studying its interdependence
-with others.</p>
-
-<p>Disease is a <em>process</em>. It is a natural process. It follows
-certain well-defined laws and consists in the abnormal performance
-of function in some bodily organ or organs, or in
-the untimely performance of some function which would be
-normal in its proper chronological relation with other functions
-or at another period of the body’s development. The
-balance of function of the body is destroyed—some function
-intensified or diminished—that is all. Every disease, properly
-studied, reveals its functional base.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_166">166</a></span></p>
-
-<p>Disturbances of the functions of <em>growth</em>, <em>nutrition</em>, and
-<em>repair</em> produce changes in structure, physical evidences of
-disease. It is probable that every disease has a certain
-amount of structural change connected with it; it is hard
-to conceive of functional derangement without structural
-change, in a universe in which Nature is eternally building,
-destroying, or modifying organic peculiarities to meet changing
-functional demands. But in many instances this structural
-change is so slight as to be undiscoverable; such
-diseases are called “functional” to distinguish them from
-those in which structural pathologic changes are directly
-discernible, called “organic.”</p>
-
-<h4>Beginning of the Process</h4>
-
-<p>Recognizing the fact that disease consists in a succession
-of steps or a series of events, each depending upon the
-next preceding one and making possible its successor, and
-desiring to arrest or check this process and correct the
-damage done, in other words, “to cure disease,” the question
-arises, “Where does this process begin?”</p>
-
-<p>If we wish merely to check the process or to modify it,
-as does medicine, the etiology of the disease is less important
-than the present state. It is then more important that we
-understand the changes which are taking place in the body
-at the time of our attempt, the condition of each organ at
-that time, and the general recuperative or resisting power of
-the individual.</p>
-
-<p>But if we would correct all the damage done instead of<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_167">167</a></span>
-merely preventing further damage or building up internal
-resistance against a still active destructive process; if we
-would so eliminate the effects of the earlier steps as to make
-the resumption of the disease process most improbable, we
-must know each step from the beginning to the present,
-understand their sequence and relation, and go back to the
-beginning with our correction, <em>removing the cause</em>.</p>
-
-<h4>The Cause of Disease</h4>
-
-<p>Since each event in the morbid process depends upon
-the preceding one and makes possible those which follow, it
-is possible to stop at any point in the chain of events and
-declare, “Here lies the Cause of Disease.” This explains
-the various etiologies adhered to each by a school of intelligent
-and scientific men, yet each apparently disagreeing
-most flatly with the others. No matter which step we select
-as our “ultimate cause” it truly is the cause, or one of the
-causes, of succeeding steps, which succeeding steps may well
-stand in our minds as the whole of the disease. Thus the
-physician, having found a germ, is quite content to look
-forward from the invasion of the germ and consider that
-as the primarily necessary requisite for disease production.
-In retrospect he follows disease back within the body to
-the time of entrance of the germ and then leaves the body to
-study the life habits of the germ and its favorite mode of
-conveyance. He has unwittingly left the direct line of
-investigation and followed a spur-track.</p>
-
-<p>So with the osteopath who discovers contractured muscles<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_168">168</a></span>
-drawing a member, or a bone, from its normal position.
-He proceeds to a study of the effect of such contracture upon
-other tissues and strives to relieve it by treatment—of the
-muscle.</p>
-
-<p>The dietist discovers that certain food combinations
-cannot be properly cared for by an individual and that if
-taken they tend to develop toxins deleterious to the system.
-Whereupon he undertakes to discover food combinations
-which the body <em>can</em> care for and believes that he has solved
-the question of etiology.</p>
-
-<p>Now it is <em>most</em> important that we find the <em>primary</em> cause,
-the one which makes possible the operation of all the rest
-and without which all would be powerless to harm man.
-This we shall expect to find at the point of entrance of disease
-into the human organism. The primary cause must
-be the first step <em>which concerns man</em>, the first change from
-normal to abnormal, on which all subsequent changes depend.
-It is useless to pass outside of the consideration of
-man and those forces which directly affect man, in our
-search for the cause of disease. We are powerless to
-affect outside forces or to control or amend the laws of
-nature through which disease exists.</p>
-
-<p>Let us attempt then to resolve disease into its successive
-steps and to find the first which concerns man. Correcting
-that, we shall have corrected, fully and completely, the
-process which constitutes disease. By striking at the root
-we may destroy the entire growth.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_169">169</a></span></p>
-
-<h4>Vital Energy</h4>
-
-<p><dfn>Irritability</dfn> is the property of being susceptible to excitement
-or stimulation. Stimulation is the process of increasing
-the functional activity of any organ. Inhibition is the act of
-checking, restraining, or holding back the functional activity
-of any organ. These definitions, taken from Gould, are
-here introduced as a necessary preface to an attempt to set
-forth, without unnecessary reference to, or discussion of,
-any other theory as to the etiology of disease, the Chiropractic
-explanation of its presence.</p>
-
-<p>Chiropractic maintains that all the chemical and physical
-activities of the human organism are controlled, directly
-or indirectly, through a third form of energy transmitted
-through the Nerve System; that while all three forms of
-energy are interdependent and closely related in their ultimate
-expression, one of the three is the <em>primary</em> and most
-essential form, and especially indicative of life. We may
-call this third form <dfn>Vital Energy</dfn>.</p>
-
-<p>There are several good reasons for believing that this
-nerve force is the primary form in which energy is expressed
-in man and for believing that it controls and directs the
-others in greater degree than it is controlled and directed
-by them.</p>
-
-<p>Of the four forms of tissue of which the body is composed—connective,
-epithelial, muscular, and nervous—the
-latter is the one damage to which is followed by the greatest
-and most permanent consequences.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_170">170</a></span></p>
-
-<p>It is a fact that there are several organs whose removal
-leads to certain death because of their importance in the
-general economy of the body, but it is also true that section
-of the nerves leading to these organs just as certainly
-causes death by the cessation of their functions. There is
-no organ in the body aside from the nerves themselves
-which does not immediately cease to act upon withdrawal
-of its nerve force and at once begin a process of degeneration
-or atrophy.</p>
-
-<p>Pathologic changes in the Nerve System invariably are
-followed by pathologic changes in the organs controlled by
-the diseased segment but the converse is not true. Excitation
-or inhibition of nerve activity produces corresponding
-and responsive change in the activity of the organs innervated,
-but excitation of an organ does not necessarily produce
-similar changes in the Nerve System. That system
-possesses the power of inhibiting or permitting responsive
-action, in other words, the power of <em>choice</em>.</p>
-
-<p>Research in Comparative Anatomy develops the fact
-that the differences in power of complex action possessed
-by different organisms are entirely measurable by differences
-in the structure and complexity of their nerve mechanisms.</p>
-
-<p>Further, by studying the effects of removal or extirpation,
-or of pathologic changes in various parts of the nerve
-system it has been demonstrated that the Brain is the center
-for those higher forms of activity known as psychic, for the
-power of accelerating or inhibiting the responses of the
-lower centers of the nerve system to stimulation from without,<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_171">171</a></span>
-and for the conveyance of authority to act to all the
-lower centers. The Nerve System is the morphologic,
-physiologic, and dynamic center of the organism and the
-Brain the center of the Nerve System. We may, then,
-logically expect to find in the Brain, or in the channels by
-which power is distributed from the Brain to lower centers
-or organs, the initial step in the disease process, which
-is our present quest.</p>
-
-<h4>One Nerve System</h4>
-
-<p>All nerve tissue in the body is organized and linked together
-in a complicated aggregation of individual units,
-communicating by <em>contact</em>, and forming one great Nerve
-System having its directing center in the Brain. It is said
-by some writers to consist of two distinct systems—cerebro-spinal
-and sympathetic—but would better be described as
-consisting of central organs—brain and spinal cord—and
-peripheral organs—cranial, spinal, and sympathetic peripheral
-axons connecting with cells in the central axis and
-linked together in a net-work improperly separable into
-separate or distinct divisions, the fibres of different parts
-being bound together in such a way as to establish an intricate
-intercommunication, closest on the one hand between
-the cranial and sympathetic and on the other between the
-spinal and sympathetic. The sympathetic system may be
-regarded as nothing more than a medium for proper distribution
-of impulses originating in the cerebro-spinal
-system, and a series of reflex centers deriving their power<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_172">172</a></span>
-to act from the central axis. The proper action of sympathetic
-ganglia has been demonstrated to depend upon the
-integrity of the spinal nerve fibres, or rami communicantes,
-which pass to and terminate in the ganglia with their telodendria
-(terminal arborizations) in contact with the dendrites
-(cellulipetal processes) of the ganglion cells.</p>
-
-<p>It will appear that interference with one division or
-part of the nerve system may be followed by effects partly
-manifested through a distant part; that excitation or inhibition
-of a spinal nerve may correspondingly excite or inhibit
-sympathetic fibres.</p>
-
-<h4>Chiropractic Hypothesis</h4>
-
-<p>Chiropractic has accepted, as a convenient working
-hypothesis amply justified by years of clinical experiment
-and anatomical and physiological research, the proposition
-that all disease in the human body is primarily made possible
-by injury to (stimulation or inhibition of) some part of the
-nervous mechanism.</p>
-
-<p>Injury to other tissues, unless the injury also involves
-nerve tissue, is quickly repaired and the body goes on without
-disease. Or the injury is sufficient at once to render the
-body untenable and death ensues. Few pathological changes
-follow trauma unless nerve tissue be injured.</p>
-
-<p>This theory to be logical must and does include the
-entire nerve system. Also, since it is noted that each nerve
-cell presides over the nutrition of its own processes and
-possesses its own power of repair, it follows that unless an<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_173">173</a></span>
-injury be of fatal nature or of permanent duration, even injuries
-to nerves tend toward automatic cure. We must
-seek a permanently operating interference with nerve tissue.</p>
-
-<p>The brain, enclosed within the comparatively solid
-cranium, is so well protected that nothing except fracture
-of the skull, violent concussion, or shutting off of its
-blood supply from without, will produce permanent change
-there. Also, unless there be pressure by foreign substance
-against the brain, an injury will be repaired in time and
-the body resume its normal functional activity. It has been
-demonstrated that comparatively few diseases occur in this
-way. Such as do are called traumatic; i. e., caused by
-wound or injury.</p>
-
-<p>In the broadest sense all disease is caused by trauma, as
-we shall presently show.</p>
-
-<p>The upper or cephalic peripheral nerves, called cranial,
-leave the skull by foramina in its base (except the auditory)
-and are so protected by the immobility of the bones of the
-skull as to be comparatively free from direct injury. Peripheral
-injuries occur to cranial nerves but are repairable;
-even section of the trigeminal for neuralgia is usually followed
-after an interval by a reunion of the severed parts.
-As will be shown later, the special end organs of the cranial
-nerves are not free from the effects of spinal subluxation
-and their nuclei (deep origins) often share in morbid
-changes in the brain tissue due to nutritional disturbances.</p>
-
-<p>The sympathetic portion of the nervous system might
-be classed with the cranial as regards infrequency of permanent<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_174">174</a></span>
-interference were it not for the proximity of the
-great gangliated cord to the transverse processes and bodies
-of the vertebrae. This proximity renders it liable to sustain
-permanent impingement in vertebral subluxation.</p>
-
-<h4>Trauma Affects Spinal Nerves</h4>
-
-<p>With the exception of the first pair of Cervical nerves
-and the Sacral and Coccygeal, all spinal nerves pass through
-foramina of exit which are composed each of two movable
-vertebrae. The Chiropractic hypothesis is based upon the
-discovery that in addition to the part these vertebrae may
-take in general movements of the spine it is possible that
-their relation to each other may be changed by the application
-of force from without, and that this change once produced
-tends to remain permanently. These permanent vertebral
-subluxations occur with great frequency, a fact clinically
-demonstrable by palpation and by the X-Ray.</p>
-
-<p>The discovery of this fact led to the ascertaining of two
-more, namely,</p>
-
-<p><em>No disease is ever found without accompanying subluxation.</em></p>
-
-<p>Since each organ or tissue is connected with some definite
-and special vertebra, subluxations accompanying disease
-bear a relation to disease which is controlled by a
-general law, operative alike on all human organisms.</p>
-
-<p>The latter fact required one other for its complete demonstration;
-namely, that the removal of the subluxation is
-always followed by the complete disappearance of the disease.<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_175">175</a></span>
-Given more perfect methods of correcting subluxations
-it would follow that proof of the Chiropractic theory
-would be so complete and overwhelming as to meet at once
-with general acceptance. The difficulty lies in the fact that
-with our present methods much time is often required for
-complete correction of the vertebral displacement and much
-skill is needed even for successful investigation of the results
-obtainable. The theory is too often judged by unskilled or
-imperfect applications of it.</p>
-
-<p>Every school of Chiropractic accepts the presence of the
-subluxation and has spent much thought and time in the
-effort to deduce the law governing its connection with disease.
-Diverse conclusions have been reached owing to the
-difficulty experienced in completely eradicating the subluxation.
-When it <em>is</em> accomplished the results are absolutely
-conclusive. When it is partially or relatively accomplished
-the results are so good in a great per cent of cases as to
-lead sometimes to the erroneous belief that the subluxation
-did not cause the disease since mere partial correction of
-the subluxation suffices to bring about the apparent total
-removal of the disease. In every case of thorough experiment
-the results warrant the recommendation of the subluxation
-theory as at least a proper working hypothesis.</p>
-
-<p>Without attempting here to review all the various conclusions
-reached or the methods by which they have been
-attained, we would simply state our own conclusion, which
-we believe is the only one compatible with demonstrable
-facts. It is briefly this: Since every portion of the body is<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_176">176</a></span>
-connected through the nervous system with the spinal nerves
-and since it has been proven that this connection is reasonably
-constant and anatomically demonstrable; since the
-removal or correction of a subluxation leads in all cases to
-the complete disappearance of disease from the organs or
-tissues innervated from the subluxated portion of the spinal
-column, we conclude that the subluxation is the <em>primary
-cause</em> of disease.</p>
-
-<p>The final test of the correctness of any theory is the
-result of its application. Since Chiropractic secures a larger
-percentage of results than any other known system of healing
-it is safe to assume, at least, that it has discovered the
-way to remove the primary cause of disease.</p>
-
-<p>That the Chiropractic theory, or more properly the subluxation
-theory, does not include all of the etiology of disease
-is evidenced by the facts of contagion and infection,
-by the effect upon the organism of the introduction of poison,
-by the consequences of worry, anger, and other abnormal
-mental states and conditions. These facts do not in the least
-invalidate the theory. They merely require explanation which
-will make clear their relation to the subluxation. That such
-explanation is abundantly at hand strengthens the position
-of Chiropractic more than would negation of all other causes
-save the one we concentrate upon.</p>
-
-<p>The Mentalist who holds that all diseases exist in and
-are but figments of the mind is as far afield as the Physicist
-who holds that special nerve energy is nonexistent. The
-Chiropractor views Man as a complex psycho-physical unit,<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_177">177</a></span>
-self-operating and internally self-healing until environmental
-forces disturb the nice adjustment of the machinery.</p>
-
-<p>Disease is produced by, and is, a series of events, chief
-and most permanent of which is the subluxation. We may
-consider its etiology according to the order in which the
-events take place thus:</p>
-
-<h4>Direct Chain</h4>
-
-<p>Concussion of Forces.</p>
-
-<p>Subluxation of Vertebra.</p>
-
-<p>Impingement of Nerve.</p>
-
-<p>Excitation or Inhibition.</p>
-
-<p>Disease—Abnormal Function.</p>
-
-<h4>Accessory Chains</h4>
-
-<p>Between the last two steps above, or following the last,
-are often introduced one or more of the following accessory
-chains which modify or increase the final effect and are
-themselves made possible by the first four steps in the direct
-chain.</p>
-
-<p>Pathogenic germ.</p>
-
-<p>Poisonous excretions from germs.</p>
-
-<p>Tissue destruction by chemical action of such toxins.</p>
-
-<p>Reflex muscular tension tending to increase subluxation
-and thus augment nerve impingement and its effects.</p>
-
-<p class="in0">Or</p>
-
-<p>Dietetic error.</p>
-
-<p>Abnormal chemical action.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_178">178</a></span></p>
-
-<p>Tissue destruction or nerve irritation by chemical poisons.</p>
-
-<p>Reflex motor disturbances which further limit digestive
-power.</p>
-
-<p class="in0">Or</p>
-
-<p>Abnormal mental condition.</p>
-
-<p>Waste of nerve energy with production of toxins.</p>
-
-<p>General metabolic disturbance.</p>
-
-<p>Increased disease wherever disease previously existed.</p>
-
-<p>These are offered merely as illustrations. There are many
-accessory chains which aid in the production or development
-of disease and act as <em>secondary causes</em>.</p>
-
-<h4>Concussion of Forces</h4>
-
-<p>Man was so created, so provided with means for repair,
-growth, etc., that the body tends to maintain its own functional
-balance—perfect harmony among all its parts—unless
-interfered with by some outside agency. There are certain
-natural laws such as the law of gravitation and the law of
-momentum and inertia which operate without regard for
-man or man’s welfare. If man, wittingly or unwittingly,
-allows himself to come into violent conflict with one of
-these laws by falling to the ground or in meeting sudden
-and unexpected opposing force or mass while in motion,
-that which may be termed a concussion is produced by the
-meeting of the outside force and the internal bodily resistance.</p>
-
-<p>Many such concussions may occur without serious damage.
-Some produce wounds or injuries which it is possible<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_179">179</a></span>
-for the body to heal without causing serious disturbance of
-function. Other concussions are so violent as to produce
-displacement of structure which tends to remain permanently.
-Under Spino-Organic Connection will be found an
-explanation of the manner in which force applied to various
-parts of the body tends to affect the spine.</p>
-
-<p>Now the displacement of a bone cannot be corrected by
-the body without outside aid. No method is provided for
-such correction. Produced by outside force affecting the
-body, it can only be reduced by outside force. It is this
-failure of Nature to make man adaptable to <em>every untoward
-circumstance</em> which renders him susceptible to disease.</p>
-
-<h4>Subluxation</h4>
-
-<p>As has been previously stated by no means all concussions
-of forces produce subluxation. (All subluxations,
-however, are produced by concussion of forces.) It may be
-added that not all subluxations impinge nerves and that when
-they do not so encroach upon nerve tissue they produce no
-noticeable effect after the first temporary soreness has disappeared.</p>
-
-<p>Every subluxation, however, evidences a <em>tendency</em> to
-disease. Once moved from its normal position and the
-poise and symmetry of the body disturbed, there are influences
-which tend more readily to affect the same vertebra.
-The subluxated vertebra is more easily disturbed by jars,
-strains, etc., than the normal one because such jars are
-less regularly distributed to all its parts. A reflex muscular<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_180">180</a></span>
-tension due to other and more pronounced subluxations
-and their disease effects may in turn increase the slight
-deviations throughout the spine, rendering them in their
-turn capable of producing disease. When the spine or any
-part of it has lost its perfect regularity disease is made
-<em>possible</em>, if not a fact at once. The average number of
-subluxations in each individual is about nine and one-third.
-Of this number probably not more than one-third (though
-no accurate figures are available) are actually productive
-of conditions nameable as disease at any given time. Discrimination
-between those which do, and those which do
-not, produce discoverable symptoms in a given case is a
-matter which requires a nice technical skill and perfect
-judgment.</p>
-
-<h4>Impingement of Nerves</h4>
-
-<p>When a vertebra has lost its normal articular relations
-with its fellows and occupies an abnormal position as a
-consequence in regard to <em>all</em> surrounding or adjacent tissues
-it may impinge nerve tissue in two ways, by <em>tension</em>
-or by <em>constriction</em>. By the displacement of one vertebra of
-a pair the size and shape of the intervertebral foramen may
-be altered (occlusion) constricting the nerve which passes
-through the opening. That this change in the size and shape
-of the foramina does frequently occur is shown by the frequency
-with which alterations in the shape of vertebrae
-appear in dry spines, by post-mortems which have demonstrated
-the altered foramina in the cadaver and by permanent<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_181">181</a></span>
-occlusion of the foramina in ankylosed spines so
-that the occlusion may be preserved. Adding cartilage
-changes in the intervertebral disks to alterations in bone
-shape and position, especially the latter, we find full and
-sufficient reason for all the pathological phenomena which
-follow the subluxation. Explain it as you will, these morbid
-results <em>do</em> follow subluxation and can be experimentally
-produced in animals. Moreover, the disease may be directed
-to a desired organ or region by selection of the particular
-vertebra to be displaced.</p>
-
-<p>The suboccipital, sacral, and coccygeal nerves cannot be
-constricted as they pass through the foramina because they
-do not emerge through complete rings formed of separate
-and movable bones. But these nerves may be <em>pressed upon</em>
-or stretched by displaced bone, as may also the great gangliated
-cord of the sympathetic, especially the Cervical portion
-of it. <em>Tension</em> of the Cervical sympathetic cord by
-subluxation of vertebrae is a very common occurrence.</p>
-
-<p>Whether the impingement be by constriction or by tension
-the effect is much the same depending upon the degree
-to which the molecular continuity of the nerve substance
-is impaired—interference with the function of the organ
-connected with the nerve and sometimes swelling and pain in
-the nerve itself followed by degeneration. The effects are
-chiefly noticeable in peripheral tissues. S. Weir Mitchell
-says (1872), “A continuous pressure upon a nerve results
-in the degeneration of the nerve and a disturbance of function
-of the parts innervated by that nerve.” No clearer
-statement can be made.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_182">182</a></span></p>
-
-<p>It must not be understood that all nerve impingement
-is due directly to subluxation of a vertebra. A dislocated
-shoulder would produce a similar effect of nerve tension.
-But dislocated shoulders are seldom met with as permanent
-conditions. Likewise there may be secondary impingement
-from new growths, themselves due to some primary subluxation.
-Aneurism of the thoracic aorta often produces
-hoarseness by impingement of the recurrent laryngeal.</p>
-
-<p>Not all impingement is sufficient to produce noticeable
-disease. To a certain extent the power of adaptation inherent
-in the body can overcome its deleterious effects and
-suppress all signs of its existence until an overtax upon
-bodily energy lessens this adaptative power. Then disease
-appears and we say that the overtax caused it.</p>
-
-<h4>Excitation or Inhibition</h4>
-
-<p>A slight impingement serves as a mechanical irritant to
-increase the action of the nerve and the functions of the
-attached peripheral organs. Such stimulation beyond the
-normal is always followed by a reaction, or fall to subnormal
-action.</p>
-
-<p>Heavy impingement, especially the impingement due to
-marked occlusion of foramina, partly or wholly paralyzes
-the affected nerves. Often the impingement produces only
-a latent weakness in some organ, a weakness which may be
-brought to light only through the introduction of some secondary
-cause which takes advantage of the susceptibility of
-the organ to produce some definite disease. As an instance<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_183">183</a></span>
-of this we may mention typhoid fever. No typhoid case is
-found without subluxation in the region of the second
-Lumbar; yet the latent weakness produced by that subluxation
-may not have been observed until the typhoid germ
-found a fertile feeding and breeding ground in the weakened
-tissue and proceeded to multiply there and develop its
-toxins.</p>
-
-<h4>Effect Upon Single Cell</h4>
-
-<p>Each nerve cell is trophic to its processes and to the
-tissue cells to which these processes are distributed. The
-growth, nutrition and repair of each cell of the body is
-dependent upon the integrity of the axon which supplies it.
-The effect of nerve impingement upon the single cell is a
-weakening of cell structure and a disturbance, slight or
-great, of the special function possessed by that cell. Dunglisson
-says of diseases, “All ... are dependent upon
-modified cell-action.”</p>
-
-<h4>Effect Upon Organs</h4>
-
-<p>Each organ is but an aggregation of cells of some special
-type or kind. Nerve Impingement usually involves either a
-whole nerve trunk or many of its fibres and thus weakens
-either the entire organ or many of its cells and increases or
-diminishes its special function. Some organs are innervated
-by more than one nerve and may be injured only in part by
-a localized impingement.</p>
-
-<p>Alteration of the action of one organ often tends to<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_184">184</a></span>
-affect the entire body, as in subluxation of the fourth Dorsal
-interfering with the nerve supply to the liver the secretion
-of bile becomes altered in character or quantity and the entire
-system suffers, through deranged digestion, from this
-alteration in a necessary secretion. Every disease presents
-symptoms only indirectly referable to the organ which is
-primarily affected and the problem of the diagnostician
-is to so discriminate between direct and indirect symptoms
-as to be able to <em>locate</em> disease.</p>
-
-<h4 id="h_38">Simple Subluxation Disease</h4>
-
-<p>We have considered a chain of events by which disease
-is produced without the intervention of any secondary cause.
-Such a condition may be called, for convenience, a simple
-subluxation disease. Its existence depends directly upon
-the subluxation which is the first change manifest in the
-individual and upon which all the other changes depend.</p>
-
-<p>The two facts that not all subluxations impinge nerves
-and not all nerve impingements cause demonstrable disease
-explain why we do not, in practice, find a disease to correspond
-with each subluxation discovered by palpation. It
-must be remembered that there may be latent weakness
-following a subluxation and of importance because it
-renders the patient susceptible to infection or to the action
-of other secondary causes.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_185">185</a></span></p>
-
-<h3 id="h_39">SECONDARY CAUSES</h3>
-
-<p>Among the secondary causes of disease may be mentioned
-the pathogenic germ, poisons, dietetic errors, abnormal
-mental states, bodily excesses, exposure to sudden
-temperature changes, and inhalation of non-poisonous but
-irritating substances as the most common. Many others
-might be included but these will suffice for complete illustration
-of the principle. It will be our endeavor to show
-how each of these secondary causes operates by virtue of
-a previous susceptibility, or breaking down of the normal
-resisting power of the organism caused by subluxation, and
-how each in turn <em>may</em> bring about increase in subluxation
-and thus, both directly and indirectly, increase disease.</p>
-
-<p>Bear in mind these two all-important facts. <em>None of
-these secondary causes can operate without previous subluxation.
-A subluxation may produce disease without the
-aid of any secondary cause.</em></p>
-
-<h3 id="h_40">GERM DISEASES</h3>
-
-<p>These comprise a large portion of the febrile affections.
-Most germ diseases are characterized by fever and the
-presence of circulating toxins with resulting disturbance of
-the metabolic processes of the body.</p>
-
-<p>It is generally agreed among pathologists that the
-greater number of varieties of micro-organisms found at
-times in man are not pathogenic. Some aid in the decomposition
-of food in the alimentary canal; others have various<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_186">186</a></span>
-beneficial functions to perform. But some, under proper
-conditions, feed upon and destroy living tissue. These are
-the so-called pathogenic germs.</p>
-
-<p>The pathogenic germs are many. They enter the body by
-various routes, in the air we breathe, the food we eat, the
-water we drink; sometimes they are communicated by
-direct contact with other persons or with objects infected
-with them. The term “contagious” is applied to those diseases
-whose germs may be carried through the air from
-one to another; “infectious” refers to those communicable
-only by contact.</p>
-
-<p>In every healthy individual are found multitudes of
-germs of both the pathogenic and harmless varieties. We
-are constantly exposed to the influence of the former yet by
-no means all bodies into which pathogenic germs find entrance
-contract disease. This fact has caused much study
-and among pathologists and bacteriologists generally the
-conclusion has been reached that the development of colonies
-of micro-organisms sufficiently to produce disease depends
-upon what is known as “susceptibility” of the organism.
-There must be a latent weakness of which the micro-organisms
-take advantage.</p>
-
-<p>This amounts to the admission that the body contains
-the inherent property of successfully resisting all germ
-action. Indeed, the fundamental proposition of Serum-Therapy
-is that under stress of the presence of dilute germ
-infusions the body <em>does</em> develop special chemicals which
-neutralize the germ poisons and kill the germs and which<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_187">187</a></span>
-remain after the inoculation to guard against any further
-entrance of germs of the same kind and vulnerable to the
-same protective chemicals.</p>
-
-<p>This theory is sufficiently correct to have served as
-an unassailable basis for a most illogical procedure. The
-truth is that the auto-protective power of the body must
-be lower than normal and the germs must find a weakened
-area for development and multiplication before they can
-develop sufficiently to produce disease. Once they gain a
-foothold they tend to multiply with great rapidity and to
-develop alarming symptoms often leading to death.</p>
-
-<p>Only in a few instances does modern science believe
-that a pathogenic germ can successfully attack a healthy
-body, but is claimed that there are a few germs, such as
-the Klebs-Loeffler bacillus (diphtheria producer) and the
-bacillus of anthrax, which may find lodgment in any organism,
-healthy or unhealthy, to produce disease.</p>
-
-<p>Now, the susceptibility of the body to germ invasion requires
-explanation. Merely to say that one is susceptible
-and another is not leaves too wide a field of possibility for
-error. It is easy to reason from the fact that all persons
-are at some time exposed to contagious or infectious diseases
-while comparatively few contract them that some persons
-are vulnerable to certain diseases while others are not. It
-is plain that while a person may be susceptible to typhoid
-fever because he has a weakness in the intestines, he may be
-quite immune from pneumonia or tuberculosis or any other
-infectious or contagious disease. But why this difference?
-Let us look at the problem from another angle.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_188">188</a></span></p>
-
-<p>Chiropractors find with every contagious or infectious
-disease certain subluxations whose location with relation to
-the disease is constant and demonstrable. Thus all cases
-of pulmonary tuberculosis show a third Dorsal subluxation
-with only enough exceptions to prove the rule; tonsilitis is
-invariably accompanied by subluxation of the second, third
-or fourth Cervical. Correction of the subluxation is, in all
-except the most fully and virulently developed cases, followed
-by a radical cure. Indeed, in many of the germ
-diseases it is possible to abort the fever with improvement
-of all symptoms in from five minutes to twelve hours. We
-are so accustomed to checking germ diseases at once that
-failure to do so leads us to immediate investigation of our
-palpation and adjustment to discover some technical error
-in the application of the principles of Chiropractic to the
-case in question.</p>
-
-<p>It is manifestly impossible by vertebral adjustment to
-raise the body beyond <em>normal power</em>. Nothing is added to
-the body; no energy is utilized other than the energy of
-the body itself which is provided by Nature and released
-through restoration of the normal carrying capacity of
-nerves. The highest goal attainable is normality, and it is
-observed that no matter whether the impingement be in
-the nature of an excitation or an inhibition of nerve action
-the effect of a correct adjustment is always in that direction—toward
-normality. It may be as well to digress here
-long enough to remark that abnormal change is never the
-result of <em>adjustment</em> but always of <em>maladjustment</em>, and those<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_189">189</a></span>
-who claim to be able to produce stimulation by moving a
-given vertebra one way and inhibition by moving it another
-are entirely wrong.</p>
-
-<p>It is evident from the results of adjustment in germ
-disease that the normal body is entirely capable of throwing
-off the poisons and exterminating the germs, which conclusion
-quite agrees with science. The fact, not known by
-other branches of science, and asserted by Chiropractic is
-simply that <em>the subluxation is the factor which determines
-susceptibility</em>.</p>
-
-<p>Upon ascertaining that a certain vertebra is in normal
-alignment we may say with absolute certainty that the organs
-innervated by the nerves passing through its foramina
-are not and cannot be the site of any pernicious germ
-activities. To go further, it has been demonstrated in a
-number of cases that the subluxation existed before the contagion
-or infection developed. A man has been known
-to have a second Lumbar subluxation for many years
-without effects other than a tendency to constipation and
-on the appearance of a typhoid epidemic to contract the disease.
-Correction of the subluxation afforded a cure. Such
-instances might be cited in great numbers. No person without
-the necessary subluxation ever contracts a germ disease
-and the necessary subluxation can be exactly located for
-the vast majority of such diseases. Unfortunately it is
-impossible to find a person who has not <em>some</em> subluxations
-and is not, therefore, subject to <em>some</em> form of contagion or
-infection.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_190">190</a></span></p>
-
-<p>So far Chiropractic agrees with general knowledge of
-germ disease and its etiology, simply adding the explanation
-of susceptibility which all other modes of investigation have
-failed to afford. In one particular we find apparent disagreement.</p>
-
-<p>We have said that several bacilli are supposed to have
-power to cause disease in healthy bodies. Diphtheria is a
-disease caused by one of these. Yet Chiropractic adjustments
-have rapidly aborted diphtheria, apparently proving
-that the body has power to react strongly enough to conquer
-even this germ, providing the nerve channels be opened
-to allow of exertion of its full activity. It is probable that
-all diseases fall under the same law and that <em>no</em> germ can
-find lodgment in healthy tissue. Chiropractic affirms this as
-a truth and as yet no experience has tended to disprove it;
-the belief is strengthened by the years.</p>
-
-<p>The experiments which are said to have proven that
-certain micro-organisms can attack healthy tissue are based
-upon the supposition that careful examination demonstrated
-the absence of disease in the animals experimented upon by
-inoculation. Since these experiments and these examinations
-were made without any knowledge of vertebral subluxations,
-and consequently without discovering whether or not there
-existed latent weaknesses of various organs, we doubt the
-validity of the experiments. Our own examination of
-human and animal spines has thus far failed to discover any
-perfectly normal specimens.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_191">191</a></span></p>
-
-<p>Our clinical experience with diphtheria at least absolutely
-disproves the conclusions of Pasteur and others in regard
-to its origin.</p>
-
-<h4>Increase of Subluxations</h4>
-
-<p>It has been observed that in many instances the subluxation
-which existed previous to infection or contagion is
-greater and more noticeable during the febrile and active
-stage of the disease than before, and this fact has led some
-careless or insufficiently skilled palpaters to assume that
-the disease caused the subluxation.</p>
-
-<p>The development of germ life is accompanied by the
-excretion of toxins of greater or less virulence which
-circulate through the blood and affect the entire body. This
-poison, irritating sensor nerves, brings about motor reactions
-in the segments irritated and, since the normal operation
-of the laws of reflex action is interrupted somewhat by
-subluxation, and since the muscles immediately around a
-subluxated vertebra tend to pull upon it with unequal leverage,
-this motor reaction is likely to <em>increase</em> already existing
-malalignments, especially in the same body segment in which
-the poison is generated and in which the irritation is consequently
-greatest. Thus subluxation is most pronounced
-during the activity of the disease caused by it and reacting
-upon it and thus a disease which began as a localized
-destructive process may manifest systemic effects through
-its action upon other abnormal spinal segments.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_192">192</a></span></p>
-
-<h3 id="h_41">DIET</h3>
-
-<p>The internal chemistry of the body varies so greatly
-under changing conditions, the operation of any two different
-organisms is so hard to compare accurately, that it
-is impossible to set down any rule for diet which will apply
-properly to all patients or to all with the same disease or
-habit of body. In fact, only experiment with an individual
-can determine the exactly proper diet for him.</p>
-
-<p>Through lack of judgment or of observation of the effects
-of certain foods upon us we often eat that which our
-bodies cannot properly digest and assimilate. Sometimes
-through accident or negligence we partake of food which
-is proper in kind for us but improper in quality, perhaps
-partially decomposed. Improper food, when taken into the
-body, tends to exert a deleterious effect upon health. This
-fact should not lead us to confine ourselves to reasoning
-superficially that improper foods <em>cause disease</em> or that dietary
-measures will <em>cure</em> disease.</p>
-
-<p>Some Chiropractors have held that the hunger of individuals
-for certain foods is a safe guide to a proper diet.
-This is manifestly untrue in some cases; the voracious appetite
-of the convalescent typhoid patient is an example.
-But it would probably be true <em>if all men were normal</em>. Close
-observation of a few exceptionally well-developed and normal
-individuals has disclosed an interesting fact. If a man
-has no subluxation in that portion of the spine which controls
-the stomach, the ingestion of decomposing food, even<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_193">193</a></span>
-though the alteration be so slight as to escape notice on
-casual examination, induces immediate vomiting followed
-by no untoward consequences. Only occasionally does one
-find persons without subluxations in some way affecting the
-stomach; in such cases the body promptly rejects and expels
-injurious material.</p>
-
-<p>This carries us to the rather surprising conclusion that
-<em>the normal person is not susceptible to the influence of bad
-food</em>. In the majority of individuals, some degree of abnormality
-existing, improper food has a decidedly bad effect.
-Passing through the alimentary canal it is improperly
-digested; toxins are developed; these chemically affect the
-entire body, perhaps leading only to a congestion and inflammation
-of some part of the lining of the alimentary
-tract, perhaps producing a general fever, malaise, diarrhea,
-and the other effects of a general poisoning.</p>
-
-<p>It has been found that proper adjustment is followed by
-quick relief in such cases, the commonest effect being the
-rapid expulsion of the deleterious matter by vomiting and
-diarrhea with breaking of the fever and lessening of all
-symptoms.</p>
-
-<p>It has also been observed that during the suffering from
-dietetic error the subluxation controlling the stomach or
-some part of the small intestines is often found increased in
-degree with tension of the adjacent muscles. With adjustment
-and relief of the other symptoms the muscular tension
-tends to disappear. This motor reaction from the irritation
-of food poison undoubtedly serves to <em>increase</em> subluxation<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_194">194</a></span>
-already existing, thus intensifying effects. But for its primary
-effect food poison requires a previous subluxation
-lowering the natural protective power of the body. Food
-poisoning is often a secondary cause of disease.</p>
-
-<p>When it is found in any specific case that certain foods
-exert a bad influence upon the progress of the case, that the
-symptoms are aggravated by the taking of these foods, they
-must be abandoned. Yet no rigid diet need be prescribed
-in any case. Every patient will require a different diet, nor
-is it possible to understand the intimate chemical relations
-within the body sufficiently to fix a proper diet except by
-experiment.</p>
-
-<p>A word here about fasting. If improper food were a
-primary cause of disease, fasting would be an effective,
-though somewhat radical, removal of the cause of disease
-and a logical procedure. Since improper food is <em>not</em> a primary
-cause of disease and since nature requires food for
-the repair work made possible through adjustments, it would
-seem unwise for Chiropractors to prescribe fasting. Also it
-is well to remember that fasting and starvation are synonymous
-and their symptoms identical.</p>
-
-<h3 id="h_42">POISONS</h3>
-
-<p>Any substance taken into the body and not usable as
-food may be considered poison. Most drugs administered
-as medicine or used habitually are either directly poisonous
-and commonly so considered or are poisonous in the sense
-that they do not build but rather tend to injure the body. Injurious<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_195">195</a></span>
-substances accidentally taken into the body; certain
-products included in the preparation of otherwise nutritious
-foods, alcohol, tobacco, etc., affect the body in varying
-degrees but in accordance with the same laws. Poisons may
-be internally generated through the action of pathogenic
-germs or through the failure of the body to digest food and
-to prevent injurious chemical changes in it. It has even
-been said by some that abnormal mental states so affect
-metabolism as to cause the formation of certain auto-toxins
-which injuriously affect the entire body.</p>
-
-<p>However poison may make its appearance in the body
-its presence is associated with certain bad effects. Poison
-may be corrosive, destroying tissue wherever it touches; it
-may be stimulating, affecting the nerves so as to increase
-their activity, following which waste of energy there is a
-weakening reaction; it may be narcotic, lowering some
-physiologic process below normal.</p>
-
-<p>If a man without subluxation—and therefore normal—have
-poison introduced into his body one of two effects will
-follow. Either the poison will be sufficient to produce death
-in a short time, and will do so, or the poison will be ejected
-from the body and the patient recover naturally and without
-treatment, and recover fully.</p>
-
-<p>This is the statement of the ideal, not the real. The
-fact is that no person has yet been found without subluxation
-in some part of the spinal column. Occasional cases
-have been reported but always by Chiropractors whose statements
-are open to question on account of imperfect training<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_196">196</a></span>
-in vertebral palpation or a known habit of unconsidered
-statement. And in the weakened body, whose natural protective
-power has been lowered, the effect is different.</p>
-
-<p>The body fails to throw off all the poison normally and
-some of it remains in the circulation and tends to cause progressively
-increasing damage. In addition to the direct
-effect of the poison upon the tissues, the irritation of sensory
-nerves gives rise to a motor reaction which increases subluxation
-generally throughout the spine but especially in
-the segment in which the sensory irritation is greatest. If
-the poison be taken into the stomach the vertebrae affecting
-that organ are most affected in the resulting motor disturbances.
-When vaccine virus is introduced into the arm
-the greatest influence is upon the last two Cervicals and
-first Dorsal, causing increased weakening of the nerves to
-the arm. If the vaccination does not “take” it is because
-the body is so normal as to be able to take up and rapidly
-excrete the poison or to neutralize it with an internally
-generated antitoxin.</p>
-
-<p>This tendency of poisons to increase subluxations already
-existing has caused many to conclude that <em>new</em> subluxations
-could be produced by the motor reactions from
-poison. The laws governing reflex action make this impossible.
-If a mild stimulus be applied in the segment occupied
-by a given, and normally aligned, vertebra, the resulting
-contraction will tend to appear on the same side as the
-irritation and would—if sufficient to subluxate the vertebra—draw
-it <em>toward</em> the irritated side. If a stronger stimulus<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_197">197</a></span>
-were applied the resulting reaction would appear on <em>both</em>
-sides and with sufficient intensity on the opposite side to the
-irritation so that the difference between the contractions on
-the two sides would never be sufficient to overcome the
-fixity and inertia of the vertebra. If this bit of theorizing
-be doubted, let me add that if poisons <em>could</em> cause subluxation
-they would undoubtedly cause drawing of the vertebra
-<em>toward</em> the irritated side—which is not the way we find
-them in poisoning cases. Almost without variation, the
-subluxation is <em>away from</em> the affected side. Such a subluxation
-produces most impingement on the side of the irritation;
-the only kind which could follow poisons would produce its
-effects on the opposite side.</p>
-
-<p>In acute poisoning cases which may possibly proceed to
-a rapidly fatal termination, while immediate adjustment
-may be sufficient to cause the expulsion of the poison and
-the recovery of the patient it is probably wisest to administer
-an antidote or to call a physician with a stomach pump.
-Just so, the pulmotor should be summoned for gas asphyxiation;
-but at least one case was recently encountered in which
-an adjustment started the heart and artificial respiration
-movements restored consciousness before the pulmotor could
-arrive. There are few, if any, acute poisoning cases in
-which an adjustment will not aid. Sometimes it should be
-assisted by other measures not strictly within the province
-of Chiropractic.</p>
-
-<p>Chronic poisoning, such as lead poisoning from paint
-work, yields well to adjustments providing the secondary<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_198">198</a></span>
-cause, the persistent inhalation of lead fumes, be discontinued.</p>
-
-<p>Poisons may wound or injure the body whether or not
-it be normal; in such case they might properly be classed
-with trauma. But no poison causes disease except through
-the medium of vertebral subluxation previously produced.
-Some subluxation which has never been sufficient to produce
-active disease may be so increased by the action of
-poisons as to be of serious effect even though the poison
-has long since been eradicated from the body—for the subluxation
-is permanent until affected by force outside itself.
-In considering the etiology of any disease the possibility of
-its being augmented by medicines, drug habits, or dietetic
-errors should be weighed with other evidence.</p>
-
-<h3 id="h_43">EXPOSURE</h3>
-
-<p>By this term is especially meant exposure to sudden temperature
-changes. The body may sustain a very high or a
-very low outside temperature providing the change is gradual
-enough so that the heat-regulating mechanism may
-adapt itself properly to protect the body and maintain an
-even temperature within. A sudden change from a very
-warm room to a very cold atmosphere; a quick transportation
-from cold air to a superheated apartment; or a sudden
-draft of air whose temperature is sharply at variance with
-surrounding air and therefore with the condition of the
-body surface may have a very bad effect.</p>
-
-<p>The skin and mucous membranes of the body have become<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_199">199</a></span>
-accustomed to a certain temperature; the change irritates
-them. And the immediate result is a motor reaction
-increasing subluxation in the same body segment in which
-the irritation is greatest and probably producing first an
-irritation of the nerves at the spine and then an inflammation
-of the exposed surface. Thus a “cold” is produced. One
-who has no subluxation affecting the respiratory tract—a
-rare degree of normality—may escape coryza, bronchitis,
-or pneumonia, the most common effects, but may suffer a
-congestion of the stomach walls or of other parts of the body.
-It is said that the cold “settled on the stomach.” The fact
-is that the motor reaction takes advantage of the weak parts
-of the spine and affects them most, like the pernicious habit
-of spine-stretching which used to prevail among Chiropractors.
-This explains why “cold in the head” is so very
-frequent. The fourth Cervical vertebra is situated at the
-middle point of the neck and is very freely movable and
-easily subluxated and, in fact, more often displaced than
-other Cervicals.</p>
-
-<p>Noxious or poisonous vapors may have an effect identical
-with that of sudden temperature change. Sleeping in an
-improperly ventilated room often appears to cause “cold.”
-Careful study of the part of the body exposed to draft, and
-of spino-organic connection, will show that in most instances
-the effect of such exposure is first felt in the same body
-segment.</p>
-
-<p>It is a well-known fact that not all people are “subject
-to colds.” One may be “subject to lung colds,” another to<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_200">200</a></span>
-“cold in the head.” The susceptibility is entirely governed
-by the condition of the spine, the person having no middle
-Cervical subluxation being immune from coryza even though
-subjected to the same exposure which will produce it in
-others. The pollen of plants produces hay fever in the
-susceptible in much the same manner that draft produces
-coryza, both acting as secondary causes.</p>
-
-<h3 id="h_44">BODILY EXCESSES</h3>
-
-<p>In this division of secondary causes may be mentioned
-overwork, continuous loss of sleep, overeating, venereal
-excesses, etc.</p>
-
-<p>They act in this manner. Wasting and overusing the
-bodily resources they lower the general vitality. Now,
-though there be subluxations at various points in the spine
-there is still transmitted through each impinged nerve a
-certain amount of Vital Force which to a certain extent
-maintains the functions of the body and keeps it in a state of
-activity sufficient for ordinary demands. When the entire
-stock of vitality is lowered through excess the amount of
-energy passing through each nerve in the body is lessened,
-but the effect of such lessening is felt most where there is
-subluxation. At the high tide of vitality the subluxations
-are not sufficient, perhaps, to produce serious disease. At
-low ebb, every organ whose nerve is interfered with suffers
-keenly. Under such conditions the body is much more subject
-to adverse influences, to shocks and jars, to contagion
-or infection, to the action of cold or exposure. Thus
-bodily excess acts as a secondary cause of disease.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_201">201</a></span></p>
-
-<h3>ABNORMAL MENTAL STATES</h3>
-
-<p>There are many who believe that fear, worry, hate, grief,
-etc., are in themselves sufficient to produce disease in a
-normal organism. Shock following the demise of a loved
-one or some deep disgrace is occasionally alleged as a cause
-of death or of a rapid decline in health which terminates
-fatally.</p>
-
-<p>The failure of Suggestive Therapeutics to cure disease
-except when it is largely imaginary rather argues against
-this theory. It is also true that proper Chiropractic adjustments
-not only lead to the cure of disease apparently
-caused by abnormal mental states but also, restoring proper
-blood-supply and nutrition to the brain, induce a happier
-mental state in the patient. Even insanity has been cured in
-a number of cases by Chiropractic.</p>
-
-<p>We hold that worry, fear, etc., are abnormal; that they
-arise from the improper expression of Mind through disordered
-brain-cells. “Diseases of the Mind,” in the strictest
-sense, cannot occur, but only diseases of the physical medium
-through which mind is expressed and translated to the
-physical plane of being—the brain.</p>
-
-<p>A condition of abnormal mental expression or activity,
-especially worry, fear or anger, probably has a two-fold
-effect: it rapidly wastes the body energy and, like bodily excess,
-renders every subluxation more effective; it is possible
-that it may also really produce auto-toxins, generated by
-abnormal brain-action and affecting the body metabolism<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_202">202</a></span>
-adversely. In this way disease appears through the action
-of abnormal mental states as secondary causes.</p>
-
-<p>They themselves are the result of subluxation of the
-first or second, sometimes third, Cervical, impinging the
-nerves which control the blood-supply to the brain and
-hence its nutrition. Correction of the subluxation causes
-them to disappear.</p>
-
-<h3 id="h_45">INFLAMMATION</h3>
-
-<p>Inflammation is a morbid process characterized by the
-presence of increased temperature and one or more of the
-symptoms, pain, redness, and swelling. It is distinguished
-from fever by being confined locally, while fever is a general
-functional disturbance showing elevation of temperature,
-increased katabolism, decreased secretion, etc.</p>
-
-<p>Our clinical experience with fevers leads us to accept
-Metchnikoff’s conclusion that the essential phenomenon of
-inflammation is hyperaemia. Upon the hyperaemia depend
-the swelling, pain, and local increase in heat-production.
-Hyperaemia in turn depends upon disturbance of the vasomotor
-nerves either as a direct result of some local subluxation
-or as an indirect consequence of local irritation.</p>
-
-<p>A newly acquired subluxation produces an acute irritation
-of the pre-ganglionic axons which connect the spinal
-nerves with the sympathetic ganglia. If these ganglia send
-out post-ganglionic axons which are vaso-motor in function,
-an inflammation may be produced without the intervention
-of any secondary cause. On the other hand, there may be a<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_203">203</a></span>
-subluxation producing weakness of some part; through injury
-to that part or the introduction of poisons or irritants
-such as germ infection, sensory end-organs are affected and
-the motor reaction which follows increases the subluxation;
-this slight increase produces acute irritation of the nerve
-and hyperaemia, with its resultant phenomena, follows.
-Stated briefly, irritants produce inflammation only by acting
-through the medium of the spine. If the spine be normal
-these irritants are insufficient to produce morbid process.
-Local inflammation tends to develop toxins, especially if it
-be of bacterial origin, which may in turn affect the entire
-organism—an effect which will be discussed presently. Exception
-must be made in those traumatic cases in which
-hyperaemia is essential to the reparatory process, and which
-are attended by what may be termed a normally increased
-heat-production. This beneficent and reparatory condition
-cannot be termed disease or morbid process.</p>
-
-<p>The normal temperature of the body depends upon the
-balance maintained between heat-production and heat-expenditure.
-This balance is maintained through a complicated
-nerve mechanism consisting of various nidi in
-thalamus, medulla, spinal cord and sympathetic ganglia, and
-a network of communicating axons of both the cerebro-spinal
-and sympathetic systems, controlling the amount of
-blood passing through any given body area at a given time,
-the secretion of the perspiratory glands, the internal metabolic
-processes, etc. Most important are the vaso-motor
-nerves, directly, but not originally, derived from the sympathetic,<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_204">204</a></span>
-and governing the size and caliber of all blood-vessels
-so as to control the amount of blood flowing to and
-through the surface capillaries on the one hand, or the deep-seated,
-heat-making organs on the other. More than seventy
-per cent of the body’s heat expenditure is through the skin
-by evaporation, radiation, and direct conduction. The major
-portion of the heat production is in the muscles and the
-parenchymatous viscera, such as liver, spleen, etc., where
-metabolism is active.</p>
-
-<p>This mechanism is so delicately adjusted that when the
-outside temperature is lowered the amount of blood passing
-to the skin is reflexly lessened while internal heat production
-is increased and the bodily temperature retained at normal.
-Conversely, the body perspires freely and the surface
-is flushed with blood in a high temperature, so that heat
-production is lessened and its discharge accelerated, again
-tending to maintain an even and normal temperature.</p>
-
-<p>The nervous mechanism is responsive to many and various
-forms of stimuli—thermic, emotional, mechanical, physiologic
-need, toxic. Poisons in circulation may affect the
-bulbar center and produce general fever. A number of centers
-in the spinal gray may be stimulated with like result.
-Or there may be purely local irritation which results in
-local hyperaemia and inflammation.</p>
-
-<p>It will always be found that the primary cause of any
-permanent derangement of the mechanism lies in vertebral
-subluxation impinging some of the nerves and thus throwing
-the mechanism out of its natural balance and poise. Other<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_205">205</a></span>
-forms of disturbance are transient and the very nature of
-the mechanism makes it normally capable of adjusting itself
-to thermic, mechanic, or emotional stimuli in a short time.
-Only the subluxation produces permanent elevation of temperature.
-When such elevation does occur there are many
-associated changes, increased katabolism, lessening of secretions,
-anorexia, sometimes mental changes, such as delirium
-or coma. Fevers vary according to the part of the nerve
-mechanism affected and the action of any secondary causes.</p>
-
-<p>Fever due to vertebral subluxation alone without any
-secondary cause operating is very rare. Ordinarily fevers
-come about in this way. A subluxation occurs which weakens
-tissue and permits germ invasion; toxins enter the circulation
-from the germ action and motor reaction increases the
-original subluxation and causes local inflammation; germ
-activity is favored by the increasing degree of abnormality
-and toxins from rapid tissue destruction are added to those
-already present. The poison-loaded blood then affects the
-general centers for heat regulation, blood becomes internally
-engorged, and a chill (internal fever) followed by general
-increase of temperature occurs. At this juncture any subluxation
-previously existing is likely to be increased and to
-add its quota of harm to the rapidly developing picture.</p>
-
-<p>Our problem is to find the original subluxation which
-controls the site of the original pathologic change and to
-correct that. In nearly all cases where this is done, even
-partially, the body is enabled to care for the remainder of
-the damage and to throw off the accumulated toxins. It is<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_206">206</a></span>
-not uncommon that the temperature falls two degrees in
-five or ten minutes after a proper adjustment. We expect
-always to abort or check a fever in twenty-four hours or
-less.</p>
-
-<p>There are cases in which the temperature drops after
-adjustment but presently rises again. This indicates the
-virulence of the autointoxication or that some other area of
-poison production is operating than the one our first adjustment
-would control. A correct diagnosis will enable one to
-give specific adjustment and check practically any fever
-except a chronic one with much tissue destruction already
-accomplished; even some of these yield.</p>
-
-<p>The commonest cause of fever is at the fifth or sixth
-Dorsal vertebra, long known as Center Place, or Fever
-Center. Here emerge many pre-ganglionic fibres which distribute
-their impulses through lower neurons in the sympathetic
-system to the coeliac plexus and thence to the blood-vessels
-supplying the major portion of the abdominal viscera.
-Adjustment here causes a sudden contraction of these abdominal
-vessels and a forcing of the blood to the surface
-with rapid cooling.</p>
-
-<p>Often, however, this adjustment is followed by a recrudescence
-which indicates that some other vertebra must
-be adjusted. Many fevers, such as typhoid, pneumonia,
-tonsilitis, etc., yield to specific local adjustment without any
-involvement of the so-called Center Place.</p>
-
-<p>I have said that we expect to check or abort a fever with
-spinal adjustments. The facts that we do so and that the<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_207">207</a></span>
-more rapidly we accomplish the result the more rapid the
-convalescence and the less likely are complications and
-sequelae argue loudly against the correctness of any theory
-which supposes fever to be a beneficial and cleansing process.
-According to such theory it would be totally wrong
-and dangerous to abort a fever but wiser to encourage it in
-taking its course. The exact opposite proves true under
-Chiropractic. The very fact that fevers <em>do</em> diminish and
-disappear under proper adjustments is a proof that they are
-abnormal, since adjustment does not in any case tend to
-lessen normal processes, but only to restore normality no
-matter in what way the functions of the body have departed
-from that condition.</p>
-
-<p>All the clinical evidence gathered by Chiropractors in
-regard to inflammations and fevers tends to prove the correctness
-of the theories herein set down. Fever plays a
-part in so many diseases that it has been considered advisable
-to consider the subject under a special head.</p>
-
-<h3>IN CONCLUSION</h3>
-
-<p>The vertebral subluxation is the primary cause of all
-truly pathological conditions. Through its existence the
-action of a large number of secondary causes becomes possible.
-Upon no other hypothesis can we explain the remarkable
-percentage of cures of all known classes of disease
-through the specific vertebral adjustment.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_208">208</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<h3 id="h_46">THE PROCESS OF CURE</h3>
-</div>
-
-<p>Nature is the only real <em>curative</em> agent. Neither suggestion,
-manipulation, adjustment, nor any other known
-method applied by Man for the eradication of disease has in
-itself any power to heal. No man possesses power to do
-more than so arouse the vital energies of the patient that the
-body heals itself.</p>
-
-<p>We contain within our own bodies the possibilities of perfect
-normality. Unless interfered with by powerful outside
-force we should continue normal from birth to death
-and death itself would only occur through the simultaneous
-wearing out of all the parts of the human mechanism. The
-Chiropractor, insofar as his work succeeds in its purpose,
-assists the body by adjusting displaced structure and affording
-the body a free and unhindered opportunity for the
-exercise of its own self-healing powers. It may be interesting
-and instructive to analyze the process of cure and to study
-the exact effects of vertebral adjustment as we have studied
-the exact effects of vertebral subluxation.</p>
-
-<h4>Cure of Simple Subluxation Disease</h4>
-
-<p>An acute subluxation—that is, one resulting entirely
-from concussion of forces within twenty-four or forty-eight
-hours prior to the moment of adjustment—rarely produces
-a condition which could be named as any particular disease.<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_209">209</a></span>
-The symptoms are those of “wrenched back,” if any. A
-single adjustment usually suffices to correct such subluxation
-just as a single movement might correct a dislocated humerus
-within the same period, and any symptoms promptly
-disappear. This is probably the maximum benefit to be
-derived from adjustment and the best time for its administration,
-because it leaves the spinal column in an exactly
-normal condition and no more susceptible to further jars or
-shocks than before the injury. All disease which might
-have resulted from that subluxation has been fully prevented.</p>
-
-<p>Older subluxations must be dealt with differently because
-they present a different condition. Adaptative changes
-have taken place in the shape of the vertebra itself and of
-every surrounding tissue as they prepare to make the best
-of their situation. But a vertebra once displaced has lost
-its poise and broken or modified the reflex arcs through its
-nerves so that it becomes more likely to respond to further
-forces applied, or to muscular contractions within the body,
-by further change of position. Such changes are always followed
-by further adaptation of the surrounding parts.</p>
-
-<p>The degree of nerve impingement must change to keep
-pace with the developing malposition and thus, by gradually
-successive steps, disease develops in the area of peripheral
-distribution of the nerves. The nerve is under a thumbscrew
-gradually tightening.</p>
-
-<p>To adjust such a vertebra many successive movements
-are required. An apparently full and free movement of a
-subluxation meets the elastic resistance of the solidly packed<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_210">210</a></span>
-tissues and the pull of the modified intervertebral disk—strains
-at these tissues—and rebounds so as to settle almost,
-but not quite, in its old abnormal position. The amount
-gained in a single adjustment can rarely be appreciated by
-palpation. To the touch it would appear that no change had
-been made, except occasionally in the Cervical region. But
-with repeated adjustments the vertebra will be found to
-have approached its normal position. Sometimes in a few
-weeks, sometimes in a few months, the gain becomes palpable
-and then perhaps visible to the eye in thin subjects.</p>
-
-<p>The relief of impingement then is not usually an instantaneous
-process, but proceeds by gradual steps. Each
-movement of the vertebra is accompanied by a shock to the
-nerve against some part of which the bone is pressing, which
-may produce some disturbance in the diseased organs and
-may even appear to have aggravated disease for a time.
-Some pain and soreness around the vertebra may accompany
-the necessary adaptative changes of shape which readapt
-the tissues to their proper shape and relation.</p>
-
-<p>As the impingement of the nerve is gradually relieved
-the disease is gradually modified and finally disappears.
-As the course of adjustments nears its conclusion and the
-impingement has been reduced to a comparatively slight one
-there may appear a stage of irritation of the nerve which
-is a reduplication of the first steps which appeared in the
-development of the disease. As most subluxations appear
-not all at once but by a series of changes, so disease develops
-synchronously, passing from stage to stage with the changes<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_211">211</a></span>
-in the impingement. Often it passes through first an acute
-and active stage due to irritation and then a chronic and
-comparatively passive stage due to heavier, inhibiting impingement.</p>
-
-<p>Under adjustment these successive stages tend to reappear
-in reverse order, the most alarming sometimes appearing
-last and just before the cure is completed. It must
-be remembered that from the moment one practitioner administers
-medicine or other remedy and the other adjusts a
-vertebra, the clinical courses differ widely. No text-book
-on medical practice has as yet described the clinical course
-of the various diseases under Chiropractic adjustment.</p>
-
-<p>In chronic diseases where the nerves are paralyzed there
-may be a period under adjustment during which no change
-is apparent. This is followed by a period of rapid gain
-leading to complete recovery. This may be accounted for by
-the fact that the nerves are degenerated and must be repaired
-all along their course before communication is reestablished
-between nerve centers and peripheral organs.
-When this repair is sufficiently completed to allow communication,
-the cure is really well advanced, although evidence
-of it then first appears. This has been noted especially in
-locomotor ataxia.</p>
-
-<h4>Cure of a Germ Disease</h4>
-
-<p>First, under adjustment, the acute or acutely increased
-impingement is relieved. The caliber of the blood-vessels
-is at once regulated and the destructive action of fever<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_212">212</a></span>
-checked. At the same time the vitality of the local tissue
-in which the germs are active is suddenly increased and
-there ensues a struggle between the body, as represented by
-its phagocytes and auto-protective chemicals, and the germs,
-which if adjustments be continued results in the rapid destruction
-of the germ colony. Also the elimination of the
-toxins already in the body proceeds so rapidly that if the
-fever can be held in check it takes only a short time for the
-body completely to overcome and eradicate the germs.</p>
-
-<h4>Cure of Mental Disease</h4>
-
-<p>Mental diseases—so-called—usually depend upon disturbance
-of the blood-supply to the brain, controlled by the
-Cervical sympathetic. Adjustments, relieving the pressure
-on the sympathetic ganglia or cord and perhaps the direct
-impingement from the vertebral arteries, restore a normal
-circulation to the brain. The time required by Nature to
-effect a cure depends upon the rapidity with which the impingement
-is removed and the amount and character of the
-damage to brain tissue which must be repaired. The cure
-often requires time for a change of materials in brain cells
-or fibre tracts, by which they are reconstructed and again
-become capable of expressing normal function.</p>
-
-<h4>Cure of Dietetic Disease</h4>
-
-<p>When the subluxation is corrected, or partially so, the
-appetite changes and the craving for food becomes more
-normal. Adjustments may lessen a voracious appetite, increase<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_213">213</a></span>
-a too capricious one, or abolish a perverted. At the
-same time the stomach is enabled to digest its contents more
-properly, the intestines to take it up and continue it, and
-the tissues to assimilate that which is brought to them. The
-body eliminates its waste with less effort and in some extreme
-cases the first effect of the adjustment may be to
-cause vomiting and diarrhea and thus purge the alimentary
-tract of materials which have become unusable.</p>
-
-<p>If injurious diet be persisted in the effects of the adjustments
-will be partly counteracted, the tendency of the
-poisons generated within the body being to increase subluxation
-while the tendency of the adjustments is to correct
-them.</p>
-
-<h4>Cure of Poisoning Cases</h4>
-
-<p>In acute poisoning by way of the alimentary canal and
-sometimes when poison has been injected hypodermically,
-the body rids itself of the menace to its integrity by means
-of vomiting, diarrhea, and increased secretion of urine.
-Chronic cases tend rather toward the gradual absorption and
-removal from the body of the poisons and their cure depends
-upon the cessation of the poisoning; i. e., it is useless to try
-to cure a morphine case while the patient is still using the
-drug.</p>
-
-<p>In acute poisoning the muscular contraction often increases
-subluxation and counteracts the effect of the adjustments,
-so that it becomes necessary to give very frequent
-adjustments until relief is had.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_214">214</a></span></p>
-
-<h4>Cure of Exposure Disease</h4>
-
-<p>After the acute irritation of nerves arising from the
-exposure and causing irritation has been removed, perhaps
-by the first adjustment, if the exposure is not repeated the
-body heals itself with great rapidity, repairing with comparative
-ease the damage done.</p>
-
-<h4>Cure of Bodily Excess Disease</h4>
-
-<p>This depends upon the nature of the excess. If it be
-overeating, perhaps a more moderate diet will of itself and
-without adjustments enable the body to rid itself of the bad
-effects and restore general equilibrium. Adjustments will
-aid and accelerate this process. Venereal excess is most
-often engendered by an improper state of mind, perhaps
-demanding attention as a mental disorder, or by an irritation
-of the genital organs which demands local adjustment for
-its relief. Normality of the reproductive tract leads to
-sane forgetfulness and libidinous habits always suggest
-sexual weakness or disease. Often where a cure would be
-possible with right habits, no cure can be effected without
-their correction. A little good sound advice which will
-arouse the will of the patient to co-operation may aid. Boys
-with the masturbation habit offer small chance for favorable
-results in enuresis or nervous disorders unless the secondary
-cause be understood and overcome.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_215">215</a></span></p>
-
-<h3 id="h_47">ADJUNCTS</h3>
-
-<p>In this connection the author cannot forbear a reference
-to the use of other methods to relieve disease in combination
-with the Chiropractic adjustment. From the foregoing
-study of the laws governing the cause and cure of disease
-it will be seen that therapeutical methods have little direct
-bearing upon the removal of disease. The logical method
-of effecting the cure is the removal of the cause. The subluxation
-being always the primary cause, its correction is
-always the logical method of effecting a cure. Not sometimes
-but <em>always</em>.</p>
-
-<p>We know that when the subluxation is corrected the
-body naturally heals itself. Can we accelerate and aid that
-healing with stimulant or narcotic? Logic says no; experience
-says no: the use of any method which strikes at the
-disease beyond its primary cause and operates upon some of
-the effects of that cause without touching the cause itself is
-inconsistent with belief in Chiropractic.</p>
-
-<p>Administration of poisonous drugs to the well body is
-considered poisoning; their administration to the sick body
-is also poisoning, whose symptoms combine with the disease
-to produce different outward signs. Fasting is starvation.
-Massage is stimulation or inhibition. Spondylotherapy
-means exhaustion of the spinal nerve centers in riotous
-expenditure of their stored-up energy.</p>
-
-<p>It would require a wisdom beyond the human to improve
-upon the natural healing processes with which the<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_216">216</a></span>
-body has been provided. It should be our entire business
-to remove the obstructions which hinder the full exercise of
-that healing power—the subluxations—to remove them
-dexterously and decisively and to interfere in no other way.</p>
-
-<p>Other methods may and do serve to scatter or modify
-disease but not to cure it—unless they affect subluxations, as
-they sometimes do without intent. This accidental adjustment
-factor is valueless in the presence of a scientific and
-intelligent adjustment.</p>
-
-<p>Let Medicine, Osteopathy, Spondylotherapy, Christian
-Science, Massage, and Electricity have their field. It is not
-ours. Nor can any of these methods be rationally combined
-with Chiropractic. Their basic principles contradict ours;
-their application interferes with the results of adjustment.
-If you claim to remove the cause of disease, <em>do so</em>, and do
-not mar your work by treatment of effects.</p>
-
-<hr />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_217">217</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<h2 id="h_48"><a id="SPINO-ORGANIC_CONNECTION"></a>SPINO-ORGANIC CONNECTION</h2>
-</div>
-
-<p id="h_49">It has been said in a previous section that when subluxation
-and disease are associated the subluxation always
-precedes the disease and that the former is the cause, the
-latter the effect. So clearly do we understand this law that
-we are able to say <em>what</em> subluxation would cause a certain
-disease and err by only so many cases per centum as there
-are variations from the usual structure of the spinal column
-and the nervous system.</p>
-
-<p>But merely to state that a second Dorsal subluxation
-causes heart disease is not enough. We must know why and
-how it causes heart disease and whether, perchance, some
-other subluxation may sometimes have a like effect. We
-must map out the sphere of malign influence of each possible
-subluxation so that when our fingers encounter it it at
-once and inevitably suggests its possible effects, from which,
-by diagnostic methods, we may choose the one toward
-which most symptoms point. And we must know the
-relation of every nerve in the body to peripheral organs and
-their functions so that when we encounter indubitable evidence
-of some functional or organic disease we may know
-exactly where, in the spinal column, to seek for its cause.</p>
-
-<p>We have learned how to discover a subluxation, how to
-adjust it, and how that adjustment permits a natural cure of
-its abnormal effects. We must now learn exactly <em>where</em> to<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_218">218</a></span>
-apply adjustment for any given organ in the body or for
-any disease. It must be understood in interpreting this
-statement and all those which follow in this section that it
-is never proper to adjust a vertebra merely because it is
-stated to be the cause of a disease believed to exist in a
-patient. No vertebra should be moved unless palpation determines
-it to be subluxated. Rather let it be known that
-<em>as a rule</em> the statements of spino-organic connection here
-made will prove to be verifiable by palpation. There is no
-rule in Chiropractic without some exceptions, and mere
-diagnosis of disease is too notoriously unreliable to serve as
-a guide to adjustment without the verification of the trained
-touch.</p>
-
-<h4>The Field of Study</h4>
-
-<p>We wish to know the relation existing between each
-part of the Nerve System and other parts and between each
-part and the other organs of the body. Especially we wish
-to understand the relation between each part of the Nerve
-System and the spinal column, by which permanent subluxations
-of the latter interfere with the former’s action and
-therefore with the peripheral organs.</p>
-
-<p>This requires a general knowledge of anatomy, physiology,
-and pathology which we shall presuppose the reader
-to possesses so that we may present only facts to which his
-attention should be particularly called. Let us begin with
-the relation of nerve tissue to other tissues where this relation
-can be most clearly comprehended, namely, with the
-development of the human embryo.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_219">219</a></span></p>
-
-<h4>Segmentation</h4>
-
-<p>The complete human organism represents the snarled
-fusion of a series of similar, yet specialized, somatic segments,
-each presenting most of the attributes of a simple
-animal, though the association and co-ordination of all are
-required for the production of higher animal phenomena.</p>
-
-<p>The embryo is composed of such segments placed with
-their centers in the same axial line. Each segment contains
-in association which is morphologic, physiologic, and anatomical,
-a segment of nerve matter and a somatic (body)
-segment. The neural segments are arranged end to end so
-as to form the rudimentary beginning of the complete central
-nerve axis of the adult human body; the somatic segments
-blend together with somewhat indefinite lines of
-cleavage which are to become much more indefinite and
-obscure by changes in relative form due to differences in the
-growth rate of different parts or to involuntionary changes
-following functional inutility at various periods. Gray says,
-“The intrinsically segmental nature of the spinal cord is
-expressed by the association of each definite segment with
-the somatic segment supplied by its nerve.”</p>
-
-<p>Within each segment there may be observed at an early
-period cell migrations from the walls of the primitive neural
-tube and amoeboid projection of axonic and dendritic processes
-from these cells, which serve to bring the other
-tissues of the segment under the control of the nerve elements;
-there is an assumption of command, as it were, by<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_220">220</a></span>
-the nervous system, so that the epithelial, connective, and
-muscular tissues of each segment are linked in sensomotor
-and vegetative co-ordination by the contact association of
-the nerves which ramify them—sensomotor because the
-nerves are presently to carry the only force capable of inciting
-activity of any kind in other tissues, vegetative because
-the functions of growth, nutrition, and repair, in each
-somatic cell, depend upon the continuity of communication
-between it and the lowest nerve cell in the nerve pathway
-which connects it with the higher motor and sensor centers.</p>
-
-<h4>Development of the Nerve System</h4>
-
-<p>Already may be noted a hint and a prophecy of that
-future segmental organization by which it becomes possible
-for some spinal vertebra to become displaced and thus begin
-a morbid process which may diffuse itself throughout an entire
-body segment, involving neural and somatic elements
-together. Already the simple organization begins to become
-rapidly complex and difficult to trace.</p>
-
-<p>Cell masses begin to migrate from the walls of the primitive
-neural tube to a position laterad to become the spinal
-ganglia; these send out long dendritic processes which marvellously
-thread their way to a predetermined peripheral
-connection which is to bring some cutaneous, or muscular,
-or joint tissue into sensor relation with the dorsal, or Sensor,
-portion of the cord and through it with the brain; at the
-same time they send their axonic processes inward to mingle
-with and communicate with the dendrites of other sensor<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_221">221</a></span>
-cells remaining in the central axis to form the gray matter
-of the cord, and thus, migrating, keep up communication
-both with the central axis and the periphery. Other cell
-masses migrate ventrolaterad to form the sympathetic
-ganglia and they also send out afferent and efferent processes
-which make a connection on the one hand with the
-periphery and on the other with the source from which the
-cells developed, the situation to be occupied by the cord.
-From this view it is seen that the sympathetic system is
-merely an offshoot from the same source with all the rest of
-the peripheral nerve system, merely a mechanism for the
-proper distribution of nerve impulses from the central organs,
-and that it retains its connection in all its parts with those
-organs. Its ganglia, like those of the cord, are always and
-from the beginning under the domination of the upper or
-cephalic end of the neural tube.</p>
-
-<p>This cephalic end rapidly expands. Its growth is faster
-than the rest of the neural tube and from its walls, by proliferation,
-develop the structures of the cerebrum, mid-brain,
-and hind-brain. It also gives off ganglionic masses from
-which grow sensor processes to form the afferent elements
-of the cranial nerves and contains, like the cord, motor
-nuclei, or nidi, from which motor axons grow toward the
-periphery to come into relation with definitely predetermined
-organs.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_222">222</a></span></p>
-
-<h4>The Spinal Column and Cranium</h4>
-
-<p>Now appear the primitive cartilaginous and membranous
-elements from which a bony wall is to be built around the
-central nerve axis, primitive vertebrae, the upper known as
-cranial and numbering four, and the lower, or spinal, numbering
-usually thirty-three. These bone structures develop
-around the brain and spinal cord. Later the cephalic vertebrae
-fuse into a solid vault, the cranium, completely enclosed
-except for various foramina for the passage of spinal
-cord, nerves, and blood-vessels. The succeeding twenty-four
-vertebrae remain separate and movable upon each other
-and leave between them the openings for the emergence of
-the spinal nerves. The last nine segments fuse eventually
-into two immovable or false vertebrae called Sacrum and
-Coccyx. These latter also contain foramina from which
-nerves issue.</p>
-
-<h4>The Adult Nerve System</h4>
-
-<p>When this development and growth of new parts is
-completed the Nerve System appears as a set of complex
-organs made of a central axis, brain and spinal cord, and
-peripheral connections made up of forty-three pairs of directly
-attached nerves (12 cranial and 31 spinal) with two
-great gangliated cords and numerous other sympathetic
-ganglia and communicating cords situated outside the
-skeletal axis but communicating with it intimately by means
-of interchange of fibre bundles between the sympathetic and
-the cerebro-spinal nerves.</p>
-
-<div id="ip_222" class="figcenter" style="max-width: 25.8125em;">
- <img src="images/i_222.jpg" width="413" height="600" alt="" />
- <div class="smaller in2 l2">
- <div class="caption"><p>Schematic diagram of Spinal nerve and Rami.</p>
- </div>
-
- <div class="captionl">
- <p class="in0">A: Spinal nerve. B: Spinal ganglion. C: Posterior nerve root.
- D: Anterior nerve root. E: White ramus communicans. F: Gray
- ramus communicans. G: Sympathetic ganglion. H: Sympathetic cord.</p>
- </div>
-
- <div class="captionr">
- <p class="sigright">
- <span class="l2">After Gray</span><br />
- Parker</p>
- </div>
- </div>
-
- <div class="caption">
- <p>31. Interchange of fibre bundles between spinal and sympathetic
- nerves.</p></div></div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_223">223</a></span></p>
-
-<p>But we who have viewed the embryonic development
-even briefly and sketchily, understand that all these complex
-organs are merely an aggregation of neurons, each neuron
-made up of a cell body, one or more axons, and dendrites;
-that the nerve cells are the controlling elements and the
-axons the centrifugal carriers of nerve energy, while the
-dendrites are the centripetal processes through which each
-nerve cell receives communications.</p>
-
-<h4>The Body Axis</h4>
-
-<p>The skull and spinal column, taken together, constitute
-the bony axis of the body, the center of organization of the
-skeleton; to these parts are attached other skeletal structures,
-mandible, ribs and sternum, extremities, classified as the
-appendicular portion of the skeleton. Likewise are attached,
-directly or indirectly, the voluntary muscles which move
-the skeleton, and the vessels and viscera. Any given structure
-in the body can be traced to a supporting connection
-with this bony axis.</p>
-
-<p>The bony axis contains the neural axis. Its strength and
-solidity are such as to preserve the integrity of the most
-vitally important tissue of the body from every form of injury
-if such protection be possible. Through openings in
-the bony axis—foramina—the central nerve organs give off
-or receive the nerve bundles which bring them into communication
-with every other structure of the body. And the
-body has been so arranged that every single part of it is
-partly or wholly under control of nerves emerging through<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_224">224</a></span>
-these foramina. Even the brain and spinal cord themselves
-respond to changes in the blood-vessels which are controlled
-by nerve impulses which have emerged through the intervertebral
-or cranial foramina and returned by other routes
-to supply the muscular coats of the vessels.</p>
-
-<h4>Concussion of Forces Affects Spinal Column</h4>
-
-<p>Reverting for a moment to the primitive segmental arrangement
-which is none the less persistent and important
-because in the completed human the regularity of contour of
-the segments has been wholly lost and aberrant organs have
-moved from their original positions carrying their nerve
-supply with them, let us first state and then illustrate a general
-law.</p>
-
-<p>Any violence applied to the body tends to affect the spinal
-column. Such violence does or does not produce permanent
-displacement of a spinal segment according as it does or does
-not succeed in overcoming the internal resistance. But whatever
-effect upon the spine is accomplished will occur most
-noticeably in the same body segment to which violence was
-applied. That is, force applied to any body segment tends
-to subluxate the vertebra which would impinge the nerves
-controlling that segment. Thus diseases are primarily segmental
-and later general just as the body is primarily
-segmental and later co-ordinated into complicated functional
-systems, all more or less interdependent.</p>
-
-<p>If a man falls so that he strikes first on the point of his
-shoulder the force will be transmitted almost directly across<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_225">225</a></span>
-the line of the spine, at right angles, and may subluxate the
-sixth or seventh Cervical or first Dorsal. If subluxation
-occurs it is because the law of gravity causes the remainder
-of the body to keep moving downward after the shoulder
-strikes and until it too comes to rest. The subluxation
-which results is a right one if the left shoulder be struck and
-vice versa. Now the brachial plexus is chiefly controlled by
-these three vertebrae and a right subluxation tends to impinge
-most the nerves on the left side, so that if any permanent
-effect of the fall follow it will be a permanent weakness
-or disease of the left shoulder or arm, with possible
-slight extensions along other branches of the same plexus,
-as to the latissimus dorsi. Also by the internal sympathetic
-communications from this same region the larynx, trachea,
-or large bronchi may be affected, occasionally the heart, all
-structures segmentally associated with the arm.</p>
-
-<p>This law applies throughout the body and can be fully
-demonstrated by any one having a complete knowledge of
-nerve connections and body segmentation upon being furnished
-with a complete and accurate history of any injury to
-the body. It goes further than this. Toxins or other
-secondary causes operating within the body tend always to
-produce their motor reactions and consequent effect upon
-any subluxated vertebrae in the same body segment with the
-peripheral irritation, so that if the stomach contain a poison
-which affects the spine the sixth or seventh Dorsal vertebrae
-will be most affected and the stomach itself the organ to
-suffer most.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_226">226</a></span></p>
-
-<p>The spinal column is peculiarly adapted, with its strong
-ligaments, its cartilage cushions, its perfect flexibility and
-flexuousness, to withstand jars and shocks. Yet the spine
-is the door by which disease enters the organism. Concussion
-of forces, the energy from the environment encountering
-the bodily resistance, is of no serious effect upon
-the organism—of no permanent or irreparable effect—unless
-it affects the spine and brings about vertebral subluxation,
-disturbance of the normal alignment between vertebrae, and
-thereby interrupts the perfect healing and controlling influence
-exerted by the vital part of the segment, the central
-nerve portion.</p>
-
-<p>When a concussion of forces <em>does</em> produce subluxations,
-does disturb the perfect poise and balance of that center of
-structure of the body, its consequences affect an entire body
-segment, producing, or tending to produce, disturbances
-through the entire segment.</p>
-
-<p>Disease is the indirect consequence of the contact of man
-with his environment and is <em>natural</em> but not <em>normal</em>.</p>
-
-<p>The spinal column is a <em>center</em> or a series of centers for
-disease. In this column will be found the primary cause—the
-introductory element—by which disease first makes its
-appearance in a previously healthy body.</p>
-
-<h4>Comparative Anatomy</h4>
-
-<p>The study of Comparative Anatomy is necessary to a
-complete understanding of the human organism. We may
-trace in the simplest forms of animal life the beginnings and<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_227">227</a></span>
-foreshadowings of the same plan of organization. We may
-follow it through the ascending scale and watch its complexity
-develop, and by viewing each step in the process we
-may come fully to realize that the original plan has been
-preserved throughout, though often in such form that by
-study of the single species we should fail to recognize it.</p>
-
-<p>We lack space for complete consideration of this subject
-and shall merely suggest certain facts and phases. No
-clear analogy can be drawn until we reach the worm, with
-its rudimentary spinal column and nerves. Roughly speaking,
-dissection of one spinal segment with its nerves and
-their controlled area—if this were possible—would separate
-from the rest a fairly regular <em>layer</em> similar to all the other
-layers. This is the primitive segmentation.</p>
-
-<p>It is shown much more clearly in the fish but the segments
-have begun to curve with their periphery directed slightly
-caudad and some have already shown a preponderating
-growth over other segments and a change of shape from the
-original symmetry.</p>
-
-<p>The reptiles and birds show still more complicated segmentation.
-It is notable that in these lower animals the
-purely reflex portion of the nervous system is highly developed
-while the volitional and sensory portions, the cerebral
-hemispheres, are yet rudimentary. In birds, particularly,
-the cerebellum is very highly developed because its function
-of co-ordination of muscles for the maintainence of equilibrium
-is required in a high degree for flying.</p>
-
-<p>Those land animals which walk on all fours approach still<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_228">228</a></span>
-closer but their arrangement is much more readily comprehensible
-than in man. As the animal stands on all fours
-with head extended, a gigantic cleaver slicing out each
-vertebra and pair of nerves and slicing straight toward the
-base of support might be said to divide the body <em>approximately</em>
-according to the structural and functional arrangement
-in segments. Yet no segment so separated would
-exactly correspond to the nerve distribution; there would
-be enlargement of some organs with extension into the zone
-previously occupied by their neighbors; enlargement here
-and atrophy there; invagination of one organ by another
-and overlapping and intermingling of parts. Even the
-relation between the spinal cord segments and the vertebrae
-has departed much from the primitive so that the growth
-of the vertebrae has exceeded that of the cord and the
-cord terminates opposite the Lumbar region instead of at the
-end of the Sacral canal. It may here be remarked that in
-the human embryo the cord at first occupies the entire length
-of the neural canal formed within the vertebrae; that in the
-adult it terminates opposite the lower border of the body of
-the first Lumbar vertebra and that the nerves, still retaining
-their original foramina of exit and their relation to the
-somatic segments, pass downward within the canal to their
-respective openings and collectively form a brush like mass
-called “cauda equina.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_229">229</a></span></p>
-
-<h4>Causes of Segmental Changes</h4>
-
-<p>The causes of the change in the shape, form, and relation
-of the different segments are functional: the body changes
-to meet the changing needs of its environment and the steady
-progressive functional development from one species to
-another.</p>
-
-<p>When the animal at last assumes the erect position, doing
-more intricately and intelligently the bidding of a developing
-and improving central nervous system, the change
-of position and the force of gravity bring about a gradual
-downward, or caudad, tendency of the parts of the somatic
-segments most remote from the spine and of the nerves
-which supply them.</p>
-
-<p>The nerves, muscles, and bones of the lower extremities
-change from almost a right angle to an extremely obtuse
-angle, less obtuse during infancy and more so in the adult.
-The forelegs become arms and hang at the sides, extending
-downward from the part of the spine which controls them.
-The ribs tend more obliquely downward and outward from
-the spine and the tendency of all the nerves is downward
-from their attachment to the spinal cord to their emergence
-from the intervertebral foramina. In the neck and head
-alone is this rule varied, the tendency of the nerves and
-some other structures there being to run from the spine
-either at right angles or upward.</p>
-
-<p>It seems almost symbolic and indicative of the purpose
-of creation that the body, which is less strong and vigorous<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_230">230</a></span>
-in Man than in the lower animals, should tend more and
-more obliquely downward from its central axis, while the
-cranium, containing a highly specialized mass of cells and
-fibres, the organ of Mind, which marks Man’s supremacy in
-the animal kingdom and is his crowning glory, is reared
-<em>above</em> the body it dominates.</p>
-
-<p>In all the form changes which mark the growth of the
-body the organs are arranged to afford the greatest possible
-economy of space and convenience for use. This perfect
-and matchless mechanism adapts itself to the changing habits
-and environments and to the quality and needs of the Mind
-which inhabits it.</p>
-
-<h4>Necessity for Table of Spino-Organic Connection</h4>
-
-<p>To the practitioner who is fully equipped with an instantly
-available knowledge of all the nerve connections in
-the body and to whom palpation of a subluxation at once
-suggests its somatic sphere of influence as a weakened or
-diseased area, or to whom mention of a disease immediately
-calls to mind the organ, or segment, which is primarily
-affected and its nerve connection with the spine, any tabulation
-of spino-organic connection or of diseases and adjustments,
-for reference, is unnecessary. But the ordinary practitioner
-finds it difficult to acquire and retain such an array
-of information and much more convenient to refer to reliable
-and easily read tables which will supply at once any such
-information desired.</p>
-
-<p>No specific adjustment is possible without knowledge of<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_231">231</a></span>
-the vertebra which controls the part diseased and toward
-the healing of which the nerve energy should be directed.
-Specific adjustment without correct diagnosis is of course
-impossible. And whenever correct diagnosis has been made
-it is essential that the mind of the Chiropractor should
-revert to one certain vertebra which he expects to find
-subluxated as the primary cause of the disease.</p>
-
-<p>Diagnosis is essential in order to find out <em>what</em> organ is
-the site of the disease, for all disease is primarily segmental.
-The <em>location</em> of the disease having been determined, a quick
-reference to a table showing the spinal connection with
-that location makes specific adjustment possible. The value
-of specific, as against general, adjustments will be considered
-under “Practice.”</p>
-
-<h4>Method of Investigation</h4>
-
-<p>One who wishes to determine for himself the proper
-specific adjustment for a certain disease must, in order to
-be able to attach any weight to his conclusions or to announce
-them with any hope of credence by the scientific world,
-proceed very much after the following method, which sets
-down what may be termed “standard test conditions” for
-research into the spino-organic connection.</p>
-
-<p>He must make a correct diagnosis which serves to
-determine the nature and location of the disease process.
-In this he may be greatly aided by vertebral palpation and
-nerve-tracing, especially in differential diagnosis. Any case
-which affords less than a quite positively correct diagnosis<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_232">232</a></span>
-should be excluded from the test list because any conclusion
-based on a doubtful diagnosis must itself be doubtful and
-may be seriously misleading.</p>
-
-<p>He must then ascertain as far as possible the known
-anatomical nerve connection between the spine and the diseased
-part. If several connections are known he must
-decide according to nervous physiology, by recognizing the
-morbid functions which constitute the disease and learning
-which nerves control these functions and which must therefore
-be deranged in order that the disease may exist. I may
-say right here that to attempt to answer the problems of
-Chiropractic on the assumption that standard anatomies are
-incorrect in their statement of nerve connections is as hopeless
-as the wail of the schoolboy that the answers in his
-arithmetic are wrong because his sums fail to come out that
-way.</p>
-
-<p>The investigator must next be accurate in Palpation,
-selecting the subluxation which would, from his knowledge
-of the body segmentation, seem most likely to influence the
-nerves involved, and positively ascertaining the <em>number</em> of
-the subluxated vertebra. No one who cannot count vertebrae
-accurately can positively say which vertebra he has
-adjusted. More than that, no one who <em>has not</em> counted the
-vertebrae in the special case in question can say which
-vertebra he has adjusted. No mere regional localization will
-suffice for scientific investigation.</p>
-
-<p>Correct and accurate adjustment must follow selection
-of the single vertebra and the adjuster must know that he<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_233">233</a></span>
-has used the one special movement, or form of adjustment,
-which is mechanically right for that kind of subluxation and
-has so moved the vertebra as to release impingement. Mere
-movement of a vertebra is not necessarily an adjustment or
-even a maladjustment; it may be movement without permanent
-change of relation or release of impingement. (See
-“<a href="#h_36">Preferable Adjustments</a>,” <a href="#Page_155">p. 155</a>.)</p>
-
-<p>There follows the observation of the progress of the
-case and this must be so careful and accurate that the
-observer knows to a certainty whether the disease is progressing
-unfavorably, or favorably, or whether it has been
-entirely eradicated. He must know the value of every changing
-symptom, the real meaning of each new development.
-Every diagnostic method should be at his command for
-this work. Constant vigilance and constant thought should
-mark each step of his work.</p>
-
-<p>Finally he must be so cautious and careful in his statements
-that no doubtful conclusion is allowed to escape from
-his own mind. We may believe or suspect or hope for proof
-of our theories but we have no right to state as a fact anything
-except that which has been proven under the most
-rigidly guarded scientific test conditions.</p>
-
-<p>Failure to observe any of the precautions mentioned
-renders worthless the results of investigation. Nothing
-further than a mere presumption can be based upon research
-which fails to observe all these rules. It will be
-readily understood that there are few Chiropractors whose
-training has been sufficient to enable them successfully to<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_234">234</a></span>
-accomplish such research. There are thus many things
-connected with the spino-organic connections which are
-commonly held as facts but which should be classed as presumptions.
-And the prevalence of the habit of general adjustment
-rather than specific makes the future final solution
-of all these problems remote.</p>
-
-<h4>Kinds of Evidence Acceptable</h4>
-
-<p>It will be seen that of the three kinds of evidence—Anatomical,
-Physiological, and Clinical—which are admissible
-in reasoning upon the connection between the spine
-and disease, only one form—clinical evidence—has been adduced
-by Chiropractic. For anatomical and physiological
-corroboration of our apparent clinical findings we are obliged
-to turn to standard works on these subjects; fortunately we
-find it in abundance.</p>
-
-<p>Anatomy, fortified now by research in the morphologic
-relations of the parts studied and by physiological and pathological
-experiment which has thrown much light on the
-proper viewpoints from which to describe structure, contains
-sufficient data on the nervous system to enable us to explain
-practically every fact observable in a Chiropractic clinic.</p>
-
-<p>It is true that there are a few statements in the ensuing
-outlines for which we cannot as yet find the anatomical or
-physiological proof. But it must be remembered that anatomists
-and physiologists have never studied the body with
-a knowledge of the subluxation theory to aid them in gaining
-perspective and that Chiropractors, as a class, have not<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_235">235</a></span>
-yet delved deeply enough into anatomy and physiology to
-extract all the available and illuminating information from
-them. Ofttimes the facts we value most are most obscure
-in the texts because to others they seem least important.
-But they are there. Armed with information concerning
-Chiropractic facts it is probable that the scientist of the
-future will corroborate all of our clinical findings of today
-and emphasize the rational explanations of them.</p>
-
-<p>In the following tables it has been found best to insert
-in parentheses the capital letter (P) to call attention to any
-statement in support of which we have gathered less than
-all three forms of admissible evidence and which is therefore
-as yet presumptive. It is well, however, for the practitioner
-to be careful lest he regard too lightly such presumptive
-statements. Unless there is very strong and reasonable
-ground for such presumption or a general belief in its correctness
-all mention of it is omitted. Those labelled presumptive
-are merely so indicated because they have not yet
-been proven and not because they have failed to serve as a
-convenient and useful guide to adjustment. For each presumption
-offered there is either clinical or anatomical justification
-but not both.</p>
-
-<h3 id="h_50">SPECIAL NERVE CONNECTIONS</h3>
-
-<p>This section does not purport to state with any degree of
-completeness the various nerve-paths by which spinal vertebrae
-come into relation with all, or nearly all, the peripheral
-organs of the body. It merely points out some of the more<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_236">236</a></span>
-interesting and important connections, some of the paths
-which serve to explain the common effects of vertebral adjustment.
-It is not expected that this resume of the subject
-will be more than suggestive to the student; certainly
-it cannot, in so brief a space, be a complete exposition.</p>
-
-<h4>Outline of Nerve System</h4>
-
-<p>Let us begin with the observation that almost every
-organ of the body, including the central nerve organs themselves,
-may be adversely affected by spinal subluxation impinging
-spinal nerve axons at their exit from, or entrance
-through, intervertebral foramina, or by spinal subluxation
-producing direct impingement upon some part of the
-sympathetic system and similarly interfering with its power
-to functionate.</p>
-
-<p>The Nerve System may be divided into two great divisions,
-the central axis and the peripheral system which
-distributes nerve energy from, and brings stimuli to, the
-central axis. The central axis consists of the brain and
-spinal cord; the peripheral system of 12 pairs of nerves attached
-to the brain and having exit (except the eighth)
-through foramina in the base of the cranium, 31 pairs of
-spinal nerves emerging through intervertebral foramina
-whose parts are movable upon each other (except the foramina
-for sacral and coccygeal nerves), and an intricate
-system of sympathetic fibres and ganglia arranged in a
-double chain of ganglia in front and at the sides of the
-vertebral column, three great prevertebral plexuses, the<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_237">237</a></span>
-cardiac, coeliac, and hypogastric, and numerous scattered
-ganglia and communicating cords which bind the ganglia
-together and connect them with spinal or cranial nerves
-and with the periphery.</p>
-
-<p>The peripheral system is somewhat complex and numerous
-intercommunications are established by which nerve impulses
-originating in the central axis and leaving by one
-part of the peripheral system may exercise a controlling influence
-over another part. Plexuses, or intertwinings of
-nerve axons, are so numerous and complicated that it is
-difficult to follow each set of nerve stimuli from their origin
-to their final destination and effect without considerable
-study.</p>
-
-<h4>Direct Distribution of Spinal Axons</h4>
-
-<p>The spinal nerve axons, taken as a whole, establish paths
-between the motor gray of the ventral horn of the spinal
-cord and all voluntary muscles of the body below the head
-except the trapezius and sternomastoid, partially innervated
-by the eleventh cranial, and between the sensor cells of the
-dorsal spinal gray and gracile and cuneate nuclei of the
-medulla on the one hand and the sensor end organs in skin
-and mucuous membrane, muscles, tendons, and joints on
-the other. The ventral cornu receives impulses from the
-cortico-spinal axons of the direct pyramidal, crossed pyramidal,
-rubrospinal, and other smaller tracts which bring the
-spinal gray under the direct voluntary domination of the
-volitional centers in the brain or of the indirectly voluntary<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_238">238</a></span>
-pathway through the cerebellum. The spinal nerves are
-the direct media for motion of the body or its parts in relation
-to its environment. The sensor gray of the cord is
-similarly in communication with the conscious sensation
-area in the cerebrum and with the cerebellum by way of the
-dorsal tracts of the cord, the lemnisci, and the cerebellar
-peduncles.</p>
-
-<p>In the main these nerves of motion and sensation are
-arranged as follows:</p>
-
-<p>The Cervical plexus is composed of the intertwining of
-axons from the anterior primary divisions of the four upper
-Cervical nerves. Its branches pass to and innervate many
-voluntary muscles of the neck and side and back of head,
-and supply sensor fibres to the adjacent cutaneous areas.
-Branches also communicate with the last three cranial nerves
-and one long branch, the Phrenic, or Internal Respiratory
-Nerve of Bell, passes through the neck and thorax to the
-diaphragm, as its motor nerve.</p>
-
-<p>The Brachial plexus is made up of the anterior primary
-divisions of the four lower Cervical nerves and the greater
-part of the first Thoracic. It is distributed chiefly to the
-voluntary muscles and integument of the shoulder and arm,
-forearm, and hand, but sends branches to some muscles of
-the neck and upper back as well. It, like the Cervical plexus,
-receives branches from, but gives none to, the Cervical sympathetic.</p>
-
-<p>The Thoracic nerves are not arranged in plexiform
-fashion like those above but pass separately, for the most<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_239">239</a></span>
-part, to their destinations. They are distributed to the walls
-of the thorax and abdomen following the curve of the ribs in
-direction. The last Thoracic sends one division downward
-as far as the outer aspect of the ilium.</p>
-
-<p>The Lumbar, Sacral, and Pudendal plexuses are formed
-of the ventral divisions of the Lumbar, Sacral, and Coccygeal
-nerves and distribute branches to the integument
-and voluntary muscles of the lower abdomen, pelvis, and
-lower extremities. From two of the sacral nerves branches
-known as “Visceral” pass through the plexus to terminate in
-the walls of the uterus and rectum.</p>
-
-<p>All of the thoracic nerves and the first and second, sometimes
-the third and fourth, lumbar give off branches to the
-sympathetic ganglia, known as white rami communicantes.</p>
-
-<h4>Direct Distribution of Cranial Nerves</h4>
-
-<p>The distribution of the 12 pairs of cranial nerves is not
-so definitely to voluntary muscles and to areas from which
-conscious sensation is to be derived as is the case with the
-spinal, although the cranial nerves present many analogies
-with the spinal and there is abundant reason for considering
-them as in one series of 43 pairs. There is direct distribution
-of some cranial nerve fibres to secreting glands, but
-these fibres are probably merely derived from sympathetic
-trunks and carried in company with the axons of cranial
-origin. There is also some direct distribution of cranial
-nerve axons to visceral walls made of non-striated muscle,
-as in the case of the vagus distribution to the respiratory and<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_240">240</a></span>
-alimentary tracts and that of the spinal accessory to the
-heart. This is a resemblance to the sympathetic.</p>
-
-<p>The cranial nerves carry afferent impressions from the
-special sense organs, except those of the sense of touch,
-which function is divided with the spinal nerves.</p>
-
-<p>Various intercommunications exist between the cranial
-and sympathetic divisions of the peripheral system, by means
-of which axons starting with one division may be finally
-distributed with another, or by which an axon of the sympathetic
-may pass to one of the sensor ganglia of the cranial
-system and influence its nutrition and condition, and therefore
-its power to act. There is a limited intermingling of
-spinal fibres with the lower cranial.</p>
-
-<h4>Distribution of Sympathetic</h4>
-
-<p>The sympathetic system directly innervates most of the
-nutritive or vegetative system, the alimentary tract and its
-accessory organs, the vascular systems, the genito-urinary
-system, and the ductless glands. To a limited degree it
-shares this control with the cerebro-spinal and to a much
-greater degree it brings the central axis into indirect connection
-with these viscera.</p>
-
-<p>Gray says, “The distinction of the sympathetic system
-from the cerebrospinal system is made merely for reasons of
-convenience. The two systems are intimately connected
-and the sympathetic is morphologically a derivative of the
-central axis disseminated in connection with the nutritive<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_241">241</a></span>
-apparatus and establishing relationships among the vegetative
-organs.”</p>
-
-<h4>Structure of Nerve Pathways</h4>
-
-<p>Most pathways which carry nerve impulses from their
-origin or inception to the organ in which they are finally
-expressed as action of some sort or translated into sensation
-or into stimuli which pass out reflexly over a connected
-neuron, are composed of more than one neuron. The neurons
-of a nerve pathway are arranged end to end with the axons
-all pointing in one general direction so that the nerve
-energy travels always in the same direction over the entire
-nerve path. Impulses are transferred from the first neuron
-in the chain to the second, and from second to third, etc.,
-by contact of the telodendria of the one neuron with the
-dendrites or receptive processes of the next. Part of the
-nerve pathway may be within the central axis and part
-within the trunk of a peripheral nerve.</p>
-
-<p>Several peripheral pathways for afferent impulses may
-be joined to an efferent pathway so as to complete reflex arcs
-and the efferent cell be under the controlling influence of
-some upper neuron coming down from the central axis with
-the power either to permit or to inhibit the reflex acts which
-would otherwise take place as a result of peripheral stimuli.
-Several such lower cells may be under the domination of one
-upper neuron.</p>
-
-<p>In some instances the nutrition of ganglia or nerve
-trunks, or of parts of the central axis itself, is under the<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_242">242</a></span>
-control of sympathetic neurons terminating in connection
-therewith, so that interruption of the normal action of the
-sympathetic neuron may be followed by effects manifested
-through some distant part of the cerebrospinal system. In
-the following pages we shall discuss nerve pathways with
-reference to the explanation of diseases caused by vertebral
-subluxation impinging nerves either by tension or constriction,
-and therefore our grouping of parts will differ somewhat
-from any anatomical or physiological grouping with
-another object in view.</p>
-
-<h4>Important Nerve Pathways</h4>
-
-<p><i>To brain</i>: C 2, 3, or 4 to superior cervical ganglion by
-direct impingement, through internal carotid nerve to sympathetic
-plexuses following branch arteries from Circle of
-Willis. The blood-supply of the brain is under control of
-the cervical sympathetic and most brain lesions or diseases
-are due to vascular changes leading to anaemia, hyperaemia,
-inflammation, or hemorrhage.</p>
-
-<p><i>To meninges</i>: Loop between first and second cervical
-nerves to trunk ganglion of vagus and through meningeal
-branches of vagus (P), or by way of internal carotid nerve
-to pial sympathetic plexuses. (P) The connection of the
-first, second, or third cervical with cerebral meningitis is
-established clinically but there is still doubt as to the explanation.</p>
-
-<p><i>Eye and Muscles</i>, <i>Retina</i>, <i>Optic Nerve</i>: The external
-muscles of the eye, the four recti and two oblique with the<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_243">243</a></span>
-levator palpebrae superioris, are innervated by the Oculomotor,
-or third cranial, and the fourth and sixth cranial,
-which receive branches from the cavernous plexus of the
-sympathetic derived from the internal carotid branch of the
-superior cervical ganglion. As the ganglion lies in front
-of the transverse processes of the second, third, and fourth
-cervical vertebrae, direct impingement upon it by subluxation
-of one of these vertebrae may cause strabismus or
-other affection of the external ocular muscles.</p>
-
-<p>The eye-ball receives filaments from the ciliary or
-ophthalmic ganglion, which in turn is connected with the
-cervical ganglion by way of cavernous plexus and internal
-carotid nerve. This pathway controls the radial fibres of
-the iris and dilates the pupil as a part of the light accommodation
-reflex mechanism. Loss of pupillary reaction,
-especially with small pupils, suggests upper cervical subluxation.</p>
-
-<p>The retina, containing the cells of origin of the optic
-nerve axons and being the special end-organ of the sense of
-sight has no direct spinal or sympathetic connections but its
-blood-supply, and therefore its nutrition, is influenced by
-branches from the sympathetic which enter with the central
-artery of the retina. Retinal hemorrhage has been cured by
-cervical adjustment, C 2, 3, or 4.</p>
-
-<p>The conjunctiva is innervated by the sympathetic and
-by the fifth cranial, or trigeminal.</p>
-
-<p><i>Olfactory Nerve</i>: Nerve of smell, distributed to the
-Schneiderian membrane over the upper portion of the nasal<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_244">244</a></span>
-septum and over the upper lateral wall. There is no known
-connection by which the trunk of the olfactory nerve can
-be reached by adjustment but the condition of the special
-end organs in the membrane and their ability to functionate
-depend not only upon the integrity of their axons but also
-upon the nutrition and moisture of the membrane in which
-they are embedded. This is under the control of the Vidian
-nerve and of branches from the spheno-palatine, or Meckel’s
-ganglion, both connected with the carotid plexus of the
-sympathetic and therefore responsive to adjustment of C 2,
-3, or 4. This is also the route by which epistaxis is usually
-checked.</p>
-
-<p>The external nasal muscles, like those of the rest of
-the face except some of the muscles of mastication, get
-their supply from the facial nerve, which connects with the
-sympathetic plexus on the middle meningeal artery. It may
-be said parenthetically here that peripheral facial paralysis
-(Bell’s palsy) yields to adjustment and proves the value of
-this connection. The nasal integument is under the sensor
-control of the trigeminal and trophic disturbances may result
-from its involvement.</p>
-
-<p><i>Trigeminal Nerve</i>: This is the great sensor nerve of
-the face and carries a motor division, the inferior maxillary,
-to some of the muscles of mastication, as the temporal,
-masseter, and buccinator. It has connected with it four
-ganglia, which also receive sympathetic roots, and the
-ganglion of origin of its sensor axons, the Gasserian or
-semilunar, also receives direct sympathetic communications.<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_245">245</a></span>
-The importance of this communication is shown by the
-powerful effect of adjustment of third or fourth Cervical
-for tic dolouroux.</p>
-
-<p><i>Ear</i>: The external ear receives branches from the
-vagus and from the first and second cervical nerves. The
-middle ear and Eustachian tube are supplied by the tympanic
-plexus made up of branches from the glosso-pharyngeal,
-otic ganglion, facial nerve and the small deep petrosal from
-the sympathetic on the carotid artery. By all these routes
-communication from the third and fourth cervicals is possible
-but especially is the latter important. The fourth cervical
-is the especially frequent subluxation with middle ear
-disease. To the internal ear and auditory or acoustic nerve
-there appears to be no direct route from the spine. It has not
-yet been conclusively established within the writer’s knowledge
-that adjustments will affect auditory deafness but
-Meniere’s Disease, inflammation of the semicircular canals,
-has been cured repeatedly by adjustments of Atlas or Axis,
-by what route I am unable to state.</p>
-
-<p><i>Teeth and Gums</i>: It is probable that the only connection
-between the vertebrae and the teeth is an afferent one by way
-of the trigeminal. Toothache may be stopped by adjustment
-of C 3, or C 4, but no evidence is at hand to show that the
-condition of the teeth is improved or that more than a temporary
-effect can be had. Trophic changes in the gums may
-be due to vascular disturbances controlled by the sympathetic.</p>
-
-<p><i>Tongue</i>: The hypoglossal, motor nerve to both the intrinsic<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_246">246</a></span>
-and extrinsic muscles of the tongue, receives direct
-axons from the loop between the first and second Cervical
-nerves. Sympathetic fibres pass to the blood-vessels and
-secreting glands of the tongue.</p>
-
-<p><i>Tonsils</i>: Receive fibres from the spheno-palatine ganglion
-and by this means are brought under the domination of
-C 2, 3, and 4. Abundant clinical evidence in tonsilitis,
-simple, follicular, and suppurative, proves this to be the
-practically, as well as anatomically, correct nerve connection.</p>
-
-<p><i>Salivary Glands</i>: The parotid receives branches from
-the great auricular nerve from the second and third cervical,
-and from the sympathetic on the external carotid artery,
-branches from the superior cervical ganglion. The submaxillary
-and sublingual glands are connected with the
-submaxillary ganglion, which receives a sympathetic root
-and which, with the chorda tympani also carrying fibres
-derived from the sympathetic, controls the secretions of
-these glands.</p>
-
-<p><i>Pharynx</i>: The pharyngeal plexus is a mixture of sensory
-axons from the glosso-pharyngeal, motor components
-from the vagus and probably sensor from the same nerve,
-and sympathetic branches from the superior cervical ganglion.
-All of these may be influenced by the upper cervical
-adjustment.</p>
-
-<p><i>Larynx</i>: According to anatomy the larynx is innervated
-by the superior and inferior, or recurrent, branches of the
-vagus and by sympathetic branches from the superior cervical
-ganglion. Clinically the sixth cervical adjustment cures<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_247">247</a></span>
-laryngitis and aphonia. The explanation probably lies in
-the fact that the thyroid branches of the middle cervical ganglion,
-lying in front of the transverses of the sixth, communicate
-within the thyroid gland with the recurrent laryngeal
-and with the external laryngeal branch of the superior
-laryngeal.</p>
-
-<p><i>Thyroid Gland</i>: “The nerves to the thyroid are amyelinic
-and are derived from the middle and inferior ganglia
-of the sympathetic.” (Gray.) The middle cervical ganglia
-are situated in front of the transverse processes of the sixth
-cervical vertebra. Clinically, the sixth cervical reaches
-goitre.</p>
-
-<p><i>Muscles of Neck</i>: The platysma is supplied by the
-facial nerve; the sternomastoid by the spinal accessory and
-cervical plexus; the infrahyoid region by the first three
-cervical nerves; the suprahyoid region by the facial and
-the ansa cervicalis; the anterior and lateral vertebral muscles
-by the cervical nerves from second to seventh inclusive,
-but especially the second, third, and fourth. It will be seen
-that muscular disturbance in the neck may result from any
-cervical subluxation. Torticollis, which usually involves the
-sternomastoid, yields to the second cervical most frequently.</p>
-
-<p><i>Lymph Nodes of Head and Face</i>: These lymph nodes
-are controlled by the cervical sympathetic. Pathological
-changes in one or more nodes requires careful cervical palpation
-to determine the presence of a subluxation away from
-the affected side.</p>
-
-<p><i>Muscles of Back</i>: The trapezius is innervated by the<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_248">248</a></span>
-spinal accessory and by the third and fourth cervical nerves;
-the latissimus dorsi by the sixth, seventh, and eighth cervical
-through the middle or long subscapular. Occasionally
-a tender nerve, traceable from the lower reaches of the latissimus
-to the cervical region has mislead the practitioner
-into imagining a cervical connection over the back with internal
-viscera.</p>
-
-<p>The second layer of the back is supplied by the third,
-fourth, and fifth cervical nerves. The third layer is innervated
-by the middle and lower cervical and upper three
-thoracic nerves except the serratus posticus inferior which
-is supplied by the ninth, tenth, and eleventh thoracic. The
-fourth and fifth layer are supplied by the posterior primary
-divisions of the spinal nerves and any given section of these
-layers may be traced to a vertebra directly above, or
-cephalad.</p>
-
-<p><i>Thoracic Walls</i>: The parietal muscles of the thorax are
-innervated by the intercostal nerves and a very definite
-segmental association with the spine is traceable.</p>
-
-<p><i>Diaphragm</i>: Phrenic nerve, which arises from fourth
-cervical chiefly; lower intercostals, especially eighth and
-ninth; and phrenic plexus of the sympathetic which may
-sometimes be reached from the fourth or fifth dorsal vertebrae
-through the gangliated cord. For motor disturbances
-of the diaphragm adjust fourth cervical.</p>
-
-<p><i>Abdominal Muscles</i>: These are supplied by the lower
-intercostals and the transversalis and internal oblique make
-connection with L 1 by the iliohypogastric. Cremaster is<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_249">249</a></span>
-supplied by L 1 and 2 by way of the genital branch of the
-genitofemoral.</p>
-
-<p><i>Perineal Muscles</i>: The anterior perineal group are supplied
-by the perineal branch of the internal pudic which
-traces to the second, third, and fourth sacral nerves. The
-posterior perineal and ischiorectal region is also supplied by
-the sacral and coccygeal nerves.</p>
-
-<p><i>Trachea and Bronchi</i>: Vagus and sympathetic filaments
-from first and second thoracic ganglia. The latter receive
-preganglionic fibres from first dorsal nerve in all probability,
-as this adjustment reaches the bronchi.</p>
-
-<p><i>Lungs</i>: The third thoracic ganglia connect with the
-pulmonary plexus and establish a connection from third
-dorsal vertebra direct to the lung parenchyma. The <i>Pleurae</i>
-have a similar connection or may sometimes be reached by
-the first dorsal.</p>
-
-<p><i>Heart and Pericardium</i>: In 55% of all heart disease or
-improper action the second dorsal is responsible; in 40%
-the first dorsal, and perhaps in the remaining 5% the atlas
-or axis. The former nerves (T 1 and 2) furnish pre-ganglionic
-fibres which stream upward through the gangliated
-cord to terminate in the three cervical ganglia in relation
-with the dendrites of new neurons (amyelinic) which form
-the superior, middle, and inferior cardiac nerves and pass
-into the thorax to mingle with vagal fibres to form the superficial
-and deep cardiac plexuses, controlling the heart.
-Probably the upper cervicals occasionally affect the vagus
-through the loop between the first and second cervical
-nerves.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_250">250</a></span></p>
-
-<p><i>Thoracic Aorta</i>: Controlled by sympathetic from first
-thoracic ganglion or last cervical ganglion, and thus by
-seventh cervical or first dorsal vertebra.</p>
-
-<p><i>Abdominal aorta—Coeliac Axis</i>: The upper portion of
-the abdominal aorta is innervated by the coeliac or solar
-plexus of the sympathetic. Sub-plexuses from the coeliac
-accompany the various branches of the aorta and are widely
-distributed to the blood-vessels and to the glands and non-striated
-muscle of the abdominal organs. The coeliac plexus
-receives fibres from the right vagus and from the greater,
-lesser, and least splanchnic nerves, by the latter route making
-connection with the thoracic ganglia of the sympathetic
-from fifth to last. These ganglia receive pre-ganglionic
-fibres from the thoracic spinal nerves in the form of white
-rami communicantes, so that it is not incorrect to say that
-the coeliac plexus and its branches are largely controlled by
-the condition of the last eight thoracic nerves.</p>
-
-<p>Through this intricate plexus it is difficult to trace the
-relations of each abdominal organ with the particular vertebrae
-of which subluxation would produce disease in said
-organ. By the aid of clinical experimentation covering a
-period of years and by diligent search among anatomies and
-physiologies, we have arrived at the conclusions indicated
-in succeeding statements.</p>
-
-<p>The most important spinal connection with the abdominal
-blood-vessels is that of the fifth dorsal vertebra, for the
-fifth dorsal nerve, by its rami, seems greatly to influence
-the caliber of the aorta and coeliac axis.</p>
-
-<div id="ip_250" class="figcenter" style="max-width: 28.5em;">
- <img src="images/i_250.jpg" width="456" height="600" alt="" />
- <div class="smaller">
- <div class="captionl in2">
-
- <p class="in0">A. Cortico Spinal nerve. B. Spino Ganglionic nerve.<br />
- C. Ganglio Ganglionic nerve. D. Ganglio Peripheric nerve.<br />
- E. Blood Vessel Wall.</p></div>
-
- <div class="captionr">
- <p class="sigright l4">
- Parker</p>
- </div>
- </div>
-
- <div class="caption">
- <p>Fig. 32. Schematic representation of nerve pathway from brain
- to periphery by way of sympathetic.</p></div></div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_251">251</a></span></p>
-
-<p><i>Liver</i>: Fourth thoracic nerves (especially the right) to
-gangliated cord, via great splanchnic nerve to coeliac plexus,
-by hepatic plexus to interior of liver. The hepatic plexus
-gives off the cystic plexus which controls the gall-bladder.</p>
-
-<p><i>Stomach</i>: Sixth and seventh dorsal nerves by white
-rami to and through the ganglia of the gangliated cord to
-coeliac plexus. The gastric plexus is an offshoot of the
-coeliac and gives off Auerbach’s plexus to the muscular
-coat, and Meissner’s plexus to the submucous and mucous
-coats of the stomach. The nutrition of the stomach walls,
-their peristaltic action, and the secretory action of the stomach
-glands are thus brought under the direct influence of the
-sixth or the seventh dorsal subluxation.</p>
-
-<p><i>Pancreas</i>: Eighth dorsal nerve by great splanchnic to
-coeliac plexus, to hepatic and superior mesenteric plexuses,
-and by the pancreatico-duodenal branches of the former and
-pancreatic branches of the latter to the pancreas.</p>
-
-<p><i>Spleen</i>: The coeliac plexus, the left semilunar ganglion,
-and the left vagus and right phrenic nerves give off
-branches which form the splenic plexus. Spinal connection
-by way of ninth dorsal nerve, by rami communicantes to
-gangliated cord to great splanchnic nerve to coeliac plexus
-to splenic plexus. Many nerve pathways like this one are
-less indirect than they sound; various names have been given
-to different parts of the same pathway through which, often,
-the axons pass without interruption. On the way from the
-cerebral cortex to one of the abdominal viscera there may
-be only three, sometimes four or five, neurons connected
-end to end.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_252">252</a></span></p>
-
-<p><i>Duodenum</i>: Coeliac plexus by way of duodenal branches
-of hepatic plexus and branches from the superior mesenteric
-plexus. Spinal connection from eighth dorsal nerve and
-possibly branches from the upper lumbar ganglia of the
-sympathetic may join the superior mesenteric plexus, as
-results in duodenal disease are occasionally reported following
-specific adjustment of L 1 or 2.</p>
-
-<p><i>Jejunum and Ileum</i>: Connection same as for duodenum,
-by superior mesenteric plexus. Adjustment of L 2 in typhoid
-fever is undoubtedly correct so that it is probable that the
-lumbar ganglia send branches to this vicinity.</p>
-
-<p><i>Peritoneum</i>: Nerve supply to the peritoneum is rather
-general owing to its great extent. It is supplied by the
-sympathetic from both the lower thoracic and lumbar portions
-of the gangliated cord through the various abdominal
-plexuses and in general it may be said that any localized
-peritoneal disease will yield to the same adjustment as would
-be made for disease in the immediately subjacent organ.</p>
-
-<p><i>Suprarenal Capsules</i>: These important glands are supplied
-by amyelinic fibres derived from the gangliated cord
-by the lesser splanchnic nerve and connecting with pre-ganglionic
-fibres from the tenth dorsal nerve. The suprarenal
-plexus is an offshoot of the coeliac.</p>
-
-<p><i>Kidneys</i>: Tenth, eleventh, and twelfth dorsal nerves by
-way of lesser and least splanchnic nerves to renal plexus,
-an offshoot of the coeliac. McConnell’s experiments and the
-frequently duplicated clinical feats of Chiropractors prove
-this to be a vital and dominant nerve pathway in kidney
-disease.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_253">253</a></span></p>
-
-<p><i>Ureters</i>: Nerves derived from inferior mesenteric, pelvic,
-and spermatic plexuses. Most important connection
-seems to be from first lumbar nerve by lumbar ganglia to
-inferior mesenteric plexus.</p>
-
-<p><i>Caecum and Vermiform Appendix</i>: The inferior mesenteric
-plexus, which supplies these organs probably carries
-to them chiefly fibres derived from the lumber ganglia which
-complete a connection with the second lumbar vertebra,
-especially on the right side.</p>
-
-<p><i>Colon</i>: Third and fourth lumbar vertebrae, influencing
-lumbar ganglia and thus inferior mesenteric plexus.</p>
-
-<p><i>Rectum</i>: Lower lumbar ganglia by inferior mesenteric
-and plevic plexuses, through superior and inferior hemorrhoidal
-plexus to rectum. Adjustment L 4 or 5. Visceral
-branches from the third and fourth sacral nerves also pass
-directly to the rectal wall and sacral adjustment may affect
-rectum or anus.</p>
-
-<p><i>Bladder</i>: The urinary bladder is innervated by the
-vesical plexus from the pelvic, and by sacral nerve fibres
-direct. It is said that the vesical plexus contains many
-spinal nerve fibres which are derived from the second and
-fourth lumbar nerves especially. Clinically the second or
-the fourth lumbar will control the bladder much oftener
-than the sacrum.</p>
-
-<p><i>Prostate Gland, Seminal Vesicles, Penis, and Urethra</i>:
-By the vesical and prostatic plexuses derived from the pelvic
-plexuses, divisions of the hypogastric plexus, which is
-formed of the abdominal aortic plexus and filaments from<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_254">254</a></span>
-the lumbar ganglia. The latter receive filaments from the
-second and third lumbar nerves. There is a connection with
-the sacral nerves also by the pelvic plexus, though the
-lumbar adjustment appears the more potent.</p>
-
-<p><i>Testes and Scrotum</i>: Ilioinguinal from second lumbar,
-genital branch of genito-femoral from second and
-third lumbar nerves, internal pudic nerve from the pudendal
-plexus, and spermatic and pelvic plexuses. The most effective
-adjustment for scrotal or testicular diseases is L 3.</p>
-
-<p><i>Uterus and Vagina</i>: Uterovaginal plexus from the pelvic
-and containing spinal nerve fibres from L 4, L 5, and
-sacrum.</p>
-
-<p><i>Ovaries and Fallopian Tubes</i>: The ovarian plexus receives
-fibres from the abdominal aortic and through it from
-the lumbar ganglia, influenced by second lumbar adjustment.</p>
-
-<p><i>Brachial Plexus</i>: The brachial plexus of spinal nerves
-arises from the nerves from the fifth cervical to the first
-thoracic inclusive and controls the voluntary muscles of the
-upper extremity, with its integument. Muscle groups,
-rather than single muscles, are represented for the most
-part in the spinal segments giving off these nerves, and
-the ramification of the nerves within the plexus is such that
-almost any given muscle might be affected by more than
-one spinal subluxation. Below are given the principal connections:</p>
-
-<p><i>Pectoralis Major and Minor Muscles</i>: Sixth or seventh
-cervical through internal anterior thoracic nerve and first
-dorsal through external anterior thoracic.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_255">255</a></span></p>
-
-<p><i>Shoulder Joint</i>: The joint, muscles covering the joint,
-and integument of this region are innervated by the circumflex
-nerve which traces through the plexus to fifth and
-sixth cervical nerves. Sixth cervical adjustment usually
-affects this joint.</p>
-
-<p><i>Serratus Magnus Muscle</i>: Sixth cervical by long thoracic,
-or External Respiratory Nerve of Bell.</p>
-
-<p><i>Elbow Joint</i>: Sixth cervical vertebra by musculocutaneous
-nerve.</p>
-
-<p><i>Anterior Arm Muscles</i>: Sixth cervical.</p>
-
-<p><i>Posterior Arm Muscles</i>: Seventh cervical and first
-dorsal.</p>
-
-<p><i>Lumbosacral Plexus</i>: This plexus, derived from the anterior
-primary divisions of the lumbar, sacral, and coccygeal
-nerves, supplies the muscles and integument of the lower
-extremity, taking with it axons derived from the sympathetic
-by the lumbar ganglia to supply the blood-vessels, perspiratory
-glands and sebaceous glands of this region. The latter
-are responsive to adjustments of the first or second lumbar
-vertebrae.</p>
-
-<p><i>Hip-Joint</i>: Third and fourth lumbar nerves by femoral
-and obturator or accessory obturator nerves and fifth lumbar
-or first sacral by the nerve to the quadratus femoris or
-the great sciatic. Fourth lumbar seems the most potent
-connection and is usually adjusted for hip-joint disease.</p>
-
-<p><i>Psoas Magnus Muscles</i>: Anterior branches of the second
-and third lumbar nerves.</p>
-
-<p><i>Anterior Thigh Muscles</i>: Supplied mostly through the
-femoral nerve from the second and third lumbar nerves.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_256">256</a></span></p>
-
-<p><i>Internal Thigh Muscles</i>: Second and third lumbar
-nerves (chiefly but not wholly) through the obturator, accessory
-obturator and femoral nerves.</p>
-
-<p><i>Gluteus Maximus</i>: From the fifth lumbar and first and
-second sacral nerves through the inferior gluteal branch of
-the sacral plexus.</p>
-
-<p><i>Obturator Externus</i>: Second, third, and fourth lumbar
-nerves through the obturator nerve.</p>
-
-<p><i>Posterior Thigh Muscles</i>: Fourth and fifth lumbar and
-sacral nerves through the great sciatic.</p>
-
-<p><i>Great Sciatic Nerve</i>: This great nerve, direct continuation
-of the sacral plexus, arises from the fourth and
-fifth lumbar and first three or four sacral nerves and is
-widely distributed to muscles and integument of the lower
-extremity. Sciatica, or sciatic rheumatism, is most commonly
-relieved by adjustment of fourth or fifth lumbar
-vertebra; but there is a condition commonly diagnosed as
-sciatica which is really a sciatic neuritis and due to vasomotor
-disturbance affecting the blood-supply to the nerve
-trunk. This responds to adjustment of first or second lumbar
-because the amyelinic fibres which control these blood-vessels
-are derived from lumbar ganglia of the sympathetic.</p>
-
-<p><i>Anterior Leg Muscles</i>: Fourth and fifth lumbar and
-first sacral nerves through the anterior tibial.</p>
-
-<p><i>Posterior Leg Region</i>: Fourth and fifth lumbar and
-first and second sacral through the internal popliteal and
-posterior tibial.</p>
-
-<p><i>Knee-Joint</i>: This joint receives branches from the<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_257">257</a></span>
-great sciatic through both internal and external popliteal,
-and from the femoral and obturator. It is therefore connected
-with the lower lumbar and sacrum and with the
-second lumbar. The latter connection seems oftenest involved
-in knee joint inflammations.</p>
-
-<p><i>Foot</i>: Fourth and fifth lumbar and sacral nerves
-through the great sciatic and its branches.</p>
-
-<p><i>Sensor Areas of Lower Extremity</i>: In general, any
-given cutaneous area receives sensor branches from the
-nerve which supplies the subjacent muscle area. For accurate
-diagnostic purposes a good chart of sensor distribution
-may be consulted.</p>
-
-<h3 id="h_51">DISEASES AND ADJUSTMENTS</h3>
-
-<p>The appended list includes the diseases with which the
-profession has had experience but is not in any sense a
-complete list of diseases. It is merely intended for quick
-and handy reference. In obscure cases or diseases not
-mentioned it is suggested that the practitioner carefully
-diagnose the case with reference to the <em>location</em> of the morbid
-process and then refer to Special Nerve Connections
-to find the nerve pathway between the spine and the organ
-indicated as the seat of the disease. Standard works on
-anatomy and physiology will explain more fully the paths
-and functions of the nerves but information gleaned from
-them must be sought out and pieced together from scattered
-statements and discussions.</p>
-
-<table id="diseases" class="p1 narrow" summary="Diseases and Adjustments">
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">A<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_258">258</a></span></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc" style="width: 50%;"><i>Disease</i></td>
- <td class="tdc" style="width: 50%;"><i>Adjustment.</i></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Abscess</td>
- <td class="tdl">According to location.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Accommodative iridoplegia</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 3 or 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Acid stomach</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 6 or 7.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Acne</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Acoria</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 6 or 7.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Acromegaly</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1 or 2, D 10, 11, or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Addison’s disease</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 10.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Adenitis</td>
- <td class="tdl">According to location.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Adenoids of pharynx</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 2 or 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Adiposis dolorosa</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 8 and D 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Adrenals, tuberculosis of</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 10.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Ageusia</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1 or 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Ague</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 4, D 9, D 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Albuminuria</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 10, 11, or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Albumosuria</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 8, D 10, 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Alcoholism</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1, D 10, 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Amenorrhoea</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 4 or 5.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Amnesia</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1 or 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Amyosthenia</td>
- <td class="tdl">General.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Amyloid liver</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Amyloid kidney</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 10, 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Anachlorhydria</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 6 or 7.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Anaemia</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 4, D 9 and D 11 or 12. Sometimes L 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Anaesthesia, general</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1 or 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Anasarca</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 10, 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Aneurism</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 1 or according to location.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Angina pectoris</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Aniscoria</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Anorexia nervosa</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1, D 6 or 7.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Anosmia</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1 or 2, C 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Anthracosis</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 3.<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_259">259</a></span></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Anterior poliomyelitis</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 3 or 4. local zones for permanent paralyses following.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Anuria</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 10, 11 or 12. Or L 2 or 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Aortic stenosis</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Aphasia</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1 or 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Aphonia</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 6.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Aphthous stomatitis</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Apoplexy</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 2, 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Appendicitis</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Apraxia</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1 or 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Argyll-Robertson pupil</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1 or 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Arrhythmia</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 2 or D 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Arteriosclerosis</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 10, 11 or 12 and local.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Arteritis</td>
- <td class="tdl">According to location.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Arthritis</td>
- <td class="tdl">According to location.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Arthritis deformans</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 10, 11 or 12 and according to location.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Ascarides</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 2 or 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Ascites</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Asphyxia, gas</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 2 or 3, Atlas (First aid only).</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Asthenia</td>
- <td class="tdl">To correct disease producing same.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Asthenopia</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Asthma</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 1.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Ataxia, cerebellar</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1 or 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Ataxia, locomotor</td>
- <td class="tdl">General adjustment.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Athetosis</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1 or 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Atrophic cirrhosis of liver</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Atrophy</td>
- <td class="tdl">According to location.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Aural discharges</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1, 2, 3 or 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">B<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_260">260</a></span></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Back, pain in</td>
- <td class="tdl">According to location.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Barber’s itch</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 5, D 10, 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Bell’s palsy</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 2, 3 or 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Biliousness</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Blepharitis</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 3 or 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Blepharospasm</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 3 or 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Blindness</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1, 2, 3 or 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">“Blood poisoning”</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 10, 11 or 12 and local.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Boils</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 10, 11 or 12 and according to location.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Bradycardia</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 1 or 2, possibly C 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Bright’s disease</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 10, 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Bronchitis</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 1.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Bronchiectasis</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 1.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Broncho-pneumonia</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 1, D 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">C</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Caked breast</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Calculi, cystic</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 2 or 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Calculi, hepatic</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Calculi, renal</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 10, 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Cancer</td>
- <td class="tdl">No cure.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Cancrum oris</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 2 or 3, D 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Canker (mouth)</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Carbuncle</td>
- <td class="tdl">According to location.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Carcinoma</td>
- <td class="tdl">No cure.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Caries of spine</td>
- <td class="tdl">According to location. See “<a href="#h_65">Prognosis</a>.”</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Cataract</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 2, 3, or 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Catarrh, nasal</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Catarrhal gastritis</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 6 or 7.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Catarrhal stomatitis</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 2 or 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Cerebral abscess</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1 or 2.<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_261">261</a></span></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Cerebrospinal meningitis</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Cervical glands, enlargement of</td>
- <td class="tdl">Any cervical.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Cervico-brachial neuralgia</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 6.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Cervico-occipital neuralgia</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1 or 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Chickenpox</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 5, D 10, 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Chills</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 5.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Chlorosis</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 4, D 9, D 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Cholangitis</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Cholecystitis</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Cholelithiasis</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Cholera infantum</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 5 or 6, D 10, 11 or 12, L 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Chorea</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1 or 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Chyluria</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 8, D 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Cirrhosis of liver</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Claw hand</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 6 or 7 or D 1.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Clubfoot</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 4 or 5.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Colic, hepatic</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Colic, renal</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 10, 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Colitis</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 2 or 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Collapse</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1, D 2, and according to associated condition.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Coma</td>
- <td class="tdl">According to cause.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Conjunctivitis</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 3 or 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Constipation</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 4, D 10, or L 3, 4 or 5.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Contractures</td>
- <td class="tdl">According to location.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Coryza</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Coxalgia</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Cramp</td>
- <td class="tdl">According to location.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Croup</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 2 or C 6.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Cutaneous eruptions</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 10, 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Cyanosis</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 2, D 3 or C 2.<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_262">262</a></span></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Cystitis</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 2 or L 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">D</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Deafness, catarrhal</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Deafness, central</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1 or 2 (P).</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Delirium</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1 or 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Dementia</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Dengue</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 5, D 10, 11 or 12 (P).</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Dentition, disorders of</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 6 or 7.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Diabetes insipidus</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 10, 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Diabetes mellitus</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 4, D 8, D 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Diarrhoea</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 10, 11 or L 2, 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Dilatation of heart</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Diphtheria</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 2, C 6 and D 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Dipsomania</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1 or 2, D 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Dropsy, abdominal</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Dropsy, cardiac</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Dropsy, renal</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 10, 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Duodenal ulcer</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 8 or 9.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Duodenitis</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 8 or 9.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Dysentery</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 2, 3, or 4 and D 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Dysmenorrhoea</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Dyspepsia</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 7.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Dysphagia</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 2 or D 6 or 7 (P).</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Dyspnea</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 1 or D 2 or D 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Dysuria</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 2 or L 4 or sacrum.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">E</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Earache</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 2 or C 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Ecchymoses</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Eczema</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 11 or 12 and according to location.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Embolism, cerebral</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 2 or 3.<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_263">263</a></span></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Emphysema</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Encephalitis</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1, 2 or 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Endocarditis</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Enlarged glands</td>
- <td class="tdl">According to location.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Enlarged heart</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Enlarged liver</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Enlarged tonsils</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 2 or 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Enteralgia</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 9 or 10, or L 1 or 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Enteritis</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 9 or 10, or L 1 or 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Enterocolitis</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 9 or 10, or L 1, 2 or 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Enteroptosis</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 9, 10, 11 or L 1, 2, 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Enterospasm</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 9 or 10, or L 1 or 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Enuresis</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 2 or 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Epilepsy</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1 or 2, sometimes L 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Epistaxis</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Epithelioma</td>
- <td class="tdl">No cure.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Eructations</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 6 or 7.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Eruptions, cutaneous</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Erysipelas</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 5 and D 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Exophthalmic goitre</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 6 or 7.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">F</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Facial hemiatrophy</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1 or 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Facial paralysis</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1 or 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Faecal obstruction</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 2, 3 or 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Fainting</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">False angina</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1 or 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Fatty degeneration of heart</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Fatty degeneration of liver</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Fatty infiltration of heart</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 2.<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_264">264</a></span></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Fatty infiltration of liver</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Felon</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 6 or 7 or D 1.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Fever</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 5. Locate organ of origin.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Fibroid tumor</td>
- <td class="tdl">According to location.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Follicular tonsilitis</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 2 or 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">G</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Gallstones</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Gangrene</td>
- <td class="tdl">According to location.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Gastralgia</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 6 or 7.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Gastrectasia</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 6 or 7.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Gastric neuroses</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 6 or 7.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Gastric ulcer</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 6 or 7.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Gastritis</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 6 or 7.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Gastro-duodenitis</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 7 or 8.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Gastroptosis</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 6 or 7.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Gland, mammary</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Glaucoma</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 2 or 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Gleet</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 3 and D 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Glossitis</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 2 or 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Glycosuria</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 4 and D 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Goitre</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 6.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Gonorrhoea</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Gonnorrhoeal rheumatism</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 11 or 12 and L 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Gout</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 11 or 12 and L 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Granulated lids</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 4 and D 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">H</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Hay fever</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 3 or 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Headache, anaemia</td>
- <td class="tdl">To correct anaemia.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Headache, bilious</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Headache, neuralgic</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1.<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_265">265</a></span></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Headache, neurasthenic</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1 or 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Headache, ocular</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 2 or C 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Headache, of constipation</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 4 or D 9 or 10, or L 4 or 5.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Headache, toxic</td>
- <td class="tdl">Locate toxin-forming organ.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Headache, uterine</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 4 or 5 or sacrum.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Hematemesis</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 6 or 7.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Hematuria</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 10, 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Hemicrania</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1, 2 or 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Hemiplegia</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 2 or 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Hemoptysis</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Hemorrhoids</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 4 or 5 or sacrum.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Hepatic hyperemia</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Hepatoptosis</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Hernia, diaphragmatic</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 4 (P).</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Hernia, femoral</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Hernia, inguinal</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 2 or 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Hernia, umbilical</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 8.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Herpes facialis</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Herpes zoster (shingles)</td>
- <td class="tdl">Vertebra above nerve involved.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Hiccough</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Hodgkins’ disease</td>
- <td class="tdl">General adjustment.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Hydrocele</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 10, 11 or 12 and L 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Hydrocephalus</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 2 and D 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Hydronephrosis</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 10, 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Hydropericardium</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Hydrothorax</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Hyperaemia</td>
- <td class="tdl">According to location.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Hyperaesthesia, general</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1 or 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Hyperchlorhydria</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 6 or 7.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Hypertrophy</td>
- <td class="tdl">According to location.<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_266">266</a></span></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Hysteria</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Hystero-epilepsy</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">I</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Icterus</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Icterus neonatorum</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Ileocolitis</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 2, 3 or 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Impacted gallstones in ducts</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Impotence</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 3 or sacrum.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Incontinence of urine</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 2 or L 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Incompetency, aortic</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 1 or 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Incompetency, mitral</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 1 or 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Incompetency, pulmonary</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 1 or 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Incompetency, pyloric</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 6 or 7.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Incompetency, tricuspid</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 1 or 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Infantile paralysis</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 3 or 4 and according to location.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Inflammation, general</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 5.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Inflammation of appendix</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Inflammation of bladder</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 2 or 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Inflammation of bowels</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 9 or 10, L 2, 3 or 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Inflammation of bronchi</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 1.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Inflammation of kidneys</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Inflammation of larynx</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 6.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Inflammation of lungs</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Inflammation of meninges</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1 or 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Inflammation of ovaries</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 2 or 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Inflammation of pharynx</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Inflammation of pleurae</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Inflammation of stomach</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 6 or 7.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Inflammation of vertebrae</td>
- <td class="tdl">Next above inflamed one.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Inflammation of uterus</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 4 or 5.<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_267">267</a></span></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Influenza</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 4, D 1, D 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Intestinal neuralgia</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 9 or 10, L 1 or 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Intestinal neuroses</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 9 or 10, L 1 or 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Intestinal obstruction</td>
- <td class="tdl">See “<a href="#h_52">Practice</a>.”</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Intussusception</td>
- <td class="tdl">See “<a href="#h_52">Practice</a>.”</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Insanity</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1 or 2, sometimes L 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Insomnia</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Iritis</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 3 or 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">J</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Jaundice</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">K</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Keratitis</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 3 or 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Kyphosis</td>
- <td class="tdl">See “<a href="#curvatures">Curvatures.</a>”</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">L</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Lactation, disorders of</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Lacunar tonsilitis</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 2 or 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">La grippe</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 4, D 1, D 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Laryngeal paralysis</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 6.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Laryngismus stridulus</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 6.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Laryngitis</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 6.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Lateral spinal sclerosis</td>
- <td class="tdl">According to location.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Lead poisoning</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 4, D 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Leucaemia</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 9 and D 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Leucorrhoea</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Lipoma</td>
- <td class="tdl">According to location.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Lobar pneumonia</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Lockjaw</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1, 2, or 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Locomotor ataxia</td>
- <td class="tdl">General adjustment.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Lordosis</td>
- <td class="tdl">See “<a href="#curvatures">Curvatures</a>.”<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_268">268</a></span></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Lumbago</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 3, 4 or 5.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Lumbo-abdominal neuralgia</td>
- <td class="tdl">Any Lumbar.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">M</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Malaria</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 4, D 9, and D 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Malignant endocarditis</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 2 and D 5 or 6.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Mastoiditis</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1 or 2.</td></tr>
- <tr id="measles">
- <td class="tdl">Measles</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 5, D 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Memory, disorders of</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1 or 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Meniere’s disease</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1 or 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Meningitis</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1 or 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Menorrhagia</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Metrorrhagia</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Migraine</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1, 2, or 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Mitral incompetency</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Mitral stenosis</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Monoplegia</td>
- <td class="tdl">According to location.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Mouth breathing</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 4 or 5.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Movable kidney</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Mucous colic</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 10 or L 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Mumps</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Mutism</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1 or 2 or C 6.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Myelitis</td>
- <td class="tdl">According to location.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Myocarditis</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Myopia</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Myositis ossificans</td>
- <td class="tdl">According to location, also D 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Myxoedema</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 6.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">N<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_269">269</a></span></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Nephritis</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 10, 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Nephrolithiasis</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 10, 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Nephroptosis</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 10, 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Neuralgia, trigeminal</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 3 or 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Neuralgia, brachial</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 6 or 7 or D 1.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Neuralgia, intercostal</td>
- <td class="tdl">According to location.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Neuralgia, of feet</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 4, L 5 or sacrum.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Neurasthenia</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Neuritis</td>
- <td class="tdl">According to location.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Nodding spasm</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1 or 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Nystagmus</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1, 2, 3 or 4 (P).</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">O</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Obesity, pathological</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 8 and D 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Obstruction, intestinal</td>
- <td class="tdl">See “<a href="#h_52">Practice</a>.”</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Oculomotor paralysis</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 2 or 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Oedema</td>
- <td class="tdl">According to location.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Optic atrophy</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 3 or 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Optic neuritis</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 3 or 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Orchitis</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Otitis media</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Ovarian disease</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">P</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Pachymeningitis</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Pallor</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 2 or to correct anaemia.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Palpitation</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 2 or C 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Pancreatic calculi</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 8.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Pancreatic hemorrhage</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 8.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Pancreatitis</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 8.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Paralysis agitans</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1 or 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Paralysis, brachial</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 6 or 7 or D 1.<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_270">270</a></span></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Paralysis, crural</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 4 or L 5.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Paralysis, facial</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1 or 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Paralysis, diplegic</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1 or 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Paralysis, hemiplegic</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1 or 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Paralysis, monoplegic</td>
- <td class="tdl">According to location.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Paralysis, sensory</td>
- <td class="tdl">According to location.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Parageusia</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1 or 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Paratyphoid fever</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Parosmia</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 2 or 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Parotitis</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Pericarditis</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Perihepatitis</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Perinephric abscess</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 10, 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Peritonitis</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 9, 10 and L 2, 3 or 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Pertussis</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 6, D 1.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Pharyngitis</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 2 or 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Photophobia</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1 or 2 or C 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Plantar neuralgia</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 4 or 5.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Pleurisy</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Pleurodynia</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Pneumonia</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Priapism</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 3 or sacrum.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Proctitis</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 4 or 5.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Prolapsed kidney</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Prolapsed uterus</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 4 or 5.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Prostatic disease</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 4 or 5 or sacrum.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Ptosis</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Puerperal fever</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 4, D 5, and D 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Pulmonary incompetence</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Pulmonary phthisis</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Pulmonary stenosis</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 2.<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_271">271</a></span></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Pyelitis</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Pyelonephrosis</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Pyaemia</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 5 or 6 and D 10, 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">Q</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Quinsy</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 2 or 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">R</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Rabies</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1 or 2, D 10, 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Rachitis</td>
- <td class="tdl">See “<a href="#adjustcurvatures">Adjustment of Curvatures</a>.”</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Raynaud’s disease</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 6 or 7 or D 1, or L 4 or 5.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Rectal fistula</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 4 or 5.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Rectal neuralgia</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 4 or 5.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Relapsing fever</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 5, D 9 and D 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Renal colic</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 10, 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Retinal hemorrhage</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Retinitis</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Retropharyngeal abscess</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 2 or 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Rheumatic fever</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 5 or 6, D 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Rheumatism</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 11 or 12 and according to location.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Rhinitis</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Roseola</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 10, 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Rubella</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 5, D 6, D 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Rubeola</td>
- <td class="tdl">See “<a href="#measles">Measles</a>.”</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">S</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Salivation</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 2, 3 or 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Salpingitis (Eustachian)</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Salpingitis (Fallopian)</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Sarcoma</td>
- <td class="tdl">No cure.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Scarlatina</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 5, D 6, D 11 or 12.<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_272">272</a></span></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Scarlet fever</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 5, D 6, D 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Sciatica</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 4 or 5, or sacrum.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Sclerosis</td>
- <td class="tdl">According to location.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Scoliosis</td>
- <td class="tdl">See “<a href="#curvatures">Curvatures</a>.”</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Scrofula</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 11 or 12 and locally.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Seminal emissions</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Septicaemia</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 5, D 11 or 12, and for site of entrance of toxins.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Smallpox</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 5, D 5, D 10, 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Sneezing</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Softening of brain</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Spasm</td>
- <td class="tdl">According to location.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Spermatorrhoea</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Splanchnoptosis</td>
- <td class="tdl">Caudad of D 5 according to palpation.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Splenic enlargement</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 9.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Splenitis</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 9.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Splenoptosis</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 9.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Spondylitis Deformans</td>
- <td class="tdl">General adjustment.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Stenosis</td>
- <td class="tdl">According to location.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Stomatitis</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 2, 3 or 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Strabismus</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 3 or 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Sudamina</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 10, 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Sunstroke</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 2, D 2, D 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Suppression of urine</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Syncope</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Syphilis, primary</td>
- <td class="tdl">According to location of ulcer.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Syphilis, secondary</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 5 or 6, D 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Syphilis, tertiary</td>
- <td class="tdl">No cure.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">T<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_273">273</a></span></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Tabes dorsalis</td>
- <td class="tdl">General adjustment.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Tapeworm</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 8, 9 or 10, L 2 or 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Tenesmus</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 4 or 5.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Tension, high arterial</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 5.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Testicles, pendulous</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Tetanus</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 4, D 5, D 10, 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Thrush</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 2 or 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Tic dolouroux</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 3 or 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Tinnitus aurium</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1 or 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Tonsilitis</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 2 or 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Toothache</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Torticollis</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 2, 3 or 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Toxaemia</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 11 or 12 and local according to indications.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Toxic gastritis</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 6 or 7.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Tricuspid incompetency</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Tricuspid stenosis</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Trigeminal neuralgia</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 3 or 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Tuberculosis of any organ</td>
- <td class="tdl">See “<a href="#h_50">Special Nerve Connections</a>” to organ diseased.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Tuberculosis, general</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 5 or 6, D 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Tuberculosis, pulmonary</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Tumor</td>
- <td class="tdl">According to location.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Typhoid fever</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Typhus fever</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 5 and L 2 (P).</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">U</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Ulceration</td>
- <td class="tdl">According to location.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Ulnar neuritis</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 1.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Ununited fracture</td>
- <td class="tdl">According to location.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Uraemia</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 10, 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Urethritis</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 3.<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_274">274</a></span></td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Urticaria</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 10, 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Uterine catarrh</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Uteroversion</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">V</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Vaccinia</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 5, D 10, 11 or 12 and for site of inoculation.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Vaginitis</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Valvular lesions</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Varicella</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 5 or 6, D 10, 11 or 12.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Varicocele</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 3.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Varicose veins of lower extremities</td>
- <td class="tdl">L 2, 3 or 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Variola</td>
- <td class="tdl">Same as Smallpox.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Varioloid</td>
- <td class="tdl">Same as Smallpox.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Vertigo</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 1 or 2. Locally for toxic vertigo.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Vomiting, pernicious</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 6 or 7 or C 1.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">W</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Whooping-cough</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 6, D 1.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Writer’s Cramp</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 6 or 7 or D 1.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Worms, stomach</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 6 or 7.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Worms, intestinal</td>
- <td class="tdl">Any Lumbar.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Wryneck</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 2, 3 or 4.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">X</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Xerostomia</td>
- <td class="tdl">C 2.</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdc hdr" colspan="2">Y</td></tr>
- <tr>
- <td class="tdl">Yellow fever</td>
- <td class="tdl">D 4, D 6, D 10, 11 or 12 (P).</td></tr>
-</table>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_275">275</a></span></p>
-
-<h3>CONCLUSION</h3>
-
-<p>The correct use of the foregoing table depends entirely
-upon correct diagnosis. Knowledge of the vertebra to be
-adjusted for the correction of any disease is useless unless
-the disease be recognized when met. Diagnosis may be, and
-usually is, aided by Palpation and Nerve-Tracing, which
-may be considered as divisions of diagnosis since the subluxation
-and the tender nerve are evidences (symptoms) of
-disease. But these two divisions can never wholly take the
-place of a complete diagnosis which calls to the aid of the
-examiner <em>every</em> harmless method of ascertaining the patient’s
-condition. The part may not suffice for the whole.</p>
-
-<p>The Chiropractor has an opportunity to become the best
-of diagnosticians because he has at his command all the
-usually taught methods and <em>in addition</em> Palpation and Nerve-Tracing,
-which are especially useful in differential diagnosis.
-(See “<a href="#h_54">Schedule of Examination</a>.”) The profession is at
-present lamentably weak in diagnosis and as long as they
-remain so they will fail to achieve the possible maximum of
-results from the application of a theory which, <i xml:lang="la" lang="la">per se</i>, is
-applicable to all disease but which is often imperfectly applied
-in practice.</p>
-
-<hr />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_276">276</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<h2 id="h_52"><a id="PRACTICE"></a>PRACTICE</h2>
-</div>
-
-<h4>Introduction</h4>
-
-<p>The ensuing section is intended rather more for the use
-of the practitioner than for the guidance of the student but
-may furnish the student a preconception which will prepare
-him somewhat, before leaving college, to meet the problems
-of practice.</p>
-
-<p>Just as too frequently the young Chiropractor overlooks
-the fundamental logic of Chiropractic which may be epitomized
-with the terse command, “Adjust the <em>cause</em>,” and considers
-his practice as requiring him to dabble in every suggested
-or discovered method of treating <em>effects</em>, so, too frequently,
-the young Chiropractor is prone to consider that
-his practice consists solely of the adjustment of vertebrae,
-that he practices a mechanic art rather than a profession; too
-frequently he overlooks the thousand details which lead to
-and surround the adjustment and are essential to its success.</p>
-
-<p>The practice of Chiropractic involves more than correct
-technic. It includes the use of a vast fund of knowledge;
-the constant study of diseases and of patients; the art of
-controlling and directing others sometimes in their very
-trivial acts. Successful practice requires a proper setting,
-proper business methods, and a knowledge of psychology.</p>
-
-<p>Anyone entering upon a profession assumes a great
-moral responsibility and the greatest responsibility of all<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_277">277</a></span>
-falls upon the doctor, of whatever school. He enters the
-stricken home at a time when all members of the household
-are off guard, as it were, at a time when all turn to him as
-to one of higher knowledge and of greater power for their
-guidance and often for their strength in affliction; he becomes
-the repository of their most sacred confidences. He who is
-unable to meet this responsibility, to realize his influence and
-his power and to prepare himself with care and conscientious
-training to acquit himself well, has mistaken his calling.
-He is unfit for his ministry.</p>
-
-<p>The thorough student wrestles not alone with the technic
-and the text-book branches necessary in practice but also
-studies his profession from every possible standpoint, broadening
-his field of usefulness wherever possible.</p>
-
-<p>This section does not by any means contain all the information
-not found elsewhere in this book but necessary to
-the Chiropractor in his practice. It is intended merely to
-suggest some of the many sides and phases of our work and
-to open the way for a life study of humanity and of professional
-life as a Chiropractor.</p>
-
-<h3 id="h_53">OFFICE EQUIPMENT</h3>
-
-<h4>Value of First Appearance</h4>
-
-<p>The patient, upon first entering an office, consciously or
-unconsciously forms an estimate of the personality and
-standing in his profession of the occupant of that office.
-This impression is gathered from the kind and arrangement<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_278">278</a></span>
-of the furniture and visible equipment, from the neatness or
-disorder of the room, from countless little things which play
-each their part in making up the whole appearance. This
-first estimate is sometimes the only one, for an unfavorable
-first impression may lead to the loss of a prospective patient.
-In any case it will play a part in all subsequent judgments
-which the patient may form concerning the Chiropractor and
-his work.</p>
-
-<p>Many patients entering our offices have no previous
-knowledge of our profession; their minds are open and
-curious, alert for new impressions of some sort. We may
-impress them as we choose. Every good business or professional
-man realizes the value of the first impression and
-strives for a good one. Therefore, upon entering practice,
-choose for yourself every article which shall have a place in
-your office. Your surroundings will then truly reflect your
-personality and will attract those upon whom that personality
-can work in harmony and understanding. It is of no avail
-to attract the type of patients you cannot hold, to draw
-through the borrowed judgment or taste of another surroundings
-alien to yourself and thus to attract people who
-will at once sense the incongruity and be repelled by it.</p>
-
-<p>Yet one may aspire. And if you are able to perceive and
-appreciate truly professional surroundings you may hope
-to school yourself by association and study to harmonize with
-them.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_279">279</a></span></p>
-
-<h4>Choice of Articles</h4>
-
-<p>In choosing the contents of your office keep in mind
-good taste, utility, and the psychological effect upon all
-visitors. Remember that you expect to spend many hours
-each day in the company of your furniture, and select such
-things as will contribute to a proper professional state of
-mind in yourself. A Chiropractor’s profession is in many
-ways like, yet in many ways unlike, any other. Therefore
-his office equipment, while following in general the equipment
-of other professional offices, must be selected with an
-eye to the special and particular needs of the Chiropractor
-and his patients. Too little attention has been paid thus far
-by the profession to the selection of office equipment.</p>
-
-<h4>Furniture in General</h4>
-
-<p>The furnishing of an office depends upon the amount
-and disposition of the room at your command. One must
-have at least a waiting room and a private office even if a
-single rented room must be cheaply partitioned to make the
-division. A larger suite is a better investment when possible.
-In the waiting-room should be found easy chairs,
-library table, hall-rack, mirror, and an easy divan or couch.
-The floor should be covered with a good rug or carpet and
-the walls properly and cleanly decorated and hung with
-restful, pleasant pictures. A book-case filled with carefully
-selected books is a good addition.</p>
-
-<p>On entering your private office the patient should see
-your diploma, which hangs in full view of the entrance and<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_280">280</a></span>
-which bespeaks with no weak voice your fitness to practice,
-your professional ability. The importance of this point
-cannot be overestimated. The intelligent visitor expects
-you to have had careful training and to possess thorough
-knowledge of your work. If he notes the diploma as evidence
-of it and of your pride in your college he is assured.</p>
-
-<p>If only two rooms are at your command the second must
-be at once consulting room, adjusting room, dressing room.
-As such it should contain your desk, desk chair, chairs for
-the patient or patients, adjusting table or tables, towel
-cabinet, lavatory, and a curtained recess for a dressing-table,
-chair, and hooks for hanging clothing. On the wall hang
-those charts from which it is at times necessary to explain
-a part of the human mechanism to the inquirer.</p>
-
-<p>This room should convey a two-fold impression—business
-and professional. It should contain the special paraphenalia
-of your profession and some of the suggestive contents
-of the ordinary business office, such as desk, card-index
-file, typewriter, etc.</p>
-
-<p>Let us consider these points more in detail.</p>
-
-<h4>Waiting Room</h4>
-
-<p>In your waiting room new patients wait and form their
-estimate of you before your appearance. They are tired
-patients, worn perhaps with years of disease, and their comfort
-must be considered. Some time is theirs for use in
-some way and the use of their minds during the waiting interval
-must be studied.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_281">281</a></span></p>
-
-<p>For these reasons first of all the waiting room should
-be furnished quietly, in perfect taste, but <em>well furnished</em>.
-A good dark rug for the floor rather than matting or linoleum
-with their suggestion of bareness, a tinted or papered
-wall done in a soothing shade, upholstered furniture pleasing
-to the eye and comfortable for tired, weak bodies, and a
-library table with proper literature for the occupation of
-the mind—these are the proper furnishings for a waiting
-room.</p>
-
-<p>Let the table contain chiefly Chiropractic literature and
-select that literature with care. Be sure that it reflects the
-view-point toward your profession with which you wish
-your patients to be impressed. It must be scientific, well
-written, not sensational, not dealing coarsely or vulgarly
-with the revolting diseases or features of disease, but quietly
-convincing. Your literature must impress with the greatness
-of Chiropractic without setting forth extravagant claims
-which your patients will expect you to vindicate. Your
-selection of books for the book-case must convince all observers
-of your proper literary taste or the book-case had
-better be omitted. Likewise the pictures on the walls must
-suggest pleasant things, restful things, good to contemplate.</p>
-
-<p>When possible secure a high-ceilinged room with good
-ventilation, plenty of fresh air without drafts. And then let
-all the articles in the room <em>harmonize</em>. One jarring note in
-form or color may mar the entire effect, which should be
-that of comfortable simplicity.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_282">282</a></span></p>
-
-<h4>Private Office</h4>
-
-<p>Even more important than the contents of the waiting
-room is the equipment of your private office. It is in this
-room that your work is done. There your patients confide
-to you their weaknesses; there they determine finally whether
-to trust themselves to your knowledge and skill; in that
-room they form their judgment as to your cleanliness, your
-use of system; <em>there they meet you</em>.</p>
-
-<h4>Arrangement of Furniture</h4>
-
-<p>Every bit of furniture for the private office having been
-carefully selected its <em>arrangement</em> should be studied.</p>
-
-<p>When the patient first enters the private office he should
-be able to see your diploma. He should also sit where he
-can notice it as he consults you and every other object within
-his vision during the consultation should be picked so as to
-avoid attracting his attention to anything foreign to his
-visit and its purpose.</p>
-
-<p>Two chairs are placed near the desk, one an easy
-chair for yourself, a revolving chair being preferable, and
-a straight-backed leather-upholstered chair for the patient.
-In placing these chairs be careful of two things: let the
-strongest light shine over your own shoulder and bring the
-face of the patient out in clear detail; and let your own
-chair be <em>higher</em> than the patient’s so that he looks slightly
-upward to meet your direct gaze. For the last mentioned
-point there is a sound psychological reason; to control any
-dialogue with another person place yourself on a higher<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_283">283</a></span>
-level than he and unconsciously he will obey the suggestion
-and lift his thought to meet yours, offering it rather than
-commanding with it. The light is arranged for its value in
-observing, as a matter of diagnosis, every indication in expression,
-gesture, and skin coloring.</p>
-
-<p>Hanging back of the desk where it may be easily reached
-but where its gruesome suggestion will not obtrude itself
-upon the nerves of the sensitive without your deliberate intention,
-have a vertebral column for demonstration purposes.
-There are many times when it is necessary to show a subluxation
-as it would occur.</p>
-
-<p>Beside the desk and within easy reach of your hand
-should be placed at least a single book-case section containing
-those reference works which you frequently consult.
-The contents of this section will be considered later;
-suffice now to say that they should be well bound and should
-be so placed that if a doubtful point arise they can be consulted
-at once without your rising. I am not of the opinion
-that a pretension of unlimited knowledge is a valuable professional
-asset. It seems better frankly to seek authoritative
-information, even in the presence of the patient, than to
-allow an error to creep into your work, and your more intelligent
-patients will appreciate your care. Furthermore,
-this placing of your books is convenient when you are alone
-and considering the cases which have passed before you
-during the day. It tempts to study.</p>
-
-<p>The desk should hold a typewriter, significant of business
-methods, and a card file for case records. Incidentally, you<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_284">284</a></span>
-should have neat bill-heads and printed stationery for all
-correspondence, though blank white paper is better than
-over-ornate design or profuse coloring.</p>
-
-<p>On the wall hang a few good anatomical and physiological
-charts upon which may be pointed out certain facts for
-the instruction of patients. It may be suggested that these
-hang on racks so that the surface charts may be easily
-changeable and that those ordinarily exposed to view be such
-as will avoid unpleasant suggestion of any kind. For instance,
-an X-Ray chart of the body showing the skeleton is
-but one degree less repugnant to the average person than
-the bones themselves. Though your college training has
-robbed the subject of all emotion, for <em>you</em>, take thought for
-the feelings of your visitors.</p>
-
-<h4>Adjusting Tables</h4>
-
-<p>For all purposes the best type of bench now on the market
-is probably that composed of two sections, one fixed
-and the other—the rear one—sliding on a track. Both
-sections should be adjustable at various angles to the plane
-of the base and some of the best tables are made so as to
-permit changes in the distance from the floor to the entire
-top or to any part of the top, a great advantage in that the
-table height may thus be made to suit the height of the
-adjuster.</p>
-
-<p>An abdominal support is now indispensable but must be
-so elastic as not to interfere with the adjustment. Leather
-upholstery is more sanitary than plush and has come into
-general use.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_285">285</a></span></p>
-
-<p>An opening in the front section such that the face may
-look downward through it and straighten the cervical and
-upper dorsal spine for palpation and adjustment has been
-proven a disadvantage instead of a help and will be entirely
-unnecessary to one who follows the technic laid down in
-this book.</p>
-
-<h4>The Roll</h4>
-
-<p>A desirable addition to this table is an upholstered roll
-of quite solid material and about eight inches in diameter.
-This can be placed under the patient’s thighs on the rear
-section, thus elevating the thighs and straightening the
-Lumbar region so as to separate the spinous processes. The
-roll is especially useful for the adjustment of posterior Lumbar
-subluxations, being inadvisable with rotation.</p>
-
-<p>With a patient lying on the bifid bench in the ordinary
-adjusting position the Lumbar spinous processes are crowded
-together and the bodies separated. In rotation, since the
-adjustment works by using a short power arm against a
-long weight arm (distance from contact point to center of
-rotation against distance from center of rotation to anterior
-margin of body), and since the heaviest portion of the vertebra—the
-body—is to be moved most, this position of suspension
-secures the easiest adjustment. But if the vertebra
-be posterior and a spinous process contact is used the best
-adjustment can be secured over the roll or with a table adjustable
-to an angle equal to that which would be secured
-with the roll.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_286">286</a></span></p>
-
-<h4>Cleanliness</h4>
-
-<p>Everything in the office should be kept scrupulously
-clean. A lavatory with towel racks well filled with clean
-towels is an absolute necessity. If no lavatory is inbuilt in
-the office a portable one may be secured which will answer
-every purpose. It will be well if the patient observes that
-you carefully cleanse your hands before giving an adjustment.</p>
-
-<p>The office should contain a towel cabinet with a stack
-of clean towels and a compartment for used towels. Or
-tissue towels may be used to save laundry bills. Before
-each adjustment a clean towel should be unfolded and placed
-upon the front section of the bench so that the patient rests
-head and face upon a perfectly clean surface. When the
-adjustment is completed toss the towel into the used-towel
-compartment. This use of towels minimizes the risk of
-contagion or infection from a germ-infested upholstery,
-suggests care and cleanliness to your patient, and gives the
-patient greater trust in you.</p>
-
-<h4>Dressing-room</h4>
-
-<p>A curtained recess separated by a screen from the remainder
-of the room will serve if no separate room is available
-for a dressing-room. It is better, if possible, to have a
-separate dressing-room and better still to have separate
-dressing-rooms for men and women. If extra rooms are
-not at your command and you use a curtained recess be
-sure that it contains good light, a dressing-table with mirror,<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_287">287</a></span>
-a small chair, and hooks for clothing. Provide also a few
-dressing-sacks for women though most of them will prefer
-to furnish their own.</p>
-
-<h4>The Rest Room</h4>
-
-<p>It is a known fact that the patient who can be kept in a
-quiet, restful, and relaxed state for some time following the
-adjustment derives the greatest benefit therefrom. Having
-loosened subluxated vertebrae by adjustment their tendency
-is to settle in their old abnormal position and every movement
-of the patient for a time aids this tendency. Quiet
-permits adaptation of surrounding tissues to the changed
-position of the vertebra; action facilitates the re-adaptation
-of the vertebra to the state of surrounding tissues.</p>
-
-<p>If possible a special room should be provided in which
-patients may lie down in comfort for twenty or thirty minutes
-following an adjustment. If more than one patient at
-a time is to rest, separate rooms should be provided for
-men and women. The rest rooms should have high ceilings
-and excellent ventilation without drafts. The floors should
-be carpeted so as to soften footfalls and suggest quiet and
-rest. Potted plants adorn such a room very well and always
-afford a pleasant suggestion.</p>
-
-<p>The patients lie on cots, foldable for convenience when
-not in use, and should lie on their backs as quietly as possible.
-Some prefer solid cots on rollers so that the cot may be
-noiselessly rolled beside the adjusting table after the adjustment,
-the patient may by one turn move himself upon it, and<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_288">288</a></span>
-it may then be gently rolled into the rest room. This is a
-more finished, if more expensive, handling of the problem.</p>
-
-<p>It may be well to furnish some occupation for the mind
-and to this end, since reading in such a position is injurious
-to the eyes, a good phonograph is a valuable addition. Equip
-it with a soft parlor needle and select only soothing, restful
-music. Just as you would avoid doing the walls of the rest
-room in striking or garish colors, exciting to a diseased
-mind, so avoid exciting or harsh music. The object of this
-room is <em>rest</em> for mind and body. Let every thought be directed
-to that end. With some patients the use of the
-phonograph or other amusement must be avoided. Study
-your cases with care.</p>
-
-<p>The trip to the Chiropractor’s office is too often regarded
-in the light of an unpleasant necessity. If proper care be
-used in equipping an office and if such means as have been
-suggested for the rest room be employed, these in addition
-to the pleasing personality of the Chiropractor may make
-of the visit a pleasant thing, a part of the day to be anticipated
-with eagerness.</p>
-
-<h4>A Complete Suite</h4>
-
-<p>The number of rooms in a perfectly convenient suite
-depends upon the approximate number of cases to be handled
-daily. If it is needful to economize the practitioner’s
-time a greater number of rooms will be required than would
-be desirable with a small practice.</p>
-
-<p>A waiting room, a consulting room, two or more adjusting<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_289">289</a></span>
-rooms, and two rest rooms make probably the best
-number and employment of rooms. It is desirable if possible
-that the adjusting room be used for that purpose only
-and that there be separate rooms for men and women. Each
-adjusting room can then have its own dressing room or
-recess. Or in addition to the other rooms named above
-there may be many small rooms each containing an adjusting
-table and a rest cot and each serving as the rest
-room after the adjustment. If a sufficient number be provided
-as many patients can be handled in this way as time
-permits, the practitioner need lose no time at all, and each
-patient may have a room entirely to himself throughout
-his visit.</p>
-
-<h4>Reference Library</h4>
-
-<p>This should consist of those standard works to which
-you will necessarily refer most often. Gray, Morris, or
-other standard anatomical authority, Brubaker’s or Haliburton’s
-physiology, Butler or Osier on diagnosis, Delafield
-and Prudden on pathology, Morat on the physiology of the
-nervous system, Bing on regional diagnosis of nerve lesions,
-one or two good works on psychology, gynecology, histology,
-etc., a good medical dictionary, and any books on Chiropractic
-in which you have confidence make up an excellent
-list. Any standard works will suffice and this list is merely
-suggested for those who may be uncertain as to their own
-tastes. Always examine a book before buying it, even those
-named above. Next to works on Chiropractic no single<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_290">290</a></span>
-book is as necessary or useful as a good medical dictionary,
-preferably a large and complete one.</p>
-
-<h4>Door Sign</h4>
-
-<p>Your door should bear a sign in gold or black, setting
-forth your name and business and perhaps your office hours.
-It may read, “W. R. Jones, Chiropractor,” or, “Jones &amp;
-Jones, Chiropractors,” with office hours appended. Avoid
-repetitions such as “Dr. W. R. Jones, Chiropractor,” or
-“W. R. Jones, D. C., Chiropractor.”</p>
-
-<h4>Advertising</h4>
-
-<p>The word of a satisfied patient to his friend is the best
-advertisement. Beyond this, considerable diversity of opinion
-exists as to what constitutes proper, ethical, and wise
-advertising. I shall make no attempt to settle this question
-but shall simply suggest that while it is undoubtedly necessary
-often to explain to the public through various avenues
-what Chiropractic is and what it can do it is wise to be as
-reserved and dignified as possible and to avoid offense to
-any. Thus it is clearly unwise to advertise that your competitor
-is a fraud, much wiser to convince your readers by
-the logic and strength of your statements that <em>you</em> are not.
-Consider good taste and avoid unpleasant references to
-loathsome or vulgar diseases. Such advertising is associated
-in the public mind with quackery, with patent medicines
-and medical institutes, and no matter how sincere and right
-your motives may be it will be misinterpreted by those you
-wish to reach.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_291">291</a></span></p>
-
-<p>Consider also the legal side of advertising. Study the
-laws of your state and avoid any statement which will conflict
-with the law. In some states it is illegal to advertise
-with the term “Dr.” unless you hold a medical license. In
-others to advertise to “treat,” “cure,” or “heal” disease is
-to practice medicine technically. Such statements miss the
-truth, in any case, because the Chiropractor administers an
-adjustment and not a treatment and because Nature alone
-can cure or heal.</p>
-
-<h4>Collection Cards</h4>
-
-<p>Different communities respond to different collection
-methods. With one class of patients it may be better never
-to mention fees except to answer inquiry and simply to submit
-monthly statements of account to all patients. With
-another it is necessary to charge in advance. More Chiropractors
-use this method than any other and many use cards
-for the purpose.</p>
-
-<p>These cards are best printed with name, address, telephone
-number, etc., on one side and on the other six or
-twelve spaces ruled off at one end for punching to indicate
-adjustments given, and the words, “Good for six (or twelve)
-Chiropractic adjustments at (office) (residence) when
-properly countersigned.” A line should be left below for
-your signature and at the bottom the price of the card
-should be printed plainly. If desired a space may be left
-for the patient’s name so that the card may be made non-transferable.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_292">292</a></span></p>
-
-<p>The card is issued at the beginning of a course of adjustments
-and a duplicate is kept on file. Each time the
-patient is adjusted he presents his card before leaving and
-one space is punched out. By this system both the patient
-and the adjuster may know exactly the number of adjustments
-given and accounts may be easily kept. Without it,
-a book entry of some sort must be made for every adjustment.</p>
-
-<p>The best thing about this system is that it reminds the
-patient that you expect to be paid in advance without the
-necessity of your saying so, since the words “in advance”
-follow the statement of price on the card. At the time of
-payment you give him, as a receipt, a card entitling him to a
-certain amount of your service at a stipulated place.</p>
-
-<h4 id="h_54">Schedule of Examination</h4>
-
-<p>This method of procedure for the investigation of new
-cases is offered as a suggestion to be followed as far as the
-education of the Chiropractor will permit. If every practitioner
-adopts some such method of making his own diagnoses
-he will advance in ability much more rapidly than by
-accepting the diagnoses given his patients by physicians or
-others. We should remember, though without arrogance,
-that our special ability to discover subluxations and our
-knowledge of their significance as the primary causes of disease
-renders us better prepared for correct diagnosis than
-our medical friends, other education being equal.</p>
-
-<p>It should be quite obvious that in attempting the accomplishment<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_293">293</a></span>
-of any object it is necessary first to have in
-mind a clear preconception of the things to be accomplished,
-and second, to have a clear and concise, yet complete, outline
-of the steps to be taken, their order or sequence, and their
-relative importance in the accomplishment. These two
-needs, as regards a Chiropractic diagnosis, we shall endeavor
-to supply in this section.</p>
-
-<p>Chiropractic Diagnosis properly consists of three parts,
-Vertebral Palpation, Nerve-Tracing, and Symptomatology,
-together with the reasoning necessary to properly weigh and
-summarize the facts ascertained. Of these three divisions
-two fall properly under the head of Physical Diagnosis and
-the third, symptomatology, should consist principally of
-physical diagnosis.</p>
-
-<p>Everywhere the physical or objective sign is given preference
-over the subjective symptom. Before a single question
-is asked of the patient relative to the case or its history,
-every other means of obtaining information properly coming
-under the head of a Chiropractic diagnosis should be utilized.
-The questions should come last and be very few and direct.
-They should serve only to illuminate the few remaining
-doubtful points in the mind of the examiner, points which
-perhaps exist only because of some fault or weakness in his
-methods of examination.</p>
-
-<p>The proper order of examination is as follows:</p>
-
-<p>1. General Observation.</p>
-
-<p>2. Vertebral Palpation.</p>
-
-<p>3. Nerve Tracing.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_294">294</a></span></p>
-
-<p>4. Special Examination.</p>
-
-<p>5. History of Case.</p>
-
-<p>6. Summary.</p>
-
-<h4>General Observation</h4>
-
-<p>Observation of the patient with a view to determining
-any signs of disease should begin with the moment the
-patient steps into the office. It should continue during your
-conversation and during the Vertebral Palpation and Nerve
-Tracing which follow. The mind of the examiner should
-be constantly on the alert to note any sign on any exposed
-part of the patient’s body, or any motion which may betray
-the nature of the disease or diseases with which he suffers.</p>
-
-<p>Before preparing the patient for palpation observe temperament,
-position and carriage of head, body, and limbs,
-and facies.</p>
-
-<p>Ask male patients to strip to the waist and female
-patients to remove all clothing down to the waist except
-a loose gown or kimono, which is worn reversed so that it
-opens behind and exposes the spine to direct examination.
-No greater error can be committed than to attempt examination
-of the vertebral column through clothing or other
-covering. Examine with patient seated on a bench or stool
-with feet evenly placed upon the floor. If the patient is for
-any reason unable to assume this position the examination
-may be varied somewhat.</p>
-
-<p>While in this position continue observation of points
-mentioned above and observe also condition of skin, whether<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_295">295</a></span>
-abnormal in color, moisture or nutrition, or whether there
-is flushing, cyanosis, or pallor, roughness, eruption, etc.; the
-condition of bones and joints other than vertebral; general
-emaciation or obesity, local malnutrition or hypertrophy;
-evidences of operation, scars etc.; and action of muscles
-more in detail than is indicated under position and carriage
-of parts.</p>
-
-<p>Having observed these things discontinue general observation
-and all other considerations for the time in favor of
-Vertebral Palpation.</p>
-
-<h4>Vertebral Palpation</h4>
-
-<p>The primary object of Vertebral Palpation is the location
-of subluxations, or partial displacements, and the determination
-of the relative degree and direction of those
-found. Next comes the recording of subluxations in such
-a manner that a perusal of your record will enable you to
-reconstruct at any time a mental picture of the spine, as
-far as possible. (See <a href="#h_11">Record</a>.) With the making of the
-record the proper form of adjustment for the correction of
-each subluxation is decided.</p>
-
-<p>Finally, by <em>failing</em> to find subluxation in certain segments
-you may safely eliminate those segments from consideration
-and confine your further attention to the remainder.
-(See <a href="#h_48">Spino-Organic Connection</a>.) It must be borne in
-mind that while the finding of a subluxation is not always
-positive evidence of the necessity for adjustment there, the
-<em>absence</em> of subluxation of any spinal segment is proof positive<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_296">296</a></span>
-that no disease exists in the corresponding somatic
-segment. Differential diagnosis is thus often greatly aided
-by palpation.</p>
-
-<h4>Nerve Tracing</h4>
-
-<p>Having thus narrowed the field of operation, trace from
-spine to periphery every nerve tender enough to be traced,
-noting the relation of the tender nerves to the subluxations
-already found by palpation. Whenever it is possible note
-the <em>degree</em> of tenderness of the various nerves and keep in
-mind through the remainder of the examination the fact that
-greater tenderness in some one segment indicated either
-greater or more acute disease in that segment.</p>
-
-<p>It is best to use great caution about entirely eliminating
-any segment from consideration because of negative findings
-in attempted nerve tracing. The fact that no nerve is traceable
-is not always proof that no impingement exists, but only
-that no <em>irritation</em> exists. Only light or acute impingement
-may irritate a nerve. In forty, and possibly fifty, per cent
-of all cases no nerves are traceable at any time. (See <a href="#h_23">Nerve-Tracing</a>.)</p>
-
-<h4>Special Examination</h4>
-
-<p>The examiner has by this time formed some concept of
-the case in hand. He has a clue to the possible nature of
-the disease and he has narrowed his observation to a few
-segments of the body or a few organs which demand a
-more special examination. This may be accomplished by
-Inspection, Palpation, Auscultation, and Percussion.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_297">297</a></span></p>
-
-<h4>History of Case</h4>
-
-<p>Having determined by these methods every fact possible
-of determination without information from the patient, it
-becomes necessary to go somewhat into the history of the
-case. The history of falls, jars, shocks, or injuries of any
-kind should be taken first and these should be viewed in the
-light of their bearing upon the previously ascertained condition
-of the spine. Sometimes the definite history of an
-accident immediately preceding the development of disease
-symptoms suggests its connection with the disease and the
-exact nature of the accident points out to us some one of
-the several recorded subluxations as the one involved. This
-in turn may aid a doubtful differential diagnosis. Each
-step in the process of examination helps to explain and
-clarify the facts elicited by other steps until the facts marshal
-themselves into a complete and comprehensible picture.</p>
-
-<p>At this point it will be possible to stop in some cases and
-rest upon the evidence gathered. If you are able at this
-time to state clearly the nature of the case, the manner of its
-cause, the site of disease and of the subluxations causing it,
-the kind of subluxations, and the chance of recovery under
-adjustment, it is preferable to do so. You will thus have
-made a complete diagnosis without recourse to information
-from the patient except the history of injuries.</p>
-
-<p>Sometimes, however, it will be necessary to go further
-into the case and ascertain the presence and nature of subjective
-symptoms. If this be necessary, the examiner should<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_298">298</a></span>
-confine his questions to the parts indicated as diseased, and
-thus limit the number of questions and make them all direct
-and essential. It is important to avoid trivial or irrelevant
-questioning.</p>
-
-<h4>Summary</h4>
-
-<p>Finally, having ascertained all necessary facts, mentally
-summarize them all, combining the results of Palpation,
-Nerve-Tracing, and Symptomatology so as to reach a definite
-conclusion as to the location and nature of the morbid
-process, the subluxation producing it, and the exact form of
-adjustment necessary to correct it.</p>
-
-<p>The examiner should be able at the end of the examination
-to state exactly what he finds to be the condition of
-the patient, to give reasons and nerve connections, and to
-demonstrate a subluxation to back every statement.</p>
-
-<p>The case record should contain all essential information
-relating to the diagnosis and the correction to be applied.</p>
-
-<h4 id="h_55">Necessity for Correct Diagnosis</h4>
-
-<p>Diagnosis, in a restricted sense, means merely the naming
-of diseases. But in the broader and more proper sense it
-means disease knowing and includes a knowledge of the
-causal factors, the location and nature of disease, the
-amount of damage to structure and of functional disturbance,
-and the probable duration and outcome of the case
-either with or without Chiropractic adjustments. In this
-broader sense we use the term hereafter.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_299">299</a></span></p>
-
-<p>The object of diagnosis is correct adjustment. Including
-as it does palpation, nerve-tracing, and symptomatology,
-the Chiropractor’s diagnosis of a case should embrace all
-the knowledge upon which he proceeds with his adjustment.</p>
-
-<p>There are really two all-important questions which constantly
-recur to confront the busy practitioner. One is,
-“What is the matter with my patient?” and the other, “What
-can I do to relieve him?” Practice resolves itself into these
-two divisions, diagnosis and adjustment.</p>
-
-<p>The real question which should suggest itself to the
-thinking Chiropractor is not, then, “Should a Chiropractor
-study diagnosis?” but rather, “From what viewpoint should
-we study diagnosis? Upon what portions of the subject
-shall we concentrate our attention?”</p>
-
-<p>Undoubtedly the most important branch of diagnosis
-to us is vertebral palpation. By its use we discover those
-facts about the spinal column without which we are entirely
-unable to proceed as Chiropractors. Knowledge concerning
-the spine is the <em>most essential</em> part of diagnosis.</p>
-
-<p>Next in order of importance comes the study of physical
-or objective signs throughout the body—the examination
-of the body for the discovery of all the changes in the
-size, shape, position, etc., of organs which indicate disease.
-This includes nerve-tracing, which in some cases
-is the most important branch of physical diagnosis after
-vertebral palpation.</p>
-
-<p>Finally, a certain degree of examination for <em>subjective</em>
-symptoms may be necessary. But the Chiropractor of the<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_300">300</a></span>
-future should become, and probably will become, par excellence
-a <em>physical diagnostician</em>.</p>
-
-<p>For many reasons we should be able to rely upon our
-own diagnoses. Capability in diagnosis renders us independent
-of the errors or false beliefs of others. Since it
-includes a knowledge of subluxations, not included in medical
-training but still vital to correct interpretation of morbid
-phenomena, it can be more accurate than any diagnosis
-which ignores these causal factors. A habit of diagnosing
-one’s own cases enables one, always resting on his own
-judgment, to correct and improve himself through all errors,
-for which he is then alone responsible.</p>
-
-<p>A general knowledge of medical diagnosis, of pathology,
-bacteriology, etc., enables a Chiropractor to meet the physician
-on common ground; in fact, it gives the Chiropractor
-a distinct advantage, since he knows not only what his
-medical friend knows but also the all-important facts regarding
-the spine which are unknown to others. Such
-knowledge and the ability to discuss disease intelligently
-also furnishes common ground with every patient. Each
-patient is a specialist in the disease he believes himself to
-have and he expects from his doctor a greater knowledge
-than his own.</p>
-
-<p>The recognition of contagious or infectious diseases
-as such is an absolute necessity in order to obey the laws
-and safeguard the public health. The exact condition and
-degree of vitality of the patient and the knowledge of the
-existence of abscess, gangrene, intestinal obstruction, etc.,<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_301">301</a></span>
-often warns the Chiropractor that his adjustment would be
-dangerous to the patient. Much possible injury is avoided
-by accurate diagnosis. Even the frequency with which
-adjustments should be given depends upon diagnosis.</p>
-
-<h4>Special Cases</h4>
-
-<p>There are certain cases which a Chiropractor is powerless
-to aid and immediate recognition of such cases will save
-much trouble. In intestinal obstruction from intussusception
-or from strangulated hernia, for instance, it is best to
-advise the calling of a surgeon immediately, while in obstruction
-from volvulus or intestinal paralysis the adjustments
-may afford relief and should at least be tried first
-of all.</p>
-
-<p>Any internal abscess presents a possibility of rupture
-into a serous cavity or the substance of a parenchymatous
-organ and is therefore dangerous, while a superficial abscess,
-pointing toward the surface, can best be cared for
-by adjustment. A badly ulcerated or gangrenous appendix
-may rupture under adjustment and be followed by diffuse
-peritonitis. The fragile walls of the ileum in typhoid may
-perforate under adjustment, while in its earlier stages the
-disease is easily curable. The rotted vertebral bodies in
-Potts’ Disease (spinal caries) may be crushed under the
-heavy hand of an ignorant adjuster.</p>
-
-<p>Intelligent case-taking <em>must</em> include accurate diagnosis.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_302">302</a></span></p>
-
-<h4 id="h_56">Frequency of Adjustments</h4>
-
-<p>The frequency of adjustments in practice should be
-determined entirely by the nature of the case and the circumstances
-in which patient and adjuster are placed. No
-hard and fast rules can be laid down but some general
-advice may be profitable.</p>
-
-<p>Acute fever cases may be adjusted, until the fever is
-broken, oftener than any other type of cases. The chief
-object is the regulation of the temperature, after which
-the body is able properly to repair itself. Sometimes it
-may be necessary to give from two to six adjustments in
-a day and in at least one tetanus case the adjustments were
-given at intervals of about ten minutes for several hours
-until the fever was under control. After such a series it
-is wisest to refrain from adjusting again for several days
-so that the patient may recuperate during the interval, providing
-the fever does not return. It has been noticed that
-after a series of adjustments given at short intervals the
-improvement of the patient often extends over a period of
-days or weeks.</p>
-
-<p>In ordinary chronic cases, with good vitality and reactive
-power, the daily adjustment is best at first. Then after
-a course of from six to twenty-four adjustments according
-to the judgment of the practitioner, the interval is lengthened
-and adjustments given on alternate days, a day of rest
-intervening between each two. In weak patients or those
-who are extremely sensitive, the shock of the daily adjustment,
-even at first, and the demand on the body’s recuperative
-power may be greater than can be met.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_303">303</a></span></p>
-
-<p>In this connection it may be mentioned that the author
-has encountered several cases of dorsal lordosis produced
-by too heavy and too frequent adjustments, straining the
-ligaments faster than they could be repaired and continuing
-the strain over too long a period. It is possible to <em>over-adjust</em>
-a patient, producing a weakened spine and other
-deleterious effects, just as it is possible to establish a “tolerance”
-for a drug by long continued use.</p>
-
-<p>During a long course of adjustments it is well to allow
-the patient an occasional week of complete rest, or even
-more, and it may be wise after a time to reduce the number
-of adjustments to two per week in some cases.</p>
-
-<p>On the other hand, the practice of giving one adjustment
-a week from the beginning, as followed by some
-practitioners who maintain offices in numerous localities and
-visit each one day per week, is not generally productive of
-good results and it is the author’s practice to refuse new
-cases who profess their inability to take more than one
-adjustment weekly. The interval is so long that all repair
-work started by each adjustment is completed and an involutionary
-change sets in before the next.</p>
-
-<h4 id="h_57">Specific vs. General Adjusting</h4>
-
-<p>By specific adjusting is meant the selection and adjustment
-of the vertebra or vertebrae which are known to be
-causing definite disease or weakness. The term “specific
-adjustment” implies that there is a particular reason existing
-and recognized for every vertebra adjusted.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_304">304</a></span></p>
-
-<p>General adjustment, on the other hand means either the
-adjustment of all palpable subluxations, or of all the most
-noticeable ones, or of all found providing that no two successive
-vertebrae be adjusted, according to the beliefs of
-different elements in the profession.</p>
-
-<p>Specific adjusting relies upon the diagnosis and requires
-correct interpretation of disease. General adjusting considers
-only the condition of the spine and is given upon the
-principle that if the spine is right the man is right—a
-perfectly correct principle regardless of whether or not the
-general adjustment is advisable. Let us consider some of
-the arguments for and against each method and reach a
-conclusion if possible.</p>
-
-<p>The use of specific adjustment demands of the Chiropractor
-an accurate diagnosis and compels him to get his
-mind into direct contact with the exact condition of the
-patient in order to select the proper vertebrae. Sometimes
-the less prominent subluxation causes a more acute or dangerous
-disease than the more pronounced. Specific adjusting
-tends to develop more discriminating and accurate
-palpation.</p>
-
-<p>Specific adjusting weakens and shocks the weak or
-nervous patient less than general adjusting. It also concentrates
-the recuperative or reparatory power of the patient
-on the parts which <em>most need repair</em>. The body possesses
-only a certain limited capacity for combating disease or
-building weakened tissue. To scatter this force widely is
-to weaken its effect in any particular locality.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_305">305</a></span></p>
-
-<p>The habit of specific adjustment and of selecting proper
-vertebrae enables the Chiropractor to explain definitely at
-any time just what he is doing and why he is doing it. We
-assert that in adjusting a vertebra we are removing the
-primary cause of disease. It is sometimes awkward to be
-asked if the patient has nine diseases or if it takes nine
-subluxations to cause one case of acute coryza. A correct
-answer to either question leaves an embarrassing discrepancy
-between theory and practice.</p>
-
-<p>In favor of the practice of general adjusting it has been
-said that errors in diagnosis become unimportant if all subluxations
-be adjusted; that if the spine be straightened the
-patient <em>must</em> recover. Against the first statement, which is
-forceful because diagnosticians are so notably liable to err,
-it may be said that errors in palpation are almost, if not
-quite, as frequent as errors in other branches of diagnosis
-and that one’s tendency to err is less if all possible methods
-be checked against each other than if one only is used.
-The second statement is quite true; but it is based upon
-the assumption that in ordinary practice the spine <em>may</em> be
-straightened completely. As a matter of fact this rarely,
-if ever, occurs. It is practically impossible ever to thoroughly
-“line up” a spine. The best that has been done as
-yet except in acute subluxations is to so modify subluxations
-that disease disappears.</p>
-
-<p>We may interject here the statement that no greater or
-more conclusive betrayal of incompetency can be offered
-by a Chiropractor than the declaration that he has completely<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_306">306</a></span>
-“lined up” a spinal column in one, six, or a dozen
-adjustments, as some have declared. If one be honest in
-such statements it is proof positive that he is not capable
-of accuracy in palpation or else lamentably liable to auto-suggestion.
-Clinicians of proven ability, who have examined
-more than five thousand spines each, agree that no
-perfectly normal spine has been discovered, whether the
-spine has been adjusted or not.</p>
-
-<p>But the chiefest argument against general adjusting is
-that it scatters the reparatory forces of the body throughout
-many segments, some of which are not really in need of
-attention, while the one or two segments which need all
-possible concentration of energy receive only a diluted
-share.</p>
-
-<p>If my patient suffers from an acute pneumonia and
-nothing else and if I require that he submit to a general
-adjustment including some eight subluxations, two of which
-are Lumbars, I am unscientific and unwise. What that
-case demands is an immediate localized improvement.</p>
-
-<p>It is highly probable that the efficient Chiropractor of
-the future will be a specific adjuster; that every recognized
-body condition will suggest a definite and scientifically determined
-corrective measure; and that guesswork will be
-largely eliminated.</p>
-
-<h4 id="h_58">Talking Points</h4>
-
-<p>The things which it is most important that the Chiropractor
-should set before his patient are the theories and<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_307">307</a></span>
-facts peculiar to Chiropractic, perhaps adduced by Chiropractic
-investigations alone. These theories and facts have
-been discussed elsewhere in detail: the subluxation theory,
-easily demonstratable with a spinal column as an object
-lesson, the relations between primary and secondary causes
-of disease, the directness and completeness of the results of
-vertebral adjustments, these explanations are more convincing
-than the display of a wealth of knowledge of methods
-and theories used by other schools of practice. Chiropractic
-has been builded not by virtue of previously established
-truths but solely on the vitality of the new principles enunciated
-by it.</p>
-
-<p>These new ideas cannot hope for full and immediate
-credence and must be presented carefully, with this fact in
-mind and with due consideration for the degree of intelligence
-of the listener. Avoid argumentative discussion with
-patients, seeking rather to enlighten them about those facts
-peculiar to Chiropractic and unknown to them than to
-antagonize them by contradicting their cherished beliefs. It
-is much wiser to begin with that knowledge of disease which
-you hold in common with the patient and advance with
-him, step by step, from that firm foundation to new truths
-than to begin by attempting to tear down his beliefs. Reason
-from the known to the unknown. Replace an old idea
-as to the causation of disease by quietly inserting a new
-one of greater verity and it will presently and painlessly
-crowd out the old. This process is much the simplest and
-easiest.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_308">308</a></span></p>
-
-<p>Nevertheless in presenting Chiropractic we must be
-gently positive. Chiropractic is known and provable. Always
-able to fall back upon the clinical test as a final argument
-with supreme assurance that it will not fail to vindicate
-our claims, we may present an unshaken front before
-the most powerful and intelligent attack.</p>
-
-<h4 id="h_59">Promises to Patients</h4>
-
-<p>The majority of patients will require from the Chiropractor
-an expression of his belief in his ability or inability
-to cure them. They will desire a statement as to the probable
-time required for a cure. They may even ask a guarantee
-of success.</p>
-
-<p>These questions are hard to meet truthfully and convincingly,
-for the truth is that every Chiropractor fails sometimes
-and is unable to predict that failure in advance and
-that no one wise enough to predict the length of time which
-will be required for the cure of any given case has yet arisen.
-And these truths do not sound reassuring or convincing.</p>
-
-<p>Explain to the patient that nature alone is the curative
-agent and that the cure depends not alone upon the skill
-of the adjuster but upon the exact condition of the vertebrae,
-the exact amount or degree of damage to tissue, the
-patient’s habits of living, etc. Any accidental interjection
-of other factors into the case may have an important bearing.
-You may assure him of the excellent results you have
-obtained in other cases similar to his, or even cite individual
-cases if to do so does not violate a professional confidence.<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_309">309</a></span>
-But you had best avoid a promise to cure or an
-exact statement of the time which will be needed. State
-your belief or opinion but do not bind yourself to a promise.
-Offer your best skill and closest attention; you can do no
-more.</p>
-
-<p>The patient should rely upon the skill of the Chiropractor
-as upon the skill of his lawyer or his physician.
-Neither can honestly promise that he will succeed in his
-efforts, even though all indications point that way.</p>
-
-<h4 id="h_60">Re-Tracing of Disease</h4>
-
-<p>From the original concussion of forces which produces
-a nerve-impigning subluxation to the stage of chronic disease
-with which the patient usually approaches the Chiropractor
-for relief, disease develops by a series of gradual
-steps. Successive changes take place from time to time in
-the degree of subluxation as it is augmented by further
-jars, strains, etc., or by the reaction of secondary causes
-upon it and with these changes come corresponding changes
-in the development of the disease.</p>
-
-<p>Perhaps the first effect of the bad subluxation is irritation
-of a nerve and acute functional disturbance such as
-pain, fever, etc. The later effect may be paralysis and its
-attendant train of evils.</p>
-
-<p>When the Chiropractor begins adjustment he does not at
-once return the long-displaced and misshapen vertebra to
-its normal position. He merely <em>tends</em> to do so, his adjustments
-making slight and gradual changes from the abnormal
-back to normal.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_310">310</a></span></p>
-
-<p>Thus it is that the subluxation passes back in reverse
-order through the successive stages of its development, following
-a process which may be called the involution of the
-subluxation. At the same time the morbid process resulting
-from the subluxation tends to retrace its steps, passing
-in reverse order through the stages by which it developed.
-Pains which have not been felt for years may unaccountably
-return under the reawakening of the long dormant
-nerves. Headache, long absent but once a prominent feature
-of the disease, may again make its appearance. The
-patient <em>feels</em> worse.</p>
-
-<p>These changes, however, take place much more rapidly
-during the correction than during the development of the
-disease. To a certain extent they are probably always present,
-although in many cases they occur so rapidly or are
-modified so much by changed environment as to be unrecognizable.
-In many cases it is possible by securing an accurate
-history and by careful observation of the patient’s
-progress to observe a definite reappearance, in reverse
-order, of every important event in the history of the disease.
-For instance, if the patient has at one time had a
-severe fever, perhaps lasting many weeks, and has later
-developed a chronic weakness marking the increase in degree
-of subluxation, the fever may reappear during adjustments,
-last a day or two, and disappear forever, having
-been corrected beyond that stage.</p>
-
-<p>If explained in advance to patients with chronic diseases,
-the facts of retracing may not cause the patient to<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_311">311</a></span>
-become discouraged as he would if he failed to understand
-them. If he knows before your work is commenced that he
-may expect such phenomena but may possibly escape them
-he meets them as necessary parts of the process of cure.
-If they are not explained in advance he is likely to feel
-that you are doing him injury and to discontinue your
-service just at the time he most needs them. In fact, it
-occasionally happens that if adjustments are stopped at
-some irritant stage of the cure that condition will remain
-and do great damage.</p>
-
-<p>This theory of retracing has been much abused. Chiropractors
-have used it to cover a multitude of errors in practice.
-With some it becomes a habit to call all unfavorable
-events which occur during adjustments retracing, thus
-shifting the blame from their own shoulders to Nature’s.
-This is a pernicious practice because it deceives the patient
-and also because too frequent repetition of this explanation
-finally deludes the practitioner into the belief that all such
-events really <em>are</em> retracing. This view withdraws his attention
-from his own technic and he ceases to discover his
-own mistakes by ceasing to look for them.</p>
-
-<p>It is best in the face of any painful or apparently unfavorable
-development always to examine our own work thoroughly
-to detect any possible error in diagnosis, palpation,
-or selection of move for correction. It is always possible
-for us to err and our cases should be observed at every
-stage with the most minute care to insure accuracy in
-detail.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_312">312</a></span></p>
-
-<h4 id="h_61">Limitations of Chiropractic</h4>
-
-<p>There are many things which can be done better by
-others than by a Chiropractor. There are others for which
-the Chiropractor’s training does not fit him at all and to
-which his methods do not in any sense apply. Knowledge
-of these limitations is just as essential as acquaintance with
-the powers of the vertebral adjustment.</p>
-
-<p>Bony dislocations other than vertebral, fractures,
-wounds causing, or likely to cause, hemorrhage or severe
-internal injury, should at sight be diverted into the hands
-of a surgeon. The Chiropractor receives no training in
-handling such cases and has neither legal nor moral right
-to attend them. In obstetrics likewise no practical training
-is given which would prepare the practitioner for delivery
-and he is unprepared to use necessary asceptic or antiseptic
-measures.</p>
-
-<p>Some individual cases of disease usually curable will
-have advanced so far as to require surgical interference.
-Abscesses or suppurative diseases internally located or having
-any liability to discharge internally must be avoided.
-Gangrene, cancer, the advanced stages of tuberculosis
-(usually) are incurable.</p>
-
-<p>Quarantinable diseases as a class yield readily to adjustment
-unless some serum treatment has been administered,
-when the chances of recovery are greatly lessened. But
-such cases must be reported in conformity with the laws
-of the state and will probably then be taken out of the hands
-of the Chiropractor—unfortunately. The laws of the various<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_313">313</a></span>
-states should be modified to permit Chiropractors, with
-precautions required of physicians to safeguard the public
-health, to pass quarantine. Every effort should be put forth
-to secure such legislation but until it is secured in any
-state and the Chiropractor’s work is brought under the
-supervision of the authorities, the laws must be respected
-strictly.</p>
-
-<p>Syphilis and gonorrhoea, communicable diseases, should
-be recognized and refused in practice. The former in the
-primary and secondary stages (not tertiary) and the latter
-in all stages is corrective by adjustment but the liability
-of transmission of the disease warns against contact with
-it unless all precautions known to science be used to avoid
-possible transmission.</p>
-
-<p>Congenital anomalies of structure do not yield to Chiropractic
-and are best let alone although no harm is likely to
-arise through any attempt to correct them by vertebral
-adjustment.</p>
-
-<h4>Relation of Chiropractic to Other Methods</h4>
-
-<p>There are certain other methods which present a superficial
-resemblance to Chropractic which leads many to
-believe them closely related. Such methods are Spondylotherapy,
-Osteopathy, etc. There is a system called Napravit
-or Naprapathy which may be dismissed with the statement
-that it is Chiropractic, renamed.</p>
-
-<p>Spondylotherapy, on the other hand, is a system of treating<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_314">314</a></span>
-disease which takes no account of the vertebral subluxation
-as its primary cause and seeks to cure disease by
-stimulating or inhibiting nerve action through the use of
-mechanical, thermic, or electrical means. Its resemblance
-is due solely to the fact that most of the treatment is applied
-to the spine. As well might we say that serum injection
-for meningitis is Chiropractic because the serum is introduced
-by lumbar puncture into the spinal canal.</p>
-
-<p>Osteopathy, since the profession has become aware of
-the superior results obtainable by vertebral adjustment, is
-rapidly adopting many Chiropractic methods and counterfeiting
-it as far as possible. Perusal of their literature of
-various periods clearly shows that this is a new growth
-and that they have never adopted in theory what they sometimes
-use in practice. In fact both the above methods <em>treat
-disease</em>, following the theory of medicine with the use of
-different remedies only, while Chiropractic <em>adjusts the cause</em>
-of disease and avoids treatment of any kind. Chiropractic
-is not a branch of medicine, never can be a branch of medicine
-because it is inherently and fundamentally antagonistic
-to the very basic principles of medicine, and no statute can
-change the fact of such antagonism. But unless we adhere
-strictly to the fundamental principles of our own practice
-and limit ourselves to the methods which grow from those
-principles Chiropractic <em>may become</em> a part of medicine.
-Which brings us to</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_315">315</a></span></p>
-
-<h4 id="h_62">The Use of Adjuncts</h4>
-
-<p>There are many methods of treating disease which are
-more or less beneficial to the patient just as there are some
-which are always injurious. Shall we employ such of these
-methods as are beneficial as adjuncts to the practice of Chiropractic?
-Or shall we adhere to the principle that the
-treatment of disease is erroneous and the adjustment of
-its cause the only logical method of procedure? There is
-much to be said on both sides of this question which has
-so long agitated the profession.</p>
-
-<p>In the class of beneficial adjuncts may be placed massage,
-hydrotherapy, spondylotherapy, dietetics, osteopathy,
-Christian Science, suggestive therapeutics, mechano-therapy,
-and many others. Each of these has its field of usefulness;
-each taken alone is productive of some good in some cases
-at least. Each might possibly augment the results of Chiropractic,
-or hasten them in some cases, if judiciously used.
-By judiciously used we mean the avoidance of any method
-which would in the least interfere with proper vertebral
-adjustment or its results or which might carelessly cause
-subluxation. Osteopathy and mechano-therapy frequently
-cause subluxation because of the ignorance on the part of
-their users; they need not do so.</p>
-
-<p>Among the pernicious adjuncts, or those which are harmful
-if combined with adjustments or harmful whenever and
-however used, may be mentioned drug medicine, serum
-therapy, and electricity. The first two may sometimes prove
-the lesser evil if used alone. With Chiropractic they are<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_316">316</a></span>
-always unnecessary and always tend to lessen the good effect
-of adjustments. The latter alone is beneficial but in combination
-with Chiropractic proves a double stimulant to the
-nerves and should be avoided. The effect of these methods
-when used with Chiropractic can never be accurately predicted.
-One can only be certain that some unfortunate
-effect will follow.</p>
-
-<p>As a secondary consideration the Chiropractor has
-neither legal nor moral right to practice medicine unless
-he has received a state license to do so.</p>
-
-<p>Having admitted that the forms of “mixing” indicated
-as beneficial to the patient may be sometimes justifiable on
-the score of immediate good to the patient, let us consider
-another side of the question.</p>
-
-<p>Just as surely as we admit into our practice any method
-which attacks the disease itself, or which treats any other
-than the primary cause of the disease, or which seeks to
-stimulate or inhibit the functions of the body without freeing
-the natural channels through which the natural healing
-power of the body should be manifested, just so surely are
-we adopting the medical theory and making our profession
-a branch of medicine. Medicine uses many remedies for
-the cure of disease. Medicine is now broader than the mere
-administration of drugs. And no matter how we vary the
-remedy, or what treatment we select, we are denying the
-truth of the Chiropractic theory and admitting the truth of
-the medical principle when we use adjuncts in our practice.</p>
-
-<p>Nor are these adjuncts necessary. It has been demonstrated<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_317">317</a></span>
-by repeated observations that the Chiropractors who
-use only the vertebral adjustment secure just as high a
-percentage of results as those who combine one or more
-other methods with it. This is due to various reasons:
-the greater perfection attained in Chiropractic by those who
-apply themselves with concentration to the task of settling
-every problem by that means; the fact that adjuncts often
-detract from the effect of adjustment as much as they add
-results of their own; the tendency of the patient to prefer
-and to insist upon the easier and less painful methods rather
-than the adjustment.</p>
-
-<p>The lay patient and the ignorant public are inclined to
-give credit for results obtained to the best known method
-used upon them. Thus in spite of the fact that Chiropractic
-alone obtains a far greater percentage of results than
-any other combination of methods, the patient is prone to
-believe that the change of diet or the massage effected a
-cure and to overlook entirely the least pleasant part of his
-“treatment,” the adjustment. He does not understand and
-cannot understand with a mind divided for the consideration
-of several methods, the connection of the spine with his disease.
-Often he fails to understand if Chiropractic is used
-alone but he is forced to conclude that the spine <em>has</em> such
-connection because adjustment of the spine cured him.</p>
-
-<p>The use of adjuncts has done more to hold back the
-advance of the profession in the public mind than any other
-single factor except ignorance within the profession. Furthermore,
-the Chiropractor who knows that he can rely upon<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_318">318</a></span>
-various other methods if his adjustment fails does not feel
-impelled to <em>study his Chiropractic</em> as he should. He weakens
-in practice, relying more and more upon adjuncts.</p>
-
-<p>It has been repeatedly proven that the Chiropractor who
-uses <em>only</em> Chiropractic becomes the better practitioner by
-necessity. It has also proven that the man who is expert
-in Chiropractic needs nothing else, providing only that he
-refuses those cases to which Chiropractic cannot apply
-at all.</p>
-
-<p>The only <em>real</em> problem in Chiropractic is the problem of
-<em>adjustment</em>. All failures may be attributed either to lack
-of knowledge and proper application of Chiropractic or to
-the fact that the patient has not vitality enough to recover
-from the disease. Do not shift the responsibility for failure
-upon the system, since with one or two exceptions every
-known disease has been cured by <em>some</em> Chiropractor, thus
-proving its possibility. Realize that the work can be done
-and that its doing depends upon your own skill in diagnosis
-and technic.</p>
-
-<p>It is inevitable that at some future time Chiropractic
-will be used in connection with other beneficial methods
-which will enable us to get results <em>sooner</em>, though not more
-surely. It is also inevitable that Chiropractic will fail to
-receive its proper place among healing methods unless we
-force the world to believe in it as we believe; to know it
-as we know it. If we develop our system in its purity until
-it obtains general recognition at its true valuation we shall
-have accomplished an infinite good for humanity for all
-time.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_319">319</a></span></p>
-
-<p>We should endeavor to accomplish the greatest good
-for the greatest number, laboring rather for the ultimate
-recognition of the subluxation theory and its application
-at its real value than for immediate slight good or personal
-gain.</p>
-
-<h4 id="h_63">Personality</h4>
-
-<p>He who would succeed in Chiropractic must have, in
-addition to a thorough education in his profession, a proper
-personality. This is the medium through which his education
-becomes effective, the channel through which he reaches
-the public, gaining their confidence and approval that he
-may utilize his knowledge to their good. Many skillful
-and well-educated practitioners have failed because they
-lacked the proper personal qualities for attracting patients.</p>
-
-<h4>Elements of Personality</h4>
-
-<p>The most essential elements of a proper personality are
-Courage, Conviction, Confidence, Honesty, Sympathy, and
-Aggressiveness.</p>
-
-<p>Courage, not recklessness or carelessness but a fearless
-willingness to assume responsibility—the heavy responsibility
-of our profession—is indispensable. He who accepts the
-easy case or the chronic and slowly progressive one and
-refuses to face the appalling rush of a dangerous and acute
-malady; he who shrinks through fear for his reputation
-from a grave risk, has no right in Chiropractic. He has
-mistaken his calling. While we acquire the knowledge of
-Chiropractic we acquire also a great responsibility for its<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_320">320</a></span>
-use; we must utilize it wherever and whenever it is best
-for the patient, whenever our chances of effecting a cure
-are the best chances, without regard to ourselves or any
-personal risk.</p>
-
-<p>By <em>conviction</em> is meant a firm and well-grounded <em>belief</em>
-in the greatness and efficiency of Chiropractic. Sincerity in
-one’s practice is a prime requisite for success. A belief
-grounded in <em>knowledge</em> girds the Chiropractor with an
-armor so strong that no adversity can pierce it. He who
-practices Chiropractic without believing in it is in his own
-mind a cheat and a fraud and cannot expect ultimate prosperity.</p>
-
-<p>Confidence in one’s own ability and knowledge, in one’s
-power and skill to contest with disease, begets confidence in
-others. Not conceit, not exaggerated egotism, but a healthy
-and sane assurance and faith in oneself, engender that steadiness
-of mind and of hand which make for accuracy and
-excellence.</p>
-
-<p>Without honesty with oneself, one’s profession, and one’s
-patients, one forfeits public confidence—and justly. If we
-promise that which we cannot perform, if we deceive our
-patients by misleading explanations of untoward events, we
-deserve failure. It is not intended here to refer to the cheerful
-and optimistic manner and habit of speech which often
-aids in the sick room to keep the patient’s mind at rest.
-This may sometimes deceive the patient as to the gravity
-of his condition and such deceit may be justifiable; but it
-should never be extended to the family or to those who have<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_321">321</a></span>
-a right to know the real condition and cannot be harmed by
-such knowledge. Strict honesty, whenever harmless to
-others, should be the fixed policy of all practitioners.</p>
-
-<p>The weak, strained minds of the very ill require and
-demand <em>sympathy</em>; not the sort which expresses itself in
-fixed words or phrases of condolence with the unfortunate
-and at once forgets their needs and sorrows, but the deeper,
-unspoken feeling of desire to aid, which springs from the
-heart and finds its best expression in active assistance. If
-you do not care whether your patient is or is not benefited,
-if you have no other feeling for him than a business
-interest in holding a case, you lack the strongest impulse
-to hard work and study, the desire to aid.</p>
-
-<p>Chiropractic is new. Its principles are yet unknown to
-the general public. Also this is an age of keen competition
-and it is our duty to our profession and to the world
-that instead of hiding our light under a bushel we proclaim
-our mission to all who will hear. We must be intelligently
-and wisely <em>aggressive</em>. We must bring ourselves into contact
-with the public in every legitimate way, compelling it
-by force of logic and personality to see the reasonableness
-and greatness of our work.</p>
-
-<p>Question yourself in regard to these things. Examine
-your own characteristics to discover whether any of these
-essential elements of personality are lacking. If one be
-found wanting cultivate it assiduously. Having chosen
-Chiropractic as a life vocation, <em>work at it</em> not alone for the
-acquisition of ever-increasing knowledge but for the unfoldment
-of a powerful and winning personality.</p>
-
-<hr />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_322">322</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<h2 id="h_64"><a id="CHIROPRACTIC_PROGNOSIS"></a>CHIROPRACTIC PROGNOSIS</h2>
-</div>
-
-<p id="h_65"><b>Prognosis</b> is the determining, in advance of the fact,
-of the probable course, duration, or outcome of a disease.
-A Chiropractic prognosis is a prediction as to the changes
-which will take place in a case during and after Chiropractic
-adjustments.</p>
-
-<p><b>General Prognosis</b> is an opinion expressed of a disease
-without reference to any particular case. It is based upon
-the experience of the profession and the average result
-obtained with the disease. It furnishes only a basis for
-consideration of the <b>special prognosis</b> of an individual
-case. This latter must be based upon the general prognosis
-of the disease and upon study of every modifying
-factor present in the case, as general vitality, living habits,
-facility of adjustment, apparent response to early adjustments,
-and especially an estimate of the amount and kind
-of damage done to tissue and the probability of its repair.</p>
-
-<p>Only general prognosis can be set down as a guide to
-others. To state even this with certainty and safety
-many precautions must be observed. All cases included
-as a basis of conclusions must be handled under standard
-test conditions (see <a href="#INDEX">index</a>) as far as may be; in accepting
-the observations of others one must be sure that
-they are sufficiently trained and sufficiently careful and
-veracious to render their statements reliable.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_323">323</a></span></p>
-
-<p>In order to introduce the subject to the literature of
-the profession and to invite comment and discussion
-looking toward the ultimate development of a complete
-Chiropractic prognosis we shall set down, without further
-preliminary, the general prognosis of those commonly
-described diseases concerning which we feel qualified to
-speak. No statement is made without the gathering of
-reliable evidence.</p>
-
-<h3 id="h_66">GENERAL PROGNOSIS</h3>
-
-<p><b>Abscesses.</b>—Those abscesses which would tend to discharge
-externally may be adjusted for with success and
-will rapidly develop, point, and discharge, with quick
-recovery. Those which might break internally absolutely
-forbid adjustment because of the almost certain
-occurrence of peritonitis, pyaemia, or other grave
-condition.</p>
-
-<p><b>Acne.</b>—Good, but usually slow.</p>
-
-<p><b>Addison’s Disease.</b>—Few cases reported, and these
-slow cures.</p>
-
-<p><b>Adenoids of Pharynx.</b>—Prognosis so good as to contraindicate
-operation in every case. The lymphoid
-growths gradually and slowly absorb under adjustment.</p>
-
-<p><b>Adiposis Dolorosa.</b>—Only one case seen, the Derkum
-case. This reduced in six months of adjustment from
-360 to 280 lbs. in weight, and was improved in every particular.
-No final report received.</p>
-
-<p><b>Alcoholism.</b>—Adjustments greatly aid a cure if alcohol<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_324">324</a></span>
-be discontinued at once, or if the daily consumption is
-gradually and steadily decreased. No permanent cure
-can be secured without the aid of the patient. Acute
-alcoholic intoxication may be lessened at once by the aid
-of a single adjustment.</p>
-
-<p><b>Amenorrhoea.</b>—Prognosis excellent. One to several
-months required. Conservative amenorrhoea, as in tuberculosis
-or other wasting disease, disappears only with
-the occasion.</p>
-
-<p><b>Anaemia.</b>—If primary, yields slowly but surely. Secondary
-anaemia depends upon some disease process and
-its prognosis is that of the disease which produces it.</p>
-
-<p><b>Angina Pectoris.</b>—A case for careful diagnosis. False
-angina recovers with general building of nervous system.
-True angina, usually associated with arteriosclerosis, is
-frequently fatal and death may occur during any adjustment.
-If this does not happen most cases recover, though
-slowly. Let me repeat, there is great danger in handling
-true angina pectoris.</p>
-
-<p><b>Anidrosis.</b>—Usually responds to adjustments for the
-kidneys.</p>
-
-<p><b>Ankylosis.</b>—Almost any ankylosis, except that in
-which there is gross deformity of the bones, would yield
-to repeated applications of force along right lines. Only
-vertebral ankyloses are amenable to Chiropractic adjustment
-and those are usually broken in time.</p>
-
-<p><b>Anterior Poliomyelitis.</b>—Chiropractic experience with<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_325">325</a></span>
-“infantile paralysis” has been very extensive and gratifying.
-During the febrile stage the disease may be
-aborted by one or several adjustments with only slight
-and transient paralyses resulting. The chronic paralysis
-which follows an unadjusted case is curable, but restoration
-of the motor function and trophic tone of the paralyzed
-members is delayed while the ventral horn cells are
-regenerated, the axons rebuilt, and the atrophied muscles
-redeveloped. Often no apparent results will be obtained
-for one or several months, after which gradual improvement
-progresses to a complete cure.</p>
-
-<p><b>Aphonia.</b>—Prognosis excellent. No failures reported.</p>
-
-<p><b>Apoplexy.</b>—The occasional case in which a premonitory
-partial paralysis precedes real hemorrhage responds
-remarkably to adjustment so that with care the hemorrhage
-may be averted. After hemorrhage the absorption
-of the clot is slow and tedious, but about 50 per cent
-recover.</p>
-
-<p><b>Appendicitis.</b>—In the early stages of the acute form,
-and in nearly all chronic cases, recovery is almost certain
-under adjustments. Signs of suppuration indicate immediate
-operative interference and drainage, and failure
-to read the signs may lead to rupture, peritonitis, and
-death. Acute cases yield very quickly as a rule.</p>
-
-<p><b>Arthritis Deformans.</b>—In well developed cases some
-almost complete cures have been effected in periods
-varying from two to four years. Prognosis good as to
-relief, but poor as to complete recovery.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_326">326</a></span></p>
-
-<p><b>Ascites.</b>—Fair prognosis, depending upon the nature
-of the portal obstruction. Cirrhotic ascites does not yield
-well.</p>
-
-<p><b>Asthma.</b>—Spasmodic bronchial asthma is almost always
-curable except in the very aged, but the usual
-posterior curvature in lower cervicals and upper dorsals
-requires time and persistent heavy adjustments for its
-correction. The asthmatic paroxysm may be relieved
-instantaneously, but will recur at intervals for a long
-period before the cure is fully established. The cardiac
-form of asthma depends upon restoration of compensation
-for a leaking valve, and yields by irregularly
-progressive diminution.</p>
-
-<p><b>Blindness.</b>—As a condition, without qualifying terms,
-blindness offers a bad prognosis. Most cases fail to
-develop sight under adjustments. Yet some individual
-cures in optic atrophy, in detached retina, and in other
-conditions, attest the possibility. Cataract blindness perhaps
-yields best.</p>
-
-<p><b>Bradycardia.</b>—If symptomatic, yields as does the disease.
-If primary, a few adjustments are usually sufficient.
-In one case the first adjustment increased to 90
-a pulse which had been at 60 for fifteen years. In twenty-four
-hours, without further adjustment, the rate had
-settled at 69 and there remained.</p>
-
-<p><b>Bright’s Disease.</b>—Prognosis good, but some cases
-terminate abruptly with intercurrent disease, such as
-pneumonia. There is danger until the albuminuria has<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_327">327</a></span>
-ceased and the strength of the patient markedly improved.
-Probably the diseased kidney area is simply
-walled off from the healthy tissue, which then hypertrophies
-and takes on the work of the entire organ, or
-pair of organs. If too much damage has been done, the
-case will terminate fatally in time, even though its
-progress is checked by adjustments.</p>
-
-<p><b>Bronchitis.</b>—Acute bronchitis is quickly checked as
-a rule. Chronic bronchitis may prove intractable, or
-may require many months for a cure. There are exceptional
-quick cures of the most chronic cases.</p>
-
-<p><b>Caked Breast—Mammary Inflammations</b>.—Rapid and
-positive cure follows proper adjustments.</p>
-
-<p><b>Cerebral Softening.</b>—Prognosis bad.</p>
-
-<p><b>Cerebrospinal Meningitis.</b>—Serious always, but no
-fatalities reported in adjusted cases. Failure to modify
-fever and cervical retraction within two or three hours,
-and with one to ten adjustments, is alarming.</p>
-
-<p><b>Chickenpox.</b>—Like smallpox and the other exanthemata,
-chickenpox should be modified at once by adjustment
-and all cases should be light, eruption hastened,
-and fever quickly broken. Sometimes the rash may be
-strongly marked and the disease run its usual course in
-all particulars except fever and prostration, being a
-febrile with absence of all the consequences of fever.</p>
-
-<p><b>Cholangitis.</b>—Recovers quickly under adjustment.</p>
-
-<p><b>Cholecystitis.</b>—Prognosis excellent.</p>
-
-<p><b>Chorea.</b>—Prognosis excellent in acute and subacute<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_328">328</a></span>
-cases, less favorable in chronic. No figures are available,
-but many chronic cases fail to respond at all.</p>
-
-<p><b>Cirrhosis of Liver.</b>—Doubtful. No statistics have
-been compiled, but it seems probable that most cases are
-unmodified by adjustment.</p>
-
-<p><b>Congestion of Liver.</b>—Prognosis good.</p>
-
-<p><b>Conjunctivitis.</b>—Readily curable, unless part of a more
-general infection.</p>
-
-<p><b>Constipation.</b>—Prognosis usually good, but some cases
-which have paralyzed the intestines with drugs, or in
-which atony of the intestinal muscles exists from any
-cause, are very stubborn. One is led to believe that any
-case of chronic constipation would respond to proper
-adjustments in time, but sometimes the time is prolonged
-more than seems reasonable.</p>
-
-<p><b>Coryza.</b>—Some cases respond instantly, others persist
-and run their usual course. Chronic nasal catarrh recovers
-in favorable climates, and in unfavorable tends to
-become permanent, though less severe and annoying
-under adjustment.</p>
-
-<p><b>Croup.</b>—Always dangerous, but no fatalities reported
-under adjustments, which are powerfully effective. Croup
-requires constant attention until all symptoms subside,
-usually within an hour or two.</p>
-
-<p><b>Cystitis.</b>—Usually curable, but some chronic cases
-prove intractable for an unknown reason. There is no
-way of recognizing the curability of a case before the
-attempt.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_329">329</a></span></p>
-
-<p><b>Deafness.</b>—Variable outlook. Deafness due to catarrhal
-occlusion of the Eustachian tubes is usually curable.
-That due to middle ear disease sometimes yields. That
-due to nerve disease is possibly—though not certainly—incurable.</p>
-
-<p><b>Diabetes Insipidus.</b>—Prognosis excellent. Few cases
-fail of cure, and no fatalities are reported.</p>
-
-<p><b>Diabetes Mellitus.</b>—Always necessitating grave and
-careful consideration, this metabolic disease is marvellously
-controlled by Chiropractic adjustment. Probably
-90 per cent of all cases are curable, and only those presenting
-impossible problems of adjustment, or those in
-the very last stages, are hopeless.</p>
-
-<p><b>Diarrhoea.</b>—Prognosis depends largely upon secondary
-causes. Adjustments sometimes produce diarrhoea
-to cleanse the intestinal tract of waste or poisons.
-Such a diarrhoea, if instituted by Nature without aid,
-does not cease with adjustments until its purpose is accomplished.
-Nervous and infective diarrhoeas usually
-respond well.</p>
-
-<p><b>Dilatation of Heart.</b>—Compensatory hypertrophy and
-strengthening of the muscle usually follows adjustment.</p>
-
-<p><b>Diphtheria.</b>—Under adjustment the false membrane
-tends to exfoliate and to be coughed out entire within a
-few hours, with rapid recovery. In children, watch for
-possible strangulation from loosened membrane. Constant
-bedside attention is imperative until fever and membrane
-have disappeared. Convalescence, unless antitoxin<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_330">330</a></span>
-has been used, is very rapid, and physicians watching the
-clinical course of diphtheria under adjustment customarily
-doubt the diagnosis unless culture is made. Antitoxin
-modifies the prognosis toward gravity, and in spite of
-adjustments persistent sequelae often follow its use.</p>
-
-<p><b>Dropsy.</b>—Cardiac or renal dropsy disappears with
-improvement in the diseased organ.</p>
-
-<p><b>Dysentery.</b>—In temperate climates death is extremely
-unlikely. Recovery is often quick and easy, but some
-cases persist. The tropical amoebic dysentery seems
-hardest to master and may not improve at all.</p>
-
-<p><b>Dyspepsia.</b>—Prognosis good.</p>
-
-<p><b>Endocarditis.</b>—If primary, recovery is the rule. Occurring
-in the course of some other disease, as rheumatic
-fever, it renders the prognosis less certain and may terminate
-fatally. Likely to leave chronic valve weakness or
-contraction.</p>
-
-<p><b>Enteritis.</b>—Prognosis generally fair. No figures
-available.</p>
-
-<p><b>Enuresis.</b>—The majority recover within a few weeks
-or months, with occasional exceptions. Failure to get
-results within a few weeks suggests a change of
-adjustment.</p>
-
-<p><b>Epilepsy.</b>—Doubtful. Less than half of all cases recover,
-and no case can be pronounced cured until all
-symptoms have been absent for a year. Cases with anterior
-cervicals offer the poorest chance. It is usually
-possible to restore consciousness and muscular control<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_331">331</a></span>
-by an adjustment during the grande mal, in the instant
-between the tonic and clonic spasms, but such immediate
-response does not—unfortunately—always mean that a
-cure will eventually be effected.</p>
-
-<p><b>Epistaxis.</b>—Nose-bleed usually stops at once following
-proper adjustment.</p>
-
-<p><b>Erysipelas.</b>—Cases adjusted early show little spreading
-of the eruption with but slight constitutional symptoms.
-After eruption is fully developed it is more difficult
-to keep down the fever and recovery is slower, but
-none the less certain unless cardiac or other grave
-weakness is present.</p>
-
-<p><b>Exophthalmic Goitre.</b>—Like other forms of goitre this
-may be reduced, and with its reduction all other symptoms
-disappear. Many cures are on record.</p>
-
-<p><b>Friedrich’s Ataxia.</b>—In hereditary cerebellar ataxia
-(which is probably congenital, rather) cures are limited
-to 40 per cent or less. History of instrumental delivery,
-with marked upper cervical subluxation, argue for the
-natal origin of the disease and increase the probability
-of cure.</p>
-
-<p><b>Gallstones.</b>—Prognosis excellent. The calculi absorb
-under adjustment by a reversal of the chemical process
-by which their deposit was induced. When small they
-may pass through the ducts and escape, with slight pain.
-Adjustment during the painful passage of a gallstone may
-act upon the duct so as to lessen greatly the pain and
-hasten the passage.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_332">332</a></span></p>
-
-<p><b>Gastralgia.</b>—Like other gastric neuroses, is easily
-curable but may sometimes require correction of a
-neurotic diathesis, which means time.</p>
-
-<p><b>Gastric Ulcer.</b>—Usually recovers, but occasionally
-leaves a fibrous cicatrix which cannot be affected by adjustment
-and which, if located at the pylorus, may produce
-stenosis, with consequent incurable dilatation of the
-stomach. Operation is required for such a condition,
-but the diagnosis is difficult, and it may be best to test
-with adjustments for some time.</p>
-
-<p><b>Gastritis.</b>—Prognosis good. To prevent recurrence
-adjustments should continue after symptoms subside.</p>
-
-<p><b>Goitre.</b>—Prognosis good. One large goitre under the
-author’s observation was reduced in one week so that the
-neck measurement decreased one inch. Most cases require
-several months for complete reduction.</p>
-
-<p><b>Gonorrhoeal Rheumatism.</b>—More stubborn than other
-forms of rheumatism and sometimes defies adjustment.
-No percentages are available. It is probable that nothing
-but a general cleansing of the system will prevent
-recurrence.</p>
-
-<p><b>Hay Fever.</b>—Perhaps one-half of all adjusted cases
-recover fully, some at once and some after several months.
-By recovery is meant failure of the annual appearance of
-the attack with no symptoms at any time. No case can
-be pronounced cured in less than a year. The remaining
-half are modified little or not at all.</p>
-
-<p><b>Headache.</b>—Nervous, bilious, ocular, and reflex headaches<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_333">333</a></span>
-yield well. Toxic headaches, or those accompanying
-systemic infections, give way slowly with the cleansing
-of the system.</p>
-
-<p><b>Hemorrhoids.</b>—Excellent, except when lower lumbars
-are anterior and defy adjustment.</p>
-
-<p><b>Hernia.</b>—In all sites and forms of hernia, excepting
-strangulated hernia, prognosis is good. Strangulation
-requires immediate surgical interference. Prognosis is
-better if a truss be used.</p>
-
-<p><b>Hodgkins’ Disease.</b>—Prognosis theoretically good,
-but the few cases under adjustment, while benefited, seem
-to have died of intercurrent disease, so that it is well to
-suspend judgment.</p>
-
-<p><b>Hydrocele.</b>—Theoretically hydrocele should respond
-well, but in practice the author has seen several failures,
-and no cures.</p>
-
-<p><b>Hydrocephalus.</b>—If due to cervical twisting at birth,
-the prognosis is fair; otherwise bad.</p>
-
-<p><b>Hypertrophy.</b>—Adaptative hypertrophies, those due
-to overstrain upon an organ, do not and should not disappear
-until the strain has been relieved. Hypertrophy
-is sometimes accelerated by adjustment, as in the case of
-defective heart valves, when thickening of the wall restores
-and maintains compensation. Other hypertrophies
-tend to disappear under adjustment.</p>
-
-<p><b>Hysteria.</b>—Good, but slow. Some extreme cases refuse
-to respond. Instant recovery from hysterical coma
-is the rule following adjustment, but the coma tends to
-recur.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_334">334</a></span></p>
-
-<p><b>Immunity.</b>—There is no doubt that adjustments often
-confer immunity from infection and contagion, but it is
-so difficult to strengthen every part of the body against
-every possible infection or contagion, and so uncertain
-that immunity really exists in a given case, that it is best
-always to assume the possibility of contagion and act
-accordingly. Adjustments following exposure to known
-contagion are always wise, but one may never know, if
-they succeed, that the patient might not have escaped
-without them.</p>
-
-<p><b>Impotence.</b>—Variable outlook, according to secondary
-causes and pathology. Previous venereal disease renders
-the prognosis most doubtful. Nervous or vascular impotence
-is likely to respond well. If due to cord disease,
-the prognosis is to be made on the original disease.</p>
-
-<p><b>Influenza.</b>—Mortality not more than 2 per cent, and
-that in the very aged and infirm. Duration varies greatly.
-May yield at once, first adjustment being followed by disappearance
-of fever, profuse perspiration, and completed
-convalescence in from twenty-four to forty-eight hours;
-or may require several adjustments at frequent intervals
-to break fever.</p>
-
-<p><b>Insanity.</b>—No accurate tabulation of results in different
-forms of insanity has been made. Numerous
-successes, interspersed with fewer failures, have been reported.
-The author has both succeeded and failed with
-acute dementia, but the failure was a twenty-four-hour
-trial only, and included but three adjustments.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_335">335</a></span></p>
-
-<p><b>Intestinal Obstruction.</b>—The prognosis of intestinal
-obstruction from intussusception or strangulated hernia
-is, under Chiropractic, bad. Such cases are almost surely
-fatal unless operated. Faecal obstructions or masses of
-worms, also volvulus, respond quickly and prognosis is
-good. Careful diagnosis is required before taking a case
-of apparent complete obstruction.</p>
-
-<p><b>Irritable Heart.</b>—If purely nervous, recovery is quick
-and easy. If there is a drug diathesis or organic disease,
-slow and doubtful.</p>
-
-<p><b>Jaundice.</b>—Yields readily, but if of the obstructive
-form the obstruction must first be reduced or removed by
-adjustments.</p>
-
-<p><b>Laryngitis.</b>—A few adjustments suffice for simple
-acute cases. Specific laryngeal infections are more difficult.
-Laryngitis with ulceration, which is either syphilitic
-or tubercular, may not recover or may recover after
-a protracted struggle. Chronic laryngitis of other forms
-is curable, but requires more time than acute.</p>
-
-<p><b>Leucorrhoea.</b>—Fair prognosis only.</p>
-
-<p><b>Lumbago.</b>—Good, unless pain prevents proper adjustment.
-True lumbago is quick to respond.</p>
-
-<p><b>Malaria.</b>—Tenacity varies according to climatic conditions.
-Malarial cachexia always yields slowly, sometimes
-defies adjustment altogether. No reports are to be
-had on pernicious malaria. Other forms recover though
-paroxysms tend to recur several times before checked, but
-of shorter duration than if no adjustment is given.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_336">336</a></span></p>
-
-<p><b>Mastoiditis.</b>—Good results in the few cases observed.</p>
-
-<p><b>Measles.</b>—Excellent. Recovers quickly. Eruption
-hastened by early adjustment, runs very mild course with
-little or no fever, catarrhal symptoms disappear early.
-No sequelae.</p>
-
-<p><b>Meniere’s Disease.</b>—Labyrinthine disease of this character
-has been cured, without reported failures, but data
-is meagre, not more than three or four cases having come
-under the author’s notice.</p>
-
-<p><b>Menorrhagia—Metrorrhagia</b>.—Results excellent, and
-usually quick. One fifty-two-hour intermenstrual hemorrhage
-from uterus was stopped in one hour by adjustment,
-with no recurrence.</p>
-
-<p><b>Migraine.</b>—Migraine, or hemicrania, gives a fair prognosis
-only. Most cases require a long course of adjustments.</p>
-
-<p><b>Movable Kidney.</b>—Prognosis good, but change of position
-and complete fixation slow. No treatment required—merely
-adjustment.</p>
-
-<p><b>Myelitis.</b>—Transverse myelitis, if adjusted in the acute
-stage, may be checked as any other inflammation, and
-the damage and resulting paralysis will be greatly
-lessened or altogether prevented. The paralyses which
-follow myelitis require time for the rebuilding of the
-degenerated axons whose course is interrupted at the
-diseased area, but tend to recover.</p>
-
-<p><b>Myocarditis.</b>—Reports conflict. It is well to consider
-this a grave condition and one open to investigation.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_337">337</a></span></p>
-
-<p><b>Myxoedema.</b>—Only one case known to have been
-under adjustment, and this after several years was
-markedly improved, but not yet quite cured.</p>
-
-<p><b>Nephritis.</b>—Prognosis good. Acute cases show rapid,
-chronic cases slow, improvement.</p>
-
-<p><b>Neuralgia.</b>—Prognosis excellent in any form. Trophic
-neuralgias, such as herpes zoster, are slowest as a rule,
-but occasional cases of tic doloureux will require several
-months. One may always expect a cure unless the
-patient, in long cases, becomes discouraged and stops
-adjustments.</p>
-
-<p><b>Neurasthenia.</b>—Good, but will be slow unless mental
-aid be given in the form of freedom from worry or strain.</p>
-
-<p><b>Neuritis.</b>—Good, but very uncertain as to time; some
-cases show quick disappearance of all pain and some
-drag interminably.</p>
-
-<p><b>Optic Atrophy.</b>—Complete atrophy with total blindness
-is rarely cured, though occasional partial or complete
-cures have been reported. Partial atrophy may
-slowly recover, or recovery may cease at some point short
-of completion and case remain stationary thereafter.</p>
-
-<p><b>Ovaritis.</b>—Good, except in suppurative forms. When
-adhesions have been formed, results are doubtful.</p>
-
-<p><b>Pancreatitis.</b>—Obscure, hard to recognize, and hard to
-cure. Prognosis probably bad.</p>
-
-<p><b>Paralysis Agitans.</b>—Probably in the earliest stages
-this is curable. Cure of a fully developed case is exceedingly
-doubtful and the writer has yet to see marked benefit
-in such a case.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_338">338</a></span></p>
-
-<p><b>Paralyses.</b>—Prognosis decidedly variable. Apoplectic
-hemorrhage recovers in about 50 per cent of all cases.
-Paralyses from central lesions require much more time
-than peripheral palsies because of the necessity for rebuilding
-degenerated nerve cells as well as fibres. The
-paralyses following anterior poliomyelitis are almost certain
-to be cured if sufficient time is allowed. Most
-peripheral palsies, except in the very aged, are curable.
-Any other paralysis but a purely functional one recovers
-slowly, but this form may yield almost in a day.</p>
-
-<p><b>Parotitis.</b>—Mumps respond immediately and may be
-checked at any stage.</p>
-
-<p><b>Pericarditis.</b>—Usually recovers. Effusions are stubborn
-and may become purulent, in which case the
-prognosis is grave.</p>
-
-<p><b>Peritonitis.</b>—Prognosis grave, but some cases have
-been reported as cured under adjustment. These are
-probably localized rather than diffuse inflammations,
-usually pelvic.</p>
-
-<p><b>Pertussis, or Whooping-Cough.</b>—Tends to run its
-course despite adjustments, though some aborted cases
-are reported. All cases mild under adjustment, with
-small liability of complications. A nervous cough is
-likely to persist for months after the infection has passed.
-Adjustments seem seldom to prevent contagion.</p>
-
-<p><b>Pharyngitis.</b>—Acute form yields readily. Chronic
-pharyngitis is more stubborn, but usually curable.</p>
-
-<p><b>Pleurisy.</b>—Pleurisy, unless purulent or tubercular,<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_339">339</a></span>
-yields well in varying periods. Purulent and tubercular
-pleurisy are stubborn and may not recover.</p>
-
-<p><b>Pneumonia.</b>—The author has had a wide and gratifying
-experience with pneumonia. At every stage it
-seems amenable to adjustment, and the usual effect of
-the first adjustment is a drop of from one to two degrees
-in the temperature with immediate softening of the consolidated
-area. Specific adjustments get best and quickest
-results. Pneumonia should <b>always</b> recover, unless it
-occurs as an intercurrent event in some chronic and
-wasting disease, as Bright’s Disease.</p>
-
-<p><b>Potts’ Disease.</b>—Tubercular caries of the bodies of the
-vertebrae is curable, within limits. Occasional cases are
-seen in which Nature has stopped the spread of the disease
-by walling off the morbid area with exostosis. Such
-cases should not be adjusted, and the disease may remain
-latent through a long life. When active the disease
-proves fatal unless checked, which is possible in the
-earlier stages, and becomes impossible when the vertebral
-bodies are too fragile to stand strong adjustments. Discernment
-in case-taking will avoid any fatalities under
-adjustment, but by no means all cases of Potts’ Disease
-are curable.</p>
-
-<p><b>Pregnancy.</b>—We may correct by adjustment any
-pathological conditions arising during pregnancy which
-would be amenable to adjustment under other conditions.
-A course of adjustments during a normal pregnancy will
-render delivery easier and lessen, but not abolish, the<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_340">340</a></span>
-pains. Great care must be exercised in the manner of
-adjustment.</p>
-
-<p><b>Prostatic Enlargement.</b>—Varies according to age and
-recuperative power. Prognosis is bad in the very aged
-and infirm, but in more vigorous subjects quite good for
-steady reduction of the hypertrophied gland, with subsidence
-of attendant symptoms. Venereal history is
-unfavorable.</p>
-
-<p id="ptb"><b>Pulmonary Tuberculosis.</b>—In the early stages, where
-little damage has been done to lung tissue, recovery is
-rapid and quite certain. In fully developed cases, with
-characteristic symptoms and marked damage to tissue,
-prognosis is very grave, and it is usually wisest to advise
-a trip to the Southwest in preference to adjustments.
-Tubercular cases should be studied with a view to estimating
-the exact condition and recuperative power of the
-patient before taking.</p>
-
-<p><b>Rachitis.</b>—Prognosis excellent. In a period varying
-from six months in the best to five to seven years in the
-slowest cases, all show complete or nearly complete cures.
-All deformity may be checked in a short time and proper
-bone nourishment established. Correction of deformities
-existing prior to adjustment is a growth process. Too
-many cases become discouraged at the slowness of the
-work and stop adjustments.</p>
-
-<p><b>Retinal Hemorrhage.</b>—Prognosis fair. Undoubted
-cures have been recorded, as well as a few failures. At
-least one case of hemorrhages followed by partially detached
-retina has been cured, or nearly so, by adjustments.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_341">341</a></span></p>
-
-<p><b>Rheumatic Fever.</b>—Hard to adjust because of its painful
-nature. Results of proper adjustment usually, but not
-always, good.</p>
-
-<p><b>Rheumatism.</b>—Muscular rheumatism yields more
-rapidly than articular. Acute tends to quick recovery,
-chronic to more or less lengthened and slow improvement.
-Rheumatic diathesis may require many months of careful
-adjustment.</p>
-
-<p><b>Rubella.</b>—Simply and easily checked. Rash slight,
-and no prostration at all.</p>
-
-<p><b>Scarlet Fever.</b>—Data on quarantinable cases is meagre,
-but scarlet fever, or scarlatina, seems to be quickly
-modified by adjustment. One may expect a drop of from
-one to two degrees in temperature after first adjustment,
-followed by steady rise, which will again be checked
-by the next adjustment. Rash appears early, and all
-symptoms are mild, but several days are often required
-to put the patient at ease. Occasional sequelae, such as
-endocarditis, otitis media, or other inflammations, occur
-unless case be watched with great care. No fatal terminations
-under adjustment except in cases which were at
-first misdiagnosed.</p>
-
-<p><b>Seminal Emissions.</b>—Prognosis excellent in cases uncomplicated
-by masturbation or excessive venery; in such
-cases bad until habits are changed.</p>
-
-<p><b>Simple Continued Fever.</b>—Always recovers. Usually
-drops one to two degrees shortly following correct adjustment,
-with amelioration of all symptoms.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_342">342</a></span></p>
-
-<p><b>Smallpox.</b>—Infections vary in virulence. In temperate
-climates all phases are hastened by adjustment and
-tend to recover without sequelae. The milder smallpox
-due to infection by vaccination is also amenable to adjustment,
-and prompt handling will often prevent serious
-poisoning.</p>
-
-<p><b>Splanchnoptosis.</b>—Partial or marked relief is usual—and
-slow. Complete natural replacement of all viscera is
-the exception rather than the rule.</p>
-
-<p><b>Splenic Enlargement.</b>—Variable prognosis according
-to cause. Secondary enlargements due to systematic
-infection yield with the disappearance of the infection.
-Primary enlargements yield more readily as a rule, with
-exceptions. Malarial spleen is slow to reduce.</p>
-
-<p><b>Splenitis.</b>—Prognosis presumably good, but few authentic
-cases reported.</p>
-
-<p><b>Spondylitis Deformans.</b>—Prognosis favorable for slow,
-slight improvement, but not for complete cure.</p>
-
-<p><b>Strabismus.</b>—Excellent in young subjects, less than
-fair in patients over thirty.</p>
-
-<p><b>Sunstroke.</b>—Theoretically curable, but no experience.</p>
-
-<p><b>Syphilis.</b>—The primary sore frequently dries under
-adjustment without the development of any secondary
-or tertiary stage. If first adjusted during the secondary
-manifestations symptoms may readily disappear and no
-tertiary stage ever appear. There are some authenticated
-cures eight and ten years past without recurrence of any
-sign. In the tertiary stage the organic lesions do not<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_343">343</a></span>
-respond. Prognosis is so hopeless in this stage that it
-seems useless to apply Chiropractic at all.</p>
-
-<p><b>Tabes Dorsalis.</b>—Posterior spinal sclerosis, commonly
-called from its chief symptom “locomotor ataxia,” recovers
-in 40 to 50 per cent of cases adjusted. No accurate
-pre-judgment can be formed as to the probabilities
-in any particular case without experiment, nor has any
-adequate explanation been offered as to why some cases
-recover and others do not. Those cases which improve
-at all are likely to recover fully. In any instance, time
-is required for the regeneration of the dorsal column
-axons, and while this is going on no improvement may
-be apparent at all.</p>
-
-<p><b>Tachycardia.</b>—If symptomatic, as of exophthalmic
-goitre, tachycardia yields as the disease does. If primary,
-a few adjustments usually establish a proper pulse rate.</p>
-
-<p><b>Tetanus.</b>—Only one undoubted case has been brought
-to the writer’s attention and this one a marvellous cure.
-Adjustments were given as often as every ten minutes
-for a time.</p>
-
-<p><b>Thoracic Aneurism.</b>—Cure exceedingly doubtful, and
-fatal termination possible at any time. Little information
-is at hand.</p>
-
-<p><b>Tonsilitis—Quinsy</b>.—Simple or follicular tonsilitis
-aborts under adjustment in from a few hours to two or
-three days. Quinsy, or suppurative tonsilitis, runs its
-regular course as to duration, but is frequently a febrile
-after the first day. Spontaneous rupture of the tonsil<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_344">344</a></span>
-will usually occur and sometimes two or three such ruptures
-will lengthen the case slightly. Sequalae are wanting,
-but all forms of tonsilar inflammation tend to recur
-unless a long course of corrective adjustments is applied
-to the cervical region.</p>
-
-<p><b>Torticollis.</b>—Acute spastic or rheumatic torticollis in
-which permanent contractures have not yet set in may
-be cured almost invariably in a period varying from a
-few days to several weeks. Chronic cases with permanent
-contractures yield very slowly, but prognosis is good
-for a fairly accurate straightening of the neck. Such
-cases often leave slight abnormalities even in the most
-competent hands.</p>
-
-<p><b>Tuberculosis, Pulmonary.</b>—See <a href="#ptb">Pulmonary Tuberculosis</a>.</p>
-
-<p><b>Tumors, Benign.</b>—Unlike malignant growths, benign
-tumors, fatty, fibroid, etc., tend to gradual absorption
-under adjustment. Perhaps 75 per cent or more may be
-completely cured. Age is a factor, tumors in young subjects
-being more readily curable than in the aged or
-infirm.</p>
-
-<p><b>Tumors, Malignant.</b>—Prognosis bad. If cancer in
-any form can be cured proof has escaped the author’s
-diligent search. It is wisest to refuse all cancerous cases.</p>
-
-<p><b>Typhoid Fever.</b>—Prognosis excellent if adjustments
-are commenced during first week of fever, in which case
-the fever should be aborted at once, followed by one or
-two mild exacerbations, then permanently checked.<span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_345">345</a></span>
-Doubtful prognosis after first week, because of liability
-to perforation during adjustment. After second week of
-fever very grave prognosis under adjustment, and better
-with nursing alone.</p>
-
-<p><b>Uteroversion—Prolapsus</b>.—Uteroversions and prolapses
-are corrected, sometimes rapidly but more often
-slowly and gradually. Favoring circumstances are freedom
-from overwork or overlifting. Some extreme cases
-result in failure.</p>
-
-<p><b>Valvular Diseases.</b>—These may be grouped for prognosis.
-No percentages have been compiled, but it may
-be said that the prognosis is generally good as to relief
-and restoration of compensation, but poor as to rebuilding
-of the valves. Many cases of apparent permanent
-and complete recovery are probably simply cases of excellent
-compensation. Death occasionally occurs despite
-adjustments.</p>
-
-<p><b>Varicocele.</b>—Outlook good for a slow, certain recovery.</p>
-
-<p><b>Varicose Veins.</b>—Probability favors cure in subjects
-not beyond middle life, providing they are not greatly
-overweight or too much on their feet. Cure always slow.</p>
-
-<hr />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_346">346</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter"><div class="index">
-<h2 class="nobreak p1"><a id="INDEX"></a>INDEX</h2>
-
-<ul class="index">
-<li class="ifrst">A</li>
-
-<li class="indx">Abdominal muscles, <a href="#Page_248">248</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Abscesses, <a href="#Page_323">323</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Acne, <a href="#Page_323">323</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Adenoids of pharynx, <a href="#Page_323">323</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Addison’s disease, <a href="#Page_323">323</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Adiposis dolorosa, <a href="#Page_323">323</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Adjuncts, <a href="#Page_215">215</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Adjuncts, use of, <a href="#Page_315">315</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Adjusting, contact in, <a href="#Page_94">94</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">definition of, <a href="#Page_89">89</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">general, <a href="#Page_303">303</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">how to learn, <a href="#Page_164">164</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">principles of, <a href="#Page_89">89</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">rapid movement in, <a href="#Page_93">93</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">specific, <a href="#Page_303">303</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">special technic of, <a href="#Page_99">99</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">speed in, <a href="#Page_131">131</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">technic of, <a href="#Page_89">89</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Adjusting position, rules for, <a href="#Page_127">127</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Adjusting tables, <a href="#Page_284">284</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Adjustment, effect of, <a href="#Page_186">186</a>, <a href="#Page_189">189</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">object of, <a href="#Page_90">90</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">specific, <a href="#Page_230">230</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">vertebral, <a href="#Page_89">89</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Adjustment of curvatures, <a href="#Page_153">153</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Adjustments, coccygeal, <a href="#Page_152">152</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">frequency of, <a href="#Page_302">302</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">iliac, <a href="#Page_150">150</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">sacral, <a href="#Page_150">150</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">table of for any subluxation, <a href="#Page_156">156</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Advertising, <a href="#Page_290">290</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Age of subluxations, <a href="#Page_84">84</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Alcoholism, <a href="#Page_323">323</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Amenorrhoea, <a href="#Page_324">324</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Anatomy, comparative, <a href="#Page_226">226</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">nervous, <a href="#Page_234">234</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Anchor move, <a href="#Page_116">116</a>, <a href="#Page_118">118</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Angina pectoris, <a href="#Page_324">324</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Anidroses, <a href="#Page_324">324</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Ankylosis, <a href="#Page_58">58</a>, <a href="#Page_88">88</a>, <a href="#Page_324">324</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Anosmia, <a href="#Page_324">324</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Anterior cervical move, <a href="#Page_102">102</a>, <a href="#Page_103">103</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">pisiform, <a href="#Page_100">100</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Anterior fifth lumbar, <a href="#Page_150">150</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Anterior poliomyelitis, <a href="#Page_324">324</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Anterior subluxations, <a href="#Page_84">84</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Aorta, abdominal, <a href="#Page_250">250</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">thoracic, <a href="#Page_250">250</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Aphonia, <a href="#Page_325">325</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Apoplexy, <a href="#Page_325">325</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Appendicitis, <a href="#Page_325">325</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Appendix, vermiform, <a href="#Page_253">253</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Approximation, vertebral, <a href="#Page_82">82</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Arm, anterior muscles of, <a href="#Page_255">255</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">posterior muscles of, <a href="#Page_255">255</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Arteria centralis retinae, <a href="#Page_243">243</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Arthritis deformans, <a href="#Page_325">325</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Ascites, <a href="#Page_326">326</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Asthma, <a href="#Page_326">326</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Atlanto-occipital move, <a href="#Page_106">106</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Atlas, <a href="#Page_18">18</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Atlas move, <a href="#Page_106">106</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Atlas palpation, <a href="#Page_35">35</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Axis, <a href="#Page_19">19</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Axis of body, <a href="#Page_223">223</a></li>
-
-<li class="ifrst">B</li>
-
-<li class="indx">Back, muscles of, <a href="#Page_247">247</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Bag punching, <a href="#Page_97">97</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Bent process, <a href="#Page_59">59</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Blindness, <a href="#Page_326">326</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Bodily excesses, <a href="#Page_200">200</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Body axis, <a href="#Page_223">223</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Brachial plexus, <a href="#Page_225">225</a>, <a href="#Page_236">236</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Bradycardia, <a href="#Page_326">326</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Brain, <a href="#Page_242">242</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Break move, the <a href="#Page_107">107</a>, <a href="#Page_109">109</a>, <a href="#Page_110">110</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Bright’s disease, <a href="#Page_326">326</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Bronchi, <a href="#Page_249">249</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Bronchitis, <a href="#Page_327">327</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Bladder, <a href="#Page_253">253</a></li>
-
-<li class="ifrst">C</li>
-
-<li class="indx">Caecum, <a href="#Page_253">253</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Caked Breast, <a href="#Page_327">327</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Cards for collection, <a href="#Page_291">291</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Caries of spine, <a href="#Page_56">56</a>, <a href="#Page_154">154</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Case history, <a href="#Page_297">297</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Causes, accessory chains of, <a href="#Page_177">177</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">direct chain of, <a href="#Page_177">177</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Cause of disease, <a href="#Page_165">165</a>, <a href="#Page_167">167</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Cause of disease, primary, <a href="#Page_207">207</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Cause of disease, secondary, <a href="#Page_185">185</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Cell, effect of impingement upon, <a href="#Page_183">183</a><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_347">347</a></span></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Center place, <a href="#Page_206">206</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Cerebrospinal meningitis, <a href="#Page_327">327</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Cervical move, double contact, <a href="#Page_120">120</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Cervical move, posterior, <a href="#Page_119">119</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Cervical plexus, <a href="#Page_238">238</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Chassaignac’s tubercle, <a href="#Page_61">61</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Chickenpox, <a href="#Page_327">327</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Chiropractice hypothesis, <a href="#Page_172">172</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Chiropractic, limitations of, <a href="#Page_312">312</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Choice of furnishings, <a href="#Page_178">178</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Cholangitis, <a href="#Page_327">327</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Cholecystitis, <a href="#Page_327">327</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Chorea, <a href="#Page_327">327</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Christian Science, <a href="#Page_216">216</a>, <a href="#Page_315">315</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Cirrhosis of liver, <a href="#Page_328">328</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Cleanliness, <a href="#Page_286">286</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Coccyx, <a href="#Page_17">17</a>, <a href="#Page_19">19</a>, <a href="#Page_45">45</a>, <a href="#Page_152">152</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Coeliac axis, <a href="#Page_250">250</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Collection cards, <a href="#Page_291">291</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Colon, <a href="#Page_253">253</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Comparative anatomy, <a href="#Page_226">226</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Concussion of forces, <a href="#Page_178">178</a>, <a href="#Page_224">224</a>, <a href="#Page_226">226</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Congestion of liver, <a href="#Page_328">328</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Conjunctiva, <a href="#Page_243">243</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Conjunctivitis, <a href="#Page_328">328</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Contact, close, <a href="#Page_94">94</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Contact point, <a href="#Page_129">129</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Constipation, <a href="#Page_328">328</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Coryza, <a href="#Page_328">328</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Count, <a href="#Page_30">30</a>, <a href="#Page_33">33</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">difficulties in, <a href="#Page_34">34</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">verifying, <a href="#Page_33">33</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Cranial nerves, distribution of, <a href="#Page_240">240</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Croup, <a href="#Page_328">328</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Cure of bodily excess disease, <a href="#Page_214">214</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">dietetic disease, <a href="#Page_212">212</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">germ disease, <a href="#Page_211">211</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">exposure disease, <a href="#Page_214">214</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">mental disease, <a href="#Page_212">212</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">poisoning cases, <a href="#Page_213">213</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">simple subluxation disease, <a href="#Page_208">208</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">process of, <a href="#Page_208">208</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Curvatures, <a href="#Page_153">153</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">causes of, <a href="#Page_55">55</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">compensatory, <a href="#Page_57">57</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">description of, <a href="#Page_54">54</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">record of, <a href="#Page_56">56</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">rotatory, <a href="#Page_55">55</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Curves and curvatures, <a href="#Page_53">53</a></li>
-
-<li class="ifrst">D</li>
-
-<li class="indx">Deafness, <a href="#Page_329">329</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Diabetes insipidus, <a href="#Page_329">329</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">mellitus, <a href="#Page_329">329</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Diagnosis, <a href="#Page_231">231</a>, <a href="#Page_275">275</a>, <a href="#Page_298">298</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Diaphragm, <a href="#Page_248">248</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Diarrhoea, <a href="#Page_329">329</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Diet, <a href="#Page_192">192</a>, <a href="#Page_193">193</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Dietetics, <a href="#Page_315">315</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Dilatation of heart, <a href="#Page_329">329</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Diphtheria, <a href="#Page_187">187</a>, <a href="#Page_190">190</a>, <a href="#Page_329">329</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Direction of subluxation, <a href="#Page_25">25</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Disease, cause of, <a href="#Page_165">165</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">functional, <a href="#Page_166">166</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">organic, <a href="#Page_166">166</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Diseases and adjustments, <a href="#Page_257">257</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">table of, <a href="#Page_258">258</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Displacements, <a href="#Page_84">84</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Door sign, <a href="#Page_290">290</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Double contact move, <a href="#Page_120">120</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Double transverse moves, <a href="#Page_135">135</a>, <a href="#Page_138">138</a>, <a href="#Page_139">139</a>, <a href="#Page_148">148</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Dressing room, <a href="#Page_286">286</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Dropsy, <a href="#Page_330">330</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Drugs, <a href="#Page_315">315</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Duodenum, <a href="#Page_252">252</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Dysentery, <a href="#Page_330">330</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Dyspepsia, <a href="#Page_330">330</a></li>
-
-<li class="ifrst">E</li>
-
-<li class="indx">Ear, <a href="#Page_245">245</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Edge contact, the, <a href="#Page_144">144</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Effect of adjustment, <a href="#Page_188">188</a>, <a href="#Page_189">189</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Effect of subluxations, <a href="#Page_79">79</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Elbow joint, <a href="#Page_255">255</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Electricity, <a href="#Page_216">216</a>, <a href="#Page_315">315</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Enuresis, <a href="#Page_330">330</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Epidemics, <a href="#Page_189">189</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Epilepsy, <a href="#Page_330">330</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Epiphysis, absent, <a href="#Page_60">60</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Epistaxis, <a href="#Page_331">331</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Erysipelas, <a href="#Page_331">331</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Eustachian tube, <a href="#Page_245">245</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Evidence, kinds of acceptable, <a href="#Page_234">234</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Examination, schedule of, <a href="#Page_292">292</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">special, <a href="#Page_296">296</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Excesses, bodily, <a href="#Page_200">200</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Excitation, <a href="#Page_162">162</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Exposure, <a href="#Page_198">198</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Eye, <a href="#Page_242">242</a></li>
-
-<li class="ifrst">F</li>
-
-<li class="indx">Fallopian tubes, <a href="#Page_254">254</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Fasting, <a href="#Page_215">215</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Fear, <a href="#Page_201">201</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Fees, <a href="#Page_291">291</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Fever, <a href="#Page_205">205</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Fever center, <a href="#Page_206">206</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Fibrocartilages, intervertebral, <a href="#Page_83">83</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">First appearance, value of, <a href="#Page_277">277</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Foods, <a href="#Page_194">194</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Foot, <a href="#Page_257">257</a><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_348">348</a></span></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Force in adjusting, <a href="#Page_98">98</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Freidrich’s ataxia, <a href="#Page_331">331</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Frequency of adjustments, <a href="#Page_302">302</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Furniture, arrangement of, <a href="#Page_282">282</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">office, <a href="#Page_278">278</a></li>
-
-<li class="ifrst">G</li>
-
-<li class="indx">Gallstones, <a href="#Page_331">331</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Ganglion, ciliary, <a href="#Page_243">243</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Gasserian, <a href="#Page_244">244</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">middle cervical, <a href="#Page_247">247</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">sphenopalatine, <a href="#Page_244">244</a>, <a href="#Page_246">246</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">superior cervical, <a href="#Page_244">244</a>, <a href="#Page_246">246</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Gastralgia, <a href="#Page_332">332</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Gastric ulcer, <a href="#Page_332">332</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Gastritis, <a href="#Page_332">332</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">General adjusting, <a href="#Page_303">303</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Germ diseases, <a href="#Page_185">185</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Germs, <a href="#Page_185">185</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">pathogenic, <a href="#Page_185">185</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Gland, thyroid, <a href="#Page_247">247</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">prostate, <a href="#Page_253">253</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Glands, salivary, <a href="#Page_246">246</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">suprarenal, <a href="#Page_252">252</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Gluteus maximus muscle, <a href="#Page_256">256</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Goitre, <a href="#Page_332">332</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Gonorrhoeal rheumatism, <a href="#Page_332">332</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Group method, the, <a href="#Page_37">37</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">example of, <a href="#Page_39">39</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Gums, <a href="#Page_245">245</a></li>
-
-<li class="ifrst">H</li>
-
-<li class="indx">Habits, <a href="#Page_15">15</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Hay fever, <a href="#Page_332">332</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Headache, <a href="#Page_332">332</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Heart, <a href="#Page_249">249</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Heat-regulating mechanism, <a href="#Page_203">203</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Heel contact, the, <a href="#Page_133">133</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Hemorrhoids, <a href="#Page_333">333</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Hernia, <a href="#Page_333">333</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Hip joint, <a href="#Page_255">255</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">History of case, <a href="#Page_297">297</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Hodgkins’ disease, <a href="#Page_333">333</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Hook support, <a href="#Page_105">105</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Hydrocephalus, <a href="#Page_333">333</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Hydrotherapy, <a href="#Page_315">315</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Hyperaemia, <a href="#Page_202">202</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Hypertrophy, <a href="#Page_333">333</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Hypothesis, chiropractic, <a href="#Page_172">172</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Hysteria, <a href="#Page_333">333</a></li>
-
-<li class="ifrst">I</li>
-
-<li class="indx">Ileum, <a href="#Page_252">252</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Iliac adjustments, <a href="#Page_150">150</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Ilium, <a href="#Page_150">150</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Immunity, <a href="#Page_334">334</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Impingement of nerves, <a href="#Page_180">180</a>, <a href="#Page_209">209</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Impotence, <a href="#Page_334">334</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Individual subluxation, <a href="#Page_40">40</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Infection, <a href="#Page_186">186</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Inflammation, <a href="#Page_202">202</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Influenza, <a href="#Page_334">334</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Inhibition, <a href="#Page_169">169</a>, <a href="#Page_182">182</a>, <a href="#Page_189">189</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Insanity, <a href="#Page_201">201</a>, <a href="#Page_334">334</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Interiliac line, <a href="#Page_34">34</a>, <a href="#Page_62">62</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Intervertebral disks, <a href="#Page_83">83</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Intervertebral foramina, <a href="#Page_18">18</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Intestinal obstruction, <a href="#Page_335">335</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Iris, <a href="#Page_243">243</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Irritable heart, <a href="#Page_335">335</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Irritability, <a href="#Page_169">169</a></li>
-
-<li class="ifrst">J</li>
-
-<li class="indx">Jaundice, <a href="#Page_335">335</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Jejunum, <a href="#Page_252">252</a></li>
-
-<li class="ifrst">K</li>
-
-<li class="indx">Key, <a href="#Page_39">39</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Kidneys, <a href="#Page_252">252</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Klebs-Loeffler bacillus, <a href="#Page_187">187</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Knee joint, <a href="#Page_256">256</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Knife move, <a href="#Page_144">144</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Kyphosis, <a href="#Page_54">54</a></li>
-
-<li class="ifrst">L</li>
-
-<li class="indx">Landmarks, <a href="#Page_61">61</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Laryngitis, <a href="#Page_335">335</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Larynx, <a href="#Page_246">246</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Last finger contact, <a href="#Page_102">102</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Lateral cervical move, <a href="#Page_107">107</a>, <a href="#Page_109">109</a>, <a href="#Page_110">110</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Lateral displacements, <a href="#Page_84">84</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Law of momentum, <a href="#Page_98">98</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Leg, anterior muscles of, <a href="#Page_256">256</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">posterior muscles of, <a href="#Page_256">256</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Leucorrhoea, <a href="#Page_335">335</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Library, reference, <a href="#Page_289">289</a><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_349">349</a></span></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Limitations of Chiropractic, <a href="#Page_212">212</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Liver, <a href="#Page_251">251</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Location of subluxations, <a href="#Page_78">78</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Lordosis, <a href="#Page_54">54</a>, <a href="#Page_85">85</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Lumbago, <a href="#Page_335">335</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Lumbar, anterior, <a href="#Page_150">150</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Lumbar plexus, <a href="#Page_239">239</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Lungs, <a href="#Page_249">249</a></li>
-
-<li class="ifrst">M</li>
-
-<li class="indx">Maladjustment, <a href="#Page_89">89</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Malaria, <a href="#Page_335">335</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Major subluxations, <a href="#Page_39">39</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Massage, <a href="#Page_215">215</a>, <a href="#Page_315">315</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Mastoiditis, <a href="#Page_336">336</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Measles, <a href="#Page_336">336</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Meckel’s ganglion, <a href="#Page_244">244</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Mechano-therapy, <a href="#Page_315">315</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Medicine, <a href="#Page_315">315</a>, <a href="#Page_316">316</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Meniere’s disease, <a href="#Page_336">336</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Meninges, <a href="#Page_242">242</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Menorrhagia, <a href="#Page_336">336</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Mental attitude, <a href="#Page_63">63</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Mental states, abnormal, <a href="#Page_201">201</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Metrorrhagia, <a href="#Page_336">336</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Migraine, <a href="#Page_336">336</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Minor subluxations, <a href="#Page_39">39</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Mixing, <a href="#Page_315">315</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Morikubo move, <a href="#Page_99">99</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Motor reaction, <a href="#Page_193">193</a>, <a href="#Page_196">196</a>, <a href="#Page_199">199</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Movable kidney, <a href="#Page_336">336</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Movement for correction, <a href="#Page_27">27</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Muscles of abdomen, <a href="#Page_244">244</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">of back, <a href="#Page_247">247</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">of neck, <a href="#Page_247">247</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">of perineum, <a href="#Page_249">249</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Muscular control, <a href="#Page_97">97</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Muscular suggestion, <a href="#Page_96">96</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Myelitis, <a href="#Page_336">336</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Myocarditis, <a href="#Page_336">336</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Myxoedema, <a href="#Page_337">337</a></li>
-
-<li class="ifrst">N</li>
-
-<li class="indx">Naprapathy, <a href="#Page_313">313</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Napravit, <a href="#Page_313">313</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Neck, muscles of, <a href="#Page_247">247</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Nephritis, <a href="#Page_337">337</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Nerve, auditory, <a href="#Page_245">245</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">chorda tympani, <a href="#Page_246">246</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">great sciatic, <a href="#Page_256">256</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">hypoglossal, <a href="#Page_245">245</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">inferior maxillary, <a href="#Page_244">244</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">internal carotid, <a href="#Page_242">242</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">olfactory, <a href="#Page_243">243</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">phrenic, <a href="#Page_248">248</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">recurrent laryngeal, <a href="#Page_246">246</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">trigeminal (trifacial), <a href="#Page_244">244</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">Vidian, <a href="#Page_244">244</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Nerve connections, special, <a href="#Page_235">235</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Nerve impingement, <a href="#Page_180">180</a>, <a href="#Page_182">182</a>, <a href="#Page_209">209</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Nerve paths, <a href="#Page_70">70</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Nerve pathways, important, <a href="#Page_242">242</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">structure of, <a href="#Page_241">241</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Nerves, cranial, <a href="#Page_240">240</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">optic, <a href="#Page_242">242</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">spinal, <a href="#Page_237">237</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">splanchnic, <a href="#Page_250">250</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">sympathetic, <a href="#Page_240">240</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">traceable, <a href="#Page_64">64</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Nerve system, <a href="#Page_171">171</a>, <a href="#Page_222">222</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">development of, <a href="#Page_219">219</a>, <a href="#Page_220">220</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">outline of, <a href="#Page_235">235</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">sympathetic, <a href="#Page_171">171</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Nerve-tracing, <a href="#Page_64">64</a>, <a href="#Page_296">296</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">errors in, <a href="#Page_73">73</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">place of in diagnosis, <a href="#Page_67">67</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">suggestion in, <a href="#Page_67">67</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">technic of, <a href="#Page_68">68</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Neuralgia, <a href="#Page_337">337</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Neurasthenia, <a href="#Page_337">337</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Neuritis, <a href="#Page_337">337</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Neurology, <a href="#Page_234">234</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Neuron, <a href="#Page_220">220</a></li>
-
-<li class="ifrst">O</li>
-
-<li class="indx">Observation of patient, <a href="#Page_294">294</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Occipital subluxations, <a href="#Page_66">66</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Occipito-atlantal move, <a href="#Page_106">106</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Occlusion of foramina, <a href="#Page_180">180</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Office equipment, <a href="#Page_277">277</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Optic atrophy, <a href="#Page_337">337</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Optic nerve, <a href="#Page_242">242</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Oral suggestion, <a href="#Page_95">95</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Organs, effect of impingement upon, <a href="#Page_183">183</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Organ-tracing, <a href="#Page_64">64</a><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_350">350</a></span></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Osteopathy, <a href="#Page_216">216</a>, <a href="#Page_313">313</a>, <a href="#Page_314">314</a>, <a href="#Page_315">315</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Ovaries, <a href="#Page_254">254</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Ovaritis, <a href="#Page_337">337</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Overadjustment, <a href="#Page_303">303</a></li>
-
-<li class="ifrst">P</li>
-
-<li class="indx">Palpation, atlas, <a href="#Page_35">35</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">cervical, <a href="#Page_42">42</a>, <a href="#Page_47">47</a>, <a href="#Page_48">48</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">coccygeal, <a href="#Page_45">45</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">difficulties in, <a href="#Page_59">59</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">dorsal, <a href="#Page_43">43</a>, <a href="#Page_46">46</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">habits of, <a href="#Page_15">15</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">lumbar, <a href="#Page_44">44</a>, <a href="#Page_46">46</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">pelvic, <a href="#Page_44">44</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">sacral, <a href="#Page_44">44</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">transverse, <a href="#Page_49">49</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">vertebral, <a href="#Page_15">15</a>, <a href="#Page_295">295</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Pancreas, <a href="#Page_251">251</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Paralysis agitans, <a href="#Page_337">337</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Parotitis, <a href="#Page_338">338</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Pectoralis muscles, <a href="#Page_254">254</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Penis, <a href="#Page_253">253</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Pericarditis, <a href="#Page_338">338</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Pericardium, <a href="#Page_249">249</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Perineal muscles, <a href="#Page_249">249</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Peritoneum, <a href="#Page_252">252</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Peritonitis, <a href="#Page_338">338</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Personality, <a href="#Page_319">319</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Pertussis, <a href="#Page_338">338</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Pharyngitis, <a href="#Page_338">338</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Pharynx, <a href="#Page_246">246</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Pisiform anterior cervical move, <a href="#Page_100">100</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Pisiform contact, <a href="#Page_125">125</a>, <a href="#Page_135">135</a>, <a href="#Page_139">139</a>, <a href="#Page_141">141</a>, <a href="#Page_146">146</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Pleurisy, <a href="#Page_338">338</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Plexus, abdominal aortic, <a href="#Page_253">253</a>, <a href="#Page_254">254</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">Auerbach’s, <a href="#Page_251">251</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">brachial, <a href="#Page_238">238</a>, <a href="#Page_254">254</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">cardiac, <a href="#Page_249">249</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">carotid, <a href="#Page_244">244</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">cavernous, <a href="#Page_243">243</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">cervical, <a href="#Page_238">238</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">coelic, <a href="#Page_250">250</a>, <a href="#Page_252">252</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">cystic, <a href="#Page_251">251</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Plexus, gastric, <a href="#Page_251">251</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">hemorrhoidal, <a href="#Page_253">253</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">hepatic, <a href="#Page_251">251</a>, <a href="#Page_252">252</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">hypogastric, <a href="#Page_253">253</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">inferior mesenteric, <a href="#Page_253">253</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">lumbar, <a href="#Page_239">239</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">lumbosacral, <a href="#Page_255">255</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">Meissner’s, <a href="#Page_251">251</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">ovarian, <a href="#Page_254">254</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">pelvic, <a href="#Page_253">253</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">pharyngeal, <a href="#Page_246">246</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">phrenic, <a href="#Page_248">248</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">prostatic, <a href="#Page_253">253</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">pudendal, <a href="#Page_239">239</a>, <a href="#Page_254">254</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">pulmonary, <a href="#Page_249">249</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">renal, <a href="#Page_252">252</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">sacral, <a href="#Page_239">239</a>, <a href="#Page_254">254</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">solar, <a href="#Page_250">250</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">spermatic, <a href="#Page_253">253</a>, <a href="#Page_254">254</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">splenic, <a href="#Page_251">251</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">superior mesenteric, <a href="#Page_251">251</a>, <a href="#Page_252">252</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">suprarenal, <a href="#Page_252">252</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">uterovaginal, <a href="#Page_254">254</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">vesical, <a href="#Page_253">253</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Pneumonia, <a href="#Page_339">339</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Point 2 contact, <a href="#Page_144">144</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Poisons, <a href="#Page_197">197</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Position A, <a href="#Page_22">22</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Position B, <a href="#Page_23">23</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Position C, <a href="#Page_23">23</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Positions for palpation, <a href="#Page_30">30</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Posterior cervical move, <a href="#Page_119">119</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Posterior subluxations, <a href="#Page_85">85</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Potts’ disease, <a href="#Page_56">56</a>, <a href="#Page_154">154</a>, <a href="#Page_339">339</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Practice, <a href="#Page_276">276</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Preferable adjustments, <a href="#Page_155">155</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Pregnancy, <a href="#Page_339">339</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Preparation of patient, <a href="#Page_22">22</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Presumptive statements, <a href="#Page_235">235</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Private office, <a href="#Page_282">282</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Process, bent spinous, <a href="#Page_59">59</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Processes, spinous, <a href="#Page_20">20</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">transverse, <a href="#Page_21">21</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Prognosis, <a href="#Page_322">322</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">general, <a href="#Page_323">323</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Prolapsus, <a href="#Page_345">345</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Promises to patients, <a href="#Page_306">306</a><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_351">351</a></span></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Prostate gland, <a href="#Page_253">253</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Prostatic enlargement, <a href="#Page_340">340</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Psychoses, <a href="#Page_201">201</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Pudendal plexus, <a href="#Page_239">239</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Pulmonary tuberculosis, <a href="#Page_340">340</a></li>
-
-<li class="ifrst">Q</li>
-
-<li class="indx">Quinsy, <a href="#Page_343">343</a></li>
-
-<li class="ifrst">R</li>
-
-<li class="indx">Rachitis, <a href="#Page_340">340</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Rami communicantes, <a href="#Page_172">172</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">white, <a href="#Page_250">250</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Recoil, name of, <a href="#Page_132">132</a>, <a href="#Page_133">133</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">the, <a href="#Page_125">125</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">uses of, <a href="#Page_131">131</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Record, the, <a href="#Page_23">23</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">the complete, <a href="#Page_29">29</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">sample of, <a href="#Page_29">29</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">use of, <a href="#Page_30">30</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Rectum, <a href="#Page_253">253</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Reference library, <a href="#Page_289">289</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Reflex arcs, <a href="#Page_241">241</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Relaxation, <a href="#Page_95">95</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Rest room, <a href="#Page_287">287</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Retina, <a href="#Page_242">242</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">central artery of, <a href="#Page_243">243</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Retinal hemorrhage, <a href="#Page_340">340</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Retracing of disease, <a href="#Page_211">211</a>, <a href="#Page_309">309</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Rheumatic fever, <a href="#Page_341">341</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Rheumatism, <a href="#Page_341">341</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Roll, the, <a href="#Page_285">285</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Rotary move, the, <a href="#Page_111">111</a>, <a href="#Page_115">115</a>, <a href="#Page_116">116</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Rotation, axis of, <a href="#Page_80">80</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">vertebral, <a href="#Page_80">80</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Rubella, <a href="#Page_341">341</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Rules for adjusting positions, <a href="#Page_127">127</a></li>
-
-<li class="ifrst">S</li>
-
-<li class="indx">Sacrum, <a href="#Page_17">17</a>, <a href="#Page_19">19</a>, <a href="#Page_149">149</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Sacral adjustments, <a href="#Page_149">149</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Sacral plexus, <a href="#Page_239">239</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Salivary glands, <a href="#Page_246">246</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Sample record, <a href="#Page_29">29</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Scarlet fever, <a href="#Page_341">341</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Schedule of examination, <a href="#Page_292">292</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Schneiderian membrane, <a href="#Page_243">243</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Scoliosis, <a href="#Page_55">55</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Scrotum, <a href="#Page_254">254</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Second metacarpal contact, <a href="#Page_103">103</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Segmentation, <a href="#Page_219">219</a>, <a href="#Page_229">229</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Selecting movement, <a href="#Page_156">156</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Seminal emissions, <a href="#Page_341">341</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Seminal vesicles, <a href="#Page_258">258</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Sensor areas of lower extremity, <a href="#Page_257">257</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Serratus magnus muscle, <a href="#Page_255">255</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Serum-therapy, <a href="#Page_186">186</a>, <a href="#Page_315">315</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Shoulder joint, <a href="#Page_255">255</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Signs, <a href="#Page_290">290</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Simple continued fever, <a href="#Page_341">341</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Single transverse moves, <a href="#Page_141">141</a>, <a href="#Page_142">142</a>, <a href="#Page_146">146</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Smallpox, <a href="#Page_342">342</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Smell, <a href="#Page_243">243</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Special cases, <a href="#Page_301">301</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Special nerve connections, <a href="#Page_235">235</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Specific adjustment, <a href="#Page_230">230</a>, <a href="#Page_303">303</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Spinal column, <a href="#Page_16">16</a>, <a href="#Page_222">222</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Spinal nerves, distribution of, <a href="#Page_237">237</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Spine, <a href="#Page_16">16</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Spino-organic connection, <a href="#Page_217">217</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Spinous, bent <a href="#Page_59">59</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Spinous process, <a href="#Page_20">20</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Splanchnoptosis, <a href="#Page_342">342</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Spleen, <a href="#Page_251">251</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Splenic enlargement, <a href="#Page_342">342</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Splenitis, <a href="#Page_342">342</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Spondylitis deformans, <a href="#Page_342">342</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Spondylotherapy, <a href="#Page_215">215</a>, <a href="#Page_313">313</a>, <a href="#Page_315">315</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Spread move, <a href="#Page_148">148</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Stimulation, <a href="#Page_169">169</a>, <a href="#Page_189">189</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Stomach, <a href="#Page_251">251</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Strabismus, <a href="#Page_342">342</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Subluxation, <a href="#Page_217">217</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">direction of, <a href="#Page_25">25</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">effect of, <a href="#Page_179">179</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">the individual, <a href="#Page_40">40</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">theory, <a href="#Page_172">172</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Subluxations, age of, <a href="#Page_87">87</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">anterior, <a href="#Page_84">84</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">contiguous, <a href="#Page_37">37</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">effect of, <a href="#Page_79">79</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">increase of, <a href="#Page_191">191</a>, <a href="#Page_193">193</a>, <a href="#Page_196">196</a>, <a href="#Page_199">199</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Subluxations, inferior, <a href="#Page_83">83</a><span class="pagenum"><a id="Page_352">352</a></span></li>
-<li class="isub1">lateral, <a href="#Page_84">84</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">law governing location of, <a href="#Page_78">78</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">major, <a href="#Page_39">39</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">minor, <a href="#Page_39">39</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">occipital, <a href="#Page_86">86</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">posterior, <a href="#Page_85">85</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">production of, <a href="#Page_76">76</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">secondary causes of, <a href="#Page_77">77</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">superior, <a href="#Page_83">83</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">varieties of, <a href="#Page_80">80</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Suggestion, muscular, <a href="#Page_96">96</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">oral, <a href="#Page_95">95</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Suggestive therapeutics, <a href="#Page_315">315</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Sunstroke, <a href="#Page_342">342</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Supporting head in adjusting, <a href="#Page_105">105</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Suprarenal capsules, <a href="#Page_252">252</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Susceptibility, <a href="#Page_186">186</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Sympathetic, cervical, <a href="#Page_242">242</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Sympathetic nerves, distribution of, <a href="#Page_240">240</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Sympathetic nerve system, <a href="#Page_171">171</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Syphilis, <a href="#Page_342">342</a></li>
-
-<li class="ifrst">T</li>
-
-<li class="indx">Tabes dorsalis, <a href="#Page_343">343</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Table of diseases and adjustments, <a href="#Page_257">257</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Table of subluxations and moves, <a href="#Page_155">155</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Tachycardia, <a href="#Page_343">343</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Talking points, <a href="#Page_306">306</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Teeth, <a href="#Page_245">245</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Tenderness <a href="#Page_69">69</a>, <a href="#Page_71">71</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Tension, <a href="#Page_181">181</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Testes, <a href="#Page_254">254</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Tetanus, <a href="#Page_343">343</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Theory of Chiropractic, <a href="#Page_172">172</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Theory, subluxation, <a href="#Page_172">172</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Thigh, <a href="#Page_255">255</a>, <a href="#Page_256">256</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Thoracic aneurism, <a href="#Page_343">343</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Thoracic nerves, <a href="#Page_238">238</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Thrust, <a href="#Page_91">91</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Thumb move, <a href="#Page_121">121</a>, <a href="#Page_123">123</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Thyroid gland, <a href="#Page_247">247</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Tipping, vertebral, <a href="#Page_82">82</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">T. M., <a href="#Page_121">121</a>, <a href="#Page_123">123</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Tongue, <a href="#Page_245">245</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Tonsilitis, <a href="#Page_343">343</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Tonsils, <a href="#Page_246">246</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Torticollis, <a href="#Page_344">344</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Trachea, <a href="#Page_249">249</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Transmitted shock, <a href="#Page_91">91</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Transverse adjusting, <a href="#Page_135">135</a>, <a href="#Page_138">138</a>, <a href="#Page_139">139</a>, <a href="#Page_141">141</a>, <a href="#Page_143">143</a>, <a href="#Page_146">146</a>, <a href="#Page_148">148</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Transverses, <a href="#Page_21">21</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Trauma, effect of, <a href="#Page_174">174</a>, <a href="#Page_178">178</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Tube, eustachian, <a href="#Page_245">245</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">fallopian, <a href="#Page_254">254</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Tuberculosis, pulmonary, <a href="#Page_344">344</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Tumors, benign, <a href="#Page_344">344</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">malignant, <a href="#Page_344">344</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Typhoid fever, <a href="#Page_189">189</a>, <a href="#Page_344">344</a></li>
-
-<li class="ifrst">U</li>
-
-<li class="indx">Underscoring, <a href="#Page_26">26</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Ureters, <a href="#Page_253">253</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Urethra, <a href="#Page_253">253</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Use of adjuncts, <a href="#Page_315">315</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Uterus, <a href="#Page_254">254</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Uteroversion, <a href="#Page_345">345</a></li>
-
-<li class="ifrst">V</li>
-
-<li class="indx">Vagina, <a href="#Page_254">254</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Valvular disease, <a href="#Page_345">345</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Variations in number of vertebrae, <a href="#Page_60">60</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Varieties of subluxation, <a href="#Page_80">80</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Varicocele, <a href="#Page_345">345</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Varicose veins, <a href="#Page_345">345</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Vermiform appendix, <a href="#Page_253">253</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Vertebrae, <a href="#Page_16">16</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">cervical, <a href="#Page_16">16</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">dorsal, <a href="#Page_16">16</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">lumbar, <a href="#Page_16">16</a></li>
-<li class="isub1">variations in number of, <a href="#Page_16">16</a>, <a href="#Page_60">60</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Vertebral palpation, <a href="#Page_15">15</a>, <a href="#Page_295">295</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Vertebra prominens, <a href="#Page_17">17</a>, <a href="#Page_19">19</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Vital energy, <a href="#Page_169">169</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Visceral nerves, <a href="#Page_239">239</a>, <a href="#Page_253">253</a></li>
-
-<li class="ifrst">W</li>
-
-<li class="indx">Waiting room, <a href="#Page_280">280</a></li>
-
-<li class="indx">Worry, <a href="#Page_201">201</a></li>
-</ul>
-</div></div>
-
-<div class="chapter"><div class="transnote">
-<h2 class="nobreak p1"><a id="Transcribers_Notes"></a>Transcriber’s Notes</h2>
-
-<p>Punctuation, hyphenation, and spelling were made consistent when a predominant
-preference was found in this book; otherwise they were not changed.</p>
-
-<p>Simple typographical errors were corrected; occasional unbalanced
-quotation marks retained.</p>
-
-<p>Ambiguous hyphens at the ends of lines were retained.</p>
-
-<p>The hierarchy of the Table of Contents has been used as the
-guide to the rest of the book, even though the two sometimes
-differ.</p>
-
-<p>Index not checked for proper alphabetization or correct page references.</p>
-
-<p>Page <a href="#Page_26">26</a>: “P R S” has an underline below “P” and a double-underline
-below “R”.</p>
-
-<p>Page <a href="#Page_34">34</a>: “flexed far toward” perhaps should be “forward”.</p>
-
-<p>Page <a href="#Page_79">79</a>: “as well all the details” may be missing “as”
-after “well”.</p>
-
-<p>Page <a href="#Page_117">117</a>: “all vertebra above, so to speak” perhaps should
-be “vertebrae”.</p>
-
-<p>Page <a href="#Page_147">147</a>: “this move is predicated” was printed as “this more
-was predicated”; changed here.</p>
-
-<p>Page <a href="#Page_158">158</a>: “Posterior, right, inferior—P. R. I.” was printed
-as “P. R. L.”; changed here.</p>
-
-<p>Page <a href="#Page_187">187</a>: “but is claimed” probably should be “but it is claimed”.</p>
-
-<p>Page <a href="#Page_307">307</a>: “has been builded” was printed that way.</p>
-</div></div>
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-<pre>
-
-
-
-
-
-End of the Project Gutenberg EBook of Technic and Practice of Chiropractic, by
-Joy Maxwell Loban
-
-*** END OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK TECHNIC AND PRACTICE ***
-
-***** This file should be named 54008-h.htm or 54008-h.zip *****
-This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
- http://www.gutenberg.org/5/4/0/0/54008/
-
-Produced by Turgut Dincer, Charlie Howard, and the Online
-Distributed Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net (This
-file was produced from images generously made available
-by The Internet Archive)
-
-
-Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions
-will be renamed.
-
-Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no
-one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation
-(and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without
-permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules,
-set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to
-copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to
-protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project
-Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you
-charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you
-do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the
-rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose
-such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and
-research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do
-practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is
-subject to the trademark license, especially commercial
-redistribution.
-
-
-
-*** START: FULL LICENSE ***
-
-THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
-PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
-
-To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
-distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
-(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
-Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project
-Gutenberg-tm License (available with this file or online at
-http://gutenberg.org/license).
-
-
-Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works
-
-1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
-and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
-(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
-the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy
-all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession.
-If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the
-terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or
-entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8.
-
-1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
-used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
-agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
-things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
-paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement
-and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
-works. See paragraph 1.E below.
-
-1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the Foundation"
-or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the
-collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an
-individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are
-located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from
-copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative
-works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg
-are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project
-Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by
-freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of
-this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with
-the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by
-keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project
-Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others.
-
-1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
-what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in
-a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check
-the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement
-before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or
-creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project
-Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning
-the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United
-States.
-
-1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
-
-1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate
-access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently
-whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the
-phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the phrase "Project
-Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed,
-copied or distributed:
-
-This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
-almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
-re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
-with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org/license
-
-1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived
-from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is
-posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied
-and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees
-or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work
-with the phrase "Project Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the
-work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1
-through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the
-Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or
-1.E.9.
-
-1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
-with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
-must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional
-terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked
-to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the
-permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work.
-
-1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
-License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
-work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
-
-1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
-electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
-prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
-active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm License.
-
-1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
-compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any
-word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or
-distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than
-"Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official version
-posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.org),
-you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a
-copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon
-request, of the work in its original "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other
-form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm
-License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
-
-1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
-performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
-unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
-
-1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
-access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided
-that
-
-- You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
- the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
- you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is
- owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he
- has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the
- Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments
- must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you
- prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax
- returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and
- sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the
- address specified in Section 4, "Information about donations to
- the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation."
-
-- You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
- you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
- does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
- License. You must require such a user to return or
- destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium
- and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of
- Project Gutenberg-tm works.
-
-- You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any
- money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
- electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days
- of receipt of the work.
-
-- You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
- distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
-
-1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set
-forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from
-both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael
-Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the
-Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
-
-1.F.
-
-1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
-effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
-public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm
-collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
-works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain
-"Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or
-corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual
-property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a
-computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by
-your equipment.
-
-1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
-of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
-liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
-fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
-LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
-PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
-TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
-LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
-INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
-DAMAGE.
-
-1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
-defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
-receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
-written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
-received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with
-your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with
-the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a
-refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity
-providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to
-receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy
-is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further
-opportunities to fix the problem.
-
-1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
-in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS' WITH NO OTHER
-WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
-WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
-
-1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
-warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages.
-If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the
-law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be
-interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by
-the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any
-provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions.
-
-1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
-trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
-providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance
-with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production,
-promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works,
-harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees,
-that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do
-or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm
-work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any
-Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause.
-
-
-Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
-electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers
-including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists
-because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from
-people in all walks of life.
-
-Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
-assistance they need, are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
-goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
-remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
-and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations.
-To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
-and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4
-and the Foundation web page at http://www.pglaf.org.
-
-
-Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive
-Foundation
-
-The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
-501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
-state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
-Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
-number is 64-6221541. Its 501(c)(3) letter is posted at
-http://pglaf.org/fundraising. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg
-Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent
-permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
-
-The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S.
-Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered
-throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at
-809 North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887, email
-business@pglaf.org. Email contact links and up to date contact
-information can be found at the Foundation's web site and official
-page at http://pglaf.org
-
-For additional contact information:
- Dr. Gregory B. Newby
- Chief Executive and Director
- gbnewby@pglaf.org
-
-
-Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
-Literary Archive Foundation
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
-spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
-increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
-freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
-array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
-($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
-status with the IRS.
-
-The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
-charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
-States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
-considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
-with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
-where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To
-SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any
-particular state visit http://pglaf.org
-
-While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
-have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
-against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
-approach us with offers to donate.
-
-International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
-any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
-outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
-
-Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
-methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
-ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations.
-To donate, please visit: http://pglaf.org/donate
-
-
-Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
-works.
-
-Professor Michael S. Hart is the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm
-concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared
-with anyone. For thirty years, he produced and distributed Project
-Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support.
-
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
-editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S.
-unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily
-keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition.
-
-
-Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility:
-
- http://www.gutenberg.org
-
-This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
-including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
-subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
-
-
-</pre>
-
-</body>
-</html>
diff --git a/old/54008-h/images/cover.jpg b/old/54008-h/images/cover.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 56e87a8..0000000
--- a/old/54008-h/images/cover.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54008-h/images/i_032.jpg b/old/54008-h/images/i_032.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index af3e378..0000000
--- a/old/54008-h/images/i_032.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54008-h/images/i_046.jpg b/old/54008-h/images/i_046.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index cf127ad..0000000
--- a/old/54008-h/images/i_046.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54008-h/images/i_048.jpg b/old/54008-h/images/i_048.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 3b3d0ca..0000000
--- a/old/54008-h/images/i_048.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54008-h/images/i_051.jpg b/old/54008-h/images/i_051.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index ba36f88..0000000
--- a/old/54008-h/images/i_051.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54008-h/images/i_069.jpg b/old/54008-h/images/i_069.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 23dec6e..0000000
--- a/old/54008-h/images/i_069.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54008-h/images/i_072.jpg b/old/54008-h/images/i_072.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 9353192..0000000
--- a/old/54008-h/images/i_072.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54008-h/images/i_099.jpg b/old/54008-h/images/i_099.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index efe4b5e..0000000
--- a/old/54008-h/images/i_099.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54008-h/images/i_101.jpg b/old/54008-h/images/i_101.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index bf09e2e..0000000
--- a/old/54008-h/images/i_101.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54008-h/images/i_102.jpg b/old/54008-h/images/i_102.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 733b897..0000000
--- a/old/54008-h/images/i_102.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54008-h/images/i_108.jpg b/old/54008-h/images/i_108.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 50d7d2f..0000000
--- a/old/54008-h/images/i_108.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54008-h/images/i_110.jpg b/old/54008-h/images/i_110.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 3ac018a..0000000
--- a/old/54008-h/images/i_110.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54008-h/images/i_113.jpg b/old/54008-h/images/i_113.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index b7db914..0000000
--- a/old/54008-h/images/i_113.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54008-h/images/i_115.jpg b/old/54008-h/images/i_115.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index ffab43e..0000000
--- a/old/54008-h/images/i_115.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54008-h/images/i_116.jpg b/old/54008-h/images/i_116.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index fa048d3..0000000
--- a/old/54008-h/images/i_116.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54008-h/images/i_117.jpg b/old/54008-h/images/i_117.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 2106a89..0000000
--- a/old/54008-h/images/i_117.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54008-h/images/i_119.jpg b/old/54008-h/images/i_119.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index be7e795..0000000
--- a/old/54008-h/images/i_119.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54008-h/images/i_120.jpg b/old/54008-h/images/i_120.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 27850db..0000000
--- a/old/54008-h/images/i_120.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54008-h/images/i_121.jpg b/old/54008-h/images/i_121.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index f936110..0000000
--- a/old/54008-h/images/i_121.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54008-h/images/i_122.jpg b/old/54008-h/images/i_122.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 903bc8d..0000000
--- a/old/54008-h/images/i_122.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54008-h/images/i_124.jpg b/old/54008-h/images/i_124.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 587b167..0000000
--- a/old/54008-h/images/i_124.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54008-h/images/i_127.jpg b/old/54008-h/images/i_127.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index c0bfc25..0000000
--- a/old/54008-h/images/i_127.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54008-h/images/i_128.jpg b/old/54008-h/images/i_128.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index aa021a0..0000000
--- a/old/54008-h/images/i_128.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54008-h/images/i_134.jpg b/old/54008-h/images/i_134.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 7ab98ae..0000000
--- a/old/54008-h/images/i_134.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54008-h/images/i_136.jpg b/old/54008-h/images/i_136.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 89a248e..0000000
--- a/old/54008-h/images/i_136.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54008-h/images/i_139.jpg b/old/54008-h/images/i_139.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index f753401..0000000
--- a/old/54008-h/images/i_139.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54008-h/images/i_141.jpg b/old/54008-h/images/i_141.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index c3d1579..0000000
--- a/old/54008-h/images/i_141.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54008-h/images/i_145.jpg b/old/54008-h/images/i_145.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 0e7a548..0000000
--- a/old/54008-h/images/i_145.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54008-h/images/i_147.jpg b/old/54008-h/images/i_147.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index f31f4e9..0000000
--- a/old/54008-h/images/i_147.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54008-h/images/i_150.jpg b/old/54008-h/images/i_150.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 8311789..0000000
--- a/old/54008-h/images/i_150.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54008-h/images/i_152.jpg b/old/54008-h/images/i_152.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 65448d2..0000000
--- a/old/54008-h/images/i_152.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54008-h/images/i_222.jpg b/old/54008-h/images/i_222.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 98de96a..0000000
--- a/old/54008-h/images/i_222.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/54008-h/images/i_250.jpg b/old/54008-h/images/i_250.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index bf98ff2..0000000
--- a/old/54008-h/images/i_250.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ